*/A
THE
EXPEDITION TO BOBIEO
OF
H. M. S. D I D
THE SUPPRESSION OF PIRACY:
WITH EXTRACTS FROM
THE JOURNAL OF JAMES BROOKE, ESQ.,
OF SARAWAK,
(Now Agent for the British Government in Borneo).
CAPTAIN THE HON, HENRY REPPEL, B, N,
NEW YORK:
HARPER & BROTHERS, PUBLISHERS,
FRANKLIN SQUARE.
1855.
;
* t
'. . -r
TO
THE EARL OF ALBEMARLE.
MY DEAR FATHER,
You could scarcely have anticipated, from
my profession, the dedication of a book in tes-
timony of my gratitude and affection ; but, hav-
ing had the good fortune to acquire the friend-
ship of Mr. JAMES BROOKE, and to be intrusted
by him with a narrative of his extraordinary
career in that part of the world where the ser-
vices of the ship I commanded were required, I
am not without a hope that the accompanying
pages may be found worthy of your approval,
and not altogether uninteresting to my country.
I am, my dear father,
Your affectionate son,
HENRY KEPPEL.
Droxfard, January, 1846.
PREFACE
TO
THE FIRST EDITION.
THE visit of her majesty's ship Dido to Bor-
neo, and her services against the pirates, oc-
cupy comparatively so small a portion of this
volume, that some excuse may be necessary
for its leading title.
It was only by undertaking to make the ac-
count of them part of the narrative, that I could
prevail upon my friend Mr. Brooke to intrust
me with his Journal for any public object ; and
when I looked at his novel and important po-
sition as a ruler in Borneo, and was aware how
much of European curiosity was attached to
it, I felt it impossible not to consent to an ar-
rangement which should enable me to trace
the remarkable career through which he had
reached that elevation. I hope, therefore, to
be considered as having conquered my own
disinclination to be the relater of events in
Which I was concerned, in order to overcome
the scruples which he entertained against being
the author of the autobiographical sketch, em-
bracing so singular a portion of his life, which
I have extracted from the rough notes confided
to me.
That his diffidence in this respect was
groundless will, I trust, be apparent from these
A2
VI PREFACE TO FIRST EDITION.
pages, however indifferently I may have exe-
cuted my unusual task, during a long home-
ward sea-voyage ; and, from the growing in-
terest which has arisen throughout the country
for intelligence on the subject of Borneo and
the adjacent archipelago, I venture also to in-
dulge the belief that the general information
will be deemed no unfit adjunct to the story of
personal adventure.
ADVERTISEMENT
TO
THE SECOND EDITION.
THE text of this edition has been carefully
revised, and has undergone numerous verbal
alterations ; some portions of it have been
transposed, and a few additions have been
made to the work. [In the American edition,
a few pages of matter, of no interest to Ameri-
can readers, have been omitted from the Ap-
pendix.]
CONTENTS.
CHAPTER I.
The Chinese War having terminated, Captain Keppel in H.M.S.
Dido appointed to command of the Straits station. Meeting
with Mr. Brooke. Sketch of his life. Mr. Brooke's outward
voyage in the Royalist. Touch at Singapore. Arrival off the
coast of Borneo. Land at the island of Talang Talang. Inter-
course with the Bandar Page I
CHAPTER II.
Progress : observations. Description of the coast of Borneo.
Account, &c. of a Pangeran. Arrival at Sarawak. Meetings
with Rajah Muda Hassim, and conversations. The Town.
Interchange of visits and presents. Excursion to Dyak tribes.
Resources and commercial products .... 14
CHAPTER III.
Second Cruise : up the River Lundu. The Sibnowan Dyaks.
Their Town of Tungong. Their Physical Proportions, and
Words of their Language. Their Customs. Skull-trophies.
Religious Ceremonies arid Opinions. Their Ornaments. Ap-
pearance of both Sexes. Dress and Morals. Missionary Pros-
pects of Conversion, and Elevation in the Social Scale. Gov-
ernment, Laws, and Punishments. Dances. Iron Manufac-
turing. Chinese Settlement. Excursion continued . 32
CHAPTER IV.
rlfinewed intercourse with the Rajah. Prospects of trade. Ou-
rang-outang, and other animals. The two sorts of mlas. Des-
cription of the Rajah, his suite, and Panglimas, &c. The char-
acter of the natives. Leave Sarawak. Songi Dyaks. Visit
Seriff Sahib. Buyat tongue. Attack by pirates. Sail for Sin-
gapore 45
CHAPTER V.
Summary of information obtained during this Visit to Borneo.
Geographical and topographical observations. Produce. Va-
rious Dyak tribes. Natural history. Language. Origin of
Races. Sail from Singapore. Celebes. Face of the country.
-Waterfall 59
Vill CONTENTS.
CHAPTER VI.
Dain Matara, the Bugis. Excursions in Celebes. Dispute with
the Rajah's son-in-law. Baboon shot. Appearance of the
country. Visit the Resident. Barometrical observations.
The Bugis. Geography. Coral reefs. Visit the Rana of La-
matte. Population and products of the country . Page 72
CHAPTER VII.
Mr. Brooke's second visit to Sarawak. The civil war. Re-
ceives a present of a Dyak boy. Excursion to the seal of war.
Notices of rivers, and settlements on their banks. Deaths
and burials. Reasons for and against remaining at Sar wak.
Dyak visitors. Council of war. Why side with the Rajah.
Mode of constructing forts. State of enemy's and Rajah's
forces. Conduct of the war 87
CHAPTER VIII.
Appearance of the country. Progress of the rebel war. Char-
acter of the Sow and Singe Dyaks. Their belief in augury.
Ruinous effects of protracted warfare. Cowardice and boasting
of the Malays. Council of war. Refuse to attack the enemy's
forts. Rebels propose to treat. The Malays oppose. Set out
to attack the rebels, but frustrated by our allies. Assailed by
the rebels. Put them to flight. Treat with them. They
surrender. Intercede with the Rajah for their lives. Renewed
treachery of the Malays 100
CHAPTER IX.
Retrospect of Mr. Brooke's proceedings and prospects. Visit of
a pirate fleet. "^tercourse with the chief leaders, and other
characteristic incidents. War dances. Use of opium. Story
of Si Tundo. Preparations for trading. Conditions of the
cession of Sarawak 1 19
CHAPTER X.
Obstacles in the way of coming to a satisfactory conclusion with
Muda Hassiin. The law of force and reprisal considered.
Capabilities of Sarawak. Account of Sarebus and Sakarran
pirates. Excursion up the river. Visit to the Singe Dyaks.
Description of Mr. Brooke's house at Sarawak. Circum-
stances relating to the wreck off Borneo Proper . . 135
CHAPTER XI.
Return of the Royalist from Borneo Proper with intelligence
of the sufferers from the wreck of the Sultana. Effect of the
arrival of the Diana on the negotiations for their release. Out-
CONTENTS. XI
amined. Returns to Sarawak. Visit of Lingire, a Sarebus
chief. The Dyaks of Tumma and Bandar Cassim. Meets an
assembly of Malays and Dyaks. Arrival of Lingi, as a deputa-
tion from the Sakarran chiefs. The Malay character. Excur-
sion up the country. Miserable effects of excess in opium-
smoking. Picturesque situation of the Sow village of Ra-at.
Nawang. Feast at Ra-at. Returns home. Conferences
with Dyak chiefs Page 290
CHAPTER XXI.
Mr. Brooke's memorandum on the piracy of the Malayan Archi-
pelago. The measures requisite for its suppression, and for
the consequent extension of British commerce in that important
locality 302
CHAPTER XXII.
Arrival of Captain Bethune and Mr. Wise. Mr. Brooke appoint-
ed her Majesty's Agent in Borneo. Sails for Borneo Prop-
er. Muda Hassim's measures for the suppression of piracy.
Defied by Seriff Houseman. Audience of the Sultan, Muda
Hassira, and the Pangerans. Visit to Labuan. Comparative
eligibility of Labuan and Balambangan for settlement. Coal
discovered in Labuan. Mr. Brooke goes to Singapore and vis-
its Admiral Sir T. Cochrane. The upas-tree. Proceeds with
the Admiral to Borneo Proper. Punishment of Pangeran Uspp.
The battle of Malludu. Seriff Houseman obliged tofly. Visit
to Balambangan. Mr. Brooke parts with the Admiral, and goes
to Borneo Proper. An attempt of Pangeran Usop defeated.
His flight, and pursuit by Pangeran Budrudeen. Triumphant
reception of Mr. Brooke in Borneo. Returns to Sarawak 314
CHAPTER XXIII. **,.
Borneo, its geographical bounds and leading divisions. British
settlements in 1775. The province of Sarawak formally ceded
by the sultan in perpetuity to Mr. Brooke its present ruler.
General view of the Dyaks, the aborigines of Borneo. The
Dyaks of Sarawak, and adjoining tribes ; their past oppression
and present position 329
CHAPTER XXIV.
Proposed British settlement on the northwest coast of Borneo,
and occupation of the island of Labuan. Governor Crawfurd's
opinions thereon 345
Concluding Observations 355
Postscript to Second Edition 859
Xll CONTENTS.
APPENDIX
I. Natural History. Mr. Brooke'* report on the Mias Page 365
II. Philology 370
III. Proposed Exploring Expedition to the Asiatic Archipel-
ago, by James Brooke, Esq. 1838 .... 373
IV. Sketch of Borneo, or Pulo Kalamantan, by J. Hunt, Eq. 381
V. Extracts from the late Mr. Williamson's Journal 409
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO,
CHAPTER I.
The Chinese War having terminated, Captain Keppel in H.M.S.
Dido appointed to command of the Straits station. Meeting
with Mr. Brooke. Sketch of his life. Mr. Brooke's outward
voyage in the Royalist. Touch at Singapore. Arrival off the
coast of Borneo. Land at the island of Talang Talang. Inter-
course with the Bandar.
AT the conclusion of the Chinese war, the comman-
der-in-chief, Vice- Admiral Sir William Parker, ordered
the Dido to the Malacca Straits, a station in which was
included the island of Borneo ; our principal duties being
the protection of trade, and suppression of piracy.
In the month of March, 1843, while at Pinang, I
received intimation from the governor of various daring
acts of piracy having been committed near the Borneon
coast on some vessels trading to Singapore. I proceeded
to that port ; and, while undergoing a partial refit, made
the acquaintance of Mr. Brooke, who accepted my invi-
tation to return to Sarawak in the Dido ; and I could
not have visited Borneo with a more agreeable or intel-
ligent companion.
The objects of Mr. Brooke in leaving England, the
reasons which induced him to settle at Sarawak, and the
circumstances which have led him to take so deep an
interest in promoting the civilization and improving the
condition of the singular people whom he has adopted,
form indeed a story veiy unlike the common course of
events in modern times.
But before illustrating these circumstances from his
own journals, it may be acceptable to sav a few words
1 A
2 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
respecting the individual himself, and his extraordinary
career. I am indebted to a mutual friend, acquainted
with him from early years, for the following brief but
interesting outline of his life ; and have only to premise,
that Mr. Brooke is the lineal representative of Sir Robert
Vyner, baronet, and lord mayor of London in the reigp
of Charles II. ; Sir Robert had but one child, a son, Sir
George Vyner, who died childless, and his estate passed
to his heir-at-law, Edith, his father's eldest sister, whose
lineal descendant is our friend. Sir Robert was renowned
for his loyalty to his sovereign, to whom he devoted his
wealth, and to whose memory he raised a monument.
" Mr. Brooke was the second, and is now the only
surviving son of the late Thomas Brooke, Esq., of the
civil service of the East India Company ; was born on
the 29th April, 1803; went out to India as a cadet,
where he held advantageous situations, and distinguished
himself by his gallantry in the Burmese war. He was
shot through the body in an action with the Burmese,
received the thanks ol the government, and returned to
England for the recovery of his prostrated strength. He
resumed his station, but shortly afterward relinquished
the service, and in search of health and amusement left.
Calcutta for China in 1830. In this voyage, while going
up the China seas, he saw for the first time the islands
of the Asiatic Archipelago islands of vast importance
and unparalleled beauty lying neglected, and almost
unknown. He inquired and read, and became convinced
that Borneo and the Eastern Isles afforded an open field
for enterprise and research. To carry to the Malay
races, so long the terror of the European meivhant-
vessols, the blessings of civilization, to suppress piracy,
and extirpate the slave-trade, became his hum;ine and
generous objects ; and from that hour the energies of
his .powerful mind were devoted to this one pursuit.
Often foiled, often disappointed, but animated with a
perseverance and enthusiasm which defied all obstacle,
he was not until 1838 enabled to set sail from England
on his darling project. The intervening years had been
devoted to preparation and inquiry; a year spent in the
Mediterranean h;id tested his vessel, the, Royalist, ;md
(.:ti|>'<-! c!\ li.nl In' I inlii-cl )ii
KXPEDITION TO BORNEO. .i
and calculated on contingencies, that the least sanguine
of his friends felt as he left the shore, hazardous and
unusual as the enterprise appeared to be, that he had
omitted nothing to insure a successful issue. ' I go,'
said he, ' to awake the spirit of slumbering philanthropy
with regard to these islands ; to carry Sir Stamford
Raffles' views in Java over the whole archipelago. For-
tune and life I give freely ; and if I fail in the attempt,
I shall not have lived wholly in vain.'
" In the admiration I feel for him, I may farther be
permitted to add, that if any man ever possessed in him-
self the resources and means by which such noble designs
were to be achieved, that man was James Brooke ! Of
the most enlarged views ; truthful and generous ; quick
to acquire and appreciate ; excelling in eveiy manly sport
and exercise ; elegant and accomplished ; ever accessi-
ble ; and above all, prompt and determined to redress
injury and relieve misfortune, he was of all others the
best qualified to impress the native mind with the high-
est opinion of the English character. How he has suc-
ceeded, the influence he has acquired, and the benefits
he has conferred, his own uncolored narrative, contained
in the following pages, best declares, and impresses on
the world a lasting lesson of the good that attends indi-
vidual enterprise, when well directed, of which every
Englishman may feel justly proud."
Such is the sketch of Mr. Brooke by one well com-
petent to judge of that to which he bears witness. In
pursuance of the mission thus eloquently and truly de-
scribed, that gentleman left his native shores in the year
1838, in his yacht the Royalist schooner, of 142 tons,
belonging to the Royal Yacht Squadron, with a crew of
upward of twenty men. His general views were dis-
tinct and certain ; but the details into which they shaped
themselves have been so entirely guided by unforeseen
occurrences, that it is necessary to look to his first visit
to Borneo for their explanation ; and in order to do so, I
must refer to his private journal, which he kindly con-
fided to me, after I had in vain tried to persuade him to
take upon himself the publication of its contents, so rich
in new and interesting intelligence.
TO
EXTRACTS FROM MK. BROOKE'S JOURNAL,
" I had for some years turned my mind to the geog-
raphy of the Indian Archipelago, and cherished an nr-
dent desire to become better acquainted with a country
combining the richest natural productions with an unri-
valed degree of luxuriant beauty. Circumstances lor a
time prevented my entering on this field for enterprise
and research; and when the barriers were removed, i
had many preparations to make and some difficulties to
overcome.
' In an expedition conducted by government, the line
of discipline is so distinctly understood, and its infringe-
ment so strictly punished, that small hazard is incurred
of any inconvenience arising from such a source. With
an individual, however, there is no such assurance, for
he cannot appeal to the articles of war ; and the ordinary
legal enactments for the protection of the manner will
not enable him to effect objects so far removed beyond
the scope of the laws. I was fully aware that many
would go, but that few might stay ; for while a \
of discovery in pros pec In possesses great attracti<
the imagination, the hardship, danger, and thousand
other rude realities, soon dissipate the illusion, and leave
the aspirant longing for that home he should never have
quitted. In like manner, seamen can be procured in
abundance, but cannot be kept from desertion whenever
any matter goes wrong ; and the total previous ignorance
of their characters and dispositions renders this more
likely, as the admission of one 'black sheep' goes far to
taint die entire crew.
" These considerations fully convinced me that it was
-ury to form men to my purpose, and, by a line of
steady and kind conduct, to raise up a personal re.ua n I
for myself and attachment for the vessel, which could
not be expected in ordinary cases. In pursuance of this
object, I was nearly three years in preparing a crew to
my mind, and gradually moulding them to consider the
hardest fate or misfortune under my command as better
than the ordinary service in a merchant-vessel. How
far I have succeeded remains yot to bo proved ; but 1
cannot help Imping that I have nii^'d the rlunv
EXPEDITION TO liOKNKo. 5
many, and have rendered all happy and contented since
they have been with me ; and certain am I that no meu
can do their duty more cheerfully or willingly than the
crew of the Royalist.
44 1 may pass over in silence my motives for under-
taking so long and arduous a voyage ; and it will be suf-
ficient to say, that I have been firmly convinced of its
beneficial tendency in adding to knowledge, increasing
trade, and spreading Christianity. The prospectus of
the undertaking was published in the Geographical
Journal, vol. viii. part hi., of 1838, when my prepara-
tions for sea were nearly complete. I had previously
avoided making any public mention of my intentions, for
praise before performance is disgusting ; and I knew I
should be exposed to prying curiosity, desirous of know-
ing what I did not know myself.
" On the 27th October, 1838, the Royalist left the
river ; and, after a succession of heavy gales, finally
quitted the land on the 16th December. I may here
state some farther particulars, to enable my readers to
become better acquainted with her and her equipment.
The Royalist, as already noticed, belonged to the Royal
Yacht Squadron, which in foreign ports admits her to
the same privileges as a man-of-war, and enables her to
carry a white ensign. She sails fast, is conveniently
fitted up, is armed with six six-pounders, a number of
swivels, and small arms of all sorts, carries four boats,
and provisions for four months. Her principal defect is
being too sharp in the floor, which, in case of taking the
ground, greatly increases the risk ; but I comfort myself
with the reflection that a knowledge of this will lead to
redoubled precaution to prevent such a disaster. She
is withal a good sea-boat, and as well calculated for the
service as could be desired.
" Most of her hands had been with me for three years
or upward, and the rest were highly recommended.
They are, almost without exception, young, able-bodied,
and active fit in all respects for enduring hardship and
privation, or the more dangerous reverse of self-indul-
gence, and willing to follow the fortunes of the Royalist
and her commander through all the various shades of
good or evil fortune which may betide. A fine, though
A2
6 EXPEDITION TO
slow passage took us to Rio Janeiro, which presents
features of natural beauty rarely equaled. The wea-
ther during our stay was hot in the extreme, and very
wet, which marred, in some degree, the satisfaction I
should otherwise have enjoyed in wandering about this
picturesque countiy. I passed ten days, however, very
agreeably, and departed with some regret from this brief
visit to America and from my friends (if they will so
allow me to call them) on board H.M.S. Calliope. I
must not omit to mention that, during my stay, I visited
a slaver, three of which (prizes to our men-of-war) lay
in the harbor. It is a most loathsome and disgusting
sight. Men, women, and children the aged and the
infant crowded into a space as confined as the pens in
Smithfield, not, however, to be released by death at the
close of the day, but to linger, diseased and festering,
for weeks or months, and then to be discharged into
perpetual and hopeless slavery. I wish I could say that
our measures tended toward the abolition of this detest-
able traffic ; but from all that I could learn and observe,
I am forced to confess that the exertions made to abolish
slavery are of no avail in this country, and never will be
till harsher means are resorted to.
" There are points of view in which this traffic wears
a more cheering aspect ; for any one comparing the
puny Portuguese or the bastard Brazilian with the ath-
letic negro, cannot but allow that the ordinary changes
and chances of time will place this fine country in the
hands of the latter race. The negro will be fit to culti-
vate the soil, and will thrive beneath the tropical sun of
the Brazils. The enfeebled white man grows more en-
feebled and more degenerate with each succeeding gen-
eration, and languishes in a clime which nature never
designed him to inhabit. The time will come when the
debased and suffering negroes shall possess this fertile
land, and when some share of justice shall be awarded
to their cheerful tempers and ardent minds.
"Quitting: Rio on the 9th, we cruised for a day or
two with H.M.S. Calliope and Grecian ; and on the llth,
parting company, prosecuted our voyage for the Cape
of.Good Hope."
The next notice runs thus : " The aspect of Trig-
KXPEDITION TO BORN !:>. 7
tan d'Acuuha is bold even to grandeur. The peak, tow-
ering upward of eight thousand feet above the sea, is
inferior only to Teneriffe, and the precipitous cliffs over-
hanging the beach are a fitting base for such a mountain.
1 regretted not being able to examine this island for many
reasons, but principally, perhaps, on account of the birds
of the South Atlantic I had hoped to collect there, many
of which are so often seen by voyagers, yet so little
known and so vaguely described.
" On the 29th March, after being detained a fortnight
{at the Cape of Good Hope] by such weather as no one
could regret, we sailed again in a southeaster, and after
a passage of six weeks reached Java Head.
" I had been suffering for some time under a severe
indisposition, and consequently hailed the termination
of our voyage with double satisfaction, for I greatly re-
quired rest and quiet two things impossible to be had
on ship-board. From Java Head we glided slowly
through Prince's Strait, and coasting along the island,
dropped our anchor in Anjer Roads. The scenery of
this coast is extremely lovely, and comprises every fea-
ture which can heighten the picturesque ; noble moun-
tains, a lake-like sea, and deeply indented coast-line,
rocks, islets, and, above all, a vegetation so luxuriant that
the eye never wearies with gazing on its matchless tints.
Anjer combines all these beauties, and possesses the in-
calculable advantage of being within a moderate ride of
the refreshing coolness of the hills. We here procured
water and provisions in abundance, being daily visited
by crowds of canoes filled with necessaries or curiosities.
Fowls, eggs, yams, cocoa-nuts, and sweet potatoes, were
mixed with monkeys of various sorts, paroquets, squir-
rels, shells, and similar temptations on the stranger's
purse or wardrobe. Great was the bartering for old clothes,
^handkerchiefs, and hats ; and great the number of use-
less and noisy animals we received in exchange. Great,
too, was the merriment aboard, and the excitement
when the canoes first came. The transition from the
monotony of a sea-life to the loquacious bustle of barter
with a half-civilized people is so sudden, that the mind
at once feels in a strange land, and the commonest pro-
ductions proclaim the luxuriant climes of the tropics.
ft EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
Until this impression is made, we hardly know why we
have been sailing onward for four months past, so quiet
and unvaiying is the daily tenor of a life aboard ship.
" 1st June, Singapore. On reaching Singapore I was
most hospitably received by the kind inhabitants, and
took up my abode with Mr. Scott. The quiet and re-
pose of my present life, the gentle ride in the cool of
the morning and evening drive after an early dinner, are
already restoring my shattered strength, and I trust
soon to be enabled to prosecute my farther undertaking.
In the mean time the Royalist is undergoing a refit after
ber passage, and, like her owner, is daily improving in,
good looks.
" I could say much of Singapore, for it is the pivot of
the liberal system in the Archipelago, and owes its pros-
perity to the enlightened measures of Sir Stamford
Raffles. The situation is happily chosen, the climate
healthy, the commerce unshackled, and taxation light ;
and these advantages have attracted the vessels of alt
the neighboring nations to bring their produce to this
market in order to exchange it for the manufactures of
England.
"The extent of the island is about 27 miles by 11
broad. The town of Singapore stands on the south-
side, facing the shores of Battam, and is intersected by
a salt-water stream, which separates the native town
from the pleasant residences of the European inhabi-
tants ; the latter stretch along the beach, and cover a
space which extends to the foot of a slight eminence, on
which stands the governor's house. Off the town lie
the shipping of various countries, presenting a most pic-
turesque and striking appearance. The man-of-war,
the steamer, and the merchant-vessels of the civilized
world, contrast with the huge, misshapen, and bedi-
zened arks of China! The awkward prahus of the
Bugis are surrounded by the light boats of the island,
The semi-civilized Cochin-Chinese, with their vessels
of antiquated European construction, deserve attention
from this important step toward improvement; and tin
rude prahus of some parts of Borneo claim it from their
exhibiting the early dawn of maritime adventure.
" 27th July After various causes of delay 1
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 9
on this day from Singapore. When I contrast my state
of health at my arrival with what it now is, I may well
be thankful for the improvement. Every kindness and
hospitality has been shown me.
" On Saturday at noon we got under weigh with a
light breeze, and stoed down the Strait on our way to
Borneo.
" 28th. In the morning we were well out in the
China Sea, running six knots per hour, N. I E. Lines
of discolored water were seen about us, and about 11 A.M.
we entered a field some two miles long and 400 yards
wide. The consistence of this dirty mass was that of
pea-soup, which it likewise resembled in color ; and I
doubt not the white water of the China Sea (vide Nau-
tical Magazine) is referable to this appearance seen in
the night, as may the report of rocks, <kc. The Malays
on board called it ' sara,' and declared it to come from
the rivers. On examination it appeared, when magni-
fied, somewhat like a grain of barley or corn. The par-
ticles were extremely minute, soft, and, when rubbed
between the fingers, emitted a strong smell like paint-
oil ; a potent odor arose while passing through the thick
patch.
" It may not be superfluous to recount here the prep-
arations I have made for this trip to Borneo, or my in-
tentions when I get there. Borneo Proper, once the
seat of piracy, which few vessels could approach with
safety, is now under the sway of the Rajah Muda Has-
sim. The character given this rajah by many persons
who know and have traded with him is good, and he is
spoken of as generous and humane, and greatly inclined
to the .English. These reasons have induced me to
abandon my intention of proceeding direct to Malludu
Bay, and during the season of the southwest monsoon to
confine myself principally to the northwest coast. Muda
Hassim being at present reported to be at Sarawak, I
propose, after taking a running sketch of the coast from
Tanjong Api, to enter the river of that name, and pro-
ceed as far as the town.
"I believe I have availed myself of every means
within my reach to render my visit agreeable to the
rajah. I carry with me many presents which are re-
10 EXI'KDYTloN TO BOH NT.".
ported to be to his liking ; gaudy silks of Surat, scarlet
cloth, stumped velvet, gunpowder, &c., beside a largo
quantity of confectionery and sweets, such as preserved
ginger, jams, dates, syrups, and to wind up all, a huge
box of China toys for his children ! I have likewise
taken coarse nankeen to the amount of 100/. value, as
the best circulating medium in the country. Beside
the above mentioned preparations, I carry letters from
the government of Singapore, to state, as fur as can be
done, the objects of my voyage, and to caution the rajah
to take every care of my safety and that of my men.
The Board of Commerce have at the same time entrust-
ed me with a letter and present to him, to thank him for
his humanity to the crew of an English vessel wrecked
on this coast. The story, as I had it from the parties
shipwrecked, is highly creditable to his humanity. The
vessel, called the Napoleon, was wrecked on the bar of
Sarawak river in the northeast monsoon. The people
were saved with difficulty, and remained in the jungle,
where they were after a time discovered by some Ma-
lays. Muda Hassim, on receiving intelligence of this,
sent down and brought them to his town, collected all
that he could recover from the wreck, clothed them
handsomely, and fed them well for several months, and,
on an opportunity arriving, sent them back to Singapore
free of expense.
"At the same time, however, that I have prepared
to meet the natives as friends, I have not neglected to
strengthen my crew, in case I should find them hostile.
Eight stout men of the Ourang Laut, or men of the sea
(Malays), have been added to the force. They arc an
athletic race, cheerful and willing; and though not sea-
men in our sense of the term, yet well calculated for
this expedition. They pull a good oar, and are invalua-
ble in saving the Europeans the exposure consequent to
wooding and watering. They possess, likewise, the
knowledge of the jungle and its resources, and two of
them have, before been to Sarawak and along the coast.
Beside these, a young gentleman named Williamson
accompanies me as interpreter; and I have fortunately
met with a medical gentleman, Mr. \Vesiennann, a
Dane, who is surgeon for this voyage, Mr. Williams
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 11
having left me at Singapore. With these arrangements
I look without apprehension to the power of the Malays ;
and without relaxing in measures of the strictest vigi-
lance, I shall never sleep less soundly when it comes to
my turn so to do.
" August 1st. I am, then, at length, anchored off the
coast of Borneo ! not under very pleasant circumstances,
for the night is pitchy dark, with thunder, lightning,
rain, and squalls of wind.
" 2d. Squally bad night. This morning, the clouds
clearing away, was delightful, and offered for our view
the majestic scenery of Borneo. At nine got under
weigh, and ran in on an east- by-south course 4 or 5
miles toward Tanjong Api. Came to an anchor about
five miles from the land, and dispatched the boat to take
sights ashore, in order to form a base-line for triangula-
tion. The scenery may really be called majestic. The
low and wooded coast about Tanjong Api is backed by a
mountain called Gunong* Palo, some 2000 feet in height,
which slopes down behind the point and terminates in
a number of hummocks, showing from a distance like
islands.
" The coast, unknown, and represented to abound in
shoals and reefs, is the harbor for pirates of every de-
scription. Here, every man's hand is raised against his
brother man ; and here sometimes the climate wars
upon the excitable European, and lays many a white
face and gallant heart low on the distant strand.
" 3d. Beating between Points Api and Datu. The
bay, as far as we have seen, is free from danger ; the
beach is lined by a feathery row of beautiful casuarinas,
and behind is a tangled jungle, without fine timber;
game is plentiful, from the traces we saw on the sand ;
hogs in great numbers, troops of monkeys, and the print
of an animal with cleft hoofs, either a large deer, tapir,
or cow. We saw no game save a tribe of monkeys, one
of which, a female, I shot, and another quite young,
which we managed to capture alive. The captive,
though the young of the black monkey, is grayish,
with the exception of his extremities, and a stripe of
blnck down his back and tail. Though very young, he
* Gunong, a mountain, part of a chain.
2 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
has already taken food, and we have some hope of pre-
serving his life.
"We witnessed, at the same time, an extraordinary
and fatal leap made by one of these monkeys. Alarmed
by our approach, he sprang from the summit of a high
tree at the branch of one lower, and at some distance.
He leaped short, and came clattering down some sixty
or seventy feet amid the jungle. We were unable to
penetrate to the spot on account of a deep swamp to as-
certain his fate.
" A rivulet flows into the sea not far from where we
landed ; the water is sweet, and of that clear brown
color so common in Ireland. This coast is evidently the
haunt of native prahus, whether piratical or other.
Prints of men's feet were numerous and fresh, and
traces of huts, fires, and parts of boats, some of them
ornamented after their rude fashion. A long pull of five
miles closed the day.
"Sunday, 4th. Performed divine service myself!
manfully overcoming that horror which I have to the
sound of my own voice before an audience. In the
evening landed again more to the westward. Shore
skirted by rocks ; timber noble, and the forest clear of
brushwood, enabling us to penetrate with ease as far as
caution permitted. Traces of wild beasts numerous
and recent, but none discovered. Fresh-water streams,
colored as yesterday, and the trail of an alligator from
one of them to the sea. This dark forest, where the
trees shoot up straight and tall, and are succeeded by
generation after generation varying in stature, but strug-
gling upward, strikes the imagination with pictures
trite yet true. Here the hoary sage of a hundred years
lies moldering beneath your foot, and there the young
sapling shoots beneath the parent shade, and grows in
form and fashion like the parent stem. The towering
few, with heads raised above the general mass, can
scarce be seen through the foliage of those benenth :
but here and there the touch of time h;is cast his with-
ering hand upon their lofify brow, and eVcay has
his work upon the gigantic find unbending trunk. H;i\v
trite and yet how true ! It was thus I meditated in my
walk. The foot of European, I said, has never touched
EXPEDITION TO BOfiNEO. 13
where my loot now presses seldom the native wanders
hero. Here I indeed behold nature fresh from the bo-
som of creation, unchanged by man, and stamped with
the same impress she originally bore ! Here I behold
God's design when He formed this tropical land, and
left its culture and improvement to the agency of man.
The Creator's gift as yet neglected by the creature ;
und yet the time may be confidently looked for when
the axe shall level the forest, and the plow turn the
ground.
" 6th. Made sail this morning, and stood in for an
island called Talang Talang, anchoring about eight miles
distant, and sending a boat to take correct observations
for a base-line.
" Our party found Malays of Sarawak on the island,
who were civil to them, and offered to conduct us up
to-morrow, if we wanted their assistance. The pirates,
both Illanuns and Dyaks, have been gone from the bay
but a few days ; the former seaward, the latter up the
rivers.
" 1th. Morning calm. In the afternoon got under
weigh, and anchored again near the island of Talang
Talang; the smaller one a conical hill bearing south.
The Bandar* of the place came off in his canoe to make
us welcome. He is a young man sent by Rajah Muda
Hassim to collect turtles' eggs, which abound in this vi-
cinity, especially on the larger island. The turtles are
never molested, for fear of their deserting the spot ; and
their eggs, to the amount of five or six thousand, are col-
lected every morning and forwarded at intervals to Sa-
rawak as articles of food.
" Our visitor was extremely polite, and, in common
with other Asiatics, possessed the most pleasing and easy
manners. He assured us of a welcome from his rajah,
and, in their usual phrase, expressed himself that the
rajah's heart would dilate in his bosom at the sight of
us. His dress consisted of trowsers of green cloth, a
dark green velvet jacket, and his sarong round his waist,
thrown gracefully over two krisses, which he wore at
his girdle. His attendants were poorly attired, and
* Pronounced short, for (properly) Bandhara ; a treasurer,
chief steward.
B
14 cxi'KDiTiuN' TO BORNEO.
mostly unarmed a proof of confidence in us, and a de-
sire to assure us of his own friendly intentions. I treat-
ed him with sweetmeats and syrup, and of his own ac-
cord he took a glass of sherry, as did his chief attendant.
On his departure he was presented with three yards of
red cloth, and subsequently with a little tea and gun-
powder."
CHAPTER II
Progress : observations. Description of the coast of Borneo.
Account, &c. of a Pangeran. Arrival at Sarawak. Meetings
with Rajah Muda Hassim, and conversations. The Town.
Interchange of visits and presents Excursion to Dyak tribes.
Resources and commercial products.
I RESUME Mr. Brooke's Journal, which requires no
introductory remark.
" Aug. 8th. A cloudy day, preventing us from taking
our wished- for observations. I made a boat-excursion
round the two islands. The north one is somewhat the
larger ; the southern one, running north and south, con-
sists of two hills joined by a low and narrow neck of
land. The water between these islands is deep, vary-
ing from seven to six fathoms ; but between the smaller
one and the main there are rocks and reefs ; and though
a passage may exist, it would not be advisable for a
vessel to try it. These two small islands possess all the
characteristic beauties of the clime. Formed of brown
granite, with a speck of white sandy beach, and rising
into hills covered with the noblest timber, wreathed with
gigantic creepers. Cream-colored pigeons flit from tree
to tree, and ;m eagle or two soared aloft, watching their
motions. Frigate-birds are numerous; and several
sorts of smaller birds in the bush, difficult to ^et at. A
small species of crocodile, or alligator, was likewise seen :
but wo were not fortunate enough to shoot one. The
natives, when asked whether they were alligators, an-
swered in thf- negative, calling them crocodiles. The tides
appear to be as irregular as tides usually are in a deep
bay. The rise and fall of the tide is about fifteen feet.
" f)fb. After In-pnlsfnpt- t!n mornim:
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 15
and at twelve o'clock the latitude of the smaller Talang
Talang and the ship for a base-line. We yesterday took
the same base-line by sound, firing alternately three
guns from the vessel and three from the shore.
U 10//i. A squall from the northward brought in a
chopping sea in the morning. We were favored with u
visit from another native party, but the chief was in every
respect inferior to our first acquaintance, Bandar Dowat.
" Ilth, Sunday Got under weigh early, after a night
of torrents of rain. The breeze being directly out of
Lundu river, I stood as near it as I could, and then bore
away for Santobong, in order to reach Sarawak. From
Gunong Gading the coast gradually declines, and forms
two points. The first of these is Tanjong Bloungei, near
which, on the right hand, runs a small river, of the same
name. The next point is Tanjong Datu, which shows
prominently from most parts of the bay. From Tanjong
Datu the coast recedes into a bay, and again forms a
low point, which I have christened Tanjong Lundu.
The river Lundu disembogues itself into the bay just
beyond the point of the same name ; and the land on
its far bank forms a bight of considerable depth. The
Lundu is a barred river with but little water ; though,
judging from the opening, it is by no means small. Our
pilots inform me at the same time, however, that within
the bar there is considerable depth of water.
44 From the Sungei Lundu the land rises behind a
wooded beach. The first hill, which may be said to
form the larboard entrance of the river, is peaked, and
called Sumpudin, and near it is a barred river of the
same name. This range of high land runs some dis-
tance ; and near its termination is the river Tamburgan.
The low coast runs into another bight ; and the first
opening after the termination of the high land is the
mouth of the river Seboo. Then comes another river ;
after which the land rises into hills, gradually larger, till
they terminate in -a round-topped hill, which forms the
starboard entrance (going in) of the Sarawak river.
" This river discharges itself at the east corner of the
bay ; and its locality is easily recognized by the highest
peak of Santobong, which towers over its left bank, close
to the entrance. A ship rounding Datu will readily per-
16 tixrubiTioN TO BORNEO.
ceive the high land of Santobong, showing like a large
island, with another smaller island at its northern ex-
tremity. Both these, however, are attached to the
main : and the northernmost point, called Tanjong
Sipang, is distinguished by two peaks, like horns, one
small, the other larger. Steer from Datu a direct course
toward this high land, and when within a mile and a
half or two miles of the shore, haul in along the land, as
there is a sand nearly dry at low water on the starboard
hand, stretching from the shore to the Saddle island, or
Pulo Satang. The leading mark to clear this sand is to
bring the hollow formed between the round hill at the
right entrance of the Sarawak river and- the next hill
a-head, and as you approach the river's mouth, steer for a
small island close to the shore, called Pulo Karra, or
Monkey Island. These marks will conduct you over a
shoal with \ three, the least depth at high water ; you
will then deepen your water, and keep away for the
low green point on the far side of the river, edging grad-
ually in ; and when you are some distance from the op-
posite low point on the port hand, cross the bar in three
fathom (high water) nearly in the center of the river.
You must not, however, encroach on the larboard side.
The bar is narrow, and just within is 7 and 7 fathom,
where we are at present anchored. The scenery is
noble. On our left hand is the peak of Santobong,
clothed in verdure nearly to the top ; at his foot a luxu-
riant vegetation, fringed with the casuarina, and termi-
nating in a beach of white sand. The right bank of the
river is low, covered with pale green mangroves, with
the round hill above mentioned just behind it. Santo-
bong peak is 2050 feet, or thereabouts, by a rough trig-
onometrical measurement.
" 12th. Lay at anchor ; took angles and observations,
and shot in the evening without any success. There is
a fine species of large pigeon of a gray color I u'as desir-
ous of getting, but they were too cunning. Plenty <>1
wild hogs wore seen, but as shy as though they had
been fired at all their lives. When the flood made, dis-
patched my gig for Sarawak, in order to acquaint the
rajah of my arrival.
" 13///. Got under weigh, and in li :v;irh
r.Xl'EDlTlOX TO BORNEO. 17
met our.gig returning, followed by a large canoe, with a
Pangeran of note to welcome us. We gave him a sa-
lute of five guns ; while he, on his part, assured us of
his rajah's pleasure at our arrival, and his own desire
to be of service. With the Pangeran Oula Deen (or
Illudeen, anglice Aladdin), came the rajah's chief wri-
ter, his shroff, a renegade Parsee, a war-captain, and
some others, beside a score of followers. They made
themselves much at home, ate and drank (the less scru-
pulous took wine), and conversed with ease and liveli-
ness. No difference can be more marked than between
the Hindoostani and the Malay. The former, though
more self-possessed and polished, shows a constraint in
manners and conversation, and you feel that his train-
ing has made him an artificial character. The Malay,
on the contrary, concealing as well the feelings upper-
most in his mind, is lively and intelligent, and his con-
versation is not confined to a dull routine of unmeaning
compliments.
" August 13th. The Pangeran spoke to me of some
ship-captain who was notoriously cruel to his Lascars,
and insolent in his language to the Malays. He was
murdered by his crew, and the circumstance was re-
lated to me as though I was to approve the act ! ' No
Malay of Borneo (added the Pangeran) would injure a
European, were he well treated, and in a manner suit-
able to his rank.' And I .am sure such a declaration, in
a limited sense, is consonant with all known principles of
human nature, and the action of the passions and feelings.
" Our Pangeran was quite the gentleman, and a manly
gentleman too. His dress was a black velvet jacket,
trimmed with gold lace, and trowsers of green cloth,
with a red sarong and kris. He was the only one of the
party armed while aboard. The rest were good, quiet
men, and one or two of them very intelligent. They
took their leave of us to get back to the town at sunset ;
but the ebb making, returned and stayed until twelve at
night, when the tide turned in their favor. We had
me difficulty in providing beds. The Pangeran slept
in my cabin, and the rest were distributed about on
couches or carpets.
" August I4,th. Got under weigh with the flood, and,
2 2
18 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
favored by a light breeze, proceeded up the river nearly
as far as the town. From the ignorance of the pilots,
however, we grounded on a rock in the middle of the
river in 1 fathom water, and it took us an hour to heave
the vessel off by the stern. Had the tide been falling,,
we should have been in a critical situation, as the rock
is dry at low water ; but as it was, we received no
damage. Shortly after getting off, several boats with
assistance came from the place, dispatched in haste by
the rajah. The intention was kind, though we needed
not the aid. Being dark, we dropped anchor in 5 3 2 fath-
om, about H mile from the town.
" I5th Anchored abreast of Sarawak at seven, and
saluted the rajah with twenty-one guns, which wore
returned with eighteen from his residence. The ra-
jah's own brother, Pangeran Mahammed, then saluted
the vessel with seven guns, which were returned.
Having breakfasted, and previously intimated our inten-
tion, we pulled ashore to visit the great man. He
received us in state, seated in his hall of audience,
which outside is nothing but a large shed, erected on
piles, but within decorated with taste. Chairs were
placed on each side of the ruler, who occupied the head
seat. Our party were placed on one hand ; on the other
sat his brother Mahammed, and Macota and some others,
of his principal chiefs, while immediately behind him his.
twelve younger brothers were seated.
" The dress of Muda Hassim was simple, but of rich-
material ; and most of the principal men were well, and
even superbly, dressed. His countenance is plain, but
intelligent and highly pleasing, and his manners perfectly
elegant and easy. His reception was kind, and, 1 am
given to understand, highly flattering. We sat, how-
ever, trammeled with the formality of state, and our
conversation did riot extend beyond kind inquiries ami
professions of friendship. We were presented with to-
bacco rolled up in a leaf, each about a foot long, and tea
was served by attendants on their knees. A hand play-
ed wild and not unmusical airs during the; interview, and
the crowd of attendants who surrounded us were seated
in respectful silence. After !i visit of half an hour. w<.
rose nml took our leave.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 19
" Sarawak is but an occasional residence of the Rajah
Muda Hassim, and he is now detained here by a rebell-
ion in the interior. On my inquiring whether the war
proceeded favorably, he replied that there was no war,
but merely some child's play among his subjects. From
what I hear, however, from other quarters, it is more
serious than he represents it ; and hints have been
thrown out that the rajah wishes me to stay here as a
demonstration to intimidate the rebels. We shall see.
" The town consists of a collection of mud huts erect-
ed on piles, and may contain about 1500 persons. The
residences of the rajah and his fourteen brothers occupy
the greater part, and their followers are the great major-
ity of the population. When they depart for Borneo
(or Bruni), the remainder must be a veiy small popula-
tion, and apparently veiy poor. The river affords a few
fish ; but there is little sign of cultivation either of rice
or other grain. Fowls and goats seem the only other
means of subsistence of these people. The geological
features of the country are easily described. Vast
masses of granite rock are scattered along the coast; for
instance, Gunong Poe, Gading, Santobong, &c. &c.,
which have evidently at some former period been de-
tached islands. The spaces between these granite
masses is now filled in with alluvial soil, intersected in
every direction with rivers and streams, and on the low
alluvial bank of the Sarawak river stands this little town.
The distance from the sea is about twenty-five miles,
through banks of mangrove and the Nepa palm, until
approaching the town, where some jungle-trees first ap-
pear. The breadth is about 100 yards, and the depth
six fathoms at low water spring-tides in mid river oppo-
site the rajah's residence. In some places below, the
river is narrower, and the depths considerable, varying
from three to seven fathoms. The prominent points,
however, are shallow, and the rocks below the town lie
on the starboard hand coming up just as the first houses
appear in sight. The larboard hand should then be kept
close aboard. Some other rocks are likewise reported ;
and in ascending the stream, though it be generally
clear, a vessel with or without a pilot should have a boat
a-head sounding. Tn the evening I went ashore sud-
20 EXPEDITION TO UOKXEO.
denly to pay a visit to the rajah, in order, if possible, to
break through the bonds of formality. The great mini
soon made his appearance, and received us very well.
We talked much of the state of his country and of ours ;
but he was very guarded when I spoke of the Dutch.
'He had no dealings whatever (he said) with them, and
never allowed their vessels to come here, and therefore
could not say what they were like.' We sat in easy
and unreserved converse, out of hearing of. the rest of
the circle. He expressed great kindness to the English
nation ; and begged me to tell him really which was the
most powerful nation, England or Holland, or, as he sig-
nificantly expressed it, which is the ' cat, and which the
rat?' I assured him that England was the mouser,
though in this country Holland had most territory. We
took our leave after he had intimated his intention of
visiting us to-morrow morning.
"16th We were ready to receive the rajah after
breakfast; but these affairs of state are not so easily
managed. There came two diplomatists on board to
know, in the first place, how many guns we intended to
salute with, and, in the second, whether I would go
ashore in my gig, in order to fetch the chief and his bro-
ther off. The latter request I might have refused, and
in a diplomatic light it was inadmissible ; but I readily
conceded it, because, in the first place, it was less trou-
blesome than a refusal ; and, in the next, I cared not to
bandy paltry etiquets with a semi-savage ; and what-
ever pride might whisper, I could not, as an individual
traveler, refuse an acknowledgment of the supremacy
of a native prince. I went accordingly. The great man
came on board, and we treated him with every distinc-
tion and respect. Much barbaric state was maintain-
ed as he quitted his own residence. His sword of state
with a gold scabbard, his war-shield, jewel-hilted kris,
and (lowing /wrse-tails, were separately carried by the
grand officers of state. Bursts of wild music announces]
his exit. His fourteen brothers and principal Panger-
ans surrounded him, and a number (formidable on the
deck of a vessel) covered the rear. He stayed two
hours and a half; ate and drank, and talked with great
familiarity : till the oppressive heat of the crowded
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. V? 1
cabin caused me to wish them all to another place.
However, he departed at last, under a salute of twenty-
one guns ; and the fatigues of the day were satisfacto-
rily brought to a close. I afterward sent the rajah the
presents I had brought for him, consisting of a silk sa-
rong, some yards of red cloth and velvet, a pocket-pistol,
scissors and knives, with tea, biscuits, sweetmeats, Chin;i
playthings, &c. &c. A person coming here should be
provided with a few articles of small importance to sat
isfy the crowd of inferior chiefs. Soap, small parcels of
tea, lucifers, writing-paper, a large stock of cigars, bis-
cuits, and knives, are the best ; for, without being great
beggars, they seem greatly to value these trifles, even
in the smallest quantity. The higher class inquired
frequently for scents ; and for the great men I know
no present which would be more acceptable than a
small pier-glass. All ranks seemed greatly pleased
with those aboard ; and some of the lower orders,
quite ignorant of the reflection, were continually laugh-
ing, moving, sitting, and rising, to observe the corres-
ponding effect.
"ISth. In the morning I intimated my intention of
paying a visit to the Pangeran Muda Mahammed ; and
being apprised of his readiness to see us, I went ashore
to his house. He was not, however, in the room to
receive us ; nor, indeed, was I much surprised at this
slight, for he is a sulky-looking, ill-favored savage, with
a debauched appearance, and wanting in the intelligence
of his brother the rajah. I seated myself, however, and
remained some time ; but the delay exceeding what I
considered the utmost limit of due forbearance, I ex-
pressed to the Pangeran Macota my regret that his
compeer was not ready to receive me, adding that, as I
was not accustomed to be kept waiting, I would return
to my vessel. I spoke in the quietest tone imaginable,
rose from my seat, and moved away ; but the assembled
Pangerans, rising likewise, assured me it was a mistake ;
that he was not yet dressed, and would greatly regret it
himself. I repeated that when I visited the rajah, he
received me in the hall. While this brief discussion passed,
the culprit Muda Mahammed appeared and apologized
for his remissness, assuring me that the error was hi?
22 EXPEDITION To J!UltM;n.
attendants', who told him I was not coming for an hour.
The excuse of course passed current, though false, as
excuses generally are. I vindicated my independence,
not until it was necessary ; and I am well aware that
any endeavor of a native to commit an indirect rudeness,
if met with firmness and gentleness, always recoils on
his own head. The routine of the visit resembled our
last tea, cigars, complimentary conversation and depart-
ure. The Pangeran afterward sent me a present of
fowls and goats, and I was right glad to have it over.
Muda Mohammed is the ' own ' brother to Muda Has-
sim, and next in rank here. As yet I had not made any
request to the rajah to allow me to visit various parts
of his country ; but thinking the time to do so was
come (the ceremonial of arrival being past), I sent Mr.
Williamson, my interpreter, to express my wish to
travel to some of the Malay towns and into the country
of the Dyaks. The latter request I fully expected,
would be evaded, and was therefore the more pleased
when an answer came giving a cheerful consent to my
going among the Dyaks of Lundu, and visiting the
towns of Sadung, Samarahan, &c. At the same time
the rajah informed me, that if I went up the river, he
could not be answerable for my safety, as the rebels were
not far distant, and constantly on the watch. Sarebus,
another large Dyak town, he advised me not to visit, as
they were inimical to his government, and a skirmish
had lately taken place between them and some of his
subjects.
" 18th, Sunday. Performed service. In the evening
walked ashore, but the jungle was wet after rain.
Every day or night since arriving it has rained, some-
limes in torrents, at others in showers, and the sky has
been so obscured that no observations can be obtained.
The thermometer never ranges above 81, and some-
times stands at 59.
" At twelve at night we were surprised by a boat
sent from the rajah, to say he was taken ill, and wanted
some physic. \Y r e dispatched our surgeon, but it was
found impossible to admit him into the sacred precincts
of*the seraglio, and he returned with the information
that the rajah was asleep.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. *<J8
* 21st. Our fleet were in readiness before daylight,
and by five o'clock we left Kuching,* and dropped
down the river. The Pangeran Illudeen and the
Panglima, both in prahus, accompanied us, and with
our long-boat (the Skimakmg) formed quite a gay pro-
cession. The prahu of the Pangeran pulled twelve
paddles, mounted two brass swivels, and in all had a
crew of about twenty men. The Panglima's boat like-
wise carried a gun, and had about ten men ; while the
Skimalong mounted an iron swivel, and carried six
Englishmen and one of our Singapore Malays. With
this equipment we might be pronounced far superior
to any force of the rajah's enemies we were likely to
meet.
" We passed from the Sarawak river into the Moro-
taba. At the junction of the two streams th Morotaba
is narrow ; but at no great distance, where it meets the
Quop, it becomes wider, and in some places more than
half a mile across.
*' The river Quop is a fine stream, fully, as far as I
could see, as broad as the Morotaba or Sarawak. Be-
yond the junction of the Quop and Morotnba the latter
river divides into two branches the left-hand one,
running to the sea, retains the name of Morotaba,
while the right is called Riam.
" The Riam is a fine stream ; at its junction with
the Morotaba it takes that name, as the Morotaba does
that of Sarawak where they join. Low mangrove or
Nepa palm banks characterize these streams ; and
occasionally slight eminences, with timber, are to be
seen. The highest hill is about 3000 feet high, called
Matang, and is at the point of junction between the
Morotaba and Riam.
" The next river on the starboard hand is the Tanjan,
a small stream ; and some distance from it, the Kul-
luong, or Parwheet river, more properly the continua-
tion of the Riam. On the port hand is a smaller river,
running N. 35 E. We pursued this stream, called
Ugong Passer; and after a hard pull against a strong
tide, emerged into the larger river of Samarahan. The
* The old name for the town of Sarawak.
"24 EXPEDITION TO JBORM
tide was so strong against us that we brought up for a
couple of hours till it slacked, and between four aud
five got under weigh again, with the expectation of
shortly arriving at our place of destination. Hour after
hour passed, however ; the sun set ; the glorious moon
rose upon our progress as we toiled slowly but cheer-
fully onward. Silence was around, save when broken
by the wild song of the Malay boatmen, responded to
by the song of our tars to the tune of ' Bonnie laddie,
Highland laddie.'
" It was such a situation as an excitable mind might
envy. The reflection that we were proceeding up a
Borneon river hitherto unknown, sailing where no
European ever sailed before ; the deep solitude, the
brilliant night, the dark fringe of retired jungle, the
lighter foliage of the river bank, with here and there a
tree flashing and shining with fireflies, nature's tiny
lamps glancing and flitting in countless 'numbers and
incredible brilliancy ! At eleven at night v,-e reached
Samarahan, having been eighteen hours in tho boat,
and fifteen at the oars, chiefly against tide. The men
were tired, but cheerful. Indeed, I can give them no
praise beyond their merits for conduct spirited, endur-
ing, and yet so orderly as never to offend the native
inhabitants, or infringe upon their prejudices. A glass
of grog with our supper, and we all soon closed our
eyes in comfortable sleep, such as fatigue alone can
bring.
" 22d. The village of Samarahan consists of a few
houses, built, as usual, upon posts, and standing close
to the brink of the river. It contains from sixty to
eighty inhabitants in all, and there is nothing in its site
different from the rest of the country. While here, a
boat, with a Dyak family, came alongside, consisting of
a father, his son, and two daughters. They belonged
to the Sibnowan tribe, and had a ' ladang,' or farm, on
the Sumarahan, toward tho sou. Tlu> women wnv
good-looking; one, indeed, handsome, plump, and intel-
ligent. They were naked to the waist, and ornamented
with several cinctures of brass and colored ratlans scrnped
very thin.
14 About ten NV(.- <:;;!iie;! Samarahan and proceeded
KXi'F.UITloX To HORNEO. 25
up the river, stopping only to take a set of sights, and
about seven in the evening reached Sibnow, having
previously passed the villages of Rembas and Siniawan.
Siniawan and Sibnow are not above half a mile from
each other, and Rembas not far distant. They are all
about the same size, consisting each of eight or ten
houses, and containing sixty or eighty inhabitants. The
river, during its course so far, is characterized by the
same clay-mud bank, evidently an alluvial deposit, with-
out one rock to be seen. The banks are low, and for
the most part cleared a quarter of a mile or more on
either side, but the jungle is rarely disturbed beyond
that distance. Occasionally, however, the scene is
varied by the rich foliage of this jungle, which here
and there kisses the tide as it flows by, and in some
spots on the cleared ground arise clumps of trees that
would be the pride of any park in Europe. Monkeys
in great numbers frisked among the branches; and
though unable to shoot them, they amused us often by
their grotesque attitudes and the tremendous leaps
they made. On one occasion we saw as many as
twenty throw themselves, one after the other, from the
branch of a high tree into a thick bush full forty feet
below, and not one missed his distance or hold ! On
our way to Sibnow the Pangeran had collected a num-
ber of men for a deer-hunt. The nets used for this
purpose are formed of rattans strongly wove together,
which, being stretched along the jungle, have nooses ot
the same material, at three feet apart, attached to this
ridge-rope. Beaters and dogs then hunt from the
opposite quarter, and the deer, in escaping them, is
caught in this trap. A length of several hundred
fathoms is stretched at once, each separate part ot
thirty or forty fathoms being joined on as required ; and
I was told that in this way many deer were taken.
" A heavy rain came on directly after we had brought
up, and quickly dispelled all our preparations for supper,
by putting out our fire, cooling our hot water, and soak-
ing our half-broiled fowls. To a hungry man such an
event is very disastrous ; but nothing could exceed the
kindness of our Malay friends. They took us to the
best house iq the village, prepared our supper, and pro
C
*^6 EM'KDITInX To BOBN :
vided us with comfortable mats and pillows to sleep on.
Some of our party preferred a bad supper and wet bed
to these accommodations; and, to consummate their
discomfort, they were kept awake a great part of the
night by sandflies. Our lot in the house was more for-
tunate. We heard the rattling of the pitiless rain, and
commiserated those whose choice or distrust kept them
in the boat. I obtained by this means an excellent op-
portunity of seeing a Malay menage, in its primitive
simplicity. Women, children, and all their domestic,
arrangements, were exposed to view. Nothing appeared
to be concealed, nor could anything exceed the simple,
kind-hearted hospitality of the inhabitants. The women
gazed upon us freely; and their children, with the
shyness natural to their age, yet took a glance at the
strangers. Never having seen a white man, their curi-
osity was naturally excited; but it was never offensive.
Our supper consisted of an excellent curry, and cold
venison broiled on a stick, flavored w'rth a glass of sherry,
and concluded by a cigar. We retired to a dry bed,
laying our head on the pillow with as entire a feeling of
security as though reposing in England.
"A description of this Malay dwelling, situated so
far up this hitherto unknown river, may be interesting.
Built, like other Malay houses, on posts, floored with
split bamboo, and covered with the leaf of the Nepa
palm, it presents the very beau ideal of fragility, but
affords, at the same time, many advantages, and with a
little improvement might be rendered admirably calcu-
lated for a new settler in any warm country. It is built
at very small expense, is remarkably roomy, free from
damp, and weather-proof. The interior of the house
consists of four rooms, the center one large and com-
modious, the front narrower, but thirty-six feet in length,
a family sleeping-apartment on one side, and a kitchen
at the back. These apartments are divided one from
the other by partitions made of the Nepa. ; the floors
were nicely spread with strong mats of JJyak manufac-
ture, and on our arrival finer white mats were laid over
these. The entrance of the house is approached by ;;
steep ladder, which in case of attack is easily reii'ov'Mi.
The river Samarahan i< admirably calculated tit;
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 27
and, indeed, the same may be said of the whole country,
from the great facility it offers of inland communication.
There is no impediment for small vessels of 200 or 300
tons navigating as far as Sibnow, the stream being deep
and clear of danger. The tides in the river are strong,
but not dangerously so ; and, sounding occasionally in
every reach, we never found less water than three
fathoms. The distant mountains, called Bukar (and
some other name), are inhabited by Dyaks, and are
said to offer many valuable articles of trade ; and we
may presume this true from the riches of the region
whence the Sarawak river takes its rise. It is highly
probable, indeed, that both these rivers, as well as the
Quop and others, have their source in the same range,
and will be found to afford the same mineral productions.
Tin, the natives confidently assert, can be procured, and
birds' nests in very considerable quantities. The latter
article, I have heretofore understood, was found only in
the vicinity of the sea, whence the material of which
they are composed is gathered ; but both here and at
Sarawak the best informed and most intelligent Malays
assure me it is likewise found in the interior, and brought
by the Dyaks from the mountains. The alluvial soil is
a rich clay loam. The principal production at present
is rice, of which considerable quantities are grown on
the banks of the river, which accounts for the clearing
of so many miles of the jungle. The mode of cultiva-
tion is similar to what is pursued in Sumatra, and so
well described by Marsden. A small spot is cleared of
jungle, and when the soil is exhausted of its primeval
richness, is deserted for another, which again in turn
is neglected, and returns to its wild state. The rice
produced is of excellent quality, and of a smaller grain
than the Java rice we have with us. It is veiy white
and of excellent flavor, and I am inclined to think is
the ' Padi ladang,' or rice grown on dry ground. (For
rice, cultivation of, &c., &c., vide Marsden's Sumatra,
p. 65.)
" Beside rice, rattans are found in great quantities,
and likewise Malacca canes, but whether of good quality
I am not able to say. On my expressing a wish to see
one, a man was dispatched into the jungle, atxl return-
28 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
ed with one in a few minutes. Bees-wax is another
article to be procured here at present to the amount
of thirty or forty peculs per year from Sibnow, Malacca
canes a small ship-load, rattans in abundance, and any
quantity of Garu wood.* When we consider the anti-
mony of Sarawak, beside the other things previously
mentioned (to say nothing of gold and diamonds), wo
cannot doubt of the richness of the country : but allow-
ance must be made for the exaggeration of- native state-
ments.
" It must likewise be borne in mind, that these ar-
ticles are collected in small quantities in a country thinly
populated ; and for the purposes of- trade it would be
necessary to have a resident European on the spot to
gather the produce of the country ready for exportation.
I have no doubt that permission might be obtained for
an English merchant to reside in the country, and that
during the lifetime of the Rajah Muda Hassim he would
be secure from outrage. The produce of the country
might likewise be obtained (at first) at a low rate in ex-
change for European goods suited to native tastes. In
addition to the articles I have already mentioned, I must
here add pins, needles, and thread, both gold and white,
showy cheap velvets, yellow, green, and red cloth,
Surat silks, cottons, colored beads (for the Dyaks), nan-
keens in small quantities, gold-lace of various qualities,
gunpowder, muskets, pistols, flints, &c., &c. The head
man of Sibnow (Orang Kay a), when I asked him win-
he did not collect the produce of the country, replied,
that the inhabitants were few, and unless an English
merchant was settled at Kuching to buy the things, it
was no use collecting them. The uncertainty of sale,
as well as the very small prices to be obtained from
trading Malays, prevents these people using the advan
tages of their country, and as yet they seemed to con-
sider it impossible that vessels would come for them.
That they will one day or other be convinced to till-
contrary, I am sure ; that it will be soon, I sincerely
hope ; for I can see no reason, with a population and
rulers so pacific, why a trade highly advantageous to
* \loes wood. Lignum atom.
EXPEDITION TO BOENEO. 29
Singapore should not be opened. I considered our
reception as an additional proof how much better the
natives are disposed where they have had no inter-
course with Europeans ; how perfectly willing they are
to extend a friendly hospitality when never previously
injured or aggravated ; and as the first white men who
ever visited their country, we can bear the most cordial
testimony to their unaffected kindness.
" It is true that we were under the protection of the
rajah and accompanied by a Pangeran, and could have
insisted on obtaining what was readily granted. But in
case the natives had shown any aversion or antipathy
toward us, it would easily have been observed.
"23c?. Heavy rain all the morning. Our salt pro-
visions being exhausted, we procured a goat, which was
cooked to last during our upward passage.
"At 12, the flood making, we quitted Sibnow, and
passing through the same description of countiy, reached
the village of Guntong, consisting of eight houses, and
about sixty or seventy inhabitants. The scattered
population on the banks of the river amounts, however,
to an equal, or probably greater number than in the
villages. Beyond Guntong the country becomes wild,
but beautiful, and the river gradually narrows until not
above twenty-five yards wide. The depth, however,
was three fathoms at high water, where we brought up
for the night, about five hours' pull from Guntong. The
course of the river is so tortuous, that in one place two
reaches are only divided by a neck of land five yards
across !
" We were now fairly in the bush, and beyond the
range of our Pangeran's knowledge ; and I was not
therefore surprised (though disappointed) when he in-
timated the necessity of returning. ' There was noth-
ing to see ; the river was narrow, rapid, and obstructed
by trees ; the Dyaks hostile ; the rajah's enemies in
ambush.'
"I had nothing to answer, save my desire to proceed;
but I felt, at the same time, bound in honor to return ;
for to abuse the indulgence of a native prince on our
first excursion would have been a poor way to obtain his
future permission to visit other places.
30 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
" I did everything man could do to shake the Pange-
ran's resolution ; and I believe I should have been suc-
cessful, had his stock of tobacco and sirih* not been ex-
pended. My last resource was resorting to the means
found efficient with most men to induce them to alter
their opinion. I was content to gain a consent to our
proceeding some miles farther up the stream in the
morning, and then returning with the ebb. Nothing
during this contention could be more polite than the
Pangeran's manner ; for he not only expressed but
looked his regret, and urged on me his responsibility to
the rajah. The plea was unanswerable, though I could
not help suspecting the want of tobacco and betel as the
leading motive.
" 24th. We proceeded, as previously agreed, up the
river some ten or twelve miles farther, during which
distance it narrows to an inconsiderable but deep stream.
In many places it was not above eighteen feet wide, with
trees overhanging the water. The depth was 2 fathoms
high water ; but being the rainy season, it would not be
deeper than necessary for boats all the year round. In
the early morning the jungle presented a charming
scene. Long vistas of noble trees with a diversity of
richest foliage were before us in some places over-
arching the water an'd forming a verdant canopy above
our heads. Birds were numerous, and woke the woods
with their notes, but rarely approached within shot.
Pigeons in numbers and of several varieties were seen,
but very shy and wild.
"We pushed on ahead of our attendant Pan<;er;uj,
and pulled up long after the ebb had made. He had a
long chase, and exhausted his lungs in shouting to us to
return ; and at last, from pity and according to promise,
I did so. Poor fellow, he was very glad, fired his swivel-
gun, and then brought up for breakfast. I believe a few
hours' progress would have brought us to the vicinity of
the hills and into the country of the Dyaks ; and although
disappointed at not being allowed to proceed thither, I
nevertheless comfort myself that we have penetrated o
* The Malay name for the betel, the aromatic leaves of which
are chewed along with the pinang or areca nut, n little pure lime,
anrl various spiers.
EXPEDITION TO 1VOKNEO. 31
hundred miles up a Borneon river hitherto unknown
a river likewise (as fur as we have yet examined it) ad-
mirably calculated for the purposes of navigation and
trade, and which may at some future period become of
importance not only to the trade of our settlement of
Singapore, but even to the commercial interests of Great
Britain. The general character of the Samarahan is
.similar to that of other rivers flowing through alluvial
soils ; the stream is deep, with muddy banks and bottom,
and apparently free from danger or obstruction. Of
course these remarks are not meant to prevent the ne-
cessity of caution in any vessel proceeding up, as our
survey was necessarily very brief; and, like other rivers,
one bank will usually be found deep, the other shallow;
which must be attended to.
4i It now remains for us to proceed up the river from
its mouth to its junction with the Ugong Passer; and
should it prove to have sufficient water for vessels on the
bar, nothing more will be desired.
" Returning, it took us five hours with a fair tide to
Sibnow ; the next ebb we reached Samarahan iu three
hours, where we stopped for the night. A heavy
rain set in after we brought to, and continued till
morning.
" 25$. The morning was cold and raw ; but cleared
up as the sun rose. At 7 we started, and at a quarter
past 10 reached the mouth of the Ugong Passer and
thence into the Riam. Thus it took us 11$ hours, with
a strong ebb tide, to pull the distance. We had ascended
the river from the junction of the Ugong Passer. Mr.
Murray's plan of the river will show the distance as
taken of each reach, together with its bearing. The
ebb tide lasted us some distance up the Riam ; but the
flood making, we entered a small creek, called Taruson-
gong, scarce wide enough for the boat to get through,
and entirely overarched with the Nepa palm. The
general direction of the creek was N.W., and we
emerged from it into the Boyur river; and pulling
through several reaches, got into the Quop,* and thence,
after a while, into the Morotaba ; from the Morotaba
* The banks of the Boyur and Quop are Nepa palm.
32 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
into the Sarawak river, reaching the schooner at sunset,
all well and happy. Thus ended our first cruise into
the interior of Borneo."
CHAPTER III.
Second Cruise : up the River Lundu. The Sibnowan Dyaks.
Their Town of Tungong. Their Physical Proportions, and
Words of their Language. Their Customs. Skull-trophies.
Religious Ceremonies and Opinions. Their Ornaments. Ap-
pearance of both Sexes. Dress and Morals. Missionary Pros-
pects of Conversion, and Elevation in the Social Scale. Gov-
ernment, Laws', and Punishments. Dances. Iron Manufac-
turing. Chinese Settlement. Excursion continued.
" Aug. 30th. Our flotilla, constituted as before, quit-
ted Sarawak with the ebb tide, and reached Santobong,
at the mouth of the river, soon after the flood had made.
We waited for the turn of the tide ; and in wandering
along the sand, I had a shot at a wild hog, but unluckily
missed. I likewise saw a deer, very like a red deer, and
nearly as large. The hog I fired at was a dirty white,
with a black head, veiy unlike in this particular to any
wild hogs I have hitherto seen either in India or Eu-
rope ; but several young pigs, likewise seen, were black.
" With the flood we weighed anchor, intending to bring
up at the mouth of the Seboo river; but the Skimalong
outsailing the prahus, foolishly parted company, causing
me much uneasiness, and keeping the prahus under
weigh all night. I was at this time aboard the Pange-
ran's boat, where 1 usually slept. About 10 on the olst
we reached Lobrek Bay, and rejoined our boat.
" With the flood tide we proceeded up Lundu river,
which has Gunong Gading on the right hand. The
course of the river is very tort nous, but it appears every
where of more than sufficient depth. The l)yak village
of Tungong is situated about eighteen miles from the
mouth, and takes its n;mie from M small stream which
joins the Lundu just below, on the left hand. It was
dark when wo arrived, and we ran againM. a boom formed
of large trees run across the river as a defense against
adverse Dynk tribes. We eonlr) son nothing of tho
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 33
town, save that it appeared longer than any we had yet
visited.
" September 1st. The River Lundu is of considerable
breadth, about half a mile at the mouth, and 150 or 200
yards off Tungong. Tungong stands on the left hand
(going up) close to the margin of the stream, and is in-
closed by a slight stockade. Within this defense there
is one enormous house for the whole population, and
three or four small huts. The exterior of the defense
between it and the river is occupied by sheds for prahus,
and at each extremity are one or two houses belonging
to Malay residents.
" The common habitation, as rude as it is enormous,
measures 594 feet in length, and the front room, or
street, is the entire length of the building, and 21 feet
broad. The back part is divided by mat partitions into
the private apartments of the various families, and of
these there are forty-five separate doors leading from
the public apartment. The widowers and young un-
married men occupy the public room, as only those with
wives are entitled to the advantage of separate rooms.
The floor of this edifice is raised twelve feet from the
ground, and the means of ascent is by the trunk of a tree
with notches cut in it a most difficult, steep, and awk-
ward ladder. In front is a terrace fifty feet broad, run-
ning partially along the front of the building, formed, like
the floors, of split bamboo. This platform, as well as the
front room, besides the regular inhabitants, is the resort
of pigs, dogs, birds, monkeys, and fowls, and presents a
glorious scene of confusion and bustle. Here the ordi-
nary occupations of domestic labor are carried on padi
ground, mats made, &c., &c. There were 200 men,
women, and children counted in the room and in front
while we were there in the middle of the day ; and, al-
lowing for those abroad and those in their own rooms,
the whole community can not be reckoned at less than
400 souls. Overhead, about seven feet high, is a second
crazy story, on which they stow their stores of food and
their implements of labor and war. Along the large
room are hung many cots, four feet long, formed of*'the
hollowed trunks of trees cut in half, which answer the
purpose of seats by day and beds by night. The Sib-
3
34 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
nowan Dyaks are a wild-looking but apparently quiet
and inoffensive race. The apartment of their chief, by
name Sejugah, is situated nearly in the center of the
building, and is larger than any other. In front of it nice
mats were spread on the occasion of our visit, while
over our heads dangled about thirty ghastly skulls, ac-
cording to the custom of these people. The chief way
a man of middle age, with a mild and pleasing counte-
nance and gentle manners. He had around him several
sons and relations, and one or two of the leading men of
his tribe, but the rest seemed by no means to be re-
strained by his presence, or to show him any particular
marks of respect : certainly nothing of the servile obse-
quiousness observed by the Malays before their prince..
Their dress consists of a single strip of cloth round tho
loins, with the ends hanging down before and behind,
and a light turban, composed of the bark of trees, twined
round the head, and so arranged that the front is stuck
up somewhat resembling a short plume of feathers.
" Their figures are almost universally well made,
showing great activity without great muscular develop-
ment ; but their stature is diminutive, as will be seen by
the following measurements, taken at random among
them, and confirmed by general observation :
"Sejugah, the chief, height, 5 ft. 1| in. Head round, 1 ft. 9
in. Anterior portion, from ear to ear, 1 foot ; posterior, 9 in. ;
across the top, 1| ft.
"Kalong, the chief's eldest son, height, 5 ft. 2| in. Anterior
portion of head, 1 ft. ; posterior, 8| in. ; across the top, 1 ft., want-
ing a few lines.
Height
Man from the crowd . 5 ft. 1% in.
Another ....
Another
Another
Another
Another
5 1
" The following is a specimen of their names, aiu!
some few words of their dialect, the only ones 1 could
get not Malayan. The fact, indeed, appears to be that,
from constant intercourse, their Dyak language is last
fading away; and, while retaining their separate relig-
ion and customs, they have substituted the soft and flu-
'nf Malav for their own harsher jargon. The names
EXPEDITION TO DORNEU. 35
are, Juguh or Sejugah, Kalong, Bunshie, Kontong, Long,
Rantie.
The vocabulary :
hairs, bok (similar to the
Lundu Dyaks).
thigh, pah.
woman, indo.
father, api.
sea, tasiek.
slave, ulon.
spear, sancho.
black, chelum.
good, badass.
bad, jaie.
quick, pantass.
that, kncah (nasal, like kgneah).
this, to.
to go, bajaK.
there, kein.
come, jail.
here, keto.
come here, jail keto.
to give, bri.
give all, bri samonia (M).
to bring, bn.
bring that, bn kneah.
bring here, bit keto.
slow, bagadie.
" The corruptions of the Malay are langan for tangon,
arm ; ai for ayer, water ; menua for benua, country ;
komah for rumah, house ; besi for besar, great.
" Like the rest of the Dyaks, the Sibnowans adorn
iheir houses with the heads of their enemies ; but with
them this custom exists in a modified form ; and I am led
to hope that the statements already made public of their
reckless search after human beings, merely for the pur-
pose of obtaining their heads, will be found to be exagger-
ated, if not untrue ; and that the custom elsewhere, as
here and at Lundu, will be found to be more accordant
with our knowledge of other wild tribes, and to be re-
garded merely as a triumphant token of valor in the fight
or ambush ; similar, indeed, to the scalps of the North
American Indian.
" Some thirty skulls were hanging from the roof of the
apartment; and I was informed that they had many
more in their possession; all, however, the heads of
enemies, chiefly of the tribe of Sarebus. On inquiring,
I was told that it is indispensably necessary a young
man should procure a skull before he gets married.
When I urged on them that the custom would be more
honored in the breach than the observance, they replied
that it was established from time immemorial, and could
not be dispensed with. Subsequently, however, Seju-
gah allowed that heads were very difficult to obtain now,
and a young man might sometimes get married by giving
presents to his lady-love's parents. At all times they
30 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
warmly denied ever obtaining nny heads but those of
their enemies ; adding, they were bad people, and de-
served to die.
" I asked a young unmarried man whether he would
bo obliged to get a head before he could obtain a wife.
He replied, ' Yes.' ' When would he get one ?' ' Soon.'
'Where would he go to get one?' 'To the Sarebus
river.' I mention these particulars in detail, as 1 think,
had their practice extended to taking the head of any de-
fenseless traveler, or any Malay surprised in his dwell-
ing or boat, I should have wormed the secret out of them.
" The men of this tribe marry but one wife, and that
not until they have attained the age of seventeen or
eighteen. Their wedding ceremony is curious ; and, as
related, is performed by the bride and bridegroom being
brought in procession along the large room, where a
brace of fowls is placed over the bridegroom's neck,
which he whirls seven times round his head. The
fowls are then killed, and their blood sprinkled on the
foreheads of the pair, which done, they are cooked, and
eaten by the new-married couple alone, while the rest
feast and drink during the whole night.
" Their dead are put in a coffin, and buried; but Se-
jugah informed me that the different tribes vary in this
particular ; and it would appear they differ from their
near neighbors the Dyaks of Lundu.
" Like these neighbors, too, the Sibnowans seem to
have little or no idea of a God. They offer prayers to
Biedum, the great Dyak chief of former days. Priests
and ceremonies they have none ; the thickest mist of
darkness is over them : but how much easier is it to dis-
pel darkness with light than to overcome the false blaze
with the rays of truth !
" The manners of the men of this tribe are somewlmt
reserved, but frank ; while the women appeared more
cheerful, and more inclined to laugh and joke at. our pe-
culiarities. Although the first Europeans they had ever
seen, we were by no means annoyed by llieir curiosity :
and their honesty is to be praised; for, though opportu-
nities wore not wanting, they never on any occasion at-
tempted to pilfer any thing. Their color resembles thr,
Malay, and is fully as dark; and the cast ol'their conn-
KXl'KDITION TO BORNEO. 3?
venance does not favor the notion that they are sprung
from a distinct origin. They never intermarry with the
Malays, so as to intermingle the two people, and the
chastity of their women gives no presumption of its oth-
erwise occurring. Their stature, as I have before re-
marked, is diminutive, their eyes are small and quick,
their noses usually flattened, and their figures clean and
well formed, but not athletic. Both sexes generally
wear the hair long and turned up, but the elder men
often cut it short. As is natural, they are fond of the
water, and constantly bathe ; and their canoes are nu-
merous. I counted fifty, besides ten or twelve small
prahus, which they often build for sale to the Malays,
at a very moderate price indeed. The men wear a num-
ber of fine cane rings, neatly worked (which we at first
mistook for hair), below the knee or on the arm, and
sometimes a brass ring or two ; but they have no other
ornaments. The ears of a few were pierced, but I saw
nothing worn in them except a roll of thin palm-leaf, to
prevent the hole closing. The women are decidedly
good-looking, and far fairer than the men ; their figures
are well shaped, and remarkable for their embonpoint.
The expression of their countenance is very good-hu-
mored, and their condition seems a happy one. Their
dress consists of a coarse stuff, very scanty (manufac-
tured by the Sakarran Dyaks), reaching from the waist
to the knee ; around the waist they have rings of ratan,
either black or red, and the loins are hung round with a
number of brass ornaments made by their husbands.
Above the waist they are entirely naked, nor do they
wear any covering or ornament on the head. They
have a few bracelets of brass, but neither ear-rings nor
nose-rings ; and some, more lucky than the rest, wear a
necklace of beads. They prefer the smallest Venetian
beads to the larger and more gaudy ones of England.
The labor of the house, and all the drudgery, falls on the
females. They grind the rice, carry burdens, fetch wa-
ter, fish, and work in the fields ; but though on a par with
other savages in this respect, they have many advanta-
ges. They are not immured ; they eat in company with
the males ; and, in most points, hold the same position
toward their husbands and children as European women.
D
38 EXPEDITION TO DORNEo.
The children are entirely naked; and the only peculiar-
ity I observed is filing their teetli to a sharp point, like
those of a shark. The men many but one wife, as I
have before observed. Concubinage in unknown ; and
cases of seduction or adultery very seldom arise. Even
the Malays speak highly of the chastity of the Dyak
women ; yet they are by no means shy under the g;i/,e
of strangers, and used to bathe before us hi a state of
nudity.
" That these Dyaks are in a low condition there is no
doubt ; but, comparatively, theirs is an innocent state,
and 1 consider them capable of being easily raised in the
scale of society. The absence of all prejudice regarding
diet, the simplicity of their characters, the purity of
their morals, and their present ignorance of all forms of
worship and all idea of future responsibility, render them
open to conviction of truth and religious impression.
Yet, when I say this, I mean, of course, only when
their minds shall have been raised by education ; for
without previous culture I reckon the labors of the mis-
sionary as useless as endeavoring to read off a blank pa-
per. I doubt not but the Sibnowan Dyaks would read-
ily receive missionary families among them, provided
the consent of the Rajah Muda Hassim was previously
obtained. That the rajah would consent I much doubt ;
but if any person chose to reside at Tungong, for the
charitable purpose of leading the tribe gradually, by
means of education, to the threshold of Christianity, it
would be worth the asking, and I would exert what in-
fluence I possess with him on the occasion. I feel sure
a missionary would be safe among them, as long as ho
strictly confined himself to the gentle precepts and prac-
tice of his faith ; he would live abundantly and cheaply,
and be exposed to no danger except from the incursion
of hostile tribes, which must always be looked for by a
sojourner amid a Dyak community.
" I must add, that this day, when so many of my
friends are destroying partridges, I have had my gun in
my hand, to procure a few specimens.
" 2d. To continue my account of the Sibnowan Dy-
aks. I made particular inquiry about the superstition
stated to exist regarding birds, and the omens said to bo
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 39
tlruwn from their flight ; but I could trace no vestige of
such a belief, nor did they seem at all acquainted with
its existence. The government of the Sibnowans may
be called patriarchal. The authority of the chief ap-
pears limited within very narrow bounds ; he is the
leader in war, and the dispenser of the laws ; but pos-
sesses no power of arbitrary punishment, and no author-
ity for despotic rule. The distinction between Sejugah
and the lowest of his tribe is not great, and rather a dif-
ference of riches than of power. A few ornamented
speai-s, presented by the Malays, seem his only insignia
of office ; and these were never displayed in our pres-
ence, save in the dance. The chiefship would appear
to be elective, and not hereditary ; but I could not dis-
tinctly understand whether the appointment rested with
the rajah or the tribe. The former claims it ; but the
latter did not speak as though his right were a matter
of necessity or certainty. On asking Kalong, the eldest
son of Sejugah (a young man of twenty years of age,
active, clever, and intelligent), whether he would suc-
ceed his father, he replied, he feared lie was not rich
enough ; but two or three of the tribe, who were pres-
ent, asserted that he would be made chief. The Rajah
Muda Hassim told me that the only hold he had on the
Dyaks was through the chief and his family, who were
attached to him ; but that the tribe at large cared noth-
ing for the Malays. I can easily believe this, as any ill
treatment or cruelty directed against a Dyak community
would soon drive them beyond the power and the terri-
tory of the prince. This is the best safeguard of the
Dyaks ; and the Malays are well aware that a Dyak
alliance must be maintained by good treatment. They
4ire called subjects and slaves ; but they are subjects at
pleasure, more independent and better used than any
Malay under his native prince.
" The laws of this Dyak tribe are administered by
the chief and the two principal men. They have no
fixed code, nor any standard of punishment, each case
of crime being judged according to its enormity. In the
event of murder in their own tribe, the murderer suffers
(death by decapitation, provided he be in fault. Theft
is punished by fine, and adultery (stated as p. heinous
40 EXPEDITION TU 11 OK NEC.
offense) by severe beating and heavy mulct. Other
crimes are, in like manner, punished by fine and beating
one or both, according to their .various shades of evil,
The latter varies greatly in degree, sometimes being in-
flicted on the head or arm, with a severity which stops
short only of death. The arm is often broken under
this infliction ; so, according to their representation, it is
a risk to be dreaded and avoided.
" Slavery holds among them; and, as among the Ma-
lays, a debtor is reduced to this state until his debt be
discharged. Children are likewise bought, and must be
considered as slaves.
"In the evening I requested Sejugah to collect his
tribe, and to show me their dances and musical instru-
ments. They readily consented, and about nine at
night we went to witness the exhibition. The musical
instruments were, the tomtom, or drum, and the Ma-
layan gong; which were beat either slow or fast, ac-
cording to the measure of the dance. The dances are
highly interesting, more especially from their close re-
semblance, if not identity, with those of the South Sea
Islanders. Two swords were placed on the mat, and
two men commenced slowly, from the opposite extrem-
ities, turning the body, extending the arms, and lifting
the legs, in grotesque but not ungraceful attitudes. Ap-
proaching thus leisurely round and round about, they at
length seize the swords, the music plays a brisker meas-
ure, and the dancers pass and repass each other, now
cutting, now crossing swords, retiring and advancing,
one kneeling as though to defend himself from the as-
saults of his adversary ; at times stealthily waiting for
an advantage, and quickly availing himself of it. Tim
measure throughout was admirably kept, and the fre-
quent turns were simultaneously made by both dancers,
accompanied by the same eccentric gestures. The ei'-
fect of all this far surpasses the impression to be made
by a meager description. The room partially lighted by
damar torches ; the clang of the noisy instruments ;
the crowd of wild spectators ; their screams of encour-
agement to the performers; the flowing hair and mpin
evolutions of the dancers, formed a scene I wish could
have been reduced to painting by such a mailer as :
KXI'KUITION TO BORNEO. 41
brandt or Caruvaggio. The next dance was performed
by a single person, with a spear, turning like the last ;
now advancing, retiring, poising, brandishing, or pre-
tending to hurl his weapon. Subsequently we had an
exhibition with the sword and shield, very similar to
the others, and only differing in the use of the weapons ;
and the performance was closed by a long and animated
dance like the first, by two of the best performers.
" The dance with the spear is called Talarnbong ; that
with the sword, Mancha. The resemblance of these
dances to those of the South Seas is, as I have observed,
a remarkable and interesting fact, and one of many oth-
ers which may, in course of time, elucidate the proba-
ble theory that the two people are sprung from a com-
mon source. The Malays of Sarawak, and other pla-
ces in the neighborhood of the Dyak tribes, dance these
dances ; but they are unknown to Borneo Proper, and
the other Malay islands ; and although the names may
be given by the Malays, I think there is no doubt that
the dances themselves belong to the Dyaks : a corrector
judgment can be formed by a better acquaintance with
other Dyak tribes. -
" The household utensils in use here are few and sim-
ple. The mode of grinding padi clear of the husk is
through the trunk of a tree cut into two parts, the up-
per portion being hollow, the lower solid ; small notches
are cut where the two pieces fit, and handles attached
to the upper part, which being filled with padi and kept
turning round, the husk is detached and escapes by the
notches.
" The Dyaks, as is well known, are famous for the
manufacture of iron. The forge here is of the simplest
construction, and formed by two hollow trees, each about
seven feet high, placed upright, side by side, in the
ground ; from the lower extremity of these, two pipes
of bamboo are led through a clay -bank, three inches thick,
into a charcoal fire ; a man is perched at the top of the
trees, and pumps with two pistons (the suckers of which
are made of cocks' feathers), which being raised and de-
pressed alternately, blow a regular stream of air into the
fire. Drawings were taken of these and other utensils
and instruments. The canoes are not peculiar, but the
D2
42 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
largest prahus (some forty feet long, with a good beam)
are constructed, in the first place, exactly like a small
canoe : a single tree is hollowed out, which forms the
keel and kelson, and on this foundation the rest of the
prahu is built with planks, and her lew timbers fasten-
ed with ratans. A prahu of fifty feet long, .fitted for
service, with oars, mast, attops, &c., was ordered by the
Panglima Rajah while we were with him, which, com-
pleted, was to cost thirty reals, or sixty Java rupees, or
d6 English. During the course of the day we ascended
the river to visit the settlement of Chinese lately estab-
lished here. It is situated about two and a half miles
up the river, on the same side as Tungong, and consists
of. thirty men (real Chinese), and five women of the
mixed breed of Sambas. Nothing can be more flourish-
ing than this infant settlement, and I could hardly credit
their statement that it had only been formed between
four and five months. The soil they represented as
most excellent, and none are better judges ; many acres
were cleared and under cultivation ; rice, slrih, sweet
potatoes (convolvulus), Indian corn, &c., &c., were grow-
ing abundantly ; and they were able to supply us with
seven pecul, or 933 pounds of sweet potatoes, without
sensibly diminishing their crop. They showed me sam-
ples of birds' nests, bees' wax, garu wood (lignum aloes),
and ebony, collected in the vicinity, chiefly from (iu-
nong Gading. Several peculs of birds' nests and bees'
wax, and the wood in large quantity, could now be
brought to market ; and no doubt, when demand stimu-
lates industry, the quantities would greatly increase.
The Dyaks, they told me, collected ratans, and like-
wise canes, which are plentiful. The mixed breed of
the Chinese with the Malay or Dyak are a good-look-
ing and industrious race, partaking much more of the
Chinese character than that of the natives of this coun-
try. This mainly arises from education and early -form-
ed habits, which are altogether Chinese ; and in religion
and customs they likewise follow, in a great measure,
the paternal stock. The race are worthy of attention,
as the future possessors of Borneo. The numbers ol'
tliis people can not be stated, but it must amount to many
thousand persons : 3000 were said to be on their way
to the Borneon territory
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 43
" The head man of this settlement, a Chinese of
Quantung, or Canton, but long resident in the vicinity of
Sambas, gave me some valuable information respecting
the Sarawak mountains. He had, with a considerable
party of his countrymen, been employed there at the
gold-mines, and he spoke of them as abundant, and of
the ore as good. Tin they had not found, but thought
it existed. Antimony ore was to be had in any quanti-
ties, and diamonds were likewise discovered. I men-
tion these facts as coming from an intelligent Chinese,
well able from experience to judge of the precious met-
als, and the probability of their being found.
3d. Night, as usual, set in with torrents of rain,
which lasted until the morning : the days, however, are
fine, though cloudy. Got sights in the afternoon ; and,
leaving our Dyak friends, we dropped down to the mouth
of the river, where we slept.
" 4^. At 2 A.M. got under weigh for the Samatan
river, which we reached at 8 A.M. I had been given to
understand that the Lundu and Sibnowan Dyaks were
to be found on this river ; but on arriving, I was informed
we must proceed to Seru, where we should see plenty
of Dy^ks. I accordingly started immediately after
breakfast, and reached Seru after mid-day. Here we
found a small Malay fishing village, with two or three
stray Dyaks of the Sibnowan tribe ; and, on inquiring,
we were told by them that their countiy was far away.
Being convinced that the Pangeran had dragged me all
this distance to answer some purpose of his own, I re-
embarked on the instant, and set off on my return to
Lundu, indignant enough. However, I had the poor
satisfaction of dragging them after me, and making them
repent their trick, which I believe was nothing else than
to visit the island of Talang Talang for turtles' eggs.
We were pretty well knocked up by the time we reached
Samatan, having been pulling thirteen hours, the greater
part of the time under a burning sun.
" The Samatan river, like the others, is inclosed in a
bay choked with sand : the boat-passage is on the right-
hand side, going in near Point Samatan. The sands are
mostly dry at low water, and stretch out a considerable
distance. There is a fishing station here, though not so
44 r.M'KbrriuiV TO
large as at Seru, and the fish at both places are very
plentiful, arid are salted for exportation to Sambas, and
along their own coast. Seru is a shallow creek; the
village may consist of 50 or 60 inhabitants, and the sands
stretch a long way out. We thus lost two days, through
the cunning of our Malay attendant ; and the only ad-
vantage gained is being enabled to fill up the details of
our survey of this bay.
" 5th. The day consumed returning along the coast
to the Lundu, and we did not reach Tungong till late.
" 6th. Remained at Tungong. Every impediment
was thrown in my way to prevent my reaching the Lun-
du Dyaks; the distance was great, the tribe small and un-
settled, there was little probability of finding them, &c.
I would, however, have gone ; but another cause had
arisen of a more ^serious nature. My feet, from the
heat of the sun, musqueto-bites, and cuts (for I foolishly
went without shoes that unlucky day to Seru), had be-
come so painful and inflamed that I felt great doubt
whether, if I walked in pain to Lundu, I could come
back again. With the best grace I could, I yielded the
point ; with a vow, however, never to have the same
Pangeran again. I did manage to be civil to him, from
policy alone. He was superfluously kind and obliging.
" 7th. Left Tungong on our return to the vessel, and
brought-to for the night at Tanjong Siri. In the even-
ing I walked along the fine sandy beach as far as the en-
trance of the Sumpudin river. We saw many wild
hogs ; and on one occasion I was able to get within twen-
ty yards of some ten of them together, among some large
drift-wood. Just as I was crawling over a tree and bal-
ancing, I found myself confronted by these animals ; but
they were out of sight almost before I could cock my
gun and fire. They were of a large size, and most of
them we saw during the evening either dirty white, or
white and black. At night, after we had retired to our
quarters in the Pangeran's boat, she tilled with water.
and was near going down. The first intimation we ha I
of it was the .writer wetting our mats on which we wet
sleeping. She was beached and haled out', and a hand
kept baling all night, as they had laden her so deep that
s!-.e leaked considerably.
EXPEDITION TO HoKNKn. 45
" Mli. In the morning we got our anchor at daylight,
and breakfasted on the island of Sumpudin. There are
deer, hogs, and pigeons on Sumpudin Island ; but what
was more interesting to me was, the discovery of the
wild nutmeg-tree in full flower, and growing to the
height of twenty or thirty feet. The nutmegs lay in
plenty under the trees, and are of considerable size,
though elongated in shape, and tasteless, as usual in the
wild sorts. While the East India Company were send-
ing Captain Forest from their settlement of Balamban-
gan as far as New Guinea in search of this plant, how
little they dreamed of its flourishing so near them on the
island of Borneo ! The soil on which they grow is a
yellowish clay, mixed with vegetable mould. I brought
some of the fruit away with me. After breakfast, a
breeze springing up, we sailed to the mouth of the Sa-
rawak river, waited for the tide, and pushed on for the
vessel, getting aboard about half past three in the morn-
ing. Our Malay attendants were left far, far behind, and
there is little chance of their being here to-morrow, for
their boats sail wretchedly."
CHAPTER IV.
Renewed intercourse with the Rajah. Prospects of trade. Ou-
rang-outang, and other animals. The two sorts of miias. Des-
cription of the Rajah, his suite, and Panglimas, &c. The char-
acter of the natives. Leave Sarawak. Songi Dyaks. Visit
Seriff Sahib. Buyat tongue. Attack by pirates. Sail for Sin-
gapore.
HAVING returned to Sarawak, Mr. Brooke renewed
his intercourse with the rajah; and his Journal pro-
ceeds :
" Sept. 9th. Visited the rajah ; civil and polite I
ought indeed to say friendly and kind. Der Macota
was on board, speaking on the trade, and very anxious
for me to arrange the subject with the rajah. I could
only say, that I would do so if the rajah wished, as I
believed it would be greatly for the benefit of their coun-
try and Singapore.
"lO/A Laid up with my bad legs, and hardly able
46 EXPEDITION TO BOllNEO.
to crawl. Muda Hassim presented us with another
bullock, which we salted. At Lundu we bought eight
pigs, which arrived to-day in charge of Kalong, the
young Dyak. He is a fine fello^v. 1 gave him a gun,
powder-flask, powder, &c. He was truly delighted.
Our Pangerans arrived at the same time.
" llth. Very bad ; got a novel, and read all day.
Went ashore to see Muda Hassim in the evening. Ho
gave us a private audience : and we finished our discus-
sion respecting the trade, and I think successfully.
" I began by saying, that I as a private gentleman,
unconnected with commerce, could have no personal in-
terest in what I was about to speak ; that the rajah
must clearly understand that I was in no way connect-
ed with the government of Singapore, and no way au-
thorized to act for them : that he must, therefore, look
upon it merely as my private opinion, and act afterward
as his wisdom thought fit. I represented to him that
the kingdom of Borneo was the last Malay state pos-
sessing any power, and that this might be in a great
measure attributed to the little intercourse they had had
with European powers. I thought it highly advisable
to call into play the resources of his country, by opening
a trade with individual European merchants. Sarawak,
I stated, was a rich place, and the territory around pro-
duced many valuable articles for a commercial inter-
course bees-wax, birds-nests, rattans, beside large
quantities of antimony ore and sago, which might be
considered the staple produce of the country. In return
for these, the merchants of Singapore could send goods
from Europe or China which his people required, such
as gunpowder, muskets, cloths, &c. ; and both parties
would thus be benefited by their commercial inter-
change of commodities. I conceived that Singapore
was well fitted for trade with this place. The raja 1 1
must not suppose I was desirous of excluding other na-
tions from trading here, or that 1 wished ho should trade
with the English alone; on the contrary, I thought that
the Americans, the French, or any other nation, should
bo admitted on 1lio same terms as the English.
" Of course, I was not allowed to proceed without
much qucstionin." and discussion; uianv of the \ie\v:-;
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 47
were urged and re-urged, to remove their false notions. ,
That Mr. Bonham had the supreme command of the
trade of Singapore was the prominent one ; and when
he died, or was removed, would not the next governor
alter all kind intentions and acts ? What friend should
they have at Singapore then ?'
" Again they thought that a few ships might come at
first ; but then they would deceive them, and not come
again. It was very difficult to explain, that if they pro-
cured cargoes at an advantageous rate, they would come
here for their own benefit ; if not, of course it would
not be worth their while to come at all. The entire
discussion proceeded with the utmost good-will and po-
liteness.
"That the political ascendency of the English is par-
amount here is apparent. They might if they pleased,
by means of an offensive and defensive alliance between
the two powers, gain the entire trade of the northwest
coast of Borneo, from Tanjong Datu to Malludu Bay.
" I obtained subsequently from Macota the following
list of imports and exports ; which I here commit to
paper, for the information of those whom it may concern.
"From Singapore. Iron; salt, Siam ; nankeen;
Madras, Europe, and China cotton cloth, coarse and
fine ; Bugis and Pulicat sarongs ; gold and other threads,
of sorts and colors ; brass wire, of sizes ; iron pans from
Siam, called qualis ; chintzes, of colors and sorts ; coarse
red broadcloth, and other sorts of different colors ; China
crockery ; gunpowder ; muskets ; flints ; handkerchiefs
(Pulicat and European) ; gambir ; dates ; Java tobacco ;
soft sugar ; sugar- candy ; biscuits ; baharri ; common^
decanters ; glasses, &c. &c. ; China silk, of colors ; ging
hams ; white cottons ; nails ; beside other little things
such as Venetian beads ; ginger; curry-powder; onions
ghee ; &c. &c.
" The returns from Sarawak are now : antimony ore
sago, timber (lackah, garu), rattans, Malacca canes, bee*
wax, birds-nests, rice, &c. Other articles, such as gola,
tin, &c. &e., Macota said, would be procured after tho
war, but at present he need say nothing of them ; the
articles above mentioned might subsequently be greatly
increased by demand ; and, in short, as every person of
48 I'KDITION To UOUNKO.
experience knows, in a wild country a trade must be
fostered at first.
" To the foregoing list I must add, pipeclay, vegetable
tallow, which might be useful in commerce, being of fine
quality ; and the ore, found in abundance round here,
of which I can make nothing, but which I believe to be
copper.
" 12ih. I received from the rajah a present of an
ourang-outang, young, and like others I have seen, but
better clothed, with fine long hair of a bright chestnut
color. The same melancholy which characterizes her
race is apparent in Betsy's face ; and though but just
caught, she is quite quiet unless teased.
" From the man who brought Betsy I procured a l^i
mur tardigradus, called by the Malays Cucan, not Pou-
can, as written in Cuvier Marsden has the name right
in his dictionaiy and at the same time the mutilated
hand of an ourang-outang of enormous size. This hand
far exceeds in length, breadth, and power, the hand of
any man in the ship ; and though smoked and shrunk,
the circumference of the fingers is half as big again as
an ordinary human finger. The natives of Borneo call
the ourang-outang the Mias, of which they say there
are two distinct sorts ; one called the M-ias romln (simi-
lar to the specimen aboard and the two in the Zoologi-
cal Gardens), and the Mias pappan, a creature far
larger, and more difficult to procure. To the latter kind
the hand belongs. The mias pappan is represented to
be as tall or taller than a man, and possessing vast
strength : the face is fuller and larger than that of the
mias rombi, and the hair reddish, but sometimes ap-
proaching to black. The mias rombi never exceeds four
or four and a half feet ; his face, unlike the pappan, is
long, and his hair redder. I must own myself inclined
to this opinion from various reasons : 1st. The natives
appear so well agreed on the point, and so well acquaint-
ed with the distinction and the different names, that it
is impossible to suppose it a fabrication for our peculiar
use. Of the many whom I asked respecting them, at
different times and in different places, the greater part
of their own accord mentioned the difference between
the mi:;-: pappan and the mias rombi. The animal
TO 1;<)11M..,. 10
\vluMi brought aboard \vas slated to be the niias rombi,
or small sort. In short, the natives, whether right or
wrong, make the distinction. 2d. The immense size of
the hand in my possession, the height of the animal
killed on the coast of Sumatra, and the skull in the Paris
Museum, can scarcely be referred to an animal such as
we know at homo ; though by specious analogical rea-
soning, the great disparity of the skulls has been pro-
nounced the result merely of age.
" However, facts are wanting, and these facts I doubt
not I can soon procure, if not actual proof; and which-
ever way it goes, in favor of Buffon's Pongo or not, I
shall be contented, so that I bring truth to light.
" 19th. From the 12th to the 19th of September we
Jay, anxious to be oft", but delayed by some trifling occur-
rence or other, particularly for the letters which I was
to receive for the merchants of Singapore. Our inter-
course the whole time was most friendly and frequent ;
almost daily I was ashore, and the rajah often visited the
vessel. How tedious and ennuy-ant to me can only be
known by those who know me well, and how repugnant
these trammels of society and ceremony are to nature.
Nevertheless, I suffered this martyrdom with exempla-
ry outward patience, though the spirit flagged, and the
thoughts wandered, and the head often grew confused,
with sitting and talking trifling nonsense, through a poor
interpreter.
" I here bid adieu to these kind friends, fully impress-
ed with their kindness, and the goodness of their dispo-
sitions. To me they are far different from anything I
was at all prepared to meet, and devoid of the vices with
which their countrymen are usually stigmatized by mod-
ern writers. I expected to find an indolent and some-
what insolent people, devoted to sensual enjoyments,
addicted to smoking opium, and eternally cock-fighting
or gambling : let me speak it to the honor of the Bor-
neons, that they neither cock-fight nor smoke opium;
and in the military train of their rajah they find at Ku-
ching few conveniences and fewer luxuries. Like all
the followers of Islam, they sanction polygamy ; and the
number of their women, and, probably, the ease and
cheerfulness of the seraglio, contrasted with the cere-
4 K
50 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
monial of the exterior, induce them to puss ;i number
of their hours amid their women, and excite habits of
effeminacy and indolence. I should pronounce them
indolent and unwarlike ; but kind and unreserved to for-
eigners, particularly to Englishmen. They are volatile,
generally speaking very ignorant, but by no means defi-
cient in acuteness of understanding ; and, indeed, their
chief defects may be traced entirely to their total want
of education, and the nature of their government. The
lower orders of people are poor and wretched, and the
freemen are certainly poorer and more wretched than
the slaves. They are not greatly addicted to theft, and
yet, unlike the scrupulous honesty of the Sibnowans,
they pilfered some trifling articles occasionally when left
in their way. The retainers of the court showed much
the same mean intriguing spirit which is too often found
in courts, and always in Eastern ones; and the rajah
himself seldom requested any favor from me directly,
but employed some intermediate person to sound me
to get whatever was required for himself if possible, if
not for the rajah. I took the hint, and always express-
ed my wishes through the interpreter when not ] > -
myself. In this way we were enabled to grant or re-
fuse without the chance of insult or alienee. The suite
of the rajah consists principally of slaves, either pur-
chased or debtors : they are well treated, and rise to
offices of some note. The Panglima rajah was u slave-
debtor, though we did not know it for some time after
our arrival. I never saw either cruelty or undue harsh-
ness exercised by the great men during my stay, and in
general their manners were affable and kind to those
about them. The Rajah Muda Hassim is a remarka-
bly short man, and slightly built ; about 45 years of age ;
active and intelligent, but apparently little inclined to
business. His disposition I formed the highest estimate
of, not only from his kindness to myself, but from the-
testimony of many witnesses, all of whom spoke of him
with affection, and gavo him the character of a mild and
gentle master. Muda Hassim' s own brother, Mud;,.
Mahammed, is a reserved and sulky man, but they spoke
well of him; and the rajah sn.id li >'l man, bus;
given to fits of < ' itv
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 51
"Der Macota, unlike other Malays, neither smokes
tobacco nor chews sirih. He sought our society, and
was the first person who spoke to me on the subject ot
the trade. His education has been more attended to
than that of others of his rank. He both reads and
writes his own language, and is well acquainted with the
government, laws, and customs of Borneo. From him I
derived much information on the subject of the Dyaks,
and the geography of the interior ; and if I have failed
to put it down, it is because I have not departed from
my general rule of never giving any native statements
unless they go far to verify my own actual observations.
I parted from the rajah with regret, some six or seven
miles down the river. Never was such a blazing as
when we left Sarawak ; twenty-one guns I fired to the
rajah, and he fired forty-two to me at least we counted
twenty-four, and they went on firing afterward, as long
as ever we were in sight. The last words the Rajah
Muda Hassim said, as I took my leave, were ' Tuan
Brooke, do not forget me.'
" Among the curiosities in my possession are spears,
swords, and shields, from various tribes ; a coat of mail,
made to the northward of Borneo, and worn by the pi-
rates ; specimens of Sakarran Dyak manufacture of
cloth, and Sarebus ditto ; ornaments and implements of
the Sibnowans ; and, last not least, a gold-handled kris,
presented me by the rajah, which formerly belonged to
his father, and which he constantly wore himself. I
likewise presented him with a small English dagger,
with a mother-of-pearl handle ; and my favor was so
high with him, that he used always to wear my gift, and
I, to return the compliment, wore his.
"The climate of Sarawak is good, and is seldom
hot : the last eight or ten days were oppressive, but
until then we could sleep with a blanket, and seldom
found it too warm in the day. Rain at this season falls
in great quantities ; and from imprudence, our crew
suffered on their first arrival from colds and rheuma-
tism ; but getting more careful, we had latterly no sick-
list.
" Farewell to Sarawak ! I hope to see it again ; and
have obtained a promise from the rajah that he will go
52 EXPEDITION TO Bo::
with me to Borneo, and show mo eveiy part of the
country by the way.
" I may here state the result of some inquiries I have
made respecting the government of Borneo. The form
of government may be considered aristocratic rather than
oligarchical : it is ruled by the sultan, but his power is
kept in check by four great officers of government.
These are, the Rajah Muda Hassim, the Bandar, in
whose hands is the government of the country; Pan-
geran Mumin. the Degadon, the treasurer, or, as Mr.
Hunt says, controller of the household of the sultan ;
Pangeran Tizudeen, Tumangong, or commander-in-
chief; and Pangeran Kurmaindar, the Pen-damei, or
mediator and interceder.- This officer is the means of
communication or mediation between the sultan and his
Pangerans ; and in case of condemnation, he sues for the
pardon or mercy of his sovereign. Mr. Hunt, in his
short but excellent paper on Borneo, mentions some
other officers of state : I will not follow him, but in the
names, as well as duties of these officers, his account
agrees with my information. Further than this, I have
not yet learned, therefore state not ; for I am not man-
ufacturing a book, but gaining information. 1 may add,
however, that these offices are elective, and not hered-
itary : as far as I yet know, I am inclined to believe the
election rests with the chief Pangerans of the state ; not
only those in office, but others. When I reach Borneo
I can procure more ample details.
44 23d. Quitted the Royalist at the entrance of the
Morotaba, and accompanied by Pangerans Subtu and
Illudeen, set sail for the river Sadung.
" The town called Songi is of considerable size, and
the entire population along the river may certainly bo
reckoned at from 2000 to 3000 persons, independent of
Dyaks. The country has a flourishing aspect, but the
soil is represented as bad, being soft and muddy. There
is a good deal of trade from this river, and it annually
sends several large prahus to Singapore : two were lying
off the town when we arrivedj and two others had sailed
for that place twenty days before. The produce of the
country is bees-wax, birds'-nests, rirr, iVc. &c., but
they seem to he pmmred in less abundance than in the
KXl'FJH'l 1<>\ I'o I'.MRNEO. 53
other (-uiili^uous rivers. There is nothing peculiar
about the Malay population, except that, generally
speaking, it struck me, they appeared better off than
the people of Sarawak, or others I have visited herea-
bouts. We ascended the river by night, anchored a
short distance from the Songi, in a tide-way like a sluice,
and entered the smaller river shortly after daylight.
Having sent the Pangerans ahead to advise Seriff Sahib
of our arrival, we pulled slowly up to the campong of the
Datu Jembrong, where we brought up to breakfast.
Datu Jembrong is a native of Mindanao, an Illanun and
a pirate ; he is slightly advanced in years, but stout and
resolute-looking, and of a most polite demeanor as oily-
tongued a cut-throat as a gentleman would wish to
associate with. He spoke of his former life without
hesitation, and confessed himself rather apprehensive of
going to Singapore. He was remarkably civil, and sent
us a breakfast of some fruit, salt fish, stale turtles' eggs,
and coffee sweetened with syrup ; but spite of all this,
his blood-thirsty education and habits prejudiced me
against him. Breakfast finished, we went forward to
visit Seriff Sahib, who received us in an open hall ;
promised to get us as many animals as he could now ;
regretted our short stay, and assured me he would col-
lect more by the time I returned. Among these is to
be a mlas pappan, living or dead. I at the same time
offered ten dollars for the skeleton belonging to the hand
already in my possession, and a less sum for the parts.
Being the first Europeans SerifF Sahib had ever met, he
was rather puzzled to know what we were like ; but we
had every reason to be satisfied with his kindness and
the civility of his people : the inhabitants, though crowd-
ing to see us, are by no means intrusive, and their curi-
osity is too natural to be harshly repressed. I need
hardly remark here how very erroneously the position
of the Sadung river is laid down in the charts, it being
placed in the bay, to the westward of Santobong, and
nearly in the position of the Samatan river.
" 25th. The last night was passed off Datu Jem-
brong's house, and I left him with a firm impression
that he is still a pirate, or at any rate connected with
them. He resides generally at Tawarron, to the north-
E2
54 EXPEDITION To HORNED.
ward of Borneo Proper, where his wivos and children
now are, and lie has conio here to superintend tin?
building of a prahu. The people about him speak of his
pursuits without disguise, and many informed us the
prahu near his house is intended for a piratical vessel.
Nothing could exceed the polite kindness of our rascally
host, and I spent the rainy evening in his house with
some satisfaction, acquiring information of the coast to
the northward, which he is well able to give.
" In the morning we dropped down with the last of
the ebb to the mouth of the Songi, and took the young
flood to proceed up the Sadung. Beyond the point of
junction with the Songi the Sadung retains an average
breadth of from three-quarters of a mile to a mile. The
banks continue to be partially cleared, with here and
there a few Dyaks residing in single families or small
communities on their ladangs or farms. The Dyak
campong, which terminated our progress up the stream,
consists of three moderately long houses inhabited by
Sibnowans. The manners, customs, a'nd language of
the Sibnowans of the Sadung are the same as those of
their Lundu brethren ; they are, however, a wilder peo-
ple, and appear poor. Like other Dyaks, they had a
collection of heads hanging before the entrance of their
chiefs private apartments. Some of these heads were
fresh, and, with the utmost sang-froid, they told us they
were women's. They declared, however, they never
took any heads but those of their enemies, and these
women (unhappy creatures) had belonged to a distant
tribe. The fresh heads were ornamented with fowl's
feathers, and suspended rather conspicuously in separate
rattan frames of open work. They professed t hemselves
willing to go with me up the river to the mountains;
and on the way, they informed me, wen; SOUK; largo
Malay towns, beside some more campongs of their own
countrymen. Farther up they enumerated some twenty
tribes of Dyaks, whose names I thought it useless to
preserve. Late in the evening we set oft* on our re-
turn, and anchored once again near Datu Jembrong's
house.
"26#t Again visited Seriff Sahib. His name and
descent are Arabic ; his father, an Arab, having married
I r;urno.\ Tfl UOUNEO. 55
l ihr l.nriKM) .Kujiih. Thu Malays evidently
honor this descent, and consider his birth very high.
His power, they say, equals his family ; as he is, in
some measure, independent ; and were he to instigate
the Sadung country to hike arms against Borneo, it
is veiy probable he would overthrow the government,
and make himself Sultan of Borneo. In person, this
noble partakes much of his father's race, both in height
and features, being tall and large, with a fine nose and
contour of face. His manners are reserved but kind ;
and he looks as if too indolent to care much about ac-
quiring power; too fat for an active traitor, though a
dangerous man to oppress. We were the first Euro-
peans he had ever seen; but, on our second visit, he
lost much of his previous reserve, and was curious in
examining our arms and accoutrements. We, as usual,
exchanged presents ; mine consisting of some nankeen,
red cloth, knife, scissors, and handkerchief; while he
gave me the shield of a great Kay an wan-ior, a Bukar
spear, a goat, fowls, and our dinner and breakfast daily.
He promised me specimens of the arms of all the Dyak
tribes, and plenty of animals, particularly my much-de-
sired mias pappan ; and I, in return, agreed to bring him
two small tables, six chairs, and a gun. Subsequently
to our interview he sent me a tattooed Dyak, the first ]
had seen. The lines, correctly and even elegantly laid
in, of a blue color, extended from the throat to his feet.
I gained but little information ; yet the history of the
poor man is curious, and similar to that of many other
unfortunates. He represented himself as a chief among
his own people in the country of Buyat, five days' jour-
ney up the Cotringen river (vulgo Coti river). Going
in his canoe from the latter place to Banjamassim, he
was captured by Illanun pirates, with whom he was in
bondage for some time, but ultimately sold as a slave to
a resident of Sadung. It was now five years since he
became first captive; but having lately got money
enough to buy his liberty, he is again a freeman ; and
having married, and turned to the religion of Islam,
desires no longer to revisit his native country. The
language of the tribe of Buyat he represents as
entirely Malay. I made him a small present for
50 EXPEDITION TO UOKNEO.
the trouble I had given him, and ho departed well
content.
" About three o'clock in the afternoon we h;id a heavy
thunder-storm, with lightning as vivid as the tropics pro-
duce. Torrents of rain descended, and continued a great
part of the night ; but, sheltered by our kajangs or mats,
we managed to keep tolerably diy. Indeed, the voya-
ger on this coast must be prepared for exposure to heavy
rains, and considerable detention from thick and cloudy
weather. The latter obstruction, of little moment or
even agreeable to those making a passage, is a cause of
much vexation in surveying the coast, as for days together
no observations are to be had.
" 27th. About 7 A. M. we quitted Songi, and dropped
down as far as TanjongBalaban, a low point forming the
larboard entrance into the Sadung river, and bounding
the bay, which lies between it and Tanjoug Sipang.
Coming to this point gave us a good offing for our return,
and enabled me to take a round of angles to finish the
survey as far as this point and Pulo Burong, which lies
ofif it. We crossed over the sand Hats with a light
breeze, and reached the Royalist at 4 r. M. In the
evening the Datu Jembrong, who had preceded us from
Sadung, spent the evening aboard. He expressed his
willingness to accompany me next season : whether I
shall take him is another question ; but, could he be
trusted, his services might be highly useful.
" Our Pangerans arrived early this morning from Sa-
dung ; and to-morrow was fixed for our departure, when
an unforeseen occurrence caused a farther detention.
The day passed quietly : in the evening I was ashore,
and took leave of the Pangerans Subtu and Jlludeen,
who returned to Sarawak, leaving the Panglima Rajah
to pilot us out. The first part of the night was dark;
and the Panglima in his prahu, with twelve men, lay
close to the shore, and under the dark shadow of the
hill. About nine, the attention of the watch on deck
was attracted by some bustle ashore, and it soon swelled
to the wildest cries; the only word we could distinguish,
however, being 'Dyak! Dyak!' All hands were in-
stantly on deck. I gave the order to charge and lire a
gun with a blank cartridge, and in the mean time lit a
DITION ro HolIiN I'.c 57
blue liulil. The &i was lowered, a few muskets ami
cutlasses thrown into her, and I started in the hope of
rescuing our poor Malay friends. The vessel meanwhile
was prepared for defence : guns loaded, boarding-nettings
ready for running up, and the people at quarters ; for
we were ignorant of the number, the strength, or even
the description of the assailants. I met the Panglima's
boat pulling toward the vessel, and returned with her,
considering it useless and rash to pursue the foe. The
story is soon told. A fire had been lit on the shore;
and after the people had eaten, they anchored then-
boat, and, according to their custom, went to sleep. The
fire had probably attracted the roving Sarebus Dyaks,
who stole upon them, took them by surprise, and would
inevitably have cut them off' but for our presence. They
attacked the prahu fiercely with their spears ; five out of
twelve jumped into the water, and swam ashore ; and
the Panglima Rajah was wounded severely. When our
blue light was seen they desisted ; and directly the gun
fired, paddled away fast. We never saw them. The
poor Panglima walked aboard with a spear fixed in his
breast, the barb being buried, and a second rusty spear-
wound close to the first ; the head of the weapon was
cut out, his wounds dressed, and he was put to bed.
Another man had a wound from a wooden-headed spear ;
and most had been struck more or less by these rude and,
luckily, innocuous weapons. A dozen or two of Dyak
spears were left in the Malay boat, which I got. Some
were well-shaped, with iron heads ; but the mass simply
pieces of hard wood sharp-pointed, which they hurl in
great numbers. Fire-arms the Dyaks had none, and
during the attack made no noise whatever ; while the
Malays, on the contrary, shouted lustily, some perhaps
from bravery, most from terror. The force that attacked
them was differently stated ; some said the boat con-
tained eighty or a hundred men, others rated the num-
ber as low as fifty ; and, allowing for an exaggeration, pei--
haps there might have been thirty-five not fewer, from
the number of spears thrown. Being fully prepared, we
set our watch, and retired as usual to our beds ; the
stealthy and daring attack, right under the guns of the
schooner, having given me a lesson to keep the guns
58 EXPEDITION TO BORN HO.
charged in future. The plan was well devised; for we
could not fire without the chance of hitting our friends
as well as foes, and the deep shadow of the hill entirely
prevented our seeing the assailants.
" 29//i. I considered it necessary to dispatch a boat
to Sarawak to acquaint the rajah with the circumstance
of the attack made on his boat. The wound of the
Panglima was so severe, that in common humanity I
was obliged to wait until all danger for him was past.
He was soon well ; and, as with natives in general, his
wound promises favorably ; to a European constitution
a similar wound would be imminently dangerous.
"3Qth. Took the long boat, and sounded along the
edge of the sand ; soundings very regular. In the eve
ning Mr. Williamson returned in the gig, and a host of
Pangerans ; the Pangeran Macota at the head. lie
urged me much to go and see Muda Hassim. The rajah,
he said, desired it so much, and would think it so kind,
that I consented to go up to-morrow. I am very desirous
to fix their good feelings toward us : and I was prompted
by curiosity to see the rajah's menage as his guest.
" October 1st We had a heavy pull against tide, and
arrived at Sarawak about 4 P.M. We had eaten nothing
since breakfast at 8 ; and we had to sit and talk, and
drink tea and smoke, till 8 in the evening ; then dinner
was announced, and we retired to the private apart-
ments my poor men came willingly too ! The table
was laid d VAnglaise, a good curry and rice, grilled
fowls, and a bottle of wine. We did justice to our
cheer ; and the rajah, throwing away all reserve, bust -led
about with the proud and pleasing consciousness of hav-
ing given us an English dinner in proper style ; now
drawing the wine; now changing our plates; pressing
us to eat; saying, 'You are at home.' Dinaerover,
we sat, and drank, and smoked, and talked cheerfully,
till, tired and weary, we expressed a wish to retire, and
were shown to a private room. A crimson silk niat-
inbroidered with gold, was my couch : it was
covered with white gold-embroidered mats and pillows.
Our men fared equally well, and enjoyed their wine. ;
luxury to us: our stock of wine and spirits having bct-r
expended some time.
i:\l'i;i)ITION TO BORNEO. 59
' -i<l. ---Once more bade adieu to our kind friends;
reached the vessel at 4 P.M., and got under weigh di-
rectly. At dusk anchored in the passage between the
sands.
3^. Five A.M. under weigh. Clear of the sands
about mid-day, and shaped our course for Singapore.
" 4th. Strong breeze from w.s.w. Beating from
leeward of Datu to Pulo Murrundum, in a nasty chop
of a head sea."
CHAPTER V.
Summary of information obtained during this visit to Borneo.
Geographical and topographical observations. Produce. Va-
rious Dyak tribes. Natural history. Language. Origin of
Races. Sail from Singapore. Celebes. Face of the country.
Waterfall.
MR. BROOKE'S journal continues his observations on
the people and country he had just left; and, I need
hardly say, communicates much of novelty and interest
in his own plain and simple manner.
" Oct. 5th. Just laying our course. I may here brief-
ly recapitulate the information acquired during the last
two months and a half. Beginning from Tanjong Api,
we have delineated the coast as far as Tanjong Balaban,
fixing the principal points by chronometer and observa-
tion, and filling in the details by personal inspection. The
distance, on a line drawn along the headlands, may be
from 120 to 130 miles, the entire coast being previously
quite unknown.
"Within this space are many fine rivers, and some
navigable for vessels of considerable burden, and well cal-
culated for the extension of commerce, such as Sarawak,
Morotaba, and Sadung. The others, equally fine streams,
are barred, but offer admirable means for an easy inland
communication ; these are the Quop, Boyur, Riam,
Samarahan, Lundu, Samatan, &c. In our excursions
into the interior of the island, most of these streams have
been ascended to a distance of 25 or 30 miles, and some
further. We traced the Samarahan river for 70 or
60 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
80 miles from its mouth, and passed through portions of
the intermediate streams of the Riam, Quop, and Boy-
ur. The Morotaba, which is but another mouth of the
Sarawak, we passed through several times from the sea
to its junction with that river. The Lundu and Sadung
rivers were likewise ascended to the distance of near
3U miles ; and plans of all these rivers have been taken
as accurately as circumstances would permit, by obser-
vations of the latitude and longitude, and various points,
and an eye-sketch of the distance of each reach and the
compass bearing. The entrances into the Sarawak and
Morotaba were carefully examined, and the former ac-
curately laid down. The productions of the country at-
tracted our attention, and the articles best fitted for com-
merce have been already enumerated. Among these
are, first, minerals ; say gold, tin, probably copper, anti-
mony-ore, and fine white clay for pipes. Secondly,
woods of the finest descriptions, for ship-building, and
other purposes ; besides aloes wood (lignum aloes], and
arang or ebony wood, canes, and ratans. To these may
be added, among vegetable productions, sago, compon,
vice, &c., &c.
" The wild nutmeg was found growing on the islands
of Sadung and Sumpudin in abundance and perfection,
proving that by cultivation it might be brought into the
market as cheap, and probably as good, as those produ-
ced in the Moluccas. W^e have various specimens of
ores and stories, which, on being tested, may prove val-
uable commodities. Among these is decomposed gran-
ite rock (I believe), containing minute particles of what
we conceive to be gold, and an ore believed to be copper.
Besides the articles above enumerated, nre birds' nesis
and bees' wax in considerable quantities, and others not
worth detailing here. We have been able, during our
residence with the Borneons, to continue on the most
friendly terms with them, and to open a field of research
for our subsequent inquiries in the proper season. My
attention lias been anxiously directed to acquiring a knowl-
edge of the Dyak tribes ; and for this purpose 1 passed
1 en days among them at Lundu. I have made such vo-
cabularies of the language of the Sibnowansand Lund us
us my means allowed ; and a further addition of iheir
EX I' EDITION TO BORNEO. 01
various dialects will furnish, I conceive, umlturs of high
importance to those interested in tracing the emigration
of nations. I may here briefly notice, that the nation
of Kayans, included under the common denomination of
Dyak, are a tattooed race, who use the sumpitan, or
blow-pipe ; while the other Dyak tribes (which are veiy
numerous) are not tattooed, and never use the blow-
pipe.
" The arms and instruments of many tribes are in my
possession ; and among the Sibnowans I had the oppor-
tunity of becoming acquainted with their habits, customs,
and modes of living.
" The appellation of the Dyak tribes near the coast
is usually the same as the rivers from which they orig-
inally came. The Dyaks of Sibnow come from the riv-
er of that name, just beyond Balaban Point, though large
communities are dispersed on the Lundu and the Sa-
dung. The same may be said of the Sarebus tribe (the
most predaceous and wild on the coast), which has pow-
erful branches of the original stock on the Skarran river.
Beyond Point Balaban is a bay between that point and
Point Samaludum ; the first river is the Sibnow ; the
next the Balonlupon, which branches into the rivers of
Sakarran and Linga ; passing Tanjong Samaludum you
come to the two islands of Talison ; and between it and
the next point, or Banting Marron, lies the Sarebus riv-
er. Between Banting Marron and Tanjong Siri are the
Kaleka river, a high mountain called Maban, and then
Rejong, the chief river of the Kayans. I may here like-
wise correct some of the statements and names usually
current in England. The Idaan, represented as a Dyak
tribe, are a hill people, and probably not Dyaks ; and
the name Marat is applied by the natives of Borneo to
the various wild tribes, Dyaks and others, without any
specific meaning.
" In natural history the expedition has done as much
as was in its power, by forming collections of birds, ani-
mals, and reptiles ; but these collections are as small as
our means. Specimens of woods and seeds have been
preserved, ; but the season was not the proper one for
flowers, as very few indeed were seen. The specimen
of the hand of tho mias pappan and the head of an adult
62 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
mias rombi will, I believe, go far to establish the exist-
ence of an animal similar to the Pongo of the Count
Bull on. I have little doubt that I shall be able in the
ensuing season to establish the fact, or set it at rest for-
ever ; though I confess myself greatly inclined to think
that the former will be the case. I here leave the coast
with an excellent prospect for the coming year ; and 1
would not now have quitted it so soon, but for the want
of provisions, added to which, the change of the mon-
soon, bringing squally and dark weather, greatly inter
feres with our further progress in surveying.
"Nov. 22d, 1839. The Malayan language has been
compared to the lingua franca of Europe. They are
both, indeed, used by various nations in their commercial
transactions ; but, beyond this, nothing can be more un-
just or absurd than the comparison. The lingua franca
is a jargon compounded at random, devoid of grammar
or elegance ; the Malayan, on the contrary, is musical,
simple in its construction, and well calculated fo*r the ex-
pression of poetry. It boasts many dialects, like tlm
Italian, of superior softness, and, like the Italian, it is
derived from many sources, refining all to the most liq-
uid sounds by the addition of a final vowel. I fully con-
cur with Mr. Marsden in his opinion that the Malayan
tongue, though derived from the Sanscrit, the Arabic,
the Hindoostani, &c., &c., is based on the language which
he calls the Polynesian ; a language which may be con-
sidered original (as far as we know), and which embra-
ces so vast an extent of geographical surface. The proof
of this rests mainly on the fact that the simple wants of
man, as well as the most striking features of nature, are
expressed in the Polynesian ; while the secondary class
of ideas is derived from the Sanscrit, c vsome other lan-
guage, and usually grafted in a felicitous manner on the
original stem. By an original language, I must be un-
derstood, however, to mean only a language which can
not be derived from any other known tongue. 1 seek
not to trace the language of Noah, or to raise a theory
which shall derive the finished and grammatical Sanscrit,
the pure and elegant Creek, from some barbarous stock,
whether Celtic or Teutonic. Such inquiries are fitted
for those, with leisure and patience to undertake :i hope-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 63
less task, and learning enough to achieve better things.
When we look for the origin of languages we are lost,
for those existing alFord us no help. They present some
affinities, as might be expected ; but their discrepancies
are irreconcilable ; and, amid many equally good claims,
who shall be able to demonstrate the only one which is
right ? Supposing even that all languages agreed as to
prinmry ideas, it would be difficult to determine the
original ; but when this primary class of ideas is express-
ed by sounds entirely and totally different, the task be-
comes utterly hopeless, and the labor as vain as that of
Sisyphus. Indeed, it would be very difficult to show
how languages, derived from one stock, could possibly
differ so far in their expression of the simplest ideas and
wants as not to be mutually traceable : and truly, until
this is done (which I conceive impossible), I am content
to rest in the belief that there are more original langua-
ges than one a conclusion agreeable to common sense,
and consonant with the early history of the Hebrews.
" To trace the original identity of distant races, and
their early migrations, through the affinity of language,
is indeed a limited task compared with the other, but
one both feasible and useful. To further this labor, the
smallest additional information is valuable ; and the dia-
lects of the rude people inhabiting the interior of the isl-
ands of Borneo and Celebes would be highly important.
Previously, however, to instituting such a comparison, as
far as in my power, I propose taking a brief glance at
the different races whose languages may be included un-
der the common name of Polynesian.
" In the first place, the Malayan. Issuing from the
interior of Sumatra, there is reason to conjecture, and
even facts to prove, that originally the dialect of Menang-
kabau resembled the other dialects of its birthplace.
The gradual extension of a warlike race gave a polish to
the language ; additional wants, increasing luxury, ex-
tended knowledge, and contact with the merchants of
many Eastern nations, all combined to produce the Ma-
layan in its present form. But, during the progress of
this change, the radical Polynesian stock remained ; and
we find, consequently, that the words necessary to man-
kind in thoir earliest stage bear a striking and convincing
64 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
resemblance to the dialects of Rejong and Lumpung,
in Sumatra. Subsequent improvements were largely
adopted from the Sanscrit and the Arabic ; but the fact
of the primary ideas being expressed in the Polynesian
must preclude the conclusion of either of these being
the source whence the Malayan is derived, its improve-
ment and extension being alone referable to them. Mars-
den positively states his inability to trace the Polynesian
to any other Eastern language ; and, at the same time,
he has demonstrated, in what he considers a convincing
manner, the identity of this language from Madagascar
and the islands of the Pacific to the Philippines and Su-
matra.
" It may here be incidentally remarked, that while so
many authors are endeavoring to prove that the Asiatic
archipelago was peopled from the Western Continent,*
they overlook the fact of the radical difference of lan-
guage. Unless the roots of the language can be traced
either to India, Cambodia, or other parts, it must follow,
as a matter of course, that the islands were peopled at;
a time previous to the introduction of the language now
spoken on the Continent; else how are we to account
for the simple dialects of a rude people being radically
distinct from the language of the mother country ? If
the Dyaks of Borneo and the Arafuras of Celebes and
New Guinea speak a dialect of the Polynesian, it will
go far to prove an original people as well as an original
language, that is, as original as the Celtic, the Teutonic,
the South American; original because not derived from
any known source.
" These brief remarks on the Malayan will, I believe,
apply to the language of the Island of Java, which,
equally improved and enlarged by the addition of Sanscrit
and Arabic words, and differently modified, retains, nev-
ertheless, its radical Polynesian stock and its distinct
written character, as do likewise the dialects of the isl-
ands of Bally and Lombock. The districts of Rejong,
Lampung, &c., in Sumatra, retain the orig'mal language
in a much higher degree, possess distinctive written
characters, and have little intermixture of Sanscrit or
* \\
EXPEDITION To H()1L.\ : (55
Arabic. ( .'olrbes, or Bugis-land, with u distinct lan-
.;ii<iuc and character, will probably be found to follow
the sin no rul; and the Philippines, including Mindanao,
according to Marsden, possess the same language, though
altered and modified into the Tagala tongue.
" .Madagascar, so far removed, exhibits in its language
fi dialect of Tagala, or, strictly speaking, of Polynesian ;
and the South Sea islands present striking and almost
convincing proofs of the same origin.
" The inquiry ought to be pushed to the languages of
the Mexicans and Peruvians of South America ; and, as
far as our knowledge permits, their identity established
ir disproved; for the language of this by-gone people
would go far toward tracing the course of emigration, it
hr'mi; evident that a strong argument would be raised in
favor of rho migration proceeding from east to west, if
the; language is common to South America and Sumatra,
and not traceable to any country of the Continent of
India.
"It remains, however, to inquire into the language of
the interior tribes of Borneo, Celebes, and New Guinea;
and, on such inquiry, should they be found to possess
the same primary roots as the rest, I believe the con-
clusion must ultimately be arrived at of the existence of
a Polynesian language common to this vast geographical
extent, and distinct from the languages of Asia. In
tracing this identity, we can only, of course, find it in
few instances in the cultivated Javanese and Malayan
languages. Discrepancies must naturally be great from
the intermixture, from early recorded times, of all lan-
guages in the archipelago ; but, nevertheless, if the rad-
ical affinities be striking, they will be conclusive in es-
tablishing the original identity of all the races before
mentioned ; for, without this original identity, how can
we account for these affinities of language ? It may,
indeed, be urged that this language has gradually crept
into the dialects of Java and Menangkabau. But, in the
first place, the affinities will be found in the very roots
of the language in the expressions for the primary and
necessary ideas, which seldom alter in any people ; in
the next, there is a high degree of improbability in sup-
posing a rude dialect to supplant a substantial portion of
F 9
66 LOXl'EDITION TO BORNEO.
a more polished one ; and, thirdly, we must not overlook
the collateral evidence of the similarity of conformation
pervading the entire race from Polynesia to the archi-
pelago distinct alike from the Caucasian and the Mon-
golian.
"In tracing the identity of this language, we may
reckon the dialects of the Dyaks of Borneo, tec., us the
lowest step of the ladder ; those of the Pacific islands
next ; and so through the dialects of Sumatra and Taga-
la, up to the Malayan and Javanese. For this purpose.
a comparative view of all must be attained ; and Eastern
scholars should point out, when possible, the words tak-
en from Sanscrit and other languages. For my own
part, these remarks are made as a sketch to be enlarged
on, and to assist in obtaining the vocabularies of the Dy~
aks and Arafuras.
" Dec. Gth. In looking over Marsden's admirable In-
troduction to his Malayan Grammar, I find I have taken
many of his views in the foregoing remarks ; but I con-
sider that his opinions may be pushed to conclusions
more extended than he has ventured upon. Having de-
scribed the ' exterior circumstance' of the Malayan lan-
guage, he proceeds to point out those more original lan-
guages from whence we may presume it to be dr
" ' The words of which it consists may be divided into
three classes, and that two of these are Hindoo ami
Arabic has been generally admitted. The doubts that
have arisen respect only the third, or thai- original and
essential part which, to the Malayan, stands in the
same relation as the Saxon to the English, and which I
have asserted to be one of the numerous dialects of the
widely-extended language found to prevail, with strung-
features of similarity, throughout the archipelago on the
hither side of New Guinea, and, with a less mar,
semblance, among the islands of the, Pacific Ocean. . . .
To show the general identity, or radical connection of
its dialects, and, at the same time, their individual dif-
ferences, I beg leave to refer the reader* 1o the, tables
annexed to a paper on the subject which I presented,
so long ago as the year 1780, to the Society of Antiqim-
EXPEDITION To IJoUNi. f)7
ries, and is printde in vol. vi. of the Archfsologia ; also,
;i table of comparative numerals, in tho appendix to vol.
iii. of Captain Cook's hist voyage ; and likewise to the
cliart of ten numerals, in two hundred languages, by
the Rev. R. Patrick, recently published in Valpy's Class-
ical, Bihl'irdl, <tnd Oriental Journal.''
ain, Marsden states :
' But whatever pretensions any particular spot may
have to precedence in this respect, the so wide dissem-
ination of a language common to all bespeaks a high de-
uree of antiquity, and gives a claim to originality, as far
as we e;m venture to apply that term, which signifies
no more Hum the state beyond which wo have not the
moans, either historically or by fair inference, of tracing
the origin. Fii this restricted sense it is that we are
justified in considering the main portion of the Malayan
as original, or indigenous, its affinity to any Continental
tongue not having yet been shown ; and least of all can
we suppose it connected with the monosyllabic, or Indo-
Chinese, with which it has been classed.'
" When we find an original language bearing no traces
of being derived from any Continental tongue, wo must
conclude the people likewise to be original, in the re-
stricted sense, or to have emigrated with their language
from some source hitherto unknown. The Sanscrit and
Arabic additions to the original stock are well marked,
though the period of the introduction of the former is
hidden in darkness. It may be inferred, however, that
it came with the Hindoo religion, the remains of which
are yet in existence. It is evident that the question re-
solves itself into two distinct branches : first, the original
language, its extent, the coincidence of its dialects, its
source, &c. ; secondly, its discrepancies, whence arising,
&c. ; together with the inquiry into the probable time
and mode of the introduction of the Sanscrit. With the
latter of these inquiries I have nothing to do ; on the
former subject I may collect some valuable information
by adding the dialects of the savage tribes in the interior
of Borneo and Celebes.
" The alphabets of the island of Java, of the Tagala,
and the Bugis of Celebes, are given by Corneille, Le
Brun. Thevenot. and Forrest."
KXi'EiUTU'iV TO yuiii\ ).
Of Mr. Brooke's sojourn at Singapore it is unnecessary
to speak ; and I accordingly resume my extracts with
his ensuing voyage from that port, and again for the I n-
dian archipelago, but contenting myself, for reasons
which need not be entered into at length, with only that
portion of his excursion to Celebes and among the Bugis
which particularly bears upon his Borneon sequel.
" Dec. 7th, 1839. Off Great Solombo. Never was
there a more tedious passage than ours has been from
Singapore. Sailing from that place on the 20th of No-
vember, we have encountered a succession of calms and
light winds creeping some days a few miles, and often
lying becalmed for forty-eight hours without a breath to
fill the sails. Passing through the straits of Rhio and
Banca, and watering at the islands of Nanka, we stood
thence for Pulo Babian, or Lubeck, lay a night becalmed
close to the Arrogants Shoal, of which, however, we saw
nothing, owing, probably, to the smoothness of the water.
The depths are greater than laid down on Horsburgh's
chart, varying from thirty-six to thirty-eight fathoms.
A calm now keeps us off the greater Solombo, which it
is my intention to visit when in my power.
" 8th. Drifted past Solombo in the calm, and, reluct-
ant to return, I continued on my voyage with a liglit
breeze from the eastward. This island is well laid
down: from the sea we made its longitude 113 31';
Horsburgh gives it 113 28', which, considering that both
observations were made afloat, is a near enough approx-
imation. The land is low, with a single hill, showing
round from the westward, flat or wedge-shaped from
the eastward. The smaller Solombo is low: both
wooded.
" 10th. In sight of Laurots islands.
" llth. In the evening stood within four miles of 1 lie
southern island of Laurots. These islands are high and
steep, covered with wood, and uninhabited. Th
ernmost island seems, by bearings, badly laid down, lie-
ing not far enough to the southward and eastward. The
southern island is called by the Bugis, Mala .^iri ; the
eas'crn, Kadapangan ; the northern one, Kalamboxv. A
few rocks and islets lay off them; water deep, and ap-
parently clear of all danger.
, il *,\ To If M; \ ! tiJ
" 15/A. Turatte Bay. Aflcr experiencing continued
calms and light winds, and falling short of water, wo at
length reached this bay, and anchored in 7 fathoms.
The first impression of Celebes is highly favorable. The
mountains present a bold outline, and rise in confused
masses, until crowned by what is commonly called Bon-
thian Hill. The sides of the mountains slope gradually
to the sea, and present an inviting and diversified aspect
of wood and cleared land. I dispatched a boat for wa-
ter to a small village ; and the crew were well received
by the natives, after they became assured that they were
not pirates.
" The outline of this bay, in Norie's chart, is not bad-
ly laid down ; but on either side there is great room for
improvement and survey. Turatte Bay may be fairly
so called, as the district (or negri) generally bears that
name. The larboard point of Turatte Bay (approach-
ing) is called Malasaro, which comes next to Tanjong
Layken in the charts. The starboard point is Tanjong
Uju Loke, and from Uju Loke the land runs low to the
point of Galumpang, the entrance of a river marked in
the charts. From Uju Loke (named Bolo Bolo in No-
rie's chart) the coast-line runs for 12 or 15 miles to Bolo
Bolo, which space is entirely omitted. Bolo Bolo forms
the entrance of Bonthian Bay.
" 16th. Bonthian Bay. Called Banthi by the natives :
is in lat. 5 37' s. ; long. 119 33' E.
" The bay is pretty well laid down by Dalrymple.
The small Dutch fort, or intrenchment, stands rather on
the eastern bight of the bay, and is composed of a few
huts, surrounded by a ditch and green bank. Two guns
at each corner compose its strength, and the garrison con-
sists of about thirty Dutchmen and a few Javanese sol-
diers. We were cordially and hospitably received by
the officers, and, after a great deal of trouble and many
excuses, here procured horses to carry us to the water-
fall. Bonthian Hill is immediately over this place ; a
flat space of rice-ground, some miles in extent, only in-
tervening. The hill (so called) may with more propri-
ety be designated as a range of mountains, which here
attain their utmost height and sink down gradually al-
most across the peninsula. The view is most attractive ;
70 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
the green and refreshing rice-grounds in the front and
behind, the slopes of the mountain and its various peaks,
verdant grass, wooded chasms, and all the inequalities
which mark a mountain region. I am very anxious to
mount to the summit ; but so many difficulties are thrown
in the way, that I almost despair horses and guides are
not to be procured. The Dutch say the natives are lazy :
the natives say they dare not go without authority ei-
ther way we are the losers ; but the officers certainly ex-
ert themselves in our favor. Coming into this bay, there
is some difficulty in distinguishing the fort ; but coming
from the westward, its position may readily be known
by steering for two lumps on the S.E. declivity of the
mountain.
" 18lh. Got ashore by seven o'clock to start for the
waterfall ; till nine we were detained by want of horses,
but after much trouble the animals were procured, and
off we started. Our party consisted of three doctors
(him of the fortification, a German gentleman, Treacher,
and Theylingen) and myself, with native guides. The
road lay for a short way along the beach, then struck
into the thicket, and we commenced a gradual ascent.
The scenery was most striking and lovely ; glades and
glens, grassy knolls and slopes, with scattered trees, and
the voice of a hidden river which reached our ears from
a deep valley on the left hand. Proceeding thus for
some distance, we at length plunged into the wood, and
descending a short space, found ourselves by the sides
of the stream below the waterfall. Here, breakfast be-
ing finished, we all stripped to our trowsers, entered the
water, and advanced along the bed of the river to the
fall. The banks on either hand, steep and woody, pre-
vented any other mode of approach, and the stream, rush-
ing down and falling over huge rocks, rendered the only
available one any thing but easy. At times we were up
to the arms, then crawling out and stealing with care over
wet and slippery stones, now taking advantage of a few
yards of dry ground, and ever and anon swimming a pool
to shorten an unpleasant climb. In this manner we ad-
vanced about half :i mile, when the fall became visible ;
thick trees and hanging creepers intervened ; between
and through the foliage we first saw the water glancing
i HDI't'ION TO BORNEO. 71
niul shining in its descent. The effect was perfect. Af-
ter some little further and more difficult progress, we
stood beneath the fall, of about 150 feet sheer descent.
The wind whirled in eddies, and carried the sleet over
us, chilling our bodies, but unable to damp our admira-
tion. The basin of the fall is part of a circle, with the
outlet forming a funnel ; bare cliffs, perpendicular on all
sides, form the upper portion of the vale, and above and
below is all the luxuriant vegetation of the East ; trees,
arched and interlaced, and throwing down long fantastic
roots and cneepers, shade the scene, and form one of the
richest sylvan prospects I have ever beheld. The water,
foaming and flashing, and then escaping amid huge gray
.stones on its troubled course clear and transparent, ex-
panding into tranquil pools, with the flickering sunshine
through the dense foliage all combine to form a scene
.such as Tasso has described.*
" Inferior in body of water to many falls in Switzer-
land, it is superior to any in sylvan beauty ; its deep se-
clusion, its undisturbed solitude, and the difficulty of ac-
cess, combine to heighten its charms to the imagination.
Our descent was like our upward progress. Having
again dressed ourselves, we rested for a time, and then
started for Bonthian wearing away the rest of the day
shooting amid the hills. Theylingen and myself pro-
cured many specimens, and returned laden with our
spoil, and charmed with our day's excursion. The wa-
terfall is called Sapo, from the neighboring green peak
of that name. The height of our resting-place (not the
highest point of the day's ascent) was 750-5 feet, by
Newman's two barometers ; yet this is the bottom of
the mountain on its western slope. The officers dined
with us ; they are veiy polite and kind ; and we retired
early to rest, all the better for our excursion.
" 19 tii. At 6 A.M. went with the Dutch officers shoot-
ing, and reached the same stream which forms the wa-
terfall. The scenery delightful ; water cool, and pleas-
ant for bathing, a luxury 1 enjoyed in high perfection.
Aboard again to a late breakfast."
* Canto xv., stanza 55, 56.
72 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
CHAPTER VI.
I)ain Matara, the Bugis. Excursions m Celebes. Dispute with
the Rajah's son-in-law. Baboon shot. Appearance of the
country. Visit the Resident. Barometrical observations.
The Bugis. Geography. Coral reefs. Visit the Rana of La-
matte. Population and products of the country.
" I MAY here indulge in a brief episode, to introduce
my Bugis companion, Dain Matnra, which properly I
should have done long since, a man well born, and, for
his country, affluent and educated : he offered at Sin-
gapore, to accompany me on this expedition, refusing all
pay or remuneration, and stating that the good name to-
be acquired, and the pleasure of seeing different places,
would recompense him. At first, I must own this dis-
interestedness rendered me suspicious ; but conceiving
that the greatest utility might accrue from his assistance,
I agreed to take him with his servant. Our long pas-
sage seemed to make us well acquainted, and, I believe,
raised a mutual confidence. Dain, cheerful, good-tem-
pered, and intelligent, gained daily on my esteem ; and,
by the time we reached Bonthian, I was rejoiced that
he accompanied me.
" On this day we succeeded in procuring horses and
guides for the hill, as it is called.
U 20/t. By 8 A. M. our preparations were complete,,
and we mounted our horses ; a motley group we formed,
composed of Treacher, Theylingen, and myself, two-
seamen (Spence and Balls), Dain Matara, a son-in-law
of the Bonthian Rajah, and six footmen. Provisions for
four days were on one of the horses, and a goodly stock
of fowling-pieces, beside my mountain barometer. The
plain was soon cleared ; and three hours' ride by a good
horse-path brought us to the village of Senua, consisting
of a dozen houses. We found the inhabitants hospita-
ble, and took refuge from a heavy squall of wind and rain
in the best house the place afforded. During tho rain
the thermometer sunk to 76, but rose directly afliu--
ward. At half-past one the rain cleared away, bui
we were detained until three by the Bugis goiling their
During this limn I stniyrd ;i!<ui'_ r th
K.\ PKIUTK >\ TO i:ic\r.t. 7>
stivani which runs by the village, and after enjoying a
bathe, called to horse, in order to proceed. Great was
my surprise, however, to be told by the rajah's son-in-
law that he supposed we were going back. A discus-
sion arose, he declaring there was no road for the
horses, and that we could not go farther ; while I insisted,
if he would not advance, I should continue my journey
on foot. After much time had been lost, our guide set
off slowly and reluctantly, and we proceeded for two or
three miles, when, finding our head turned to the south-
ward, and the road descending, I again called a halt, and
was once more told it was not possible to mount farther.
A scheme had been formed to lead us round about,
and take us gradually down, until too late to mount
again. A long parley ensued ; both parties seemed res-
olute ; and it finished by our unloading the baggage-
horse, and making a small parcel of necessaries to carry
on foot. Our guide, however, never intended matters to
go so far, and we finished at last by taking half the horses,
and allowing him (the rajah's son-in-law) to descend
with the rest. This being done, we had to retrace our
road nearly to Senua ; and a little before sunset our
party crossed an awkward stream, and struck into the
path up the mountains.
" A short walk brought us to Lengan Lengang about
dusk, where we put up for the night. For the first
time, this day I saw the cockatoo in his wild state ; I
was within easy shot of two of them, but the stream lay
between us, and I felt some compunction at shooting
these favorite birds.
" Lourikeets were in great plenty, and many varie-
ties of pigeons and doves, beside other birds. Near
Lengan Lengang we encountered a community of dusky
baboons, many of them very large and powerful : after
a hard scramble I got within shot of them ; on my firing
the first barrel, the young ones and females made off,
but the leaders of the band disdained to retreat, and,
with threatening gestures and grimaces, covered the re-
treat of their party. The consequence was, I sacrificed
one of these heroes, of a large size : he fell from the branch
on which he was seated into a deep valley, and his fall
completed the rout of the rest. Spence, in the mean
G
74 SEDITION i:u.
lime, having urrived, I dispatched him to secure the
pri/,e ; but at the bottom of the valley the baboons again
showed themselves, and manifested every inclination to
fall on him ; another barrel put them to flight, and be
tween us we dragged the fallen hero to the horses.
" The village of Lengan Lengang consists of about a
dozen houses, is situated in a nook of the hills, and
surrounded by cocoanut-trees. We were accommo-
dated in the principal house, and treated with every
hospitality. The people of the hills are poor, though
their land is fertile, and produces abundance of rice and
Indian corn. Theft is said to be common, especially of
horses, and the care of the horses belonging to travelers
devolves on the villagers ; for, in case a horse is stolen,
a fine is imposed on the population in general. To
prevent this misfortune, our hosts kept playing, as long
as we could bear it, on an instrument like a clarinet;
but at twelve o'clock, after tiying in vain to sleep, we
were obliged to stop the noise and risk the horses.
" This instrument is about three feet long, with five
or six holes, and a flat mouthpiece on the cane -tube ;
the sound is musical when gently breathed into, but in
their usual mode of playing, it emits frightful shrieks.
During the night the thermometer sunk to 69, and we
were glad of our blankets.
" 21st. Rose between five and six. Took some
barometrical observations, and at half-past six continued
our upward way. As far as Lengan Lengang the
country presents beautiful woodland and mountain
scenery, with luxuriant vegetation, thickly wooded val-
leys, and sparkling streams. The flats and valleys are
occupied by rice-grounds, and the pasturage is of the
veiy finest description for all sorts of cattle ; the grass
short and rich. Lengan Lengang is the last point
where the cocoanut or other palms is seen ; but there.'
it grows remarkably well, and attains a great height.
Above this point the wood, generally speaking, becomes
smaller, and the vegetation more coarse, the hills being
covered with a rank high grass, and ferns, similar to
those in England. Three hours' slow traveling brought
us to the village of Lokar, situated at the foot of the
peak of that name. 1 mounted, while breakfast \\;;s
I 1 i KIN I ( . l!Ult\ I'.ll. 75
;, nearly to the top, and up to the belt oi' thick
wood which surrounds the last 100 or 150 feet. Obser-
vations were repeated here, showing a great fall of the
mercuiy, and afterward taken at the village. Lokar
consists of a few scattered huts, situated amid gardens
of fruit and vegetables : the mango, the guava, the
jack, and the plantain, with cabbages and Indian corn,
compose the stock of the inhabitants ; the latter con-
stitutes their principal food, and is granaried for use in
large quantities, not only in the house, but on frame-
works of bamboo without, on which it is thickly hung
in rows, with the head downward, to protect it from
the weather. The highest summit, called Lumpu
Balong, was visible when we first arrived, some miles
in advance : at breakfast-time the clouds entirely cov-
ered it, and rolled down upon Lokar in heavy rain,
driving us into a miserable hut for shelter.
" During the rain the thermometer fell to 70. At
3 P.M. started for some huts we saw at the foot of
Lumpu Balong, having first sent our horses back to
Lengan Lengang, being assured their farther progress
was impracticable. When, however, our guide from
Lokar understood our intention of reaching Lumpu
Balong, he objected to proceed, on the plea that the
village in advance was inhabited by people from Turatte.
We' managed to coax him on, and, after two and a half
hours' walk, reached Parontalas. The country, as-
cending gradually, becomes more and more wild ; the
wood stunted ; and the streams, finding their way
through masses of rock, leave strong traces of their
occasional violence. Parontalas stands on the edge of
the forest which skirts Lumpu Balong, from which it
has not long been retrieved. It consists of a few scat-
tered huts, far apart. Potatoes, tobacco, and coffee
are grown here, the former in great abundance. Like
the rest -of the people, their food consists of Indian
corn ; and, as in the other villages, they breed horses.
Our host of Parontalas was very polite, and gave us
some fowls and the accommodation of his house ; the
latter, indeed, was needful, for we were all badly pro-
vided with covering, and the mountain air was raw and
cold. To our request for guides to ascend the maun-
76 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
tain he replied, that it was necessary to consult the
head man of the district, who lived some little distance
off. In the interim we made ourselves very happy,
determined to ascend with or without a guide or guides.
We Jay down at nine, in order to be ready for the
morning's work, the thermometer standing at 59 in the
house.
"22^. At five, when we rose, the thermometer
stood at 56 in the air. The head man had arrived,
and willingly gave us guides, warning us only of the
difficulty of the ascent. Nothing could exceed the
kindness and attention of this simple old man. He re-
membered the time the English had the country, and
spoke of his people's respect for our nation, and their
regret that we had left the country. At 6 A.M. we
started, and, after walking about a mile, plunged into
the belt of forest which environs Lumpu Balong. From
six till half-past two, we were alternately ascending and
descending, scrambling over rocks or fallen timber, or
cutting a path through the most tangled thicket that
ever tore the wayfarer. To add to our difficulty,
during the latter half of the ascent, we could procure
no water, which caused us considerable suffering. At
length, however, we stood at the summit of Lumpu
Balong, and looked, on either side, over a vast sea of
fleecy clouds which rolled beneath. The top is a nar-
row ridge, covered with stunted trees and luxuriant
moss ; and a second peak to the westward, of rather
less elevation, is separated from it by a declivity. I
climbed to the top of a tree to look along the mountain,
and make certain that we were at the highest point ;
and having convinced myself of this, 1 proceeded with
the barometric observations, which were concluded by
3 P.M. ; for it was highly necessary to get down before
night overtook us in the dreary and inhospitable forest.
Our thirst, too, was tormenting, and increased by hear-
ing the fall of a torrent deep in the valley to the north-
ward.
" As far as I could observe, the northern face of ill.
mountain was perpendicular, and the- ascent on that side
would have been attended with greater difficulty than
from the point we chose. Our way down was -
ilM-KIHTION TO BORNEO. 77
mid the descent was made as expeditiously us the nature
of tlit! ground would allow. Having fairly worn our
shoes oil' our feet, we were pierced by brambles and
thorns in a cruel manner. Our guide, in going down,
discovered a tree with a bee-hive in it containing great
store of honey. The Bugis instantly attacked the tree,
on seeing which my first impression was, that it would
be prudent to retreat to a distance ; but their composure
induced me to remain ; and, to my surprise, when the
tree was laid open, the honey was taken out in large
quantities, and the bees brushed off the comb without
offering to sting. Though flying round about us, and on
the hands of all the people, they were quite innocent of
harm ; and I conclude, therefore, they were different
from tho common honey-bee. The honey was excel-
lent, and refreshed us for a few minutes, but ultimately
only added to our thirst. At length, about five, we
reached a stream of water, and quenched our thirst
with draughts of the coolest and most limpid mountain
stream. The Bugis, though, like ourselves, they had
been without any water from nine o'clock in the morn-
ing till five in the evening, refused to drink, alleging
that it was highly injurious after eating honey ! Glad
were we, just at dark, to get clear of the forest ; and a
short walk farther brought us to our temporary dwel-
ling. We w r ere much knocked up, and very much torn
with the thorns. A brief dinner and a delicious cigar,
and we lay down to sleep not even incommoded by the
cold, which kept us awake the last night.
" 23d. Having, through mistake, forgotten to bring
ii}) any money, I had no means of repaying the obliga-
tions received from these simple hill-people except by
promises. My old friend ordered the guide of yesterday
to accompany us to the plains, to receive his own pay-
ment, and to bring some things, for others, up there.
At ten we hobbled forth, very foot-sore, and lacking
proper covering for our feet. The prospect of four or
five hours' walk to Lengan Lengang was very unpleas-
ant; and in proportion to our expected pain was our
gratification on meeting all our horses within three
miles of Parontalas all the horses, which all the men
swore could not. by any possibility, ascend, were there ;
78 EXPEDITION TO BOIlNHO.
and though without saddles and bridles, or the Bugiy,
we were too glad to mount. We went down by another
road. Four hours brought us to Lengan Lengang,
where we rested for two hours, and, remounting,
reached Bonthian at about seven o'clock in the evening.
Thus concluded this interesting excursion into a hill-
region, where we attained the summit of Lumpu Ba-
long, never before reached by European. The Dutch
officers informed me that three successive residents of
Bonthian had attempted it and failed.
" Before I conclude, I may take a brief survey of the
country. The hills are generally rounded or flat at top,
and not offering any rugged or broken peaks. The
scenery about Senna and Lengan Lengang is the per-
fection of woodland, with the picturesque characteristics
of a mountain region ; the climate admirably suited,
thence to the summit, for Europeans, and capable of
producing most European and tropical plants to perfec-
tion. Coffee plantations on these hills might be under-
taken with certainty of success, and there is much in
the character of the natives which would facilitate the
operation. To the westward of Lokar, and somewhat
lower, is a fine extensive plain, which we just skirted
coming down ; it was cultivated in every part, apparently
with rice. The vegetable productions of the hills I have
briefly mentioned ; but I may add that the wild raspberry
was found, and that wild guavas grow in the greatest
abundance, as well as oranges and grapes.
" The animal kingdom, of course, we had no time to
examine ; but the babi rupa is said to be found in the
higher regions ; and in the forest, toward the summit
of Lumpu Balong, we saw the dung of wild cattle,
which, I. am told, are a species of urus. The birds we
saw were, paroquets of two sorts, vi/,., the lourikeet :md
a small green paroquet; a largo green pigeon, specimens
of which we got ; the cream-colored pigeon of Borneo,
beside many others.
" The geological formation of the region I must leave
to others. I brought down some specimens of the rocks
and loose stones, which are, I believe, pummice ; if so,
I presume the formation volcanic, similar to Java.
"''I///, Called on file resident, nnd saw the rajah.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
7<J
" 25tfi Christmas, with his jolly nose and icy hands.
Hero it is hot enough ! Were I to live in this country,
I should retire for the season up in the mountains.
Dined with the Resident of Bonthian ; by no means
surprised that he and his congeners had failed in their
attempt to climb the mountain : the resident is a native !
In the evening, celebrated the day with all sorts of
sports.
" 26th. Mid-day, quilted Bonthian, and ran to Boele
Comba or Compa.
44 27th. I have little to say of Boele Comba. It is
situated in the bight of the bay, eastward of Bonthian.
There appears to be much confusion in Horsburgh's
.Directory about the latitude and longitude, and the
hill called after the place. This hill is the last of the
mountain-range, somewhat detached, covered with
wood, of moderate elevation, and peaked. From our
anchorage, two miles from the fort, it bore N.N.W.
The fort is similar to the one at Bonthian, the country
pretty, and nearly level. The Bonthian mountains (i. e.
Lumpu Balong and the range) show steep and well in
the background. Game abounds, by report. Europeans
are subject to complaints of the eyes, and occasionally
to fever. Any vessel running in should be very careful,
for the charts are defective, and Boele Comba reef is
said to project farther to the westward of the fort than
laid down.
41 1 here subjoin a list of our barometric observations,
the upper barometer reduced to the rate of the lower
and standard one :
Senua, 20th December, 1839.
Bar. A. D.
1. 30-054 . . 86 87).,,, , r
2. 28-385 . . 79 80 } 3
Lengan Lengang, 2\st December.
Bar. A. D.
1. 30-119 . . 79 78-5 6^ 30 A.M.
2. 27-988 . . 70 69'5 6''
Lokar Peak, 21st December, 100 feet below summit.
Bar. A. D.
1. 30-095 . . 90 90) lnh . 0m
2. 25-975 . . 70 79 f 10 30 A<M>
80 PJBWTIOK TO :.
Hill on the way to Lumpu Balong, 22d Dccc,.
Bar. A. D.
1. 30-144 . . 90 90 Mean between 8 1 ' and noon.
2. 23-612 . . 66 65'5 10'' 40 A.M.
Lumpu Bating Peak, 22d December.
Bar. A. D.
1. 30-146 . . 89-5 90-5 2'' 0'" P.M.
2. 22-718 . . 64 63'5 2>> 30'"
28th Leaving BoeJe Oomba after breakfast, we
shaped our course for Point Berak.
" With the richest country, the natives of these places
nre poor, and they bear no good-will to their rulers, ft
is likewise certain that few active measures are resort ud
to for forwarding the development of the native charac-
ter and local resources. The resident is a Macassa.r-
born native, and this fact alone speaks volumes for the
mode and manner of government. The people of the
countiy I found a kind and simple race ; and though
they are accused of pride and laziness by their masters,
I could not, circumstances taken into consideration, dis-
cover any trace of the latter vice, and the former I
COB readily forgive them. That the Bugis are not, an
indolent race is w r ell proved by their whole conduct,
wherever circumstances offer any inducement i<
tion. Even here, the cleared country and tin-
cultivation prove them far otherwise ; and traces are
visible everywhere on the mountains of their having
been more highly cultivated than at present. Coffee
plantations once flourished, and being destroyed during
a war, years ago, have never been renewed. Inclosures
and partition walls in decay are veiy frequent, marking
the former boundary of cultivation. That they are in-
dependent enough to be proud, I honor them for ! The
officers allowed they were courageous, and one desig-
nated them as 'fier comme un Espagnol;' and, on the
whole, no doubt exists in my mind that they are people
easily to be roused to exertion, either agricultural or com-
mercial ; their sullen and repulsive manners toward their
masters rather indicating a dislike to tlieir sway, and the
idleness complained of only proving that the profits of
labor are lower than they ought to be.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 81
" Nothing so strongly marks the degradation of a race
or nut ion as a cheerful acquiescence under a foreign rule.
The more virtuous, the more civilized, the more educa-
lod <i people, the more turbulent, indolent, and sullen,
when reduced to a state of subjection ; the fewer quali-
ties will they have to please their masters, when foreign
rule is oppressive, or looks solely to the advantage of
the countiy of the conquerors, and not of the con-
quered. There is no race will willingly submit : the
bayonet and the sword, the gallows and the whip, im-
prisonment and confiscation, must be constantly at work
to keep them under.
" Leaving Boele Comba, as I before said, we shaped
our course for Taujong Berak, passing between that
point and the north island. The passage is excellent,
clear of all danger, as far as we could see, with deep
water. The rocks reported to exist by Horsburgh, and
put down on Norie's chart, have no existence. The
Bugis prahus always use this channel, and know them
not ; and the captain of a Dutch cruiser informed me
that he had often run through the passage at night, and
that it was clear of all danger or obstruction.
"My own observation went to verify the fact, for
every part of the passage appears deep and clear, and
we passed over the spots where these rocks are marked.
Approaching Tanjong Berak, there is a sandy beach,
where a vessel may get anchorage in case the wind dies
away. The tides in the channel are strong ; here, and
along the south coast, the ebb runs from the eastward,
the flood from the west. Having cleared the channel,
we hauled into the Bay of Boni, which, although run-
ning in a north and south direction, has some headlands
extending to the eastward. There are two places
marked on the chart, viz. Berak and Tiero ; but these,
instead of being towns or villages, are names of districts ;
the first, reaching from Tanjong Berak, about 15 miles,
till it joins Tiero ; Tiero, extending from the northern
confine of Berak to Tanjong Labu, 15 miles in all. To
the northward and eastward is a high island called Bal-
unrueh. From Tanjong Berak the water along the
coast is very deep ; no soundings with 50 fathoms. To-
ward evoninir \v-f- went int.) Tif-ro Bay, a pretty secluded
82 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
spot. The southern part of the bay is foul, having a
reef visible at low water. The northern headland has
a spit running from it, with 14 fathom half a mile (or
little more) oif. Within the bay there is no bottom
with 50 fathom till near its northern extremity, where
the water shoals suddenly. Running in, in a squall, we
got into 34 fathom, where we anchored. This country
belongs to the Dutch as far as Point Labu.
" 29th. Calm all day. Sounded the bay : the south-
ern point has a steep coral reef nearly a quarter of a
mile off. The southern part of the bay is inclosed by
a reef, part of which seems to me artificial, for the pur-
pose of catching fish, and is shallow : outside the reef
the water is deep close to. The western shore is lined
by a reef close to it, and the water is deep. The cen-
ter part of the bay is very deep ; and within 100 yards
of where we lay we got no bottom at 17 fathoms. The
next cast was G, and the next 3 fathoms hard clay bot-
tom. A small river discharges itself, in the northern
part, inside the anchorage : there is a considerable depth
within, but the bar is shallow. The scenery on the
river is beautiful; wild at first, and gradually becoming
undulating and cultivated. .Birds' are plenty: cockatoos
abound, of which I shot two. This part of the country
possesses considerable geological interest : the hills round
the bay are of slight elevation ; and 80 or 100 feet from
the sea level are large masses of coral rock, upheaved
by some convulsion.
" 30th. Under weigh. Brought up in 23 fathoms,
amid the coral shoals.
" 3lst. Visited the island of Btilunrueh for sights.
" Tanjong Labu is bluif and bold, and of moderate
elevation. The land from thonco trends away west-
ward, forming a long bay, which, for distinction, may bo
called Labu Bay, at the N.W. part of which is the town
of Songi, the principal place about here. !!et\veen
Labu and Songi are the following countries: Kupi J\a-
jang, Pakah, Buah, Kalaku, BaringHn, and M;:;_
bunbang; each with a separate petty rajah. The
country is moderately well cleared; about an average
height, near the shore, <>!' .",00 feet; with few haluta-
ibuiit. I'm MM '< cnntain
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 83
raiij;i' throws a spur downward to the sea, in the vicinity
of Songi and the fine peaks of Lumpu Balong ; rind
Wawa Karang, with the confusion of mountains, form a
magnificent background to the prospect. From Magna-
rabunbang the land runs away to the eastward toward
Tanjoug Salanketo, which must be described on a fu-
ture occasion. In the offing are several islands and
numerous reefs. The principal island is Balunrueh,
400 or 500 feet high ; bold, steep, and covered with
trees, except at its northern extremity, where it is low,
with a sandy point. Off this north point runs a coral
reef; direction 354, and extent about two miles. At
the S.W. angle of the island there is likewise a reef
stretching half a mile ; and the shores all round, for a
short distance, are lined with coral, outside of which
the water is apparently very deep. We could get no
soundings with a hand lead, half a mile to the west-
ward.
" Off Balunrueh, to the S.E., is the islet of Liang Li-
ang ; next to Liang Liang, Tanbunoh, which is larger ;
then Cadingareh Batantampeh (the largest), Coting-
duan Lariahriah, and two islands to the northward
called Canallo. Balunrueh and Batantampeh have both
indifferent fresh water ; the former near the low point
at the north end. From the S.W. end of Liang Liang
a reef runs out. The bearing, from the small hill, over
the watering place of Balunrueh, was 77. The reef
extends to 104, and stretches to the southward beside :
near Liang Liang it is narrow. Its limits I could not
define.
" Between Liang Liang and Tanbunoh a narrow reef,
and spits from most of the islands. Two patches lay off
Balunrueh about two miles and a half : the first, bearing
319, is narrow, and about half a mile long; the other
smaller, and bearing 287. Part of the day we passed
on Balunmeh was very hot; but we got satisfactory
sights, and sailed round the island, returning to the vessel
about six in the evening.
" I must now return to Labu, to give some account of
the channel between the reefs ; as, from the appearance
of the charts, it would seem impossible to navigate the
western side of the bay. Having passed Tanjong Labn
84 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO-
at a distance of 3 or 4 miles, get the flat-topped hill
called Bulu Tanna ahead. Close to the Bulu Tanna,
in the foreground, is another smaller hill, with two
remarkable tufts on the top : this hill, just open to the
eastward of Bulu Tanna, is the leading mark for Songi,
which stands to the westward. This mark will lead
clear, or very nearly so, of all the reefs ; but as there
is uncertainty in the distance from Tanjong Labu, it
may be necessary to diverge from the straight course in
order to avoid some of the patches. In the daytime the
coral is seen with the greatest ease ; and a vessel with
a lookout aloft, and a breeze, may proceed with safety.
The first reef is on the starboard hand ; part was dry,
and shoal-water about. This first patch is in the prox-
imity of the great reef called Melompereh, which runs
to the eastward. Beside these*, the channel is occasion-
ally lined by patches on either hand ; but is nowhere
narrower than a mile and a half, and is anything but
difficult navigation, so far, in clear weather.
" Jan. 4th, 1840. Arrived off Songi on the 1st, and
dispatched a boat to the old Rajah, or Rana, of Lamatte.
Our answer was, that not having been to Boni, she feared
receiving us, as she felt inclined ; but if we would come
to her house, she should be glad to see us. On tho fol-
lowing day, accordingly, we paid our visit at her resi-
dence, which is situated about four miles up the river
Tanca.
" The old lady is about sixty-five years of age, and
(as she herself informed us) "very poor. Her house,
indeed, bears every mark of great poverty ; having a
leaky roof, and not sufficient matting to cover tho bam-
boo floors. She was kind, and seemed pleased to see
us ; said I should henceforward be her son, and that
nothing but her fear of the Boni Rajah prevented her
receiving me in the best way in her power ; but point ing
to the roof and to the floor, she repeated, ' I have no-
thing.' I presented her with such articles as I thought;
would be acceptable to her ; and, in return, she gave me
a sarong.
" The population of tho country is considerable. The
last district I mentioned v.as i\lanara!>unl>anu. Tho
town of that name, on ' i y-fivc
EXPEDITION TO BORN! Hf>
houses, In-side a roving population nl' Badjows.
the coast to the eastward, and close to Magnarabunbang,
is the river of Songi. Proceeding up this shallow river,
the first village is Tacolompeh, situated on the right
bank, and consisting of twenty houses ; nearly opposite
the village of Pangassa, of thirteen houses ; and farther
up, about four miles from the river's mouth, stands
Songi, consisting of 164 houses on the right bank, and
60 on the left. These places are all on the low ground,
and surrounded with cocoanut-trees.
'* Joining the district of Magnarabunbang, on the coast,
is Lamatte, the rajanate of our old friend. The river,
like the Song!, is shallow, and running through very low
ground. On the left bank is Luppa, consisting of twenty-
five houses ; then, on the right, Ulo, twenty-two houses ;
and above Ulo comes Ullue, of twelve houses. Nearly
opposite Ullue is Balammepa, with thirty houses, supe-
rior to the others, and inhabited by merchants who have
made money in trading voyages. This village sends
yearly two prahus to Singapore. Just above Ullue
stand seven houses ; and above Balammepa is Tanca, the
residence of the Rajah of Lamatte, consisting of ten
houses. The streams, as I have said, are shallow, and
the ground low, neatly cultivated with Indian corn, and
abounding in cocoanut-trees. Behind Magnarabunbang
there is a narrow strip of low ground, which becomes
wider as it advances to the eastward, with here'and there
moderate elevations.
The chief product of the country is coffee, which is
grown in great quantities on the hills, but brought down
as it ripens, when it is collected by the Bugis merchants
for their yearly shipments. The yearly produce is
stated to be 2000 coyans or 80,000 peculs. The price is
from fifteen to sixteen Java rupees the pecul ; to which
must be added the trouble and expense of storing and
clearing from the inner skin. Tortoise-shell is brought
in by the Badjows ; and mother-of-pearl shells in any
quantity there is demand for. Taking the number of
nouses in this small space, above described, the total
will bo 308 houses, which reckoned at the low estimate
of eight persons for each house, will give 2464 inhabi-
tants : this, however, is far below the proper estimate,
H
86
as there are villages scattered between the rivers, and
numbers of detached houses ; in all, therefore r safely
computed at 5000 persons, The villages, with the ex-
ception of Balammepa, have an aspect of poverty, and
the country is ravaged by that frightful scourge the
small-pox, and likewise some cases apparently of chol-
era, from the account given of the complaint. Near the
hill of Bulu Tanna there is a hot spring, and likewise,
by the report of the natives, some slight remains of an
old building. I regretted much not seeing these ; but
the natives, with much politeness, begged me not to go
previous to my visit to Boni, as they would be answer-
able for allowing strangers to see the country without
orders from the chief rajah. All I see and hear convin-
ces me that the Rajah of Boni has great power over the
entire country. On a friendly communication with him,
therefore, depends our chance of seeing something of
the interior.
" The inhabitants here are polite, but shy and re-
served : and the death of the Rana of Songi and the
absence of the Rajah Mooda, her reported successor,
have been against us.
" 5^/j. Sailing from Songi about 4 P.M., we directed
our course for Tanjong Salanketo. The breeze was
stiff, which caused us to use considerable precaution in
sailing among the shoals. Assisted by a native Nac-
odah, by name Dam Pativi, we were enabled to keep
,the tortuous channel, of which otherwise we should
have been ignorant. A little farther than the Tanca
river is a shoal stretching from the shore, to avoid
which we kept Canallo on our lee bow : this being clear-
ed, we gradually luffed up, ran between two shoals, and
passed several others."
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 87
CHAPTER VII.
Mr. Brooke's second visit to Sarawak. The civil war. Re-
ceives a present of a Dyak boy. Excursion to the seat of war.
Notices of rivers, and settlements on their banks. Deaths
and burials. Reasons for and against remaining at Sarawak.
Dyak visitors. Council of war. Why side with the Rajah.
Mode of constructing forts. State of enemy's and Rajah's
forces. Conduct of the war.
MR. BROOKE continued his cruise for some time, and
made very interesting collections of natural history , be-
side acquiring much insight into the native history, lan-
guage, and customs, his detailed remarks on which it is
to be hoped he will at a future day give to the public.
He then returned to Singapore, where he was detained
for several months by ill health ; but availed himself of
the opportunity to recopper and refit the Royalist, and
set everything else in order for his next visit to Sara-
wak, the remarkable results of which are related in the
following pages. Still sick and languid though he was,
the veiy air of Borneo, and the prospect of activity,
seemed to restore him to life, after the listless rest at
Singapore, with " nothing to observe ;" and only cheered
by the kindest attentions and hospitalities of the inhab-
itants of that interesting and important settlement.
On the second visit of Mr. Brooke to Sarawak, about
the end of August, 1840, he found the inhabitants in
nearly the same state as at first, although there was
much talk of reinforcements, and decisive measures for
bringing the war to a close. The two parties lay within
thirty miles of each other, the rebels holding the upper
part of tine river, and communication with the interior.
The sultan, however, had sent down the Orang Kaya
de Gadong to take more active measures, and his arrival
stimulated Muda Hassim to something like exertion.
This occurred on the fourth September, 1840, as appears
by Mr. Brooke's journal, from which I shall give various
extracts indicative not only of the character of my friend,
whose ideas were written down at the time the impres-
sions were made, but also supplying a distinct picture
of the progress of this novel and amusing civil warfare,
H& EXPEDITION TO BORN I
and demonstrating the unwarlike character oi' the Sarft-
wak Borncons.
" An army of mixed Malays and Dyaks was raised to
attack the Dyak tribes in rebellion, and this service was
successfully performed ; the rebel Dyaks were defeated,
and most of them have since come over to the rajah.
Their forces being weakened by desertion, were reported
not to amount to more than 400 or 500 men, in four or
five forts situated on the river ; and it now remained to
drive them from their last stronghold of resistance. It
was confidently asserted by the rajah and Macota, that,
were it not for the underhand assistance of the Sultan
of Sumbas, who had constantly supplied them with food
and ammunition, the insurgents would long since have
been dispersed.
"At the period in question they were said to be in
great distress for want of provisions ; and as a force was
collecting to attack them from various quarters, it was
greatly to bo hoped that the war was verging to a ter-
mination. During my week's stay I have frequently
visited Muda Hassim, and he has likewise been on board :
our good understanding knows no interruption ; and these
savage, treacherous, bloodthirsty Borneons are our good
friends, with whom we chat and laugh every evening in
familiar converse. I find no cause to alter my last year's
opinion, that they have few active vices ; but indolence
is the root of their evils.
" Sept. 7th. Last night I received a strange and
embarrassing present, in the shape of a young Dyak boy
of five years old a miserable little prisoner, made during
this war, from the tribe of Brong. The gift mused me
vexation, because I knew not what to do with the poor
innocent ; and yet I shrink from the responsibility of
adopting him. My first wish is to return him to his
parents and his tribe ; and if I find I cannot do this, I be-
lieve it will be better to carry him with me than leave
him to become the slave of a slave : for should I send
him back, such will probably be his fate. I wish the
present had been a calf instead of a child.
" [)tk. Situ, my Dyak boy, seems content and happy ;
and judging by his ways, and his fondness for tobacco,
he must be older than I at first supposed. Tn pursuance
i:\i'i:i>rn<-\ TO BORNEO. 89
of my desire to restore him to his parents I made every
inquiry as to their probable fate; but have learned no-
thing that leaves me any hope that I shall be able to do
so. The Brong tribe having taken part with the rebels,
were attacked by the rajah's people; and many were
killed and the rest scattered. Pino, the Brong, knows
not whether Situ's parents are alive or dead ; nor, if the
former, whither they have fled. Supposing my endeav-
ors to restore the child fail, I have resolved to keep him
with me, for many reasons. The first is that his future
prospects will be better, and his fate as a freeman at
Singapore happier, than as a slave in Borneo ; the second,
that he can be made a Christian. I can easily provide
for him in some respectable household, or take him to
England, as may hereafter be most advantageous for
him ; and at the former place he can always be made a
comfortable servant with good training. Yet with all this,
I cannot disguise from myself that there is responsibility
a heavy moral responsibility attached to this course,
that might be avoided : but then, should it be avoided ?
Looking to the boy's interests temporal, perhaps,
eternal I think it ought not ; and so, provided always I
cannot place him where humanity and nature dictate, I
will take the responsibility, and serve this wretched and
destitute child as far as lies in my power. He is cast
on my compassion ; I solemnly accept the charge ; and
I trust his future life may bear good fruit and cause me
to rejoice at my present decision.
" Oct. 2d. Lying at Sarawak, losing valuable time,
but pending the war difficult to get away ; for whenever
the subject is mentioned, Muda Hassim begs me not to
desert him just as it is coming to a close, and daily holds
out prospects of the arrival of various Dyak tribes. The
rajah urged upon me that he was deceived and betrayed
by the intrigues of Pangerans, who aimed at alienating
his country ; and that if I left him, he should probably
have to remain here for the rest of his b'fe, being resolved
to die rather than yield to the unjust influence which
others were seeking to acquire over him ; and he appealed
to me that after our friendly communication I could not,
as an English gentleman, desert him under such circum-
stances. I felt that honorably I could not do so : and
90 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
though reluctantly enough, I resolved to give him the aid
he asked; small indeed, but of consequence in such a
petty warfare;.
" 3d. I started to join Macota at Leda Tanah. At
4h. 30m. P.M. a pouring rain delayed us some time :
and darkness setting in, rendered our pull a long and very
disagreeable one. We did not reach Loda Tanah until
eleven, when we found the army in their boats, and a
small fort they had built on the bank of the river. I
moved into Macota's large boat, and slept there ; while
he, as Commander-in-chief, went backward and forward
from one post to another during the night.
"4/&. At -Leda Tanah the river divided into two
branches ; one part running past Siniawan, and the
other to the left likewise to another point of the
mountain-range. Above Siniawan is Sarambo, a high
detached mountain, perhaps 3000 feet in height, with a
notch in the center. Off Leda Tanah is a sand and
pebble bank formed by the junction of the two streams,
and the country around is well cleared for this part;
while the graves on the right bank bear witness to the
population of former days. It is represented to have
been a flourishing place, and the neighborhood well
inhabited, until the breaking out of this unhappy war.
The situation is delightful, and advantageously chosen
at the confluence of the two streams.
" 5th. Ascended that to the left for a short distance.
On the left hand, just above Leda Tanah, is the small
creek of Sarawak, the original settlement, and from
which the larger river now takes its name. I intended
to have returned to-day ; but as the weather threat-
ened another deluge, I stopped till the following morn-
ing. It was a curious sight to see the whole army
bathe, with the cornmander-in-chief at their head, and
his Pangerans. The fare of these people is anything
but luxurious, for they get nothing but rice and salt ;
and they were thankful in proportion for the small sup-
plies of tea, sugar, and biscuit I was able to spare them.
" (\th. Quitted Leda Tanah, and reached the Roy-
alist in five hours, one of which we were delayed by
the way. The river is remarkably pretty ; hanks
cleared of jungle, with fine trees, and a view of tho
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 91
mountains. Many parts arc exceedingly shallow ; but
the natives state there is a channel for a moderate-sized
vessel as far as Leda Tanah."
On Mr. Brooke's return on board the Royalist, he
found his steward Rankin, who had been lingering
some time, still alive ; and a seaman named Daniel,
whom he had left with a slight fever, suddenly expired
at ten at night in a fainting fit. He writes in his journal :
" It is difficult to allege the immediate cause of his
death, which probably arose from some organic com-
pliant of the heart or the brain, quite independent of
fever. Five minutes befoi'e his decease the man's
pulse was high and full. The steward will follow in a
few days ; and death, which has never before entered
on board, will thus strike two blows. To me it is a
satisfaction that neither is in any way attributable to
climate.
" 7th. Muda Hassim rendered me every assistance.
A grave was prepared, and wood for a coffin, so that by
two o'clock we proceeded to inter the dead. His last
resting-place was situated on a gently rising ground
behind the Chinamen's houses. The ensign was placed
over his simple bier, and he was carried by his ship-
mates to the grave. All who could be spared attended,
and I performed the service that impressive and beau-
tiful service of the Church of England.
" Qth. Having the melancholy duty of yesterday
over was a relief, only alloyed by the sad prospect of a
near recurrence. I now turned my mind seriously to
departure, having well weighed the pros and cons of
the subject.
" In the first place, the greatest advantage would
result from my accompanying the rajah along the coast
of Borneo ; and if I could hope a reasonable time
would leave him free to go there, I would wait spite of
the season : for it is evident that by myself I should
have to form fresh connections among the chiefs, and
without that I reckon it next to impossible to penetrate
even a moderate distance from the coast in a strange
place. The next reason is, that it has been intimated
to me that a rival faction, headed by Pangeran Usop,
exists in Borneo Proper, and that that Pangeran. from
92 TO BORN i
my known friendship to Muda Hassan, might endeavor
to injure me, ?'. e. kill me. At any rate, during Muda
Hassim's absence, I should be obstructed in all my
proceedings, and could not do more than sketch the
bare coast-line. These are strong and cogent reasons
for remaining for a time, if the ultimate object be at-
tainable ; and to these may be added my own feelings
my reluctance to quit the rajah in the midst of diffi-
culty and distress, and his very very sad face whenever
I mention the topic.
" On the other hand must be weighed the approach
of the adverse monsoon, the loss of time, and the failure
of provisions, which, though but luxuries to gentlemen
which they can readily dispense with, are nevertheless
necessaries to seamen, without which they get dis-
contented, perhaps mutinous. There are good reasons
on both sides.
" 9th. I sent Williamson to intimate my approaching
departure; and when I went in the evening the little
man had such a sorrowful countenance that my heart
smote me. When I told him I would remain if there
were the slightest chance of a close to the war, his
countenance cleared, and he gaily repeated that my
fortune and his would bring this struggle to an end,
though others forsook him. I then consented to await
the issue a few days longer, and to revisit Leda Tanah
to ascertain if the news were true. It ran to the effect
that the rebels, under the Patingi and Tumangong, are
fortified at the foot of the mountain of Sarambo, on
which hill are three Dyak tribes below that ol' Sarambo :
over them Bombak ; and on the summit the Paninjow.
The Bombak and Paninjow have already, in part,
joined Macota, and the Sarambo are to come in as to-
day. These three last Dyak tribes deserting the rebels
will leave them surrounded in their forts, which are
commanded by the rest of the hill ; and everything
promises well, if the opportunity be vigorously used.
The Sow and the Singe are in part at Leda Tauah,
and more Dyaks daily joining. I must push the rajah
on to action, for help from without is not likely to come.
Yet I wish still more to accommodate matters ; and if
he would spare the leaders' lives. T believe they would
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 93
lay down their arms on my guaranty. But though he
does not say that he will kill them, he will 1'rsten to no
terms of compromise ; and when I reflect that a
European monarch, in the same circumstances, would
act in the same way that the laws of my own country
would condemn the men for the same offence I cannot
urge the subject into a personal matter.
" 16^. Rankin's (my steward's) death having been
some time inevitable, it was a relief when the event oc-
curred. He was cut off in the flower of manhood, from
the effects of hard drinking, which even his fine consti-
tution could not resist. 1 buried him near the other
man, and had a neat inscription, with the name of the
individual, his ship and age, placed over each.
" Days passed on, but not quite unrelieved by events.
And now I may positively state, that the war will be
over in a few days, or not over at all. The first of
these events was the desertion of the Dyaks, and the
arrival of their chiefs with Macota. Next arrived 200
Chinese from Sambas, under a very intelligent capi-
tan. Rajah AH came next, bringing some ourang-
outangs' heads ; thenDntu Naraja ; and lastly, Pange ran
Jedut from Sarebus, with the information that the Dyaks
of that name, in consequence of a war with Linga,
would not come here. Thus they not only refused to
come themselves, but obliged the Linga people to stay
at home to defend their country. To quiet this coast
the Sarebus should receive a severe lesson.
" 17 th. I had a large party of Dyaks on board in the
evening, viz. the Singe, Sow, Bombak, and Paninjow,
in all about fifteen men and two old chiefs. They ate
and drank, and asked for everything, but stole nothing.
One man wore a necklace of beads set with human
teeth, taken of course in war, which I got from him for
two yards of red cloth. Another was ornamented with
a necklace of bears' teeth ; and several had such a pro-
fusion of small white beads about their necks as to re-
semble the voluminous foldings of the old fashioned cra-
vat. As far as I could observe, they all seemed in earnest
about attacking Siniawan ; and their allegiance to the
rajah was as warm now (in words) as it had been here-
tofore defective in action.
94 EXPEDITION TO BORNEn.
"18/i. Proceeded in the long-boat to Leda Tanali,
which we reached in three and a half hours' pulling,
and just in time to witness the start of 150 Malays and
100 Dyaks of Lundu for the mountain of Sararabo, at
the foot of which Siniawan and the enemies' forts are
situated.
" 19th. Did everything in rny power to urge Macota
to advance and divert the attention of the rebels from
the party going up the mountain, but in vain : Malay-
like, he would wait.
" 20th. I have before remarked that two rivers form-
ed a junction at Leda Tanah ; and this day I ascended
the left hand stream, or, as they call it, the Songi besar
(i. e. great Songi). The sceneiy is picturesque ; the
banks adorned with a light and variegated foliage of fruit-
itrees : and everywhere bearing traces of former clear-
ing and cultivation. In the background is the range of
mountains, among which Stat is conspicuous from his
noble and irregular shape. On our return, the white
flag (a Hadji's turban) was descried on the mountain,
being the prearranged signal that all was well. No
news, however, came from the party ; and in spite of
the white banner Macota took fright at the idea that
the rebels had surrounded them.
" 21st. Detachments of Dyaks are coming in. Ten of
the tribe of Sutor were dispatched as scouts ; and in a
few hours returned with the welcome intelligence that
the detachment was safe on the top of the mountain,
and that the three tribes of Paninjow, Bombak, and Sa-
rambo, had finally decided on joining the rajah, and sur- 1
rendering their fortified houses. Soon after this news
the chiefs of the tribes arrived with about 100 men, and
were of course well received ; for if chargeable with de-
serting their cause, it is done with the utmost simplicity,
and perfect confidence in their new associates. From
their looks it was apparent they had suffered greatly
from want of food ; and they frankly confessed that
starvation was their principal motive for coming over. 1
did all in my power to fix their new faith by presents of
provisions, &c. tVc. : and I think they are trustworthy;
for there is a straightforwardness about the Dyak char--
actor far different from the double-fared dealings of (he
TO BUllM. 95
i\Jalay. Their stipulations were, forgiveness for the
past, and an assurance that none of the Dyaks from the
sea (i. e. Sarebus and Sakarran) should be employed ;
for they were, they said, hateful to their eyes. These
terms being readily conceded the first from interest,
the second from necessity they became open and
communicative on the best means of attacking the forts.
A grand council of war was held, at which were pres-
ent Macota, Subtu, Abong Mia, and Datu Naraja, two Chi-
nese leaders, and myself certainly a most incongruous
mixture, and one rarely to be met with. After much dis-
cussion, amove close to the enemy wafe determined on for
to-morrow, and on the following day to take up a position
near their defences. To judge by the sample of the council,
I should form very unfavorable expectations of the con-
duct in action. Macota is lively and active; but whether
from indisposition or want of authority, undecided.
The Capitan China is lazy and silent ; Subtu indolent
and self-indulgent ; Abong Mia and Datu Naraja stupid.
However, the event must settle the question ; and, in
the mean time, it was resolved that the small stockade
at this place was to be picked up, and removed to our
new position, and there erected for the protection of
the fleet. I may here state my motives for being a
spectator of, or participator (as may turn out), in this
scene. In the first place I must confess that curiosity
strongly prompted me ; since to witness the Malays,
Chinese, and Dyaks in warfare was so new, that the
novelty alone might plead an excuse for this desire.
But it was not the only motive ; for my presence is a
stimulus to our own party, and will probably depress the
other in proportion. I look upon the cause of the ra-
jah as most just and righteous : and the speedy close
of the war would be rendering a service to humanity,
especially if brought about by treaty. At any rate
much might be done to ameliorate the condition of the
rebels in case of their defeat ; for though I cannot, per-
haps ought not to, save the lives of the three leaders, yet
all the others, I believe, will be forgiven on a slight in-
tercession. At our arrival, too, I had stated that if they
wished me to remain, no barbarities must be committed ;
and especially that the women and children must not be
96 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
fired upon. To counterbalance these motives was the
danger, whatever it might amount to, and which did not
weigh heavily on my mind. So much for reasons,
which, after all, are poor and weak when we determine?
on doing anything, be it right or be it wrong. If evil
befall, I trust the penalty may be on me rather than on
my followers.
"22cZ. At daylight the fleet was astir; and in an
hour the defences were cut down, the timber, bamboos,
&c., formed into rafts ready for transportation, and the
stockade, by breakfast- time, had as completely vanished
as though it had been bodily lifted away by some genius
of the Wonderful Lamp. Everything was ready for a
start, and we waited lazily for the flood-tide ; but when
it did make, the usual procrastination ensued, and there
was no move till it was near done. Then, indeed, we
proceeded up about two-thirds of the way, and brought
up with two good hours' daylight, in spite of my remon-
strances. No place could be better calculated than
where we rested for an attack upon boats: high banks
covered with grass and trees offered a safe shelter for
musketry, against which no return could be made. The
night, however, passed away quietly.
24/i. Dawn found us on the advance to our proper
position. A thick fog concealed us, and in half an hour
the people were on shore busy recreating our fort, less
than a mile from two forts of the enemy, but concealed
from them by a point of the river. No opposition was
offered to us ; and in a few hours a neat defence was
completed from the debris of the former. The ground
was cleared of jungle ; piles driven in a square, about
fifteen yards to each face ; and the earth from tin; cen-
ter, scooped out and intermixed with layers of reeds,
was heaped up about five feet high inside the piles. At
the four corners were small watch-towers, and along the
parapet of earth a narrow walk connecting them. In the
center space was a house crowded by the Chinese gar-
rison, a few of whose harmless gingalls were stuck up
at the angles to intimidate rather than to wound. While
they labored at the body of the defence, the I )yaks sur-
rounded it by an outer work, made of slight sticks run
into the ground with <TOS< hiiidinj; of <\A\\ l>a:nli
i'KHITlC.N K> BOfcNEG. J)7
bristling with a chcvaux de frise (if it may be so styled)
of sharpened bamboos about breast-high. The festenings
of the entire work were of rattan, which is found in
plenty. It was commenced nt7 A.M. and finished about
:> P..M., showing how the fellows can get through busi-
ness when they choose. This stockade, varying in
strength according to circumstances, is the usual defence
of the Sambas Chinese. The Malays erect a simple
and quicker-constructed protection by a few double up-
rights, filled in between with timber laid lengthwise and
supported by the uprights. Directly they are under
cover, they begin to form the ranjows or sudas, which
are formidable to naked feet, and stick them about their
position. Above our station was a hill which entirely
commanded both it and the river ; to the top of which I
mounted, and obtained an excellent view of the country
around, including the enemies' forts and the town of
Siniawan. A company of military might finish the war
in a few hours, as these defences are most paltry, the
strongest being the fort of Balidah, against which our
formidable assault was to be leveled. It was situated at
the water's edge, on a slight eminence on the right bank
of the river ; and a large nouse with a thatched roof and
a lookout house on the summit ; a few swivels and a gun
or two were in it, and around it a breastwork of wood
judging from a distance, about six or seven feet high.
The other defences were more insignificant even than
this ; and the enemies' artillery amounted, by account,
to three six-pounders and numerous swivels ; from 350
to 500 men, about half of whom were armed with mus-
kets, while the rest carried swords and spears. They
were scattered in many forts, and had a town to defend,
all of which increased their weakness. Their principal
arm, however, consisted in the ranjows, which were
stated to be stuck in every direction. These ranjows
are made of bamboo, pointed firo uhd stuck in the
ground ; and there are beside, holes about three feet
deep, filled with these spikes, and afterward lightly cov-
ered, which are called patobong. Another obstacle con-
sists of a spring formed by bending back a stiff cane with
a sharp bamboo attached to it, which, fastened by a slight
twine, flies forcibly against any object passing through
7 I
98 ilXl'EDITfON TO BORNEO.
the bush and brushing against it: they resemble \h&
mole-traps of England. The Borneons have a great
dread of these various snares ; and the way they deal
with them is by sending out parties of Dyaks during the
night to clear the paths from such dangers.
" Though I have stated the insignificant nature of the
enemies' lines, it must not be supposed I imagined them
at all inferior to our own resources. Our grand army
consisted of 200 Chinese, excellent workmen, but of
whose qualities as soldiers I can say nothing. They
were, however, a stout, muscular set of men, though
wretchedly armed, having no guns and scarcely any
muskets ; but swords, spears, and shields, together with
forty long thin iron tubes with the bore of a musket and
carrying a slug. These primitive weapons were each
managed by two men, one being the carrier of the ord-
nance, the other the gunner ; for while one holds the
tube over his shoulder, the other takes aim, turns away
his head, applies his match, and is pleased with the
sound. Their mode of loading is as curious as the piece
and its mode of discharge. Powder is poured in, the
end knocked on the ground, and the slug with another
knock sent on the powder, without either ramming or
cartridge. Indeed, it is difficult to imagine any weapon
more rude, awkward, or inefficient.
" Of Malays we had 250, of whom 150 were on the
Sarambo mountain, occupied in defending the Dyak
houses. Of the hundred remaining with the grand
army, about half were armed with muskets. A few
brass guns composed our artillery ; and in the boats
were a good many swivels. The Dyaks amounted to
about 200, of various tribes, vi/,., Sibnowans, Paninjows,
Bombak, Sarambo, Kampit, Talmh, Sanpro, Smitali :
but these were merely pioneers, and would not face tin-
report of fire-arms. 'The Borneons, in lighting, wear
a quilted jacket or spencer, which reaches over the
hips, and from its size has a most unservicelike appear-
ance : the bare legs and arms sticking out from under
this puffed-out coat, like the sticks which support the
garments of a scarecrow. Such was our incongruous
and most inefficient army ; yet with 300 men who
would fight, nothing would have lip<>n easier than loiake
TO : iJU
the dctuclic:! defences of the enemy, HOIK; of which
could contain above thirty or forty men. But our allies
seemed to have little idea of fighting except behind a
wall; and my proposal to attack the adversary was im-
mediately treated as an extreme of rashness amounting
tu insanity. At a council of war it was consequently
decided that advances should be made from the hill be-
hind our fort to Balidah by a chain of posts, the distance
being a short mile, in which space they would probably
erect four or five forts ; and then would come a bom-
bardment, noisy but harmless.
41 During the day we were not left quiet. The beat-
ing of gongs, shouts, and an occasional shot, gave life to
the scene. With my glass I could espy our forces at
the top of the hill, pleased no doubt to see us coming to
their support. At night loud shouts and firing from the
rebels caused us to prepare for an attack ; but it proved
to be nothing but lights moving about the hill-side, with
what intent we were ignorant. The jungle on the left
bank having been cleared, we did not much expect any
skirmishers ; but some spies were heard near our boats.
With this exception the night passed away unbroken on
our part, though the rebels kept up an incessant beating
of gongs, and from time to time fired a few stray shots,
whether against an enemy or not was doubtful.
44 25th. The grand army was lazy, and did not take
the field when they possessed themselves of two emi-
nences, and commenced forts on each. About 11 A.M.
we got intelligence that the enemy was collecting on
the right bank, as they had been heard by our scouts
shouting one to another to gather together in order to
attack the stockades in the course of building. Even
with a knowledge of their usual want of caution, I could
not believe this, but walked nevertheless to one of the
forts, and had scarcely reached it when a universal rebel
shout, and a simultaneous beating of the silver-tongued
gongs, announced, as I thought, a general action. But
though the shouts continued loud and furious from both
sides, and a gun or two was discharged in the air to re-
fresh their courage, the enemy did not attack, and a
heavy shower damped the ardor of the appi-oaching
armies, and reduced all to inaction. Like the heroes of
i'a 13ORN1
old, however, the adverse parties spoke to each other:
' We are coming, we are coming,' exclaimed the rebels ;
'lay aside your muskets and fight us with swords.'
' Come on,' was the reply ; 'we are building a stockade,
and want to fight you.' And so the heroes ceased not
to talk, but forgot to fight, except that the rebels opened
a fire from Balidah from swivels, all of which went over
the tops of the trees. Peace, or rather rest, being re-
stored, our party succeeded in entrenching themselves,
and thus gained a field which had been obstinately as-
saulted by big words and loud cries. The distance of
one fort from Balidah was about 800 yards, and manned
with sixty Malays ; while a party of Chinese garrisoned
the other. Evening fell upon this innocent warfare.
The Borneons, in this manner, contend with vociferous
shouts ; and, preceding each shout, the leader of the
party offers up a prayer aloud to the Almighty, the cho-
rus (or properly response) being the acclamation of the
soldiery. We, on our side, kept up a firing and hallooing
till midnight, to disguise the advance of a party who
were to seize and build a stockade within a shorter dis-
tance of Balidah. When they reached the spot, how-
ever, the night being dark, the troops sl<?epy, and the
leaders of different opinions, they returned without ef-
fecting anything."
CHAPTER VIII.
Appearance of the country. Progress of the rebel war. Char-
acter of the Sow and Singe Dyaks. Their belief in augury.
Ruinous effects of protracted warfare. Cowardice and boasting
of the Malays. Council of war. Refuse to attack the enemy's
forts. Rebels propose to treat. The Malays oppose. Set out
to attack the rebels, but frustrated by our allies. Assailnl by
the rebels. Put them to flight. Treat with them. They
surrender. Intercede with the Rajah for their lives. Renewed
treachery of the Malays.
" 26th. 1 MUST hero pause in my account of this
extraordinary and novel contest, briefly to describe the
general appearance of the country.
"It is one delightful to look upon, combining all tho
requisites of the picturesque, vix. wood, water, mountain,
KXI'KDITIOM TO IJOUNKn. 10 J
cliff, and a foreground gently undulating, partially culti-
vated, and of the richest soil. The mountain of Sarambo,
about 3000 feet in height, is the principal feature in the
scene, situated at a short distance from the left bank of
the river. The remainder of the ground slopes gradu-
ally ; and the town of Siniawan, likewise on the left
bank, is close to the water, and at the foot of the emi-
nence called Gunga Kumiel.
" The advance of the party last night was, as I have
said, disguised by firing, drumming, and shouting from
the fleet and forts ; and, in the deep stillness of the fine
night, the booming of the guns, the clamor of the gongs,
and the outcries raised from time to time, came on our
ears like the spirit of discord breaking loose on a fair
and peaceful paradise. About one o'clock the noises
died away, and I enjoyed as quiet a slumber till daylight
as though pillowed on a bed of down in the heart of
Old England. About six I visited the three forts. The
Chinese, Malays, and Dyaks were taking their morn-
ing meal, consisting of half a coacoanut-shell full of boiled
rice with salt. The Dyaks were served in tribes ; for
as many of them are at war, it is necessary to keep them
separate ; and though they will not fight the enemy,
they would have no objection to fall out with one an-
other, and the slightest cause might give rise to an in-
stant renewal of hostilities.
" About 9 A.M. a party proceeded to the elevation
previously marked, within 300 yards of Balidah, and
worked quietly till 2 P.M., by which time they had
made considerable progress ; and being then reinforced,
they soon finished this new stockade, with a strong face
toward their adversaries, and an outer fence. This
erection, however, being below the brow of the hill, is
useless as a post whence to assault Balidah ; and to-mor-
row another stockade is to be made close to it on the
summit, the present being intended to cover the work-
ing party at the next. The enemy, about 4 P.M.,
having discovered the stockade, opened a fire for half an
hour; but finding it ineffectual, they sank into their
usual apathy. It is difficult to attribute this quietude
to any other cause than weakness ; and they are doubt-
less harassed by the want of Dyak light troops, as they
10!^ KXl'KDITIo.N To I'.oKNEU.
arc \inable to oppose stockade to stockade. Our party,
by these successful advances, seem to gain confidence ;
and it must soon come to an issue one way or other. To
make it favorable, I have sent for two six-pounder c.ar-
ronades, guns of vast caliber here, together with a small
addition to our force. I had the curiosity to inquire of
Macota the progress of his former campaign, when he
had 1000 Malays with only a few Dyaks. He repre-
sented the enemy as active and daring then, and very
different from their want of spirit now. They had, he
declared, combats by sea and by land ; stockade was
opposed to stockade, and the fighting was constant and
severe ; but he never lost a man killed during the two
months, and only boasted of killing five of the enemy !
The principal danger in Malay warfare is the ' Menga-
muk' (Anglice, running a-muck), which is the last re-
source of a desperate man.
"27tfi. The night passed quietly as usual. About G
A.M. I started for the hills, and inspected each post in
turn. They are about commencing another fort. I
visited the spot to reconnoiter it ; and the enemy opened
a fire directly they perceived me, which we returned.
They shot wretchedly ill ; and the position is good, but
exposed. About 10 A.M. they again began to fire from
their fort, and detached thirty or forty men, who crept
out between our forts in order to interrupt the work.
The Malays, however, received them steadily ; while
the Chinese placed them between two fires, and, by a
discharge from a tube, knocked down one man. The
rebels showed anxiety to possess themselves of their
fallen comrade, while the opposite party shouted, ' Cut
off his head;' but he was carried off; and the enemy,
when they had saved his body, fled in all directions,
dropping a number of their rmall bamboo powder flasks
on the way. Some fierce alarms were given of an at-
tack by water, and I went up the river to ascertain
really whether there was any mischief to be expected ;
but there was no appearance of any adversary. A
slack fire from the hill proclaimed that our work was
going on there ; and toward evening all was in repose.
" 28th. The stockade was completed in the evening,
with ranjows stuck round the outer defence. It was
KXI'KUITION TO BORNEO. 103
j\ccllmitry situated for battering Balidah; but Balidah,
I fear, is too loosely constructed to be battered to the
test advantage. During the day the Sow and Singe
Dyaks joined, to the amount of about 150 men, and other
iribes have been gradually dropping in ; so that altogeth-
er there aro not fewer than 500 of these men joined to
.iur equipment. Most of them show all the character-
istics of a wild people ; never openly resisting their mas-
ters, but so obstinate that they can always get their own
way in every thing ; to all threats and entreaties oppos-
ing a determined and immovable silence. Many of
them depend upon us for their food and salt, and their
applications are endless. Three women of Singd are
our regular pensioners ; for their sex excludes them
from the rations granted to the men. By these means
we had many excellent opportunities of judging of their
habits and temper. Among all these tribes the language
differs but slightly so slightly, indeed, that it is need-
iess to note the variations in detail. They have the
same superstition about particular birds, and I often
heard this omen alluded to in conversation ; but their
birds are not the same as those of the sea Dyaks
The chief of the Sarambo, explaining his reasons for
leaving the rebels, urged the constant unfavorable omen
of the bii'ds as one. Often, very often, he said, when
he went out, the bird cried, and flew in the direction of
Siniawan, which will be explained by what I have be-
fore stated ; for if they hear the bird to the right, they
go to the left, and vice versa; so that the bird may be
considered as warning them from evil.
" The Sow Dyaks brought in the head of an unfor-
tunate Malay whom they had decapitated in the jungle.
This species of wai-fare is extremely barbarous, and in
its train probably brings more evil than the regular cam-
paigns of civilized nations. Not that it is by any means
so fatal to human life directly ; but it is the slow poison
which wastes the strongest frame, the smoldering fire
which does its work of destruction slowly but surely.
Year after year it is protracted ; few fall in open fight,
but stragglers and prisoners tire murdered ; and while
fcoth weak parties, gradually growing weaker, hold their
*nvn ground, the country .becomes a desert. First, trade
104
stagnates, agriculture withers, ibud becomes scarce, all
are ruined in finances, all half-starved and .most misera-
ble and yet the war drags on, and the worst passions
are aroused, effectually preventing the slightest conces-
sion, even if concession would avail. But each comba-
tant knows the implacable spirit the deep desperation
of the other too well to trust them ; and if at length the
fortunes of famine decide against them, they die rather
than yield ; for a Dyak can die bravely, I believe, though
he will not fight as long as life has any prospect. This
is also the case here : for the rebel chiefs know there
is no pardon, and the Bandar is disgraced if he fails. It
is indeed a slow process, but one of extermination.
" 29th. Our guns arrived with a welcome reinforce-
ment. In the evening I dropped up the river to recon-
noiter ; but the adversary discovered us, as we were
dressed in white clothes.
" 30th. Fort not finished. All quiet.
" 3lst. Got the guns and ammunition up, and while
fixing them opened a fire from one of our swivels to over-
bear the fire of the enemy. The little piece was well
served ; and, in a quarter of an hour, we silenced their
fire entirely, and knocked about the timber considera-
bly, making a breach which several men could enter
together. Seeing the effect, I proposed to Macota to
storm the place with 150 Chinese and Malays. The
way from one fort to the other was protected. The
enemy dared not show themselves for the fire of the
grape and canister, and nothing could have been easier :
but my proposition caused a commotion which it is diffi-
cult to forget, and more difficult to describe. The ( 'hi-
nese consented, and Macota, the commander-in-chief,
was willing ; but his inferiors were backward, and there
arose a scene which showed me the full violence of the
Malay passions, and their infuriated madness when once
roused. Pangeran Houseman urged with energy the
advantage of the proposal, and in the course of a speech
lashed himself to a state of fuiy ; he jumped to hi
and with demoniac gestures stamped round and round,
dancing a war-dance after the most approved fashion ;
his countenance grew livid, his eyes glared, his features
inflamed : and, for my part, not 1
1'IOIHTION TO BORNEO. 105
the torrent of his oratory, I thought the man possessed
of a devil, or about to ' run a-muck.' But after a min-
ute or two of this dance, he resumed his seat, furious
and panting, but silent. In reply, Subtu urged some
objections to my plan, which was warmly supported by
Illudeen, who apparently hurt Subtu's feelings ; for the
indolent, the placid Subtu leapt from his seat, seized his
spear, and rushed to the entrance of the stockade, with
his passions and his pride desperately aroused. I never
saw liner action than when, with spear in hand, pointing
to tin 1 ! enemy's fort, he challenged any one to rush on
with him. Houseman and Surradeen (the bravest of
the brave) like madmen seized their swords to inflame
the courage of the rest it was a scene of fiends but in
vain : for though they appeared ready enough to quarrel
and tight among themselves, thei-e was no move to at-
tack the enemy. All was confusion ; the demon of dis-
cord and madness was among them, and I was glad to
see them cool down, when the dissentients to the as-
sault proposed making a round to-night and attacking to-
morrow. In the mean time our six-pounders were
ready in battery, and it is certain the assailants might
walk nearly to the fort without any of the rebels daring
to show themselves in opposition to our fire.
" Nov. 1st. The guns were ready to open their fiery
mouths, and their masters ready to attend on them ; but
both had to wait till mid-day, when the chiefs of the
grand army, having sufficiently slept, breakfasted, and
bathed, lounged up with their straggling followers.
Shortly after daylight the forts are nearly deserted of
their garrisons, who go down at the time to the water
more like a flock of geese than warriors. The instant
the main division and head-quarters of the army arrived
at the battery, I renewed my proposal for an assault,
which was variously received. If the Malays would
go, the Chinese agreed; but the Malays had grown
colder and colder. In order to encourage them, I opened
a fire to show the effect of our guns ; and having got a
good range, every ball, as well as grape and canister,
rattled against and through the wood. I then urged
them again and again, but in vain ; that coward Pangli-
ma rajah displayed that dogged resolution which is
100 iniTION TO BORNEO.
invincible an invincible resolution to do nothing ; .aid
the cold damp looks of the others at once told the amount
of their bravery ! A council of war was called grave
faces covered timid hearts and fainting spirits. The
Chinese contended with justice, that in fairness they
could not be expected to assault without the Malays did
the same ; Abong Mia was not brave enough. The
Datu agreed, and Panglima delivered himself of a wise
harangue, to the effect that, ' the last campaign, when
they had a fort, how had the enemy fired then ? stabbed
thorn, speared them, &c. &c. ; and without a fort, as-
saulting ! how could it be expected they should suc-
ceed ? how unreasonable they, should go at all !' But
even his stolid head seemed to comprehend the sarcasm
when I asked him how many men had been killed dur-
ing all this severe fighting. However, it was clear that
it was no battle. We were all very savage, and I inti-
mated how useless my being with them was, if they
intended to play instead of fight. ' What,' I asked, ' if
you will not attack, are you going to do?' Oh, the wise
councils of these wise heads ! Abong Mia proposed
erecting a fort in a tree, and thence going ' puff, puff,'
down into Balidah, accompanying the words ' puff, puff','
with expressive gestures of firing ; but it was objected,
that trees were scarce, and the enemy might cut down
the tree, fort and all.*
" 2d. Till two o'clock last night, or thereabouts, I
*The following is an extract from an equally sapient proposi-
tion, published in the Chinese state-papers on the 14th January,
1840; it is headed, Memorial of Toang Wangyen to the emperor,
recommending plans for the extermination of barbarians : " Your
minister's opinion is this : that we, being upon shore and they in
their ships, it is not at all requisite to order our naval forces to
proceed out a great distance to contend with them in battle.
When the commercial intercourse of the said barbarians shall
have been entirely put an end to, and their supplies grow scanty,
it will be impossible for them to remain a long time anchored in
the outer seas, and they will necessarily, as formerly, enter the
inner waters in order to ramble and spy about them. We can
then, by means of our naval vessels, tempt them and cause them
to enter far in ; and a previous arrangement having been made, we
can summon the people who live along the coasts, such as an;
expert and able swimmers, and those who possess bravery and
strength, to the amount of several hundreds of men : we can then
cause them, during the night, to divide themselves into companies,
KVl'EDITION TO BORNEO. 1 07
sat on our rampart and gazed upon the prospect around,
shaded with gloom. The doctor was with me, and we
ran over every subject the past, present, and the future.
Such a scene a rude fort in the interior of Borneo ;
such a night, dark but starlight leaves an indelible
impression on the mind, which recurs to move it even
after long years. The morning, however, found us
ready, and no one else. The fort was left to ourselves ;
we waited and waited until 2 P.M., when I was made
aware that all thoughts of attack were at an end. Ma-
cota, for very shame, staid below ; and I must say there
was not a countenance that met mine but had that bash-
ful and hang-dog look which expresses cowardice and
obstinacy predominant, yet shame battling within. They
were now resolved not to make the attempt ; and I asked
them casually whether they would fly a white flag, and
hold a conference with the enemy. They caught at
the alternative ; the flag was hoisted ; the rebels were
ready to meet me, and it was agreed that we should as-
semble on the morrow. But no sooner was the arrange-
ment made than a thousand objections were started, and
any thing, even attack itself (though that was out of the
question), was held to be preferable. 1 need not dwell
on this mixture of deceit and fear ; in short, as they
would do nothing themselves, they expected us to do
nothing : and without the courage to cany on the war,
they had not either wisdom or sorcery to bring it to a
conclusion.
" 3d. Dispatched an express during last night to the
rajah, and received an answer that he was coming up in
person ; but my resolve was taken, and I quitted the
grand army, much to their evident surprise and vexa-
tion. Nevertheless, they were still friendly and polite,
and very very lazy about bringing down our guns. This
was, however, done at last, and we were ready for a
start.
; ' 4th. Reached the ship at two P.M., saw rajah,
&c. &c.
"'From the 4th to the 10th of November I may con-
and silently proceeding through the water, straightway board the
foreign ships ; and overcoming the crews in their unprepared
state, make an entire massacre of the whoje of them
108 , i;mno\ TO KORNKO.
dense into the shape of a narrative. I explained to the
rajah how useless it was my remaining, and intimated
to him my intention of departing ; but his deep regret
was so visible, that even all the self-command of the
native could not disguise it. He begged, he entreated
me to stay, and offered me the country of Siniawan and
Sarawak, and its government and trade, if I would only
stop, and not desert him. I could at once have obtained
this grant, but I preferred interposing a delay ; because
to accept such a boon when imposed by necessity, or
from a feeling of gratitude for recent assistance, would
have rendered it both suspicious and useless : and I was
by no means eager to enter on the task (the full difficul-
ties of which I clearly foresaw) without the undoubted-
and spontaneous support of the rajah.
"Jan. 8th, 1841. The following narrative, extracted
from my journal, includes a period from the 10th of
December to the 4th of January, and it is put into its
present shape to avoid the tedium of detailing each day's
proceedings. On the 10th of December we reached
the fleet and disembarked our guns, taking up our resi-
dence in a house, or rather shed, close to the water.
The rajah's brother, Pangeran Budrudeen, was with
the army, and I found him ready and willing to urge
upon the other indolent Pangerans the proposals I made
for vigorous hostilities. We found the grand army in a
state of torpor, eating, drinking, and walking up to the
forts and back again daily ; but having built these im-
posing structures, and their appearance not driving the
enemy away, they were at a loss what next to do, or
how to proceed. On my arrival, I once more insisted
on mounting the guns in our old forts, and assaulting
Balidah under their fire. Macota's timidity and vacil-
lation were too apparent ; but in consequence of Budru-
deen's overawing presence, he was obliged, from shame,
to yield his assent. The order for the attack was fixed
as follows : Our party of ten (leaving six to serve the
guns) were to be headed by myself. Biidmdeen, M;;
cota, Subtu, and all the lesser chiefs, wore to lead their
followers, from (JO to 80 in number, hy the same route,
while- 50 or more Chinese, under their captain, wore to
assault by another path to the left. Macota was to make
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 109
tin- p.-itlis as near as possible to Balidah, with his Dyaks,
who were to extract the sudas and fill up the holes.
The guns having been mounted and their range well
ascertained the previous evening, we ascended to the
fort at about eight A.M., and at ten opened our fire, and
kept it up for an hour. The effect was severe : every
shot told upon their thin defences of wood, which fell in
many places so as to leave storming breaches. Part of
the roof was cut away and tumbled down, and the
shower of grape and canister rattled so as to prevent
their returning our fire, except from a stray rifle. At
mid-day the forces reached the fort, and it was then
discovered that Macota had neglected to make any road
because it rained the night before ! It was evident that
the rebels had gained information of our intention, as
they had erected a frieze of bamboo along their defences
on the very spot which we had agreed to mount. Ma-
cota fancied the want of a road would delay the attack ;
but I well knew that delay was equivalent to failure,
and so it was at once agreed that we should advance
without any path. The poor man's cunning and re-
sources were now nearly at an end. He could not refuse
to accompany us ; but his courage could not be brought
to the point, and, pale and embarrassed, he retired.
Everything was ready Budrudeen, the Capitan China,
and myself, at the head of our men when he once more
appeared, and raised a subtle point of etiquet which an-
swered his purpose. He represented to Budi-udeen
that the Malays were unanimously of opinion that the
rajah's brother could not expose himself in an assault ;
that their dread of the rajah's indignation far exceeded
the dread of death ; and in case any accident happened
to him, his brother's fuiy would fall on them. They
stated their readiness to assault the place ; but in case
Budrudeen insisted on leading in person, they must
decline accompanying him. Budrudeen was angry, I
was angry too, and the doctor most angry of all ; but
anger was unavailing : it was clear they did not intend
to do anything in earnest ; and after much discussion, in
which Budrudeen insisted that if I went he should like-
wise go, and the Malays insisted that if he went they
not go, it was resolved we should serve the guns,
K
110 EXPEDITION TO
while Abong Mia and the Chinese (not under the cap-
tain) should proceed to the assault. But its fate was
sealed, and Macota had gained his object ; for neither
he nor Subtu thought of exposing themselves to a single
shot. Our artillery opened and was beautifully served.
The adverse troops advanced ; but our fire completely
subdued them, as only three rifles answered us, by one
of which a seaman (Williams) was wounded in the hand,
but not seriously. Two-thirds of the way the storming-
party proceeded without the enemy being aware of their
advance ; and they might have reached the very foot of
the hill without being discovered, had not Abong Mia,
from excess of piety and rashness, begun most loudly to
say his prayers. The three rifles then began to play
on them ; one Chinaman was killed, the whole halted,
the prayers were more vehement than ever, and, after
squatting under cover of the jungle for some time, they
all returned. It was only what I expected ; but I was
greatly annoyed at their cowardice and treachery
treacheiy to their own cause. One lesson, however, I
learned, and that w r as, that, had I assaulted with our
small party, we should assuredly have been victimized !
The very evening of the failure the rajah came up the
river. I would not see him, and only heard that the
chiefs got severely reprimanded ; but the effects of rep-
rimand are lost where cowardice is stronger than shame.
Inactivity followed ; two or three useless forts were
built, and Budrudeen, much to my regret and the detri-
ment of the cause, was recalled.
" Among the straggling arrivals I may mention Pan-
glirna Dallam, with a number of men, consisting of the
OrangBentulu, Meri Muka, and Knyan, J)yaks from the
interior. Our house or, as it originally stood, shed
deserves a brief record. It was about twenty feet long,
with a loose floor of reeds, and an attop roof. It served
us for some time ; but the attempts at theft obliged us
to fence it in and divide it into apartments : one at the
end served Middle ton, Williamson, and myself; adjoining
it was the store-room and hospital ; and the other ex-
treme belonged to the seamen. Our improvements kept
pace with our necessities. Theft induced us to shut in
our house at the ;;ides. and the iu:evenness of tin
i.M'KDlTlON TO BORNEO. Ill
suggested the advantage of laying a floor of the bark
of trees over them, which, with mats over all, ren-
dered our domicile far from uncomfortable. Our forts
gradually extended at the back of the enemy's town, on
a ridge of swelling ground ; while they kept pace with
us on the same side of the river on the low ground.
The inactivity of our troops had long become a by-word
among us. It was indeed truly vexatious, but it was in
vain to urge them on, in vain to offer assistance, in vain
to propose a joint attack, or even to seek support at their
hands ; promises were to be had in plenty, but perform
ances never !
" At length the leaders resolved on building a fort at
Sekundis, thus outflanking the enemy and gaining the
command of the river. The post was certainly an im-
portant one, and in consequence they set about it with
the happy indifference which characterizes their pro-
ceedings. Pangeran Illudeen (the most active among
them) had the building of the fort, assisted by the Orang
Kaya Tumangong of Lundu. Macota, Subtu, &c. were
at the next fort, and by chance I was there likewise ;
for it seemed to be little apprehended that any interrup-
tion would take place, as the Chinese and the greater
number of Malays had not left the boats. When
the fort commenced, however, the enemy crossed the
river and divided into two bodies, the one keeping in
check the party at Pangeran Gapoor's fort, while the
other made an attack on the works. The ground was
not unfavorable for their purpose ; for Pangeran Gapoor's
fort was separated from Sekundis by a belt of thick wood
which reached down to the river's edge. Sekundis it-
self, however, stood on clear ground, as did Gapoor's
tort. I was with Macota at the latter when the enemy
approached through the jungle. The two parties were
within easy speaking distances, challenging and threat-
ening each other; but the thickness of the jungle pre-
vented our seeing or penetrating to them. When this
body had advanced, the real attack commenced on Se-
kundis with a tire of musketry, and I was about pro-
ceeding to the scene, but was detained by Macota, who
assured me there were plenty of men, and that it was
inl.hin;. 1 ; ;i! .ill. As th<> musketry bc-rumo thicken 1 , I
112 ...:- TO liOKM
had my doubts, when a Dyak came running through the
jungle, and with gestures of impatience and anxiety
begged me to assist the party attacked. He had been
sent by my old friend the Tumangong of Lundu, to say
they could not hold the post unless supported. In spite
of Macota's remonstrances, I struck into the jungle.
winded through the narrow path, and after crossing an
ugly stream, emerged on the clear ground. The sight
was a pretty one: to the right was the unfinished stock-
ade, defended by the Tumangong; to the left, at the
edge of the forest, about twelve or fifteen of our party,
commanded by Illudeen, while the enemy were stretched
along between the points and kept up a sharp shooting
from the hollow ground on the bank of the river. They
fired, and loaded, and fired, and had gradually advanced
on the stockade as the ammunition of our party failed ;
and as we emerged from the jungle, they were within
twenty or five and twenty yards of the defence. A
glance immediately showed me the advantage of our
position, and I charged with my Europeans across the
padi-field ; and the instant we appeared on the ridge
above the river, in the hollows of which the rebels were
seeking protection, their rout was complete. They
scampered off in every direction, while the Dyaks and
Malays pushed them into the river. Our victory was
decisive and bloodless : the scene was changed in an in-
stant, and the defeated foe lost arms, ammunition, &c.
&c., whether on the field of battle or in the river, and
our exulting conquerors set no bounds to their triumph.
" I cannot omit to mention the name of Si Tundo,
the only native who charged with us. His appearance
and dress were most striking, the latter being entirely
of red, bound round the waist, arms, forehead, cVc. with
gold ornaments ; and in his hand bearing his formidable
Bajuck sword, he danced or rather galloped across tlio
field close to me, and mixing with the enemy was about
to dispatch a hadji or priest who was prostrate before
him, when one of our people interposed and saved him
by stating that ho was a companion of our own. The
Lundu Dyaks wero very thankful for our support, our
praises were loudly sung, and the slockadr was concluded.
Alter the rout, Macota, Sublu, and Abong Mia ai
IIXI'KUITION TO BORNEO. 113
on ihe field ; the latter with forty followers had ven-
tured halfway before the firing ceased, but the detach-
ment, under a paltry subterfuge, halted, so as not to be
in time. The enemy might have had fifty men at the
attack; the defending party consisted of about the same
number ; but the Dyaks had very few muskets. I had
a dozen Englishmen, Seboo, one of our boatmen, and
Si Tundo. Sekundis was a great point gained, as it
hindered the enemy from ascending the river and seek-
ing any supplies.
'* Macota, Subtu, and the whole tribe arrived as
soon as their safety from danger allowed, and none
were louder in their own praise ; but nevertheless
their countenances evinced some sense of shame, which
they endeavored to disguise by the use of their tongues.
The Chinese came really to afford assistance, but too
late. We remained until the stockade of Sekundis was
finished, while the enemy kept up a wasteful fire from
the opposite side of the river, which did no harm.
" The next great object was to follow up the advan-
tage by crossing the stream; but day after day some
fresh excuse brought on fresh delay, and Macota built
a new fort and made a new road within a hundred
yards of our old position. I cannot detail further our
proceedings for many days, which consisted on my part
of efforts to get something done, and on the others a
close adherence to the old system of promising every-
thing and doing nothing. The Chinese, like the Ma-
lays, refused to act ; but on their part, it was not fear,
but disinclination. By degrees, however, the prepara-
tions for the new fort were complete, and I had grad-
ually gained over a party of the natives to my views ;
and, indeed, among the Malays, the bravest of them
had joined themselves to us, and what was better, we
had Datu Pangeran, thirteen Illanuns, and the Capitan
China allowed me to take his men whenever I wanted
them. My weight and consequence were increased,
and I rarely moved now without a long train of fol-
lowers. The next step (while crossing the river was
uncertain) was to take my guns up to Gapoor's fort,
which was about GOO or 700 yards from the town, and
half the distance iroui H rf>hr] fort, -mi ili.* rigor's bank-
114 ro BORNI.
" Pauglima Rajah, the day after our guns were in
battery, took it into his head to build a fort on the
river's side close to the town, in front and between two
of the enemy's forts. It was a bold undertaking for
the old man, after six weeks of uninterrupted repose.
At night, the wood being prepared, the party moved
down, and worked so silently that they were not dis-
covered till their defence was nearly finished, when the
enemy commenced a general firing from all their forts,
returned by a similar firing from all ours, none of the
parties being quite clear what they were firing at or
about, and the hottest from either party being equally
harmless. We were at the time about going to bed in
our habitation ; but expecting some reverse, I set off (to
scale the hills) to the stockade where our guns were
placed, and opened a fire upon the town and the stock-
ade near us, till the enemy's fire gradually slackened
and died away. We then returned, and in the morning
were greeted with the pleasing news that they had
burned and deserted five of their forts, and left us sole
occupants of the right bank of the river. The same
day, going through the jungle to see one of these
deserted forts, we came upon a party of the enemy,,
and had a brief skirmish with them before they look \<>
flight. Nothing can bo more unpleasant 1o a Euro
pean than this bush-lighting, where 1
ibe, while he is well aware that their eyesight i:< far
superior to his own. To proceed with this narrative,
I may say that four or live forts were built on th:
of the river opposite ihe enemy's town, and distant not
above 50 or 00 yards ; here our guns were removed,
and a fresh battery formed ready lor a bombardment,,
and fire-balls essayed to ignite the houses.
"At this time SerifF ,) after, from Singe, arrived with
about seventy men, Malays and J)yaks of I 'alow. The
river Singe being situated close to Sarebus, and inces-
sant hostilities being waged between the two places.
he, with his followers, was both more active and more
warlike than the Borneons, but their warfare consists
of closing hand to hand with spear and sword. They
scarcely understood the proper use of lire-arms, ;n\(\
were of littli' use in attacking stockades. \s :
EXPEDITION TO Ui.tRNUO. 115
tiator, however, the seriff bore a distinguished part;
and on his arrival a parley ensued, much against Ma-
cota's will, and some meetings took place between
Jaffer and a brother seriff at Siniawanj named Mok-
siiin. After ten days' delay nothing came of it, though
the enemy betrayed great desire to yield. This nego-
tiation being at an end, wo had a day's bombardment
and a fresh treaty brought about thus; Macota being
absent at Sarawak, I received a message from Seriff
.laffer and Pangeran Subtu to say that they wished to
meet me; and on my consenting, they stated that
Seriff Jaffer felt confident the war might be brought to
an end, though alone he dared not treat with the
rebels ; but in case I felt inclined to join him, we could
bring it to a favorable conclusion. I replied that our
habits of treating were veiy unlike their own, as we
allowed no delays to interpose ; but that I would unite
with him for one interview, and if that interview was
favorable, we might meet the chiefs at once and settle
it, or put an end to all further treating. Pangeran
Subtu was delighted with the proposition, urged its
great advantages, and the meeting by my desire for
that very night, the place Pangeran Illudeen's fort at
Sekundis. The evening arrived, and at dark we were
.it tlie appointed place, and a message was dispatched
for Seriff Moksain. In the mean time, however, came
a man from Pangeran Subtu to beg us to hold no inter-
course ; that the rebels were false, meant to deceive
us, and if any did come, we had better make them
prisoners. Seriff Jaffer, after arguing the point some
time, rose to depart, remarking that with such proceed-
ings he would not consent to treat. I urged him to
stay ; but finding him bent on going, I ordered my gig
(which had some time before been brought overland) to
be put into the water, my intention being to proceed to
the enemy's campong, and there hear what they had to
say. I added that it was folly to leave undone what we
had agreed to do in the morning because Pangeran
Subtu changed his mind that I had come to treat,
and treat I would. I would not go away now without
giving the enemy a fair hearing for the good of all
parlies I would do it; and if the seriff liked to join me,
116 ['EDITION TO BORNEO.
as we proposed before, and wait for Seriff Moksain,
good ; if not, I would go in the boat to the campong.
My Europeans, on being ordered, jumped up, ran out
and brought the boat to the water's edge, and in ;i lew
minutes oars, rudder, and rowlocks were in her. My
companions, seeing this, came to terms, and we waited
for Seriff Moksain ; during which, however, I overheard
a whispering conversation from Subtu's messenger, pro-
posing to seize him ; and my temper was ruffled to such
a degree that I drew out a pistol, and told him I would
shoot him dead if he dared to seize, or talk of seizing,
any man who trusted himself from the enemy to meet
me ! The scoundrel slunk off, and we were no more
troubled with him. This past, Seriff Moksain arrived,
and was introduced into our fortress alone alone and
unarmed in an enemy's stockade, manned with two hun-
dred men ! His bearing was firm ; he advanced with
ease and took his seat; and, during the interview, the
only sign of uneasiness was the quick glance of hi.s eye
from side to side. The object he aimed at was to gain
my guaranty that the lives of all the rebels should be
spared ; but this I had it not in my power to grant. He
returned to his campong, and came again toward morn-
ing, when it was agreed that Seriff Jailor and myself
should meet the Patingis and the Tumangoug, and ar-
range terms with them. By the time our conference
was over, the day broke, and we descended to the boats
to enjoy a little rest.
" On the 20th of December we met with the chiefs
on the river; and they expressed themselves ready to
yield, without conditions, to the rajah, if I would promise
that they should not bo put to death. My reply was,
that I could give no such promise; that if they surren-
dered, it must be for life or death, according to the ra-
jah's pleasure ; and all I could do was to use my influence
in order to save their lives. To this they assented after
awhile ; but then there arose the more difficult question,
how they were to be protected until the rajah's orders
arrived. They dreaded both Chinese and Main .
pecially the former, who had just cause for jingiy feel-
ings, and who, it was feared, would make an attack on
them directly their surrender had taken from them
KXrr.DITION TO BORNEO. 117
their means of defence. The Malays would not
them in a body, but would individually plunder them,
and give occasion for disputes and bloodshed. These
apprehensions were almost sufficient to l>n-;ik off the
hitherto favorable negotiations, had I not proposed to
them myself to undertake their defence, ana to become
responsible for their safety until the orders of their
sovereign arrived. On my pledging myself to this, they
yielded up their strong fort of Balidah, the key of their
position. I immediately made it known to our own
party that no boats were to ascend or descend the river,
and that any persons attacking or pillaging the rebels
were my enemies, and that I should tire upon them
without hesitation.
" Both Chinese and Malays agreed to the propriety
of the measure, and gave me the strongest assurances
of restraining then- respective followers, the former with
good faith, the latter with the intention of involving
matters, if possible, to the destruction of the rebels. By
the evening we were in possession of Balidah, and cer-
tainly found it a formidable fortress, situated on a steep
mound, with dense defences of wood, triple deep, and
surrounded by two inclosures, thickly studded on the
outside with ranjows. The effect of our fire had shaken
it completely, now much to our discomfort ; for the walls
were tottering, and the roof as leaky as a sieve. On the
20th of. December, then, the war closed. The very
next day, contrary to stipulation, the Malay Pangerans
tried to ascend the river, and when stopped began to
expostulate. After preventing many, the attempt was
made by Subtu and Pangeran Hassim, in three large
boats, boldly pulling toward us. Three hails did not
check them, and they came on in spite of a blank car-
tridge and a wide ball, to turn them back. But I was
resolved ; and when a dozen musket-balls whistled over
and fell c.ose around them, they took to an ignominious
flight. I subsequently upbraided them for this breach
of promise, and Macota loudly declared they had been
greatly to blame ; but I discovered that he himself had
set them on.
" I may now briefly conclude this detail. I ordered
the rebels to burn all their stockades, which they did at
KXIMIDITION TO NORNKU.
once, and delivered tip the greater part of their anus ;
and I proceeded to the rajah to request from him their
Jives. Those who know the Malay character will ap-
preciate the difficulty of the attempt to stand between
the monarch and his victims ; I only succeeded when,
at the end of a long debate I soliciting, he denying I
rose to bid him farewell, as it was my intention to sail
directly, since, after all my exertions in his cause, if lie
would not grant me the lives of the people, I could only
consider that his friendship for me was at an end. On this
he yielded. I must own that during the discussion he
had much the best of it ; for he urged that they had for-
feited their lives by the law, as a necessary sacrifice to
the future peace of the country ; and argued that in a
similar case in my own native land no leniency would be
shown. On the contrary, my reasoning, though per-
sonal, was, on the whole, the best for the rajah and the
people. I stated my extreme reluctance to have the
blood of conquered foes shed ; the shame I should ex-
perience in being a party, however involuntarily, to their
execution ; and the general advantage of a merciful line
of policy. At the same time I told him their lives were
forfeited, their crimes had been of a heinous and unpar-
donable nature, and it was only from so humane a man
as himself, one with so kind a heart, that I could ask
for their pardon ; but I added, he well knew that it was
only my previous knowledge of his benevolent disposi-
tion, and the great friendship I felt for him, which had
induced me to take any part in this struggle. Other
stronger reasons might have been brought forward,
which I forbore to employ, as being repugnant to his
princely pride, viz. that severity in this case would arm
many against him, raise powerful enemies in JJonieo
Proper, as well as here, and greatly impede the future
right government of the countiy. However, I gained
my point, and was satisfied.
" Having fulfilled this engagement, and being more-
over, together with many of my Europeans, attacked
with an ague, I left the scene -with all the dignity of
complete success. Subsequently, the rebels were or-
dered to deliver up all their arms, ammunition, and
property: and last, the wives and children of the prin-
. rilDlTloN 1'n iioRNiJ). 1 19
cipiil |H'o|>lt: worn (hMituiulod us hostages, and obtained.
The women and children were treated with kindness,
and preserved from injury or wrong. Siniawan thus
dwindled away ; the poorer men stole off in canoes and
were scattered about, most of thenvcoming to Sarawak.
The better class pulled down the houses, abandoned the
town, and lived in boats fora month ; when, alarmed by
the delay and impelled by hunger, they also fled Patingi
Gapoor, it was said, to Sambas ; and Patingi All and the
Tumangong among the Dyaks. After a time it was
supposed they would return and receive their wives
and children. The army gradually dispersed to seek
food, and the Chinese were left in possession of the
once-renowned Siniawan, the ruin of which they com-
pleted by burning all that remained, and erecting a vil-
lage for themselves in the immediate neighborhood.
Seriff JafFer and many others departed to their respect-
ive homes, and the pinching of famine succeeded to the
horrors of war. Fruit being in season, helped to sup-
port the wretched people, and the near approach of the
rice-harvest kept up their spirits."
CHAPTER IX.
Retrospect of Mr. Brooke's proceedings and prospects. Visit of
a pirate fleet. Intercourse with the chief leaders, and other
characteristic incidents. War dances. Use of opium. Story
of Si Tundo. Preparations for trading. Conditions of the
cession of Sarawak.
I HAVE gone into the details of this curious rebellion,
and selected from my friend's memoranda more, per-
haps, than the actual and present importance of the cir-
cumstances might seem to require ; but I have done so
under the impression that in developing the traits and
lineaments of the native character, I am laying the foun-
dation for a more accurate estimate of them and their
bearing upon futurity. The difference between the
Malay and the Chinese, between the sea and the land
Dyak, and even between one tribe and another, presents
a variety of elements out of which a consistent whole
120 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
lias to be compounded, and a new state of things to be
established in Borneo. It is, therefore, of considerable
interest to view these elements in their earliest contact
with European mind and civilization, and thence endeav-
or to shape out the course which is best calculated to
insure the welfare of all in the closer ties and more ex-
tended connection which is springing out of this new in-
tercourse. To enlarge the beneficial effects of trade and
commerce, it is not enough to ascertain the products of
a strange country, nor oven the chief wants of its pop-
ulation ; but to inform ourselves of their habits, feelings,
and disposition, and so devise the wisest measures for
supplying what is immediate, removing obstacles, and
increasing demand by a continually growing improve-
ment in government and general condition.
Following the war, and receiving the investiture of
the government of Sarawak, Mr. Brooke was enabled,
from the insight he had obtained into the diversified re-
lations and habits, motives and ways of thinking of these
people, to address himself clearly and at once to reform
the evils which oppressed, and the abuses which de-
stroyed them. Had he not mixed with them and shared
in this protracted contest, he must have begun rather as
an experimentalist with a theory which might be right
or might be wrong. But he had acquired the necessa-
ry experience, and could proceed to put his finger where
it was required to repress or to foster, without danger
of mistake. It was extraordinary what his energy pro-
duced within a small compass of time. Security suc-
ceeded the utmost uncertainty, equal justice superseded
tyrannical caprice, order arose out of confusion, and
peace was gradually spread over the fruitful soil so
lately polluted by the murderous warfare of heads-tak-
ing and imperishable feud. It is to bo hoped that such
mi example will not be lost in the further prosecution of
international and commercial policy in this interesting
and important quarter of the eastern world. Piracy
must be put down, slavery must bo effaced, industry
must be cherished and protected ; and these objects, we
shall see, from the model afforded by our truly illustri-
ous countryman, may be accomplished ; and wo may
further learn from his example, that from the oxperi-
i:\i'i:i>rnoN To BORNEO. 121
ence even of " a little war, 1 ' an enlightened observer may
deduce the most sound data on which to commence a
mighty change, loading, probably, to the happiness of mill-
ions, and the foundation of colonial empire.
With these few retrospective remarks, I resume the
sequel of my friend's Bornean Journal.
" Our subsequent adventures." he notes, " may be
easily related. We lay for some days, after winding up
tmr iii'i'airs, in order to have an agreement drawn out
between the rajah and myself, and during this time
heard the bruit of a pirate fleet being on the coast. In
a day or two after, certain news arrived of their having
taken two Sadung boats, bound from Singapore, and
Datu Pangeran was, in consequence, dispatched to com-
municate with them. He returned from Tanjong Datu,
bringing the fleet with him to the mouth of the river,
whence they requested permission to visit Sarawak, and
pay their respects to the rajah. I was consulted on
the subject whether I would meet them ; and as I pre-
ferred a pacific to a hostile rencounter, and had, moreo-
ver, a considerable curiosity to see these roving gentry, I
consented without hesitation. Reports a greater curse
in Malay countries than elsewhere stated their object
to be the capture of the Royalist, as they had, it was
averred, received positive accounts of her having fifty
lacks of dollars on board, and that her figure-head was of
solid gold. As, however, we had no such treasure, and
the meeting was unavoidable, and might be hostile, I put
myself into a complete posture of defense, with a de-
termination neither to show backwardness nor suspicion.
The day arrived, and the pirates swept up the river;
eighteen prahus, one following the other, decorated with
flags and streamers, and firing both cannon and musket-
ry ; the sight was interesting and curious, and height-
ened by the conviction that these friends of the moment
might be enemies the next. Having taken their stations,
the chief men proceeded to an interview with the rajah,
which I attended to witness. Some distrust and much
ceremony marked the meeting ; and both parties had nu-
merous followers, who filled the hall of audience and the
avenues leading to it ; and as few of the Illanuns spoke
Malay, the communication was rendered difficult and
122 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
troublesome. The pirates consisted of lllauuns and
Malukus from Gillolo. The lllanuns are fine athletic
men, with a strong resemblance in appearance to the
Bugis ; their bearing was haughty and reserved, and
they seemed quite ready to be friends or foes, as best
suited their purpose. The Malukus are from a bay in
Gillolo, and their countiy is now in possession of the
Dutch ; they are a darker and an uglier race, but their
manners more supple and pliant. They were the prin-
cipal talkers, while the lllanuns maintained a dignified
silence.
" These Malukus, from their own account, since the
capture of their rajah, and the subjugation of their coun-
try, have led a wandering, piratical life ; they represent
their force at about twenty-five boats, of which three
are now joined by the lllanuns, as a matter of mere con-
venience. Beyond the usual formalities, this meeting
had nothing to distinguish it ; one party retired to their
boats, while the other went to. their respective houses,
and eveiy thing betokened quiet. In the evening I pull-
ed through the fleet, and inspected several of the largesi
prahus. The entire force consisted of eighteen boats,
viz., three Malukus and fifteen lllanuns ; the smallest of
these boats carried thirty men, the largest (they are
mostly large) upward of a hundred; so that, at a mod-
erate computation, the number of fighting men might be
reckoned at from five to six hundred. The Illanum ex-
pedition had been absent from Magindano upward of
three years, during which time they had cruised among
the Moluccas and islands to the eastward, had haunted
JJoni Bay and Celebes, and beat up the Straits of Ma-
kassar. Many of their boats, however, being worn out,
they had fitted out Bugis prize prahus, and were now
on their return home. They had recently attacked O;M>
of the Tambelan islands, and had been repulsed ; and
report said they intended a descent upon Sirhassan, ono
of tho Southern NaUmiis group. These large prahus
:u-e too heavy to pull well, though they carry thirty,
forty, and even fifty oars : their armament is one or two
eix-pounders in the bow, one four-pounder stern-;
and a number of swivels, besides musketry, spears, and
swords. The boat is divided into three
vPEDlTION TO BORNEO. 123
tortiiied with strong planks, one behind the bow, one
amidships, and ono astern, to protect the steersman. The
\\HKifii and children are crammed down below, where
the unhappy prisoners are likewise stowed away during
an action. Their principal plan is boarding a vessel, if
possible, and carrying her by numbers ; and certainly if
a merchantman fired ill, she would inevitably be taken ;
but with grape and canister fairly directed, the slaughter
would be so great that they would be glad to sheer oft'
before they neared a vessel. This is, of coui-se, suppos-
ing a calm, for in a breeze they would never have the
hardihood to venture far from land with a ship in sight,
and would be sorry to be caught at a distance. Their
internal constitution is as follows : one chief, a man usu-
ally of rank, commands the whole fleet ; each boat has
her captain, and generally from five to ten of his rela-
tions, free men : the rest, amounting to above four fifths,
are slaves, more or Jess forced to pursue this course of
life. They have, however, the right of plunder, which
is indiscriminate with certain exceptions ; viz., slaves,
guns, money, or any other heavy articles, together with
the very finest description of silks and cloths, belonging
to the chiefs and free men ; and the rest obey the rule
of ' First come, first served.' No doubt the slaves be-
come attached to this predatory course of life ; but it
must always be remembered that they are slaves and
have no option ; and it appears to me that, in the oper-
ation of our laws, some distinction ought to be drawn on
this account, to suit the circumstances of the case. The
Datus, or chiefs, are incorrigible ; for they are pirates
by descent, robbers from pride as well as taste, and they
look upon the occupation as the most honorable hered-
itary pursuit. They are indifferent to blood, fond of
plunder, but fondest of slaves : they despise trade, though
its profits be greater ; and, as I have said, they look upon
this as their ' calling,' and the noblest occupation of
chiefs and free men. Their swords they show with
boasts, as having belonged to their ancestors who were
pirates, renowned and terrible in their day ; and they
always speak of their ancestral heir-loom as decayed
from its pristine vigor, but still deem the wielding of it
as the highest of earthly existences. That it is in real-
124 EXPEDITION T<
ity die most accursed, there can be no doubt, for its
chief support is slaves they capture on the different
coasts. If they attack an island, the women and chil-
dren, and as many of the young men as they require,
are carried off. Every boat they take furnishes its quota
of slaves ; and when they have a full cargo, they quit
that coast or country and visit another, in order to dis-
pose of their human spoil to the best advantage. Thus
a cargo of slaves, captured on the east coast of Borneo,
is sold on the west; and the slaves of the south find
ready purchasers to the northward, and vice versd. As
the woolly-haired Papuas are generally prized by the na-
tives, constant visits are made to New Guinea and the
easternmost islands, where they are procured, and af-
terward sold at high prices among any Malay communi-
ty. The great nests of piracy are Magindano, Sooloo,
and the northern part of Borneo ; and the devastation
and misery they inflict on the rest of the Archipelago
are well known ; yet are no measures adopted for their
suppression, as every European community, be it Eng-
lish, Dutch, or Spanish, seems quite satisfied to clear
the vicinity of its own ports, and never considers the
damage to the native trade which takes place at a dis-
tance. To be attacked with success, they must be at-
tacked on their own coasts with two or -three steamers.
A little money would gain every intelligence as to where
they were preparing; and while the steamers were so
worthily engaged in suppressing piracy, they might at
the same time be acquiring information respecting coun-
tries little known, and adding to our stock of geography
and science. A few severe examples and constant har-
assing would soon cure this hereditary and personal
mania for a rover's life ; and while we conferred tin-
greatest blessings on the rest of the Archipelago, Magin-
dano itself would be improved by the change.
"The Illanun Datus and the Gillolo chiefs visited
the schooner constantly, and were always considerate
enough to bring but few followers. We conversed much
upon piracy in general, their mode of life, their success-
es, and their privations. They seemed to have but few
fears of the Dutch or English men-of-war being able to
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 125
take them, and during their three years' cruise had nev-
er been chased by any of them.
" After being three or four days in company with these
worthies, i. e., the fleet of Illanuns and Malukus, the
Knyidist dropped down the river to Santobong, while
Williamson and myself stayed yet a few days with Muda
Hassim in his house. We had a week's incessant tor-
rent of rain. Nothing could exceed the kindness of the
rajah during our stay, with his brothers, of all ages, as
our constant companions. We had one day a dance of
the Illanuns and Gillolos : they might both be called war-
dances, but are very different. The performer with the
llliimms is decked out with a. fine helmet (probably bor-
rowed from our early voyagers), ornamented with bird-
of- paradise feathers. Two gold belts, crossed, like our
soldiers', over the breast, are bound at the waist with a
fantastical garment reaching half way down the thigh,
and composed of various-colored silk and woolen threads
one above another. The sword, or 'kempilan,' is dec-
orated at the handle with a yard or two of red cloth,
und the long upright shield is covered with small rings,
which clash as the performer goes through his evolutions.
The dance itself consists of a variety of violent warlike
gestures, stamping, striking, advancing, retreating, turn-
ing, falling, yelling, with here and there bold stops, and
excellent as to aplomb, which might have elicited the ap-
plause of the opera-house ; but, generally speaking, the
performance was outrageously fierce, and so far natural
as approaching to an actual combat ; and in half an hour
the dancer, a fine young man, was so exhausted that he
fell, fainting, into the arms of his comrades. Several
others succeeded, but not equal to the first; and we had
hardly a fair opportunity of judging of the Maluku dance
from its short continuance ; but it is of a more gentle na
ture, advancing with the spear stealthily, casting it, then
retreating with the sword and shield. The Maluku
shield, it should be observed, is remarkably narrow, and
is brandished somewhat in the same way as the single
stick-player uses his stick, or the Irishman his shillelah,
that is to say, it is held nearly in the center, and whirled
every way round. I procured some of the instruments,
and found that the sword of the Malukus of Gillolo is
L2
126 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
similar to that of the Moskokas of Boni Bay, in Celebes.
All these pirates are addicted to the excessive use of
opium ; but the effects of it are by no means so delete-
rious or so strongly marked as has been represented ;
and it must likewise be remembered that they are in
other respects dissolute and debauched. Among the
Chinese it would be difficult nay, impossible to de-
tect the smokers of the drug. Here and there you may
see an emaciated man ; but, out of a body of five hun-
dred, some are usually emaciated and unhealthy. I do
not mean to deny the bad effects of opium ; but the sto-
ries of its pernicious results are greatly exaggerated
where the habit exists in moderation. The Chinese
themselves, when I spoke to them of the' bad consequen-
ces, always argued that, taken moderately, it was a stim-
ulus to industry and activity ; but they allowed, at the
same time, that excess was highly injurious.
" The time at length came for my departure, but I
was pressed to stay one day after another, for our soci-
ety was a relief to the usual monotonous tenor of their
lives. The papers were signed which made me Resi-
dent oi Sarawak. I started to Santobong, and reach-
ed the vessel on the 13th of February ; and sifter wait-
ing two days, in the vain hope of a lull or change of wind,
we beat out of the channel."
Mr. Brooke did not remain long at Singapore. His
principal object was to procure a vessel to trade between
that place and Sarawak. Trading, however, was not
his forte ; but he already felt the deepest interest in the
welfare of those people. By accident or, more prop-
erly, by Providence he appears to have been sent to
put a stop to an unnatural war, and to save the lives of
the unfortunate rebels ; and the benefit he had conferred
on so many of his fellow-creatures, the good he had al-
ready done, and the infinity of good which he saw ho
still might do, made him anxious to return.
After some difficulty, he succeeded in purchasing a
schooner of 90 tons, called the Swift, which I recollect-
ed in the, Malacca St rails as the Zephyr, then a cruiser
in the East India Company's service. Having put ;
suitable cargo into her, lie sailed with his Mjuiidron (Roy-
alist and Swift) for Sarawak early in \pril, i
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 127
The rajah, already described as an indolent, weak-
minded man, had promised Mr. Brooke the government
of the country ; but, among other obstacles with which
he would have to contend in accepting it, I do not think
my friend calculated on jealousy, low cunning, and
treachery, or the dangerous enemy he had made in
Pangerau Macota. He had been an eye-witness to his
cowardice, and had more than once detected and expos-
ed his cunning and trickery ; sins not to be forgiven, es-
pecially by a Malay. Notwithstanding this, firmness,
courage, and straightforward honesty gained the victory,
as the sequel will show.
Among the characters with whom Mr. Brooke got
acquainted during the rebel war was a young chief
named Si Tundo, who was constantly by his side when-
ever there was danger. He was an Illanun, and had
been sent from Sadung, with some thirteen of his coun-
trymen, by Seriff Sahib, to offer his services to Maco-
ta, commander-in-chief of the rajah's forces ; and I re-
sume Mr. Brooke's memoranda, with the following in-
teresting account of this poor fellow's fate : " On rny
arrival at Sarawak, we were received with the usual
honors ; and the first thing I heard of was the decease
of my poor companion, Si Tundo of Magindano, who
had been put to death by the rajah's orders. The
course of justice, or, rather, injustice, or perhaps, more
justly, a mixture of both, is so characteristic of the peo-
ple, that I am tempted to give the particulars. Si Tun-
do fell in love with a woman belonging to an adopted
son of Macota, and the passion being mutual, the lady
eloped from her master and went to her lover's house.
This being discovered in a short time, he was ordered
to surrender her to Macota, which he reluctantly did,
on an understanding that he was to be allowed to marry
her on giving a proper dowry. Either not being able to
procure the money, or the terms not being kept, Si Tun-
do and a relation (who had left the pirate fleet and resided
with him) mounted to Macota's hill, and threatened to
take the woman and to bum the house. The village,
however, being roused, they were unable to effect their
purpose, and retired to their own residence. Here they
remained for sonifi days in n state of incessant '
128 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
ness ; and when they moved, they each carried their
kempilan, and wore the krisses ready to the hand. The
Rajah Muda Hassira, being well aware of the state of
things, sent, at this crisis, to order Si Tundo and his
friend to his presence ; which order they obeyed forth-
with, and entered the balei, or audience-hall, which was
full of their enemies. According to Muda Hassim's ac-
count, he was anxious to save Si Tundo's life, and offer-
ed him another wife ; but, his affections being fixed on
the girl of his own choice, he rejected the offer, only
praying he might have the woman he loved. On enter-
ing the presence of the rajah, surrounded by foes, and
dreading treachei*y (which most probably was intended),
these unfortunate men added to their previous fault by
one which, however slight in European estimation, is
here of an aggravated nature they entered the pres-
ence with their kempilans in their hands, and their sa-
rongs clear of the kris-handle ; and instead of seating
themselves cross-legged, they only squatted on their
hams, ready for self-defense. From that hour their
doom was resolved on : the crime of disrespect was
deemed worthy of death, though their previous crime
of abduction and violence might have obtained pardon.
It was no easy matter, however, among an abject and
timid population, to find executioners of the sentence
against two brave and warlike men, well armed and
watchful, and who, it was well known, would sell their
lives dearly; and the subsequent proceeding is, as al-
ready observed, curiously characteristic of the people,
and the deep disguise they can assume to attain their
purposes. It was intimated to Si Tundo that, if he
could raise a certain sum of money, the woman should
be made over to him ; and to render this the more prob-
able, the affair was taken out of Macota's hands, and
placed at the decision of the Orang Kay a de Gadong,
who was friendly to the offenders, but who received his
private orders how to act. Four men were appointed to
watch their opportunity, in order to soi/.n tlu> culprits.
It is not to be imagined, however, that a native would
trust or believe the friendly assurances held out to him ;
nor was it so in the case of Si Tundo and his compan-
ion : they ahr.-iiU'i! at flin < )rnn Kayo dp (.';:
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 129
bouse frequently for weeks, with the same precautions,
and it was found impossible to overpower them ; but the
deceit of their enemies was equal to the occasion, and
delay brought no change of purpose. They were to
die, and opportunity alone was wanting to carry the
sentence into effect. Time passed over, suspicion was
lulled; and as suspicion was lulled the professions to
serve them became more frequent. Poor Si Tundo
brought all his little property to make good the price
required for the woman, and his friend added his share ;
but it was still far short of the required amount. Hopes,
however, were still held out ; the Orang Kaya advanced
a small sum to assist, and other pretended friends, slow-
ly and reluctantly, at his request, lent a little money.
The negotiation was nearly complete ; forty or fifty
reals only were wanting, and the opposite party were
ready to deliver the lady whenever the sum was made
good. A final conference was appointed for the conclu-
sion of the bargain at the Orang Kaya's, at which num-
bers were present ; and the devoted victims, lulled into
fatal security, had ceased to bring their formidable kern-
pilans. At the last interview, the forty reals being still
deficient, the Orang Kaya proposed receiving their gold-
mounted krisses in pledge for the amount. The krisses
Were given up, and the bargain was complete, when the
four executioners threw themselves on the unarmed
men, and, assisted by othez-s, overpowered and secured
them. Si Tundo, wounded in the scuffle, and bound,
surrounded by enemies flourishing their krisses, remark-
ed, ' You have taken me by treachery ; openly you
^Md not have seized me.' He spoke no more. They
triumphed over and insulted him, as though some great
feat had been achieved, and every kris was plunged into
his body, which was afterward cast, without burial, into
the river. Si Tundo's relation was spared on pleading
for mercy; and after his whole property, even to his
clothes, was confiscated, he was allowed to retire to Sa-
dung. Thus perished poor Si Tundo, a Magindano pi-
rate, with many, if not all, the vices of the native char-
acter, but with boldness, courage, and constancy, which
retrieved his faults, and raised him in the estimation of
brave men. In person he was tall, elegantly made, with
9
130 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
small and handsome features, and quiet and graceful
manners ; but toward the Malays, even of rank, there
was in his bearing a suppressed contempt, which they
often felt, but could not well resent. Alas ! my gallant
comrade, I mourn your death, and could have- better
spared a better man ; for as long as you lived, I had
one faithful follower of tried courage among the natives.
Peace be with you in the world to come, and may the
great God pardon your sins and judge you mercifully !
" The case of poor Si Tundo proves that the feeling
of love is not quite dead among Asiatics, though its power
is obscured by their education and habits of polygamy ;
and that friendship and relationship may induce a man
here, as elsewhere, to risk his life and sacrifice his prop-
erty without any prospect of personal advantage. An old
Magindano man, a sort of foster-father of Si Tundo's,
when he saw me for the first time, clasped my arm, and
repeatedly exclaimed, ' Si Tundo is dead ; they have killed
him;' adding, 'had you been here, he would not have
been killed.' I was touched by the old man's sorrow,
and his expression of feeling."
Datu Jembrong was likewise an lllanum, and retired
to Sadung when the rebel war had closed, and died tit-
ter a few days' illness. Mr. Brooke writes : " Thus if
have lost the two bravest men men whom I would rath-
er trust for fair dealing than any score of Borneons ; for
the Magindanos, though pirates by descent and education,
are a far superior people to any in the Archipelago, with
the exception of the Bugis. Whatever may be their
vices, they are retrieved by courage to a, certain degree^
and when- we find a manly character, we may presume
that the meaner arts of_////rw and treachery are less
prevalent. Dumpier and Forivst both give them an <:\
cellent character; ur.d it is ;i pity that m late years liltlr.
is known o them, and so little pains taken to hold a
friendly intercourse either with them or the Sooloos."
The important changes which ensued on the rerun
of Mr. Brooke to Sarawak, in the spring of 1841, now
demand attention ; and, as heretofore, I proceed to de-
scribe them from the data intrusted to my charge.
"In a former part of my journal." s;ivs i\1r. IJrookn,
" I have mentioned brirflv (In- dccH^mn which l<"!
EXPEDITION TO 13ORM-. 131
invitation, and the reasons which induced me to accept
the offer of the Rajah Muda Hassim ; but 1 will repeat
these, in order to bring the narrative at once more dis-
tinctly before the memory. When I returned here foi
the second time, in August of last year, it was with the
determination of remaining for a few days only on my
way to the northward ; and nothing but my feeling for
the miserable situation of Muda Hassim induced mo lo
alter my intention. The rebellion, which he had come
from Borneo to quell, had defied eveiy effort for nearly
four years ; and the attacks he had made on the rebels
had failed entirely and almost disgracefully. His imme-
diate followers were few in number, and aid from the
neighboring countries was either denied, or withheld on
trivial excuses ; while the opposition of Pangeran Usop
in Borneo paralyzed the efforts of his supporters in the
capital, and, in case of non-success, threatened his own
power. The pride, the petty pride of the Malay prince
bent before these circumstances, and induced him to
'state his difficulties to me, and to request my assistance.
His failure was strongly dwelt on, and his resolution to
die here rather than abandon his undertaking to die
disgraced and deserted ! Under these circumstances,
could I, he urged upon me, forsake him ? could I, ' a
gentleman from England,' who had been his friend, arid
knew the goodness of his heart, could I leave him sur-
rounded and begirt with enemies ? It was possibly fool-
ish, it was perhaps imprudent, but it accorded with my
best feelings ; and I resolved not to abandon him without
at any rate seeing the probabilities of success ; and it
must always be remembered that, in doing so, I had no
ulterior object, no prospect of any personal advantage.
1 joined his miserable army, which, in numbers, barely
exceeded that of the rebels, strongly stockaded. I joined
them at the outset of their campaign ; and in a few days
(ten days) witnessed such scenes of cowardice, treach-
ery, intrigue, and lukewarmness among his followers,
such a determination not to take advice or to pursue any
active measures, that I left them and returned to my
vessel. The Chinese I do not include in this represent-
ation ; they were true and willing, but wretchedly
armed, and very justly refused to be thrust forward into
182 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
posts of danger, which the Malays in their own country
would not share. On my return to the vessel, 1 frankly
stated how useless my presence was among men who
would not do any thing I desired, yet would do nothing
for themselves ; and, under the circumstances, I intima-
ted my intention of sailing. Here, again, I was pressed
'with the same entreaties ; every topic was exhausted to
excite my compassion, every aid was at my disposal ;
and lastly, if I would stay, and we were successful, the
country was offered to me. The only inquiry was,
whether the raj all had the right and authority to make
over the country to me, and this I was assured he had.
The government, the revenue (with slight deductions for
the sultan), and one of his brothers to reside here in or-
der to insure the obedience of the Malays, were all com-
prehended in this cession, freely and without condition.
I might, at this point of the negotiation, have insured the
title to the government as far as a written agreement
could give it ; but for two sufficient reasons 1 declined
all treaty upon the subject until the war was over. The
first of these reasons was, that it would have been high-
ly ungenerous to take advantage of a man's distress to tie
him down to any agreement which, in other circum-
stances, he might not be willing to adopt; and by acting
thus ungenerously, it would be tempting the rajah to
deceive me when the treaty came to be ratified. The
second reason was equally cogent ; for a mere barren
bond, which I had no means to enforce, was worse than
useless, and no man would be nearer possession by mere-
ly holding a written promise. I may add, likewise, that
1 saw so many difficulties in the way of the undertaking,
that I was by no means over-anxious to close with it ;
and, previously to accepting and entering on so bold a proj-
ect, i was desirous thoroughly to be assured of the good
faith of the promisor. To the Rajah Muda Hassim's
proposal 1, therefore, replied, that I could not accept it
while the Wiir was ponding, as I considered it wrong to
take any advantage of his present situation ; and that, if
he conferred authority on me in the camp, I would once
more go up the river and nssisthiiu to the utmost of my
power. It is needless to repent any details of the war,
except to say that I found every support from him, and
'l' HORNEO. 133
the highest consideration, both in personal attentions and
the bestowal of influence. He conquered, I may say
without self-praise, through my means ; and on the close
of hostilities our negotiation about the country was re-
vived. In its progress I stated to him that Malay gov-
ernments were so bad, that the high were allowed so
much license, and the poor so oppressed, that any at-
tempt to govern without a change of these abuses was
impossible ; and as a foundation of my acceptance was
the proposition, that all his exertions must be employed
to establish the principle that one man was not to take
any thing from another, and that all men were to enjoy
the produce of their labor, save and except at such times
as they were engaged in working for the revenue. That
the amount of the revenue was to be fixed and certain
for three years, at a stated quantity of rice per family ;
in lieu of which, should a man prefer it, he might pay in
money or in labor : the relative price of rice to money or
labor being previously fixed at as low a rate as possible.
That the officers, viz., Patingi, Bandar, and Tumangong,
were to receive stated salaries out of this revenue, in order
to prevent any extortion, either by themselves or in their
name ; and that they were to be answerable for the
whole revenue under my superintendence. That the
Dyaks were to be treated the same as the Malays, their
property protected, their taxes fixed, and their labor free.
At the same time, I represented to him the difficulty of
doing this, and that nothing but his power could effect
it ; as any foreigner, without his unlimited support and
confidence, would have no chance of finding obedience
from the numerous inferior Pangerans and their follow-
ers. This, with much more, was the theme of my con-
versation ; to which was replied, imprimis, That their
customs and religion must not be infringed. That with
regard to the violence and rapacity of the higher classes,
and the uncertainty of taxation, which led to so much
oppression, they were by no means any part of the On-
dong Ondong, i. e., the written law of Borneo, but gross
abuses which had arisen out of lax government. That
it was the wish of his heart to see these things mended ;
and that nothing should be wanting on his part to assist
me in accomplishing objects so desirable, particularly
M
134 K.\ I'KDITloX TO l!iK:N :
with respect to the Dyaks, who were so grossly abused.
On this, a written agreement was made out, merely to
the purport that I was to reside at Sarawak in order to
4 seek for profit ;' and on my remarking that this paper
expressed nothing, he said I must not think that it was
the one understood between us, but merely for him to
show to the sultan at Borneo in the first place. I ac-
cepted this version of the story, though it looked suspi-
cious ; and on my part, over and above our written agree-
ment, which expressed nothing, I consented to buy a
vessel, and bring down trade to the place, in return for
which I was assured of antimony ore in plenty ; and
though I knew that profit was not to be expected, I was
desirous to comply, as, without a vessel regularly trading
here, it would be impossible to develop the resources of
the country. While I went to Singapore, the rajah
promised to build me a house, in which I was to take up
my residence. I sailed accordingly, and returned with-
in three months, having performed all my engagements ;
but on reaching Sarawak, the first disappointment 1 ex-
perienced was, that the house was not commenced. I
urged them to begin it, and after the most provoking de-
lays at length got it finished. I mention this because it
was the only instance in which good faith was kept.
" August 3d. -The two schooners, Royalist and Swift,
having arrived at Sarawak, I found myself with a heavy
monthly expense, and was naturally anxious to dispatch
them as speedily as possible. I was assured that GOOO
peculs of antimony ore would be down immediately, and
that whenever the people were set to work, any quantity
might be procured without difficulty ; which, indeed, I
knew to be true, as Macotah had loaded a ship, a brig, and
three native vessels in six weeks. The procrastination,
therefore, was the more provoking ; but as I had deter-
mined to arm myself with patience, and did- not antici-
pate foul play, I was content to wait for a time. The
Swift being leaky and requiring repairs, was another in-
ducement to me to lie by and land her cargo, which,
ever since my arrival, the rajah petitioned to have
ashore, giving every pledge for a quick and good return.
At length I consented to let him have tlie cargo into his
own hands, on the assurance that the antimony ore" (?, r.,
i:\fHlHTluN Tn iluKM.'-. 135
di GOOO peculs which were ready '/) " should bo brought
down directly. Nothing could be more correct than the
way they received the cargo, taking an account of each
separate article, comparing it with the invoice, and noting
down the deficiency ; and the rajah himself superintend-
ed this interesting process from morning till dark. At
-this time, having agreed with him for the whole, as the
easiest and best mode of dealing under the circumstances,
I did not much trouble myself about the deposit ; and
any attention was first roused by the extreme apathy of
the whole party directly the cargo was in their possession
overhauled, reckoned, and disposed of among them."
CHAPTER X.
Obstacles in the way of coming to a satisfactory conclusion with
Muda Hassim. The law offeree and reprisal -considered.
Capabilities of Sarawak. Account of Sarebus and Sakarran
pirates. Excursion up the river. Visit to the Singe Dyaks.
Description of Mr. Brooke's house at Sarawak. Circum-
stances relating to the wreck off Borneo Proper.
DURING the succeeding pages of any friend's journal,
one hardly knows which to admire most ; his firmness,
his cool courage, his determined perseverance, or his
patience. On the other hand, it is difficult to decide
whether the rajah's indolence and ingratitude, or Ma-
cota's low cunning and treachery are the more disgust-
ing. But I continue the narrative, and readers will
judge for themselves.
"Yet," says Mr. Brooke, "I had confidence, and
was loth to allow any base suspicion to enter my mind
against a man who had hitherto behaved well to me,
.and had not deceived me before. From the time the
-cargo had been disposed of, I found myself positively
laid on the shelf. No return arrived ; no steps were
taken to work the antimony ore ; no account appeared
of the positive amount to be received : a promise was
tendered ; and all my propositions nay, my veiy de-
.ire to speak of the state of the country were evaded.
l found myself clipped like Samson, while delay was
heaped upon delay, excuse piled on excuse, and all cov-
Lit) EX
ered with the utmost show of kindness and civility. It
was provoking beyond sufferance ; but with several
strokes which I considered important, I bore it with
saint-like patience. I remonstrated mildly but finnly
on the waste of my money, and on the impossibility of
any good to the country while the rajah conducteded
himself as he had done. I urged upon him to release
the poor women whom he had kept confined for nearly
five months ; and I guarantied the peaceful disposition
of the people if it were done. I might as well have
whistled to the winds, or have talked reason to stones.
I was overwhelmed with professions of affection
and kindness, but nothing ensued. I had trusted
my eyes gradually opened I feared I was betrayed
and robbed, and had at length determined to be obser-
vant and watchful, when an event occurred which fin-
ished the delusion, and woke me fully to the treachery,,
or at any rate the Weakness, at work against me. My
house was finished, and 1 had just taken possession of
it, when I understood that an overwhelming body of
Dyaks, accompanied by Malays, were proceeding up*
the river, with the avowed purpose of attacking a hostile
tribe, but with the real design of slaughtering all the
weak tribes in their way. Upward of 100 boats, with
certainly not fewer than 2500 men, had been at Sarawak
a week, asking permission for this expedition; and I was
informed there was not the slightest chance of its being
granted, when to my surprise I saw the expedition start.
"On being convinced that they really were going up
the country, I instantly quitted the house and returned
on board the Royalist, sending to know whether the
rajah had granted leave for their entrance into the
interior. By him the whole blame of the transaction
was thrown upon Macota and the Orang Kaya de
Gadong ; and he himself was said to be so ill that he
could not be seen ; but it was added, as I disliked the
measure so greatly, the same parties who had sent lh<
Dyaks up could recall them down, which indeed I had
insisted on being done. They accordingly retrograded
and left; after which I continued sulky on board and
the rajah, shamming sick, sulked in his harem. That
any man beside the rajah UiraseU' would have beea
i:\PEDITION TO BORNEO. 137
bold enough to grant the permission, I knew, from ex-
perience, was impossible. I accepted his denial as tho
groundwork of a reconciliation. In the mean time, as
he continued indisposed, I intimated my intention of
proceeding to Borneo in three days, and dispatching
the Swift at the same time to proceed to Singapore ;
part of her cargo, 750 peculs of antimony ore, having
been at length put on board. On this being made known
to the rajah, he forgot his sickness, and came out and
proffered me a meeting to discuss affairs, which I post-
poned until the following day. In the mean time I took
a candid view of my position, and considered the best
means of extricating myself from my difficulties with as
little trouble and inconvenience as possible to either party.
" I had lost much valuable time, spent much money,
and risked my life. and the lives of my crew, in order to
render assistance to Rajah Muda Hassim in his distress ;
in return for which he had voluntarily offered me the
country. The conditions of my acceptance had been
discussed and mutually understood, and I had, in fulfill-
ment of my part, brought vessel and cargo. Profit I did
not much care about ; the development of the country
was my chief, I may say my only, aim ; and on my ar-
rival I had been delayed and cheated by false promises,
which showed too plainly that he neither meant to ad-
here to his former agreement, nor to pay for what he
had on false pretences obtained. It may appear to many
that no measures ought to be kept with one who had so
behaved ; but for the following reasons I resolved still to
wait his pleasure. In the first place, it was barely pos-
sible that indolence, and not treachery, might have actu-
ated him ; and in the next place, if it was possible to ar-
range so as to get back the amount of the Swift's cargo,
I was in duty and justice bound to use every endeavor
before resorting to measures of force. As for the ces-
sion of the country, and all the good which must have
resulted from it, I put these considerations altogether
out of the question. I had been deceived and betrayed,
and had met with the grossest ingratitude ; but I had no
claim, nor would any written agreement have given me
one ; and I was therefore constrained to submit without
returning evil for evil. Every point weighed, I felt,
M 2
138 KXPKblTluN TO BORNEO.
from every motive, inclined, nay desirous, to avoid a rup-
ture, or taking an equivalent for my property by force.
The Swift, with the part of her cargo received on board,
after three months' detention, and no more even talked
of, I therefore resolved, as already stated, to dispatch to
Singapore. My first intention on arriving here had been
to send the Royalist back to that port and dispose of her ;
but a native rumor being afloat that the crew of a ship-
wrecked vessel were in Borneo Proper, I deemed it in-
cumbent on me to visit that place and effect their release.
I had used every means in my power since my arrival
to induce the Rajah Muda Hassim to send one or two
of his Pangerans and a letter from himself to the sultan
by the Royalist, in order to insure that object; but al-
though, day by day, I had received promises, they were
never performed. Seeing now that this duty of human-
ity could no longer be delayed with propriety, 1 resolved
to dispatch the Royalist to Borneo, and myself to remain
here, to endeavor, if I could, to obtain my own. Each
vessel was to return as quickly as possible from her place
of destination ; and I then resolved to give two additional
months to the rajah, and to urge him in every way in
my power to do what he was bound to do as an act of
common honesty. Should these means fail, after making
the strongest representations and giving amplest time,
I considered myself free to extort by force what I could
not gain by fair means.
" Having determined on these steps, I met the rajah
by appointment, and repeated all rny grievances, and set
strongly before him the injury done in consequence ;
and lastly, plainly told him that I only came and now
only stayed in his country at his request, but that the
property he had taken must be repaid, and subsequently
to that, if he had any proposition to make, I would en-
deavor to meet his wishes. To all this I received no
one satisfactory (/naive.!; and, from the shuffling on every
complaint, I formed the worst opinion of his intentions.
" My determination, however, having been previously
made, the result of this conversation had no effect upon
me; and at the end oftliree days, the time I had limit-
ed, no letter for the sultan being forthcoming, on the
fourth morning the two schooners proceeded to sen., one
t.\!M.l>IT!0\ TO BOi 189
ibr Borneo, the other for Singapore, while, with three
companions, I remained in my new house.*
" I wish now to discuss a question which has often
occupied my mind, and upon which I have been very
desirous to arrive at a right conclusion. It is certain
that a British subject cannot wrongfully attack or injure
any prince or person in his own country without render-
ing himself liable to be punished by the laws of Eng-
land. It is both right and just that it should be so, be-
cause in demi-civilized or savage countries the natives
are often unable to protect themselves, and an attack
upon them savors of piracy. On the other hand, if the
native prince be the party to blame ; if he fraudulently
possess himself of property under 'false pretences, make
promises which he breaks, and enter into agreements
before witnesses which he never intends to fulfill ; then,
I ask, is a British subject to submit to the loss, when the
party defrauding him is able to pay and will not ? I
answer decidedly, he is not bound to submit to be cheat-
ed, and, if he have the means, he has the right to en-
force repayment. It may be urged that trust ought not
to be reposed ; but trust is the ordinary course of trade,
and cannot alter the question. Again, it may be said,
Apply to the government ; but it is well known and ac-
knowledged that the government will not interfere in any
case of the sort. Seek redress by law ! there is no law
to meet the contingency. Bear the loss, i. e. be betray-
ed, deceived, and cheated, and submit ! It cannot be ;
for although the law may properly inquire into the cir-
cumstances, yet as it will not protect me here, or give
me any redress for fraud or murder, it cannot punish,
if right be on my side. Am I quite sure that the right
* I need hardly remark on the singular courage and disregard
of personal safety and life itself evinced by my friend on this oc-
casion. At issue with the rajah on points of great temptation to
him, beset by intrigues, and surrounded by a fierce and lawless
people, Mr. Brooke did not hesitate to dispatch his vessels and
protectors, the one on a mission of pure humanity, and the other
in calm pursuance of the objects he had proposed to himself to
accomplish ; and with " three companions," place himself at the
mercy of such circumstances; regardless of the danger, and rely-
ing on the overruling Providence in which he trusted, to bring him
safely through all his difficulties and perils. H. K.
140 i:X I'l'DlTloX TO 1!OK\KO.
is on my side ? It is, as far us I can judge ; and having
candidly stated eveiy fact and circumstance, I am con-
vinced there can be but one opinion on the subject. I
am sure that if I seize property to the amount of that
taken from me, I act justly, though perhaps not legally ;
yet I firmly believe legally likewise, although law and
justice do not necessarily go always hand in hand. On
the whole, there was the old sore rankling the false
promises, the gross deceit, the base ingratitude to a man
who had done everything to relieve this equivocating
rajah from disgrace, defeat, and perhaps death. But
here I close this account for the present, to be resumed
on the return of the Royalist from Borneo.
" August 4th. Both retrospectively and prospectively
the grounds for all these transactions were ever pressing
on my mind and guiding my actions. The capabilities
of the Sarawak countiy were very great. It could
abundantly supply the richest produce of the vegetable
kingdom ; it abounded in mineral wealth, and especially
in avast staple commodity of antimony ore ; with a con-
siderable population of Dyaks, whose condition was de-
cidedly improvable; a Malay population, by no means
large, which was advantageous ; and a Chinese popula-
tion ready to immigrate with even a moderate prospect
of protection. Beside these inducements, must be added
its propinquity to the Pontiana river, and the trade
which by that route might flow even from the center of
this little-known island. To crown all, there were the
credit to myself in case of success, the amelioration of
the native condition, however partial, and the benefit to
commerce in general. These were the reasons that
induced me to enter on this arduous task ; and to these
I may add a supplementary one, viz., that when I had
struggled for a time, I might rouse the zeal of others,
and find efficient support either from government or the
mercantile body.
" I have in a former part of my journal mentioned the
Illanun pirates, and my meeting with them here. < >>
our return we heard of their being still on the coast, mid
from that time to this they have been ravaging and plun-
dering between Tanjong Datu, Sirliassun. and j'ontiana.
Malays and Chinese have horn carried off in groat num-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 141
bers ; Borneo and Sambas prahus captured without end ;
and so much havoc committed, that the whole coast, as
far as the natives are concerned, may be pronounced in
a state of blockade.
"Beside the Illanuns, there are two other descrip-
tions of pirates infesting these seas : one, the Dyaks of
Sakarran and Sarebus, two predatory tribes already
mentioned ; the other called Balagnini, a wild people
represented to come from the northward of Sooloo. I
have not seen them ; but their boats are said to be very
long and swift, with sometimes outriggers ; and one par-
ticular in their mode of attack is too curious to omit. In
closing on their victims they use long poles, having a
hook made fast at the extremity, with which, being ex-
pert, they hook their opponents at a distance and drag
them overboard, while others are fighting with saligis
and spears.
" I have before mentioned the arrival of one hundred
Dyak boats at Sarawak, to request permission from the
rajah to ascend the river and attack a tribe toward Sam-
bas. What a tale of rmsgovernment, tyranny, and weak-
ness, does this request tell ! These Dyaks were chiefly
from Sakarran, mixed with the Sarebus, and with them
three boats of the Malo tribe, whose residence is toward
the Pontiana river. The Sakarrans are the most pow-
erful, the most predatory, and the most independent
tribe on the N.W. coast, their dependence on Borneo
being merely nominal. The latter are likewise preda-
tory and numerous, but they are on good terms with
all the coast tribes and with the Malays, while the Sa-
rebus are against all, and all are against them. Speak-
ing generally, they are a remarkably fine body of people,
handsome, intelligent, powerful, well-made, beautifully-
limbed, and clear-skinned. They are somewhat fairer
than the Malays and the mountain Dyaks ; but in man-
ners, customs, and language, exactly resemble the Sib-
nowans, except that the last, from misfortune, have be-
come a peaceful tribe. The Sarebus and Sakarrans are
only distinguishable by the numerous rings they wear in
their ears. On one man I counted fourteen of brass,
various sizes, in one ear only. They are rajher fond of
ornament, and wear grotesque caps of various-colored
142 EXPEDITION TO UORNEO.
cloths (particularly red), some of them square, others
peaked, and others like a cocked hat worn athwart-ships,
and terminating in sharp points on the top of the head.
These head-dresses are ornamented with tufts of red
hair or black human hair, shreds of cloth, and sometimes
feathers ; but what renders them laughable to look at
is, that the hair is cut close to match the shape of the
cap ; so that when a man displaces it, you find him bare
of hair about the forehead and posterior part of the skull,
that over the ears cut into points, and the rest of the
skull showing a good crop of black bristles.
" The commanders of this party were yclept poeti-
cally by their own people, as noms de guerre, the Sun
and the Moon, i. e., Bulan, for moon, and Matari for
sun. The Sun was as fine a young man as the eye
would wish to rest upon ; straight, elegantly yet strongly
made, with a chest and neck, and head set on them,
which might serve Apollo ; legs far better than his of
Belvidere ; and a countenance mild and intelligent. J
became very good friends with both Sun and Moon, and
gave them a great deal of good advice about piracy,
which, of course, was thrown away.
" Their boats are built very long, raised at the stern,
and the largest pulling as many as sixty paddles ; but I
should not think them fast, and any boat with a swivel
might cut them up. The least average I could give the
hundred boats is twenty-five men per boat, making, as
already observed, 2500 in all. We counted ninety, and
there were others down the reach we could not see ;
and they themselves stated their force to be 140 boats
and 4000 men. The manners of these Pyaks toward
us were reserved, quiet, and independent. They stole
nothing, and in trading for small quantities of rice, bees-
wax, cotton, and their cloths, showed a full knowledge
of the relative value of the articles, or rather they priced
their own at far above their proper worth. I may indeed
say of all the Dyaks I have seen, that they are anxious
to receive, but very loth to give ; and when they have
obtained cloth, salt, copper, beads, &c. to the amount of
two or three dollars as a present, will bring in a bunch
of plantains or a little rice, and ask you in h//i/. The
Sibnowans are the chief exceptions lo this, and they are
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 143
my pet tribe. The language of Sakarran and Sarebus
is the same as the Sibnowan ; and with all the word
God, the Allah Talla of the Malays, is expressed by
Battara, from which we may infer that their notion of
the Deity, as probably was all the religion of these
regions, was derived from the Hindoos.
44 When this force of Dyaks was, contrary to the as-
surance given to me, sweeping up the river, I had just
finished a late dinner. I was angry enough,and resolved
instanter to leave the house, when who should come in,
as if by pure accident, but Pangeran Budrudeen, the
rajah's brother. I controlled myself, spoke strongly
withal but civilly, and sent him away wishing he had
not come near me; and the boat being ready, I retired
from the house to the Royalist. Their immediate recall
was the consequence ; for the rajah having denied his
permission, those who fathered the act dared not per-
sist in it when I told them it was an act of disobedience.
They tried to frighten me with the idea that the Dyaks
would attack us ; but as I felt sure we could blow them
away in ten minutes, it had not the desired effect. They
had in the mean time reached Leda Tanah, whence
they were brought down again sulky enough, and did
show a slight inclination to see whether the people on
board the Swift were keeping watch : for several of
their boats dropped close to her, and one directly under
the bowsprit, as silently as death ; but on being chal-
lenged, and a musket leveled near them, they sheered
off, and the next day finally departed. The poor Dyaks
in the interior, as well as the Chinese, were in the
greatest state of alarm, and thence I gained some credit
among them for my interference on their behalf. The
very idea of letting 2500 wild devils loose in the interior
of the country is horrible ; for though they have one
professed object, they combine many others with it,
and being enemies of all the mountain tribes, they cut
them up as much as they can. What object, it maybe
inquired, can the Malays have in destroying their own
country and people so wantonly? I must endeavor to
explain, to the best of my belief and knowledge. The
Malays take part in these excursions, and thirty men
joined the Sakarrans on the present occasion, and con-
144 DiTiuN TO BORNEO.
sequently they share in the plunder, and share largely.
Probably Muda Hassim would have got twenty shares
(women and children) ; and these twenty being reck-
oned at the low rate of twenty reals each, makes four
hundred reals, beside other plunder, amounting to one
or two hundred reals more. Inferior Pangerans would
of course partake likewise. Muda Hassim must have
given his consent, must have been a participator in this
atrocity, nobody being desperate enough to do such a
thing without his orders. In fact, they dare not move
up the river themselves without leave, much less send
up the Dyaks. It is a hateful feature in this govern-
ment, newly developed since the close of the w;ir.
"August 5th. One excursion I made up the river
over our old ground, staying a week, visiting various
places. Where the village of Siniawan once stood is
now a small Chinese settlement, and their garden be-
speaks the fertility of the soil. From Siniawan I walked
over to Tundong, now the principal Chinese station.
The scenery was beautiful all the way from Siniawan
to Tundong gently undulating ground rising into re-
spectable hills, and backed by noble mountains, and
valleys so quiet and still, and looking so fertile, that 1
sighed to think man's cultivating hand was not here.
We paused, and rested at a farm of the Paninjow.
Their mode of cultivation is the same as described by
Marsden cutting, clearing, planting, and abandoning
after one or two crops. They seem likewise to prefer
the upland to the wet ground. Tundong is quite a new
settlement, situated close on the banks of the river,
which is hero quite narrow and shallow. The distance
may be ten miles by water, as it took our boat four
hours and a half to pull against stream. Wo spent the
same time walking, but diverged from the road. Wher-
ever the Chinese are, the sound of the axe and the s;i\\
is to be heard in the woods as you approach, and all are
industriously employed. They have their carpenters,
sawyers, blacksmiths, and housebuilders, while the
mass work the antimony ore, or are busy constructing
ihe trench where they find and wnsh the gold. With
such inhabitants n rouniry must <<( on well, if they : un-
allowed fnir play. I w;is quit*' tired. ;ind >.t;iyrl ;il!
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 145
night at Tundong. On the following morning I started
for the Singe mountain, which is the residence of the
Dyak tribe of the same name. The walk, including a
rest, occupied nearly three hours, the latter part up-
hill, and we reached the village a good deal knocked up
from the heat of the sun and the badness of the way.
Our entertainment was not of the best ; yet the Sing6
were not inhospitable, but suspicious that we came to
rob them. The rice and the fowls we required, al-
though we paid for them at double their value, were
reluctantly produced ; while at the same time they
showed themselves anxious enough to obtain the salt we
had brought to exchange, without giving the equivalent.
" The village is built on the shoulder of a mountain, not
half way up, and only accessible by a ladder-like path
on either side. It consists of about 200 miserable huts,
and is as dirty and filthy as any place I ever was in, with
numerous half-starved pigs and dogs running about it.
The houses are small and mean, and detached from
ach other, contrary to the usage of the other Dyaks,
who inhabit one large house containing numerous parti-
tions for families ; here, however, they have one or two
public halls or council-houses, which are built and
thatched in a circular form, and in which their young
men and bachelors sleep ; here likewise are deposited
the heads, of which they have more than enow, as above
one hundred ghastly remnants of mortality ornamented
the abode in which we slept. I could not on this occa-
sion find out that they professed to take the heads of
friends or strangers, though the latter may fall victims if
on enemies' ground. They seem to have no idea of
cannibalism or human sacrifice, nor did they accuse their
enemies of these practices. They have a custom, that
in case of sickness in a house, or child-bearing, the
house is forbidden to the males and strangers, which is
something similar to the tabboo of the South- Sea Islands.
This plea was urged as a reason why the head man or
Orang Kaya Parembam could not receive us in his
dwelling. The Dyaks are always decorous in their be-
havior, rarely give way to mirth, and never annoy by
Iheir curiosity. Toward the Malays they are extremely
sulky and mulish ; but they have good reasons, as tho
10 N
146
EXPEDITION TO BOK
Malays are ever extorting from them, and threatening
them with the anger of the rajah or the incursion of the
Sakarrans. The women wear black bamboo stays, which
are sewn on when they arrive at the age of puberty, and
never removed save when enceinte. These Singe Dyaks,
like the others, attend to the warning of birds of various
sorts, some birds being in more repute than others. On
starting forahunting excursion we metone of them on the
hill-side, who said, 'You will be fortunate: I heard the
bird behind you.' Here, if a bird is before you, it is a
sign that enemies are there too. and they turn baek : if
behind, they proceed in good spirits. They have a pre-
judice against the flesh of deer, which the men may not
-eat, but which is allowed to women and children. The
reason given for this is r that if the warriors eat the flesh
of deer, they become as faint-hearted as that animal.
These maybe called their superstitions, but religion they
have none ; and though they know a name for God, and
entertain some faint notion of a future state, yet it is only
. in the abstract, for practically the belief seems to be a dead
letter. At their marriage they kill fowls, as I have nar-
rated ; but this is a ceremony, not a sacrifice. They have
no priests or idols, say no prayers, make no offerings to
propitiate the Deity, and it is little likely therefore that
human sacrifice should exist among them. In this re-
spect they are different from any known people who have
arrived at the same state of civilization. The New
Zealanders, the inhabitants of the South Seas, &c. &c.
for instance, all bow to their idols, toward which the
same feelings of reverence and devotion, of awe and fear,
obtain as with more civilized beings in regard to the in-
visible Deity ; but here are the mere words, barren and
without practice.
" The day following our arrival at Singe wo de-
scended into the plains, amid theii- former rice-fields, to
shoot deer. The place is called Pasar (bazaar or mar-
ket), though it could scarcely ever have been one.
The rice-cultivation was formerly very extensive, and
the low ground all about the mountain is well cleared
of wood by the industry of these Dyaks. But the
country becoming unsettled and troubled, and roving
parties nf strnn^e l>y;>ks lauding >u the cu;ist nour One-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 147
toug, cut oif the people employed in the fields, and
they consequently were abandoned. We took up our
quarters in a ruinous little deserted hovel, and in the
evening walked over the neighboring district, where the
cocoanut and betel-trees mark its former state of pros-
perity. The sago is likewise planted in considerable
quantity, and serves for food when rice falls short.
Deer, the large deer of Borneo, abound, and in a walk
of a few miles we saw from fifteen to twenty, and from
their tracks they must be very numerous indeed. The
walking was difficult, for owing to the softness of the
ground, we often sank in up to our thighs, and gene-
rally to our knees : and a short distance in this sort of
wading in stiff inud serves to knock a man up. I was
fortunate enough to kill one of the deer, and have no
doubt that with more favorable light a man might get
many. The night's repose in the hut was broken and
uncomfortable, and our people were busy for several
hours curing the flesh of the animal, which is done as
follows : first it is slightly salted, and then burnt over a
quick wood-fire in slices or lumps, and thus keeps for
many days, and is very palatable. Serif? Hussein (for-
merly of Siniawan) was my companion on this excur-
sion. He had three followers, while I had three
Javanese with me, beside my Bugis boy Situ, who
walks with the best of us. The morning after killing
the deer we ascended the Singe again by a desperately
steep path ; and after resting an hour or two, walked to
our boats, and descended the stream to Siniawan.
The night was marked by torrents of rain, thunder,
and lightning, which left the roads so bad that I re-
signed my intention of walking up to Sarambo, and in
die evening dropped down to Leda Tanah, and tried
unsuccessfully for another deer. We saw some, but
could not get near them. Here likewise are plenty of
rice-fields deserted, but which a little labor would bring
again into cultivation. The dfiy following we rejoined
the schooner, and, as usual, found everything at a
stand-still on shore.
" I may here mention our house, or, as I fondly
styled it, our palace. It is an edifice fifty-four feet
square, mounted upon numerous posts of the Nibong
148 Kxi'Eim'iujv TO
palm, with nine windows in each front. The roof
(atap) is of Nipah leaves, and the floor and partitions
are all of plank : furnished with couches, tables, chairs,
books, &c. the whole is as comfortable as man would
wish for in this out-of-the-way country; and we have,
beside, a bathing-house, cook-house, and servants'
apartments detached. The view from the house to
the eastward comprises a reach of the river, and to the
westward looks toward the blue mountains of Matang ;
the north fronts the river, and the south the jungle ;
and but for the uncertainty of our affairs, I would have
had a garden ere this, and found amusement in clearing
and improving. Farewell, I fear, to these aspirations ;
our abode, however, though spacious, cool, and com-
fortable, can only be considered a temporary residence,
for the best of all reasons that in the course of a year
it will tumble down, from the weight of the super-
structure being placed on weak posts. The original
plan was to have had a lower story, but about this I am
now indifferent. The time here passes monotonously,
but not unpleasantly. Had we but the animation of
hope, and the stimulus of improvement, time would
pass rapidly, though without a companion to converse
with.
" August 6th. The Royalist, as I mentioned before
I reverted to the subject of the pirate fleet, started for
Borneo Proper, to inquire respecting the crew of an
English vessel, reported to have been shipwrecked.
Pangeran Sulieman brought the intelligence from Bor-
neo, but he knew very few particulars ; and having
been here four months before my arrival, the chances
were that with the change of the monsoon they had
sailed for Manilla. As, however, he assured me he
had seen European men and women, and a numerous
Lascar crew, I thought it right, at ail events, to ascer-
tain the fact; and in case of their bring there still, to
endeavor to obtain their release. For this purpose I
was very desirous of procuring a letter from Muda
Ifassim to the sultan, conveyed by a Pangeran of rank;
which, in addition to my own application, would most
likely insure the object in view. This, however,
though promised, 1 could not accomplish: dolny coming
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 149
upon delay, and the plague of my own alfairs also inter-
vening, postponed ray intention till I could see the
Swift fairly off for Singapore. The Royalist then went
out with her on the Sunday, July 25th, proceeding to
Borneo to demand the crew, if there : arid the other to
Singapore. On the 2d of August I was surprised by
the receipt of a letter brought from Sadong, and bearing
date the 10th of July. The gentleman who writes it
can best tell his own story.
Island Sirhassan, off Tan Datu,
' July 10th, 1841.
' A boat leaves this to-morrow for Sarawak ; perhaps this
may fall into the hands of Mr. Brooke, or some of my country-
men, which, should I not succeed in getting to Singapore, I
trust will lose no time in letting the authorities know, so that
steps may be taken for the release of the remaining thirty-six
British subjects now at Borneo; which I fear nothing but
one of H. M. ships will effect. The pirates are cruising in
great force between Sambas and this, and have taken thir-
teen Borneo prahus, or more ; they know that there are Euro-
peans in the prahu, and have expressed a wish to take them.
Our situation is not very enviable. The bearer of this has
just escaped from them. I have been living ashore with
Abduramon, a native of Pulo Pinaug, who knows Mr. Brooke,
and has been very kind to me. Trusting penmanship and
paper will be excused,
' I remain, &c. (fee.
G. H. W. GILL.'
" On the reverse was the following attestation, which
threw more light on the circumstances :
'I, G. H. Willoughby Gill, late chief officer of the ship
Sultana, of Bombay, do hereby certify that the said ship was
totally destroyed by lightning, thirty miles N. E. of the Bom-
bay shoal, coast of Palawan, on the 4th of January, 1841.
Part of the crew, forty-one in number, succeeded in reaching
Borneo on the 16th of January, in a state .of starvation and
misery not to be described ; the remainder are reported to
have landed on the coast of Borneo per long-boat : Captain
John Page; G. H. W. Gill, chief officer ; Alexander Young,
second officer ; one gunner ; five sea-cunnies ; two carpen-
ters ; twenty -three natives and Lascars ; two Nakodas. Pas-
sengers : Mrs. Page (of a daughter, 31st of March) ; Mr. and
Miss cle Souza ; Mrs. Anderson, servant ; one Ayah ; in all
N2
150 KXPKlilTloX 'I't' HOUM
forty-two souls. The sultan has permitted myself, Mr. and
Miss <]( S<m/.a, with three servants, to proceed to Singapore
in one of his prahiis, where I hope to succeed in procuring
the release of the remainder of my companions from their
present very uncomfortable situation. I dare not say more.
Mr. de Souza and myself left on the 24th of May, and put in
here dismasted on the 20th of June; since then hav;
detained by a fleet of piratical prahus, which arrived on the
24th, and left 9th of July. Should nothing prevent, -we t>x-
pect to be ready by the 15th ; but am very doubtful of ever
getting to Singapore, as I fear they are on the look-out for us
outside.'
" This is the contents of the paper, which arriving
after I had retired to rest, effectually banished sleep
from my pillow. The ' uncomfortable situation,' coupled
with ' I dare say no more,' gives the worst suspicions of
their treatment in Borneo ; while the chance of the
party at Sirhassan falling into the hands of the pirates
is extremely shocking. 1 instantly, on the receipt of the
letter, sent to the rajah to request that he would dis-
patch a boat for Sirhassan, with a person competent to
treat with the pirates ; and on the morning of the 3d I
succeeded in dispatching a boat to Songi, in the Sadong,
to get some of the Datu Pangeran's people, who are
Illanuns ; but up to this time they have not returned.
I can only hope these poor people at Sirhassan will be
wise enough to stay there, instead of risking a capture
by the pirates. Should the Royalist return shortly, and
have obtained the crew, we may fight our way to that
place and release the party, who, I have little doubt, are
.still detained there. If the Royalist is long away, and
the captain goes in search of the missing boat's crew,
we may yet have the Illanuns from Sadong here in time
to dispatch. As for myself, I am tied, and have not tho
means at present of locomotion ; my situation is an anx-
ious one. The Swift must have been liable to fall in
with this great force of pirates on her way to Singapore,
and will be again liable on her return. The doubt and
uncertainty about the poor fellows in Borneo and Sir-
hassan, and tho wretched condition of my own affairs,
all cause unpleasant reflections to my mind ; yet I yield
not, but will fight it out.
" I have just brought up my history to the present
KXi'KDlTlON Tu IJUKXKO. 1 ."> I
f inn ; jnul, liko a log on the water, must wait i'or events
to develop themselves.
" 7th. A report arrived this morning that the Sir-
hassan party sailed for Singapore on the 3d of the moon ;
and as Mr. Gill says they would be ready for sea about
the 15th of last month, I consider it likely to be true.
I trust they may escape the pirates, and safely reach
their destination."
CHAPTER XL
Return of the Royalist from Borneo Proper with intelligence
of the sufferers from the wreck of the Sultana. Effect of the
arrival of the Diana on the negotiations for their release. Out-
rage and oppression of Macota. Fate of the Sultana and her
crew. Mr. Brooke made Rajah of Sarawak. Liberation of
rebel prisoners. State of Dyak tribes. Court of justice open-
ed. Dyak burials, and respect for the dead. Malay cunning
and treachery.
WHILE waiting events, Mr. Brooke amused himself
by writing down such accounts of the interior as he was
enabled to collect, from time to time, from the natives
visiting Sarawak, as well as a brief description of the
constitution and government, as enacted in Borneo Prop-
er. But as my object now is to trace the progress of
my friend up to the time when he embarked on board
the Dido, I shall refer to these matters hereafter.
" Tuesday, August 17th, 1841. Three weeks the
Royalist has now been absent, and I begin, in spite of
my determination to the contrary, to be somewhat un
easy about her. Suspense is certainly more difficult to
bear than misfortune, for the certainty of an event arous-
es within us some of our best feelings to resist it; but
suspense lets loose our imagination, and gives rise to
that sickening feeling of ' hope deferred,' so truly char-
acterized in the Scriptures.
" 18th. The Royalist arrived near Sarawak, having
come into the river on the 16th, and in one tide from
the Morotaba entrance as far as the Paduman* rocks.
They reported that they had not effected the release
* Now called Samarang.
152 i'KUl'i "Jo.V TO i!(K.\KtJ,
of the prisoners, were very rudely treated, the boat de-
tained at a fort near the entrance of the Borneo river,
all conmmnicatiou denied with the Europeans, a letter
for them seized from the native crew, and provisions and
water refused. In addition to this, a letter from the
sultan, addressed to me, stated to the effect, that the
crew of the Sultana having entered into a treaty with him,
the merchant and mate (Messrs, de Souzaand Gill) had
gone to Singapore to fulfill that agreement. The captain
having a wit'o in the family way, preferred staying in Bor-
neo, as the vessel was a small one, and therefore the
sultan did not grant my request ou this occasion ; and
further, having an agreement, he did not wish to be de-
ceived regarding it. This w r as a falsehood from begin-
ning to end, as \vill be clear by comparing it with Mr.
Gill's statement, though I fear the poor men have been
rash enough to enter into some arrangement to ransom
themselves."
On the 19th of August the Swift arrived; but the
journal was laid by until the 24th of October, when it
thus recommences :
" I may now continue my narrative of events which
have happened since I last used my pen, together with
fresh details of my present intentions, and such addition-
al knowledge as has been acquired. After the arrival of
the Swift, I still adhered to my former resolution of
waiting patiently for a settlement. I made several strong
remonstrances, and urged for an answer to a letter I
had addressed to Muda Hassim, in which was recapitu-
lated our entire negotiation. This letter w r as acknowl-
edged to be perfectly true and correct, and the rajah,
in the conference which folio wed, again pledged himself
to give me the country, saying he always intended to
do so, but was involved in difficulties of the nature of
which I could not be aware. Thus far things went
well, and there appeared, indeed, a frankness in his
manner which had formerly pleased me, but had long
been in abeyance.
" On tie upturn of the Royalist from Borneo, I had
assured mem mat a government vessel would be sent to
demand the captives ; but, taking this assurance for a
men; boast, they paid little attention to it, and were
KXJ'I mrio.N To KOKNEO. 153
thoreloro excessively frightened when, a week after the
Swift, the Diana steamer entered the river. I had the
pleasure of calming their fears, and was too generous to
push matters to a settlement during the two days the
steamer remained.
" Muda Hassim now expressed himself desirous of
sending some Pangerans to Borneo, and I wished him
likewise to do so on account of the reflective power of
the steamer, which, in that case, would have shone upon
him. With his usual delay, however, he failed to be
ready, and these Pangerans did not quit the river for
two days afterward, when they proceeded in a native
prahu. I accompanied the steamer to the mouth of the
river, and wishing them success, pulled back to the cap-
ital of Sarawak.
" Oct. 30th. The Swift was slowly laden with anti-
mony ore, worked by the Chinese ; and I gradually rob-
bed the Royalist of furniture for my house on shore.
But I had no intention of allowing either vessel to sail
until the time arrived which I had fixed on for the final
adjustment of my affairs. By degrees, however, I learn-
ed many of the difficulties of poor Muda Hassim's situ-
ation, and much of the weakness of his character. The
dissensions in Borneo ; the intrigues of Macota ; the ra-
pacity of his own people, and their total want of fidelity ;
the bribes from the Sultan of Sambas ; the false repre-
sentations of numerous Borneo Pangerans who asserted
the immense profit to be derived from the country ; the
dilatory movements of the Chinese ; some doubts of my
good faith ; and, above all, the natural tenacity of pow-
er, all conspired to involve the rajah in the utmost per-
plexity, and would, but for counterbalancing circumstan-
ces, have turned the scale against me. Muda Hassim
knew Macota to be false and in league with the Sul-
tan of Sambas ; and he felt that he had no power, and
that if he broke with me, it would be extremely difficult
to support himself against the former rebels. He was
fond of me, and trusted me more than he trusted any
one else ; and pecuniary considerations Md f6 doubt
some weight, for with all Macota' s promises he could
not get sufficient ore to repay one quarter ofTiis debt to
me However, all these conflicting considerations, ki-
154 KXI'EIHTIOX TO BORNEO.
stead oi' inducing Muda Hnssim to take one course, only
served to encourage his dilatory temper, and although
puzzled, ashamed, and fearful, he could not decide.
" At this period a robbery was committed up the riv-
er by some of Macota's followers on a Chinese hadji, a
converted Mohammedan. They beat the old man, threw
him into the water, and robbed him of a tael of gold.
The beating and attempt at drowning were certain, for
the Chinese hadji was so ill for several days under my
care, that he was in considerable danger. He complain-
ed to me loudly of Macota ; and from other sources I
gained a pretty accurate account of that gentleman's
proceedings. By threats, by intrigue, by falsehood, and
even by violence, he had prevented or driven all persons
fi-om daring to visit or come near me, whether abroad or
ashore. He was taxing the poor Dyaks, harassing the,
Siniawans, and leagued with the Borneo Pangerans to
plunder and get all he possibly could. Every Dyak com-
munity was watched by his followers, and a spear rais-
ed opposite the chief's house, to intimate that no person
was to trade or barter except the Pangeran. The mode
of plunder is thus perpetrated. Rice, clothes, gongs,
and other articles are sent to a tribe at a tixed price,
which the Dyaks dare not refuse, for it is at the risk of
losing their children ! The prices thus demanded by
Macota were as follows : one gantong of rice for thirty
birds' nests. Twenty-four gantongs here is equal to a
pecul of rice a pecul of rice costs one dollar and a half:
whereas thirty birds' nests weigh one catty, and are val-
ued at two rupees, so that the twenty-fourth part of
one and a half dollars is sold for two rupees. Was it
surprising that these people were poor and wretched /
My astonishment was, that they continued to labor, and.
indeed, nothing but their being a surprisingly industrious
race can account for it, and they are only enabled to live
at all by secreting a portion of their food. Yet war and
bad government, or, rather, no government, have had the
effect of driving more than half the Dyak tribes beyond
the I'm A-ak.
" The rapacity of these Malays is as unbounded as it
is short-sighted; for one would think that the slightest
tlr'/ren of common sense would induce some of the chiefs
K\rKi;JTio\ TII i:mi.\ i-:u. 155
t<> allow no one to plunder except themselves. But this
is so far from being the case, that, when their demand
has been enforced, dozens of inferior wretches extort and
plunder in turn, each according to his ability ; and though
the Dyak is not wanting in obstinacy, he can seldom
withstand these robberies, for each levy is made in the
name of the rajah, or some principal Pangeran ; and the
threat of bringing the powerful tribe of Sakarrans or
Sarebus to deprive them of their heads and wives jand
families, generally reduces them to obedience. While
on this subject, I may as well mention a fact that came
later to my knowledge, when several of the Dyak chiefs,
and one of particular intelligence, Si Meta by name, as-
sured me that each family paid direct revenue from thir-
ty to fifty pasus (tubs) of padi, besides all the other pro-
duces, which are extorted at merely nominal prices.
" To return to my relation : the Chinese hadji recov-
ered, and I determined to punish the aggressors, for
which purpose I seized an Illanun said to be concerned,
but who was innocent. In the mean time the steamer
returned from Borneo, and once more put in here for
wood and water. She brought Captain and Mrs. Page,
Mr. Young, the second officer, and all the rest of the
crew, save only a few who had landed atthe north part
of Borneo, and there been seized and sold as slaves, and
brought afterward as slaves to Borneo Proper. As the
history of the shipwreck and detention is curious, I may
here relate it as nearly as I can.
" The Sultana, a fine ship of 700 tons, the day previ-
ous to her being struck by lightning, found the French
frigate Magicienne aground and deserted on the Bom-
bay shoal; Captain Page boarded her, and discovered
every thing as it had been left by the crew provisions,
water, &c., in abundance. The day after, the Sultana
met with a worse fate, being struck, and the cotton in
the hold, fore and aft, fired by the electric fluid. They
had scarcely tune to hoist out the boat when the flames
burst forth, and they quitted her very short of provisions,
and saving only some money and jewels. Captain Page
bore up for the wreck of the French frigate, intending
to refit his long-boat aboard her, and take provisions and
arms to last them to Singapore ; but. on making her, there
156 KXPKDITIOX TO iiOltNEo.
was so great a wash of the sea on tho lee part of the
reef, that it was totally impossible to reach the Magi-
cienne. Under these unfoitunate ch'cumstances they
bore up once more, still intending to prosecute the voy-
age to Singapore, and made the land to the southward
of Palawan ; and, being then short of water and provis-
ions, landed on a small islet off Balabac, or Balambangan.
Here they procured a few shell-fish and some very bad
water; but seeing some natives in prahus on a neigh-
boring islet, and being unarmed and apprehensive, they
lighted large fires in the evening to mislead these peo-
ple, and, as night advanced, silently put to sea, and made
the best of their way along the coast. With a heavy
sea, and often high wind, they reached as far as Labu-
an, off the entrance of the Borneo river ; and here, be-
ing in the utmost want, and reduced to an allowance of
half a biscuit and a cup of water per day, they were
forced to put into Borneo Proper, not without hopes of
being well used, and enabled to buy provisions and stores
sufficient to caiey them to Singapore or Sambas. I
have omitted to mention that, on making the land the
first time, they parted from the cutter, in consequence
of the tow-rope breaking in the night ; but as they were
then within sight of Borneo, and the wind fair, there
was no doubt of its making the land somewhere. This,
indeed, it did at Malludu Bay, where tho native crew
were seized and sold as slaves.
" The arrival of Captain Page in his long-boat caused,
as may well be imagined, considerable sensation in the
campong; and they reached the sultan's house, thinking
it the best place to seek shelter and protection. In this,
however, they were soon undeceived ; for neither the
one nor the other was granted, but a message sent that
they must deliver up all their property into the sultuif s
hands, as otherwise he was afraid they would be plun-
dered by his people. Accordingly, having possessed
himself of their money, some jewels, their boat, &c., he
gave them a miserable shed to live in. Here they pass-
ed the time, and were gradually robbed of every thing
they had in the world, even to the baby-linen which
Mrs. Page had prepared for an expected infant. Some-
times, indeed, when Captain Page refused to yield to
EXPEDITION TO UOKM.o. 157
:!i au's demands, their provisions were stopped till
they could no longer hold out; and in this way they
were compelled to sign bonds for considerable sums,
with the understanding that, till these were procured
and paid, they should be detained.
" In this sad situation Mrs. Page was confined of a
daughter, on the 31st of March; and this miserable life
continued .from the 4th of January, 1841, to August of
the same year. Their first ray of hope was the Roy-
alist coming to fetch them : the steamer followed, and
they were released.
" After a stay of two or three days, the steamer once
more sailed ; though I would fain have persuaded Cap-
tain Congleton to search for the piratical fleet, of which
I had excellent information ; but he considered himself
not authorized, or, in other words, he declined the re-
sponsibility.
" As there was a chance that Mr. Gill and the De
Souzas were either at Sirhassan or Tambelan, the
steamer decided to touch at the latter place, and a na-
tive chuliah brig was directed to call at the former. I
afterward learned that the pirates were then at Sirhas-
san ; but as the' brig knew nothing about Sirhassan, it is
probable she never went there. In the evening the Di-
ana sailed, and I reached Sarawak about two o'clock in
the morning.
" I now return to my concerns. The Chinese hadji,
whom I had protected, continued to reside with my
servants, till one evening we were alarmed at an attempt
to poison my interpreter, a native of the name of Mia.
Arsenic had certainly been put into his rice ; but as the
servants endeavored to point suspicion on this hadji, and
as I learned, at the same time, that they did not agree
with the old man, I cleared him in my own mind, and
rather leaned to the opinion of Mia having placed the
arsenic in the plate himself, for the express purpose of
accusing the hadji. Connecting this event with all Ma-
cota's former intrigues, I determined to bring matters to
a crisis, and test at once the strength of the respective
parties. Accordingly, after complaining of the matter
previously mentioned to the rajah, I landed a party of
men, fully armed, and loaded the ship's guns with grape
5 * *
158 EXPEDITION TO UOKNEO.
and canister; after which I once more proceeded to
Muda Hassira, and, while I protested my kindness to-
ward him, exposed Macota's machinations and crimes,
his oppression and his deceit, and threatened him with
an attack, as neither Muda Hassim nor myself were safe
while he continued practicing these arts. Muda Has-
sim was frightened ; but how Macota felt I can not say,
as he never moved out of his house, and it was long af-
terward before he was seen. From my knowledge,
however, of his temperament, I can well conceive that
he was reduced to a pitiable state of terror. The Sini-
awans took my part directly ; and their chiefs came to
me to say that 200 men were all ready whenever 1
pleased to call for them. The Chinese and the rest of
the inhabitants took no side ; and Macota did not get a
single follower besides his immediate slaves, perhaps
about twenty in number. After this demonstration af-
fairs proceeded cheerily to a conclusion. The rajah
was active in settling ; the agreement was drawn out,
sealed, and signed ; guns fired, flags waved ; and on the
24th of September, 1841, I became the Governor of Sa-
rawak, with the fullest powers."
Being now regularly established in his government,
Mr. Brooke, with his usual activity and circumspection,
applied himself to the discharge of the onerous duties it
imposed upon him ; and his first acts were such as equal-
ly displayed his wisdom, firmness, and humanity. His
journal runs thus :
" Nov. 3d. I have a country ; but, oh ! how beset
with difficulties, how ravaged by war, torn by dissen-
sions, and ruined by duplicity, weakness, and intrigue !
Macota's underhand dealings, after the conclusion of my
agreement with Muda Hassim had been ratified, soon
brought) 'letters from his Sambas friends, i. c., one from
the sultaifc one from the Tumangong, and one from an-
other Pangeran an immense effort of conspiracy and
correspondence! Of these letters the sultan's alone
was curious ; for the rest only dealt in professions of
devoted attachment to the person and interests ol'M'udu
Hassim. But the sultan, for want of some better plea,
made use of the following singular specimen of re.iismi-
inp-, vi/,., that the Chinese Kinisi wnro indebted to him a
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 159
sum of money, which they had agreed to pay him in an-
timoiiy ore; the agreement was not to pay him in gold,
or money, or other commodity only in antimony ore ;
therefore he wanted antimony ore. To this it was prop-
erly replied, that an arrangement had been made with
me, and that the Chinese could not agree to give anti-
mony ore without his (Muda Hassim's) consent.
"My first object, on holding the reins of government,
was to release the unfortunate women confined for a
whole year by the rajah. This, indeed, was not only
necessary to inspire confidence in my just intentions,
but was dictated by humanity. I found Muda Hassim
not averse to take the measure, now that he had really
resolved to adhere to my advice, and consequently I had
the sincere satisfaction, within a few days, of liberating
upward of a hundred females and young children, and
of restoring them to their husbands and fathers; this
act being somewhat alloyed by Muda Hassim detaining
twelve females, and among them two wives. I urged as
strongly as I could, but without success, the advisability
of releasing the whole ; and I was obliged, at last, to con-
tent myself with the mass, and yield the few whom I
could only have got by force or the utter abrogation of
our infant treaty. When 1 pressed the affair, it was
answered that, except for me, none would have regain-
ed their liberty ; and that the release waa an act of great
kindness and unexampled confidence toward me ; that
what had been done was perfectly accordant with their
customs ; and that the women detained were for the ra-
jah's brothers so far, indeed, from being intended as an
injury to the women, it was a great honor and advan-
tage. I explained the circumstances to the Patingi and
Tumangong, and they acquiesced in the decision allow-
ing the custom and said they had gained so much more
than they had ever hoped for, that they could submit to
the rest.
" The next step was to assemble the Siniawans, who,
since the close of the war, would run away, and whom
it was found impossible to keep here. Some had retired
to Sambas ; some (among them Patingi AH) had gone to
Sariki ; and others had built a village on the borders of
the Sambas territory. The whole aim and nbjpct of
160 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
Macota's government was to get these people back ; and
those who were already here were constantly plying
backward and forward to recall their companions ; but
as soon as they succeeded in getting one family, another
absconded. Confidence alone could restore them ; and
I therefore intimated to the Patingi and Tumangong
that there was no occasion for their seeking them ; that
I by no means desired their return ; and that any of
their people who wished to leave the country were at
liberty to do so whenever they felt inclined. This had
the desired effect, in a short time, of bringing back the
fugitives from Pankalon Nibong; and they continued
daily to arrive from Sambas.
"My next measure was to inquire into the state of
the Dyaks, to gain their confidence, and, ns much as it
was within my power, prevent the oppressions of the
Malays. It was necessary, likewise, to fix a rate of tax
to be levied yearly; and the prospect seemed fair, as
the chief people of the following tribes had come in, and
agreed that such a tax on rice, amounting to sixteen
gantongs, would be required from each man, and that
for the rest they would be obliged to labor ; that they
could trade at pleasure ; that no man could demand any
thing from them ; that their wives and children were
safe; and that, in case any trouble arose, they were. v<>
let me know, and I would myself come to their assist-
ance. The tribes were, Lundu, Sarambo, Bombftk,
Paninjow, and Sow. The only other tribe on the right-
hand river were the Singe, a powerful and stilt-nocked
people, with good reason to be shy ; but when once
they are treated justly, their strength will be advanta-
geous, and give them confidence to resist oppression.
" The story told me by the three heads of the Sow
Dyaks brought tears into my eyes, as they each in turn
related their grievances. One of them, a remarkably
intelligent person, addressed me nearly in the following
terms: 'From former times wo have been the rfubjecis
of the Patek of Borneo. Tho Borneons are the elder
brothers, we the younger; and tin 4 custom of old was.
that we should pay revenue and find protection. But
they forgot what was right, and departed from the cus-
lom, and robbed the 'Dyahs, and oppressed ihen;. \Vo
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 161
have done no wrong : we listened to the commands of
the Patingi who was put over us by the Patek. If he
did wrong, he should be punished ; but we have suffer-
ed because we obeyed the commands of the officer le-
gally appointed. You might, sir, a few years ago, have
sought in this river, and not have found a happier tribe
than ours. Our children were collected around us ; we
had rice in plenty, and fruit-trees ; our hogs and fowls
were in abundance ; we could afford to give what was
demanded of us, and yet live happily. Now we have
nothing left. The Sadong people and the Sakarran
Dyaks attacked us : they burned our houses, destroyed
our property, cut down our fruit-trees, killed many of
our people, and led away our wives and young children
into slavery. We could build another house ; we could
plant fruit-trees and cultivate rice ; but where can we
find wives ? Can we forget our young children ? We
have asked the Patek to restore them ; we have asked
Pangeran Macota to restore them : they have told us
they would, but have not ; we can not trust them ; their
words are fair, but in their hearts they do not mean to
help us. We have now no one to trust but you will
you help us ? Will you restore our wives and children ?
If we get our families, you will never repent it : you
will find us true.'
" What could I answer ? I could not deceive them,
as I knew not how to obtain their object; I therefore
told them I feared it was impossible ; but I would try,
and they themselves should go and try at the same time.
Poor, unhappy people, who suffer for the crimes of
others ! God knows, I will aid you to the utmost of my
power.
" Nov. 5th. To-day the greatest, and I hope the final,
struggle of the opposing faction was developed by the ar-
rival of a brig from Sambas, with two of the sultan's sons
on board ; Macota in high spirits, and my party looking
rather desponding; and, in fact, I can not trust them
against Sambas. For good or for bad, for success or for
failure, for life or for death, I will act justly, and pre-
serve the high hand over Macota.
" After the steps I have mentioned, I determined to
open a court for the administration of justice, wherein I
11 O2
162 EXPEDITION TO BOKNo.
should preside, together with such of the rajah's brothers*
as liked to assist me. As for a jury, or any machinery
of form or law, it was rejected, because it must be ineffi-
cient, if not corrupt ; and the only object I aimed at was.
keeping witnesses out of ear-shot of each other, hearing
the evidence, deciding as appeared best, and in future
punishing. This simple plan insured substantial re-
dress ; and it gave all the people confidence in rne, and
a notion of what was right.
"The first case was a follower of the rajah's, of the
name of Sunudeen ; and a greater villain could not exist
either in this or any other land. It was as follows : A
man from Samarahan, named Bujong, had undertaken
to marry his daughter to a Sarawak man called Abdul-
lah; but Abdullah proving a dissolute character, and
greatly in debt, Bujong broke off the engagement before
the proper authorities, and returned the presents which
Abdullah, according to custom, had made. Abdullah, it
appeared, was indebted a small sum to Matassim (Mo-
hammed Orsin), and, between Sunudeen and Matassim,
they resolved to lay the debt on Bujong' s shoulders ; in-
other words, to plunder Bujong under false pretenses.
Accordingly, Sunudeen, with his comrade, went to Sa-
marahan ; and, in his capacity of follower of the rajah,
demanded the debt due by Abdullah to Matassim. Bu-
jong having no money, Sunudeen proceeded and sei/eu
his nephew, a boy, and a slave-man belonging to him, s
his slaves. Poor Bujong resisted, and recovered 1m
nephew, but yielded his slave; he appealed, however, to
the Orang Kay a de Gadong's sons, and they failing, a
Nakodah stated the case secretly to me. T investigau-d
it, and ordered the return of the slave in my presence.
which was obeyed. This may give an idea of the stale
of the country, and the power of every petty scoundrel
hanging about the rajah to rob and plunder at pleasure.
" 7th. I have before mentioned that the Dyaks of
Sibnow bury their dead ; but 1 always found a reluct
ance on their part to show me their place of sepulture.
Once, indeed, chance led me to the burial-ground of part
of that tribe settled at Simunjang ; but, as they seemed
restless to get away, I only took a hasty survey. The
reason, J have lately learned, for this is, that in their
EXPEDITION To BOKNKO. 103
graves they deposit the golden ornaments and other
property of the person deceased, amounting lrc(|iitnily
to a considerable value in the precious metals, Inu^s
swivels, gongs, &c.
" The tribe now at Lundu were formerly settled on
the Samarahan river for many years ; and their burial-
place there contained the ashes of the parents and grand-
parents of the present chief, who, with his followers,
were not long ago driven to Lundu ; and their former
settlement being deserted, it has been the employment
of some of the rascals here to rob these graves of their
contents, and to desecrate the repose of the dead. The
Orang Kaya of Lundu complained to rne sadly, but
mournfully, on this account, and said that if he could not
find redress from the rajah, he must obtain it himself by
taking the heads of those who had disinterred the bones
of his ancestors. His whole manner convinced me that
they hold the bury ing -places in great respect ; and my
advice, to remove the wealth and bones to a place of se-
curity at Lundu, was rejected on the ground that they
could not disturb the remains of those whom they had
once deposited in the earth.
" While there is so much of right feeling and manly
principle in the actions of these Dyaks, the miserable
race who pretend to be their superiors have no single
virtue or good intention. I do not, however, mean to
confound the inhabitants of Sarawak, or the other rivers,
with those of Borneo Proper. The latter are thoroughly
corrupt and profligate. The former are Malays, but
have their good qualities, and certainly are not possessed
with the spirit of intrigue which seems the life, the only
moving principle of the Borneons. It may truly be said
of the latter, that they would tell a lie when the truth
would serve them better. They will employ duplicity
and treachery on eveiy slight occasion ; defeat their own
purpose by their meanness, and yet continue in the
same crooked paths. They will conspire without any
object, or one too mysterious to arrive at; and, while
they raise a cloud of doubts in the mind of the poor,
their own equals look on and detect the game. Yet,
after all, they gain but little individually ; because so
many are practicing the same arts at the same time with
164 EXPEDITION TO BOliNEU.
equal skill ; and the countiy is so exhausted by their op-
pressions and rapacity, that in the end there is nothing
to be got by their tricks and maneuvers. It is a strange
state of society, and it is only wonderful how it can ex-
ist; but they have their reward in being poor and ill-
provided, though living in the midst of a marvelously fer-
tile and luxurious country.
" December 31st. The last day of the year, in which
I must bring up the arrears of my account.
" The Sambas brig left only yesterday, after exhaust-
ing every effort of intrigue, and every artifice which Ma-
lays can invent, to' compass their ends.
"With the Sambas brig came Seriff Hussein, a rela-
tion of the Sultan of Pontiana, and half Arab half Bugis
by descent. He came with the avowed purpose of en-
tering into the most friendly communication with me,
and residing here, provided I gave him any encourage-
ment. His real motive (if he has one) not being obvi-
ous, I, in the mean time, treated him with all kindness;
and he is an intelligent and pleasing person, and, more-
over, connected with the Siniawans, who have a good
opinion of him."
CHAPTER XII.
Reflections on the new year. The plundered village, and other
wrongs. Means for their suppression. The new government
proceeds to act. The constitution. Preparations for an expe-
dition against the Sea Dyaks. Form of a treaty. Wreck of
the Viscount Melbourne. Administration of justice. Difficul-
ties and dangers. Dyak troubles. Views and arrangements
of the Chinese. Judicial forms. Wrongs and sufferings of the
Lundus.
"Jan.. 1st, 1842. The past year is in the bosom of
eternity, into which bourne we are all hurrying. Here
we have no merry-making, no reunion of families, no
bright fires or merry games, to mark the advent of 1842 ;
but we have genial weather, and are not pinched by cold
or frost. This is a year which to me must be eventful ;
for at its close I shall be able to judge whether 1 can
maintain myself against all the circumstances and ilifli-
i:\i'i:iiiTi<>\ ro BORM 105
culties which beset me, or whetlier I must retreat,
broken in fortune, to some retirement in my native
land. I look with calmness on the alternative, and God
knows no selfish motives weigh on me ; and if I fail, my
chief regret will be for the natives of this unhappy coun-
try. Let the year roll on, let the months pass ; and
whatever they bring whether it be life or death, for-
tune or poverty I am prepared ; and in the deep soli-
tude of my present existence I can safely say that I
believe I could bear misfortune better than prosperity.
In this, probably, I am not singular ; fcr there is some-
thing in prosperity which, if it does not make us worse,
makes us more foolish and more worldly which decks
passing time with wreaths of gay flowers, and gilds the
things of this life with tinsel hopes and wishes, to the
exclusion of the pure gold of reflection for the life to
come. What are all these gewgaws, these artificial
flowers, these momentary joys, these pleasures of the
sense, before the war of time ? Nothing ! And yet, if
exertion can benefit our race, or even our own country
if the sum of human misery can be alleviated if these
suffering people can be raised in the scale of civilization
and happiness it is a cause in which I could suffer,
it is a cause in which I liave suffered and do suffer ;
hemmed in, beset, anxious, perplexed, and the good in-
tent marred by false agents surrounded by weakness,
treachery, falsehood, and folly, is suffering enough ; and
to feel myself on the threshold of success, and only
withheld by the want of adequate means, increases this
suffering. Hail, however, 1842 ! Come good, come ill,
still hail ! and many as are the light hearts which have
already greeted thee, mine will be more ready to bow
to the decrees of Providence which thy twelve montlis
will develop.
" Jan. 3d. I have mentioned that the Sanpro had
been attacked from Sadong; and I now learn that, at
the time, the men were out of the village, and thus the
women and children alone suffered ; twenty-two have
been carried away into slavery. The village was burned
after being plundered, and the unfortunate people have
since been living in the- jungle, with only such food as
they could get there. The head of the tribe and about
166 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
six of his followers came down the river on a raft to ask
assistance from me, and I had the story from them.
They were relieved as far as my means admitted, and
returned far happier than they came. The very same
day arrived news that six men of the Sows were cut off
by a wandering party of the Sakarrans.
" This leads me naturally to consider the means by
which these atrocities may be prevented. I propose
first to send letters to Seriff Sahib of Sadong, Seriff
Muller of Sakarran, and Seriff Jaffer of Singe, stating
that I wish to be on good terms with my neighbors, but
am determined to attack any place which sends Dyaks
to rob in my country ; and that I call on them to re-
strain their subjects from making incursions here. In
case this warning is neglected, I must strike one blow
suddenly, as a farther warning, and keep a good look-
out at sea to destroy any Dyak fleet that may be prowl-
ing outside. A good-sized boat, with a six-pounder and
a swivel or two, will effect the latter object, backed by
two or four light, fast-pulling boats, with musketry,
which, when the Dyak prahus fly, may keep pace with
them and thin their pullers, till the heavier boat can
come up. To carry one of their campongs, I must
have twenty-five Europeans, and from some thirty to
fifty Bugis, who, coming from Singapore, may proceed
at once to Sadong, or, rather, the cam pong Tangi.
Seriff Sahib is a great freebooter, and dispatches his
retainers to attack the weak tribes here for the sake of
the slaves, calculating, on the rajah's presumed weak-
ness, that he can do so with impunity. He may find
himself mistaken.
" Seriff Muller is a brother of Seriff Sahib, and lives
at Sakarran, which powerful Dyak tribe are always
willing to be sent by either brother on a forage for heads
and slaves. It is certain, however, that they could never
come from the Sadong side without Seriff' Sahib's per-
mission ; and on the late attack on Sanpro they were
accompanied by a party of Malays.
" Seriff Jaffer is by no means mixed up with these
brothers, and there is no love lost between them ; nor
would he, I think, do anything to annoy me. This is
the foreign policy.
EXPEDITION TO JlOKNKu. 167
* The domestic policy is as disturbed as the foreign.
The rajah weak, Macota intriguing, and my ministers
viz., the Patingi (Abong Mia), the Bandar, and Tuman-
gong all false and foolish, and Macota's men ; with me,
however, are the Siniawans.
" Jan. 6th. The Sambas brig returned, having been
baffled and beat about, and nearly lost at sea, unable to
weather Tanjong Datu. The crew say she was one
hour under water. She now remains here to wait the
/change of the monsoon, and her intriguing Pangerans
return by land.
" 8th. SerilF Hussein returned from Sambas, having
tbeen nearly stabbed while there. The assassins, it was
understood, were here, and I endeavored to apprehend
them ; but, having heard of the seriff's arrival, they
made off.
" IQtfi This day the first laws and regulations are to
'be promulgated in Sarawak ; and as the event is a rare
one, I here inscribe a copy for the benefit of future le-
gislators, observing that there is an absolute necessity
for mildness and patience, and that an opposite course
would raise such a host of enemies as to crush every
good seed ; for, as it is, the gentlest course -of justice
brings down much odium, and arouses intense dislike
among a people who have had no law but their own vile
intrigues to guide or control them.
" Two eases have lately come to notice, which will
serve as examples of their singular crimes.
" One poor man owed another sixteen reals, and the
-debtor was away trading for a few days, when the cred-
itor sold the daughter (a free woman) for thirty reals,
to a person of influence.
" The second case, a respectable man, or a respect-
ably born man, owed a Pangeran fifty peculs of ore,
-and proposed to make over to him in payment, a slave
woman and her four children. The woman had been a
slave of his grandfather's, but was adopted as his daugh-
ter, and enfranchised publicly; yet by intimidation,
they were near getting her and her offspring. Here
the Pangerans and Nakodas bully a man into silence
and acquiescence ; and the people dare not, as yet,
&ring .their .complaints to me. But I hear these things,
168 EXPEDITION TO BuK.N!
call the parties together, and often prevent the commis-
sion of a premeditated crime ; by which means I save
myself from the odium of punishing.
" There is great difficulty in acting at once with
temper and firmness, so as to appear the benefactor
rather than the tyrant. It is, indeed, an arduous and;
troublesome task ; but / think I see a ray of light to en-
courage me.
"Here are the regulations, which I had printed at
Singapore in the Malayan language :
"'James Brooke, esquire, governor (rajah) of the
country of Sarawak, makes known to all men the follow-
ing regulations :
" 1st. That murder, robbery, and other heinous
crimes will be punished according to the ondong-ondong
(i.e. the written law of Borneo) ; and no person com-
mitting such offences will escape, if, after fair inquiry >
he be proved guilty.
" ' 2d. In order to insure the good of the country, all
men, whether Malays, Chinese, or Dyaks, are permitted
to trade or labor according to their pleasure, and to enjoy
their gains.
" ' 3d. All roads will be open, that the inhabitants at
large may seek profit both by sea or by land ; and all boats
coming from others are free to enter the river and de-
part, without let or hinderance.
" * 4th. Trade, in all its branches, will be free, with
the exception of antimony ore, which the governor holds
in his own hands, but which no person is forced to work,
and which will be paid for at a proper price when ob-
tained. The people are encouraged to trade and labor,,
and to enjoy the profits which are to be made by fair and
honest dealing.
" ' 5th. It is ordered that no person going among the
Dyaks shall disturb them, or gain their goods under false
pretences. It must be clearly explained to the different
Dyak tribes, that the revenue will be collected by the
three Datus, bearing the seal of the governor; and (ex-
cept this yearly demand from the government) they are
to give nothing to any person ; nor are they obliged
to sell their goods except they please and at their own
prices.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 169
" * 6th. The governor will shortly inquire into the rev-
enue, and fix it at a proper rate ; so that every one may
know certainly how much he has to contribute yearly to
support the government.
" ' 7th. It will be necessary, likewise, to settle the
weights, measures, and money current in the country,
and to introduce doits, that the poor may purchase food
cheaply.
" ' 8th. The governor issues these commands, and will
enforce obedience to them ; and while he gives all pro-
tection and assistance to the persons who act rightly, he
will not fail to punish those who seek to disturb the pub-
lic peace or commit crimes ; and he warns all such
persons to seek their safety, and find some other country
where they may be permitted to break the laws of
God and man.'
" Jan. llth. I have frequently said that all law and
custom have been long banished from this country ; but
I may here retrace the customs which once obtained,
the best of which I wish to restore.
" The inhabitants were all considered the property of
the sultan serfs rather than slaves and were divided
into four classes. Imprimis, the Dyaks (the aborigines) ;
the Bruni, or people of the soil, probably the descend-
ants of the first Malay emigrants ; the Awang-Awang,
the meaning of which I am ignorant of ; and the Hamba
Rajah, or rajah's slaves. There is eveiy reason to be-
lieve the Dyaks are an aboriginal people ; but between
the Bruni and Awang-Awang it is difficult to decide the
priority. The Hamba Rajah speaks for itself.
" These three distinctions have been long confounded
by intermarriage ; and the names rather than the reality
are retained. The governors of the country are the
Patingi, a Bandar, and a Tumangong, who are appointed
from Borneo. Each of the classes was formerly ruled
by its particular officer, and the Dyaks were appropria-
ted likewise among them ; the Patingi holding the tribes
on the right-hand river, the Bandar to the left, and
the Tumangong on the sea-coast. The annual revenue
paid to Borneo was 300 reals ; but they were subject to
extra demands, and to the extortions of the powerful
chiefs.
P
170 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
" The government of the Dyaks I have already de-
tailed ; and though we might hope that in a more settled
state of things they would have been more secure from
foreign pillage, yet they were annually deprived of the
proceeds of their labor, debarred from trade, and de-
prived of every motive to encourage industry. The
character of their rulers for humanity alone fixed the
measure of their suffering, and bad was the best ; but
it seems to be a maxim among all classes of Malays,
that force alone can keep the Dyaks in proper sub-
jection ; which is so far true, that force alone, and the
hopelessness of resistance, could induce a wild people to
part with the food on which they depend for subsistence.
At a distance I have heard of and pitied the sufferings
of the negroes and the races of New Holland yet
it was the cold feeling dictated by reason and humanity;
but now, having witnessed the miseries of a race supe-
rior to either, the feeling glows with the fervor of per-
sonal commiseration : so true is it that visible misery will
raise us to exertion, which the picture, however power-
fully delineated, can never produce. The thousands daily
knelled out of the world, who lie in gorgeous sepulchres,
or rot unburied on the surface of the earth, excite no
emotion compared to that conjured up by the meanest
dead at our feet. We read of tens of thousands killed
and wounded in battle, and the glory of their deeds, or
the sense of their defeat attracts our sympathy ; but if
a single mangled warrior, ghastly with wounds and
writhing with pain, solicited our aid, we should deplore
his fate with tenfold emotion, and curse the strife which
led to such a result. Among the thousands starving for
want of food we trouble not ourselves to seek one ; but
if the object is presented before our eyes, how certain a
compassion is aroused ! To assist is a duty ; but in the
performance of this duty, to be gentle and feeling is god-
like; and probably between individuals, there is no
greater distinction than in this tender sympathy toward
distress. Poor, poor Dyaks! exposed to starvation,
slavery, death ! you may well raise the warmest feelings
of compassion enthusiasm awakes at witnessing your
sufferings! To save men from death has its merit; but
to alleviate suffering, to ameliorate all tho ills of slavery,
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 171
to protect these tribes from pillage and yearly scarcity,
is lar nobler ; and if, in the endeavor to do so, one poor
life is sacrificed, how little is it in the vast amount of
human existence!
" Ibth. A Chinese boat with four men was chased
into the river by four Dyak prahus, and escaped with
difficulty. On the intelligence reaching me, I, with
some trouble, mustered three canoes, and we proceeded
down, about one o'clock in the morning, in search of
the enemy. After rowing in the dark for some hours,
we discovered a light gliding up the river, and gave
chase, but did not succeed ; and at daybreak returned,
wet and tired, without seeing anything more, when we
learnt that the chase was a Sarawak boat, which, mis-
taking us for Dyaks, as we did them, pulled with all
speed home, and gave the alarm of being nearly captured.
" In the evening I ordered a fine boat to be prepared
for the war with S are bus and Sakarran, which appears
to me inevitable ; as it is impossible, laying all motives
of humanity aside, to allow these piratical tribes to con-
tinue their depredations, which are inconsistent with
safety, and a bar to all trade along the coast. Eighty
prahus of Sarebus and Sakarran are reported to be
ready, and waiting for further reinforcements before
putting to sea.
" 19th. Information of three more of my Dyaks
being cut off in the interior by the predatory tribes.
" 2Qih. Opened the subject of restoring the old Pa-
tingi, Bandar, and Tumangong, and found Muda Has-
sim quite willing, but wishing to wait till he hears from
Borneo ; at the same time telling me that I might em-
ploy them in their respective situations. This matter I
consider, therefore, settled ; and as these men are na-
tives, and have the command of all the common people,
and are, moreover, willing to serve under me, I con-
ceive it a great advance in my government. Since my
return here they have proved themselves faithful and
ready ; but though true in adversity, will they continue
equally so in prosperity ? I hope the best from them,
especially as their circumstances will be easy ; and I
will endeavor to pay them as much as I can. Pay well,
and men may be trusted. Either way, it is a great
1^ EXPEDITION TO HORNF.O.
advance ; for every change will not occur immediately ;
and, in the mean time, I shall be strengthened by in-
comers, especially Chinese, so that the parties may be
balanced, and each look to me as the link which holds
them together. The government must be a patchwork
between good and evil, abolishing only so much of the
latter as is consistent with safety. But never must I
appear in the light of a reformer, political or religious ;
for to the introduction of new customs, apparently trivial,
and the institution of new forms, however beneficial,
the disgust of the semi-barbarous races may be traced.
People settled like myself too often tiy to create a Uto-
pia, and end with a general confusion. The feeling of
the native which binds him to his chief is destroyed,
and no other principle is substituted in its stead ; and as
the human mind more easily learns ill than good, they
pick up the vices of their governors without their vir-
tues, and their own good qualities disappear, the bad of
both races remaining without the good of either.
" We are in active preparation to fit out a fleet to
meet the piratical Dyaks. The rajah has a fine prahu,
which I have taken in hand to repair, and I have pur-
chased a second ; and the two, with three or four small
canoes, will be able to cope with a hundred or a hundred
and fifty Dyak boats. The largest of these boats is worth
a description. Fifty-six feet in length and eight in
breadth ; built with a great sheer, so as to raise the bow
and stern out of the water, and pulling thirty paddles,
she is a dangerous customer when mounting four swivels
and carrying a crew of twenty men with small arms.
She is called the ' Snake,' or ' Ular.' The second boat,
somewhat shorter and less fast, is named the ' Dragon ;'
her complement of paddles twenty, and her fighting-
men twenty, make one hundred and forty in two boats.
The long canoes carry fifteen men each, which will
bring the force up to one hundred and eighty-five ; and
one boat of the rajah's will complete two hundred men,
of whom nearly one hundred are armed with muskets.
" To show the system of these people, I may men-
tion that one of the principal men proposed to me to
send to Sakarran and Sarebus, and intimate that I was
about to attack Siquong (a large interior tribe), and in-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 173
vite them to assist. ' They will all come,' he said : ' noth-
ing they will like so well ; and when they are up the
Samarahan river, we will sally forth, attack, and destroy
them at one blow.' My answer was, that I could not
deceive; but if they did come, I would attack them.
"Feb. 1st. Matari, or ' the Sun,' the Sakarran chief
I have already mentioned, arrived with two boats, and
paid me several visits. He assured me he wanted to
enter into an agreement, to the effect that neither should
injure the other. To this treaty I was obliged to add
th& stipulation, that he was neither to pirate by sea nor
by land, and not to go, under any pretence, into the in-
terior of the country. His shrewdness and cunning
were remarkably displayed. He began by inquiring, if
a tribe, either Sakarran or Sarebus, pirated on my ter-
ritory, what I intended to do. My answer was, ' To
enter their country and lay it waste.' Bnt he asked me
again, ' You will give me, your friend, leave to steal a
few heads occasionally?' 4 No,' I replied, 'you cannot
take a single head ; you cannot enter the country : and
if you or your countrymen do, I will have a hundred
Sakarran heads for every one you take here.' He re-
curred to this request several times : 'just to steal one
or two !' as a schoolboy would ask for apples. There is
no doubt that the two tribes of Sakarran and Sarebus
are greatly addicted to head-hunting, and consider the
possession as indispensable. The more a man has, the
greater his honor and rank ; nor is there anything with-
out to check or ameliorate this barbarous habit ; for the
Malays of all classes, on this coast, take the same pride
in heads as the Dyaks themselves, with the exception
that they do not place them in their houses, or attach
any superstitious ideas to them.
"I a^ked Matari what was the solemn form of agree-
ment among his tribes ; and he assured me the most
solemn was drinking each other's blood, in which case it
was considered they were brothers ; but pledging the
blood of fowls was another and less solemn form.
" On the 26th of January the Royalist's boat, with
Captain Hart and Mr. Penfold, second mate, of the
Viscount Melbourne, arrived here. The reason, it ap-
pears, of the Royalist coming was, to seek the missing
p2
174 EXPEDITION TO BoHNLU,
crew of the Viscount Melbourne, a large ship wrecked
on the Luconia shoal. The captain in the launch, with
some Coolies ; the first and third mates, with Colonel
Campbell of the 37th, M.N.I., in a cutter; the second
mate, Mr. Penfold, and the surgeon, in the second cut-
ter ; a fourth boat with twenty-five Lascars, and the
jolly-boat, making in all five boats, left the vessel well
provisioned, and steered in company for the coast, which
they made somewhere between Borneo and Taujong
Barram. The fourth boat was missed the night they
made the land ; and being all at anchor, and the weather
ne, it was strongly suspected that the twenty-five Las-
s deserted with her.
" The other four boats proceeded a day or two, when
the first cutter, with Colonel Campbell on board, went
in the evening in search of water ; and though the rest
showed lights all night, returned no more. They were,
on the following day, attacked by a prahu, which fired
into them and severely wounded one man, and succeeded
in capturing the jolly-boat ; but finding nothing in her,
set her on fire Lascars and all. The crew, however,
was rescued, and she was abandoned ; and the two re-
maining boats, in course of time, arrived at Singapore.
The Royalist was taken up by government to seek the
missing boats, and just touched here for an hour or two,
the boat coming up while the vessel kept the sea.
" Feb. 9th. Mr. Williamson returned from Sanpro,
where I sent him to watch a party of natives who had
gone among the Dyaks ; the Panglima Sadome, of the
tribe of Sanpro, came with him, and brought the la-
mentable account of the death of eight more Dyaks, cut
off by the Sakarrans. It frets me dreadfully ; however,
on the whole I see a vast improvement, and a degree of
confidence in me arising among the Dyaks, greater than
[ expected.
" 14/7t. 1 have now entered on the most difficult
task, and the one most likely tocau.se. ;m ultimate failure
in my undertaking, but which is indispensably necessary.
I mean, the administration of justice. As long as my
laws are applied to the people of the country, there is
no trouble ; but directly equal justice is administered, it
causes heartburn and evasion : the rajahs and
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 175
raus are surrounded by a gang of followers who hereto-
fore have robbed, plundered, and even murdered, with-
out inquiry being made. It was enough that a follower
of the rajah was concerned, to hush up all wrongs ; and
any of the oppressed, who were bold enough to lodge u
complaint, were sure to rue it. All the rascals and ruf-
fians who follow the great men find this species of pro-
tection the best and the only reward ; and as the slaves
are looked upon as personal property, any punishment
inflicted upon them is likewise inflicted upon their mas-
ters. I have all along foreseen these obstacles, and the
necessity of at once combating them whether success-
fully or not signifies little ; but they must be encountered, .
and the result left to the Almighty.
' Equal justice is the groundwork of society ; and
unless it can be administered, there can be no hope of
ultimate improvement. The country may have bad
laws ; but such laws as it has must be enforced, gently
and mildly as may be toward the superiors, but strictly
toward the guilty; and all crimes coming under my
cognizance must meet with their punishment. These
remarks are preliminary to two cases, in which the
rajah's followers have been concerned.
" The first of these was a man stealing sago, which
is stored without the houses at the water's edge ; he
was convicted. The other occurred some time since,
but has only just been traced. A party at night gutted
a house, getting a booty of upward of 200 reals ; the
goods have been discovered ; but the three followers of
the rajah have absconded since the affair has been
blown ; whether to return or not is uncertain. There
can be no doubt, however, that they have been sent
away to keep clear of the consequences, by one of the
rajah's brothers named Abdul Khadir, who, when they
were ofl', accused two accomplices, people of the
country !
" Another most shameful mode of exaction and tyr-
anny is practiced by these Borneo people, particularly
their Nakodas. It consists in lending small sums of
money to the natives (that is, Sarawak people), and de-
manding interest at the rate of fifty per cent per month ;
by this means a small sum is quickly converted into one
176 EXPEDITION TO BO11NEO,
which is quite out of the power of the poor man to pay ;
and he, his wife, and children, are taken to the house
of the creditor to work for him, while the debt still ac-
cumulates, and the labor is endless. I intend to strike
at this slavery in disguise, but not just yet; the sup-
pression of robbery, the criminal department of justice,
being more immediately important.
" 15th I may, in continuation of yesterday, mention
another instance in illustration of this oppressive system.
Si Pata (a Siniawan), son of the Tumangong, lost in
gambling to Nakoda Ursat eighteen reals, which in
eighteen months has now arisen to a debt of 170 reals;
but all prospect of payment of such an accumulated sum
being impossible from a poor man, Nakoda Ursat con-
signs the debt to Pangeran Abdul Khadir, who can de-
mand it by fair means or by foul ; and if Si Pata cannot
pay, make his father pay. Thus a gambling transaction
is run up to ten times its original amount, and a whole
family involved in distress by these iniquitous proceed-
ings. Such things must not be ; and odious as they
seem to a European, and indignant as they make him,
yet he must not proceed with the strong hand. Re-
flection, too, teaches us that vice is comparative ; and in
forming a judgment, we must not forget a man's educa-
tion, the society in which he lives, the absence of re-
straint, and the force of example from childhood ; so
that what would be heinous in a Christian long under a
settled government, is light by comparison in a Malay,
who is a nominal professor of Islam, and brought up with
the idea that might makes right, and has no one external
cause to deter him from crime.
" March 12th. On the whole getting on very well,
but with many reasons for vexation, and more for anxi-
ety. The chief of these is, whether Mr. Bonham will
come here, as I have suggested, or rather pressed.
Another feature of inquietude is from the Chinese of
Sipang, who certainly aim at greater power than I shall
allow them, and perhaps, some day or other, it will come
to a struggle,
" Petty troubles I do not reckon, though there are
enow on all sides, and for the last few days I have felt
as if sinking under them ; but that is not my usual tern-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 177
perament. I now look impatiently for intelligence.
Blow, fair breezes, and waft Royalist here !
"25^. A period -of 'wearing uncertainty since my
last, having news neither of the Royalist nor of Mr.
Bonham, and kept on the qui vive by a schooner or two
at the entrance of the river. The plot thickens in and
around ; and for the sake of keeping up a register of
events in something like order, I will here mention the
leading features. Seriff Sahib, of Sadong, pretends to
be friendly, but is treacherous in his heart, as is his
brother, Seriff Muller of Sakarran. We have been
quite clear of Dyaks, and our own tribes enjoying rest
nnd peace; and one tribe from without, namely Serang,
has come in and claimed my protection. The only
tribe at all troublesome is the Singd, the chtef of which
(the Orang Kaya Parembam) is decidedly opposed to
me, and swears by Macota. I am given to believe,
however, that the majority of his people do not agree
with him ; and I shall dispossess him of his dignity, and
substitute a friendly chief. The Singe Dyaks are the
most powerful and numerous in my territory, and the
only ones who have not been attacked and plundered by
the Sakarrans.
" At Lundu are the Sjbnowan Dyaks, under the
Orang Kaya Tumangong ; and the Lundu Dyaks, once
a flourishing tribe, now, by ill-treatment of all sorts,
reduced to twenty persons. I may mention among my
other difficulties, that many, nay most, of the Dyak tribes
are held as private property : any rascally Borneon mak-
ing a present to the sultan, gets a grant of a Dyak tribe,
originally to rule, now to plunder or sell ; and in this
way the portion of the Sibnowans settled at Lundu are
under Bandar Surnsu ; but, being a resolute people, he
cannot do them much wrong. This Bandar Sumsu has
lately been disturbing the Lundu Dyaks in the follow-
ing manner : a Sibnowan Dyak lived with the Lundu
Dyaks, which gave him an opening to demand of the
Lundus the sura of fifty reals (100 rupees), which was
paid; but unluckily the Sibnowan died in the course
of a few months, still with the Lundus, and a farther
sum of eighty reals, or 160 rupees, was demanded,
which not toing raised, the daughter of one of the
12
178 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
head people was seized, and sold for that sum to a
Chinaman !
" Pangeran Macota has likewise been injuring these
poor people, though I shall find it difficult to bring it
home to him. His agent, Bandar Dowud (a man in-
volved in debt), took fifteen Dyak cloths and sold them,
or rather forced them to take them, at an exorbitant
rate ; in a month or two after, he returns and demands
200 reals over and above the large price already paid
for articles worth seven or eight reals ; the poor Dyaks
not being able to pay, he seizes the chief's daughter (a
married woman), and demands four other women in
lieu of the sum. Happily for the poor Dyaks, this
news came to my ears, and I sent to Lundu in haste.
They had all fled, having stolen their two women, one
from each Bandar, and carried them away. On the
Patingi and Tumangong reaching Lundu, they found
two of the tribe, one the Pangeran, the other the father
of the girl sold to the Chinaman, after a long search in
the jungle. These two men I have now with me, and
wait for the Orang Kaya Tumangong before going into
the case. The Pangeran is the same Dyak whose
conversation I have detailed at large on my first visit to
the place. He is a man of intelligence ; and this tribe
(if it may yet be so called) has always borne the
character of being the most hospitable and generous
among the Dyaks. I may at some future time revert to
them.
" There is a rumor of war between the Sarebus and
Sakarran Dyaks, in consequence of the former tribe
seizing a Balow woman on the territory of the latter,
and refusing to restore her. Let these two predatory
tribes employ and weaken one another, and it will be
well for us and all the other people of this country, and
they will afterward be the more easily brought into sub-
jection.
" From Borneo we have news, but as uncertain as
everything else regarding the capital. A hundred ves-
sels, it is reported, are coming to attack them ; and
they, in consequence, are building a fort. The Royalist
had been then? and departed.
Vsop. it is said, \vsis about to rnmn here.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 179
when the arrival of the Royalist induced lura to post-
pone his design.
" There is every reason to believe that the Chinese
of Sambas, particularly those of Montrado, are extremely
dissatisfied ; and a report yesterday states that a man
sent by the sultan to demand gold had been kUled by
them, and that the sultan's letter to the Kunsi, after
being defiled, was publicly burned. Our own Chinese
of Sipang are certainly intriguing with Sambas ; and, as
the rajah well expresses it, ' their clothes-box is here,
but their treasure-chest is at Sambas.'
" It is impossible to say what quantity of gold the
Kunsi may get ; but their pretence that they get none
must be false, when every common Malay obtains from
half to one bunkal per month.
" To counteract the chance of evil, I have intimated
that the Simbock Kunsi are to come here ; and on the
whole, they (of Sipang) have taken it more quietly than
I expected. They are not in a state for war; but they
have vague notions and intentions provided they can keep
out opposition, to make this place subservient to them,
as it would indeed be, provided they were allowed to
strengthen themselves while the other parties remained
stationary. But ' divide and rule' is a good motto in my
case ; and the Chinese have overlooked the difference
between this country and Sambas. There they have
numerous rivers in the vicinity of their settlements
here but one ; and, the Dyak population being against
them, starvation would soon reduce them to terms. The
Royalist arrived about the end of March, and sailed
again on the 9th April.
" I have before mentioned the difficulty of adminis-
tering justice ; and experience teaches me that the risk
to myself, on this score, is more to be apprehended than
on any other. The forms I have not much alluded to ;
and the following is as nearly as possible the Malay cus-
tom : The rajah's brothers and myself sit at one end of
the long room in my house ; at the sides are the Patin-
gis and Tumangong, and other respectable people ; in
file center the parties concerned; and, behind them, any-
body who wishes to be present. We hear both par-
ties ; question, if necessary ; and decide and from this
180 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
decision there is no appeal. One only condition I in-
sist upon ; and that is, that in any intricate case, or
whenever I dread confederacy, I do not allow the wit-
nesses to hear each other. The laws of evidence, in a
free country, prohibit any leading questions being put to
witnesses : here, for the purposes of justice, it is indis-
pensable ; for the people, being ruled by fear, and ap-
prehensive of consequences, often falter before the face
of the accused, and their testimony has to be wrung from
them. To decide also according to the technicalities of
construction would be here ridiculous, and defeat the
ends of justice. The people are rude and uncivilized ;
their oppressors crafty and bold, who have no hesitation
about lying, and bringing others to lie for them. Oaths
are a farce to them. The aggrieved are timid, vacilla-
ting, and simple, and cannot readily procure even ne-
cessary evidence ; for their witnesses are afraid to speak.
Under these circumstances, I look at the leading fea-
tures of the case, the probability, the characters, the
position of parties, and determine according to my judg-
ment. It is not, indeed, a very difficult task ; for the
disputes are generally glaring, and, when bolstered up,
usually fail in their most important links ; and at a
touch of cross-questioning, the witnesses, resolved to
tell the same stoiy, fall into opposite ones. In one case,
about a slave, three witnesses had resolved on the sex ;
but, questioned separately as to size and age, all disa-
greed. They were not prepared. One represented
her a woman grown and marriageable ; another, as high
as my walking-stick ; the third, a little child.
" 1 have now on hand a serious matter, of robbery to
a large extent, and three of the rajah's followers are
implicated. Would it were over and well! but done
it must be. How little can those at a distance know
my difficulties alone, unaided, the unceasing attention
by day, the anxiety and sleeplessness by night, the
mountain of doubt upon mountain piled, and the uncer-
tainty of necessary support or assistance !
" The Pangeran of the Lundu Dyaks lived with me
three weeks, and I was able to do him substantial jus-
tice ; and hope for the future that his life, and that of the
remnant of his tribe, may be rendered more endurable.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 181
"His residence with me was doubly advantageous,
as it enabled me to ascertain his character, and him to
see something of our habits nnd manners. The impres-
sion on my part was highly favorable ; for I found him
a quiet, intelligent man, and a keen observer; and I
believe the impression he received was equally favora-
ble. The poetry of the Dyak expressions is remark-
able ; and, like most wild people, they seem to delight
in oratory, and to be a good deal swayed by it. For
hours I have talked with the Pangeran, listened to his
history, heard his complaints, sympathized in the mis-
fortunes of his tribe, and shuddered at the wrongs and
sufferings they have endured. 'We are few,' he ex-
claimed, ' and therefore our oppressions are aggravated;
the same demands are made upon us as though we
were many, and we have not the means of resisting or
complying. We fly to the jungle; we are like deer
we have no home, no perch. Our wives and children
are taken from us ; our sufferings are very great,' On
another occasion he said, ' I have felt my sufferings to
be so great, that I wished to die, if Jovata would permit
it. 1 wished to die; for I remembered how happy we
were once, and how miserable now.' I could dwell
largely on these and suchlike language and descrip-
tions, which appear to me highly pathetic and touching
at least I found them so in reality; and I cannot
forbear adding one or two more such, highly charac-
teristic.
" ' Our home,' said the Pangeran, 'was a happy one;
none who came to us wanted. The fruit on the trees
was saved ; the fish in the river near us was never de-
stroyed. Rice was plenty ; if it was scarce, we kept it,
and fed ourselves upon vegetables, that we might give it
to those who visited our habitation. The fish, the fruit,
and the rice were preserved,* that the men of the seas
(Malays) might eat of them ; yet they had no pity on
us. We were free men, yet they treated us worse than
slaves. We are now but few ; and unless you protect
us, we shall soon cease to be.' Again : ' The Tuman-
* This 1 found on inquiry, to be strictly true a most amiablo
trait ' B.
Q
18*<J EXI'EIMTKJX TO BORNEO.
gong was severe to us ; and when Macota came, he said
the Tumangong w r as a bad man, and he would shield
us ; but he was much worse than the Tumangong.
Now, you say you will cherish us ; we believe you ;
but you are at a distance, and perhaps may not be able.'
Further: 'Pangeran Macota kept me nine months in
his house, and wanted to make me a slave ; but I es-
caped, and traveled through the woods, and swam the
rivers, till I came to my own country. He thought the
Dyak had no eyes except in the jungle ; he thought he had
no ears except to listen to the bird of omen ; he thought
he had no wit except to grow rice ; but the Dyak saw,
and heard, and understood, that while his words were
sweet, his heart was crooked, and that, whether they
were men of the sea or Dyaks, he deceived them with
fair sayings ; he said one thing to one man, and another
to a second ; he deceived with a honied mouth. I saw
and understood it all while I lived in his house. How
could I trust him afterward ?' These expressions were
concluded by significantly twisting his two fore-fingers
round each other, to show the intrigues that were car-
ried on. I grew very fond of this poor naked savage ;
for if honesty and a kind heart entitle a man to our
esteem, he is worthy of it.
" I had a long conference with Si Nimook, the Sow
Dyak, and hope to recover his wife. Amid all the
wealth and all the charity of England, how well be-
stowed would a small portion be for the purpose of re-
storing one hundred and fifty women and children to
their husbands and parents, and releasing them from
slavery ! A small rill from the plenteous river would
cheer this distant misery, and bestow the blessing of
fertility on the now barren soil of these poor Dyaks.
Oh, that I had the brass to beg to draw out a piteous
tale so as to touch the heart !"
KXI'KDITION TO BORNEO. 183
CHAPTER XIII.
Ascent of the left-hand river to the Stabad. Remarkable cave
in the Tubbang. Diamond works at Simtah. Return. In-
fested by Dyak pirates. A meeting of prahus, and fight. Se-
riff Sahib's treatment of the Suntah Dyaks. Expedition
against the Singe. Their invasion of the Sigos, and taking
heads. The triumph over these trophies. Arms and modes
of war. Hot and cold council-houses. Ceremonies in the
installation of the Orang Kaya Steer Rajah. Meeting of
various Dyak tribes. Hostile plans of Seriff Sahib, and their
issue. Resolves to proceed to Borneo Proper.
THE next portion of Mr. Brooke's Journal details
another excursion up the country, and then proceeds
to describe the early incidents of his infant government.
As he advanced on his way, affairs began to assume more
important aspects ; and yet they could hardly be painted
with greater force or interest than in his simple notes.
" April 25th. Ascended the left-hand river, in order
to introduce the Kunsi Simbock to their new territory ;
passed the night on a pebbly bank ; moon at full, bright
and unclouded, tinging the luxuriant foliage, and glan-
cing on the clear rapid stream. Four distinct and dis-
tant races met on this lonely and lovely spot English,
Chinese, Malays, and Dyaks ! What a scope for
poetry and reflection the time, the clime, the spot,
and the company !
" 26th. After our morning meal and bath, entered
the small river Stabad, which, according to report, runs
from a source two or three days' journey further into
the interior. At present it is so obstructed by fallen
trees, that we were forced to return, after ascending
about four miles. We left our boats near its entrance,
and walked to the small but steep mountain, Tubbang.
Its length may be about 400 feet. After mounting, by
a winding path, about half-way up toward the top, we
arrived at the entrance of a cave, into which we de-
scended through a hole. It is fifty or sixty feet long,
and the far end is supported on a colonnade of stalac-
tites, and opens on a sheer precipice of 100 or 150 feet.
Henoe the spectator can overlook the distant scene ;
the forest lies at his feet, and only a few trees growing
184 KXPEIHTlo.V Tu BOttNEO.
from the rock reach nearly to the level of the grotto.
The effect is striking and panoramic ; the grotto cheer-
ful ; floored with fine sand ; the roof groined like Gothic,
whence the few clear drops which filter through form
here and there the fantastic stalactites common to such
localities. The natives report the cave to be the resi-
dence of a fairy queen ; and they show her bed, pillow,
and other of her household furniture. Within the cave
we found a few remnants of human bones ; probably
some poor Dyak who had crawled there to die.
" Having finished our survey of the place, and wan-
dered sufficiently about the mount, we reembarked,
and dropped a short way down the river, and started
again into the jungle to look for antimony ore, but
without success, our guide having forgotten the road.
After a couple of hours' wandering, the latter part in a
heavy storm of rain, we reached the boats ; and I
thence ascended to Suntah, where we were all glad to
house ourselves, as the deluge continued.
" 27th. I will say nothing of my works at Suntah,
except that they run away with my money, are badly
conducted by my Chinese hadji, and, above all, that J
have great reason to suspect the integrity and steadi-
ness of this said hadji. 1 must therefore make up my
mind either to change him when the business is finished,
or to watch him very narrowly ; for the honesty of a
diamond-worker, like the virtue of Caesar's wife, must
be above suspicion, or he must be watched closely ;
but how ?
" 28th. Descended the river, and, arriving at Sara-
wak, found both work and cause for inquietude. The
rnjah had heard of Dyak pirates, and dispatched four
boats, two large and two small : the Snake, weakly
manned by the Tumangong's people, and the rest led
by Pangerans (who neither work nor fight^ and a
wretched crew, chiefly Borneons. Mr. Crimble, tak-
ing my servant Peter and four Javanese, went most
imprudently in the second of the large boats. The
whole, being dispatched in haste (foolish haste), insuf-
ficiently provided in every respect, may fall into trouble,
and involve me in very unpleasant circumstances.
" The other cause for uneasiness is the attack of a
i:xi'i:uiTio\ TO BORNEO. 185
Chinese boat ut the mouth of the river. The boat that
attacked her is a small one, with eight or terr men,
which came out of Sadong, and had been lying here for
a week or more. She is commanded by a Pangeran
named Badrudeen, has some Illanuns on board, and is
bound on a piratical cruise. As she descended the
river, she met with the small China boat, likewise from
Sambas, with eight men, which she treacherously as-
sailed, desperately wounding one man and severely
another ; but the China boat's consort heaving in sight,
the pirate pulled away. 1 must redress this, if it be in
my power ; and have ordered the Datus to gather men
to follow the rascals, as it is probable they will be lurk-
ing not far from hence. In the mean time it gave me
great pain dressing the hurts of these poor Chinese,
one of whom I think must die, being cut along the back
and side across the body from the side nearly to the
backbone, a ghastly gaping wound, beside having his
arm slashed through. The other man is very severely,
and perhaps, without medical attendance, mortally,
hurt, having his arm half cut through at the muscular
development between the shoulder and elbow poor
fellow ! I must say for the Chinese, they seem very
grateful for any attention shown them.
" 29th. My birthday. Men collected, and to-morrow
we start for Telang Telang. This morning, much to
my relief, our fleet returned, after an encounter with
thirteen Dyak boats. About one o'clock on the 28th,
pulling into a bay between Morotaba and Tanjong Poe,
they came unexpectedly on them. One Borneon boat
had lagged behind ; the Pangeran who commanded de-
serted the second, and sought refuge with the Tuman-
gong, trying to induce him to fly ; and the crew of the
third, a large boat with my two Europeans on board,
was, by their account, in a state of fear, which totally
incapacitated them from acting. All rose, none would
pull ; all shouted, none would serve the guns ; all com-
manded, none obeyed ; most were screaming out to run ;
all bellowing out, in hopes of frightening the enemy ;
none to direct the helm. The Tumangong, with only
seventeen men in all, insisted on. advance ; and the Bor-
neons, encouraged by threats from the Europeans, and
) KXI'KDITIn.X 'J'O BORNKU.
the good example of the Javanese, did not fly. The
two boats opened their fire ; the Dyaks retreated in
confusion and alarm : but from the tumult, the noise,
and the rocking of the boat, Mr. Crimble could only fire
three times with the bow six-pounder carronade, and
from other guns loaded with grape and canister, while
the rascally Borneons never fired at all. The Dyaks
suffered loss, and left behind them clothes, rice, fish,
cooking-pots, swords, &c. ; and, considering the state of
the Borneons, it was lucky the dread of our prowess put
them to flight so easily. Crimble assured me that, with
a Siniawan crew, he could have destroyed half their
force. The Dyaks behaved very well, pulling off with
great steadiness and without noise.
" June 20th The events of the month may be com-
pressed into a narrative comprising the internal and ex-
ternal.
" The internal state of the country is decidedly im-
proving and flourishing, and bears the aspect of gradu-
ally increasing prosperity. Justice has been strictly
administered. Robberies, which a few months ago were
of nightly occurrence, are now rarely heard of; and that
vile intriguing to make poor people slaves, from debt or
false claims, is entirely stopped.
" The people who had scattered at the close of the
war have been collected, and are building their houses a
short way up the river at the Campong Jekiso, which,
when finished, will be a neat-looking village.
"The Pangeran Macota is intriguing; but as ho is
sure to do that, it need not be insisted upon.
" Muda Hassim is true and agreeable, and entirely
reconciled to the Patingi and Tumangongs ; so far.
indeed, nothing can be better than our internal state :
there is peace, there is plenty; the poor are not harassed,
and justice is done to all.
" The Dyaks of the interior are improving and con-
tent, and gaining courage daily to complain of any wrong
that may be offered them. To the sena, or forced
trade, I have almost put a stop, by confiscating the goods
wherever met with ; and this plan once acted on, the
Dyaks have not been slow to bring me bundles ofbidongs
(Dyak cloths), iron, mid tho liko.
I :.\l> EDITION TO BOKM.o. 187
" The tribes that continue unsettled are the Suntah
and Singe : the affairs of the latter I will mention here-
after.
" Suntah lias been for a long time under the govern-
ment of Seriff Sahib of Sadong, and through his pater-
nal charge has dwindled away from four hundred to
fifty or sixty families. Shortly after my assuming the
reins of government, he dispatched (according to cus-
tom) a mixed party of Malays and Dyaks, and falling on
my helpless tribe of Sanpro, killed some, and carried
away twenty women and children into captivity. I was
not strong enough to resent the injury ; but wrote him
a strong letter, demanding the women, and telling him he
was not to send, under any pretext, into my country. The
women I did not get ; but I heard that the communica-
tion frightened him : for, of course, they deem I am
backed by all the power of my country. While the
Royalist still lay here, I heard that his people were
raising the revenue from the Suntah Dyaks ; but it
must be remarked, that the Suntah are on the edge of
my territory, having left the former location. As this
was done in the face of my caution not to intermeddle
without my consent, I resolved at once to put the matter
to the issue ; and having armed four boats, went up and
seized all the rice and padi collected for my neighbors'
use. The Suntah Dyaks were and are alarmed to a
pitiable degree ; for they fear Seriff Sahib with good
reason ; and yet my being on the spot gave them no op-
tion of evading my demand. Thus the matter was
brought to a crisis ; and having taken the revenue (as it
was called) for the poor Dyaks themselves, I shall be
able to keep them from starvation, to the verge of which,
so early in the season, they are already reduced. The
Dyaks remain unsettled; but I am now in hopes of
bringing them to the interior of the Quop, which is fur-
ther within our own territory. Muda Hassim wrote to
Seriff Sahib to tell him the Dyaks were no longer his,
but mine; and Seriff Sahib, sore-hearted, conspired
against us, and held for some time a higher tone than
his wont.
" I shall now narrate my proceedings at the mountain
of Singe, from which T have just returned. The moun-
188 K X I' EDITION To ]) O U \ K ( ) .
tain, with its groves of fruit-trees, has been already de-
scribed ; and as a preface to my present description, I
must particularize the circumstances of the Dyak tribe
of Singe. The tribe consists of at least 800 males, the
most ignorant, and therefore the most wild, of the Dyaks
of my country ; and, from their position, they have never
been overcome or ruined, and are therefore a rich com-
munity, and proportionately independent. Their old
chief is by name Parembam, and the Panglima, or head-
warrior, his younger brother, by name Si Tummo.
These men have for a very long time ruled this tribe ;
and the elder has certainly acquired from the Malays a
portion of cunning and intrigue, and lost the general
simplicity of the native Dyak character. He is unques-
tionably a man of ability. His sway, however, on the
mountain has for a long time been unpopular; and a
large proportion of the people, dissatisfied with his ex-
tortions, have been attached to a younger chief, by name
Bibit. Some time past, finding it impossible to manage
this old chief, Parembam, and being convinced that the
change might readily be made, I called Bibit, and made
him chief, or Orang Kaya of tho tribe. Parembam nei-
ther was nor is inclined to give up his authority without
a struggle ; and though the mass adhere to the new
chief, by title ' Steer Rajah,' yet Parembam's long-
established customs, his great wealth, and his talents,
render him a dangerous old man to the younger leader.
One quality, however, Parembam is deficient in. as well
as his brother the Panglima, and that is bravery ; and
on this much depends in a Dyak tribe. Steer Rajah,
on the contrary, has always been renowned in war, and
is the envied possessor of many heads. The Dyaks
have among them a fashion which they call bunkit, or
vaunting ; for instance, in the present case Steer Rajah
and Parembam dared each other to go on excursions to
procure heads, i. e. against their enemies this is bun-
kit. One of Steer Rajah's followers went accordingly,
and quickly procured tho head of a hostile warrior far
out of my territory ; and on the return of tho party,
Parembam in turn sent forty men to Simpoko, which is
a tribe attached to Samarahan, and on our immediate
border. Close to the Dyaks of Sim poke live a party of
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 189
the Sigo Dyaks, who belong to me ; and this party of
Parembam's, confounding friends and enemies, killed
some of the Sigo Dyaks how many is not certain. The
Sigos, taking the alarm, cut off their retreat, and killed
two of the Singe Dyaks ; and many beside were wound-
ed by sudas and ranjows, and, all broken, fled back to
their own country. Thus, though they obtained five
heads, they lost two, and those belonging to their prin-
cipal warriors. This news reaching me, I hurried up to
the hill, and arrived just after part of the war-party had
brought the heads.
" I may here remark, that I have positively forbidden
the Dyak tribes within my territory to war one upon
the other; and this, therefore, was a serious offence
against me on the part of Parembam. At once to aim
at more than this restriction would be fruitless, and even
risk my ability to effect this first step on the road to im-
provement. I likewise came up here to go through the
ceremony of installing the Orang Kaya Steer Rajah in
his office ; and thus I have had an excellent opportunity
of seeing their customs and manners. What follows will
be a personal narration, or nearly so, of what I have
seen ; and it applies, with slight difference, to almost all
the interior tribes.
" On our ascending the mountain, we found the five
heads carefully watched, about half a mile from the
town, in consequence of the non-arrival of some of the
war-party. They had erected a temporary shed close
to the place where these miserable remnants of noisome
mortality were deposited ; and they were guarded by
about thirty young men in their finest dresses, composed
piincipally of scarlet jackets ornamented with shells,
turbans of the native bark-cloth dyed bright yellow, and
spread on the head, and decked with an occasional fea-
ther, flower, or twig of leaves. Nothing can exceed
their partiality for these trophies ; and in retiring from
the ' war-path,' the man who has been so fortunate as
to obtain a head hangs it about his neck, and instantly
commences his return to his tribe. If he sleep on the
way, the precious burden, though decaying and offen-
sive, is not loosened, but rests on his lap, while his head
(and nose!) reclines on his knees. The retreat is al-
190 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
ways silently made until close to home, when they set
up a wild yell, which announces their victory and the
possession of its proofs. It must, therefore, be consid-
ered, that these bloody trophies are the evidences of
victory the banner of the European, the flesh-pot of
the Turk, the scalp of the North American Indian and
that they are torn from enemies, for taking heads is the
effect and not the cause of war. On our reaching the
Balei, or public hall, of the Orang Kaya Steer Rajah, I
immediately called a number of their chiefs together,
and opened a conference with them on the subject of
Parembam having attacked and killed the Dyaks of
Sigo. They all disapproved of it most highly, asserting
that the Sigos were their younger brothers ; that no
sufficient cause had ever existed ; that Parembam had
acted badly, and must pay to purchase peace. Were
they, I asked, willing to force Parembam into payment ?
They were. Would they insist on the heads being re-
stored to the Sigos, and receive those of their own
people ? They would !
" It may be observed, that their causes for war, as
well as its progress and termination, are exactly the same
as those of other people. They dispute about the limits
of their respective lands ; about theft committed by one
tribe upon another ; about occasional murders ; the
crossing each other on the war-path ; and about a
thousand other subjects.
" When a tribe is on a warlike excursion, it often
happens that their track (or ' trail') is crossed by another
tribe. Those who strike the trail guard it at some con-
venient spot, apprehending the party to be enemies ;
they plant ranjows in the path, and wait till the return-
ing party are involved among them to make an attack.
If enemies, and they succeed, all is well ; but if friends,
though no attack be made, it is a serious offence, and
mostly gives occasion to war if not paid for. The pro-
gress of the contest consists in attacking each other by
these surprises, particularly about the time of sowing,
weeding, and cutting the rice-crops. When one party
is weaker, or less active, or less warlike than the other,
they solicit a peace through some tribe friendly to both,
and pay for the lives they have taken : the price is about
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 191
two gongs, value 33* reals, for each life : thus peace is
concluded. This is the custom with these Dyaks uni-
versally; but it is otherwise with the Sarebus and
Sakarran. But Sarebus and Sakarran are not fair
examples of Dyak life, as they are pirates as well as
head-hunters, and do not hesitate to destroy all persons
they meet with.
" Parembam, having been called before me, declared
that these heads belonged to the Simpoke Dyaks, and
that they had not attacked the Sigos. As I was not
quite certain of the fact, I thought it unjust to proceed
against him till I had stronger proof.
" On the following morning the heads were brought
up to the village, attended by a number of young men
all dressed in their best, and were carried to Parembam's
house amid the beating of gongs and the firing of one or
two guns. They were then disposed of in a conspicuous
place in the public hall of Parembam. The music
sounded and the men danced the greater part of the day;
and toward evening carried them away in procession
through all the campongs except three or four just about
me. The women, in these processions, crowd round
the heads as they proceed from house to house, and put
sirih and betel-nut in the mouths of the ghastly dead,
and welcome them ! After this they are carried back
in the same triumph, deposited in an airy place, and left
to dry. During this process, for seven, eight, or ten
days, they are watched by the boys of the age of six to
ten years ; and during this time they never stir from the
public hall they are not permitted to put their foot out
of it while engaged in this sacred trust. Thus are the
youths initiated.
"For a long time after the heads are hung up, the
men nightly meet and beat their gongs, and chant ad-
dresses to them, which were rendered thus to me :
* Your head is in our dwelling, but your spirit wanders
to your own country.' ' Your head and your spirit are
now ours : persuade, therefore, your countrymen to be
slain by us.' ' Speak to the spirits of your tribe : let
them wander in the fields, that when we come again to
their country we may get more heads, and that we may
bring the heads of your brethren, and hang them by your
192 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
head,' &c. The tone of this chant is loud and monoto-
nous, and I am not able to say how long it is sung ; but
certainly for a month after the arrival of the heads, as
one party here had had a head for that time, and were
still exhorting it.
' These are their customs and modes of warfare ;
and I may conclude by saying that, though their trophies
are more disgusting, yet their wars are neither so bloody,
nor their cruelties so great, as those of the North Amer-
ican Indian. They slay all they meet with of their
enemies men, women, and children ; but this is com-
mon to all wild tribes. They have an implacable spirit
of revenge as long as the war lasts, retort evil for evil,
and retaliate life lor life ; and, as I have before said,
the heads are the trophies, as the scalps are to the red
men. But, on the contrary, they never torture their
enemies, nor do they devour them : and peace can
always be restored among them by a very moderate
payment. In short, there is nothing new in their feel-
ings, or in their mode of showing them ; no trait re-
markable for -cruelty ; no head-hunting for the sake of
head-hunting. They act precisely on the same im-
pulses as other wild men : war arises from passion or
interest ; peace from defeat or fear. As friends, they
are faithful, just, and honest ; as enemies, blood-thirsty
and cunning, patient on the war-path, and enduring
fatigue, hunger, and want of sleep, with cheerfulness
and resolution. As woodmen they are remarkably
acute ; and on all their excursions carry with them a
number of ranjows, which, when they retreat, they
stick in behind them, at intervals, at a distance of twenty,
fifty, or a hundred yards, so that a hotly-pursuing ene-
my gets checked, and many severely wounded. Their
arms consist of a sword, an iron-headed spear, a few
wooden spears, a knife worn at the right side, with a
sirih-pouch, or small basket. Their provision is a par-
ticular kind of sticky rice, boiled in bamboos. When
once they have struck their enemies, or failed, they re-
turn, without pausing, to their homes.
"To proceed with my journal. My principal object
in coming up the hill was, to appoint the Orang Kaya
Steer Rajah as the rhir-f, Imside Png'ise ns Panplima.
KXTEUITlUN TO HOKNKO. 193
or head warrior, and Pa Bobot as Pangeran, or revenue
officer. It was deemed by these worthy personages
quite unfit that this ceremony should take place in tlie
public hall or circular house, ns that was the place
wherein the heads are deposited, and where they hold
councils of war.
" With the Dyaks, all council is divided into hot and
cold ; peace, friendship, good intentions, are all included
under the latter head war, &c., are under the former.
Hot is represented by red, and cold by white. So in
everything they make this distinction ; and as the public
hall is the place for war-councils and war-trophies, it is
hot in the extreme, unfit for friendly conference. A
shed was therefore erected close to the Orang Kaya's
house, wherein the ceremony was to take place. About
nine in the evening we repaired to the scene ; loud mu-
sic, barbai-ous but not unpleasing, resounded, and we
took our seats on mats in the midst of our Dyak friends.
A feast was in preparation ; and each guest (if I may
call them such) brought his share of rice in bamboos,
and laid it on the general stock. As one party came up
after another, carrying their burning logs, the effect was
very good ; and they kept arriving until the place and
its vicinity was literally crammed with human beings.
A large antique sirih-box was placed in the midst ; and
I contributed that greatest of luxuries, tobacco.
" The feast, in the mean time, was in preparation, some
of the principal people being employed in counting the
number who were to eat, and dividing the bamboos into
exactly equal portions for each person. About six inches
were allotted to every man ; and it took a very long
time to divide it, for they are remarkably particular as
to the proper size and quantity to each share. The
bamboos of rice being, however, at length satisfactorily
disposed, the Orang Kaya produced as his share a large
basin full of sauce, composed of salt and chilis, and a small
stock of sweetmeats ; and then the ceremony of his in-
stallation commenced as follows :
" A jacket, a turban, a cloth for the loins, and a kria
(all of white) were presented to the chief as a token of
sejiek dingin, or cold, i. e. good. The chief then rose,
and, taking a white fowl and waving it over the eatables,
13 R
194 KXI'EDITION TO BORNEO.
repeated nearly the following words : (The commence-
ment, however, is curious enough to dwell upon : the
opening is a sort of invocation, beginning with the
phrase, ' Samungut, Simungi.' Samungut is a Malay
word, Simungi signifying the same in Dyak ; the exact
meaning it is difficult to comprehend ; but it is here
understood as some principle, spirit, or fortune, which
is in men and things. Thus the Dyaks, in stowing their
rice at harvest, do it with great care, from a superstitious
feeling that the Simungi of the padi will escape. They
now call -this principle to be present that of men, of
pigs (their favorite animal), of padi, and of fruits. They
particularly mimed my Simungi, that of my ancestors,
of the Pangeran from Borneo, of the Dafcis and of their
ancestors, and of the ancestors of their own tribe. They
call them that is, their Simuugi to be present. They
then call upon Jovata to grant their prayer, that the
great man from Europe, and the Datus, might hold the
government for a length of time) ' May the govern-
ment be cold' (good) ; ' May there be rice in our
houses ;' ' May many pigs be killed ;' ' May male chil-
dren be born to us ;' ' May fruit ripen ;' 4 May we be
happy, and our goods abundant ;' ' We declare ourselves
to be true to the great man and the Datus : what they
wish we will do, what they command is our law.'
Having said this nnd much more, the fowl was taken
by a leading Malay, who repeated the latter words,
while others bound strips of white cloth round the heads
of the multitude. The fowl was then killed, the blood
shed in a bamboo, and each man dipping his finger in
the blood, touched his forehead and breast, in attesta-
tion of his fidelity. The fowl was now earned away to
be cooked : and when brought back, placed with the
rest of the feast, and the dancing commenced. The
chief, coming forward, uttered a loud yell ending in
' ish,' which was oftentimes repeated during the dance.
He raised his hands to his forehead, and taking a dish,
commenced dancing to lively music. Three other old
chief men followed his example ; each uttering the yell
and making the salute, but without taking the dish.
They danced with arms extended, turning the body
frequently, taking very mall step? und liitl'- mon- than
i:\L'HIHTJO\ TO BUKMlo. 195
lifting their feet from the ground. Thus they turned
backward and forward, passed in and out of the inner
rooms, and frequently repeating the yell, and making
the salutation to me. The dish, in the mean time, was
changed from one to the other : there was little variety,
no gesticulation, no violence ; and, though not deficient
in native grace, yet the movements were by no means
interesting. The dance over, the feast commenced ;
and everything was carried on with great gravity and
propriety. I left them shortly after they began to eat,
and retired, very fagged, to my bed, or rather, to my
board ; for sitting cross-legged for several hours is surely
a great infliction.
" I may add to this account that, while writing it, the
Dyak land-tribes of Siquong, Sibaduh, and Goon, sent
their deputies to me. These people are not under any
Malay government, and it is now for the first time they
have trusted themselves as far as Sarawak. They have
an objection to drinking the river-water, and expressed
great surprise at the flood-tide. Their confidence is
cheering to me, and will, I trust, be advantageous to
themselves. Their trade in rice is very considerable :
and toward Sambas they exchange eight or ten pasus of
rice for one of salt.
" Our conference was pleasing. They desired pro-
tection, they desired trade. ' They had all heard, the
whole world had heard, that a son of Europe was a friend
to the Dyaks.' My visitors drank Batavia arrack with
great gusto, declaring all the time it was not half so
good as their own ; however, at a pinch anything will
do. Some other Dyaks met these strangers ; they
were not adversaries, and so they chewed sirih, and
drank grog in company ; but among enemies this may
not be : they can neither eat nor drink in company
without desiring a reconciliation. I may add, that the
Siquong tribe consists of at least four hundred families,
with forty public halls, or baleis, for heads. A Dyak
family cannot be estimated at fewer than twelve people,
which will give four thousand eight hundred or five
thousand people. Sibaduh and Goon may be about
seventy-five families : beside these, Si Panjong and Sam
Penex want to come in to me, which will give one hun-
190 EXPEDITION TO BOKMEO.
dred and one more families. What might be done with
these people, if I had a little more power and a little
assistance !
" I was going to close my account of the Dyaks ; but
I had scarcely penned the last sentence when a large
party of Singe Dyaks and five Dyaks of Sigo arrived
thus all these enemies meeting. In the conference
which followed, the Singe allowed they were wrong in
attacking Sigo, and laid all the blame on the old chief,
Parembam. They likewise allowed it to be just that
Parembam should be forced to pay, and conclude a
peace. With the Goon and Sibaduh Dyaks they had
long been at enmity ; but they agreed to make peace if
Sibaduh would pay two gongs, formerly demanded, as
the price of peace. The Sibaduh, however, did not al-
low the justice of the demand ; but the parties were
reconciled so far as that each promised to maintain a
truce and to eat together : and the Singes declared they
would not attack the Sibaduhs on account of the two
gongs, but obtain them in a friendly conference. I have
(being hurried) briefly mentioned these circumstances,
which took a long time to settle, as the Dyaks are very
fond of speechifying, which they do sitting, without ac-
tion or vivacity, but with great fluency, and using often
.highly metaphysical and elegant language. It was a
great nuisance having fifty naked savages in the house
all night, extended in the hall and the anterooms. They
finished a bottle of gin, and then slept ; and I could not
avoid remarking that their sleep was light, such as tem-
perance, health, and exercise bestow. During many
hours I heard but one man snore, while half the num-
ber of Europeans would have favored me with a concert
sufficient to banish rest.
" I shall now briefly mention our foreign policy for
the last few months.
" For a time we were annoyed with incessant reports
of their coming to attack us in force ; but, though scarce-
ly believing they would be bold enough, I took precau-
tions, pushed on the completion of our boats, built a fort,
and made a fence round the village. These precautions
taken, and fifteen boats in the water ready foi notion, I
cared very little, though the news retched me llutl By-
EXPEDITION TO BORM 197
ong, the Sarebus chief, had hung a basket on a high
tree which was to contain ray heacT.
" Sadong. Our relations with Seriff Sahib were
very unsettled ; and by the bullying tone of the people
of Singe I thought it probable he might be induced to
measure his strength, backed by the Sakarran Dyaks,
against us. I have already mentioned his attack upon
my Dyaks of Sanpro, and the second dispute about the
Suntah Dyaks ; in the first of these he came off with
impunity ; in the second I met him with success, and
out-manoeuvered him, and wrested the Dyaks from him.
Shortly after the transactions at Suntah, a boat of Sa-
karran Dyaks came to Sarawak nominally to trade, but
in reality to tamper with the fidelity of the Datus and
others. They proposed to the Tumangong to join
Seriff Sahib, stating that they were sent by him to try
all the people here. ' They had been rained here ;
Seriflf Sahib would restore them their property ; and if
they left Muda Hassim, James Brooke, and the Chi-
nese, they could afterward easily make a prey of the
Dyaks and Chinese, with Seriff Sahib's assistance, and
get plenty of slaves.'
" The plan proposed for the removal was as follows :
Seriff Sahib, with forty Malay boats, and the Sakar-
rans with one hundred boats, were to request permis-
sion from Muda Hassim to attack the Dyak tribe of
Siquong, and under this pretence were to come up the
river, when the Datus were to join, with their wives
and children, and all were to take flight together. The
Tumangong told me this as soon as he heard it himself;
and, to make sure, I sent Patingi Gapoor to fish their
story out of them, which he did most successfully.
Being assured of the fact, I called the Dyaks, and, be-
fore some dozens of our people and one or two persons
from Singe, taxed them with their guilt. They were
obliged to confess, and insisted upon it that Seriff Sahib
had sent them, &c. Many urged me to put these
Dyaks to death ; but the reluctance we all have to
shedding blood withheld me, and I had no desire to
strike at a wren when a foul vulture was at hand. I
dismissed the emissaries scot-free, and then both Muda
Hassim and myself indited letters to Seriff Sahib, that
198 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
of Muda Hassim being severe but dignified. Before
they were dispatched, an ambassador arrived from
Singe with letters both to the rajah and myself, dis-
claiming warmly all knowledge of the treachery, swear-
ing the most solemn oaths in proof of his truth, and
declaring that, so far from having committed so shame-
ful an action, he had never even dreamed of such a
thing in his worst dreams, as he hoped that God would
save him. Our letters were sent before his ambassador
was received, and a second disclaimer, like the first,
quickly reached us. Of course it was my policy, what-
ever my opinion might be, to receive his offers of
friendship and to believe all Hte said ; and, therefore,
the matter ended, and ended so far well, that Seriff
Sahib lowered his former tone ; and, certainly, what-
ever he may desire in his heart, or dream of, he wants
to be well with us here, and, I can see, fears us. I am
content, because I really wish for peace, and not war ;
Muda Hassim is content, because he has humbled Seriff
Sahib, and acted decisively ; and the seriff is content as
the fiend in the infernal regions. I leave it to all gentle
readers to form their own opinion of his truth or treach-
ery ; but I must hint to them my private opinion that he
did send agents to tempt, and would have gained the
Datus if he could ; and as for his oaths, my belief is,
he would swear a basketful of the most sacred before
oreakfast to support a lie, and yet not lose his appetite !
The Datus were too old, and knew him too well, to be
caught in his trap.
" Seriff Sahib has now sent a fleet of boats up the
Sarebus river ; but the result I do not yet know.
" To conclude our foreign policy, I must mention
Borneo Proper.
" My great object is to reconcile Muda Hassim and
the sultan, and to restore the former to Borneo, be-
fore the coming of Mr. Bonham on his diplomatic mis-
sion. To effect this, I have resolved to proceed my-
self; and Muda Hassim, equally anxious, has letters
and two of his brothers ready to accompany me. If
we can gain this object, I shall be firmly established,
and relieved from the intriguing, mean, base Borneons.
And it will be an advantage to the government measure,
1:XPKL>1T10\ To iioKMCo. J 99
in us i'ar us they will be enabled to tbriii tlieir arrange-
ments with all instead of a single faction of the Borneo
Pangerans. From all I hear, Muda Hassim is more
powerful than either the sultan or Pangeran Usop ; and
if he appeals to arras. I am assured he will carry his
point, and become the sovereign of Borneo virtually, if
not nominally.
" The Royalist now waits for us at the mouth
of the river, which I hope to reach on the 14th, this
being the 12th July. Heigh for the sea once more !
But yet, though I go, I take my cares with me ; and
but for the necessity, the absolute necessity, of bringing
the Borneo question to a crisis, good or bad, I would
fain stop where I am. For even during one short
month's absence I fear my poor people will suffer from
the intrigues of the rascally Borneo Pangerans. In
this I do not include Muda Hassim, who, with a most
amiable private character, and with integrity and good
faith, desires to do right, as far as his education and
prejudices will permit. It is sad to reflect that this
very prince, who really wishes to do good, and to con-
duce to the comfort of his people, should, from want of
energy, have been so fearful an oppressor, through the
agency of others ; and it is not here alone that vile
agents for vile purposes are plentiful."
CHAPTER XIV.
Visit of Captain Elliott. Mr. Brooke sails for Borneo Proper.
Arrival. Visited by leading men. Condition of the country.
Reception by the Sultan. Objects in view. The different
chiefs, and communications with them. The Sultan and his
Pangerans. Objects of the visit accomplished. Return to
Sarawak. Ceremonies of the cession. Sail for Singapore.
AFTER Mr. Brooke's return from his expedition
against the Singe Dyak chief Parembam, he was vis-
ited by his friend Captain Elliott, of the Madras en-
gineers, whose acquaintance I had the pleasure of
subsequently making at Singapore. He is, as Mr.
Brooke describes him, " a man of science and educa-
tion, and the best of good fellows." During his stay at
200 EXPEDITION TD BORNEO,
Sarawak, he established his observatory, und all its
apparatus ; and a shed (now converted into a goat-
house) will always retain the appellation of "the Ob-
servatory." Mr. Brooke and Captain Elliott appear to
have made gome very amusing and agreeable excursions
up the different rivers, an account of which is given in
the journal ; but I shall pass it over, as I am anxious to '
follow my friend through with his government u-p to* the
time of my meeting him at Singapore.
" Thursday, July I4tk We were to have started on
this most lucky day at ten o'clock, but what with innu-
merable preparations and delays, it was near six before
the rajah was ready to dismiss the procession ; and my
alarm became considerable that, Friday (an unlucky day)
having commenced by the native reckoning, we should
again be postponed till Sunday. However, by making
six o'clock five, and keeping back the watches to suit
our purpose, our departure was achieved. The state
spears and swords were brought forth. The letters
for the sultan, in their brass tray covered with em-
broidered cloth, were duly mounted, with the greatest
reverence, on the head of Bandar Sumsu ; and nothing
remained but to take leave. The rajah addressed a
few words to his brothers, requesting them to tell the
sultan that his heart was always with him; that he
could never separate from him, whether far or near ;
and that he was, and always had been, true to his son.
Budrudeen then rose, and approaching the rajah, seated
himself close to him, bending his head to the ground
over his hand, which he had grasped. The rajah
hastily withdrew his hand, and clasping him round,
embraced, kissing his neck. Both were greatly agitated
and both wept, and I could have wept for company, for
it was no display of state ceremony, but genuine feel-
ing. It is seldom, very seldom, they show their feel-
ings ; and the effect was the more touching from being
unexpected; beside, it is a part of our nature (one's
better nature) to feel when we see others feel. Pan-
geran Marsale followed ; both brothers likewise p;irlc<:
with Muda Mahammed in the same way, and they cer-
tainly rose in my opinion from this token of affection
toward ench other. My adieus followed: we nil rose-;
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. ^01
the rajah accompanied us to the wharf; and as we em-
barked, I could see the tears slowly steal from his eyes.
I could not help taking his hand, and bidding him be of
good cheer; he smiled in a friendly manner, pressed
my hand, and I stepped into ray bout. Our gongs
struck up ; the barge, decorated with flags and stream-
ers, was towed slowly along against the flood-tide ; the
guns fired from the wharf, from the Chinese houses,
and from our fort, and we passed along in all the pomp
and pride of Sarawak state. It was dusk when we got
down to the first reach, and there we brought up to
wait for the ebb."
I shall omit that part of my friend's journal containing
his remarks and observations along the coast between
Sarawak and the entrance of the Borneo river. On the
21st July his narration continues thus :
"I must now leave geography, and turn to politics.
On casting anchor we acted on a plan previously formed,
and sent off the gig, with SerhY Hussein and Nakoda
Ahmed, to the city, to intimate my arrival, and that of
the rajah's brothers, with letters from Muda Hassim. I
trusted to their dread of and curiosity about the English
expedition to insure my reception ; but I gave particular
directions, in case the sultan asked about me, that my
ambassadors were to say I was here ; that I had beeti
corresponding about the English coming ; that I was not
a man in authority, or belonging to the East India Com-
ry ; and that they were sure I should not land unless
invited me to come and see him. To show eager-
ness would have raised suspicion ; backwardness excites
the contrary feeling, and a desire to entertain some in-
tercourse.
" July 22d. At the unconscionable hour of 2 A.M., a
mob of Pangerans came on board, in number not fewer
than fifty, and with a multitude of followers. They
awoke us out of our first sleep, and crowded the vessel
above and below, so that we could scarce find room to
make our toilet in public, while the heat was suffocating us.
However, we did manage it, and sat talking till daylight.
Our visitors were chiefly relations or adherents of Muda
Hassim, and some of the first men in the country. Pan-
geran Budrudeen and Pangeran Marsale were in their
^O'sJ EXPEDITION" TO BOKNKo.
glory, und happy ; and it was evident at once thut our
affairs were likely to succeed to our heart's content.
All were anxious and eager in inquiries about Muda
Hassim, and wishing his return. The sultan, Pangeran
Usop, Pangeran Mumin, and others declared, 'Borneo
could never be well till he came back.' In short, it was
clear that the country was in distress and difficulty from
within : trade ruined, piracy abounding, the mouth of
the river unsafe, their forts insulted by the pirates, the
communication with their dependencies cut off, food
dear, and the tobacco, which comes from the northward,
not to be had. Everything conspires to forward Muda
Hassim' s views and mine ; and during this conversation,
it was evident they were looking to me as a friend.
" At daylight a boat from the sultan arrived to carry
up the letters ; but Budrudeen and his brother resolved
to proceed first, in order to make sure of an honorable
reception for the chop. At 7 o'clock there was a stir. I
saw them over the side with delight, and gave them a
salute with pleasure. Breakfast done, I was too happy
to lie down, and slept till past midday, having then only
to wait for Budrudeen's return.
" 23d. Budrudeen came at 3 P.M., bringing with him
.good news of the most favorable reception from all par-
ties, all wishing for reconciliation and the return of Muda
Hassim. To-morrow, boats are to come for the letters,
which are to be conveyed in state. The day following
I am to go up, and am likewise to be received in all hon-
orable form.
" 24th. At 7 A.M. the state-boat, a shabby concern,
decorated with yellow flags, arrived, and at eight the
letters were borne away under a salute. Thus we had
a second time the satisfaction of getting rid of the mob
at an early hour.
" 25th. At 9- A.M. I started with Williamson in the
gig, with the long-boat in company, carrying the presents.
On approaching the town, before the ebb had run long,
it appeared to be a very Venice of hovels, a river Cybele
rising from the water. For those who like it, the locality
is not ill chosen. The hills recede from the river, und
form an amphitheatre ; and several other rivers or
streams flowing in, cause a muddy deposit, on which
KXl'KDl Tlo\ Tti JUJliM.u. _'().''
the houses are built. At high water they are surround-
ed ; at low water stand on a sheet of mud. On nearing
it, we were encompassed by boats which preceded
and followed us, and we passed the floating market,
where women, wearing immense hats of palm-leaves,
sell all sorts of edibles, balanced in their little canoes,
now giving a paddle, now making a bargain, and dropping
down with the tide, and again regaining their place when
the bargain is finished. The first impression of the
town is miserable. The houses are crowded and nu-
merous, and even the palace does not present a more
captivating aspect, for, though large, it is as incommo-
dious as the worst. Our presentation was exactly sim-
ilar to that of our first meeting with Muda Hassim at
Sarawak, only the crowd was much greater. We had
been seated but a few minutes when Pangeran Usop
arrived, and directly afterward the sultan. He gave us
tea, leaf-cigars, and sirih, and, in short, showed us every
attention; and what was best of all did not keep us
very long. Our apartment was^mrtitioned off from the
public hall, a dark-looking place, but furnished with a
table brought by us, and three rickety chairs, beside
matresses and plenty of mats. We were kept up nearly
all night, which, after the fatigues of the day, was hard
upon us.
"Further observation confirmed us in the opinion
that the town itself is miserable, and its locality on the
mud fitted only for frogs or natives ; but there is a level
dry plain above the entrance of the Kiangi river, admi-
rably suited for a European settlement ; and across the
Kiangi is swelling ground, where the residents might
find delightful spots for their country-houses. The
greatest annoyance to a stranger is the noisome smell
of the mud when uncovered ; and all plated or silver
articles, even in the course of one night, get black and
discolored. The inhabitants I shall estimate moderately
at 10,000. and the. Kadien population are numerous
amid the hills.
" 27th. Our objects in coming to Borneo were three-
fold. Firstly, to effect a reconciliation between the sul-
tan and Muda Hassim ; secondly, to gain the sultan's
approval and signature to my holding Sarawak ; and
204 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
thirdly, to release the Kleeses [Hindoostanees] of the
ship-wrecked vessels, the Sultana and Lord Melbourne.
The first object was gained at once, as the sultan seem-
ed really overjoyed at being good friends with his uncle ;
and Pangeran Usop, from whom we anticipated diffi-
culty, stepped forward directly to aid us, while Pange-
ran Mumin was not averse. I will not now stop to
sketch the characters of these worthies, as I shall here-
after have a better knowledge of them ; but I may re-
mark, en passant, that it was evident, even to my inex-
perience, that no two of them were on good terms, and
all probably united in a feeling that Muda Hassim's re-
turn would be a personal as well as public advantage.
The other principal Pangerans, namely, Tizudeen (the
sultan's natural brother), Kurmaindar (the father of the
country^, Bahar (the rajah's brother-in-law), Tizudeen
second (the rajah's natural brother), were all for Muda
Hassim ; and the population, as far as I could learn, de-
cidedly desirous of his being restored to them.
" Each day I had several interviews with the sultan,
in his surow or private room ; and he assured me of his
fondness for Muda Hassim, his wish to have him near
him again, and the great benefit it would be. Moreover,
^he was pleased to express great personal regard for me ;
and eveiy five minutes I had to swear ' eternal friend-
ship,' while he, clasping my hand, kept repeating, 'amigo
suya,' ' amigo suyaj meaning, my friend, my friend. At
the same time he professed great readiness to give me
Sarawak inquired the amount of revenue seemed sat-
isfied, and said, ' I wish you to be there ; I do not wish
any body else ; you are my anaigo, and it is nobody's
business but mine ; the country is mine, and if I please
to give you all, I can.' His majesty is very proud of
displaying his very small smattering of Spanish or Por-
tuguese ; and almost all the higher people having ac-
quired a few words, shows there must have been a
communication at no very distant date. I was :ils<>
warned not to care for any of the other Pangerans,
not, indeed, to have anything to say to them.
" With this advice I took the liberty to dispense ; and
sent to Pangerans Mumin and Usop to intimate my wish
to visit them. The former y eaded that his house was
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 205
unfit to receive me ; but the latter immediately sent a
most polite message, that any timey .either by day or
night, ho should be happy to see me ; and accordingly
I went. The house and style are the best in Borneo.
I was politely and kindly greeted ; and I soon found that
I was with a man of sense and quickness. There was
a little diplomacy at first on his part ; but as I proceeded
direct to my object, he at once laid it aside. In fact,
candor is the basis of our right influence with the na-
tives ; and as I desired to make Pangeran Usop my
friend, I went candidly to work, and immediately told
him all that I had already told the sultan. The amount
of my conversation was as follows : The first topic being
the anticipated visit of the English, ' Were the English
cpming?' 'Was Mr. Bonham coming?' were the first
questions ; and ' With what intent ?' I replied, that the
English were cei'taiuly coming, but with no evil inten-
tions ; that it was true they were offended by the ill
usage the captain and people of the Sultana had met
with ; yet that I had endeavored to put it in the best
light, and had urged that a friendly communication for
the future was better than a retrospect which might
give rise to unpleasant feelings : I was sure that the
English desired a friendly intercourse ; and I hoped,
though I could not say, that they would look to the fuv
ture, and not to the past. I had, I added, no authority ;
but my friendship for the sultan induced me to inform
him what I had heard abroad. When Mr. Bonham
came, he would be able to tell them all ; but I could say
now that I thought he would demand a treaty between
Singapore and Borneo for the mutual protection of trade,
and the care of individuals of each nation who were
shipwrecked or otherwise sought protection at either
place.
"On the whole, it is certain that the feelings of Bor-
neo are decidedly friendly, and equally certain that the
persons of influence will receive us in their warmest
manner, and grant us every thing, if we resort only to
measures of conciliation. It never can be too often re-
peated, that conciliation is the only policy with Malays,
and particularly the Borneons, who have very vague and
confused ideas of our power. A harsh truth, a per-
S
206 KXI'KUITION TO J{ul(.\i:<).
emptory demand, they have never heard in their lives,
and they will not hear it for the first time and remain
friendly ; for all who have the least acquaintance with
the native character know their acute sense of false
shame. To demand, therefore, of the chief here to ac-
knowledge our superiority would, I am sure, be met
with a haughty refusal. In a few years, if we proceed
mildly to establish a beneficial influence, they will fall
into our views without reserve ; for, as I have often be-
fore stated, their government is in the last stage of de-
struction and decay.
" The reconciliation of Muda Hassim was Boon com-
plete ; and as to the Kleeses of the Lord Melbourne,
twenty in number, they were at once surrendered to
me, with a request that I would forward them to Sin-
gapore as quickly as I could. The boat of the Lord
Melbourne was likewise given to me. I had some
scruples about three Kleeses of the Sultana, who had
been sold at Malludu Bay, bought there by an Arab
seriff, and brought here. By all their laws and customs
they were his slaves, purchased at a distance, and, as I
had no right to claim them (supposing even that to be
just), and was resolved not to leave them in captivity. I
paid a fair price for them at the rate of twenty-five
dollars per man. I regret to add, there is one other
man not in the place ; and one is gone to Tutorga
about a day's journey hence.
" 28th. I may here draw a brief sketch of the prin-
cipal personages of this most primitive court, beginning
with its worthy head, the sultan.
" The sultan is a man past fifty years of age, short
and puffy in person, with a countenance which ex-
presses very obviously the imbecility of his mind. His
right hand is garnished with an extra diminutive thumb,
the natural member being crooked and distorted. His
mind, indexed by his face, seems to be a chaos of con-
fusion ; without acuteness, without dignity, nnd without
good sense. He can neither read nor write ; is guided
by the last speaker ; and his advisers, as might be ex-
pected, are of the lower order, and mischievous from
their ignorance and their greediness. He is always
talking, nnd generally joking: and the mop! fpirious
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 207
subjects never meet with five minutes' consecutive
attention. The favorable side of his character is, that
he is good-tempered and good-natured ; by no means
cruel; and, in a certain way, generous, though rapa-
cious to a high degree. His rapacity, indeed, is carried
to such an excess as to astonish a European, and is
evinced in a thousand mean ways. The presents I
made him were unquestionably handsome; but he was
not content without begging from me the share I had
reserved for the other Pangerans; and afterward,
through Mr. Williamson, solicited more trifles, such as
sugar, penknives, and the like. To crown all, he was
incessantly asking what was left in the vessel ; and
when told the truth, that I was stripped as bare as a
tree in winter, he frequently returned to the charge.
In the middle of the night, when our boat came up with
some gifts for him, he slipped out his royal person,
that he might see what packages there were. I must
say, however, that this was not intended for me to
know ; and, personally, he did not behave very ill to-
ward me, only dunning me occasionally. In regard to
the Sarawak revenue, he was eager in his inquiries ;
and was very ready, on the strength of his thousand
dollars, and my generosity, to give me a list of things
which amounted to 30,000 dollars in value. I may
note one other feature which marks the man. He re-
quested, as the greatest favor, he urged, with the
earnestness of a child, that I would send back the
schooner before the month Ramban (Ramadan of the
Turks) ; remarking, ' What shall I do during the fast
without soft sugar and dates ?' What effect the exag-
gerated promises of Mr. de Souza must have had on
such a temper, may readily be imagined ; and what
the evil influence of such a prince on the countiy, needs
not be stated; for, like other fools, he is difficult to
guide where the object is right, and facile whenever it
promises any immediate advantage. I will only add,
that during my intercourse of six days, he has given
me the impression that he is not in his right mind ; and,
at any rate, that flattery and bad counsel have deprived
him of the little wit he might probably originally have
808 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
"Of Pangeran Mumin, the De Gadong and the
sultan's son-in-law, I know little ; and he is, in secret,
a most determined opposer of mine ; but I believe he,
as well as most, is desirous of being good friends with
the English, and will readily listen to any overtures
which promise increase of trade. He seemed to me a
shrewd, cunning man, fit for a Nakoda.
" Pangeran Usop is a man of middle age, short,
active, and intelligent, and, I may add, ambitious.
Pangeran Muda Hassim will throw himself into the
arms of the English, from his partiality, and from the
hope of a better order of things, and the eventual suc-
cession to the throne, to which he stands next, the
present sultan having no legitimate children.
" Two of my objects were thus achieved at once ;
and the Kleeses (twenty-three) were, much to their
satisfaction, dispatched to the vessel in the Melbourne's
gig. My own affair of Sarawak meets with some oppo-
sition from Mumin, who is decidedly friendly to Macota.
The sultan, however, is steady to me, gabbles daily and
hourly of his intentions ; and Pangeran Usop likewise
pushes on my suit with his influence, at the same time
giving me this one piece of good advice, viz. that Muda
Hassim must be induced to return to Borneo, for that
two persons (Muda Hassim and myself) cannot govern
together ; and he added, ' If Muda Hassim returns,
you will have a fine trade at Sarawak ; but while ho is
there, no native prahus will visit the place.' This is
true : I have no fear of ultimate success in my suit ;
but delay is formidable, and I have already inti-
mated that I propose making my conge on the 2d of
August.
" 30th. I have little more to add about Borneo, save
my plaint against our dungeon, though the said dungeon
be honorably situated behind the throne, and within the
royal apartments. Just below the town are several rills
of the finest water ; and the natives report that they
issue from a smnll but deep lake at a veiy short distance.
Beneath one of these spouts we each evening took a
most delicious bath in water as cold as it is limpid. I
am no great bustler at any time ; but since being here,
[ have purposely abstained from all manifestation of cu-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 209
riosity, and never desired or requested to see much ; it
rouses suspicion, and suspicion rouses distrust, and dis-
trust draws the kris. On the contrary, by being back-
ward at first, you become subsequently a sort of domes-
ticated animal, and privileged to use your eyes and
limbs. Most Europeans do themselves great injury by
searching the mountains and the waters, breaking the
rocks, shooting the birds, and gathering the plants. The
natives can never believe they would take so much
trouble without being well paid by the value of the
treasures found, or employed by the East India Com-
pany to espy their land, in order that the said company
might seize it at their convenience.
" 31st. A conclave of Pangerans, when it was finally
resolved to grant the country of Sarawak to me as rajah
or governor.
"August 1st, 1842. An important day in my his-
tory, and I hope one which will be marked with a white
stone in the annals of Sarawak. The letters to Muda
Hassim being finished and signed, tfye contract giving me
the government of Sarawak came under discussion, and
was likewise completed by ten at night, signed, sealed,
and witnessed. Thus I have gained every object for
which I came to Borneo ; and to-morrow, God willing^
I take ray leave.
" The miserable state of Borneo I have already men-
tioned ; and it is now a saying of the Balagnini pirates,
that ' it is difficult to catch fish, but easy to catch Bor-
neons.' Externally and internally they are equally
wretched, and torn by factions ; yet, on the whole, I am
not inclined to judge harshly of the poorer order of them.
They are a good-tempered, very hospitable, and unwar-
like people, the victims of their rajahs ; the oppressed,
but not the oppressors. In this character, however, I
do not reckon the Pangerans and their followers. It is
from these latter that Europeans take their estimate of
the people generally, and consequently truly account
them, from that standard, to be a wretched sample of
humanity mean, thievish, arrogant, insolent, and ready
for any wickedness. The Pangerans themselves are
only a step better : but even here I must make a little
allowance ; for I believe their crimes arise more from
J4 s2
210 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO,
their poverty and impunity than from any inherent vi-
ciousness.
" 3d. The Pangerans Budrudeen and Marsale, and
a host more, came on board this night, and kept us up
as usual.
" 4th Another mob arrived the middle of last night.
I retreated from them, being far from well, and got some
sleep. At 2 P.M. the letters eame on board ; were re-
ceived with honors ; and as soon as we could rid our-
selves of our troublesome visitors, we dropped outside
Tanjong Sapo, and sailed the following day.
" The Kleeses sold at Malludu were brought from
Ambun, and reported to. the- authorities that a European
woman was detained there. I made particular inquiries
oftheBorneon Pangerans,and they said they had always
imderstood that such was the case. Unhappy lady, if
she be a lady ! Is it a compassionate part to release
her after many years of captivity ?
" 14A. Anchored off the Morotaba^ having had noth-
ing but calms, light winds, and squalls.
" \5th. Got part of the way up the river, and at &
P.M. dropped our anchor ; and in about an hour later
two boats started for Sarawak. The night was moon-
light, with a cold breeze-; and, after a pleasant pull, we
arrived, and created as much sensation as we could de-
sire. But it was better, and I was gratified with the
intelligence that everything had gone on well during our
absence. At break of day I went, fudged, to bed. So
ended our mission to Borneo.
"On the evening of the 18th the sultan's letters were
produced in all the state which could possibly be attained.
On their arrival they were received and brought up-
amid large wax torches, and the person who was to read
them was stationed on a raised platform ; standing below
him was the rajah, with a saber in his- hand; in front of
the rajah was his brother, Pangeran Jaffer, with a tre-
mendous kempilan drawn ; and around were the other
brothers and myself, all standing the rest of the com-
pany being seated. The letters were then read, the
last one appointing me to hold the government of Sara-
wak. After this the rajah descended, and said aloud,
'If any nn<- pp'^mt. rlisnwir.; r contests <lit> --ult;in's np-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 211
point mr m . let him now declare.' All were silent. He
next turned to the Patingis, and asked them ; they were
obedient to the will of the sultan. Then came the other
Pangerans 'Is there any Pan^eran or any young rajah
that contests the question ? Pangeran Der Macota,
what do you say ?' Macota expressed his willingness to
i-l)c\ . One or two other obnoxious Pangeraus who had
ahviiys opposed themselves to me were each in turn
challenged, and forced to promise obedience. The ra-
jah then waved his sword, and with a loud voice ex-
claimed, ' Whoever he is that disobeys the sultan's
mandate now received, I will separate his skull ;' at the
moment some ten of his brothers jumped from the ve-
randah, and, drawing their long krisses, began to flourish
and dance about, thrusting close to Macota, striking the
pillar above his head, pointing their weapons at his
breast. This amusement, the violence of motion, the
freedom from restraint, this explosion of a long pent-up
animosity, roused all their passions; and had Macota,
through an excess of fear or an excess of bravery, started
up, he would have been slain, and other blood would
have been spilt. But he was quiet, with his face pale
and subdued, and, as shortly as decency would permit
after the riot had subsided, took his leave. This scene
is a custom with them ; the only exception to which
was, that it was pointed so directly at Macota. I was
glad, at any rate, that all had gone off without bloodshed.
" 22rf. I found that though matters had been quiet
during my absence, repeated efforts had been made to
disturb the country. First, it was positively stated and
industriously circulated that I was certain to be killed in
Borneo; and next a report was propagated that 6000
Chinese were on their march from Sambas, with evil
intentions. These rumors did not serve any object, and
my return has set them at rest ; but I regretted to hear
that the Singe Dyaks had, contrary to my positive pro-
hibition, killed a Dyak of Sanpro.
" Other affairs are prosperous. Macota is to be sent
out of the country, and the rajah himself talks of return-
ing to Borneo ; and both these events will please me
greatly.
"January 1st, 1843. Another yew passed and gone ;
212 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
a year, with all its anxieties, its troubles, ite dangei'S,
upon which I can look back with satisfaction a year in
which I have been usefully employed in doing good to
others.
" Since I last wrote, the Dyaks have been quiet, set-
tled, arid improving ; the Chinese advancing toward
prosperity ; and the Sarawak people, wonderfully con-
tented and industrious, relieved from oppression, and
fields of labor allowed them.
"Justice I have executed with an unflinching hand;
and the amount of crime is. certainly small the petty
swindling very great.
" The month of January was a dreary month. A
sick man in the house, and veiy little medicine ; and
what was worse, the Royalist did not make her ap-
pearance. Yet both these troubles disappeared nearly
together; for M'Kenzie got well, and the .schooner,
bringing with her Dr. Treacher, ai-rived. She had
been detained undergoing some necessary repairs. The
accession of a medical man is particularly valuable.
"I have nothing to say about the country, except
that I have given Pangeran Macota orders to leave,
which he is obeying in as far as preparing his boat ; and
I hope that in six weeks we shall be rid of his cunning
and diabolically intriguing presence.
" The Rajah Muda Hassim, his brothers, and the
tag-rag following, I also hope soon to be rid of; for al-
though they behave far better than they did at first, it
is an evil to have wheel within wheel ; and these young
rajahs of course expect, and are accustomed to, a license
which I will not allow.
" Budrudeen is an exception a striking and won-
derful instance of the force of good sense over evil edu-
cation.
"The rest of the people go on well; the time re-
volves quietly ; and the Dyaks, as well as the Malays
and Chinese, enjoy the inestimable blessing of peace and
security. At intervals a cloud threatens the serenity
of our political atmosphere ; but it speedily blows over.
However, all is well and safe ; and so safe that I have
resolved to proceed in person to Singapore.
" My motives for going are various ; but I hope to do
KXIM'.IHTION T> 15(11! \: 21'3
good, to excite interest, and make friends ; and I can
find no season like the present for my absence. It is
now two years since I left Singapore, ' the boundary of
civilization.' I have been out of the civilized world,
living in a demi-civilized state, peaceably, innocently,
and usefully.
" Feb. 8th. After ten days' delay at the mouth of
the river, got out."
CHAPTER XV.
Captain Keppel's voyage in the Dido with Mr. Brooke to Sara-
wak. Chase of three piratical prahus. Boat expedition. Ac-
tion with the pirates, and capture of a prahu. Arrival at Sara-
wak. Mr. Brooke's reception. Captain Keppel and his officers
visit the Rajah. The palace and the audience. Return royal
visit to the Dido. Mr. Brooke's residence and household. Dr.
Treacher's adventure with one of the ladies of Macota's harem.
Another boat affair with the pirates, and death of their chief.
I HAVE now followed Mr. Brooke's journal up to the
time of our first meeting at Singapore, and his accompa-
nying me to Sai'awak, and have no remarks of my own
to offer that could add in the slightest degree to its in-
terest ; happily, none such are needed. I had not yet
seen my friend's journal when I arrived at Sarawak, nor
was it until some time after that I by degrees learned
the progress of his infant government from its com-
mencement. It was with unfeigned pleasure I then
found that, while performing my duty in the suppression
of piracy, I was, at the same time, rendering the great-
est assistance and support to an individual in his praise-
worthy, novel, and important position.
I had long felt a desire to explore the Island of Bor-
neo, which the few travelers who have called there de-
scribe as not only one of the largest and most fertile in
the world, but one of the most productive in gold and dia-
monds, and other rich minerals and ores ; one from which
the finest camphor known is brought into merchandise,
and which is undoubtedly capable of supplying every kind
of valuable spice, and articles of universal traffic and con-
sumption. Yet, with all these capabilities and induce-
ments to tempt the energetic spirit of trade, the internal
214 KXl'KlMTIiiV Tt ItOKNEO.
condition of the country, and the dangers which beset its
coasts, have hitherto prevented the interior from being
explored by Europeans ; and to prove how little we are
acquainted even with its shores, I actually sailed by the
best Admiralty chart eighty miles inland, and over the
tops of mountains !
May 4th, 1843. Passed through the Tambelaus, a
beautiful group of between 100 and 150 small islands.
They are very extensive, and but thinly inhabited.
There is good anchorage near some of them ; but we
had nothing less than twenty fathoms. They are
placed so close together that, after passing the first,
we were to all appearance completely land-locked in a
magnificent -and capacious harbor. The following morn-
ing we anchored off the mouth of the Sambas river, and
sent the boats away to examine the creeks, islands, and
rivers along the coast for traces of pirates which were
discovered by the remains of their fires on different parts,
although no clew could be obtained as to the direction in
which they had gone. On the morning of the 8th I
again sent the pinnace and two cutters, Mr. Partridge,
Messrs. D'Aeth and Jenkins, with a week's provisions,
the whole under the command of Lieutenant Wilmot
Horton, Mr. Brooke kindly ottering his assistance, which,
from his knowledge of the Malay language, as well as of
the kind of vessels used by the pirates, was thankfully
accepted. I directed them to proceed to the Island of Ma-
rundum, and, after visiting the South Natunas, to rejoin
the Dido at Sarawak. In the mean time 1 proceeded
leisurely along the coast, anchoring where convenient, and
finding regular soundings all the way in from four to ten
fathoms : weather remarkably fine, and water smooth.
On the morning of the 9th, on rounding Tanjong Datu,
we opened suddenly on a suspicious-looking boat, which,
on making us out, ran for a small, deep bay formed by
Cape Datu and the next point to the eastward. Stand-
ing a little further on, we discovered a second large boat
in the offing, which likewise stood in shore, and after-
ward a third at the bottom of the bay. From the de-
scription I had received, I easily made these out to be
Illanuns, an enterprising tribe of pirates, of whose daring
adventures I had heard much. Thev inhabit a small
P EDITION TO BORN KM. 215
cluster of islands off the N.E. const of Borneo, and go out
in large fleets eveiy year to look for prahus bound to
Singapore or the Straits ; and, after capturing the ves-
sels, reduce their crews to slavery. It is of a cruel na-
ture ; for Mr. Brooke observes : " Nor is the slavery of
that mild description which is often attributed to the
Asiatics ; for these victims are bound for months, and
crowded in the bottom of the pirate vessels, where they
suffer all the miseries which could be inflicted on board
an African slaver." Having fairly pinned these wor-
thies into a corner, and knowing that the only two small
boats I had left on board would stand no chance with
them in polling, to make sure of my prizes I loaded the
two foremost guns on each side, and, having no proper
chart of the coast, proceeded under easy sail, feeling my
way into the bay with the lead. When just within
musket-range, I let go the anchor, which was no sooner
done than the three boats commenced making a move.
I thought at first they were coming alongside to sue for
pardon and peace ; and my astonishment was great when
I discovered that nothing was further from their inten-
tion. One pulled away, close in shore, to the eastward,
and the other two to the westward. They were rowed
by about forty oars each, and appeared, from their swift-
ness, to be flying, and that, too, from under my very nose ;
and what rendered it still more ridiculous and disagree-
able, owing to a strong ebb tide, the ship remained ex-
actly in a position that no gun could be brought to bear
on either side. The dingy and jolly-boat gave chase ;
but the pirates had the start, and it was useless ; for al-
though a few men were seen to drop from their oars in
consequence of our fire of musketry from the forecastle,
still their pace never slackened ; and when they did
come within the bearing of our guns, which they were
obliged to do for a minute or two while rounding the
points that formed the bay, though our thirty-two pound
shot fell thickly about their heads, frequently dashing the
spray all over them, not a man flinched from his oar. We
could not help admiring their plan of escape, and the gal-
lant manner in which it was effected. I saw that it would
be quite unavailing to attempt to catch the boats that had
pulled to windward: but we lost no time in slipping our
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO,
cable and making all sail in chase of the one that had gone
to leeward. But the " artful dodger" was still too fast for
us : we lost sight of him at dusk, close off the mouth of a
river, up which, however, I do not think he went ; for our
two boats were there very shortly after him; arid al-
though they searched all night and next morning, they
could discover no traces of the fugitive. Besides, these
pirates have no friends among the inhabitants of the prov-
ince of Sarawak who would have screened them from
us ; on the contrary, they would have put them to death
if once in their power. I certainly never made so sure
of any thing in my life as of capturing the three prahus
after I had seen them safe at the bottom of the little bay
at Tanjong Datu : but "there is many a slip between
the cup and the lip." We returned the following day
to pick up the anchor and cable, and observed that it was
a place well adapted as a rendezvous for pirates. The
bay is studded with rocks ; and, to my horror, I found
that I had run her majesty's ship Dido inside two that
were a- wash at low water ! A mountain stream of most
delicious water runs into the bay between two rocks,
and the coast abounds with oysters.
On the 13th the Dido anchored off Tanjong Poe, out-
side the bar at the entrance of the river leading to Mr.
Brooke's residence and seat of government, at the town
of Sarawak, situated about twenty-four miles up. At
half-tide on the following morning we crossed the bar,
carrying no less than three and a half fathoms, and en-
tered the beautiful river of Morotaba, which we ran up
for the first fifteen miles under <ill sail, with a fresh,
leading breeze. The Dido was the first square-rigged
vessel that had ever entered those waters. We came to
at the junction river which unites the two principal en-
trances to the Sarawak.
In the evening our boats returned on board from their
expedition, having reached Sarawak the day previous by
the western entrance. On leaving the Dido, on the
morning of the 8th, they proceeded to the Island of Ma-
rundum, a favorite rendezvous for pirates, where they
came on a fleet of the Illanum tribe, who, however, did
not give them an opportunity of closing ; but, cutting
their sampans adrift, made a precipitate flight, opening
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 217
fire as they ran out on the opposite side of a small bay,
in which they had been watering and refitting. This,
of course, led to a very exciting chase, with a running
fire kept up on both sides ; but the distance was too great
for the range of the guns on either side ; and the pirates,
who, in addition to sailing well, were propelled by from
forty to sixty oars each, made their escape. It was not
until nearly hull-down that they (probably out of brava-
do) ceased to fire their stern guns. As they went in
the direction of the Natunas, our boats steered for those
islands, and anchored under the south end of one of
them. At daylight next morning, although in three
fathoms water, the pinnace, owing to the great rise and
fall of tide, grounded on a coral reef, and Lieutenant
Horton and Mr. Brooke proceeded in one of the cutters
to reconnoiter. As they neared the s.w. point, they
were met by six prahus, beating their tom-toms as they
advanced, and making every demonstration of fighting.
Lieutenant Horton judiciously turned to rejoin the oth-
er boats ; and the pinnace having, fortunately, just then
floated, he formed his little squadron into line abreast,
leared for action, and prepared to meet his formidable-
looking antagonists. Mr. Brooke, however, whose eye
had been accustomed to the cut and rig of all the boats
in these seas, discovered that those advancing were not
Illanuns, and fancied there must be some mistake. The
Natunas people had been trading with Sarawak, and he
was intimately acquainted with a rich and powerful chief
who resided on the island ; he therefore raised a white
flag of truce on his spy-glass, and from the bow of the
pinnace hailed, waved, and made all the signs he could to
warn them of the danger into which they were running ;
but a discharge of small arms was the only reply he got.
They then detached their three smallest vessels inshore,
so as to command a cross-fire, and cut off the retreat of
our boats ; and the rest advanced, yelling, beating their
tom-toms, and blazing away with all the confidence of
victory, their shot cutting through the rigging, and splash-
ing in the water all around. It was an anxious moment
for the Dido's little party. Not a word was spoken.
The only gun of the pinnace was loaded with grape and
canister, and kept pointed on the largest prahu. The
T
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
men waited, with their muskets in hand, for permission
to fire ; but it was not until within pistol-range that
Lieutenant Horton poured into the enemy his well-pre-
pared dose. It instantly brought them to a halt ; yet
they had the temerity to exchange shots for a few min-
utes longer, when the largest cried for quarter, and the
other five made for the shore, chased by the two cutters,
and keeping up a fire to the last.
The prize taken possession of by the pinnace proved
to be a prahu mounting three brass guns, with a crew
of thirty-six men, belonging to the Rajah of Rhio, and
which had been dispatched by that chief to collect trib-
ute at and about the Natunas islands. They had on
board ten njen killed, and eleven (four of them mortally)
wounded. They affected the greatest astonishment on
discovering that our boats belonged to a British man-of-
war, and protested that it was all a mistake ; that the
island had lately been plundered by the Illanun pirates,
for whom they had taken us ; that the rising sun was in
their eyes, and that they could not make out the colors,
&c. Lieutenant Horton, thinking that their story might
possibly have some foundation in truth, and taking into
consideration the severe lesson they had received, di-
rected Dr. Simpson, the assistant-surgeon, to dress their
wounds ; and after admonishing them to be more cir-
cumspect in future, restored them their boat, as well as
the others which belonged to the island, two of them bo-
ing a trifle smaller, but of the same armament as the one
from Rhio, and the remaining three still smaller, carry -
ing twelve men each, armed with spears and muskets.
These had been taken possession of by the cutters after
they had reached the shore and landed their killed and
wounded, who were borne away from the beach so
smartly by the natives that our people had not time to
ascertain the number hurt. The surgeon went ashore,
and dressed the wounds of several of them, an act <>!
kindness and civilization far beyond their comprehension.
The natives, however, appeared to bear us no malice for
the injury we had inflicted on their countrymen, but
loaded our boats with fruit, goats, and every thing we
required. It afforded some amusement to find that
among the slightly wounded was Mr. Brooke's old.
EXPEDITION TO BORNKo. Si 19
wealthy, and respectable friend already alluded to, who
was not a little ashamed at being recognized ; but piracy
is so inherent in a Malay, that few can resist the temp-
tation when a good opportunity for plunder presents it-
self. The fact, which I afterward ascertained, was, that
they took our boats for some coming from a wreck with
whatever valuables they could collect ; and their not hav-
ing seen any thing of the ship rather strengthened this
conjecture ; the excuse they made for continuing the
fight after they had discovered their mistake being that
they expected no quarter.*
May 16th. We proceeded up the river twelve miles
further into the interior of this interesting country, and
with my friend Mr. Brooke on board, approached Sara-
wak, his seat of government ; in the reach before you
near which, and off the right bank of the river, is a long
and dangerous shelf of rocks. The deep channel which
lies between the bank and the rocks is not more than
sixty or seventy feet wide, and required some little care
in passing; but, with the exception of the flying jib-
boom, which got nipped off in the branch of a magnifi-
cent overhanging tree, we anchored without accident in
six fathoms water, and greatly astonished the natives
with a royal salute in honor of Muda Hassim, the Rajah
of Borneo. During the whole morning large boats, some
carrying as many as two hundred people, had been com-
ing down the river to hail Mr. Brooke's return ; and one
of the greatest gratifications I had was in witnessing the
undisguised delight, mingled with gratitude and respect,
with which each head man welcomed their newly-elect-
ed ruler back to his adopted country. Although many
of the Malay chiefs had every reason to expect that in
the Dido they saw the means by which their misdeeds
were to be punished, they showed their confidence in
Mr. Brooke by bringing their children with them a
sign peculiar to the Malay. The scena was boflji novel
and exciting ; presenting to us, just anchored in a large
fresh-water river, and surrounded by a densely-wooded
* I am happy to say that the Lords of the Admiralty have since
been pleased to promote Lieut. Wihnot Horton and Mr. W. L.
Partridge, mate, who commanded the pinnace, for their gallant-
ry on this occasion. H. K.
220 EXPEDITION TO BOR.XEO.
jungle, the whole surface of the water covered with
canoes and boats dressed out with their various-colored
silken flags, filled with natives beating their tom-toms,
and playing on their wild and not unpleasant-sounding
wind-instruments, with the occasional discharge of fire-
arms. To them it must have been equally striking and
extraordinary (as few of them had ever seen any larger
vessel than their own war-boats, or a European, until
?rlr. Brooke's arrival) to witness the Dido anchored al-
most in the center of their town, her mast-heads tow-
ering above the highest trees of their jungle ; the loud
report of her heavy two-and-thirty pounder guns, and
the running aloft, to furl sails, of 150 seamen, in then-
clean white dresses, and with the band playing, all which
helped to make an impression that will not easily be for-
gotten at Sarawak. I was anxious that Mr. Brooke
should land with all the honors due to so important a
personage, which he accordingly did, under a salute.
The next business was my visit of ceremony to the ra-
jah, which was great fun, though conducted in the most
imposing manner. The band, and the marines, as a
guard, having landed, we (the officers) all assembled at
Mr. Brooke's house, where, having made ourselves as
formidable as we could with swords and cocked hats,
we marched in pi-ocession to the royal residence, his
majesty having sent one of his brothers, who led me by
the hand into his presence. The palace was a long, low
shed, built on piles, to which we ascended by a ladder.
The audience-chamber was hung with red and yellow
silk curtains, and round the back and one side of the
platform occupied by the rajah were ranged his min-
isters, warriors, and men-at-arms, bearing spears, swords,
shields, and other warlike weapons. Opposite to them
were drawn up our royal marines, the contrast between
the two body-guards being very amusing. Muda Has-
sim is a wretched-looking, little man ; still there was ;i
courteous and gentle manner about him that prepossess-
ed us in his favor, and made us feel that we wore before
an individual who had been accustomed to command.
We took our seats in a semicircle, on chairs provided
for the occasion, and smoked cigars and drank tea. His
majesty chewed his sirih-leaf and betel-nut, seated with
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 221
one leg crossed under him, and playing \vil.4 his toes.
Very little is ever said during these audiences, so we
sat staring at one another for half an hour with mutual as-
tonishment ; and, after the usual compliments of wishing
our friendship might last as long as the moon, and my hav-
ing offered him the Dido and every thing else that did not
belong to me in exchange for his house, we took our leave.
May 19th. This was the day fixed for the rajah's
visit to the Dido, about which he appeared very anxious,
although he had seldom been known to go beyond his
own threshold For this ceremony all the boats, go3,
tom-toms, flags, and population were put in requisition^
and the procession to the ship was a very gorgeous and
amusing spectacle. We received him on board with a
royal salute. He brought in his train a whole tribe of
natural brothers. His guards and followers were strange
enough, and far too numerous to be admitted on the
Dido's deck, so that as soon as a sufficient number had
scrambled on board, the sentry had orders to prevent
any more from crowding in ; but whether, in so doing,
the most important personages of the realm were kept
out, we did not ascertain. One fellow succeeded in ob-
taining a footing with a large yellow silk canopy, a corn-
er of which having run into the eye of one of the mid-
shipmen, the bearer missed his footing, and down came
the whole concern as I was informed, by accident !
The party assembled in my cabin, and the remarks were
few, nor did they manifest great astonishment at any
thing. In fact, a Malay never allows himself to be tak-
en by surprise. I believe, however, the rajah did not
think much of my veracity, when I informed him that
this was not the largest ship belonging to her Britannic
majesty, and that she had several mounting upward of
100 guns, though he admitted that he had seen a grand-
er sight than any of his ancestors. There was much
distress depicted in the royal countenance during his
visit, which I afterward ascertained was owing to his
having been informed that he must not spit in my cabin.
On leaving the ship, whether the cherry brandy he had
taken made him forget the directions he had received,
I do not know, but he squirted a mouthful of red betel-
nut juice over the white deck, and then had the temer-
T2
222 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
ity to hold out his hand to the first lieutenant, who has-
tily applied to him the style (not royal) of" a dirty beast,"
which not understanding, he smiled graciously, taking
it as some compliment peculiar to the English.
This farce over, I had now some time to look about
me, and to refit my ship in one of the prettiest spots on
earth, and as unlike a dock-yard as any thing could be.
Mr. Brooke's then residence, although equally rude
in structure with the abodes of the natives, was not with-
out its English comforts of sofas, chairs, and bedsteads.
It was larger than any of the others, but being, like
them, built on piles, we had to mount a ladder to get
into it. It was situated on the same side of the river
(the right bank), next to, but rather in the rear of, the
rajah's palace, with a clear space of about 150 yards be-
tween the back and the edge of the jungle. It was sur-
rounded by palisades and a ditch, forming a protection
to sheep, goats, pigeons, cats, poultry, geese, monkeys,
dogs, ducks, and, occasionally, bullocks. The house con-
sisted of but one floor. A large room in the center, neat-
ly ornamented with every description of firearms, in
admirable order and ready for use, served as an audi-
ence and mess-room ; and the various apartments round
it as bed-rooms, most of them comfortably furnished
with matted floors, easy chairs, pictures, and books, with
much more taste and attention to comfort than bachelors
usually display. In one corner of the square formed by
the palisades were the kitchen and offices. The Euro-
peans with Mr. Brooke consisted of Mr. Douglas, for-
merly in the navy, a clever young surgeon, and a gen-
tleman of the name of Williamson, who, being master
of the native language, as well as active and intelligent,
made an excellent prime minister. Besides these were
two others, who came out in the yacht, one an old man-
of-war's man, who kept the arms in first-rate condition,
and another worthy character, who answered to the
name of Charley, and took care of the accounts and
charge of every thing. These were attended by serv-
ants of different nations. The cooking establishment
was perfect, and the utmost harmony prevailed. The
great feeding-time w;is at sunset, when Mr. Brooke took
his seal at tho lirml of the table, and nil fix 1
TO BOKNUU. 223
as in days of yore, seated themselves according
to their respective grades. This hospitable board was
open to all the officers of the Dido ; and many a jovial
evening we spent there. All Mr. Brooke's party were
characters all had traveled ; and never did a minute
flag for want of some entertaining anecdote, good story,
or song, to pass away the time ; and it was while smok-
ing our cigars in the evening that the natives, as well as
the Chinese who had become settlers, used to drop in,
and, after creeping up according to their custom, and
touching the hand of their European rajah, retire to the
further end of the room, and squat down upon their
haunches, remain a couple of hours without uttering a
word, and then creep out again. I have seen sixty or
seventy of an evening come in and make this sort of sa-
laam. All the Malays were armed ; and it is reckoned
an insult for one of them to appear before a rajah with-
out his kris. I could not help remarking the manly, in-
dependent bearing of the half-savage and nearly naked
mountain Dyak compared with the sneaking deport-
ment of the Malay.
The following little adventure was told me during my
stay at Sarawak, by Dr. Treacher, who had lately join-
ed Mr. Brooke, his former medical attendant having re-
turned to England. It appears that Dr. Treacher re-
ceived a message by a confidential slave that one of the
ladies of Macota's harem desired an interview, appoint-
ing a secluded spot in the jungle as the rendezvous.
The doctor, being aware of his own good looks, fancied
he had made a conquest, and, having got himself up as
showily as he could, was there at the appointed time.
He described the poor girl as both young and pretty,
but with a dignified and determined look, which at once
convinced him that she was moved to take so dangerous
a step by some deeper feeling than that of a mere fancy
for his person. She complained of the ill treatment she
had received from Macota, and the miserable life she led,
and avowed that her firm resolve was to destroy (not her-
self, gentle creature ! but) him ; for which purpose she
wanted a small portion of arsenic. It was a disappoint-
ment that he could not comply with her request ; so
they parted he full of pity and love for her, and she, in
224 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
all probability, full of contempt for a man who felt for her
wrongs, but would not aid in the very simple means she
had proposed for redressing them.
While at Singapore, Mr. Whitehead had kindly offer-
ed to allow his yacht, the Emily, a schooner of about
fifty tons, with a native crew, to bring our letters to Bor-
neo, on the arrival at Singapore of the mail from Eng-
land. About the time she was expected, I thought it
advisable to send a boat to cruise in the vicinity of Cape
Datu, in case of her falling in with any of these piratical
gentiy. The Dido's largest boat, the pinnace, being un-
der repair, Mr. Brooke lent a large boat which he had
had built by the natives at Sarawak, and called the Jolly
Bachelor. Having fitted her with a brass six-pounder
long gun, with a volunteer crew of a mate, two mid-
shipmen, six marines, and twelve seamen, and a fort-
night's provisions, I dispatched her under the command
of the second lieutenant, Mr. Hunt; Mr. Douglas, speak-
ing the Malayan language, likewise volunteered his serv-
ices. One evening, after they had been about six days
absent, while we were at dinner, young Douglas made
his appearance, bearing in his arms the captured colors
of an Illanun pirate. It appears that the day after they
had got outside they observed three boats a long way in
the offing, to which they gave chase, but soon lost sight
of them, owing to their superior sailing. They, how-
ever, appeared a second and a third time, after dark,
but without the Jolly Bachelor being able to get near
them; and it now being late, and the crew both fatigued
and hungry, they pulled inshore, lighted a fire, cooked
their provisions, and then hauled the boat out to her
grapnel, near some rocks, for the night ; lying down to
rest with their arms by their sides, and muskets round
the mast, ready loaded. Having also placed sentries and
look-out men, and appointed an officer of the watch,
they one and all (sentries included, I suppose), owing
to the fatigues of the day, fell asleep ! At about three
o'clock the following morning, the moon being just about
o rise, Lieut. Hunt happening to be awake, observed a
savage brandishing a kris, and performing his war-dance
on the bit of deck, in an ecstasy of delight, thinking, in
all probability, of thr> ruso -\virh wliifli lu> liml gol
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 225
session of a fine trading-boat, and calculating the cargo
of slaves he had to sell, but littlo dreaming of the horn-
ets' nest into which he had fallen. Lieut. Hunt's round
face meeting the light of the rising moon, without a tur-
b'ui surmounting it, was the first notice the pirate had
of his mistake. He immediately plunged overboard;
and before Lieut. Hunt had sufficiently recovered his
astonishment to know whether he was dreaming or not,
or to rouse his crew up, a discharge from three or four
cannon within a few yards, and the cutting through the
i-igging by the various missiles with which the guns
were loaded, soon convinced him there was no mistake.
It was as well the men were still lying down when this
discharge took place, as not one of them was hurt ; but
on jumping to their legs, they found themselves closely
pressed by two large war-prahus, one on each bow.
To return the fire, cut the cable, man the oars, and
back astern to gain room, was the work of a minute ;
but now came the tug of war ; it was a case of life and
death. Our men fought as British sailors ought to do ;
quarter was not expected on either side ; and the quick
and deadly aim of the marines prevented the pirates
from reloading their guns. The Illanun prahus are
built with strong bulwarks or barricades, grape-shot
proof, across the fore part of the boat, through which
ports are formed for working the guns ; these bulwarks
had to be cut away by round shot from the Jolly Bach-
elor before the musketry could bear effectually. This
done, the grape and canister told with fearful execution.
In the mean time, the prahus had been pressing forward
to board, while the Jolly Bachelor backed astern ; but,
as soon as this service was achieved, our men dropped
their oars, and, seizing their muskets, dashed on : the
work was sharp, but short, and the slaughter great.
While one pirate boat was sinking, and an effort made
to secure her, the other effected her escape by round-
ing the point of rocks, where a third and larger prahu,
hitherto unseen, came to her assistance, and putting
fresh hands on board, and taking her in tow, succeeded
in getting off, although chased by the Jolly Bachelor,
after setting fire to the crippled prize, which blew up
and sunk before the conquerors got back to the scene
15
226 . i'EJUlTlON TO BORNEO,
of action. While there, a man swam off to them from
the shore, who proved to be one of the captured slaves,
und had made his escape by leaping overboard during,
the fight. The three prahus were the same Illanun pi-
rates we had so suddenly come upon off Cape Datu in
the Dido, and they belonged to the same fleet that
Lieut. Horton had chased off the Island of Maruudum.
The slave prisoner had been seized, with a companion,
in a small fishing canoe, off Borneo Proper; his compan-
ion suffered in the general slaughter. The sight that
presented itself on our people boarding the captured boat
must indeed have been a frightful one. None of the
pirates waited on board for even the chanee of receiving
either quarter or mercy, but all those capable of moving
had thrown themselves into the water. In addition to
the killed, some lying across the thwarts, with their
oars in their hands, at the bottom of the prahu, in which
there was about three feet of blood and water, were seen
protruding the mangled remains of eighteen or twenty
bodies. During my last expedition I fell in with a slave
belonging to a Malay chief, one of our allies, who inform-
ed us that he likewise had been a prisoner, and pulled
an oar in one of the two prahus that attacked the Jolly
Bachelor; that none of the crew of the captured prahu
reached the shore alive, with the exception of the lad
that swam off to our people ; and that there were so
few who survived in the second prahu, that, having sep-
arated from their consort during the night, the slaves,
fifteen in number, rose and put to death the remaining
pirates, and then ran the vessel into the first rive;
reached, which proved to be the Kaleka, whore they
were seized, and became the property of the governing
Datu; and my informant was again sold to my compan-
ion, while on a visit to his friend the Datu. Each of
the attacking prahus had between fifty and sixty men,
including slaves, and the larger one between ninety and
a hundred. The result might have been veiy different
to our gallant but dosy Jolly Bachelors.
I have already mentioned the slaughter committed by
the fire of the pinnace, under Lieutenant Hurl on, into
the largest Malay prahu ; jind the account inven of the
\vliirli |ir<'
EXPEDITION TO BORN Kn. 221
pirate, when taken possession of, affords a striking proof
of .the character of these fierce rovers; resembling
greatly what wo read of the Norsemen and Scandina-
vians of early ages. Among the mortally wounded lay
the young commander of the prahu, one of the most no-
ble forms of the human race ; his countenance handsome
as the hero of Oriental romance, and his whole bearing
wonderfully impressive and touching. lie was shot in
front and through the lungs, and his last moments wero
rapidly approaching. He endeavored to speak, but the
blood gushed from his mouth with the voice he vainly
essayed to utter in words. Again and again he tried,
but again and again the vital fluid drowned the dying
effort. He looked as if he had something of importance
which he desired to communicate, and a shade of disap-
pointment and regret passed over his brow when he felt
that every essay was unavailing, and that his manly
strength and daring spirit were dissolving into the dark
night of death. The pitying conquerors raised him
gently up, and he was seated in comparative ease, for
the welling out of the blood was less distressing ; but the
end speedily came : he folded his arms heroically across
his wounded breast, fixed his eyes upon the British sea-
men around, and, casting one last glance at the ocean
the theater of his daring exploits, on which he had so
often fought and triumphed expired without a sigh.
The spectators, though not unused to tragical and
sanguinary sights, were unanimous in speaking of the
death of the pirate chief as the most affecting spectacle
they had ever witnessed. A sculptor might have carved
him as an Antinous in the mortal agonies of a Dying
Gladiator.
The leaders of the piratical prahus are sometimes
poetically addressed by their followers as Matari, i. o.,
the sun ; or Bulan, the moon ; and from his superiority
in every respect, physical and intellectual, the chief
whose course was here so fatally closed seemed to be
Worthy of either celestial name.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
CHAPTER XVI.
The Rajah's letter to Captain Keppel, and his reply. Prepares
for an expedition against the Sarebus pirates. Pleasure excur-
sion up the river. The Chinese settlement. The Sing6 moun-
tain. Interior of the residences. Dyak festival of Maugut.
Relics. Sporting. Return to Sarawak. The expedition
against Sarebus. State and number of the assailing force.
Ascent, of the river. Beauty of the scenery.
May 21st. I received intimation that the rajah had
written a letter, and wished me to appoint a time and
place, that it might be presented in due form. Accord-
ingly I attended in Mr. Brooke's hall of audience on the
following day, where I found collected all the chiefs,
and a crowd of natives, many of them having already
been informed that the said letter was a requisition for
me to assist in putting down the hordes of pirates who
had so long infested the coast. I believe many of those
present, especially the Borneons, to have been casually
concerned, if not deeply implicated, in some of their
transactions. After I had taken my seat with Mr.
Brooke at the head of the table, the rajah's sword-bearers
entered, clearing the way for the huge yellow canopy,
under the shade of which, on a large brass tray, and
carefully sewn up in a yellow silk bag, was the letter,
from which it was removed, and placed in my hands by
the Pangeran Budrudeen. I opened the bag with my
knife, and giving it to an interpreter, he read it aloud in
the Malayan tongue. It was variously received by the
Miidience, many of whose countenances were far from
prepossessing.
The following is a copy of the letter, to which was
affixed the rajah's seal :
" This friendly epistle, having its source in a pure minil,
comes from Rajah Muda Hassim, next in succession to the
royal throne of the kingdom of Borneo, and who now holds
his court at the trading city of Sarawak, to our friend J Ic'iiry
Keppel, head captain of the war-frigate Ix-longing to IHM-
Britannic Majesty, renowned throughout all c.oiuitrics who
is valiant and discreet, and endowed with a mild and gcnilr
nature :
iiXl'KDITION TO NORM
" This is ID inform our friend that there are certain
pirates, of the people of Sarebus and Sakarran, in our neigh-
borhood, seizing goods and murdering people on the high
seas. They have more than three hundred war-prahtis, and
extend their ravages even to Banjarmassim ; they are not
subject to the government of Bruni (Borneo) ; they take
much plunder from vessels trading between Singapore and
the good people of our country.
" It would be a great service if our friend would adopt
measures to put an end to these piratical outrages.
" We can present nothing better to our friend than a kris,
such as it is.
" 90th day of Rabial Akhir, 1257."
To which I sent the following reply :
" Captain Keppel begs to acknowledge the receipt of the
Rajah Muda Hassim's letter, representing that the Dyaks of
Sarebus and Sakarran are the pirates who infest the coast of
Borneo, and do material damage to the trade of Singapore.
" Captain Keppel will take speedy measures to suppress
these and all other pirates, and feels confident that her
Britannic Majesty will be glad to learn that the Rajah Muda
Hassim is ready to cooperate in so laudable an undertaking."
Not being prepared for the oriental fashion of ex-
changing presents, I had nothing to offer to his rajah-
ship ; but I found out afterward that Mr. Brooke had
(unknown to me) sent him a clock in my name. The
royal kris was handsome, the handle of carved ivory,
with a good deal of gold about it.
This information about the pirates gave me good
ground to make a beginning ; and having arranged with
Mr. Brooke to obtain all necessary intelligence relative
to their position, strength, and numbers,* I determined
on attacking them in their strongholds, commencing with
the Sarebus, who, from all accounts, were by far the
* Piratical habits are so interwoven with the character of these
Sarebus people, that the capture at sea of a few prahus would
have but small effect in curing the evil ; while a harassing duty
is encountered, the result is only to drive the pirates from one
cruising-ground to another ; but, on the contrary, a system which
joins conciliation with severity, aiming at the correction of the
native character as well as the suppression of piracy, and carry-
ing punishment to the doors of the offenders, is the only one which
can effectually eradicate an evil almost as disgraceful to those
who permit it as to the native states engaged in it.
230 EXPEDITION TO
most strongly fortified. Mr. Brooke accepted my invi-
tation to accompany us, as well as to supply a native
force of about three hundred men, who, should we suc-
ceed in the destruction of the pirate forts, would be
useful in the jungle. Mr. Brooke's going to join per
sonally in a war against (in the opinion of the Datus)
such formidable opponents as the Sakarran and Sarebus
pirates who had never yet been conquered, although
repeatedly attacked by the united forces of the surround-
ing rajahs was strongly opposed by the chiefs. On his
informing them that he should go, but leaving it optional
whether they would accompany him or not, their simple
reply was, " What is the use of our remaining ? If you
die, we die ; and if you live, we live ; we will go with
you." Preparations for the expedition were accord-
ingly commenced.
No place could have suited us better for a refit. Within
a few yards of the ship was a Chinese woi'kshop. Our
boats were hauled up to repair under sheds, and we
drew our fresh water alongside ; and while the Dido was
at Sarawak, Mr. Jago, the carpenter, built a very beau-
tiful thirty-foot gig, having cut the plank up in the Chi-
naman's sawpit.
While these works were in progress, I accompanied
Mr. Brooke up the river. The Royalist having been
dispatched to Singapore with our letters, we started on
our pleasure-excursion. With the officers from the
Dido and the chiefs, who always accompany the " Tuan
Besar," we mustered about sixty persons ; and with our
guns, walking-sticks, cigars, and a well-supplied com-
missariat, determined to enjoy ourselves.
We were not long in making the acquaintances of the
chiefs. Men who had formerly rebelled, who were
conquered by Mr. Brooke, and had their (forfeited) lives
saved, their families restored to them, and themselves
finally reinstated in the offices they had previously held
these men were very naturally and faithfully attached.
Our young gentlemen found their Malayan names diffi-
cult to remember, so that the gallant old Patingi AH was
seldom called any other name than that of " Three-
Fingered Jack," from his having lost part of his right
hand; the Tumangongwas spoken of as thn "Father of
EU>MM1<
Hoprlul," I'roui one of his children, a lim- lilil" hlli>\v.
whom he was foolishly attached to, and seldom seen
without.
Der Macota, who had somotime before received the
appellation of " the Serpent," had, ever since he got his
orders to quit, some six months before, been preparing
his boats, but which were ready iu an incredibly short
time after the Dido's arrival ; and thus Mr. Brooke got
rid of that most intriguing and troublesome rascal ; a
person who had, from the commencement, been trying
to supplant and ruin him. He it was that gave the Sa-
karran pirates permission to ascend the river for the
purpose of attacking the comparatively defenceless moun-
tain Dyaks ; and he it was that persecuted the unfortu-
nate young Illanun chief, Si Tundo, even to his assassi-
nation. He was at last got rid of from Sarawak, but
only to join and plan mischief with that noted piratical
chief, Seriff Sahib ; he, however, met his deserts.
We ascended the river in eight or ten boats. The
scene to us was most novel, and particularly fresh and
beautiful. We stopped at an empty house on a cleared
spot on the left bank during the ebb-tide, to cook our
dinner ; in the cool of the afternoon we proceeded with
the flood ; and late in the evening brought up for the
night in a snug little creek close to the Chinese settle-
ment. We slept in native boats, which were nicely and
jcomfortably fitted for the purpose. At an early hour
Mr. Brooke was waited on by the chief of the Kunsi ;
.and on visiting their settlement he was received with a
salute of three guns. We found it kept in their usual
neat and clean order, particularly their extensive vege-
table gardens ; but being rather pressed for time, we did
not visit the mines, but proceeded to the villages of dif-
ferent tribes of Dyaks living on the Sarambo mountain,
numbers of whom had been down to welcome us, very
gorgeously dressed in feathers and scarlet.
The foot of the mountain was about four miles from
the landing-place ; and a number of these kind savages
voluntarily shouldered our provisions, beds, bags, and
Jraggage, and we proceeded on our march. We did, not
xpect to find quite a turnpike-road ; but, at the same
time, I, for one, was not prepared for the dance led us
232 Kxi'fliiiTfox ro B
by our wild cat-like guides through thick jungle, am!
alternately over rocky hills, or up to our middles in the
soft marshes we had to cross. Our only means of doing
so was by feeling on the surface of the mud (it being
covered in most places about a foot deep with grass or
discolored water) for light spars thrown along length-
wise and quite unconnected, while our only support
was an occasional stake at irregular distances, at which
we used to rest, as the spars invariably sunk into the
mud if we attempted to stop ; and there being a long
string of us, many a fall and flounder in the mud (gun
and all) was the consequence.
The ascent of the hill, although as steep as the side
of a house, was strikingly beautiful. Our resting-places,
unluckily, were but few; but when we did reach one,
the cool, fresh breeze, and the increasing extent and
variety of scene our view embracing, as it did, all the
varieties of river, mountain, wood, and sea amply re-
paid us for the exertion of the lower walk ; and, on
either hand, we were sure to have a pure cool rivulet
tumbling over the rocks. While going up, however, our
whole care and attention were requisite to secure our
own safety ; for it is not only one continued climb up lad-
ders, but such ladders ! They are made of the single trunk
of a tree in its rough and rounded state, with notches, not
cut at the reasonable distance apart of the ratlins of our
rigging, but requiring the knee to be brought up to the
level of the chin before the feet are sufficiently parted
to reach from one step to another ; and that, when the
muscles of the thigh begin to ache, and the wind is
pumped out of the body, is distressing work.
We mounted, in this manner, some 500 feet ; and it
was up this steep that Mr. Brooke had ascended only a
few months before, with two hundred followers, to at-
tack the Singe Dyaks. He has already described the
circular halls of these Dyaks, in one of which we were
received, hung round, as the interior of it is, with hun-
dreds of human heads, most of them dried with the skin
and hair on ; and to give them, if possible, a more ghastly
appearance, small shells (the cowry) are inserted where
the eyes once were, and tufts of dried grass protrude
from the cars. I5ut my eyes soon r<'w accustomed to
EXPEDITION TO BORNi;<>. 233
the sight ; and by the time dinner was ready (I think I
may say we) thought no more about them than if they
had been as many cocoa-nuts.
Of course the natives crowded round us ; and I no-
ticed that with these simple people it was much the
same as with the more civilized, and that curiosity was
strongest in the gentler sex ; and again, that the young
men came in more gorgeously dressed, wearing feath-
ers, necklaces, armlets, ear-rings, bracelets, beside
jackets of various-colored silks, and other vanities than
the older and wiser chiefs, who encumbered themselves
with no more dress than what decency actually re-
quired, and were, moreover, treated with the greatest
respect.
Wo strolled about from house to house without caus-
ing the slightest alarm : in all we were welcomed, and
invited to squat ourselves on their mats with the fam-
ily. The women, who were some of them very good-
looking, did not run from us as the plain-headed
Malays would have done ; but laughed and chatted
to us by signs in all the consciousness of innocence and
virtue.
"We were fortunate in visiting these Dyaks during one
of their grand festivals (called Maugut) ; and in the
evening, dancing, singing, and drinking were going on in
various parts of the village. In one house there was a
grand fete, in which the women danced with the men.
The dress of the women was simple and curious a
light jacket open in front, and a short petticoat not com-
ing below the knees, fitting close, was hung round with
jingling bits of brass, which kept "making music"
wherever they went. The movement was like all
other native dances graceful, but monotonous. There
were four men, two of them bearing human sculls, and
two the fresh heads of pigs ; the women bore wax-lights,
or yellow rice on brass dishes. They danced in line, moving
backward and forward, and carrying the heads and dishes
in both hands ; the graceful part was the manner in
which they half turned the body to the right and left,
looking over their shoulders and holding the heads in the
opposite direction, as if they were in momentary expec-
tation-of some one coming up behind to snatch the nasty
U2
234 Exi-Knn K.\ ro HORNEO.
relic from them. At times the women knelt down in a
group, with the men leaning over them. After all, the
music was not the only thing wanting to make one imagine
oneself at the opera. The necklaces of the women were
chiefly of teeth bears' the most common human the
most prized.
In an interior house at one end were collected the
relics of the tribe. These consisted of several round-
looking stones, two deer's heads, and other inferior trum-
pery. The stones turn black if the tribe is to be beaten
in war, and red if to be victorious : any one touching
them would be sure to die ; if lost, the tribe would be
ruined.
The account of the deer's heads is still more curious :
A young Dyak having dreamed the previous night that
he should become a great warrior, observed two deer
swimming across the river, and killed them ; a storm
came on with thunder and lightning, and darkness came
over the face of the earth ; he died immediately, but
came to life again, and became a rumah guna (literally
a useful house) and chief of his tribe ; the two deer still
live, and remain to watch over the affairs of the tribe.
These heads have descended from their ancestors from
the time when they first became a tribe and inhabited
the mountain. Food is always kept placed before them,
and renewed from time to time. While in the circular
building, which our party named " the scullery," a young
chief (Meta) seemed to take great pride in answering our
interrogatories respecting different skulls which we took
down from their hooks : two belonged to chiefs of a tribe
who had made a desperate defence ; and judging from
the incisions on the heads, each of which must have been
mortal, it must have been a desperate affair. Among
other trophies was half a head, the skull separated from
across between the eyes, in the same manner that
you would divide that of a hare or rabbit to get at the
brain this was their division of the head of an old wo-
man, which was taken when another (a friendly) tribe
was present, who likewise claimed their half. 1 after-
ward saw these tribes share a head. But tho skulls,
the account of which our informant appeared to dwell
on with the greatest delight, were those which won*
EXPEDITION I'n ISiiUNEO.
l;ikMi \vl i ilc the owners were asleep cunning with them
being the perfection of warfare. We slept in their
"scullery;" and my servant Ashford, who happened
to be a sleep-walker, that night jumped out of the win-
dow, and unluckily on the steep side ; and had not the
ground been well turned up by the numerous pigs, and
softened by rain, he must have been hurt.
May 25th. Having returned to our boats, we moved
up another branch of the river, for the purpose of deer-
shooting, and landed under some large shady trees.
The sportsmen divided into two small parties, and,
under the guidance of the natives, went in search of
game, leaving the remainder of the party to prepare
dinner against our return.
The distance we had to walk to get to our ground
was what our guides considered nothing some five
miles through jungle ; and one of the most distressing
parts in jungle-walking is the having to climb over the
fallen trunks of immense trees.
A short time before sunset we came to a part of the
jungle that opened on to a large swamp, with long rank
grass about six feet high, across which was a sort of
Dyak bridge. The guide having made signs for me to
advance, I cautiously crept to the edge of the jungle ;
and after some little trouble, and watching the direction
of his finger, I observed the heads of two deer, male
and female, protruding just above the grass at about
sixty yards' distance. From the manner the doe was
moving about her long ears, it had, to my view, all the
appearance of a rabbit. Shooting for the pot, I selected
her. As soon as I fired, some of my boat's crew made
a dash into the grass ; and in an instant three of them
were nearly up to their chins in mud and water, and
we had some difficulty in dragging them out. Our
Malay guide more knowingly crossed the bridge ; and
being acquainted with the locality," reached the deer
from the opposite side, taking care to utter a prayer and
cut the throat with the head in the direction of the
Prophet's tomb at Mecca, without which ceremony no
true follower of Islam could partake of the meat. The
doe was struck just below the ear ; and my native com-
panion appeared much astonished nt the distance and
EXPEDITION TO Hol.'MKu.
deadly effect with which my smooth-bored Wcstley
Richards had conveyed the ball.
The buck had got oft* before the smoke had cleared
sufficiently for me to see him. From what I had
heard, I was disappointed at not seeing more game.
The other party had not killed anything, although
they caught a little fawn, having frightened away the
mother.
My time was so occupied during my stay in Borneo,
that I am unable to give any account of the sport to be
found in the island. Neither had Mr. Brooke seen
much of it ; unless an excursion or two he had made
in search of new specimens of the ourang-outang, or
mias, may be brought under that head. This excursion
he performed not only with the permission and under
the protection, but as the guest, of the piratical chief
Seriff Sahib ; little thinking that, in four years after-
ward, he would himself, as a powerful rajah, be the
cause of destroying his town, and driving him from the
country.
So much for sporting. The pleasure, I believe, in-
creases in proportion to the risk. But, while on the
subject, I may mention that of pig-shooting, which I
found an amusement not to be despised, especially if
you approach your game before life is extinct. The
jaws are long, tusks also, and sharp as a razor ; and
when once wounded, the animals evince a strong incli-
nation to return the compliment : they are active, cun-
ning, and very fast. I shot several at different times.
The natives also describe a very formidable beast, the
size of a large bullock, found farther to the northward,
which they appear to hold in great dread. This I con-
ceive to be a sort of bison ; and if so, the sporting in
Borneo altogether is not so bad.
The following day we went to other ground for deer;
but the Dyaks had now enjoyed peace so long that the
whole country was in a state of cultivation ; and after
scrambling over tracts of wild-looking country, in which
Mr. Brooke, two years before, had seen the deer in
hundreds, we returned to our boats, niid down the
river to Sarawak.
We now began to prepare in earnest for work of an-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 237
other sort. The news of our intended attack on the
Sarebus pirates had soon reached them, and spread all
over the country ; and we had daily accounts of the for-
midable resistance they intended to make. By the 4th
July our preparations were complete, and the ship had
dropped down to the mouth of the river. I forgot to
mention that all the adjoining seriffs had, in the greatest
consternation, sent me assurances of their future good
intentions. Seriff Jaffer, who lived with an industrious
but warlike race of Dyaks up the Linga river, a branch
of the Batang Lupar, had never been known to commit
piracy, and had been frequently at war with both the
Sarebus and Sakarrans, offered to join our expedition.
From Seriff Sahib, who lived up a river at Sadong, ad-
joining the Sarebus territory, and to whom the " Ser-
pent" Macota had gone, Mr. Brooke and myself had
invitations to partake of a feast on our way to the Sare-
bus river. This was accompanied with a present of a
couple of handsome spears and a porcupine, and also an
offer to give up the women and children he had, with
the assistance of the Sakarran pirates, captured from
the poor Sow Dyaks up the Sarawak.
Farther to the eastward, and up the Batang Lupar,
into which the Sakarran runs, lived another powerful
seriff by the name of Muller, elder brother and coadjutor
of Seriff Sahib. These all, however, through fear at
the moment, sent in submissive messages ; but their
turn had not yet come, and we proceeded toward the
Sarebus.
The island of Burong, off which the Dido was to re-
main at anchor, we made the first place of rendezvous.
The force from the Dido consisted of her pinnace, two
cutters, and a gig ; beside which Mr. Brooke lent us his
native-built boat, the Jolly Bachelor, carrying a long six-
pounder brass gun and thirty of our men ; also a large
tope of thirty-five tons, which earned a well-supplied
commissariat, as well as ammunition.
The native force was extensive ; but I need only
mention the names of those from Sarawak. The three
chiefs (the Tumangong and two Patingis, Gapoor and
Ali) had two large boats, each carrying about 180 men.
Then there w;is the rajah's large, heavy boat, with the
238 EXPEDITION TO BOltNEO.
rascally Borneons and about 40 men, and sundry other
Sarawak boats ; and, beside, a Dyak force of about 400
men from the different tribes of Lundu, Sow, Singe,
&c. Of course, it caused some trouble to collect this
wild, undisciplined armament, and two or three succes-
sive points of rendezvous were necessary ; and it was
the morning of the 8th before we entered the river.
Lieutenant Wilmot Horton was to command the expe-
dition ; with him, in the pinnace, were Mr. W. L.
Partridge, mate ; Dr. Simpson, assistant-surgeon ; Mr.'
Hallowes, midshipman ; 14 seamen, and 5 marines. In
the first cutter was Mr. D'Aeth, Mr. Douglas, from
Sarawak, and Mr. Collins, the boatswain ; in the second
cutter, Mr. Elliott, the master, and Mr. Jenkins, mid-
shipman. The Jolly Bachelor was commanded by
Lieutenant Tottenham, and Mr. Comber, midshipman,
with Mr. Brooke's medical friend, Dr. Treacher, and
an amateur gentleman, Mr. Ruppel, from Sarawak.
The force from the Dido was about 80, officers and
men. The command of the boats, when sent away
from a man-of-war, is the perquisite of the first lieuten-
ant. My curiosity, however, would not allow me to
resist the temptation of attending the party in my gig ;
and I had my friend Mr. Brooke as a companion, who
was likewise attended by a sampan and crew he had
taken with him to Sarawak from Singapore. His cox-
swain, Seboo, we shall all long remember : he was civil
only to his master, and, I believe, brave while in his
company. He was a stupid-looking and powerfully-
built sort of savage, always praying, eating, smiling, or
sleeping. When going into action, he always went
down on his knees to pray, holding his loaded musket
before him. He was, however, a curious character,
and afforded us great amusement took good care oi
himself and his master, but cared for no one else.
In the second gig was Lieutenant E. Guunell, whoso
troublesome duty it was to preserve order throughout
this extensive musketoe fleet, and to keep the natives
from pressing too closely on the rear of our boats an
office which became less troublesome us we appro;i<:h<>,d
the scene of danger. The whole formed a novel, pic-
( ure;(jiie, iind exriliii" scene; -mil it \va - < 'iinni; !n
EXPEDITION TO BOKNEO. 2&J
contemplate the different feelings that actuated the sep-
arate and distinct parties the odd mixture of Euro-
peans, Malays, and Dyaks, the different religions, and
the eager and anxious manner in which all pressed for-
ward. The novelty of the thing was quite sufficient to
excite our Jacks, after having been cooped up so long
on board ship, to say nothing of the chance of a broken
head.
Of the Malays and Dyaks who accompanied us, some
"came from curiosity, some from attachment to Mr.
Brooke, and many for plunder, but I think the majority
to gratify revenge, as there were but few of the inhabi-
tants on the north coast of Borneo who had not suffered
more or less from the atrocities of the Sarebus and Sa-
karran pirates either their houses burned, their rela-
tions murdered, or their wives and children captured
and sold into slavery.
. We did not get far up the river the first day, as the
tope was very slow, and carried that most essential part
of all expeditions, the commissariat. Patingi Ali, who
had been sent the day before to await the force in the
mouth of the Sarebus, fell in with five or six native
boats, probably on the look-out for us, to which he gave
chase, and captured one, the rest retreating up the
river.
On the 9th June, 1843, we had got some thirty miles
in the same direction ; every thing was in order ; and,
as we advanced, I pulled from one end of my little fleet
to the other, and felt much the same sort of pride as
Sir William Parker must have experienced when lead-
ing seventy-five sail of British ships up the Yeang-tse
Keang river into the very heart of the Celestial Empire.
It rained hard ; but we were well supplied with kajans,
a mat admirably adapted to keep out the wet ; and se-
curely covered in, my gig had all the appearance of a
native boat, especially as I had substituted paddles for
oars. In this manner I frequently went a little in ad-
vance of the force ; and on the 9th I came on a couple
of boats, hauled close in under the jungle, apparently
perfectly unconscious of my approach. I concluded
them to bo part of the small fleet of boats that had been
I, the previous day, in the mouth of tho river ; and
240 iHTloN TO UOllNliO.
when abreast of them, and within range, I fired from
my rifle. The crews of each boat immediately precipi-
tated themselves into the water, and escaped into the
iungle. They were so closely covered in, that I did
not see any one at first ; but I found that my ball had
passed through both sides of an iron kettle, in which
they were boiling some rice. How astonished the cook
must have been ! On coming up, our Dyak followers
dashed into the jungle in pursuit of the fugitives, but
without success.
We moved on leisurely with the flood-tide, anchoring
always on the ebb, by which means we managed to col-
lect our stragglers and keep the force together. Toward
the evening, by the incessant sound of distant gongs, we
were aware that our approach was known, and that prep-
arations were making to repel us. These noises were
kept up all night ; and we occasionally heard the distant
report of ordnance, which was fired, of course, to intim-
idate us. During the day, several deserted boats were
taken from the banks of the river and destroyed, some
of them containing spears, shields, and ammunition, with
a few fire-arms.
The place we brought up at for the night was called
Boling ; but here the river presented a troublesome and
dangerous obstacle in what is called the bore, caused by
the tide coming in with a tremendous rush, as if an
immense wave of the sea had suddenly rolled up the
stream, and, finding itself confined on either side, ex-
tended across, like a high bank of water, curling and
breaking as it went, and, from the frightful velocity with
which it passes up, carrying all before it. There are,
however, certain bends of the river where the bore does
not break across : it was now our business to look out
for and gain these spots between the times of its activ-
ity. The natives hold them in great dread.
From Boling the river becomes less deep, and not safe
for large boats ; so that here we were obliged to leave
our tope with the commissariat, and a sufficient force
for her protection, as we had received information that
thirteen piratical boats had boon some time cruising out-
side, and were daily expected up the river on iheir re-
turn, when our unguarded tope would h;ive made them
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 241
an acceptable prize. In addition to this, we were now
fairly in the enemy's country: mid for all we knew,
hundreds of canoes might have been hid in the jungle,
ready to lanch. Just below Boling, the river branches
oft' to the right and left; that to the left leading to
another nest of pirates at Pakoo, who are (by land) in
communication with those of Paddi, the place it was our
intention to attack first.
Having provisioned our boats for six days, and provi-
ded a strong guard to remain with the tope, the native
force not feeling themselves safe separated from the
main body, we started, a smaller and more select party
than before, but, in my opinion, equally formidable, leav-
ing about 150 men. This arrangement gave but little
satisfaction to those left behind, our men not liking to
exchange an expedition where a fight was certain, for a
service in which it was doubtful, although their position
was one of danger, being open to attack from three dif-
ferent parts of the river. Our party now consisted of
the Dido's boats, the three Datus from Sarawak, and
some Sow Dyaks, eager for heads and plunder. We
arrived at our first resting-place early in the afternoon,
and took up a position in as good order as the small
space would admit.
I secured my gig close to the bank, under the shade
of a large tree, at some little distance from the fleet of
boats ; and, by myself, contemplated my novel position
in command of a mixed force of 500 men, some sev-
enty miles up a river in the interior of Borneo ; on the
moiTow about to cany all the horrors of war among a
race of savage pirates, whose country no force had ever
yet dared to invade, and who had been inflicting with
impunity eveiy sort of cruelty on all whom they en-
countered, for more than a century.
As the sun went down, the scene was beautiful, ani-
mated by the variety and picturesque appearance of the
native prahus, and the praying of the Mussulman, with
his face in the direction of the Prophet's tomb, bowing
his head to the deck of his boat, and absorbed in devo-
tions from which nothing could withdraw his attention.
For a time it being that for preparing the evening
meal no noise was made : it was n perfect calm ; and
J6 X
242 EXPEDITION TO HORN I
the rich foliage was reflected in the water us in u mirror,,
while a small cloud of smoke ascended from each boat,
to say nothing of that from my cigar, which added much
to the charm I then experienced.
Late in the evening, when the song and joke passed
from boat to boat, and the lights from the different fires
were reflected in the water, the scenery was equally
pleasing ; but later still, when the lights were out, there
being no moon, and the fcanks overhung with trees, it
was so dark that no one could see beyond his own bout.
A little after midnight, a small boat was heard passing
up the river, and was regularly hailed by us in succes-
sion ; to which they replied, " We belong to your party."
And it was not until the yell of triumph, given by six or
eight voices, after they had (with a strong flood-tide in
their favor) shot past the last of our boats, that we found
how we had been imposed on.
CHAPTER XVII.
Ascent of the river to Paddi. Town taken and burnt. Narrow
escape of a reinforcement of friendly Dyaks. Night-attack
by the pirates. Conference : they submit. Proceed against
Pakoo. Dyak treatment of dead enemies. Destruction of
Pakoo, and submission of the pirates. Advance upon Rem-
bas. The town destroyed : the inhabitants yield. Satisfactory
effects of the expedition. Death of Dr. Simpson. Triumph-
ant return to Sarawak.
June Hth. We moved on immediately alter the pass-
ing up of the bore, the dangers of which appeared to
have been greatly exaggerated. The benting of gongs
and discharge of cannon had been going on the whole
of the previous night.
The scenery improved in beauty eveiy yard that we
advanced ; but our attention was drawn from it by the
increase of yelling as wo approached the scene* of action.
Although as yet we had only heard onr enemies, our
rapid advance with a strong tide must have her!
by them from the jungle on the various hills which now
rose to our view.
in my g\<j.. somewhat aliend ofthobontfr ' h;i.< 1
KXl'KIU TluN TO BORNEO. '1 ['!
the advantage of observing ;ill that occurred. The scene
was the most exciting I ever experienced. We had no
time for delay or consideration : the tide was sweeping
us rapidly up ; and had we been inclined to retreat then,
we should have found it difficult. A sudden turn in the
river brought us (Mr. Brooke was by my side) in front
of a steep hill which rose from the bank. It had been
cleared of jungle, and long grass grew in its place. As
we hove in sight, several hundred savages rose up, and
gave one of their war-yells : it was the first I had heard.
No report from musketry or ordnance could ever make
a man's heart feel so small as mine did at that horrid
yell : but I had no leisure to think. I had only time for
a shot at them with my double barrel, as they rushed
down the steep, while I was carried past. I soon after
heard the report of our large boat's heavy gun, which
must have convinced them that we likewise were pre-
pared.
On the roof of a long building, on the summit of the
hill, were several warriors performing a war-dance,
which it would be difficult to imitate" on such a stage.
As these were not the forts we were in search of, we
did not delay longer than to exchange a few shots in
sweeping along.
Our next obstacle was more troublesome, being a strong
barrier right across the river, formed of two rows of
trees placed firmly in the mud, with their tops crossed
and secured together by ratans ; and along the fork,
formed by the crossing of the tops of these stakes, were
other trees firmly secured. Rapidly approaching this
barrier, I observed a small opening that might probably
admit a canoe; and gathering good way, and putting my
gig's head straight at it, I squeezed through. On pass-
ing it the scene again changed, and I had before me three
formidable-looking forts, which lost not a moment in
opening a discharge of cannon on my unfortunate gig.
Luckily their guns were properly elevated for the range
of the barrier ; and, with the exception of a few strag-
gling grape-shot that splashed the water round us, the
whole went over our heads. For a moment I found my-
self cut off from my companions, and drifting fast upon
the enemy. The banks of the river were covered with
244 KXi'EDlTlON TO BORNEO.
warriors, yelling and rushing down to possess themselves
of my boiit and its crew. 1 had some difficulty in get-
ting' my long gig round, and paddling up against the
stream ; but, while my friend Brooke steered the boat,
my cockswain and myself kept up a fire with tolerable
aim on the embrasures, to prevent, if possible, their re-
loading before the pinnace, our leading boat, could bring
her twelve-pound carronade to bear. I was too late to
prevent the pinnace falling athwart the barrier, in which
position she had three men wounded. With the assist-
ance of some of our native followers, the ratan-lashings
which secured the heads of the stakes were soon cut
through ; and I was not sorry when I found the Dido's
first cutter on the same side with myself. The other
boats soon followed ; and while the pinnace kept up a
destructive fire on the fort, Mr. D'Aeth, who was the
first to land, jumped on shore, witli his crew, at the foot
of the hill on the top of which the nearest fort stood, and
at once rushed for tile summit. This mode of warfare
this dashing at once in the very face of their fort
was so novel and incomprehensible to our enemies, that
they fled, panic-struck, into the jungle ; and it was with
the greatest difficulty that our leading men could get
even a snap-shot at the rascals as they went.
That evening the country was illuminated for miles by
the burning of the capital, Paddi, and adjacent villages ;
at which work, and plundering, our native followers were
most expert.
At Paddi the river branches oft' to the right and left ;
and it was on the tongue of land formed by them that
the forts were very cleverly placed. We took all their
guns, and burned the stockades level with the ground.
The banks of the river were here so confined, that a
man might with ease throw a spear across ; and, as the
jungle was close, it was necessary to keep pretty well
on the alert. For the greater part of the night, the
burning of the houses made it as bright as day. In the
evening,'Drs. Simpson and Treacher amputated a poor
fellow's arm close to the shoulder, which, in the cramp-
ed space of the boat, was no easy operation. He was
one of our best men, and captain of the forecastle on
board the Dido
EXPEDITION TO BORNF.n. 245
Early on the following morning (12th) our boats, with
the exception of the Jolly Bachelor, now become the
hospital, proceeded up the two branches of the river ;
almost all the native force remaining to complete the
work of destruction.
An accident had nearly occurred at this period. A re-
port had reached us that several large boats supposed
to be a fleet of Sarebus pirates returning from a cruise
were in the river; and knowing that they could not well
attack and pass our force at Boling without our hearing
of it, I took no further notice of the rumor, intending to
go down in my gig afterward and have a look at them.
While we were at breakfast in the Jolly Bachelor, a
loud chattering of many voices was heard, attended by a
great beating of tom-toms ; and suddenly a large prahu,
crowded with savages, came sweeping round the bend
of the river, rapidly nearing us with a strong flood-tide.
As she advanced, others hove in sight. In a moment
pots and spoons were thrown down, arms seized, and
the brass six-pounder, loaded with grape and canister,
was on the point of being fired, when Williamson, the
only person who understood their character, made us
aware that they were a friendly tribe of Dyaks, from the
River Linga, coming to our assistance, or, more likely,
coming to seek for plunder and the heads of their ene-
mies, with whom they had for many years been at war.
Those in the leading boat had, however, a narrow escape.
I had already given the order to fire; but luckily the
priming had been blown off from the six-pounder. Had
it not been so, fifty at least out of the first hundred
would have been sent to their long homes. They were
between eight and nine hundred strong. The scene to
me was indeed curious and exciting: for the wild ap-
pearance of these fellows exceeded any thing I had yet
witnessed. Their war-dresses each decorating him-
self according to his own peculiar fancy, in a costume
the most likely at once to adorn the wearer and strike
teiTor into the enemy made a remarkable show. Each
had a shield and a handful of spears ; about one in ten
was furnished with some sort of firearm, which was
of more danger to himself or bis neighbor than to any
X 2
^40 'KIHTIo.N TO BORNEO.
one else. They wore short padded jackets, capable of
resisting the point of a wooden spear.
The first thing necessary was to supply each with u
strip of white calico, to be worn in the head-dress as a
distinguishing mark, to prevent our people knocking them
over if met by accident while prowling about the jungle.
We also established a watch word, " Datu," which many
of them, who had great dread of the white men, never
ceased to call out. Sheriff J 'after, in command of their
force, had promised to join us from the beginning; but
as they did not make their appearance off the mouth of
the river, we thought no more of them. It was neces-
sary to dispatch messengers up the rivers to inform our
boats of this re-enforcement, as in all probability an attack
would have been made immediately on the appearing in
sight of so formidable a force.
At 10 A.M. our boats returned, having gone up the
right-hand branch as far as it was practicable. That to
the left having been obstructed by trees felled across the
stream, was considered, from the trouble taken to pre-
vent our progress, to be the branch up which the ene-
my had retreated, and not being provisioned for more
than the day, they came back, and started again in the
afternoon with the first of the flood-tide. Of this party
Lieutenant Horton took charge, accompanied by Mr.
Brooke. It was a small, but an effective, and determined,
and well-appointed little body, not likely to be deterred
by difficulties. A small native force of about forty men
accompanied them, making, with our own, between
eighty and ninety people. The forts having been de-
stroyed, no further obstacles were expected to our ad-
vance beyond the felling of trees and the vast odds as to
numbers in case of attack, the pirates being reckoned to
be about six thousand Dyaks and five hundred Malays.
The evening set in with rain and hazy weather. Our
native skirmishing parties were returning to their boats
and evening meals; our advancing party had been ab-
sent about an hour and a half, and 1 had just commenced
a supper in the Jolly Bachelor on ham and poached eggs,
when the sound of the pinnace's twelve-pounder rar-
ronade broke through the stillness of the night. This
was responded to by one of those simultaneous war-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. '^17
yells apparently from eveiy part of the country. My
immediate idea was that our friends had been surround-
ed. It was impossible to move so large a boat as the
Jolly Bachelor up to their assistance ; nor would it be
right to leave our wounded without, a sufficient force for
their protection. I immediately jumped into my gig,
taking with me a bugler, whom I placed in the bow, and
seeing our arms in as perfect readiness as the rain would
allow us to keep them in, I proceeded to join the com-
batants.
Daylight had disappeared, as it does in tropical cli-
mates, immediately after the setting of the sun. The
tide had j ust turned against me ; and as 1 advanced up
the river, the trees hung over many parts, nearly meet-
ing across ; at the same time the occasional firing that
was kept up assured me that the enemy were on the
alert, and with all the advantages of local knowledge and
darkness on their side. From the winding of the stream,
too, the yells appeared to come from every direction,
sometimes ahead and sometimes astern. I had pulled,
feeling my way, for nearly two hours, when a sudden
and quick discharge of musketry, well on my left hand,
intimated to me that I was approaching the scene of ac-
tion ; and, at the same time, passing several large canoes
hauled up on the bank, I felt convinced that my antici-
pation was right, that our party were surrounded, and
that we should have to fight our way to each other. My
plan was to make it appear as if I was bringing up a
strong re-enforcement ; and the moment the firing ceased,
I made the bugler strike up " Roiy O'More," which
was immediately responded to by three British cheers,
and then followed a death-like stillness if any thing,
more unpleasant than the war-yell and I could not help
feeling certain that the enemy lay between us.
The stream now ran rapidly over loose stones. Against
the sky, where the jungle had been cleared, I could dis-
tinctly see the outlines of human beings. I laid my
double-barrel across my knees, and we pulled on. When
within shot-range, I hailed, to make certain, and receiv-
ing no answer, after a second time, I fired, keeping the
muskets of the gig's crew ready to repel the first attack
in case the onerny did not decamp. My fire was an-
248
swered by Lieutenant Horton, " We are here, sir."
At first I was much distressed from the fear that I might
have hurt any one. They had not heard me hail, ow-
ing, I suppose, to the noise of the water rushing over
the stones ; and they had not hailed me, thinking that I
must of course know that it was them, and the enemy
being in the jungle all round, they did not like to attract
attention to where they were. I found they had tiiken
up a veiy clever position. The running stream had
washed the ground away on the right bank, leaving a
sort of little, deep bay, just big enough to hold the boats,
from which the bank rose quite perpendicularly. On
the top of this bank the jungle had been cleared for about
thirty yards, and on this Lieutenant Gunnel, with seven
royal marines, was posted as a rear-guard. This was
an important position, and one of danger, as the jungle
itself was alive with the enemy ; and although the spear.-;
were hurled from it continually during the night, no
shot was thrown away unless the figure of the pirate
could be distinctly seen.
It continued to rain : the men wore their great-coats
for the purpose of keeping their pieces diy ; and sever-
al times, during that long night, 1 observed the muskets
of these steady and good men brought to the shoulder
and again lowered without firing, as that part of tho
jungle whence a spear had been hurled to within a
few feet of where they stood did not show a distim-t
form of any tiling living. The hours were little less in-
teresting for those who, in the boats below, stood facing
the opposite bank of the river with their arms in their
hands. It appears that the enemy had come down in
great force to attack the boats from that side ; and as the.
river was there very shallow, and the bottom hard, they
could, by wading not more than knee-deep, have ap-
proached to within five or six yards of them ; but in the
first attack they had lost a great many men, and it is
supposed that their repeated advances throughout the
night were more to recover their dead and wounded
than to make any fresh attack on our compact little force,
whose deadly aim and rapid firing must havo astonished
them, and who certainly were, one and all, prepared |<;
sejl their livos as dearly as possible.
KXl'KlHTIuN TO BORNEO. 249
To the left of our position, mid about 200 yards up
the river, large trees were being felled during the night ;
and by the torch -lights showing the spot, the officer of
the boat, Mr. Partridge, kept up a very fair ball-practice
with the pinnace's gun. Toward morning a shot fell
apparently just where they were at work ; and that being
accompanied by what we afterward ascertained caused
more horror and consternation among the enemy than
any tiling else, a common signal sky-rocket, made them
resign the ground entirely to us. The last shot, too,
that was fired from the pinnace had killed three men.
As daylight broke I found that most of our party had
squatted down with their guns between their knees, and,
being completely exhausted, had fallen asleep in spite of
the rain. Few will ever forget that night. There were
two natives and one marine only of our party badly
wounded ; the latter was struck by a rifle shot, which
entered his chest and lodged in his shoulder; and this
poor fellow, a gallant young officer named Jenkins, al-
ready distinguished in the Chinese war, volunteered to
convey in the second gig, with four boys only, down to
the Jolly Bachelor. He performed this duty, and was
again up with the party before daylight.
At daylight we found the pirates collecting in some
force above us ; and several shots were fired, as if to try
the range of their rifles ; but they took good care not to
come within reach of our muskets. Shortly after, the
tide beginning to rise, we made preparations for ascend-
ing further up the river. This was more than they bar-
gained for, as we were close to where they had removed
their families, with such little valuables as they could
collect, when we so unexpectedly carried their forts and
took possession of their town ; and we were not sorry on
observing, at that moment, a flag of truce advance from
their party down the stream, and halt half way to our
position. We immediately sent an unarmed Malay to
meet them; and after a little talk, they came to our
boats. The message was, that they were ready to abide
by any terms we might dictate. 1 promised that hos-
tilities should cease for two hours ; but told them we
could treat only with the chiefs, whose persons should
be protected, and 1 invited them to a conference at 1 P.M
250 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
J a the mean while, having first sent notice by the mes-
sengers, I took advantage of the time, and ascended in
my gig, without any great difficulty, above the obstruc-
tion they had been so busy throwing across the river dur-
ing the night. The news that hostilities were to cease
was not long in being communicated; and, by the time
I had got up, the greatest confidence appealed to be es-
tablished. Having pulled up into shoal water, and where
the river widened, the banks were soon covered with na-
tives ; and some seventy or eighty immediately laid aside
their spears and walked off to my boat, the whole of
which, together with its crew, they examined with the
greatest curiosity.
In the heat of the day we indulged in a most refresh-
ing bath under the shade of overhanging trees, the bot-
tom of the river being fine sand and pebbles worn smooth
by the running stream.
At the appointed hour the chiefs made their appear-
ance, dressed in their best, but looking haggard and de-
jected. Mr. Brooke, the " Tuan Besar," or great man,
officiated as spokesman.
He fully explained that our invasion of their country,
and destruction of their forts and town, was not for the
purposes of pillage or gain to ourselves, but as a punish-
ment for their repeated and aggravated acts of piracy ;
that they had been fully warned, for two years before,
that the British nation would no longer allow tho native
trade between the adjacent islands and Singapore to be
cut oft' and plundered, and the crews of the vessels cru-
elly put to death, as they had been.
They were very humble and submissive ; admitted
that their lives were forfeited, and if wo said they were
to die, they were prepared; although, they explained,
they were equally willing to live. They promised to re-
frain forever from piracy, and offered hostages for their
good behavior.
Mr. Brooke then explained how much more advan-
tageous trade would be than piracy, and invited them to
a further conference at Sarawak, where they might wit-
ness all the blessings resulting from the line of conduct
lie had advised them to follow. If, on the oilier hand,
we heard of a single act of piracy l>einji committed ly
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 251
them, their couutry should be again invaded and occu-
pied ; and their enemies, the whole tribe of Linga Dyaks,
let loose upon them, until they were rooted out and utter-
ly destroyed.
To other questions they replied, that although the chief
held communication, and was in the habit of cruising with
the people of the other settlements of Pakoo and Rem-
bas, still they could not hold themselves responsible for
their good conduct ; and as both held strongly fortified
positions (of course supposed by themselves to be im-
pregnable), they did not think that they would abstain
altogether from piracy unless we visited and inflicted
a similar chastisement to that they themselves had suf-
fered. They also stated that, although they never would
again submit to the orders of the great and powerful
chiefs, Seriffs Sahib and Muller, still they could not join
in any expedition against them or their old allies, their
blood-thirsty and formidable neighbors in the Sakarran
river.
On our return to the still smoking ruins of the once
picturesque town of Paddi, we found that Seriff Jaffer,
with his 800 warriors, had not been idle. The country
round had been laid waste. All had been desolated, to-
gether with their extensive winter-stores of rice. It was
a melancholy sight ; and, for a moment, I forgot the hor-
rid acts of piracy and cruel murders of these people, and
my heart relented at what I had done it was but for a
few minutes.
Collecting our forces, we dropped leisurely down the
river, but not without a parting yell of triumph from our
Dyak force a yell that must have made the hearts of
those quail whose wives and children lay concealed in
the jungle near to where we had held our conference.
We arrived at Boling soon after midnight, where we
found the tope, with our provision, quite safe. Several
shots had been fired at her the night before ; and large
parties had repeatedly come down to the banks, and en-
deavored to throw spears on board.
At daylight (Wednesday, 14th) we lost no time in
completing to four days' provisions, and starting, with
the flood-tide, for Pakoo. It took us until late in the
evening before we appeared in sight of two newly-built
252 i HD1TION TO BORNEO.
stockades, from which the pirates Hod, panic-si ruci;,
without ii'ring a shot, on our first discharge. We. hud
evidently come on them before they were prepared, as
we found some of the guns in the forts with the slings
still on by which they had been carried.
The positions of the forts here, as at Paddi, were se-
lected with great judgment; and had their guns been
properly served, it would have been sharp work for boats.
The same work of destruction was carried on ; but the
town was larger than at Paddi, and night setting in, the
conflagration had a grand effect.
Although the greater part of their valuables had been
removed, the place was alive with goats and poultry, the
catching of which afforded great sport for our men.
Some of the Singe Dyaks succeeded in taking the heads
of a few pirates, who probably were killed or wounded
in the forts on our first discharge. I saw one body af-
terward without its head, in which each passing Dyak
had thought proper to stick a spear, so that it had all the
appearance of a huge porcupine.
The operation of extracting the brains from the lower
part of the skull, with a bit of bamboo shaped like a
spoon, preparatory to preserving, is not a pleasing one.
The head is then dried, with the flesh and hair on it,
suspended over a slow fire, during which process the
chiefs and elders of the tribe perform a sort of war-dance.
Soon after daylight the following morning (Thursday,
loth) the chiefs of the tribe came down with a flag of
truce, when much the same sort of conference took place
as at Paddi. They were equally submissive, offering
their own lives, but begging, those of their wives and
children might be spared. After promising to accede to
all we desired, they agreed to attend the conference
about to assemble at Sarawak, where the only terms on
which they could expect lasting peace and mutual good
understanding would be fully explained and discussed.
Like their friends at Paddi, they were of opinion that
their neighbors at Rembas would not abstain from pira-
cy until they had received convincing proof that the pow-
er existed which was capable and determined to put
down piracy. All lliese misguided people appeared not
only to listen In iv;ison. hut to be open 1" conviction : and
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 253
1 am far tVom imputing to them that treachery so com-
monly attributed to all classes of Malays. The higher
grades, I admit, are cunning and deceitful; but subse-
quent events during the last two years have proved the
truth and honesty of the intentions of these people. They
have strictly adhered to their promises ; and have since,
although surrounded by piratical tribes, been carrying on
a friendly trade with Sarawak.
Our next point of attack was Rembas. Although
there was a nearer overland communication between
those places, the distance by water was upward of sixty
miles ; but the strong tides were of great assistance, as
we could always rest when they were against us. High
water was the only time, however, that suited us for
landing, as the fall of tide left a considerable space of soft
mud to wade through before reaching terra firma : this
was sufficiently unpleasant to our men, without the ad-
ditional trouble of having to load and fire when in that
position ; besides, when stuck fast in the mud, you be-
come a much easier object to be fired at. At Rembas
the tide was not up until just before daylight; and, hav-
ing no moon to light us, a night attack was not consider-
ed advisable ; so that we brought up about a quarter tide
below the town, on the evening of the 16th. As Rem-
bas contained a larger proportion of Malays (who are al-
ways well supplied with firearms) than the other settle-
ments, though we had not experienced any opposition at
Pakoo, we fully expected they would here make a bet-
ter stand.
We advanced early in the morning, and soon came up
with a succession of formidable barriers, more trouble-
some to cut through than any we had before encounter-
ed. About a mile below the town we landed 700 of the
Linga Dyaks on the left bank of the river, who were to
separate into two divisions commanded by Seriff Jaffer
and his son, a remarkably fine and spirited youth and
creep stealthily through the jungle, for which the coun-
try was well adapted, so as to get to the rear of the town
and forts, and make a simultaneous attack on the first
shot being fired from our boats. The last barrier (and
there were four of them) was placed just within point-
blank range ; the gig being a light boat, 1 managed to
254 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
haul her over, close to the bank, and advanced so as to
be both out of sight and out of range ; and just as our
first boat came up with the barrier, I pushed out from
under the bank, and opened a fire of musketry on the
stockade, which was full of men. This, with the war-
yell that followed from their rear (both unexpected), to-
gether with their fears having been already worked upon
by the destruction of Paddi and defeat of Pakoo, threw
them into the greatest confusion. They fled in all di-
rections, without provoking us by firing a shot, although
we found the guns loaded. Seriff Jaifer and his Dyaks
were gratified by having all the fighting to themselves,
and by some very pretty hand-to-hand encounters. We
were much amused, afterward, by their own account
of the heroic deeds they had performed. Lives were
lost on both sides, and heads taken. This Rernbas was
by far the largest and strongest place we had assaulted.
We found some very large war-boats, both fitted and
building ; one measured ninety-two feet in length, with
fourteen beam ; and in addition to the usual good supply
of fruit, goats, and poultry, our men were gratified by
finding several bullocks. The plunder was great ; and
although, with the exception of the guns, of no value to
us, it was very much so to our native followers.
After we had destroyed every thing, we received a
flag of truce, when similar explanations and promises
were made as at Paddi and Pakoo ; and here ended,
for the present, the warlike part of our expedition.
The punishment we had inflicted was severe, but not
more than the crime of their horrid piracies deserved.
A few heads were brought away by our Dyak follow-
ers, as trophies ; but there was no unnecessary sacrifice
of life, and I do not believe there was a woman or child
hurt. The destruction of these places astonished the
whole countiy beyond description. In addition to the
distance and difficulty of access to their strongly-fortified
positions, they looked for protection from the bore that
usually ran up the Sarebus, and which they imagined
none but their own boats could manage. As the differ-
ent Malay chiefs heard that, in ten days, a handful of
white men had totally destroyed their strongholds, they
shook their heads, and exclaimed, "God is great .'" and
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 255
the Dyaks declared that the Tuan Besar (Mr. Brooke)
had charmed the river to quiet the bore,* and that the
whites were invulnerable. Although this expedition
would have a great moral effect on all the more respect-
able and thinking natives, inasmuch as the inhabitants
of the places destroyed were looked upon, from the
large proportion of Malays, as more civilized than their
formidable and savage neighbors, the Dyaks inhabiting
the Saknrran river ; still, it was not to be supposed,
when the settlements of Paddi, Pakoo, and Rembas
could not be responsible for the good behavior of one
another, that it was probable the severe lesson taught
them would have any great effect on the Sakarrans.
On regaining the tope at Boling, we found our assist-
ant surgeon, Dr. Simpson, who had been left in charge
of the sick, laid up with fever and ague. For convenien-
cy's sake, the wounded men had been removed to a
large native boat; and while the doctor was passing
along the edge of the boat, his foot slipped, he fell over-
board, and not being much of a swimmer, and a strong
tide running, he was a good while in the water, though
a native went after him. He had, for some time past,
been in bad health ; but the cold he then caught brought
on inflammation in the lungs, under the effects of which
he sank soon after our return to Singapore. Poor Simp-
son ! he was not only clever in his profession, but en-
deared to us all by his kind and gentle manner, so grate-
ful to the sick. There were few of us, while in China,
who had not come under his hands, and experienced his
tender, soothing, and unremitting attention.
We now gave our native followers permission to de-
part to their respective homes, which they did loaded
with plunder, usually, hi India, called loot ; ourselves
getting under weigh to rejoin the Dido off the Island of
Burong, and from thence we proceeded to the mouth of
the Morotaba, where, leaving the ship, Mr. Brooke and
I went in my boat, with two others in attendance, to
take leave of the rajah, prior to my return to Singapore
and China. Although the greater part of the native
boats attached to the expedition had already arrived at
* It had never been known so quiet ns dnrinpr the days we
were up their river.
256 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
Sarawak, the rajah had sent them back, some miles
down the river, with as many others as he could collect,
gorgeously dressed out with flags, to meet Mr. Brooke
and myself, the heroes of the grandest expedition that
had ever been known in the annals of Malayan liistory.
Our approach to the grand city was, to them, most tri-
umphant, although to us a nuisance. From the mo-
ment we entered the last reach, the saluting from every
gun in the capital that could be fired without bursting
was incessant; and as we neared the royal residence,
the yells, meant for cheers, and the beating of gongs, in-
tended to be a sort of " See, the conquering hero comes !"
were quite deafening. The most minute particulars of
our deeds, of course greatly exaggerated, had been de-
tailed, long before our arrival, by the native chiefs, who
were eye-witnesses ; and when we were seated in the
rajah's presence, the royal countenance relaxed into a
smile of real pleasure as he turned his wondering eyes
from Mr. Brooke to myself and back again. I suppose
he thought a great deal of us, as he said little or noth-
ing; and, as we were rather hungry after our pull, we
were very glad to get away once more to Mr. Brooke's
hospitable board, to which we did ample justice.
My stay at Sarawak was but of short duration, u.s,
before I had time to carry out the arrangements 1 had
made to put down this horrid traffic, the Dido was, ow-
ing to some changes in the distribution of the floor, re-
called to China.
As the tide would not suit for my return to the Dido
until two o'clock the following morning, we sat up until
that hour, when, with mutual regret, we parted. I had
just seen enough of Borneo and my enterprising friend,
Mr. Brooke, to feel the deepest interest in both. No
description of mine can in any way give my readers a
proper idea of the character of the man I had just then
left; and however interesting his journal may appeal- in
the reading, it is only by being in his company, and by
hearing him advocate the cause of the persecuted inland
natives, and listening to his vivid and fair description of
the beautiful country he has adopted, that one can be
made to enter fully into and feel what I would fain de-
scribe, but ran not.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 257
We parted ; and I did not then expect to bo able so
soon to return and finish what I had intended, viz., the
complete destruction of the strongholds belonging to the
worst among the pirate hordes, so long the terror of the
coast, either by capturing or driving from the country
the piratical Se rift's Sahib and Muller, by whose evil influ-
ence they had been chiefly kept up. From all that I had
seen, the whole countiy appeared to be a large garden,
with a rich and varied soil, capable of producing any^
thing. The natives, especially the mountain Dyaks, are
industrious, willing, inoffensive, although a persecuted
race ; and the only things wanted to make the country
the most productive and happiest in the world were, the
suppression of piracy, good government, and opening a
trade with the interior, which could not fail of success.
All these I saw partially begun ; and I felt assured that
with the assistance of a vessel of war, and the counte-
nance only of the government, Mr. Brooke would, al-
though slowly, yet surely, bring about their happy con-
summation.
CHAPTER XVIII.
Captain Keppel sails for China. Calcutta. The Dido ordered to
Borneo again. Arrival at Sarawak. Effect of her presence
at Sarawak. Great improvements visible. Atrocities of
the Sakarran pirates. Mr. Brooke's letter. Captain Sir E.
Belcher's previous visit to Sarawak in the Samarang. Coal
found. Second letter from the Rajah Muda Hassim. Expe-
dition against the Sakarran pirates. Patusen destroyed.
Macota remembered, and his retreat burnt. Further fighting,
and advance. Ludicrous midnight alarm.
June 2Uh. I reached the Dido at 8 o'clock, and
immediately got under weigh. After remaining twenty-
four hours to water at Singapore, I sailed for Hong
Kong. My time, during the year that I was absent
from Borneo, if not quite so usefully, was not unpleas-
antly passed. We lay a few months in the Canton
river. In addition to having good opportunities of seeing
the natives of China in their domestic state, I witnessed
one of those most curious and extraordinary sights that
occasionally occur during the winter months in the city
17 Y2
258 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
of Canton, namely, a fire. The one I saw was about
the most extensive that had ever been experienced;
and the Dido's crew had the gratification of being ot
some assistance in the protection of British property.
From China the Dido accompanied the commander-in-
chief, in the Cornwallis, to the Spanish colony at
Manilla, which is a place that few forget ; and a short
description of our visit there has been given in an inter-
esting little work, written by Captain Cunynghame.
On my return to Hong Kong, I had the gratification of
receiving on board the Dido, Major-General Lord
Saltoun and his staff, consisting of two old and esteemed
friends of mine, Captain, now Major Arthur Cunyng-
hame, his lordship's aid-de-camp, and Major Grant, of
the 9th Lancers, who had been adjutant-general to the
forces. A more agreeable cruise at sea I never expe-
rienced. We called at the island of Pinang, in the
Malacca straits, on our way, where we again fell in
with the admiral ; and I was most agreeably surprised
at meeting my friend Mr. Brooke, who had come on to
Singapore to meet Sir William Parker, and had fol-
lowed him up in the Wanderer, commanded by my
friend Captain -Henry Seymour, that vessel, in com-
pany with the Harlequin, Captain the Hon. George
Hastings, and the H. C. steamer Diana, having just
returned from an expedition to Acheen, whither they
had been dispatched by the commander-in-chief, to
inquire into and demand redress for an act of piracy,
committed on an English merchant-vessel. An account
of the expedition has already been published. Tho
pirates had made a desperate resistance, and several
lives were lost, and many severely wounded on our
side; among the latter was my friend Mr. Brooke
(in the head and arm), for which I took the liberty of
giving him a lecture on his rashness, he having quite
sufficient ground for fighting over in his newly-adopted
countiy. He was much pleased at the admiral's having
promised that the Dido should return again to the
Straits station as soon as she had completed her voyage
to Calcutta.
On the llth March, 1844, we anchored oil' the grand
' 'itv of Palaces, and well due;, ii merit the name. W* 1
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. Vl5i)
could not have timed our visit better. The governor-
general, the Earl of Ellenborough, was being filed on
his return from the frontiers, which fetes were con-
tinued on the arrival, a few days after ourselves, of the
Cornwallis at Kedgeree, when the flag of Sir William
Parker was shifted to the Dido. The admiral experi-
enced the same style of hospitable entertainment tluit
had previously been given to General Sir Hugh Gough
on his return from the Chinese expedition. At Cal-
cutta I was kindly invited by the " Tent Club," and
introduced to that noble and most exciting of all field-
sports, "Hog-hunting in India;" but with which tho
pleasures of the day did not cease. The subsequent
convivial meeting was a thing not easily to be forgotten.
Although under a tent pitched by the edge of the jungle,
thirty miles from the city, none of the comforts of the
house were wanting ; there were the punkah and the
hookah, those luxuries of the East, to say nothing of
heaps of ice from the far West, which aided considerably
the consumption of champagne and claret ; and to better
all these good things, every man brought with him the
will and the power to please and to be pleased.
A few days before my departure from Calcutta, the
governor-general finding it necessary to send treasure
to China, the admiral desired me to receive it on board.
Although a welcome cargo, it delayed for a couple of
months my return to Borneo. I found Mr. Brooke
awaiting my arrival at Singapore ; but as I could not
then receive him on board, Captain Hastings took him
over to Sarawak in the Harlequin.
On arriving at Hong Kong, Rear- Admiral Sir T.
Cochrane appointed Mr. Frederick Wade as first lieu-
tenant, Lieutenant Wilmot Horton having been pro-
moted to the rank of commander for his gallant defence
when the Dido's boats were attacked by the very supe-
rior force of pirates off the island of Sirhassan.
Having landed the treasure at Hong Kong, and com-
pleted stores and provisions, I sailed from Macao on
the 21st June, and working down against the monsoon,
arrived at Singapore on the 18th July. I here found
letters from Mr. Brooke, stating that the Sakarrans had
been out in great force : and although he was not aware
2( KXl'KLM i'loX TO 1JUUM.
of any danger to himself or his settlement, still, by coin-
ing over quickly, I might have a fair chance of catching
and crushing them in the very act of piracy. I lost no
time in preparing for another expedition. The govern
ment at Calcutta had become fully sensible of the ne-
cessity of protecting the native trade to Singapore, and
had sent down the Phlegethou steamer, of light draught
of water, and better adapted to service in the straits or
rivers than any of her majesty's larger vessels. She-
was, moreover, fitted in eveiy way for the peculiar ser-
vice on which she was to be employed, with a zealous,
experienced, and active commander, F. Scott,* as well
as a fine enterprising set of young officers. I lost no
time in making application for her to the resident coun-
selor, Mr. Church (in the absence of Colonel Butter-
worth, the Governor of the Straits), who immediately
placed her at my disposal ; and with such means, I was
anxious to commence operations as speedily as possible,
leaving the Vixen and Wolverine to perform the other
duties of the station.
Thursday, 2oth July. Sailed from Singapore, having
dispatched the Phlegethon the previous night, with
orders to rendezvous at the entrance to the Morotaba,
which we entered in the evening of the 29th ; and
anchoring the ship inside the river, I went on in the
steamer to within four miles of Sarawak, when I pulled
up in my gig, accompanied by the Dido's pinnace, that
I might, by firing her carronade as a signal, be enabled
to give notice of our approach, not feeling myself quite
secure from a shot from the forts, which were very
judiciously placed so as to command the last reach ap-
proaching the town, as I knew that before Mr. Brooke's
return they had been put in a state of defence, and u
regular watch kept, by self-appointed officers, sleeping
on their arms. I, however, got up without accident, in
time to receive a hearty welcome, about daylight.
Not expecting to revisit Borneo during the period
that the ship had to run before completing her usual
time of commission, it was gratifying for me to read in
my friend's journal, alluding to my former visit; "I
* I have lately heard, with much regret, of the death of this va)
uable officer.
KM'EUITKJN' Ti> 11O11NEO. '<il>l
came myself in the Dido; and I may say that her
appearance was the consummation of my enterprise."
" The natives saw directly that there was a force to
protect and to punish ; and most of the chiefs, conscious
of their evil ways, trembled ; Muda Hassim was grati-
fied, and felt that this power would exalt his authority
both in Borneo and along the coast, and he was not
slow in magnifying the force of the Dido. The state
in which Captain Keppel and his officers visited the ra-
jah all heightened the effect ; and the marines and the
band excited the admiration and the fears of the natives.
I felt the rajah's hand tremble at the first interview :
and not all the well-known command of countenance,
of which the natives are masters, could conceal his
emotion."
Gentle reader, excuse my vanity if 1 continue a little
further with my friend's journal, although it gets rather
personal :
" I believe the first emotion was anything but pleas-
urable ; but Captain Keppel's conciliatory and kind
manner soon removed any feeling of fear, and was all
along of the greatest use to me in our subsequent doings.
The first qualification, in dealing with a Malay, is a kind
and gentle manner ; for their habitual politeness is such
that they are hurt by the ordinary brusquerie of the
European.
" I shall not go over the chase of the three boats of
the Balagnini pirates, or the attack made on the Dido's
boats by the Sirhassan people, except to remark, that in
the latter case, I am sure Lieutenant Horton acted
rightly in sparing their lives and property; for, with
these occasional pirates, a severe lesson, followed by
that degree of conciliation and pardon which shall best
insure a correction of their vices, is far wiser and pref-
erable to a course of undistinguishing severity."
I found Sarawak much altered for the better, and the
population considerably increased. Mr. Brooke had es-
tablished himself in a new house built on a beautiful and
elevated mound, from which the intriguing Macota had
just been ejected on my first visit. Neat and pretty-
looking little Swiss cottages had sprung up on all the
most picturesque spots, which gave it quite a European
2tiX EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
look. Ho had also made an agreeable addition to hts
English society; and a magazine of English merchan-
dise had been opened to trade with the natives, together
with many other improvements.
On the other hand, Seriff Sahib, not deterred, as I
had anticipated he would be, by the example I made of
his neighbors in the Sarebus, had taken measures for
withdrawing from the adjoining river of Sadong, where
he had been living in a comparatively unguarded .state,
and had, during the last nine months, been making busy
preparations for fortifying himself at a place called Pa-
tusen, up the Batang Lupar. He had lately got things
in a forward state, had called out a large fleet of Sakar-
rans as an escort; and being puffed up with his own
power and importance, had thought proper to prolong
the performance of his voyage, of about 100 miles, from
his residence in Sadong to his fortified position at Patu-
sen, for three weeks or a month, during which time he
hud dispatched small parties of his fleet, which consisted
of upward of 150 war-prahus, on piratical excursions.
These robbers had, in addition to their piracies on the
high seas, scoured the coast in all directions, and com-
mitted the greatest atrocities, attended with some of the
most cruel murders. One sample will be sufficient to
show their brutal character : A detachment of throe of
their boats, having obtained information that a poor
Dyak family, belonging to a tribe in Mr. Brooke's terri-
tory, had come down from their mountain to cultivate a
small portion of land nearer the coast, and, for their
better security, had made their dwelling in the upper
branches of a large tree on the outskirts of the forest,
determined to destroy them. Their little children
were playing in the jungle when the pirates were seen
approaching the tree with their diabolical war-yells.
As the poor man did not descend immediately on being
summoned, he was shot ; when other ruffians, to save
their ammunition, mounted the tree, murdered the wo-
man, and returned in triumph to their boats with the
heads of both victims. The children, who had wit-
nessed this from their hiding-places, succeeded in get-
ting to Sarawak.
Taking advantage of Mr. Brooke's unusually long
To ItnKNKO.
absence, Sarawak itself was threatened, aucl open defi-
ance hurled at any European force that should dare ap-
proach Patusen. Reports, too, had been industriously
spread that Mr. Brooke never intended to return ; and
when he did get back to his home, he found the town
guarded and watched like a besieged city. With his
usual nerve and decision he withdrew his men from
the forts, and sent to SeriflT Sahib to inform him that he
should suffer for his temerity.
A letter I received from him is so characteristic, and
gives so lively a description of these events, that I am
tempted to print it
M Satftwnk, 26th May, 1844.
" Mr DEAR KEPPKL,
" It is useless applying a spur to a willing horse ; so I will
only tell you that there is plenty to do here, and the sooner
you can come the better lor all of us, especially your poor
friends the Dyaks. Bring with you as much force as you
an to attack Sakarran.
" The case stands thus : Seriff Sahib, quite frightened at
Sadong since last year, enraged likewise at his loss of power
and his incapability of doing mischief, collected all the Sa-
karran Dyaks, and was joined by many of the Dyaks of
.Sarebus and some Balows. He likewise had a good many
Malays, and bullied every one in his vicinity. This force
met at the entrance of the Sadong Delta, and committed
depredations. They were not less than 200 Dyak boats, and
.sqme 15 or 26 armed Malay prahus, beside others. Just as
they were collected, the Harlequin appeared off the coast,
and had the Dido been with us, we might have had them, all;
but the opportunity will never again occur. Seriff Sahib, with
this force, has started to-day for Sakarran, and I was not
.strong enough with my eight native boats to attack him. It
is really greatly to be lamented, because we should most
completely have crushed the head of the snake. We must,
however, make the best of it. It is his intention, on his
-arrival at Sakarrau, to fortify and wait for our attack, and in
the mean time to send out his Dyaks along the coast and
inland to such places as they dare venture to attack.
" Come then, my dear Keppel, for there is plenty to do for
all hands. I have ordered a gun-boat from Mr. Goldie, to
make our force stronger ; and had I possessed such a one the
day before yesterday, I would have pulled away for the Sa-
dong to-day.
204 EXPEDITION TO
' My regards to all. I still propose Pepper-Pot Hull lor
your residence. I only wish I felt quite sure that Fortune
had it in store that you would be here on your return from
China. That dame, however, seems to delight in playiug
me slippery tricks just at present ; and never was the time
and tide so missed before, which would have led to fortune,
as the other day. All the queen's ships and all the queen's
men could not bring such a chance together again.
" Ever, my dear Keppel, your sincere friend,
" J BROOKK
" Captain the Hon. Henry Keppel."
No one could have been more disappointed or have
regretted more than my gallant friend Captain Hastings,
that his orders did not admit of any delay, or of his at-
tacking that redoubtable pirate Seriff Sahib, especially
as he had a small score to settle with that kind of
gentry, having had his first lieutenant, H. Chads, se-
verely wounded in two places, and several men killed,
m the affair at Acheen Head. It was, however, all
for the best, as the few boats that the Harlequin could
have sent would have stood but a poor chance against
upward of 200 war-prahus, all fitted and prepared for
fight.
On the 1st of August, with the Dido and Phlegethon
at anchor off Sarawak, the warlike preparations were
going on rapidly. I had saluted and paid my visit to
Muda Hassim ; he was delighted to see me again, and
we went through the form of holding several confer-
ences of war in his divan. He appears to be a good
well-meaning man, well inclined toward the English,
moderately honest, and, if roused, I daresay not with-
out animal courage ; and altogether, with the assistance
of his clever younger brother, Budrudeen, a very fit
person to govern that part of Borneo of which he is
rajah.
During my absence, Sarawak had been visited by
H.M.S. Samarang, Captain Sir Edward Belcher, who
had received directions to call on and communicate
with Mr. Brooke. In dropping down the river the
Samarang grounded on a long shelf of rocks, at the top
of high water, and with the ebb-tide rolled over, filling
with the succeeding flood. Sho was nearly :i fortnight
EXP1-:UITU>N TO BORNK*'. 265
in this position, but was ultimately saved by the skill
and almost unparalleled perseverance (aided by such
assistance of men and spars as Mr. Brooke could
afford) of her captain, officers, and crew a feat that
must have given the natives a good idea of what British
seamen are capable of. This accident delayed for a
short time a visit that was afterward made by Sir Ed-
ward Belcher, accompanied by Mr. Brooke, to Borneo
Proper. A hurried inspection of the capabilities of that
part of the coast took place ; and the fact of there being
coal on the island was ascertained.
I received a second letter from Muda Hassim, of
which the following is a translation :
" This comes from Pangeran Muda Hassim, Rajah of
Borneo, to our friend Captain Keppel, in command of
her Britannic Majesty's ship.
(After the usual compliments) :
" We beg to let our friend Captain Keppel know, that the
pirates of Sakarran, whom we mentioned last year, still con-
tinue theft piracies by sea and land ; and that many Malays,
under Seriflf Sahib, "who have been accustomed to send or to
accompany the pirates and to share in their spoils, have gone
to the Sakarran river, with a resolve of defending themselves
rather than accede to our wishes that they should abandon
piracy.
" Last year Captain Belcher told the aaltan and myself,
that it would be pleasing to the Queen of England that we
should repress piracy ; and we signed an agreement, at his
request, in which we promised to do so ; and we tell our
friend of the piracies and evil actions of the Sakarran people,
who have, for many years past, doue much mischief to trade,
and make it dangerous for boats to sail along the coast ; and
this year many prahns, which wanted to sail to Singapore,
liave been afraid. We inform our friend Captain Keppel of
this, as we desire to end all the piracy, and to perform our
agreement with the Queen of England."
44 Monday, 5th August, 1844, being the morning fixed
for the departure of our expedition against the Sakarran
pirates, the Phlegethon steamer weighed at 8 o'clock, and
proceeded down the river to await at the mouth the col-
lection of our force. Among those who accompanied us
from Sarawak was the Pangeran Budrudeen, the intel-
Z
EXPEDITION To HORNKn.
ligent brother of the rajah already noticed. This was a
great and unusual event in the royal family ; and the
departure from the rajah's wharf, which I viewed from
Mr. Brooke's house, on the opposite bank of the river,
was intended to be very imposing. The barge of state
was decked out with banners and canopies ; all the
chiefs attended, with the Arab priest Mudlana at their
head, and the barge pushed off amid the firing of can-
non, and a general screech, invoking the blessing of
Mahomet.
Having seen the last boat off, Mr. Brooke and myself
took our departure in the gig, when another and last
farewell salute was fired from the rajah's wharf.
Three hours brought us to the steamer, anchored ofl'
the fishing huts at the mouth of the river. Here we
heard that a small boat from the enemy's country had,
under the pretence of trading, just been in to spy into
our force, but decamped again on the appearance of the
steamer. We now all got fairly away together, the
smaller boats keeping near the shoals in shore, while
the steamer was obliged to make an offing some miles
from the coast. From the masthead we distinctly made
out the small boat that had left the mouth of the river
before, both pulling and sailing in the direction of the
Batang Lupar, up which the Sakarran country lies ;
and as it was desirable that the pirates should not get
information of our approach, at dusk, being well in ad-
vance, and our auxiliary force following, I dispatched
Mr. Brooke's Singapore sampan and one of the Dido's
cutters in chase. At half-past nine we anchored in the
stream within the entrance.
We were fortunate at Sarawak in picking up two
excellent and intelligent pilots, who had long known the
whole river, and had themselves been several times
forced to serve in the boats while on their piratical ex-
cursions.
Tuesday 6th. With the flood-tide arrived all the
well appointed and imposing little fleet, and with them
the cutter and sampan with two out of the three men
belonging to the boat of which they had been in chase ;
the third having been speared by Seboo, on showing a
strong inclination to run a-muck in his own boat, ?'. c. to
KXt'KIMTIoN To BORNEO. 'K'tl
sell his life as dearly as he could. From these men we
obtained information that Seriff Sahib was fully pre-
pared for defence that his harem had been removed
and that he would fight to the last. We also learned
that Macota, better known among us by the name of
the " Serpent," and often mentioned in Mr. Brooke's
journal, was the principal adviser, in whose house the
councils of war were generally held.
We anchored, in the afternoon, off the mouth of the
river Linga ; and while there we dispatched a messen-
ger to Seriff Jaffer to caution him against giving any
countenance or support to either of the Seriffs Sahib
and Muller, on whose punishment and destruction we
were determined.
The Batang Lupar, as far as this, is a magnificent
river, from three to four miles wide, and, in most parts,
from five to seven fathoms water.
Wednesday, 7th. We weighed at daylight, but were
obliged to anchor again before appearing in sight of Pa-
tusen, until the tide should rise sufficiently to enable us
to pass a long flat shoal, over which, during the spring-
tides, a bore rushes with frightful velocity.
We now collected our boats, and made our arrange-
ments as well as we could, for attacking a place we had
not yet seen. We had now a little more difficulty in
keeping our native force back, as many of those who
had accompanied the expedition last year had gained
so much confidence that the desire of plunder exceeded
the feeling of fear.
After weighing at 11, with a strong tide sweeping us
up, we were not many minutes in coming in sight of the
fortifications of Patusen ; and indeed they were not to
be despised. There were five of them, two not quite
finished. Getting suddenly into six feet water, we
anchored the steamer ; not so formidable a berth, al-
though well within musket-range, as we might have
taken up had I been aware of the increasing depth of
water nearer the town ; but we approached so rapidly
there was no time to wait the interpretation of the
pilot's information.
The Dido and Phlegethon's boats were not long in
forming alongside. They were directed to pull in shore,
268 i:\PEDITION TO BORNEO.
and then attack the forts in succession ; but my gallant
first-lieutenant, Wade, who had the command, was the
first to break the line, and pull directly in the face of
the largest fort. His example was followed by the
others ; and dividing, each boat pulled for that which
appeared to the officer in command to be the one most
likely to make a good fight. The forts were the first to
open fire on both steamer and boats, which was quickly
and smartly returned. It is impossible to imagine a pret-
tier sight than it was from the top of the Phlegethon's
paddle-box. It was my intention to have fired on the
enemy from the steamer, so as to draw their attention
off the boats ; but owing to the defective state of the
detonating priming-tubes, the guns from the vessel did
not go off, and the boats had all the glory to themselves.
They never once checked in their advance ; but the
moment they touched the shore the crews rushed up,
entering" the forts at the embrasures, while the pirates
fled by the rear.
In this sharp and short affair we had but one man
killed, poor John Ellis, a fine young man, and captain of
the main-top in the Dido. He was cut in two by a
cannon-shot while in the act of ramming home a car-
tridge in the bow-gun of the Jolly Bachelor. Standing
close to poor Ellis at the fatal moment was a fine prom-
ising young middy, Charles Johnson, a nephew of Mr.
Brooke's, who fortunately escaped unhurt. This, and
two others badly wounded, were the only accidents on
our side.
Our native allies were not long in following our men
on shore. The killed and wounded on the part of the
pirates must have been considerable. Our followers
got several heads. There were no fewer than sixty-
four brass guns of different sizes, beside many iron,
found in and about the forts : the latter we spiked and
threw into the river. The town was very extensive ;
and after being well looted, made a glorious blaze.
Our Sarawak followers, both Malays and Dyaks, be-
haved with the greatest gallantry, and dashed in under
the fire of the forts. In fact, like their country, anything
might be made of them under a good government ; and
such is their confidence in Mr. Brooke's judgmeni, and
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 269
their attachment to his person, that he might safely
defy in his own stronghold the attacks of any foreign
power.
After our men had dined, and had a short rest during
the heat of the day, we landed our whole force in two
divisions and a strange but formidable-looking force
they made to attack a town situated about two miles
up, on the left bank of a small river called the Grahan,
the entrance to which had been guarded by the forts ;
and immediately after their capture the tide had fallen
too low for our boats to get up. Facing the stream, too,
was a long stockade ; so that we determined on attacking
the place in the rear, which, had the pirates only waited
to receive us, would have caused a very interesting
skirmish. They, however, decamped, leaving every-
thing behind them. In this town we found Seriff Sa-
hib's residence, and, among other things, all his curious
and extensive wardrobe.. It was ridiculous to see our
Dyaks dressed out in all the finery and plunder of this
noted pirate, whose very name, a few days previous,
would have made them tremble. Goats and poultry
there were in abundance. We likewise found a maga-
zine in the rear of the seriff's house, containing about
two tons of gunpowder ; also a number of small barrels of
fine powder, branded " Dartford," in exactly the same
state as it had left the manufactory in England. It
being too troublesome and heavy to convey on board the
steamer, and each of our native followers staggering up
to his knees in mud, under a heavy load of plunder, I
had it thrown into the river. It was evident how deter-
mined the chief had been to defend himself, as, beside
the defences already completed, eight others, in different
states of forwardness, were in the course of erection ;
and had the attack been delayed a few weeks, Patusen
would not have been earned by boats without consider-
able loss of life. It was the key to this extensive river ;
the resort of the worst of pirates ; and each chief had
contributed his share of guns and ammunition toward
its fortification and defence.
We returned to our boats and evening meal rather
fatigued, but much pleased with our day's work, after
ascending nearly seventy miles from the mouth of the
z2
270 KXI'EJDITION TO BORNEO,
river. The habitations of 5000 pirates had been burnt
to the ground ; four strong forts destroyed, together with
several hundred boats ; upward of sixty brass cannons
captured, and about a fourth that number of iron spiked
and thrown into the river, beside vast quantities of other
arms and ammunition ; and the powerful Seriff Sahib,
the great pirate-patron for the last twenty years, ruined
past recovery, and driven to hide his diminished head in
the jungle.
The 8th and 9th were passed in burning and destroy-
ing the rest of the straggling town, and a variety of
smaller boats, which were very numerous. I had also
an account to settle with that cunning rascal Macota, for
his aiding and abetting Seriff Sahib in his piracies. He
had located himself very pleasantly near a bend in the
river, about a mile above Seriff Sahib's settlement, and
was in the act of building extensive fortifications, when
I had the satisfaction of anticipating the visit and some
of the compliments he would have conferred on my
friend Mr. Brooke at Sarawak. Budrudeen, the rajah's
brother, had likewise been duped by this fellow, and
was exceedingly anxious to insert the blade of a very
sharp and beautiful kris into the body of his late friend.
Mr. Brooke, however, was anxious to save his life,
which he afterward had the satisfaction of doing. I
shall never forget the tiger-like look of the young Pan-
geran when we landed together in the hopes of surpri-
sing the " Serpent " in his den ; but he was too quick
for us, having decamped with his followers, and in so
great a hurry as to leave all his valuables behind among
them a Turkish pipe, some chairs once belonging to the
Royalist, and other presents from Mr. Brooke. Every-
thing belonging to him was burnt or destroyed save some
handsome brass guns. There was one of about 12 cwt.
that had been lent by the sultan when Macota was in
favor, and which I returned to Budrudeen for his
brother.
We were hero joined by a large number of the
Linga Dyaks, the same force that had joined us the
year previous, while up the Sarebus, but unaccom-
panied by Seriff Jailer, of whom it was not quite clear
I hilt lie- had nol l)(H-ii secretly aiding thr
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 271
sent them back with assurances to their chiefs that
they should not be molested unless they gave shelter or
protection to either Seriff Sahib or Muller. Seriff
Sahib, with a considerable body of followers, escaped
inland in the direction of the mountains, from the other
side of which he would be able to communicate with
the river Linga. Macota was obliged to fly up the
river toward the Undop, on which the village and resi-
dence of Seriff Sahib's brother, Seriff Muller, was
situated.
Having destroyed eveiy boat and sampan, as well as
house or hut, on the 10th, as soon" as the tide had risen
sufficiently to take us over the shoals, we weighed, in
the steamer, for the country of the Sakarran Dyaks,
having sent the boats on before with the first of the
flood.
About fifteen miles above Patusen is the branch of
the river called the Undop : up this river I dispatched
Lieutenant Turnour, with Mr. Comber, in the Jolly
Bachelor, and a division of our native boats, while we
proceeded to where the river again branches off to the
right and left, as on the tongue of land so formed wo
understood we should find a strong fort ; beside, it was
the highest point to which we could attempt to take the
steamer. The branch to the left is called the Sakarran ;
that to the right retains the name of Lupar, inhabited
chiefly by Sakarrans. We found the place deserted
and the houses empty. Knowing that these people
depended almost entirely for protection on the strongly
fortified position at Patusen, I did not expect any
similar opposition from either Seriff Muller or the des-
perate bloodthirsty Sakarrans, and consequently divided
rny force into three divisions the one, already men-
tioned, under Lieutenant Turnour, up the Undop;
another, under Mr. D'Aeth, up the Lupar; while
Lieutenant Wade, accompanied by Mr. Brooke, as-
cended the Sakarran. I had not calculated on the dis-
turbed and excited state in which I found the country ;
and two wounded men having been sent back from the
Undop branch with accounts of the pirates, chiefly
Malays, who were collected in great numbers, both
before and in the rear of our small force; and an at-
272 KXI'KLUTlON To HOKM-U.
tempt having been made to cut off the bearer of this
information, Nakoda Bahar, who had had a very nar-
row escape, and had no idea of taking back an answer
unless attended by a European force, I determined
on sending assistance. But I had some difficulty in
mustering another crew from the steamer, and was
obliged to leave my friend Capt. Scott, with only tho
idlers, rather critically situated.
I deemed it advisable to re-collect my whole force ;
and before proceeding to the punishment of the Sakar-
rans, to destroy the power and influence of SerifF
Muller, whose town was situated about twenty miles
up, and was said to contain a population of 1500 Ma-
lays, independently of the surrounding Dyak tribes.
Having dispatched boats with directions to Lieutenant
Wade and Mr. D'Aeth to join us in the Undop, I pro-
ceeded in my gig to the scene of action, leaving the
steamer to maintain as strict a blockade of the Sakarran
and Lupar branches as, with their reduced force, they
were capable of. On my joining Lieutenant Tumour,
I found him just returned from a very spirited attack
which he had made, assisted by Mr. Comber, on a
stockade situated on the summit of a steep hill; Mr.
Allen, the master, being still absent on a similar ser-
vice, on the opposite side of the river. The gallant old
chief Patingi Ali was likewise absent, in pursuit of the
enemy that had been driven from the stockades, with
whom he had had a hand-to-hand fight, the whole of
which being on the rising ground was witnessed by
our boats' crews, who could not resist hailing his return
from his gallant achievement with three hearty British
cheers. This had the effect of giving such an impulse
to his courage, that, in a subsequent affair, it unhappily
caused a serious loss among this active and useful branch
of our force.
We had now to unite in cutting our way through a
barrier across tho river similar to that described in the
attack on the .Surebus, which having passed, we brought
up for the night close to a still more serious obstacle,
being a number of huge trees felled, the branches of
which meeting midway in the river, formed apparently
:'n insuiTmmntahlo obstacle t<> our ro^n 1 .^-. |>ui.
EXFH1UTION TO BORNEO. 273
44 patience and perseverance overcome all difficulties;"
and by night only three of the trees remained to be
cleared away. We were now within a short distance
of their town, so that we could distinctly hear the noise
and confusion which our advance had occasioned. On
the right bank, and about fifty yards in advance of the
barrier, stood a farm-house, which we considered it
prudent to occupy for the night, for which advanced
post we collected about fifty volunteers. These con-
sisted of Messrs. Steward, Williamson, and Comber ; a
corporal and four marines ; my gig's crew ; and a med-
ley of picked men from our Dyak and Malay followers ;
not forgetting my usual and trusty attendant John
Eager with his bugle, the sounding of which was to be
the signal for the whole force to come to the rescue, in
the event of surprise not at all improbable from the
nature of our warfare and our proximity to the enemy's
town.
And here a most ludicrous scene occui'red during the
night. Having placed our sentries and look-out men,
and given " Tiga" as the watchword, we were, shortly
after midnight, suddenly aroused from sound sleep by a
Dyak war-yell, which was immediately responded to by
the whole force. It was pitch dark : the interior of our
farmhouse, the partitions of which had been removed
for the convenience of stowage, was crowded to excess.
In <i moment every man was on his legs : swords, spears,
and krisses dimly glittered over our heads. It is impos-
sible to describe the excitement and confusion of the
succeeding ten minutes : one and all believed that we
had been surrounded by the enemy, and cut off from
our main party. I had already thrust the muzzle of my
pistol close to the heads of several natives, whom, in the
confusion, I had mistaken for Sakarrans ; and as each
in his turn called out " Tiga," I withdrew rny weapon
to apply it to somebody else ; until, at last, we found
that we were all " Tigas." I had prevented Eager,
more than once, from sounding the alarm, which, from
the first, he had not ceased to press me for permission
to do. The Dyak yell had, however, succeeded in
throwing the whole force afloat into a similar confusion,
and not hearing tlie signal, they concluded fhat they,
18
274 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO'.
and not we, were the party attacked. The real
we afterward ascertained to have arisen from the alarm-
of a Dyak, who dreamt, or imagined, that he felt a spear
thrust upward through the bamboo-flooring of our build-
ing, and immediately gave his diabolical yell. The con-
fusion was ten times as much as it would have been had
the enemy really been there. So ended the adventures
of the night in the wild jungle of Borneo.
CHAPTER XIX.
Seriff Muller's town sacked. Ascend the river in pursuit of the
enemy. Gallant exploit of Lieutenant Wade. His death and
funeral. Interesting anecdote of him. Ascend the Sakarran
branch. Native boats hemmed in by pirates, and their crews
slaughtered to a man. Karangan destroyed. Captain Sir E.
Belcher arrives in the Samarang's boats. Return to Sara-
wak. New expedition against Seriff Sahib and Jaffer. Ma-
cota captured. Flight of Seriff' Sahib. Conferences. Serift
.Tafier deposed. Mr. Brooke's speech in the native tongue.
End of the expedition, and return to Sarawak. The Dido sails
for England. .
AT daylight we were joined by Lieutenant "Wade
and Mr. Brooke their division making a very accepta-
ble increase to our force and by 8 o'clock the last bar-
rier was cut through between u and Seriff Muller's
devoted town. With the exception of his own house,
from which some eight or nine Malays were endeavor-
ing to move his effects, the whole place was deserted.
They made no light ; and an hour afterward the town
had been plundered and burnt. The only lives lost
jwere a few unfortunates, who happened to come within
range of our musketry in their exertions to save some-
of their master's property. A handsome large boat,
belonging to that chief, was the only thing saved ; and
this I presented to Budrudeen. After a short delay in-
catching our usual supply of goats and poultry, with
which the place- abounded, we proceeded up the river
in chase of the chief mid his people ; and here again w&
had to encounter the same obstacle presented by the
felled trees thrown across the river if possible of in-
! difficult! their crea " ; 1 the-
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 275
narrow breadth of the stream ; but although delayed we
were not to be beaten. We ascertained that the pirates
had retreated to a Dyak village, situated on the summit
of a hill, some twenty-five miles higher up the Undop,
five or six miles only of which we had succeeded in as-
cending, as a most dreary and rainy night closed in,
during which we were joined by Mr. D'Aeth and his
division from the Lupar river.
The following morning, the 13th of August, at day-
break, we again commenced our toilsome work. With
the gig and the lighter boats we succeeded better ; and
I should have despaired of the heavier boats ever getting
up, had they not been assisted by an opportune and
sudden rise of the tide, to the extent of twelve or four-
teen feet, though with this we had to contend against a
considerably increased strength of current. It was on
this day that my ever active and zealous first lieutenant,
Charles Wade, jealous of the advanced position of our
light boats, obtained a place in my gig. That evening
the Phlegethon's first and second cutters, the Dido's
two cutters, and their gigs, were fortunate enough to
pass a barrier composed of trees evidently but recently
felled ; from which we concluded ourselves to be so
near the enemy, that, by pushing forward as long as we
could possibly see, we might prevent further impedi-
ments from being thrown in our way. This we did ;
but at 9 P.M. arriving at a broad expanse of the river,
and being utterly unable to trace our course, we anchored
our advanced force for the night.
On Wednesday, 14th, we again pushed on at daylight.
We had gained information of two landing-places leading
to the Dyak village on the hill, round three-fourths of
the foot of which the Undop flowed. The first land-
ing-place we had no trouble in discovering, from the
number of deserted boats collected near it. Leaving
these to be looted by our followers, we proceeded in
search of the second, which we understood was situated
more immediately under the village, and which, having
advanced without our guides, we had much difficulty in
finding. The circuit of the base of the hill was above
five miles. In traversing this distance, we had repeated
skirmishing with straggling boats of the enemy, upon
276 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
whom we came unexpectedly. During this warfare,
Patingi Ali, who, with his usual zeal, had here come
up, bringing a considerable native force of both Malays
and Dyaks, was particularly on the alert; and while we
in the gig attacked the large war-prahu of Seriff Muller
himself the resistance of whose followers was only the
discharge of their muskets, after which they threw
themselves into the river, part only effecting their es-
cape the Patingi nearly succeeded in capturing that
chief in person. He had escaped from his prahu into a
remarkably beautiful and fast-pulling sampan, in which
he was chased by old Ali, and afterward only saved his
life by throwing himself into the water, and swimming
to the jungle ; and it was with no small pride that the
gallant old chief appropriated the boat to his own use.
In the prahu were captured two large brass guns, two
smaller ones, a variety of small arms, ammunition, pro-
visions, colors and personal property, among which were
also two pair of handsome jars of English manufacture.
After this, having proceeded some considerable distance
without finding the second landing-place, we put in close
to a clear green spot, with the intention of getting our
breakfasts, and of waiting the arrival of the other boat
with the guides.
While our crew were busily employed cooking, Lieu-
tenant Wade and myself fancied we heard the sup-
pressed voices of many people not far distant, and taking
up our guns we crept into the jungle. We had not
penetrated many yards before I came in sight of a mass
of boats concealed in a snug little inlet, the entrance to
which had escaped our notice. These were filled with
the piratical Dyaks and Malays, and on shore at various
points were placed armed sentinels. My first impulse
was to conceal ourselves until the arrival of our force ;
but my rash, though gallant friend deemed otherwise ;
and without noticing the caution of my upheld hand,
dashed in advance, discharging his gun, and calling upon
our men to follow. It is impossible to conceive the con-
sternation and confusion this our sudden sally occasioned
among the pirates. The confused noise; and scrambling
from their boats I can only liken to that of a suddenly-
roused dork of wild durks. ( >ur attack from tlio point
HXW^DITION TO 1IOKNKO. 277
whence it came was evidently unexpected ; and it is my
opinion that they calculated on our attacking the hill, it'
we did so at all, from the nearest landing-place, without
pulling round the other five miles, as the whole attention
of their scouts appeared to be directed, toward that
quarter. A short distance above them was a small
encampment, probably erected for the convenience of
their chiefs, as in it we found writing materials, two or
three desks of English manufacture, on the brass plate
of one of which, I afterward noticed, was engraved the
name of "Mr. Wilson." To return to the pirates:
with our force, such as it was nine in number and
headed by Lieutenant Wade, we pursued our terrified
enemy, who had not the sense or courage to rally in
their judiciously selected and naturally protected en-
campment, but continued their retreat (firing on us from
the jungle) toward the Dyak village on the summit of
the hill.
We here collected our force, reloaded our fire-arms ;
and Lieutenant Wade, seeing from this spot the arrival
at the landing-place of the other boats, again rushed on
in pursuit. Before arriving at the foot of the steep as-
cent on the summit of which the before-mentioned Dyak
village stood, we had to cross a small open space of
about sixty yards, exposed to the fire from the village as
well as the surrounding jungle. It was before crossing
this plain that I again cautioned my gallant friend to
await the arrival of his men, of whom he was far in ad-
vance ; and almost immediately afterward he fell mor-
tally wounded at my feet, having been struck by two
rifle-shots, and died instantaneously. I remained with
the body until our men came up, and giving it in charge,
we carried the place on the height without a check or
further accident. The Dyak village we now occupied
I would have spared, as on no occasion had we noticed
any of the tribe fighting against us ; but it was by shot
fired from it that poor Wade was killed, and the work
of destruction commenced simultaneously with the arri-
val of our men. It was most gratifying to me through-
out the expedition to observe the friendly rivalry and
emulation between the crews of the Phlegethon and the
Dido's boats. On this occasion the former had the glory
AA
278 KXl'EIUTloN TC BORNEO.
of first gaining the height ; and one of the officers of tho
former, Mr. Simpson, wounded, with a pistol-shot, a
man armed with a rifle, supposed to have been the per-
son who had slain our first-lieutenant.
I may here narrate n circumstance, from which one
may judge of the natural kind-heartedness of my
lamented friend. During the heat of the pursuit,
although too anxious to advance to await the arrival of
his men, he nevertheless found time to conceal in a
place of security a poor terrified Malay girl whom he
overtook, and who, by an imploring look, touched his
heart. The village and the piratical boats destroyed,
and the excitement over, we had time to reflect on the
loss we had sustained of one so generally beloved as the
leader of the expedition had been among us all. Hav-
ing laid the body in a canoe, with the British union-jack
for a pall, we commenced our descent of the river with
very different spirits from those with which we had as-
cended only a few hours before. In the evening, with
our whole force assembled, we performed the last sad
ceremony of committing the body to the deep, with all
the honors that time and circumstance would allow. I
read that beautiful, impressive service from a prayer-
book, the only one, by the by, in the expedition, which
he himself had brought, as he said, " in case of acci-
dent."
Before we again got under weigh, several Malay fam-
ilies, no longer in dread of their piratical chief, Seriff
Muller, who had fled nobody knew whither, gave them-
selves up to us as prisoners, trusting to the mercy of a
white man ; the first instance of any of them having
done so. We heard, also, that Macota had retreated
with the seriff ; and on examination we found the papers
captured in the encampment belonged to them, exposing
several deep intrigues and false statements addressed
to the sultan, the purport of which was to impress his
mind with the belief of a hostile intention on the part of
the British goverment toward his country. We brought-
up for the night off the still-burning ruins of Seriff Mul-
ler' s town.
On Thursday the 15th we again reached tho steamer.
We found her prepared Cor action, having been much
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 279
amioycd during the night by tho continued Dyak war-
yells sounds, to uninitiated ears, as unpleasant as those
of musketry. Having driven away the two principal
instigators and abettors of all the piracies committed
along the coast of Borneo and elsewhere, and destroyed
their strongholds, it now remained for us to punish the
pirates themselves as far as lay in our power. The
Sakarran Dyaks being the only ones now remaining who
had not received convincing proofs that their brutal and
inhuman trade would be no longer allowed, the loth and
16th were passed on board the steamer, to rest the men
after the severe fatigue encountered up the Undop, and
in making preparations for an advance up the Sakarran.
During the night of the IGth, several of our native fol-
lowers were wounded. Their boats not being furnished
with anchors, and the river being deep, they were obliged
to make fast to the bank, which in the dark afforded
great facility for the enemy to creep down through the
jungle unperceived, so close as to fire a shot and even
thrust their spears through the thin mat covering of the
boats. One poor fellow received a shot in his lungs,
from which he died the following day ; a Dyak likewise
died from a spear-wound ; and in the morning we wit-
nessed the pile forming for burning tho Dyak, and the
coffin making for conveying the body of the Malay to
Sarawak, his native place ; both parties having an equal
horror of their dead falling into the hands of the enemy,
although differing in their mode of disposing of them.
On Saturday, the 17th, the expedition, consisting of
the Dido's pinnace, her two cutters and gig, the Jolly
Bachelor, and the Phlegethon's first and second cutters
and gig, started up the Sakarran. A small division of
light native boats, under the command of the brave old
Patingi Ali, "were selected to keep as a reconnoitering
party with our leading boats, while the remaining native
force, of above thirty boats, followed as a reserve. We
advanced the first day some twenty miles without so
much as seeing a native, although our progress was con-
siderably delayed by stopping to burn farm-houses, and
a number of war-prahus found concealed in the jungle
or long grass on either side of the river. We brought
up early in the afternoon, for the purpose of strongly
280 KXl'KDM'iOX TO HOKNKU.
fortifying ourselves, both .ashore and afloat, against sur-
prise before the night set in. by which time it would
have taken a well-disciplined and powerful force to have
dislodged us.
This evening we had unusually fine weather ; and we
squatted down to our meal of curry and rice with better
appetites and higher spirits than we had done for some
days. We advanced the following day : and although
we reached several villages, the grain had been removed
from them all; which, in all probability, was done im-
mediately upon their hearing of the fall of their supposed
impregnable Patusen. In the evening we took the same
precautions as on the preceding night, considering that
our enemies were not to be despised. Owing to heavy
rains which fell during the night, and caused a strong
current, our progress was considerably retarded. The
scenery was beautiful more so than in any of the rivers
we had yet visited. We likewise now repeatedly fell
in with small detachments of the enemy, and spears
were thrown from the banks, which, added considerably
to our excitement and amusement. On every point we
found the remains of the preceding night's watch-fires,
so that news of our approach would have been conveyed
rapidly along. While leading in the gig with a select
few of our followers, we came suddenly on a boat full
of warriors, all gorgeously dressed, and apparently per-
fectly unconscious of our approach. The discharge of
our muskets and the capsizing of their war-boat was the
work of an instant; but most of their crew saved their
lives by escaping into the jungle.
This evening, Sunday, the 18th, we experienced
some difficulty in finding a suitable place for our bivouac.
While examining the most eligible-looking spot on the
bank of the river, the crew of one of the Phlegethon's
boats, having crept up the opposite bank, came suddenly
on a party of Dyaks, who saluted them with a war-yell
and a shower of spears ; and it was absurd to see the
way in which they precipitated themselves into the wa-
ter again to escape from this unexpected danger. The
Dyaks, too, appear to have been equally surprised. The
place we selected for the night was a large house about
forty yards from the edge of the river; and for a mus-
KXPKDTTION TO BORNEO. 281
ket-rango around which we had not much difficulty in
clearing the ground. Here we all united our different
messes, and passed a jovial evening. The night, how-
ever, set in with a most fearful thunder-storm, accom-
panied by the most vivid flashes of lightning I ever wit-
nessed. The rain continued to fall in torrents ; it cleared
up at daylight, when we proceeded. As yet the banks
of the river had been a continued garden, with sugar-
cane plantations and banana-trees in abundance. As we
advanced, the scenery assumed a wilder and still more
beautiful appearance, presenting high steep points, with
large overhanging trees, and occasionally forming into
pretty picturesque bays, with sloping banks. At other
times we approached narrow gorges, looking so dark
that, until past, you almost doubted there being a pas-
sage through. \\fe were in hopes that this morning
we should have reached their capital, a place called Ka-
rangan, supposed to be about ten miles farther on. At 9
o'clock Mr. Brooke, who was with me in the gig, stopped
to breakfast with young Jenkins in the second cutter.
Not expecting to meet with any opposition for some
miles, I gave permission to Patingi Ali to advance cau-
tiously with his light division, and with positive instruc-
tions to fall back upon the first appearance of any natives.
As the stream was running down very strong, we held
on to the bank, waiting for the arrival of the second cut-
ter. Our pinnace and second gig having both passed
up, we had remained about a quarter of an hour, when
the report of a few musket-shots told us that the pirates
had been fallen in with. We immediately pushed on ;
and as we advanced, the increased firing from our boats,
and the war-yells of some thousand Dyaks, let us know
that an engagement had really commenced. It would
be difficult to describe the scene as I found it. About
twenty boats were jammed together, forming one con-
fused mass; some bottom up; the bows or sterns of
others only visible ; mixed up, pell-mell, with huge
rafts ; and among which were nearly all our advanced
little division. Headless trunks, as well as heads with-
out bodies, were lying about in all directions; parties
were engaged hand to hand, spearing and krissing each
other; others were striving to swim for their lives;
A A2
KXPKIMTioX 'I'U
entangled in the common indite were our advanced
boats ; while on both banks thousands of Dyaks were
rushing down to join in the slaughter, hurling their
spears and stones on the boats below. For a moment
I was at a loss what steps to take for rescuing our peo-
ple from the embarrassed position in which they were,
as the whole mass (through which there was no pas-
sage) were floating down the stream, and the addition
of fresh boats arriving only increased the confusion.
Fortunately, at this critical moment one of the rafts,
catching the stump of a tree, broke this floating bridge,
making a passage, through which (my gig being pro-
pelled by paddles instead of oars) I was enabled to pass.
It occurred to Mr. Brooke and myself simultaneously,
that, by advancing in the gig, we should draw the atten-
tion of the pirates toward us, so as to give time for the
other boats to clear themselves. This had the desired
effect. The whole force on shore turned, as if to secure
what they rashly conceived to be their prize.
We now advanced mid-channel : spears and stones
assailed us from both banks. My friend Brooke's gun
would not go off; so giving him the yoke-lines, lie steered
the boat while I kept up a rapid fire. Mr. Allen, in the
second gig, quickly coming up, opened upon them, from
a congreve-rocket tube, such a destructive fire as caused
them to retire panic-struck behind the temporary bar-
riers where they had concealed themselves previous to
the attack upon Patingi Ali, and from whence they
continued, for some twenty minutes, to hurl their spears
and other missiles. Among the latter may be men-
tioned short lengths of bamboo, one end heavily loaded
with stone, and thrown with great force and precision ;
the few fire-arms of which they were possessed were-
of but little use to them after the first discharge, the
operation of reloading, in their inexperienced hands, re-
quiring a longer time than the hurling of some twenty
spears. The sumpitan was likewise freely employed by
these pirates; but although several of our men belong-
ing to the pinnace? were struck, no fatal results ensued,
from the dextrous and expeditious manner in which
the wounded parts were excised by Mr. Beith, the \\-.\-
sistant -surgeon : any poison flint might remain being
I'Al'KlHTlOlV TO IIOKNEO. 'J>.'*
ut'ti'i -\vani sucked out by one of the comrades of the
wouoded men.
As our force increased, the pirates retreated from
their position, and could not again muster courage to
rally. Their loss must have been considerable ; ours
might have been light, had poor old Patingi AH attended
to orders.
It appears that the Patingi (over-confident, and pro-
bably urged on by Mr. Steward, who, unknown to me,
was concealed in Ali's boat when application was made
by that chief for permission to proceed in advance for
the purpose of reconnoitering), instead of falling back, as
particularly directed, on the first appearance of any of
the enemy, made a dash, followed by his little division
of boats, through the narrow pass above described. As
soon as he had done so, huge rafts of bamboo were
lanched across the river, so as to cut off his retreat.
Six large war-prahus, probably carrying 100 men each,
then bore down three on either .side on his devoted
followers; and one only of a crew of seventeen that
manned his boat escaped to tell the tale. When last
seen by our advanced boats, Mr. Steward and Patingi
AH were in the act (their own boats sinking) of boarding
the enemy. They were doubtless overpowered and
killed, with twenty-nine others, who lost their lives
on this occasion. Our wounded in all amounted to
fifty-six.
A few miles higher up was the town and capital of
Karangan, which place it was their business to defend,
and ours to destroy, and this we succeeded in effecting
without further opposition. We ascended a short
distance above this, but found the river impracticable
for the further progress of the boats ; but our object
having been achieved, the expedition may be said to
have closed, as no more resistance was offered ; so we
dropped leisurely down the river, and that evening
reached our resting-place of the previous night: but
having burnt the house in the morning, we were
obliged to sleep in our boats, with a strong guard on
shore.
Attempts were made to molest the native boats by
hurling spears into them from the jungle under cover of
4 <J84 KXI'KUITIOTV TO
the night ; but after a few discharges of musketry the
enemy retired, leaving us to enjoy another stormy and
rainy night as we best could.
On the 20th we reached the steamer, where we re-
mained quiet all the next day, attending to the wound-
ed, and ascertaining the exact extent of our loss. On
the 22d we again reached Patusen. We found every-
thing in the same wretched state as when we left ; and
a pile of firewood, previously cut for the use of the
steamer, had not been removed. After dark a storm
of thunder, lightning, and heavy rain, came on as usual,
and with it a few mishaps. A. boat belonging to the old
Tumangong was capsized by the bore, by which his
plunder, including a large brass gun, was lost, and the
crew with difficulty saved their lives. At eight we
heard the report of a gun, which was again repeated
much nearer at nine ; and before a signal-rocket could
be fired, or a light shown, we were astonished by being
hailed by the boats of a British man-of-war ; and the
next moment Captain Sir E. Belcher, having been as-
sisted by a rapid tide, came alongside the steamer with
the welcome newi of having brought our May letters
from England. On the arrival of the Samarang oil" the
Morotaba, Sir Edward heard of the loss we had sus-
tained ; and, with his usual zeal and activity, came at
once to our assistance, having brought his boats no less
than 120 miles in about thirty hours. At the moment
of his joining us, our second mishap occurred. The
night, as previously mentioned, was pitch dark, and a
rapid qurrent running, when the cry of "a man over-
board" caused a sensation difficult to describe. All
available boats were immediately dispatched in search:
and soon afterward we were cheered by the sound of
"all right." It appears that the news of the arrival of
the mail was not long in spreading throughout our little
fleet, when Mr. D'Aeth, leaving the first cutter in a small
sampan, capsized in coming alongside the steamer ; the
man in the bow (who composed the crew) saved him-
self by catching hold of the nearest boat ; Mr. D'.Yelh
would have been drowned bad he not been an excellent
swimmer. This was not the last of our mishaps ; for
we had no sooner arranged ourselves and newly-arrived
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 285
visitors from the Samarang comfortably on board the
steamer from the pelting rain, than the accustomed
and quick ear of Mr. Brooke heard the cry of natives in
distress. Jumping into his Singapore sampan, he pushed
off to their assistance, and returned shortly afterward,
having picked up three, half drowned, of our Dyak
followers, whom he had found clinging to the floating
trunk of a tree. They too had been capsized by the
bore ; when, out of eleven composing the crew, only
these three were saved although the Dyaks are in-
variably expert swimmers.
On the 23d, after waiting to obtain meridian observa-
tions, we moved down as far as the mouth of the river
Linga, and then dispatched one of our Malay chiefs to
the town of Bunting to summon Seriff Jaffer to a con-
ference. This, however, he declined on a plea of ill
health, sending assurance, at the same time, of his good-
will and inclination to assist us in our endeavors to sup-
press piracy.
On the night of the 24th, we once again reached
Sarawak, where the rejoicings of the previous year,
when we returned from a successful expedition, were
repeated. On the third evening after our return, we
were just settling down to enjoy a little rest, having got
our sick and wounded into comfortable quarters, and
were beginning heartily to indulge in the comforts of a
bed after our fatigue and harassing duties in open boats
during the previous three weeks, when information ar-
rived that Seriff Sahib had taken refuge in the Linga
river, where, assisted by Seriff Jaffer, he was again
collecting his followers. No time was to be lost ; and
on the 28th, with the addition of the Samarang's boats,
we once more started, to crush, if possible, this per-
severing and desperate pirate ; and, in the middle of
the night, came to an anchor inside the Linga river.
When our expedition had been watched safely out-
side the Batang Lupar, on its return to Sarawak, all
those unfortunate families that had concealed them-
selves in the jungle, after the destruction of the dif-
ferent towns of Patusen and Undop, had emerged from
their hiding-places, and,, embarking on rafts, half-ruined
boats, or, in short, anything that would float, were in
286 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
the act of tiding and working their passage toward the
extensive aud flourishing town of Bunting. Their
dismay can well be imagined, when, at daylight on the
morning of the 29th, they found themselves carried by
the tide close alongside the long, black, terror-spread-
ing steamer, and in the midst of our augmented fleet.
Escape to them was next to hopeless ; nor did the
softer sex seem much to mind the change probably
thinking that to be swallowed up by the white man
was not much worse than dying in the jungle of starva-
tion. I need not say that, instead of being molested,
they were supplied with such provisions and assistance
as our means would permit us to afford, and then al-
lowed to pass quietly on ; in addition to which we
dispatched several of our native followers into the
Batang Lupar, to inform the poor fugitives that our
business was with the chiefs and instigators of piracy,
and not to molest the misguided natives.
With the ebb tide a large number of boats came
down from the town the news of our arrival having
reached them during the night containing the principal
chiefs, with assurances of their pacific intentions, and
welcoming us with presents of poultry, goats, fruit, &c.,
which we received, paying the fair market-price for
them, either by way of barter or in hard dollars. They
assured us that Seriff Sahib should not be received
among them ; but that they had heard of his having ar-
rived at Pontranini, on a small tributary stream some
fifty miles above their town. We immediately decided
on proceeding in pursuit before he could have time to
establish himself in any force. It was also evident
that the Balow Dyaks, who inhabit this part of the
country, were decidedly in favor of our operations
against Seriff Sahib, although afraid on account of
Seriff Jaffer and his Malays to express their opinions
openly. We also ascertained that Macota, with a rem-
nant of his followers, was hourly expected in the mouth
of the river, from the jungle, into which he had been
driven during the fight on the Undop heights. Knowing
that it would fare badly with this treacherous and cun-
ning, although now harmless chief, should ho fall into
the handa of 'any <>!' our unlive followers. T dispatched
EXPEDITION TO BOK.N'Ko. 287
two boats to look out for and bring him to us alive.
This they succeeded in doing, securing him in a deep
muddy jungle, into which he had thrown himself upon
perceiving the approach of our men. Leaving him a
prisoner on board the Phlegethon, we, with the flood-
tide, pushed forward in pursuit of Seriff Sahib.
For two days we persevered in dragging our boats,
for the distance of twenty miles, up a small jungly
creek, which, to all appearance, was impassable for any-
thing but canoes. But it had the desired effect, proving
to the natives what determination could achieve in ac-
complishing our object, even beyond the hopes of our
sanguine Balow Dyak guides. The consequence was,
that Seriff Sahib made a final and precipitate retreat,
across the mountains, in the direction of the Pontiana
river. So close were we on his rear harassed as he
was by the Balow Dyaks, who had refused him com-
mon means of subsistence that he threw away his
sword, and left behind him a child whom he had hitherto
carried in the jungle ; and this once dreaded chief was
now driven, single and unattended, out of the reach of
doing any further mischief.
The boats returned, and took up a formidable position
off the town of Bunting, where we summoned Seriff
.Taffer to a conference. To this he was obliged to
attend, as the natives had learnt that we were not to be
trifled with, and would have forced him on board rather
than have permitted their village to be destroyed. With
Pangeran Budrudeen, acting as the representative of
the sultan, Seriff Jaffer was obliged to resign all pre-
tensions to the government of the province over which
he had hitherto held sway, since it was considered, from
his being a Malay and from his relationship to Seriff
Sahib, that he was an unsafe person to be intrusted
with so important a post.
A second conference on shore took place, at which
the chiefs of all the surrounding country attended, when
the above sentence was confirmed. On this occasion I
had the satisfaction of witnessing what must have been
from the effect I observed it to have produced on the
hearers a fine piece of oratory, delivered by Mr.
Brooko in the native tongue, with a degree of fluency I
288 EXPEDITION TO BOIlNKo.
had never witnessed before, even in a Malay. The
purport of it, as I understood, was, to point out em-
phatically the horrors of piracy on the one hand, which
it was the determination of the British government to
suppress, and on the other hand, the blessings arising
from peace and trade, which it was equally our wish to
cultivate ; and it concluded by fully explaining, that the
measures lately adopted by us against piracy were for
the protection of all the peaceful communities along
the coast. So great was the attention bestowed during
the delivery of this speech that the dropping of a pin
might have been heard.
From these people many assurances were received of
their anxiety and willingness to coo'perate with us in
our laudable undertaking ; and one and all were alike
urgent that the government of their river should be
transferred to the English.
On the 4th September the force again reached Sara-
wak, and thus terminated a most successful expedition
against the worst pirates on the coast of Borneo.
We found the Samarang off the Morotaba entrance,
when Mr. Brooke and myself became the guests of Sir
Edward Belcher for several days, during which time we
made excursions to all the small islands in that neigh-
borhood, discovered large quantities of excellent oysters,
and had some very good hog-shooting. Afterward, ac-
companied by the boats of the Samarang, we paid a visit
to the Lundu Dyaks, which gave them great delight.
They entertained us at a large feast, when the whole
of the late expedition was fought over again, and a war-
dance with the newly-acquired heads of the Sakarran
pirates was performed for our edification. Later in the
evening, two of the elder chiefs got up, and, walking
up and down the long gallery, commenced a dialogue,
for the information, as they said, of the women, chil-
dren, and poorer people who were obliged to remain at
home. It consisted in putting such questions to one
another as should elicit all the particulars of the late
expedition, such as, what had become of different cele-
brated Sakarran chiefs (whom they named) ? how had
they been destroyed ? how did they die ? by whom
had fhfv been slain ? iVr. Ml these inquiries received
UXPEDIT1UN TO HUUXEO. 289
the most satisfactory replies, in which the heroic con-
duct of themselves and the white men WHS largely
dwelt upon. While this was performing, the two old
warriors, with the heads of their enemies suspended
from their shoulders like a soldier's cartouch-box.
stumped up and down, striking the floor with their
clubs, and getting very excited. How long it lasted
none of our party could tell, as one and all dropped off
to sleep during the recital. Mr. Brooke has given so
good a description of these kind and simple people that
I need not here farther notice them.
Shortly after our return to the Samarang, she, get-
ting short of provisions, sailed for Singapore, and Mr.
Brooke and myself went up to Sarawak, where the
Dido was still lying. Great rejoicings and firing of can-
non, as on a former occasion, announced our return ;
and, after paying our respects to the rajah, we visited
the Tumangong and Patingis.
A curious ceremony is generally performed on the
return of the chiefs from a fortunate war expedition,
which is not only done by wiy of a welcome back, but
is supposed to insure equal success on the next excur-
sion. This ceremony was better performed at the old
Tumangong' s than at the other houses. After entering
the principal room we seated ourselves in a semicircle
on the mat floor, when the old chief's three wives ad-
vanced to welcome us, with their female relatives, all
richly and prettily dressed in sarongs suspended from
the waist, and silken scarfs worn gracefully over one
shoulder, just hiding or exposing as much of their well-
shaped persons as they thought most becoming. Each
of these ladies in succession taking a handful of yellow
rice, threw it over us, repeating some mystical words,
and dilating on our heroic deeds, and then they sprinkled
our heads with gold-dust. This is generally done by
grating a lump of gold against a dried piece of shark's
skin. Two of these ladies bore the pretty names of
Inda and Amina. Inda was young, pretty, and grace-
ful ; and although she had borne her husband no chil-
dren, she was supposed to have much greater influence
over him than the other two. Report said that she had
a temper, and that the Tumangong WHS much afraid of
19 BB
290 PEDiTloN TO
her; but this may have been only Sarawak scandal.
She brought her portion of gold-dust already grated,
and wrapped up in a piece of paper, from which she
took a pinch ; and in reaching to sprinkle some over my
head, she, by accident, put the prettiest little foot on to
my hand, which, as she wore neither shoes nor stock-
ings, she did not hurt sufficiently to cause me to with-
draw it. After this ceremony we (the warriors) feasted
and smoked together, attended on by the ladies.
Another conference with Muda Hassim took place,
and I subsequently quitted Sarawak for Singapore, in-
tending to re-provision the Dido at that port, and then
return to Sarawak, in order to convey the rajah and his
suite to Borneo Proper. At Singapore, however, I
found orders for England, and sailed accordingly ; but
the service alluded to was readily performed by Sir
Edward Belcher, in H.M.S. Samarang, accompanied by
the H. C.'s steamer Phlegethon.
On my return to England I had the gratification to
learn that Mr. Brooke had been appointed agent for the
British government in Borneo, and that Captain Bethune,
R.N., C.B., had been dispatched on special service to-
that island : events I cannot but consider of great im-
portance to the best interests of humanity, and to the
extension of British commerce throughout the Malayan
Archipelago.
CHAPTER XX.
Later portion of Mr. Brooke's Journal. Departure of Captam
Keppel, and arrival of Sir {]. Heldier. Mr. Brooke proceeds,
with Muda Hassim, in the hiamarnng to Borneo. Labuan < >.
amined. Returns to Sarawak. Visit of Lingire, a Sarcbu^
chief. The Dyaks of Tunnna and Bandar Cassim. AI
assembly of Malays and Dyaks. Arrival of Lingi, as a drpui;;
tion from the Sakarran chiefs. The Malay character. Excur-
sion up the country. Miserable effects of excess in opium-
smoking. Picturesque situation of the Sow village of Ra-al.
Nawang. Feast at Ra-at. Returns home. Conferences
with Dyak chiefs.
THE return to England of Captain Bethune, C.B.,
bringing with him a further portion of Mr. BronkoV
KXI'EDITION To ISOKNKn.
Journal to my charge, enables me to afford my r
some interesting details relative to the important events
that have occurred in Borneo subsequent to my depar-
ture from Sarawak.
"January, 1845. The departure of the Dido left mo
sad and lonely, for Captain Keppel had been really my
companion and friend ; and he so thoroughly entered
into my views for the suppression of piracy, and made
them his own, that I may not expect any successor to
act with the same vigor and the same decision. Gallant
Didos ! I would ask no further aid or pi'otection than I
received from you. Sir Edward Belcher, with the
Phlegethon in company, arrived not long after the
Dido's departure, and conveyed the Rajah Muda Has-
sim nnd his train to Borneo Proper. H.M.S. Samarang
and Phlegethon visited and examined Labuan, and pro-
ceeded thence to Ambun. Ambun is a miserable village,
and it at once gave the lie to the report of a European
female being there in captivity, for no poor Orang Kaya
could retain such a prize. The inhabitants of Ambun
are Badjows, and the country people, or Dyaks of the
interior, are called Dusuns, or villagers. I saw many
of them, and they appeared a gentle, mild race, and far
less warlike by account than our Dyaks. They are not
tattooed, and the sumpitan is unknown among them.
Leaving Ambun, which is situated in a pretty bay, we
proceeded to Tampasuk, a considerable town, inhabited
by Illanuns and Badjows. This is a piratical town ;
and I was informed by an Arab in captivity there that
scarcely a week passes without strife and contention
among themselves. There, likewise, I received infor-
mation respecting the Balagnini, the great pirates of
these seas. They are represented as inhabiting numer-
ous small islands in the vicinity of Sooloo ; their origin
is Badjow. I apprehend there would be little difficulty
in breaking their power, and curing their propensity to
piracy.
" This cruise being over, I established myself quietly
at Sarawak. The country is peaceable ; trade flour-
ishes ; the Dyaks are content ; the Malays greatly in-
creased in number in short, all goes well. I received
a visit from Lingire, a Dyak chief of Sarebus. At
first he was shy and somewhat suspicious ; but a little
attention soon put him at his ease. He is an intelligent
man ; and I hail with pleasure his advent to Sarawak,
as the dawn of a friendship with the two pirate tribes.
It is not alone for the benefit of these tribes that I desire
to cultivate their friendship, but for the greater object
of penetrating the interior through their means. There
are no Malays there to impede our progress by their
lies and their intrigues ; and, God willing, these rivers
shall be the great arteries by which civilization shall be
circulated to the heart of Borneo.
" I4th. The Dyaks of Tumma, a runaway tribe from
Sadong, came down last night, as Bandar Cassim of Sa-
dong wishes still to extract property from them. Bandar
Cassim I believe to be a weak man, swayed by stronger-
headed and worse rascals ; but, now that Seriff Sahib
and Muda Hassim are no longer in the country, he re-
tains no excuse for oppressing the poor Dyaks. Si
Nankan and Tumma have already flown, and most of
the other tribes are ready to follow their example, and
take refuge in Sarawak. I have fully explained to the
Bandar that he will lose all his Dyaks if he continues
his system of oppression, and more especially if he con-
tinues to resort to that most hateful system of seizing
the women and children.
" I had a large assembly of natives, Malay and Dyaks,
and held forth many good maxims to them. At present,
in Sarawak, we have Balows and Sarebus, mortal ene-
mies ; Lenaar, our extreme tribe, and our new Sadong
tribe of Tumma. Lately we had Kantoss, from near
Siirambow, in the interior of Pontiana; Undops, from
that river; and Badjows, from near Lantang tribes
which had never thought of Sarawak before, and per-
haps never heard the name. Oh, for power to pursue
the course pointed out !
"16th. The Julia arrived, much to my relief; and
Mr. Low, a botanist and naturalist, arrived in her. He
will be a great acquisition to our society, if devoted to
these pursuits. The same ctey that the Julia entered,
the Ariel left the river. I dismissed the Tumma
Dyaks ; re-warned Bandar Cassim of the consequences
if his oppression: and had H parting interview with
I-'.X I' EDITION TO BORNF.n. ^9H
Liugiro. 1 had another long talk with Lingire, and did
him honor by presenting him with a spear and flag, for
I believe he is true, and will be useful; and this Orang
Kaya Pa-nmncha, the most powerful of these Dyaks,
must be mine. Lingire described to me a great fight
ho once had with the Kayans, on which occasion he got
ninety-one heads, and forced a large body of them to
retire with inferior numbers. I asked him whether the
Knyans used the sumpitan ? he answered, ' Yes.' ' Did
many of your men die from the wounds ?' 'No; we
can cure them.' This is one more proof in favor of Mr.
Crawfurd's opinion that this poison is not sufficiently
virulent to destroy life when the arrow is (as it mostly
is) plucked instantly from the wound.
" 26th. Lingi, a Sakarran chief, arrived, deputed (as
he asserted, and I believe truly) by the other chiefs of
Sakarran to assure me of their submission and desire for
peace. He likewise stated, that false rumors spread
by the Malays agitated the Dyaks ; and the principal
rumor was, that they would be shortly attacked again
by the white men. These rumors are spread by the
Sariki people, to induce the Sakarrans to quit their
river and take refuge in the interior of the Rejong ; and
once there, the Sakarrans would be in a very great
measure at the mercy of the Sariki people. This is a
perfect instance of Malay dealing with the Dyaks ; but
in this case it has failed, as the Sakarrans are too much
attached to their country to quit it. I am inclined to
believe their professions ; and at any rate it is convenient
to do so and to give them a fair trial.
" 28th. How is it to be accounted for, that the Ma-
lays have so bad a character with the public, and yet that
the few who have had opportunities of knowing them
well speak of them as a simple and not unamiable peo-
ple ? With the vulgar, the idea of a Malay and by the
Malay they mean the entire Polynesian race, with the
exception of the Javanese is that of a treacherous, blood-
thirsty villain ; and I believe the reason to be, that from
our first intercourse to the present time, it is the Pan-
gerans or rajahs of the countiy, with their followers,
who are made the standard of Malay character. These
rajahs, born in the purple, bred amid slaves and fighting-
BB2
TO BORNEO.
cocks, inheriting an undisputed power over their subjects,
and under all circumstances, whether of riches or pov-
erty, receiving the abject submission of those around
their persons, are naturally the slaves of their passions
haughty, rapacious, vindictive, weak, and tenacious
unto death of the paltry punctilio of their court. The
followers of such rajahs it is needless to describe ; they
are the tools of the rajah's will, and more readily dis-
posed for evil than for good ; unscrupulous, cunning, in-
triguing, they are prepared for any act of violence. We
must next contrast these with a burly, independent
trader, eager after gain, probably not over-scrupulous
about the means of obtaining it, ignorant of native charac-
ter, and heedless of native customs and native etiquet.
The result of such a combination of ingredients causes
an explosion on the slightest occasion. The European
is loud, contemptuous, and abusive ; the Malay cool and
vindictive. The regal dignity has been insulted ; the
rajah has received " shame " before his court ; evil
counselors are at hand to whisper the facility of revenge,
and the advantages to be derived from it. The conse-
quence too frequently follows the captain and crew are
krissed, and their vessel seized and appropriated. The
repeated tragedy shocks the European mind; and the
Malay has received, and continues to this day to receive,
a character for treachery and bloodthirstiness. Even in
these common cases an allowance must be made for the
insults received, which doubtless on numerous occasions
were very gross, and such flagrant violations of native
customs as to merit death in native eyes ; and we must
bear in mind, that we never hear but one side of the
tale, or only judge upon a bloody fact. It is from such
samples of Malays that the general character is given
by those who have only the limited means of trade for
forming a judgment ; but those who have known the
people of the interior and lived among them, far re-
moved from the influence of their rajahs, have given
them a very different character. Simple in their habits,
they are neither treacherous nor bloodthirsty ; cheerful,
polite, hospitable, gentle in their manners, they live in
communities with fewer crimes and fewer punishments
than most other people of the globe. They are passion-
v,\f;i>n'io\ TO
aVeJy load of their children, and indulgent even to u
fault ; and the ties of family relationship and good feel-
ing continue in force for several generations. The
feeling of the Malay, fostered by education, is acute,
and his passions are roused if shame bo put upon him ;
indeed, this dread of shame amounts to a disease ; and
the evil is, that it has taken a wrong direction, being
more the dread of -exposure or abuse, than shame or
contrition for any offence.
" I have always found them good-tempered and obli-
ging, wonderfully amenable to authority, and quite as
sensible of benefits conferred, and as grateful, as other
people of more favored countries. Of course there is a
reverse to this picture. The worst feature of the Ma-
la}- character is the want of all candor or openness, and
the restless spirit of cunning intrigue which animates
them, from the highest to the lowest. Like other Asia-
lies, truth is a rare quality among them. They are
superstitious, somewhat inclined to deceit in the ordi-
nary concerns of life, and they have neither principle
nor conscience when they have the means of oppressing
an infidel, and a Dyak who is their inferior in civilization
.and intellect.
" If this character of the Malay be summed up, it will
ibe anything but a bad one on the whole ; it will present
a striking contrast to the conduct and character of the
rajahs and their followers, and I think will convince any
impartial inquirer, that it is easily susceptible of improve-
ment. One of the most fertile sources of confusion is,
-classing at one time all the various nations of the Archi-
pelago under the general name of Malay, and at another
restricting the same term to one people, not more an-
cient, not the fountain-head of the others, who issued
from the center of Sumatra, and spread themselves in a
few parts of the Archipelago.
" The French, the German, the English, Scotch, and
Irish are not more different in national character than
the Malay, the Javanese, the Bugis, the Illanun, and
the Dyak ; and yet all these are indiscriminately called
Malay, and a common character bestowed upon them.
It would be as wise -and us .sensible to speak of a Euro-
pean .character-
2ti j:\ri:i)]Tio\ TO
"31s/. Started on a short excursion up the country,
and slept at Siniawan. Here I found a young Pangerati
(who came from Sambas with Mr. Hupe, a German
missionary) enchained in the delights of opium. He
left Sarawak for Sambas two months since, proceeded
iive hours' journey, and has since been smoking the drug
and sleeping alternately. His life passes thus : between
lour and five he wakes, yawns, and smokes a pipe or
two, which fits him for the labors of taking his guitar
and playing for an hour. Then follows a slightly tasted
meal, a pipe or two succeeds, and content and merri-
ment for another hour or two. About eight o'clock the
gentleman reclines, and pipe succeeds pipe till, toward
daylight, he sinks intoxicated and stupid on his pillow,
to wake up again in due course to play again the same
part. Poor wretch ! two months of this life of dissipa-
tion have reduced him to a shadow two more months
will consign him to his grave.
"Feb. 1st Started after breakfast, and paddled
against a strong current past Tundong, and, some dis-
tance above, left the main stream and entered the branch
to the right, which is narrower, and rendered difficult
of navigation by the number of fallen trees which block
up the bed, and which sometimes obliged us to quit our
boat, and remove all the kajang covers, so as to enable
us to haul the boat under the huge trunks. The main
stream was rapid and turbid, swollen by a fresh, and its
increase of volume blocked up the waters of the tribu-
tary, so as to render the current inconsiderable. The
Dyaks have thrown several bridges across the rivers,
which they effect with great ingenuity ; but I was sur-
prised on one of these bridges to observe the traces of
the severe flood which we had about a fortnight since.
The water on that occasion must have risen twenty feet
perpendicularly, Jind many of the trees evidently but re-
cently fallen, are the effects of its might. The walk to
Rat, or Ra-at, is about two miles along a decent path.
Nothing can be more picturesque than the hill and the
village. The former is a huge lump (I think of granite),
almost inaccessible, witli bold bare sides, rising out of a
rich vegetation at the base, and crowned with trees.
The height is nbont oOO feet: jind nhont a hundred feet
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 297
lower is a shoulder of the hill on which stands the eagle-
uest-like village of Ra-at, the ascent to which is like
climbing by a ladder up the side of a house. This is one
of the dwelling-places of the Sow Dyaks, a numerous
but dispersed tribe. Their chief, or Orang Kaya, is an
imbecile old man, and the virtual headship is in the hands
of Nimok, of whom more hereafter. Our friends seem-
ed pleased to see us, and Nimok apologized for so few
of his people being present, as the harvest was approach-
ing ; but being anxious to give a feast on the occasion of
my first visit to their tribe, it was arranged that to-mor-
row I should shoot deer, and the day following return to
the mountain. The views on either side from the vil-
lage are beautiful one view enchanting from its variety
and depth, more especially when lighted up by the gleam
of a showery sunshine, as I first saw it. Soon, how-
ever, after our arrival, the prospect was shut out by
clouds, and a soaking rain descended, which lasted for
the greater part of the night.
" 2d. Started after breakfast, and after a quiet walk
of about three hours through a pleasant country of alter-
nate hill and valley, we saw the valley of Nawang below
us. Nawang is the property of the Singe Dyaks, and is
cultivated by poor families, at the head of which is Niarak.
The house contained three families, and our party was
distributed among them, ourselves, i. e. Low, Crookshank,
and myself, occupying one small apartment with a man,
his wife, and daughter. The valley presented one of
the most charming scenes to be imagined a clearing
amid hills of moderate elevation, with the distant moun-
tains in the background ; a small stream ran through it,
which, being damned in several places, enables the cul-
tivator to flood his padi-fields. The padi looked beauti-
fully green. A few palms and plantains fringed the
farm at intervals, while the surrounding hills were clothed
in their native jungle. Here and there a few workmen
in the fields, heightened the effect ; and the scene, as
evening closed, was one of calm repose, and, I may say,
of peace. The cocoa-nut, the betel, the sago, and the
gno or gomati, are the four favorite palms of the Dyaks.
In their simple mode of life, these four trees supply
them many necessaries and luxuries. The sago fur-
I'KIMTIOV Tii 1JORNEO.
nishes loud ; and after the pith has been extracted, the
outer part forms a rough covering for the rougher floor,
ou which the tanner sleeps. The leaf of the sago is
preferable for the roofing of houses to the nibong.
The gomati, or gno, gives the black fibre which enables
the owner to manufacture rope or cord for his own
usre ; and over and above, the toddy of this palm is a
luxury daily enjoyed. When we entered, this toddy
was produced in large bamboos, both for our use and that
of our attendant I)yaks ; I thought it, however, very
bad. In the evening we were out looking for deer, and
passed many a pleasant spot which once was a farm,
and which will become a farm again. These the Dyaks
called rapack, and they are the favorite feeding-grounds
of the deer. To our disappointment we did not get a
fleer, which we had reckoned on as an improvement to
our ordinary dinner-fare. A sound sleep soon descended
on our party, and the night passed in quiet ; but it is
remarkable how vigilant their mode of life renders the
Dyaks. Their sleep is short and interrupted ; they con-
stantly rise, blow up the fire, and look out on the night :
it is rarely that some or other of them are not on the
move.
" Yearly the Dyaks take new ground for their farm ;
yearly they fence it in, and undergo the labor of reclaim-
ing new land ; for seven years the land lies fallow, and
then may be used again. What a waste of labor ! more
especially in these rich and watered valleys, which, in
the hands of the Chinese, might produce two crops
yearly.
" 3d. Took leave of this pleasant valley, and by an-
other and shorter road than we came reached Ka-at.
We arrived in good time on the hill, and found every-
thing prepared for a feast. There was nothing new in
this feast. A fowl was killed with the usual ceremony;
afterward a. hog. The hog is paid for by the company
at a price commensurate with its size : a split bamboo
is passed round the largest part of the body, and knots
lied on it at given distances; and according to the num-
ber of these knots are the number of pasus 1 or jxidi for
fhe price.
"Our host of Nawanff. Niarnk, nrrivrd 1o this feast
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 299
with a plentiful supply of toddy ; and before the dance
commenced, we were requested to take our seats. The
circumstances of the tribe, and the ability of Nimok,
rendered this ceremony interesting to me. The Sow
tribe has long been split into four parties, residing at dif-
ferent places. Gunong Sow, the original locality, was
attacked by the Sakarran Dyaks, and thence Nimok and
his party retired to Ra-at. A second smaller party subse-
quently located at or near Bow, as being preferable ; while
the older divisions of Jaguen and Ahuss lived at the places
so named. Nimok's great desire was to gather together
his scattered tribe, and to become de facto its head.
My presence and the Datus' was a good opportunity for
gathering the tribe ; and Nimok hoped to give them the
impression that we countenanced his proposition. The
dances over, Nimok pronounced an oration : he dwelt on
the advantages of union ; how desirous he was to benefit
his tribe ; how constantly it was his custom to visit Sa-
rawak in order to watch over the interests of the tribe
the trouble was his, the advantage theirs; but how,
without union, could they hope to gain any advantage
whether the return of their remaining captive women, or
any other ? He proposed this union ; and that, after
the padi was ripe, they should all live at Ra-at, where,
as a body, they were always ready to obey the com-
mands of the Tuan Besar or the Datu.
" This was the substance of Nimok's speech. But
the effect of his oratory was not great ; for the Bow,
and other portions of the tribe, heard coldly his prop-
osition, though they only opposed it in a few words.
It was evident they had no orator at all a match for
Nimok : a few words from Niana drew forth a second
oration. He glanced at their former state ; he spoke
with animation of their enemies, and dwelt on their
great misfortune at Sow ; he attacked the Singe as the
cause of these misfortunes : and spoke long and elo-
quently of things past, of things present, and things to
come. He was seated the whole time ; his voice varied
with his subject, and was sweet and expressive ; his ac-
tion was always moderate, principally laying down the
law with his linger on the mats. Niarak, our Singe
friend, attempted a defence of his tribe ; but he had
300 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
drunk too freely of his own arrack ; and his speech was
received with much laughter, in which he joined. At
this juncture I retired, after saying a few words ; but
the talk was kept up for several hours after, amid feast-
ing and drinking.
"4$. After breakfast, walked to our boats, and at
six P.M. reached home, just in time ; weather very
rainy.
" 10^. Nothing to remark in these days, except the
ordinary course of business and of life.
" I3tk. The Tumangong returned from Sadong, and
brought me a far better account of that place than I had
hoped for. It appears that they really are desirous to
govern well, and to protect the Dyaks ; and fully im-
pressed with the caution I gave them, that unless they
protect and foster their tribes, they will soon lose them
from their removal to Sarawak.
" One large tribe, the Maluku, a branch of the Sib-
nowans, are, it appears, very desirous of being under
my protection. It is a tempting offer, and I should like
to have them ; but I must not deprive the rulers of Sa-
dong of the means of living comfortably, and the power
of paying revenue. Protect them I both can and will.
There are great numbers of Sarawak people at Sadong,
all looking out for birds'-nests ; new caves have been ex-
plored ; mountains ascended for the first time in the
search. It shows the progress of good government and
security, and, at the same time, is characteristic of the
Malay character. They will endure fatigue, and run
risks, on the chance of finding this valuable commodity ;
but they will not labor steadily, or engage in pursuits
which would lead to fortune by a slow progress.
" 15th. Panglima Laksa, the chief of the Undop
tribe, arrived, to request, as the Badjows and Sakarrans
had recently killed his people, that I would permit him
to retort. At the same time came Abong Kapi, the Sa-
karran Malay, with eight Sakarran chiefs, named Si
Miow, ono of the heads, and the rest Tadong, Lengang,
Barunda, Badendang, Si Bunie, Si Ludum, and Kuno,
the representatives of other heads. Nothing could be
more satisfactory than the interview, just over. They
denied any knowledge or connection with the Badjows,
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. ,'JOI
who had killed some Uyaks at Undop, and said all that
I could desire. They promised to obey me, and look
upon me as their chief; they desired to trade, and
would guaranty any Sarawak people who came to
their river ; but they could not answer for all the Dy-
aks in the Batang Lupar. It is well known, however,
that the Bataug Lupar Dyaks are more peaceable than
those of Sakarran, and will be easily managed ; and as
for the breaking out of these old feuds, it is compara-
tively of slight importance, compared to the grand settle-
ment ; for as our influence increases we can easily put
down the separate sticks of the bundle. There is a no-
ble chance, if properly used ! It may be remarked that
many of their names are from some peculiarity of per-
son, or from some quality. Tadong is a poisonous snake ;
but, on inquiry, I found the young chief so named had
got the name from being black. They are certainly a
tine-looking race.
" 17th. Plenty of conferences with the Sakaraan
chiefs ; and, as far as I can judge, they are sincere in
the main, though some reserves there may be. Treach-
ery I do not apprehend from them; but, of course, it
will be impossible, over a very numerous, powerful, and
warlike tribe, to gain such an ascendency of a sudden
as at once to correct their evil habits."
Here again Mr. Brooke appears to have been placed
on the horns of a dilemma by his ignorance of the
views of the British Government. Had his position in
Borneo been certain had he either been supported or
deserted his path of policy would have been clear;
whereas he evidently did not know what the morrow
would bring forth ; whether it would find him with an
English force at his back, or abandoned to his own re-
sources.
Cc
302 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
CHAPTER XXI.
Mr. Brooke's memorandum on the piracy of the Malayan Archi-
pelago. The measures requisite for its suppression, and for
the consequent extension of British commerce in that important
locality.
I CANNOT afford my readers n more accurate idea of
the present state of piracy in the Malayan Archipelago,
of the best mode of suppressing it, and of the vast field
which the island of Borneo offers for the extension of
British commerce, than by quoting a few of Mr. Brooke's
observations on these important subjects, written before
the operations of the squadron under command of Rear-
Admiral Sir Thomas Cochrane took place, of which an
account will be given in Chapter XXII. With reference
to the first topic, piracy, Mr. Brooke remarks :
" The piracy of the Eastern Archipelago is entirely
distinct from piracy in the Western world ; for, from
the condition of the various governments, the facilities
offered by natural situation, and the total absence of all
restraint from European nations, the pirate communities
have attained an importance on the coasts and islands
most removed from foreign settlements. Thence they
issue forth and commit depredations on the native trade,
enslave the inhabitants at the entrance of rivers, and
attack ill-armed or stranded European vessels ; and rov-
ing from place to place, they find markets for their slaves
and plunder.
"The old-established Malay governments (such as
Borneo and Sooloo), weak and distracted, are, probnbly
without exception, participators in or victims to piracy ;
and in many cases both purchasing from one set of
pirates, and enslaved and plundered by another; and
while their dependencies are abandoned, the unpro-
tected trudo languishes from the natural dread of the
better-disposed natives to undertake a coasting voyage.
" it is needless to dwell upon the evil effects of pira-
cy ; but before venturing an opinion on the most effect-
ual moans of suppression, I propose briefly to give an
account of such pirate communities as I am acquainted
with.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 303
" The pirates on the coast of Borneo may be classed
into those who make long voyages in large heavy-armed
prahus, such as the Illanuns, Balignini, &c., and the
lighter Dyak fleets, which make short but destructive
excursions in swift prahus, and seek to surprise rather
thuu openly to attack their prey. A third, and probably
the worst class, are usually half-bred Arab serifls, who,
possessing themselves of the territoiy of some Malay
state, form a nucleus for piracy, a rendezvous and mar-
ket for all the roving fleets ; and although occasionally
sending out their own followers, they more frequently
seek profit by making advances, in food, arms, and gun-
powder, to all who will agree to repay them at an exor-
bitant rate in slaves.
" The Dyaks of Sarebus and Sakarran were under
the influence of two Arab serifFs, who employed them
on piratical excursions, and shared in equal parts the
plunder obtained. I had once the opportunity of count-
ing ninety-eight boats about to start on a cruise ; and
reckoning the crew of each boat at the moderate aver-
age of twenty-five men, it gives a body of 2450 men on
a piratical excursion. The piracies of these Arab se-
riffs and their Dyaks were so notorious, that it is need-
less to detail them here ; but one curious feature, which
throws a light on the state of society, I cannot forbear
mentioning. On all occasions of a Dyak fleet being
about to make a piratical excursion, a gong was beat
round the town ordering a particular number of Malays
to embark ; and in case any one failed to obey, he was
fined the sum of thirty rupees by the seriff of the
place.
" The blow struck by Captain Keppel of her majesty's
ship Dido on these two communities was so decisive as
to have put an entire end to their piracies ; the leaders
Seriff Sahib and Seriff Muller have fled, the Malay
population has been dispersed, and the Dyaks so far
humbled, as to sue for protection ; and in future, by
substituting local Malay rulers of good character in lieu
of the piratical seriffs, a check will be placed on the
Dyaks, and they may be broken of their piratical habits,
in as far as interferes with the trade of the coast.
" The next pirate horde we meet with is a mixed
304
TO HOUM;.
community oi' Iliauuns and Badjows (or sea-gipsys)
located at Tampasuk, a few miles up a small river; they
are not formidable in number, and their depredations
are chiefly committed on the Spanish territory ; their
market, until recently, being Bruni, or Borneo Proper.
They might readily be dispersed and driven back to
their own country ; and the Dusuns, or villagers (as the
name signifies), might be protected and encouraged.
Seriff Houseman, a half-bred Arab, is located in Mallu-
du Bay, and has, by account, from fifteen hundred to
two thousand men wit?i him. He is beyond doubt a
pirate direct and indirect, and occasionally commands
excursions in person, or employs the Illanuns of Tam-
pasuk, and others to the eastward, who for their own
convenience make common cause with him. He has
no pretension to the territory he occupies ; and the au-
thority he exerts (by means of his piratical force) over
the interior tribes in his vicinity, and on the island of
Palawan, is of the worst and most oppressive descrip-
tion. This seriff has probably never come in contact
with any Europeans, and consequently openly professes
to hold their power in scorn.
"To my own knowledge Seriff Houseman seized and
sold into slavery a boat's crew (about twenty men) of
the Sultana, a merchant ship, which was burned in the
Palawan passage. Within the last few months he has
plundered and burned a European vessel stranded near
the Mangsi Isles ; and to show his entire independence
of control, his contempt for European power, and his de-
termination to continue in his present course, he has
threatened to attack the city of Bruui, in consequence
of the Bruni government having entered into a treaty
with her majesty's government for the discouragement
and suppression of piracy. This fact speaks volumes ;
an old-established and recognized Malay government is
to be attacked by a lawless adventurer, who has seized
on a portion of its territory, and lives by piracy, for ven-
turing to treat with a foreign power for the best pur-
poses. If any further proof of piracy were requisite, it
would readily be established by numerous witnesses
(themselves the victims), and by the most solemn dec-
laration of the Bruni authorities, that peaceful iniclrr
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 305
tn .the high seas have been stopped by the prahus of
this serifF and his allies, their vessel seized, their prop-
erty plundered, and their persons enslaved ; numerous
witnesses could attest their having been reduced to
slavery and detained in the very household of Serift'
Houseman ! When, however, the facts of his having
sold into slavery the crew of a British vessel (which has
been established before the Singapore authorities) come
to be known, I conceive every other proof of the char-
acter of this person is completely superfluous.
'* The indirect piracy of Seriff Houseman is even
more mischievous than what is directly committed ; for
he supplies the Balagnini (a restless piratical tribe,
hereafter to be mentioned) with, food, powder, arms,
salt, &c. under the agreement that they pay him on
their return from the cruise, at the rate of five slaves
for every 100 rupees' worth of goods. . The Balagnini
are in consequence enabled, through his assistance, to
pirate effectively, which otherwise they would not be
able to do ; as, from their locality, they would find it
difficult to obtain fire-arms and gunpowder. The most
detestable part of this traffic, however, is Seriff House-
man selling, in cold blood, such of these slaves as are
Borneons, to Pangeran Usop, of Bruni, for 100 rupees
for each slave, and Pangeran Usop re-selling each for
:200 rupees to their relations in Bruni. Thus, this vile
serifF (without taking into account the enormous prices
charged for his goods in the first instance) gains 500
per cent for every slave, and Pangeran Usop clears 100
per cent on the flesh of his own countrymen, thereby de
facto becoming a party to piracy, though doubtless veiled
under the guise of compassion.
" More might be added on the subject of the piracies
committed by this serifF; and it could easily be shown
that the evils accruing from them affect, not only the
peaceful trader, but extend to the peaceful agricultu-
rist ; but, for the sake of brevity, I deem it sufficient to
add, that he exercises the same malign influence on the
north coast as SerifF Sahib exercised on the northwest ;
and that, having surrounded himself by a body of pirates,
he airogates the rights of sovereignty, defies European
power, -contemns every right principle, and threatens
20 r c 2
306 EXPEDITION TO BOIiNEOv
the recognized and legitimate governments of the Ar-
chipelago.
" The Balagnini inhabit a cluster of small islands
somewhere in the vicinity of Sooloo ; they are of the-
Badjow or sea-gipsy tribe, a wandering race, whose
original country has never been ascertained. At pres-
ent, as far as I can learn, they are not dependent on
Sooloo, though it is probable they may be encouraged
by some of the rajahs of that place, and that they find
a slave market there.
" The Balagnini cruise in large prahus, aad to each
prahu a fleet sampan is attached, which, on occasion,,
can carry from ten to fifteen men. They seldom carry
large guns, like the Illanuns, but in addition to their
other arms, big lelas (brass pieces, carrying from a one
to a three pound ball), spears, swords, &c. They use
long poles with barbed iron points, with whieh r during
an engagement or flight, they hook their prey. By
means of the fleet sampans already mentioned, they aro
able to '-iiplu'v all small boats; and it; is a favorite de-
vice with them to disguise one or two men, while the
rest lie concealed in the bottom of the boat, and thus to
surprise prahus at sea, and fishermen or others at the
mouths of rivers. By being disguised as Chinese they
have carried off numbers of that nation from the Sambas
and Pontiana rivers. The cruising-grounds of these-
pirates are very extensive ; they frequently make the-
circuit of Borneo, proceed as far as the south of Ce-
lebes, and in the other direction have been met off Trin-
ganu, Calantan, and Patani. Gillolo and the Moluccas
lie within easy range, and it; is probable that Papua is-
occasionally visited by them. It will readily be con-
ceived how harassing to trade must be the continued
depredations of the Balagnini pirates, and more espe-
cially to the trade of Bruni, which seems, from the un-
warlike habits of the natives, the chosen field of their
operations. The number of Borneor.s yearly taken
into slavery is very considerable, as a fleet of six or
eight boats usually hangs about the island of Labuan, to
cut off the trade, and to catch the inhabitants of the
city. The Borneons, IVoni being so harassed by these
pivaU's. c;iU ill'' Pastel llie pimie wind." Th'
KXI'EUITION TO BORNEO. 307
Balagniui commence cruising on the northwest coast
about the middle of March, and return, or remove
to the eastern side of the island, about the end of No-
vember.
" Of Magindano, or Mindanao, we are at the present
time very ignorant; but we know that the inhabitants
are warlike and numerous, and that that part of the
island called Illanun Bay sends forth the most daring
pirates of the Archipelago. The first step requisite is
to gain more information concerning them, to form an
acquaintance with some of their better-disposed chiefs,
and subsequently we might act against them with a suit-
able force ; but it would be rash and premature, in the
present state of our knowledge, to come in contact with
them in their own country. On one occasion I met
eighteen Illanun boats on neutral ground, and learned
from their two chiefs that they had been two years ab-
sent from home ; and from the Papuan negro-slaves on
board it was evident that their cruise had extended from
the most eastern islands of the Archipelago to the north-
western coast of Borneo.
44 Having now enumerated the pirates I have become
acquainted with since my residence in Sarawak, I shall
proceed to oiler an opinion of the best mode for the sup-
pression of piracy in these seas.
" In the first place, a blow should be struck at the
piratical communities with which we are already ac-
quainted, and struck with a force which should convince
all other pirates of the hopelessness of resistance ; sub-
sequently the recognized Malay governments may be
detached from all communication with pirates ; and,
joining conciliation with punishment, laying down the
broad distinction of piracy and no piracy, we may foster
those who abandon their evil habits, and punish those
who adhere to them.
44 A system of supervision will, however, be necessary
to carry out these measures : our knowledge of the na-
tive states must be improved ; and as we become able to
discriminate between the good and the bad, our sphere
of action may be enlarged, and we may act with decision
against all descriptions of pirates ; against the indirect
as well as the direct pirate ; against the receiver of
308 EXPEDITION TO BOltNKO.
stolen goods as well as the thief; and against the pro-
moter as well as the actual perpetrator of piracy.
" I would especially urge that, to eradicate the evil,
the pirate-haunts must be burned and destroyed, and
the communities dispersed ; for merely to cruise against
pirate-prahus, and to forbear attacking them until we
see them commit a piracy, is a hopeless and an endless
task, harassing to our men, and can be attended with
but very partial and occasional success ; whereas, on
the contrary principle, what pirate would venture to pur-
sue his vocation if his home be endangered if he be
made to feel in his own person the very ills he inflicts
upon others ?
" A question may arise as to what constitutes piracy ;
and whether, in our efforts to suppress it, we may not
be interfering with the right of native states to war one
upon another. On the first point, it appears clear to
me, that the plunder or seizure of a peaceful and lawful
trader on the high seas constitutes an act of piracy,
without any reference to the nation or color of the in-
jured party ; for if we limit our construction of piracy,
we shall, in most cases, be in want of sufficient evidence
to convict, and the whole native trade of the Archipelago
will be left at the mercy of pirates, much to the injury
of our own commerce and of our settlement of Singa-
pore.
" On the second point, we can only concede the right
of war to recognized states ; and even then we must
carefully avoid introducing the refinements of European
international law among a rude and semi-civilized people,
who will make our delicacy a cloak for crime, and de-
clare war merely for the sake of committing piracy with
impunity. On the contraiy, all chiefs who have seized
on territory and arrogate independence (making this in-
dependence a plea for piracy) can never be allowed the
right of declaring war, or entering on hostilities with
their neighbors ; for, as I have before remarked, all na-
tive trade must in that case be at an end, as the piratical
chiefs, no longer in dread of punishment from European
powers, would doubtless declare wav against every un-
warliko native state which they did not need as a mar-
kef for the sale of their slaves and plunder.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 309
" Practically acting, however, on the broad principle,
that the seizure of any lawful trader constitutes piracy,
I consider no injustice could be done to the native states,
and no interference occur with their acknowledged
rights ; for in practice it would be easy to discriminate a
war between native nations from the piracies of lawless
hordes of men ; and without some such general princi-
ple, no executive officer could act with the requisite de-
cision and promptitude to insure the eradication of this
great evil.
"With a post such as is proposed to be established,
our measures for the suppression of piracy (after the
punishment of SerifF Houseman and the Balagnini)
would advance step by step, as our knowledge increased,
and with alternate conciliation and severity, as the case
might require. By detaching the recognized govern-
ments from the practice, and gradually forming among
the chief men a friendly and English party opposed to
piracy, we should, I doubt not, speedily obtain our prin-
cipal object of clearing the Sea of marauders, and ulti-
mately correct the natural propensity of the natives for
piracy.
" In order to' extend our commerce in these seas gen-
erally, and more particularly on the N.W. coast of Bor-
neo, it is requisite, 1st, that piracy be suppressed ; 2dly,
that the native governments be settled, so as to afford
protection to the poorer and producing classes ; and,
3dly, that our knowledge of the interior should be ex-
tended, and our intercourse with the various tribes more
frequent.
" That our commerce may be largely extended is so
clear that I shall not stop to detail the productions of
the island of Borneo, as it will suffice here to state gen-
erally that all authorities agree in representing it as one
of the riches* portions of the globe, and in climate, soil,
and mineral and vegetable productions, inferior to no
portion of the same extent.
" If these opinions be true and from my experience
I believe them to be so it follows that the materials for
an extensive and extended trade exist, and only require
development, while a numerous and industrious, though
wild population, which inhabits the interior, is debarred
S10 KXI'KIHTLOA To
from all intercourse with Europeans from the badness of
Malay government.
44 On the first requisite for the development of com-
merce I need add nothing further, as it is a duty incum-
bent on all governments to eradicate piracy at any cost;
and in the present ease it would not be found a difficult
or tedious task.
" A. post like Labuan or Balambangan would, beyond
doubt, give an impetus to trade, merely from the free-
dom from all restrictions, and the absence of all exac-
tions, which the natives would enjoy; and (piracy being
checked) countries which now lie fallow would, from
their proximity, be induced to bring their produce into
market.
" This limited extension is, however, of little moment
when compared with the results which must attend our
exerting a beneficial influence over the native govern-
ments for the purposes of affording protection to the
poorer classes, insuring safety to the trader, and opening
a field for the planter or the miner.
" The slightest acquaintance with the northwest coast
of Borneo would convince any observer of the ease with
which these objects might be effected ; for the native
government, being in a state of decadence, requires pro-
tection, and would willingly act justly toward traders and
capitalists, and encourage their enterprises, in order to
continue on friendly terms with any European power
located in their vicinity. The numerous rivers on the
coast, with their local rulers, are harassed by the de-
mands of every petty Pangeran ; and while the sovereign
is defrauded of his revenue, which the people would
cheerfully pay, and his territory ruined, this host of
useless retainers (acting always in his name) gain but
very slight personal profits to counterbalance all the mis-
chief they do.
" The principal feature is the weakness of the govern-
ments, both of the capital and its dependencies ; and in
consequence of this weakness there is a strong desire
for European protection, for European enterprise, and
for any change effected by Kuropeans. Supposing La-
otian to be taken as ;i iiiivnl post, I consider that Euro-
pean cnpital might with safety be employed in Bruni.
V:\PKIMTION TO BORNEO. .'ill
" In tho rivers contiguous to Sar&wak the presence of
Europeans would be hailed with joy, not only by the
JDyaks, but by the Malays ; and subsequently it would
depend on their own conduct to what degree they re-
tained the good-will of the natives ; but with ordinary
conciliation, and a decent moral restraint on their ac-
tions, I feel assured that their persons and property
would be safe, and no obstruction offered to fair trade or
to raining operations.
" Supposing, as I have before said, the occupation of
Labuan by the English, our influence over the govern-
ment of Bruni would be complete ; and one of our prin-
cipal objects would be to maintain this ascendency, as a
means of extending our trade.
" Our position at Labuan would, it must be borne in
mind, differ from the position we occupied in relation
to the native princes in Singapore. In the latter case,
the native princes were without means, without follow-
ers, arid with a paltry and useless territory, and became
our pensioners. In the case of Labuan, we shall have
an acknowledged independent state in our vicinity ; and
for the prosperity of our settlement we must retain our
ascendency by the support of the government of Muda
Hassim. Let our influence be of the mildest kind ; let
us, by supporting the legitimate government, ameliorate
the condition of the people by this influence ; let us pay
every honor to the native princes ; let us convince them
of our entire freedom from all selfish views of territorial
aggrandizement on the mainland of Borneo, and we shall
enjoy so entire a confidence that virtually the coast will
become our own without the trouble or expense of pos-
session. I have impressed it on the Rajah Muda Hassim
and Pangeran Budrudeen, that the readiest and most
direct way of obtaining revenues from their various pos-
sessions will be by commuting all their demands for a
stated yearly sum of money from each; and by this
direct taxation, to which Muda Hassim and his brother
seem ready to accede, the system of fraud and exaction
would be abolished, the native mind tranquillized, and
the legitimate government would become the protector
rather than the oppressor of its dependencies. ' By this
measure, likewise, a tone might be imparted to the
3I'J . ."lODiriu.v TO mm* FA).
native chiefs and rulers of rivers, and the people at large
taught to feel that, after the payment of a specified sum,
a right existed to resist all extra demands. Beside this,
these rajahs are convinced that a certain yearly revenue
is what they require, and is the only means by which
they can retain their independence ; and I have im-
pressed it on their minds that, to gain a revenue, they
must foster trade and protect Europeans in their deal-
ings.
" If Labuan were English, and if the sea were clear
of pirates, I see no obstacle to bringing these and other
measures into immediate operation ; and I am assured
we should have the sincere and hearty cooperation of
the Borneon government.
" Since the advent of Europeans in the Archipelago,
the tendency of the Polynesian governments generally
has been to decay ; here,.the experiment may be fairly
tried on the smallest scale of expense, whether a bene-
ficial European influence may not reanimate a falling
state, and at the same time extend our own commerce.
We are here devoid of the stimulus which has urged us
on to conquest in India. We incur no risk of the collision
of the two races : we occupy a small station in the vi-
cinity of a friendly and unwarlike people ; and we aim
at the development of native countries through native
agency.
" If this tendency to decay and extinction be inevita-
ble ; if this adaptation of European policy to a native state
be found unable to arrest the fall of the Borneon govern-
ment, yet we shall retain a people already habituated to
European manners, industrious interior races, and at ;i
future period, if deemed necessaiy, settlements gradu-
ally developed in a rich and fertile country. We shall
have a post in time of war highly advantageous as com-
manding a favorable position relative to China, we shall
extend our commerce, suppress piracy, and prevent the
presentand prospective advantages from falling into other
hands ; and we shall do this at a small expense.
" I own the native development through their own
exertions is but a favorite theory; but whatever may be
the fate of the government of Borneo, the people will
still remain : and if they be protected and enabled to live
TO BORM 313
in quiet security, I cannot entertain a doubt of the coun-
try's becoming a highly productive one, eminently cal-
culated as a field for British enterprise and capital.
" If the development of the resources of the country
can be effected by its native rulers it will be a noble task
performed ; but if it fail, the people of the coast will still
advance and form governments for themselves under
British influence.
"In concluding this hasty and general view of the
subject, I may remark that commerce might be ex-
tended and capital laid out on the northwest coast of
Borneo, to an amount to which it is difficult to fix limits, as
the country is capable of producing most articles of com-
merce in demand from this quarter of the world, and
the natives (who, as far as we know them, are an un-
warlike, mild, and industrious race) would receive our
manufactures, from which they are now in a great
measure debarred. I have not alluded to any other
countries of the Archipelago : for we must first become
acquainted with them ; we must become intimate, cul-
tivate an English party, and accustom them to our
manners ; and probably the same conciliatory policy,
the same freedom from design, which has succeeded in
Borneo, will succeed elsewhere, if pushed with temper
and patience.
"The general principle ought to be to encourage
established governments, such as those of Borneo and
Sooloo, provided they will with all sincerity abandon
piracy, and assist in its suppression ; but at the same
time, by supervision to convince ourselves of the fact,
and keep them in the right path ; for all treaties with
these native states (and we have had several) are but so
much waste paper, unless we see them carried into ex-
ecution.
" I have now only to mention the third means for the
extension of commerce. Our intercourse with the na-
tives of the interior should be frequent and intimate :
these people (beyond where I am acquainted with
them) are represented as very numerous, hospitable,
and industrious ; and a friendly intercourse would de-
velop the resources of their country, draw its produce
to our markets, and give the natives a taste for British
DD
<JI4 l-'.Xl'Klil'TIUV TO JJOllNI-'.o.
manufactures. r riiis intercourse, however, must bo
prudently introduced nnd carefully advanced ; for to
bring these wild people into contact with ignorant and
arrogant Europeans would produce bloodshed and con-
fusion in a month. In Borneo, it is an advantage that
the two races can not come in collision ; for from its cli-
mate it precludes all idea of colonization ; and that,
which is next to an impossibility, the maintaining a good
understanding between ignorant civilized men and igno-
rant savages. It is a field for commerce and capital, but
no violent change of native customs should be attempted ;
and in this way alone, by gradual means, can we really
benefit the natives and ourselves. Wlien we consider
the amount of produce obtained from the countries of
the Archipelago, and their consumption of British manu-
factures, under the worst forms of government, living
in a state of distraction and insecurity, and exposed to
the depredations of pirates at sea, we may form some
idea how vast may be the increase, should peace and se-
curity be introduced among them ; and judging of the
future by the past by the limited experiment made at
Sarawak we may hope that the task is neither so diffi-
cult nor so uncertain as was formerly supposed."
CHAPTER XXII.
Arrival of Captain Bethune and Mr. Wise. Mr. Brooke appoint-
ed her Majesty's Agent in Borneo. Sails for Borneo Prop-
er. Muda Hassim's measures for the suppression of piracy.
Defied by Seriff Houseman. Audience of the Sultan, Muda
Hassim, and the Pangerans. Visit to Labuan. Comparative
eligibility of Labuan and Balambangan for settlement. Coal
discovered in Labuan. Mr. Brooke goes to Singapore and vis-
its Admiral Sir T. Cochrane. The upas-tree. Proceeds with
the Admiral to Borneo Proper. Punishment of Pangeran Usop.
The battle of Malludu. SeriffHouseman obliged to fly. Visit
to Balambangan. Mr. Brooke parts with the Admiral, and goes
l.o Borneo Proper. An attempt of Pangeran Usop defeated.
His flight, and pursuit by Pangeran lUidrudcon. Triumphant
reception of Mr Brooke in Borneo. Returns to Sarawak.
"February 25//?. Borneo River, H.M.S. Driver.
Sram'lv, on ihe 17th, had 1 finished writing, wlx-n a
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 315
boat from her majesty's steamer Driver, bringing Cap-
tain 1J (Ml i mm and my friend Wise, arrived. How strange,
the same day, and almost the same hour, I was penning
my doubts and difficulties, when a letter arrives from
Lord Aberdeen appointing me confidential agent in Bor-
neo to her majesty, and directing me to proceed to the
capital, with a letter addressed to the sultan and the Ra-
jah A lud a Hassim, in reply to the documents requesting
the assistance of the British government to effect the
suppression of piracy.
" My friend Wise I was glad to see, and a few hours'
conversation convinced me how greatly I have been in-
debted to his exertions for success and my present po-
sition. His knowledge of trade, his cheerfulness regard-
ing our pecuniary future, all impart confidence. Thus
I may say, without much self-flattery, that the first
wedge has been driven which may rive Borneo open to
commerce and civilization, which may bestow happiness
on its inhabitants. Captain Bethune is commissioned to
report on the best locality for a settlement or station on
the N.W. coast. I will only say here that no other per-
son's appointment would have pleased me so well : he
is intelligent, educated, and liberal, and in concert with
him I am too happy to work.
" On the 18th of February the Driver arrived ; on
the 21st left Sarawak, and at noon of the 24th arrived
at the anchorage in Borneo river, having towed the gun-
boat against the N.E. monsoon. Mr. Williamson was
dispatched to Borneo, and found all right. They were
delighted with our coming and our mission, and the sul-
tan himself has laid aside his fears. A few presents
have been sent, which will delight the natives, and all
will prosper.
" 26f/t. Budrudeen arrived, and from him I learned
the politics of Borneo since my last visit, when Muda
Hassim was reinstated in authority.
"As my mission refers more especially to piracy, 1
may here notice Muda Hassim's measures relative to
that subject. Shortly after his arrival he addressed a
letter to the Illanuns of Tampasuk, informing them of
the engagement with the English to discourage and sup-
press piracy, advising them to desist, and ordering them
310 HXI'KDITIOX TO UOK,\K<>.
not to visit Borneo until he (Muda Hassim) was convin-
ced they were pirates no longer. This is good and can-
did. Muda Hassim at the same time requested Seriff
Schaik to address a communication to Seriff Houseman
of Malludu, acquainting him with his engagements, and
the resolve of the Europeans to suppress piracy, adding
that he was friends with the English, and no man could
be friends with the English wlio encouraged piracy.
The answer to this letter of Seriff Schaik, as far as I
have yet learned, is a positive defiance. Three months
since, I am informed, a brig or schooner was wrecked
at a place called Mangsi, and she has been completely
plundered and burned by Seriff Houseman : her cargo
consisted of red woolens, fine white cloths, Turkey red
cotton handkerchiefs, tin, pepper, Malacca canes, rat-
ans, &c., &c. This evidently is a vessel bound to Chi-
na, whether English or not is doubtful: the crew have
not been heard of or seen here, and it is to be hoped
may have reached Manilla.
"28^/i. Borneo, or Bruni city. Left the Driver at
9 A.M. in the gun-boat, with the pinnace and cutter in
company : a fine breeze earned us to Pulo Chermin,
and nearly the whole way to Pulo Combong, where we
met with the state-boat bearing the letter. We enter-
ed the town straggling, and the Letter having been receiv-
ed with firing of guns, banners displayed, and all the re-
spect due to a royal communication, we were dragged
in haste to the audience ; the sultan on his throne, Muda
Hassim and every principal Pangeran waiting for us
Pangeran Usop to boot. The letter was read ; twenty-
one guns fired. I told them in all civility that I was de-
puted by her majesty the queen to express her feelings
of good will, and 1o offer every assistance in repressing
piracy in these seas. The sultan stared. Muda Has-
sim said, ' We are greatly indebted ; it is good, very
good.' Then, heated, and sunburned, and tired, we took
leave, and retired to the house prepared for us.
"March 1st. A long conference with Budrudeen,
when, I believe, we exhausted all the important topics
of Borneo politics : subsequently we visited Muda I las-
sim and the sultan. The latter was profuse in his kind
expressions, and inquired of the interpreter when the
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 317
English would come to Labuan, adding, ' I want to have
the Europeans near me.' On this head, however, he
gained no information. The presents were given to the
sultan and rajah.
" 5th. In the evening visited Muda Hassim, and heard
news from Malludu, which, divested of exaggerations,
amounted to this : that Seriff Houseman was ready to
receive us ; was fortified, and had collected a fleet of
boats ; and that if the English did not come and attack
him, he would come and attack Borneo, because they
were in treaty with Europeans. After leaving Muda
Hassim, paid the sultan a visit.
" lOfh. I have nothing to say of our departure. Bu-
drudeen accompanied us to the Mooarra, and thence, on
Friday eve'ning, we crossed to the anchorage of Labuan.
u 12th. Labuan. An island of about fifty feet high ;
twenty -five miles in circumference; woody; timber
good ; water from wells and a few small streams, which,
after a drought, are dry ; natives say water never fails.
Anchorage good for the climate ; well protected from
theN.E.; not extensive ; situation of contemplated town
low ; climate healthy, i. e., the same as Borneo ; soil,
as far as seen, sandy or light sandy loam. Coal found
near the extreme N.E. point : by native reports it is like-
wise to be found in many other places ; traces of coal
are frequent in the sandstone strata. Anchorage not
difficult of defense against a European enemy ; en-
trance sufficiently broad and deep between two islands,
with a shoal : vide chart. The island of Labuan, for the
purposes of refuge for shipwrecked vessels, of a wind-
ward post relative to China, for the suppression of pira-
cy, and the extension of our trade, is well suited ; it is
no paradise, and any other island, with good climate,
wood, and water, would suit as well. Its powerful rec-
ommendation is its being in the neighborhood of an un-
warlike and friendly people. There is no other island
on the N.W. coast, and the abandoned Balambangan, to
the northward of Borneo, is the only other place which
could by possibility answer. The comparison between
Balambangan and Labuan may be stated as follows :
Balambangan, as a windward post relative to China, is
superior, and it commands in time of war the inner pass-
D 2
318 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
age to Manilla, and the eastern passages to China by
the Straits of Makassar. Of its capabilities of defense
we know nothing. It was surprised by the Sooloos.
Its climate was not well spoken of. The island is larger
than that of Labuan, and, as far as we know, has no coal.
The great, and to me conclusive consideration against
Balambangan is, that it is in the very nest of pirates, and
surrounded by warlike and hostile people ; and that to
render it secure and effective, at least double the force
would be necessary there that would suffice at Labuan.
If Labuan succeeds and pays its own expenses, we might
then take Balambangan ; for the next best thing to a lo-
cation on the main is to influence the people thereon by
a succession of insular establishments. Yesterday we
made an agreeable excursion to the N.E. point of Labu-
an ; near the point it is picturesque, the cliffs are bold
and cave-worn ; the trees hang over the cliffs, or en-
croach on the intermediate sands, till they kiss the wave.
Near a small cavern we discovered a seam of coal, which
afforded us employment while Captain Bethune and Mr.
Wise walked to obtain a view of the southern coast of
the island.
" JBruni, 21st May, 1845. After a longer time passed
in Singapore than I wished, we at length started, in the
Phlegethon steamer, for this city. At Singapore I had
several interviews with Sir Thomas Cochrane.
" 22d. On the authority of Sulerman, an intelligent
Meri man, I am told that the tree below the town is the
real upas, called by the Meri men tajim the Borneons call
it upas. Bina (the name we formerly got from a Bor-
neon for upas) is, by Sulerman's statement, a thin creep-
er, the root or stem of which, being steeped in water, is
added to the upas, to increase the poisonous quality ; it
is not, however, poisonous in itself. There is another
creeper, likewise called bina, the leaves of which are
steeped and mixed with the upas, instead of the stem
of the first sort. This information may be relied on (in
the absence of personal knowledge), as the man is of a
tribe, which uses the sumpitan, and is constantly in the
habit of preparing the poison.
"August 8th. Off Ujong Sapo, at the entrance ni'
Borneo river. The time siix-n I last added to my most
! M'KDITIO* TO BOKNKU. 319
desultory journal is easily accounted for. 1 have been
at Singapore and Malacca, and am now anchored off
Borneo Proper, with seven vessels, and an eighth is
hourly expected. It is difficult, with such a force, to be
moderate ; and, with Sir Thomas Cochrane's other du-
ties and engagements, it is probably impossible to devote
any length of time on this coast ; yet moderation and
time are the key-stones of our policy. I have settled ali
the ceremonial for a meeting between the sultan and the
admiral.
" The Pangeran Bndrudeen came on board H.M.S.
Agincourt, with every circumstance of state and cere-
mony, and met the admiral, I acting as interpreter. It
was pleasing to witness his demeanor and bearing,
which proved that, in minds of a certain quality, the
power of command, though over savages, gives ease and
freedom. The ship, the band, the marines, the guns,
all excited Budrudeen's attention. On the 9th, it is ar-
ranged that the admiral shall meet the sultan arid the
rajah.
" 9th. In the course of the day, after the audience
had terminated, the admiral made his demand of repara-
tion on the sultan and Muda Hassim for the detention
and confinement of two British subjects subsequent to
their agreement with the British government. Of course,
the sultan and the rajah replied that they were not in
fault ; that the act was Pangeran Usop's, and that he
was too powerful for them to control by force. If Sir
Thomas Cochrane would punish him, they should be
much obliged, as they desired to keep the treaty invio-
late.
" 10th. Pangeran Usop had to be summoned; come
he would not, and yet I was in hopes that, when he
saw the overwhelming force opposed to him, his pride
would yield to necessity. About 2 p.iq, the steamers
took up their positions ; the marines were landed, ev-
ery thing was prepared, yet no symptom of obedience.
At length a single shot was fired from the Vixen, by the
admiral's order, through the roof of Usop's house, which
was instantly returned, thus proving the folly and the
lemper of the man. In a few minutes his house was
tenantless. having been overwhelmed with shot. Usop
320 EXPEDITION To HUKXKO.
was a fugitive ; the amount of mischief done inconsider-
able, and no damage except to the guilty party. Twen-
ty captured guns the admiral presented to the sultan
and the rajah ; two he kept, from which to remunerate
the two detained men. So far nothing could be more
satisfactory. Usop has been punished severely, the
treaty strictly enforced, and our supremacy maintained.
No evil has been done except to the guilty ; his house
and his property alone have suffered, and the immediate
flight has prevented the shedding of blood.
" Ilth. At mid-day the admiral, with the Vixen and
Nemesis, went down the river, leaving the Pluto to me,
to follow in next day.
" 12th. This morning I. visited the sultan in compa-
ny with Muda Hassim. By twelve at night the Pluto
was anchored in the creek at Labuan, and on the 13th
I once more took up my quarters aboard the flag-ship.
" 14th. Wooding.
" 16th. Last evening anchored within the point call-
ed in the chart Sampormangio, or, properly, Sampang
Mengayu, which, being translated, signifies piratical or
cruising waiting-place. The weather was thick and
squally, and it was late before the Daedalus and Vestal
arrived with their tows, the Nemesis and Pluto, the for-
mer frigate having carried away her mizzon top-mast.
" nth. Squadron under weigh pretty early, getting
into Malludu Bay. After breakfast, had a very heavy
squall. Agincourt heeled to it, and sails of various sorts
and sizes were blowing about in ribbons aboard some of
the ships : afterward brought up nearly off the Melow
river.
" 18th. Vixen, Nemesis, Pluto, and boats, proceeded
up the bay, and anchored as near as possible to the en-
trance of the Marudu, or Malludu river. The charac-
ter of Malludu bay generally may be described as clear
of danger, witfi high, wooded banks on either side, till
in the bight, when the land gets flat and mangrovy, and
the water shallow, and whore the mouths of stiver:'!
small rivers are seen, one of which is Malludu.
" 19th. On the 19th of August was fought the cele-
brated battle of Malludu; the boats, 24 in number, and
containing 550 marines and blue-jackets, having left the
EXPEDITION TO UOIINEO. 321
previous afternoon. As I was not present, I can say only
what I heard from others, and from what I know from
subsequently viewing the position. A narrow river with
two forts mounting eleven or twelve heavy guns (and de-
fended by from 500 to 1000 fighting men), protected by
a strong and well-contrived boom, was the position of
the enemy. Our boats took the bull by the horns, and
indeed had little other choice ; cut away part of the boom
under a heavy fire ; advanced, and earned the place in
a fight protracted for fifty minutes. The enemy fought
well and stood manfully to their guns ; and a loss of six
killed, two mortally and fifteen severely wounded, on
Dur side, was repaid by a very heavy loss of killed and
wounded on theirs. Gallant Gibbard,* of the Wolverine,
fell mortally Wounded while working at the boom, ax in
hand. In short, the engagement was severe and trying
to our men from the fire they were exposed to. At two
minutes to nine, aboard the Vixen, we heard the report
of the first heavy gun, and it was a time of anxiety and
uneasiness till the first column of black smoke proclaimed
that the village was fired.
" I may here mention that before the fight commenced
a flag of truce came from the enemy, and asked for me.
Captain Talbot (in command) offered to meet Seriff
Houseman either within or without the boom, provided
his whole force was with him. Seriff Houseman de-
clined ; but offered (kind man !) to admit two gigs to be
hauled over the boom. No sooner was this offer de-
clined, and the flag returned the second time with a
young SerifF, son of Seriff Layak of Bruni, than the en-
emy opened fire, which was promptly returned. Had
Captain Talbot entered as proposed, I deem it certain he
would never have quitted the place alive ; for the Seriff
and his followers had made themselves up to fight, and
nothing but fight. Many chiefs were killed; two or
three Seriffs in their large turbans and flowing robes ;
many Illanuns in their gay dresses and golden charms ;
* Leonard Gibbard made his first trip to sea under my charge
in 1834, when I commanded the Child ers in the Mediterranean, and
at that early age gave promise of what he afterward proved him-
self to be a gallant officer and thorough seaman. Poor fellow !
ne was always a general favorite wherever he went. H. K.
21
322 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
many Badjaws ; many slaves among them a captive'
Chinaman ; many were wounded ; many carried away :
and many left on the ground dead or dying.
44 2o//z. On the evening of the 19th a detachment of
ten boats, with fresh men and officers, qTiitted the Vix-
en, and arrived at the forts shortly after daylight. I ac-
companied this party ; and the work of destruction, well
begun yesterday, was this day completed. Numerous
proofs of the piracies of this Serift* came to light. The
boom was ingeniously fastened with the chain cable of a
vessel of 300 or 400 tons ; other chains were found in
the town ; a ship's long-boat ; two ship's bells, one orna-
mented with grapes and vine leaves, and marked ' Wil-
helm Ludwig, Bremen ;' and every other description of
ship's furniture. Some half-piratical boats, Illanun and
Balagnini, were burned; twenty-four or twenty-five
brass guns captured; the iron guns, likewise stated to
have been got out of a ship, were spiked and otherwise
destroyed. Thus has Malluda ceased to exist; and
Seriff Houseman's power received a fall from which it
will never recover.
" Amid this scene of war and devastation was one epi-
sode which moved even harder hearts than mine. Twen-
ty-four hours after the action, a poor woman, with her
child of two years of age, was discovered in a small ca-
noe ; her arm was shattered at the elbow by a grape
shot ; and the poor creature lay dying for want of water
in an agony of pain, with her child playing round her
and endeavoring to derive the sustenance which the moth-
er could no longer give. This poor woman was taken
on board the Vixen, and in the evening her arm was am-
putated. To have left her would have been certain
death; so I was strongly for the measure of taking her
to Sarawak, where she can be protected. To all my
inquiries she answered, ' If you please to take me, I shall
go. I am a woman, and not a man ; I am a slave, and
not a free woman : do as you like.' She stated too, pos-
itively, that she herself had seen Serift' Houseman wound-
ed in the neck, and carried off; and her testimony is
corroborated by two Manilla men, who, among others,
ran away on the occasion, and sought protection from us,
who likewise say that ihey saw the Sp.rif''<
EXPEDITION TO BOltN !:<>. .'Wll
in the j ungle, but they can not say whether dead or wound-
ed. The pi-oof how great a number must havo been
killed and wounded on their part is, that on the follow-
ing day ton dead men were counted lying where they
fell; among them was Seriff Mahomed, the bearer of
the flag of truce, who, though offered our protection,
fought to the last, and in the agonies of death threw a
spear at his advancing foes.
" The remnant of the enemy retired to Bungun ; and
it will be some time before we learn their real loss and po-
sition. It is needless here to say any thing on the political
effects to be expected from the establishment of a gov-
ernment in Bruni, and the destruction of this worst of
piratical communities. When I return to Bruni, and
see how measures advance, I may mention the subject
again ; but I will venture here to reurge, that mere mil-
itary force, however necessary, can not do what it is de-
sirable should be done. Supervision and conciliation
must go hand in hand with punishment ; and we must
watch that the snake does not again rear his head through
our neglect. The key-stone is wanting as yet, and must
be supplied if possible ; we must, to back the gallant
deeds of the admiral and fleet, continue to pursue a
steady course of measures. In the evening returned to
the Vixen.
" 2lst. The morning quiet. After breakfast, under
weigh ; proceeded off the river Bankoka, where we
found the Cruiser at anchor. As there was nothing to
detain us, crossed over to the squadron remained an
hour aboard Agincourt ; then rejoined Sir Thomas Coch-
rane aboard Vixen, and before dinner-time were at an-
chor in the northeast side of Balambangan. Our wom-
an prisoner doing well, and pleased with the attention
paid her.
" 23d. Southwestern harbor of Balambangan. Yes-
terday examined the N.E. harbor; a dreary-looking
place, sandy and mangrovy, and the harbor itself filled
with coral patches ; here the remains of our former set-
tlement were found : it is a melancholy and ineligible
spot. The s.w. harbor is very narrow and cramped, with
no fitting site for a town, on account of the rugged and
unequal nature of the ground ; and if the town were
EXPEDITION TU BORNEO.
crammed in between two eminences, it would be de-
prived of all free circulation of air. Water is, I hear, in
sufficient quantity, and good. On the whole, I am
wretchedly disappointed with this island ; it has one, and
only one recommendation, viz., that it is well situated in
the Straits for trading and political purposes ; in every
other requisite it is inferior to Labuau. Balambangan
is commercially and politically well placed. Labinin,
though inferior, is not greatly inferior in these points :
the harbor, the aspect, the soil, are superior : it may
probably be added, that the climate is superior likewise ;
and we must remember that those who had an opportu-
nity of trying both places give the preference to Labuan.
"Then, on other points, Labuau has a clear advan-
tage. It commands the coal ; it is in the vicinity of a
friendly people, and settlement may be formed with cer-
tainty and at a moderate expense, and with small estab-
lishments. Can this be done at Balambangan ? I own
I doubt it ; the people in the vicinity we know nothing
of, but we shall find them, in all probability, hostile. The
Sooloos we are already too well acquainted with. The
lllanuns are in the vicinity. In the case of Labuan, the
details of the first establishment (no small step) can be
clearly seen and arranged ; but I do not see my way re-
garding Balambangan. The matter is of secondary im-
portance, but a languishing settlement at first is to be
dreaded ; food will be scarce, and houses difficult to
ouild ; while at Labuan the population of Bruni are at.
our disposal, and the government our own. I leave oth-
ers to judge whether a superior (but somewhat similar)
position, commercially and politically, will outweigh the
other disadvantages mentioned, and repay us for the ex-
tra expenses of the establishment ; but, for myself, I can
give a clear verdict in favor of Labuan.
" 24th. Buried poor Mr. East, of the Agincourt, on
Balambangan. Gibbard, poor, gallant fellow, was con-
signed to the deep a day or two before.
" 25th. A day of disaster and parting : the morning
blowy, with an unpleasant sea. Vestal ran ashore on a
coral-patch, but soon swung off. I was very sorry to
part with the Agincourt. Farewell, gallant Agincourl s !
farewell, kind admiral ! farewell, the" pride, pomp, mid
EXPEDITION TO HORNEO.
panoply of a flag-ship liner ! My occupation's over fpr
the present, and I retire with content to solitude and the
jungle of Sarawak. I step down the huge side, wave a
parting adieu, jump on the Cruiser's deck the anchor
is weighed, and away we fly.
" 30^. Coming down in her majesty's ship Cruiser,
and now off Ujong Sapo. On our passage we had some
good views of Kina Balow, and from various points ;
judging the distance by the chart, the angle of elevation
gives the mountain not less than 12,000 feet and up to
14,000 ; the latter result agreeing with the computation
of the master of the Daedalus.
" 31st. Started for Bruni, and half way met a boat
with Pangeran Illudeen, bringing the news of the place.
Two days after the admiral and his steamers left, Pan-
geran Usop seized the hill behind his late house with
300 Kadiens, and commenced an attack on the town.
Pangeran Budrudeen on this mustered about the like
number and mounted the hill, and by a fire of musketry
dislodged the enemy, who retired, stood again, were
again defeated, and finally dispersed. This victory
raised the courage of the Brunions, and a counter-attack
was planned, when the arrival of her majesty's ship Es-
piegle delayed them. As the officers of the Espiegle
and the rajah could not speak a word of each other's lan-
guage, the boat only stayed a few hours, and went away
in ignorance of the condition of the town. After her de-
parture, Budrudeen gathered about a thousand men of
all arms, with some hundred muskets ; and leaving Bru-
ni at three o'clock in the morning, reached the landing-
place at 6 A.M., and at eight marched for Barukas, where
they arrived at one o'clock. On the way the Kadiens
humbled themselves, and begged their houses might bo
spared, which were spared accordingly. On reaching
Barukas, they found Pangeran Usop had been deserted
by the Kadiens, and was in no way expecting their com-
ing. The few persons who remained fled ignominious-
ly, Pangeran Usop showing them the example ; and his
women, children, gold, and other property, fell into the
hands of his victors. The same evening Budrudeen re-
turned to the city in triumph ; and there can be no doubt
tlics:- vigorous measures have not only settled them in
EK
326 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
power, but have likewise raised the spirits of their ad-
herents, and awed the few who remain adverse. * Nev-
er,' the Brunions exclaim, ' was such a war in Bruni.
Pangeran Budrudeen fights like a European; the very
spirit of the Englishman is in him ; he has learned this
at Sarawak.' Fortune favored Usop's escape. He fled
to the sea-shore near Pulo Badukan, and there met a
boat of his entering from Kimanis : he took possession
and put out to sea, and returned with her to that place.
" Budrudeen we found in active preparation for pur-
suit. A dozen war-prahus were nearly ready for sea,
and this force starts directly we depart.
"Budrudeen's vigor has given a stimulus to this un-
warlike people, and he has gained so great a character
victory sits so lightly on his plume that his authority
will now be obeyed ; while Usop, in consequence of his
cowardly flight (for so they deem it), from the want of
energy he has displayed, has lost character as well as
wealth, and would scarce find ten men in Bruni to follow
him. Unluckily for himself, he was a great boaster in
the days of his prosperity ; and now the contrast of his
past boasting with his present cowardice is drawn with
a sneer. 'His mouth was brave,' they exclaim, 'but
hie heart timid.' ' He should have died as other great
men have died, and not have received such shame ; he
should have amoked,* or else given himself up for exe-
cution.' This seems to be the general impression in the
city.
" My mind is now at rest about the fate of my friends ;
but I still consider a man-of-war brig coming here every
month or two as of great importance ; for it will be nec-
essary for the next six months to consolidate the power
of Muda Hassim and Budrudeen ; and if, with the new
oi-der of things, they constantly see white faces, and find
that they are quiet and inoffensive, the ignorant terror
which now prevails will abate. Besides this, we might
find the opportunity a favorable one for becoming ac-
quainted with the Kadiens and the Marats, and giving
them just impressions of ourselves ; for I have no doubt
that on the late occasion the Kadiens were worked upoji
* Anglice, run-a-muck.
EXPEDITION TO BOUNiio. 327
by all kinds of false reports of the pale faces taking their
lands, burning their houses, &c., &c., &c. We only
see the effects ; we do not see (until we become very
well acquainted with them) the strings which move the
passions of these people. The Kadiens are, however,
an unwarlike and gentle race, and have now given in
their submission to Muda Hassim. I do not mention
the sultan, because, as I before said, he is so imbecile
that, as regards public affairs, he is a cipher : he will
some day cease to be sultan, and give pkce to a better
man.
" Our interview with the rajah, with Budrudeen, and
all the other host of our acquaintance, was quite a tri-
umph they hot with their success, and we bringing the
account of Malludu's sanguinary fight. Happy faces
and wreathed smiles supplied the place of the anxious
and doubtful expression which I had left them wearing.
All vied in their attentions ; fruit enough to fill a room :
the luscious durian, the delicate mangosteen and lousch,
the grateful rombusteen, the baluna, pitabu, mowha,
plantain, &c., &c., were showered upon us from all quar-
ters. The rajah daily sent a dinner ; all was rejoicing,
and few or no clouds lowered in the distance. I was
proud and happy ; for I felt and feel that much of this
has been owing to my exertions. I will not stop to say
how or why ; but I first taught them to respect and to
confide in Englishmen, and no one else has yet untaught
them this lesson.
" September 3d. After parting interviews we quitted
the city at two, and arrived aboard her majesty's ship
cruiser at eight P.M. To-morrow morning we sail for
Sarawak, where, at any rate, I hope for rest for a month
or two.
" ISth. Sarawak. Thus concludes a large volume.
Captain Bethune and myself, with Commander Fan-
shawe and a party of Cruisers, returned from a five days'
excursion among the Dyaks, having visited the Suntah,
Stang, Sigo, and Sanpro tribes. It was a progress ; at
each tribe there was dancing, and a number of cere-
monies. White fowls were waved as I have before
described, slaughtered, and the blood mixed with kuny-
!t,. a yellow root, &c., &c., which delightful mixture was
328 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
freely scattered over them and their goods by me, hold-
ing in my hand a dozen or two women's necklaces. Cap-
tain Bethune has seen and can appreciate the Dyaks :
to-morrow he leaves me, and most sorry shall I be to
lose him. A better man or a better public servant is
not to be found.
"Among my Dyak inquiries, I found out that the
name of their god is Tuppa, and not Jovata, which they
before gave me, and which they use, but do not ac-
knowledge. Tuppa is the great god ; eight other gods
were in heaven ; one fell or descended into Java seven
remained above ; one of these is named Sakarra, who,
with his companions and followers, is (or is in) the con-
stellation of a cluster of stars, doubtless the Pleiades ;
and by the position of this constellation the Dyaks can
judge good and bad fortune. If this cluster of stars be
high in the heavens, success will attend the Dyak ; when
it sinks below the horizon, ill luck follows ; fruit and
crops will not ripen ; war and famine are dreaded.
Probably originally this was but a simple and natural di-
vision of the seasons, which has now become a gross su-
perstition.
" The progress is ended ; to-morrow I shall be left in
the solitude and the quiet of the jangle : but, after wit-
nessing the happiness, the plenty, the growing prosperity
of the Dyak tribes, I can scarcely believe that I could
devote my life to better purpose, and I dread that a re-
moval might destroy what I have already done.
" We must now wait the decision of government with
patience. Captain Be'thune, in making his report, will
have the advantage of real substantial personal knowl-
edge. I esteem him highly, and regard him as a man
of the most upright principles, who is not, and will not
be swayed in his duty by any considerations whatever.
I am glad we are to stand the ordeal of such a man's in-
quiry."
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 329
CHAPTER XXIII.
Borneo, its geographical bounds and leading divisions. British
settlements in 1775. The province of Sarawak formally ceded
by the sultan in perpetuity to Mr. Brooke its present ruler.
General view of the Dyaks, the aborigines of Borneo. The
Dyaks of Sarawak, and adjoining tribes ; their past oppression
and present position.
I WILL now endeavor to make the reader better ac-
quainted with the nature of a countiy and people so
imperfectly known, by offering that general view of its
past events and present condition which will make the
information respecting them more intelligible, as well as
applicable to new circumstances and future measures.
By looking at the map, it will be seen that the island
of Borneo extends over 11 degrees of latitude and as
many of longitude, from 4 N. to 7 S., and 108 to
119 E. The N.W. coast is but thinly populated ; and
the natives who inhabit the banks of some of the beauti-
ful rivers differ, as has been already stated, from each
other in manners and customs, and have but little com-
munication among themselves. The S., E., and N.E.
coasts of Borneo are also but thinly inhabited, and very
little known. There are various divisions of Malays, as
well as different tribes of Dyaks, who live in an unset-
tled state, and occasionally make war on one another:
their principal occupation, however, is piracy. The
north part of the island was once in the possession of
the East India Company, who had a settlement and
factory on the island of Balambangan, which was at-
tacked in 1775, when in a weak and unguarded state,
by a powerful piratical tribe of Sooloos, who surprised
the fort, put the sentries to death, and turned the guns
on the troops, who were chiefly Buguese (or Bugis)
Malays. Those who escaped got on board the vessels
in the harbor, and reached the island of Labuan, near
the mouth of the Borneo river; while the booty ob-
tained by the pirates was estimated at 375,OOOZ. From
that time to this these atrocious pirates have never been
punished, and still continue their depredations.
The remainder of the coast on the N.W. is now called
E E3
330 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
Borneo Proper, to distinguish it from the name that
custom has given to the whole island, the original name
of which was Kalamantan, and Bruni that of the town
now called Borneo. The latter was probably the first
part of the coast ever visited by Europeans, who conse-
quently extended the appellation to the island itself.
The town of Borneo, situated on the river of that name,
was, until the last few years, a port of some wealth, and
carrying on an extensive trade, which has been ruined
entirely by the rapacity of the Malay chiefs, who have
now but little control over that part of Borneo Proper
which lies to the northward of the river. The province
of Sarawak is situated at the S.W. end of Borneo Proper,
and was formally ceded in perpetuity by the sultan in
1843 to Mr. Brooke, who, indeed, had possessed the al-
most entire management of the district for the two pre-
vious years. " It extends from Tanjong Datu (I quote
from Mr. Brooke's description of his territory) to the
entrance of the Samarahan river, a distance along the
coast of about sixty miles in an E.S.E. direction, with an
average breadth of fifty miles. It is bounded to the
westward by the Sambas territory, to the southward
by a range of mountains which separate it from the
Pontiana river, and to the eastward by the Borneon
territory of Sadong. Within this space there are sev-
eral rivers and islands, which it is needless here to
describe at length, as the account of the river of Sara-
wak will answer alike for the rest. There are two
navigable entrances to this river, and numerous smaller
branches for boats, both to the westward and eastward ;
the two principal entrances combine at about twelve
miles from the sea, and the river flows for twenty miles
into the interior in a southerly and westerly direction,
when it again forms two branches one running to the
right, the other to the left hand, as far as the mountain
range. Beside these facilities for water-communica-
tion, there exist three other branches from the eastern-
most entrance, called Morotaba, one of which joins the
Samarahan river, and the two others flow from differ-
ent points of the mountain range already mentioned.
The country is diversified by detached mountains, and
the mountain range has an elevation of about three
TO UMKM:<>. MUl
thousand feet. The aspect of the country may be gen-
erally described as low and woody at the entrance of
the rivers, except a few high mountains ; but in the
interior undulating in parts, and part presenting fine
level plains. The climate may be pronounced healthy
and cool, though for the six months from September to
March a great quantity of rain falls. During my three
visits to this place, which have been prolonged to eight
months, and since residing here, we have been clear of
sickness, and during the entire period not one of three
deaths could be attributed to the effects of climate.
The more serious maladies of tropical climates are very
infrequent; from fever and dysentery we have been
quite free, and the only complaints have been rheuma-
tism, colds, and ague ; the latter, however, attacked us
in the interior, and no one has yet had it at Sarawak,
which is situated about twenty-five miles from the
mouth of the river.
" The soil and productions of this countiy are of the
richest description, and it is not too much to say, that,
within the same given space, there are not to be found
the same mineral and vegetable riches in any land in
the world. I propose to give a brief detail of them, be-
ginning with the soil of the plains, which is moist and
rich, and calculated for the growth of rice, for which
purpose it was formerly cleared and used, until the dis-
tractions of the country commenced. From the known
industry of the Dyaks, and their partiality to rice-cul-
tivation, there can be little doubt that it would become
an article of extensive export, provided security were
given to the cultivator and a proper remuneration for
his produce. The lower grounds, beside rice, are well
adapted for the growth of sago, and produce canes, rat-
tans, and forest-timber of the finest description for ship-
building and other useful purposes. The Chinese ex-
port considerable quantities of timber from Sambas and
Pontiana, particularly of the kind called Balean by the
natives, or the lion-wood of the Europeans ; and at this
place it is to be had in far greater quantity and nearer
the place of sale. The undulating ground differs in
soil, some portions of it being a yellowish clay, while
the rest is a rich mold ; these grounds, generally
33^ EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
speaking, as well as the slopes of the higher mountains,
are admirably calculated for the growth of nutmegs,
coffee, pepper, or any of the more valuable vegetable
productions of the tropics. Beside the above men-
tioned articles, there are birds' -nests, bees-wax, and
several kinds of scented wood, in demand at Singapore,
which are all collected by the Dyaks, and would be
gathered in far greater quantity provided the Dyak was
allowed to sell them.
" Turning from the vegetable to the mineral riches
of the country, we have diamonds, gold, tin, iron, and
antimony ore certain ; I have lately sent what I believe
to be a specimen of lead ore to Calcutta ; and copper is
reported. It must be remembered, in reading this list,
that the country is as yet unexplored by a scientific
person, and that the inquiries of a geologist and a mine-
ralogist would throw further light on the minerals of
the mountains, and the spots where they are to be
found in the greatest plenty. The diamonds are stated
to be found in considerable numbers, and of a good
water; and I judge the statement to be correct from
the fact that the diamond-workers from Sandak come
here and work secretly, and the people from Banja-
massim, who are likewise clever at this trade, are most
desirous to be allowed to work for the precious stone.
Gold of a good quality certainly is to be found in large
quantities. The eagerness and perseverance of the
Chinese to establish themselves is a convincing proof of
the fact ; and ten years since a body of about 3000 of
them had great success in procuring gold by their
ordinary mode of trenching the ground.
" The quantity of gold yearly procured at Sambas is
moderately stated at 130,000 bunkals, which, reckoned
at the low rate of 20 Spanish dollars a bunkal, gives
2,600,000 Spanish dollars, or upward of half a million
sterling. The most intelligent Chinese are of opinion,
that the quantity here exceeds that at Sambas ; and
there is no good reason to suppose it would fall short
of it were once a sufficient Chinese population settled
in the country.
" Antimony ore is a staple commodity, which is to be
procured in any quantity. Tin is said to bo plentiful,
1:\1'K1>1TION TO BORNEO. 333
nud the Chinese propose working it; but I have had
no opportunity of visiting the spot where it is found.
Copper, though reported, has not been brought; and
the iron ore I have examined is of inferior quality.
The specimen of what I supposed to be lead ore has
been forwarded to Calcutta, and it remains to be seen
what its value may be. And beside the above-men-
tioned minerals, there can be little doubt of many others
being discovered, if the mountain range was properly
explored by any man of science. Many other articles
of minor importance might be mentioned ; but it is
needless to add to a list which contains articles of such
value, and which would prove the countiy equal in
vegetable and mineral productions to any in the world.
" From the productions (continues Mr. Brooke) I
turn to the inhabitants, and I feel sure that in describing
their sufferings and miseries I shall command the in-
terest and sympathy of every person of humanity, and
that the claims of the virtuous and most unhappy JDyaks
will meet with the same attention as those of the Af-
rican. And these claims have the advantage, that
much good may be done without the vast expenditure
of lives and money which the exertions on the African
coast yearly demand, and that the people would readily
appreciate the good that was conferred upon thenij and
rapidly rise in the scale of civilization."
The inhabitants may be divided into three different
classes, viz? the Malays, the Chinese, and the Dyaks ;
of the two former little need be said, as they are so
well known.
The Dyaks (or more properly Dyak) of Borneo offer
to our view a primitive state of society ; and their near
resemblance to the Tarajahs of Celebes,* to the inland
people of Sumatra, and probably to the Arafuras ol
Papua,f in customs, manners, and language, affords
* See Prichard's Researches, 1 826, which, meager as they must
have been from the want of data, tell us in two or three pages
nearly all we know on the subject. That able investigator states
that the Dyaks of Borneo resemble the Taraj of Celebes.
t With regard to the Arafuras, or Haraforas, it is stated that
they are termed in some districts Idaan, in others Murut, and in
others Dayaks. See Raffles' Java. And Leyden assures us that
all these varieties were originally called Idaan.
334 TO
reason for the conclusion that these are the aboriginal
race of the Eastern Archipelago, nearly stationary in
their original condition. While successive waves of
civilization have swept onward the rest of the inhab-
itants, while tribes as wild have arisen to power, flour-
ished, and decayed, the Dyak in his native jungles still
retains the feelings of earlier times, and shows the
features of society as it existed before the influx of
foreign races either improved or corrupted the native
character.
The name " Dyak" has been indiscriminately applied
to all the wild people cm the island of Borneo ; but as
the term is never so used by themselves, and as they
differ greatly, not only in name, but in their customs
and manners, we will briefly, in the first instance, men-
tion the various distinct nations, the general locality of
each, and some of their distinguishing peculiarities.
1st. The Dusun, or villagers of the northern extrem-
ity of the island, are a race of which Mr. Brooke knows
nothing personally ; but the name implies that they are
an agricultural people : they are represented as not
being tattooed, as using the sumpitan, and as having a
peculiar dialect.*
2d. The Murut. They inhabit the interior of Borneo
Proper. They are not tattooed, always use the sumpi-
tan, and have a peculiar dialect. In the same locality,
and resembling the Murut, are some tribes called the
Basaya.
3d. The Kadians (or Idaans of voyagers) use the
sumpitan, and have likewise a peculiar dialect ; but in
other respects they nowise differ from the Borneons,
either in religion, dress, or mode of life. They are,
however, an industrious, peaceful people, who cultivate
the ground in the vicinity of Borneo Proper, and nearly
as far as Tanjong Barram. The wretched capital is
greatly dependent upon them, and, from their numbers
and industry, they form a valuable population. In the
interior, and on the Balyet liver, which discharges itself
* A singular contrast to preceding accounts, which represent
the north and northeastern population not only as pirates, called
Tiran or Zedong, but even as cannibals. Near them there ap-
pear to be the piratir:il n< sts of Mapindanp, Sooloo, &c.
.(EDITION TO IlOltNEO.
near Tanjong BaiTam, is a race likewise called Kadian,
not converted to Islam, and which still retains the prac-
tice of " taking heads."
4th. The Kayan. The Kayans are the most numer-
ous, the most powerful, and the most warlike people iu
Borneo. They are an inland race, and their locality
extends from about sixty miles up the country from
Tanjong Barram to the same extent farther into the
interior, in latitude 3 30' N., and thence across the island
to probably a similar distance from the eastern shore.
Their customs, manners, and dress are peculiar, and
present most of the characteristic features of a wild and
independent people. The Malays of the N.W. coast fear
the Kayans, and rarely enter their country; but the
Millanows are familiar with them, and there have thence
been obtained many particulars respecting them They
are represented as extremely hospitable, generous, and
kind to strangers, strictly faithful to their word, and
honest in their dealings ; but on the other hand, they
are fierce and bloodthirsty, and when on an expedition,
slaughter without sparing. The Kayans are partially
tattooed, use the sumpitan, have many dialects, and are
remarkable for the strange and apparently mutilating
custom adopted by the males, and mentioned by Sir
Stamford Raffles.
5th. To the southward and westward of Barram are
the Millanows,* who inhabit the rivers not far from the
sea. They are, generally speaking, an intelligent, in-
dustrious, and active race, the principal cultivators of
sago, and gatherers of the famous camphor barus. Their
locality extends from Tanjong Barram to Tanjong Sirak.
In person they are stout and well-made, of middling
height, round good-tempered countenances, and fairer
than the Malays. They have several dialects among
them, use the sumpitan, and are not tattooed. They
retain the practice of taking heads, but they seldom seek
them, and have little of the ferocity of the Kayan.
* There are several rivers, Meri, Bentulu, &c., the inhabitants
of which, says Mr. Brooke, I class under the general term Milla
now, as their dialects show a very close connection, and their
habits are the same. Evidently from language they are civilized
t ribee of Kayans.
336 KXPE1HT1ON TO BURM-O.
6th. In the vicinity of the Kayans and Millanows are
some wild tribes, called the Tatows, Balanian, Kanow-
it, &c. They are probably only a branch of Kayans,
though differing from them in being elaborately tattooed
over the entire body. They have peculiar dialects, use
the sumpitan, and are a wild and fierce people.
7th. The Dyak. They are divided into Dyak Dar-
rat and Dyak Laut, or land and sea Dyaks. The Dyak
Lauts, as their name implies, frequent the sea; and it
is needless to say much of them, as their difference
from the Dyak Darrat is a difference of circumstances
only. The tribes of Sarebus and Sakarran, whose rivers
are situated in the deep bay between Tanjong Sipang
and Tanjong Sirak, are powerful communities, and
dreadful pirates, who ravage the coast in large fleets,
and murder and rob indiscriminately ; but this is by no
means to be esteemed a standard of Dyak character.
In these expeditions the Malays often join them, and
they are likewise made the instruments for oppressing
the Laut tribes. The Sarebus and Sakarran are fine
men, fairer than the Malays, with sharp keen eyes,
thin lips, and handsome countenances, though frequently
marked by an expression of cunning. The Balows and
Sibnowans are amiable tribes, decidedly warlike, but
not predatory ; and the latter combines the virtues ot
the Dyak character with much of the civilization of the
Malays. The Dyak Laut do not tattoo, nor do they
use the sumpitan ; their language assimilates closely to
the Malay, and was doubtless originally identical with
that of the inland tribes. The name of God among
them is Battara (the Avatara of the Hindoos). They
buiy their dead, and in the graves deposit a large por-
tion of the property of the deceased, often to a consid-
erable value in gold ornaments, brass guns, jars, and
arms. Their marriage ceremony consists in two fowls
being killed, and the forehead and breast of the young
couple being touched with the blood ; after which the
chief, or an old man, knocks their heads together several
times, and the ceremony is completed with mirth and
feasting. In these two instances they differ from the
Dyak Darrat.
Ft must 1)0 observed that the Dyak also differs from
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 387
the Kayan in not being tattooed ; and from tho Kayan
Millanows, &c., in not using the national weapon the
sumpitan. The Kayan and the Dyak, as general dis-
tinctions, though they differ in dialect, in dress, in
weapons, and probably in religion, agree in their belief
of similar omens, and, above all, in their practice of taking
the heads of their enemies ; but with the Kayan this
practice assumes the aspect of an indiscriminate desire
of slaughter, while with the Dyak it is but the trophy
acquired in legitimate warfare. The Kadians form the
only exception to this rule, in consequence of their con-
version to Islam; and it is but reasonable to suppose,
that with a slight exertion in favor of Christianity,
others might be induced to Jay aside this barbarous
custom.
With respect to the dialects, though the difference is
considerable, they are evidently derived from a common
source ; but it is remarkable that some words in the
Millanow and Kayan are similar to the Bugis and Bad-
jow language. This intermixture of dialects, which
can be linked together, appears to be more conclusive
of the common origin of the wild tribes and civilized na-
tions of the Archipelago than most other arguments ;
and if Marsden's position be correct (which there can
be little or no reason to doubt), that the Polynesian is
an original race with an original language,* it must like-
wise be conceded that the wild tribes represent the
primitive state of society in these islands.
We know little of the wild tribes of Celebes beyond
their general resemblance to the Kayans of the east coast
of Borneo ; and it is probable that the Kayans are the
people of Celebes, who crossing the Strait of Makassar,
have in time by their superior prowess possessed them-
selves of the country of the Dyaks. Mr. Brooke (from
whom I am copying this sketch) is led to entertain this
opinion from a slight resemblance in their dialects with
those used in Celebes, from the difference in so many
of their customs from those of the Dyaks, and from the
Kayans of the northwest coast of Borneo having one
* Leyden concluded that the language was allied to the Batta
and Tagala, and the whole derived from and varieties of the
primitive tongue of the' Philippine Islands.
22 FF
338 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO,
custom in common with the wild tribe of Minkoka ia
the Bay of Boni. Both the Kayans and Minkokas on
the death of a relative seek for a head; and; on the
death of their chief many human heads must be pro-
cured : which practice is unknown to the Dyak. It
may further be remarked, that their probable immigra-
tion from Celebes is supported by the statement of the
Millanows, that the Murut and Dyak give place to the
Rayan whenever they come in contact, and that the
latter people have depopulated large tracts in the rate-
rior, which were once occupied by the former.
Having thus briefly noticed the different wild people
of the island, I proceed with the more particular task of
describing the Dyak Darrats.
The locality of these Dyaks may be marked as fol-
lows : The Pontiana river, from its mouth, is traced
into the interior toward the northward and westward,
until it approaches at the farthest within 100 miles of
the northwest coast ; a line drawn in latitude 3 N. till it
intersects the course of the Pontiana river will point out
the limit of the country inhabited by the Dyak. Within
this inconsiderable portion of the island, which includes
Sambas, Landak, Pontiana, Saugow, Sarawak, &c., are
numerous tribes, all of which agree in their leading cus-
toms, and make use of nearly the same dialect. Per-
sonally (writes our sole authority for any intelligence
respecting them), I am acquainted only with the tribes-
of Sarawak and some tribes further in the interior be-
yond the government of the Malays, who inhabit the
country between Sarawak and Landak ; and the de-
scription of one tribe will servo as a description of all,
so little do they vary.
Before, however, I say anything of the character of
the Dyaks, or their temper, it will be necessary to de-
scribe briefly the government under which they live, and
the influence it has upon them ; and if afterward in the
recital there appear some unarniable points in thoir
character, an allowance will bo made for their failings,
which those who rule them would not deserve.
The Dyaks have from time immemorial been looked
upon us the bomlsnien of the Malays, and the rajahf*
ronsiflor them much i;> tlu> >-;mu> li.'jli*: 11* 1 h<-v \vould o
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 339
drove of oxeii i. e. as personal and disposable property.
They were governed in Sarawak by three local officers,
called the Patingi, the Bandar, and the Tumangong. To
the Patingi they paid a small yearly revenue of rice, but
this deficiency of revenue was made up by sending them
a quantity of goods chiefly salt, Dyak cloths, and iron
and demanding a price for them six or eight times more
than their value. The produce collected by the Dyaks
was also monopolized, and the edible birds'-nests, bees-
wax, &c. &c. were taken at a price fixed by the Patingi,
who moreover claimed mats, fowls, fruits, and every other
necessary at his pleasure, and could likewise make the
Dyaks work for him for merely a nominal remuneration.
This system, not badly devised, had it been limited within
the bounds of moderation, would have left the Dyaks
plenty for all their wants ; or had the local officers
known their own interest, they would have protected
those upon whom they depended for revenue, and under
the worst oppression of one man the Dyaks would have
deemed themselves happy. Such unfortunately was
not the case ; for the love of immediate gain overcame
every other consideration, and by degrees old-established
customs were thrown aside, and new ones substituted in
their place. When the Patingi had received all he
thought proper to extort, his relatives first claimed the
right of arbitrary trade, and gradually it was extended as
the privilege of every respectable person in the country
to serra* the Dyaks. The poor Dyak, thus at the mercy
of half the Malay population, was never allowed to refuse
compliance with these demands ; he could plead neither
poverty, inability, nor even hunger, as an excuse, for
the answer was ever ready : " Give me your wife or
one of your children;" andin case he could not supply
what ws required, the wife or the child was taken, and
became a slave. Many modes of extortion were resorted
to ; a favorite one was convicting the Dyak of a fault and
imposing a fine upon him. Some ingenuity and much
trickery were shown in this game, and new offences
were invented as soon as the old pleas would serve no
longer ; for instance, if a Malay met a Dyak in a boat
* Probably a Dyak phrase for levying exactions on the op-
pressed people. It is not Malay.
340 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
which pleased him, he notched it, as a token that it was
his property ; in one day, if the boat was a new one,
perhaps three or more would place their marks on it ;
and as only one could get it, the Dyak to whom the boat
really belonged had to pay the others for his fault. This,
however, was only " a fault ;" whereas, for a Dyak to
injure a Malay, directly or indirectly, purposely or oth-
erwise, was a high offence, and punished by a propor-
tionate fine. If a Dyak's house was in bad repair, and
a Malay fell in consequence and was hurt, or pretended
to be hurt, a fine was imposed ; if a Malay in the jungle
was wounded by the springs set for a wild boar, or by
the wooden spikes which the Dyaks for protection put
about their village, or scratched himself and said he was
injured, the penalty was heavy ; if the Malay was really
hurt, ever so accidentally, it was the ruin of the Dyak.
A.nd these numerous and uninvited guests came and
went at pleasure, lived in free quarters, made their
requisitions, and then forced the Dyak to carry away
for them the very property of which he had been
robbed.
This is a fair picture of the governments under which
the Dyaks live ; and although they were often roused to
resistance, it was always fruitless, and only involved thorn
in deeper troubles ; for the Malays could quickly gather a
large force of sea Dyaks from Sakarran, who were read-
ily attracted by hope of plunder, and who, supported by
the fire-arms of their allies, w T ere certain to overcome
any single tribe that held out. The misfortunes of the
Dyaks of Sarawak did not stop here. Antimony ore
was discovered ; the cupidity of the Borneons was roused ;
then Pangerans struggled for the prize ; intrigues and
dissensions ensued ; and the inhabitants of Sarawak in
turn felt the veiy evil they had inflicted on the Dyaks ;
while the Dyaks were compelled, amid their other
wrongs, to labor at the ore without any recompense, and
to the neglect of their rice-cultivation. Many died in
consequence of this compulsory labor, so contrary t<
their habits and inclinations; and more would doubt !<:-*
have fallen victims, hud not civil war rescued them from
this ovil. to inflict upon them others a thousand times
worse.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 341
Extortion had before been carried on by individuals,
but now it was systematized ; and Pangerans of rank,
for the sake of plunder, sent bodies of Malays nnd
Sakarrau Dyaks to attack the different tribes. The
men were slaughtered, the women and children carried
off into slavery, the villages burned, the fruit-trees cut
down,* and all their property destroyed or seized.
The Dyaks could no longer live in tribes, but sought
refuge in the mountains or the jungle, a few together;
and as one of them pathetically described it " We do
not live," he said, " like men ; we are like monkeys ;
we are hunted from place to place ; we have no houses ;
and when we light a fire, we fear the smoke will draw
our enemies upon us."
In the course of ten years, under the circumstances
detailed from enforced labor, from famine, from slavery,
from sickness, from the sword one half of the Dyak
populationf disappeared ; and the work of extirpation
would have gone on at an accelerated pace, had the
remnant been left to the tender mercies of the Pange-
rans ; but chance (we may much more truly say Provi-
* The utter destruction of a village or town is nothing to the
infliction of cutting down the fruit-trees. The former can be
rebuilt, with its rude and ready materials, in a few weeks ; but
the latter, from which the principal subsistence of the natives is
gathered, cannot be suddenly restored, and thus they are reduced
to starvation.
t The grounds for this opinion are an estimate personally made
among the tribes, compared with the estimate kept by the local
officers before the disturbance arose ; and the result is, that only
two out of twenty tribes have not suffered, while some tribes have
been reduced from 330 families to 50 ; about ten tribes have lost
more than half their number ; one tribe of 100 families has lost
all its women and children made slaves ; and one tribe, more
wretched, has been reduced from 120 families to 2, that is, 10
persons ; while two tribes have entirely disappeared. The list of
the tribes and their numbers formerly and now are as follows :
Suntah, 330 50; Sanpro, 10069; Sigo, 8028; Sabungo, GO
33; Brang, 50 22; Sinnar, 80 34; Stang, 80 30 ; Samban,
6034 ; Tubbia, 8030 ; Goon, 4025 ; Bang, 4012 ; Kuj-juss,
350 ; Lundu, 802 ; Sow, 200100 ; Sarambo, 10060 ; Bom-
bak, 3535 ; Paninjow, 8040 ; Singe, 220220 ; Pons, 200;
Sibaduh, 2525. Total, formerly, 1795 now, 849 families ; and
reckoning eight persons to each family, the amount of population
will be, formerly, 14,360 now, 6792 : giving a decrease of popu-
lation in ten years of 846 families, or 7568 persons !
FF2
,'jl^- KXl'KIUTIMN TD HOUM
dence) led our countryman Mr. Brooke to this scene ot
misery, and enabled him, by circumstances far removed
beyond the grounds of calculation, to put a stop to the
sufferings of an amiable people.
There are twenty tribes in Sarawak, on about fifty
square miles of land. The appearance of the Dyaks is
prepossessing: they have good-natured faces, with a
mild and subdued expression ; eyes set far apart, and
features sometimes well formed. In person they are
active, of middling height, and not distinguishable from
the Malays in complexion. The women are neither so
good-looking nor well-formed as the men, but they have
the same expression, and are cheerful and kind-tem-
pered. The dress of the men consists of a piece of
cloth about fifteen feet long, passed between the legs
and fastened round the loins, with the ends hanging be-
fore and behind ; the head-dress is composed of bark-
cloth, dyed bright yellow, and stuck up in front so as to
resemble a tuft of feathers. The arms and legs are
often ornamented with rings of silver, brass, or shell ;
and necklaces are worn, made of human teeth, or those
of bears or dogs, or of white beads, in such numerous
strings as to conceal the throat. A sword on one side,
a knife and small betel-basket on the other, complete
the ordinary equipment of the males ; but when they
travel they cany a basket slung from the forehead, on
which is a palm-mat, to protect the owner and his
property from the weather. The women wear a short
and scanty petticoat, reaching from the loins to the
knees, and a pair of black bamboo stays, which are never
removed except the wearer be enceinte. They have
rings of brass or red bamboo about the loins, and some-
times ornaments on the arms ; the hair is worn long ;
the ears of both sexes are pierced, and earrings of brass
inserted occasionally ; the teeth of the young people
are sometimes filed to a point and discolored, as they
say that " Dogs have white teeth." They frequently
dye their feet and hands of a bright red or yellow color ;
and the young people, like those of other countries, af-
fect a degree of finery and foppishness, while the elders
invariably lay aside all ornaments, as unfit for a wise
person or one advanced in ye;ir>.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 343
In character the Dyak is mild and tractable, hospitable
when he is well used, grateful for kindness, industrious,
honest, and simple; neither treacherous nor cunning,
and so truthful that the word of one of them might safely
be taken before the oath of half-a-dozen Borneons. In
their dealings they are very straightforward and correct,
and so trustworthy that they rarely attempt, even after
a lapse of years, to evade payment of a just debt. On
the reverse of this picture there is little unfavorable to
be said ; and the wonder is, they have learned so little
deceit or falsehood where the examples before them
have been so rife. The temper of the Dyak inclines to
be sullen ; and they oppose a dogged and stupid obstinacy
when set to a task which displeases them, and support
with immovable apathy torrents of abuse or entreaty.
They are likewise distrustful, fickle, apt to be led away,
and evasive in concealing the amount of their property ;
but these are the vices rather of situation than of char-
acter, for they have been taught by bitter experience
that their rulers set no limits to their exactions, and that
hiding is their only chance of retaining a portion of the
grain they have raised. They are, at the same time,
fully aware of the customs by which their ancestors
were governed, and are constantly appealing to them as
a rule of right, and frequently arguing with the Malay
on the subject. Upon these occasions they are silenced,
but not convinced ; and the Malay, while he evades or
bullies when it is needful, is sure to appeal to these
veiy much-abused customs whenever it serves his pur-
pose. The manners of the Dyaks with strangers are
reserved to an extent rarely seen among rude or half-
civilized people ; but on a better acquaintance (which is
not readily acquired), they are open and talkative, and,
when heated with their favorite beverage, lively, and
evincing more shrewdness and observation than they
have gained credit for possessing. Their ideas, as may
well be supposed, are very limited ; they reckon with
their fingers and toes, and few are clever enough to
count beyond twenty ; but when they repeat the opera-
tion, they record each twenty by making a knot on a
string.
Like other wild people, the slightest restraint is irk-
3 l-l CXl'KblTloX To litii:
sonic, and no temptation will induce them to slay long
from their i'avorite jungle. It is there they seek the
excitement of war, the pleasures of the chase, the la-
bors of the field, and the abundance of fruit in the rich
produce which assists in supporting their families. The
pathless jungle is endeared to them by every association
which influences the human mind, and they languish
when prevented from roaming there as inclination dic-
1 ate-s.
With reference to the gradual advance of the Dyaks,
Mr. Brooke observes in an early part of his journal :
" The peaceful and gentle aborigines how can I speak
too favorably of their improved condition ? These peo-
ple, who, a few years since, suffered every extreme of
misery from war, slavery, and starvation, are now com-
fortably lodged, and comparatively rich. A stranger
might now pass from village to village, and he would
receive their hospitality, and see their padi stored in
their houses. He would hear them proclaim their hap-
piness, and praise the white man as their friend and
protector. Since the death of Parembam, no Dyak of
Sarawak lost his life by violence, until a month since,
when two were cut, off by the Sakarran Dyaks. None
of the tribes have warred among themselves ; and I be-
lieve their war excursions to a distance in the interior
have been very few, and those undertaken by the Sar-
ambos. What punishment is sufficient for the wretch
who finds this state of things so baleful as to attempt to
destroy it? Yet such a wretch is Seriff Sahib. In do-
scribing the condition of the Dyaks, I do not say that it
is perfect, or that it may not be still further improved ;
but with people in their state of society innovations
ought not rashly or hastily to be made ; as the civilized
being ought constantly to bear in mind, that what is
clear to him is not clear to a savage ; that intended ben-
efits may be regarded as positive injuries; and that his
motives are not, and scarcely can be, appreciated ! The
greatest evil, perhaps, from which the Dyaks suffer, is
the influence of the Datus or chiefs ; but this influence
is never carried to oppression, and is only used to obtain
the expensive luxury of * birds'-nests' at a cheap rate.
In short, the Dyaks are happy and content; and their
1 ') BORNEO. 345
gradual development must now be left to the work of
time, aided by the gentlest persuasion, and advanced
(if attainable) by the education of their children."
The latest accounts from Sarawak describe the in-
creasing prosperity of that interesting settlement. Among
other recent intelligence I have heard from Mr. Brooke
that Seriff Sahib died of a broken heart, shortly after
his arrival at the Pontiana river.
CHAPTER XXIV.
Proposed British settlement on the northwest coast of Borneo,
and occupation of the island of Labuan. Governor Crawfurd's
opinions thereon.
THE establishment of a British settlement on the
northwest coast of Borneo, and the occupation of the
island of Labuan, are measures that have for some time
past been under consideration by her majesty's govern-
ment ; and I am courteously enabled to lay before my
readers the valuable opinions of Mr. Crawfurd (late
Governor of Singapore) on this subject :
" I am of opinion (Mr. Crawfurd writes) that a set-
tlement on the northwest coast of Borneo that is, at
a convenient point on the southern shore of the China
Sea would be highly advantageous to this country, as
a coal depot for steam navigation ; as a means of sup-
pressing Malayan piracy ; as a harbor of refuge for ships
disabled in the China Sea ; and finally, as a command-
ing position during a naval war.
" The island of Labuan has been pointed out for this
purpose ; and as far as our present limited knowledge
of it will allow me to judge, it appears to possess all the
necessary qualities for such a settlement.
" The requisite properties are, salubrity of climate,
a good harbor, a position in the track of steam-navigation,
conveniency of position for ships disabled in typhoons,
conveniency of position for our crjiisers during war, and
a locality strong and circumscribed by nature, so as to
be readily capable of cheap defence.
" Labuan lies in about 6 of north latitude, and con-
346 KXl'KUlTloX TO KOKNKO.
sequently the average heat will be about 83 of Fahren
heit; the utmost range of the thermometer will not
exceed ten degrees. In short, the year is a perpetual
hot summer. It is, at the same time, well ventilated by
both monsoons ; and being near twenty miles from the
marshy shores of the Borneo river, there is little ground
to apprehend that it will be found unhealthy, even if
those shores themselves had been ascertained to be so,
which, however, is not the case ; for, in proof of their
salubrity, it may be stated, that the town of Borneo is
healthy, although it stands, and has stood for centuries,
on the flooded banks of the river ; the houses being built
on posts, and chiefly accessible by boat.
" With respect to harbor, a most essential point, I do
not perceive that the island is indented by any bay or
inlet that would answer the purpose of one.* The
channel, however, which lies between it and the main-
land of Borneo is but seven miles broad, and will proba-
bly constitute a spacious and convenient harbor. The
name of the island itself, which means anchorage, I have
no doubt is derived from the place affording shelter to
native shipping, and those probably, in most cases, fleets
of pirate prahus. This channel is again further re-
stricted by four islets, and these, with four more lying
to the southwest, will afford shelter in the southwest or
mild monsoon ; protection is given in the northeast, the
severest monsoon, by Labuan itself: and I may add,
that the island is, by four degrees of latitude, beyond
the extreme southern limit of the typhoons of the Chi-
nese Sea.
" In the channel between Labuan and the main, or
rather between Labuan and the islets already mention-
ed, the soundings on the Admiralty chart show that ves-
sels drawing as much as eighteen feet water may anchor
within a mile of trie shore, and the largest vessels within
a mile and a half; a convenience for shipping which
greatly exceeds that of Singapore. One of the advan-
tages of Labuan will be that it will prove a port of refuse
for shipping disabled in the storms of the Chinese Se;m.
* Sir Edward Belcher has since surveyed Labuan in her majes-
ty's ship Samarang, and finding an excellent, harbor, named it
Victoria Bay. If. K.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 347
Muny examples, indeed some of recent occurrence,
might be adduced to show the need there is of such a
port.
" Labuan lies nearly in the direct track both of steam
and sailing navigation from India to China, during the
northeast, the worst and severest of the two monsoons ;
and is as intermediate a position between Singapore and
Hong Kong as can be found, being 700 miles from the
former and 1000 from the latter.
" The insular character and narrow limits of Labuan
will make it easily and cheaply defensible. The ex-
treme length of the island appears to be about six miles,
its greatest breadth about four and a half, and probably
its whole area will not be found to exceed thirty square
miles.
44 From the rude tribes of the immediate vicinity no
hostile attack is to be apprehended that would make the
present erection of forts or batteries necessary. No
Asiatic enemy is at any time to be feared that would
make such defences requisite. In five-and-twenty years
it has not been found imperative to have recourse to
them at Singapore. It is only in case of war with a
naval power that fortifications would be required ; but I
am not informed what local advantages Labuan possess-
es for their erection. A principal object of such fortifi-
cations would be the defence of the shipping in the har-
bor from the inroads of an enemy's cruisers. At one
point the soundings, as given in the Admiralty chart, are
stated nine fathoms, within three quarters of a mile of
the shore : and I presume that batteries within this dis-
tance would afford protection to the largest class of mer-
chantmen. In Singapore Roads no class of shipping
above mere native craft can lie nearer than two miles of
the shore ; so that in a war with a European naval
power, the merchant shipping there can only be defend-
ed by her majesty's navy.
"One of the most striking national advantages to be
expected from the possession of Labuan would consist
in its use in defending our own commerce, and attacking
that of opponents, in the event of a naval war. Between
the eastern extremity of the Straits of Malacca and
Hong Kong, a distance of 1700 miles, there is no British
348 KXl'KDlTfOX Ti)
harbor, and no safe and accessible port of refuge ; HOIIJJ
Kong is, indeed, the only spot within the wide limits of
the Chinese Sea for such a purpose, although our legiti-
mate commercial intercourse within it extends over a
length of 2000 miles. Everywhere else, Manilla and
the newly opened ports of China excepted, our crippled
vessels or our merchantmen pursued by the enemy's
cruisers, are met by the exclusion or extortion of semi-
barbarous nations, or in danger of falling into the power
of robbers and savages.
" Labuan fortified, and supposing the Borueon coal tc
be as productive and valuable in quality as it is repre-
sented, would give Great Britain in a naval war the en-
tire command of the China Sea. This would be the
result of our possessing or commanding the only availa-
ble supply of coal, that of Bengal and Australia except-
ed, to be found in the wide limits which extend east of
the continents of Europe and America.
." The position" of Labuan will render it the most conve-
nient possible for the suppressing of piracy. The most
desperate and active pirates of the whole Indian Archi-
pelago are the tribes of the Sooloo group of islands lying
close to the north shore of Borneo, and the people of the
north and northeastern coast of Borneo itself; these
have of late years proved extremely troublesome both to
the English and Dutch traders ; both nations are bound
by the Convention of 1824 to use their best endeavors
for the suppression of piracy, and many efforts have
cortainly been made for this purpose, although as yet
without material effect in diminishing the evil.
" From Labuan, these pirates might certainly be in-
tercepted by armed steamers far more conveniently and
cheaply than from any other position that could be easily
pointed out : indeed, the very existence of a British set-
tlement would tend to the suppression of piracy.
" As a commercial depot, Labuan would have consid-
erable advantages by position ; the native trade of the
vicinity would of course resort to it, and so would that
of the north coast of Borneo, of the Sooloo lalands, jind
of a considerable portion of the Spice Islands. Even for
the trade of the Philippines and China, it would havo
the advantage over Singapore of a voyage by 700 miles
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 340
shorter ; a matter of most material consequence to na-
tive commerce.
" With all the countries of the neighborhood lying
west of Lnbuan I presume that a communication across
both monsoons might be maintained throughout the
year. This would include a portion of the east const
of the Malay peninsula, Siam, and part of Cochin
China.
" Labuan belongs to that portion of the coast of Bor-
neo which is the rudest. The Borneons themselves are
of the Malay nation, originally emigrants from Sumatra,
and settled here for about six centuries. They are the
most distant from their original seat of all the colonies
which have sprung from this nation. The people from
the interior differ from them in language, manners, and
religion, and are divided into tribes as numerous and as
rude as the Americans when first seen by Europeans.
" From such a people we are not to expect any valu-
able products of art or manufacture, for a British
mercantile depot. Pepper is, however, produced in
considerable quantity, and the products of the forests
are very various, as bees-wax, gum-benjamin, fine cam-
phor, camphor oil, esculent swallows' nests, canes and
rattans, which used to form the staple articles of Bor-
neon import into Singapore. The Borneon territory
opposite to Labuan abounds also, I believe, in the palm
which yields sago, and indeed the chief part of the man-
ufactured article was thirty years ago brought from
this country. The Chinese settlers would, no doubt,
as in Singapore and Malacca, establish factories for its
preparation according to the improved processes which
they now practice at those places.
" There may be reason to expect, however, that the
timber of the portion of Borneo referred to may be
found of value for ship-building ; for Mr. Dalrymple
states that in his time, above seventy years ago, Chinese
junks of 500 tons burden used to be built in the river of
Borneo. As to timber" well-suited for boats and house-
building, it is hardly necessary to add that the northwest
coast of Borneo, in common with almost every other
part of the Archipelago, contains a supply amounting to
superfluity.
G G
350 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
" I may take this opportunity of stating, as evidence
of the conveniency of this portion of Borneo for a com-
mercial intercourse with China, that down to within the
last half century a considerable number of Chinese junks
were engaged in trading regularly with Borneo, and
that trade ceased only when the native government be-
came too bad and weak to afford it protection. With-
out the least doubt this trade would again spring up on
the erection of the British flag at Labuan. Not a single
Chinese junk had resorted to the Straits of Malacca
before the establishment of Singapore, and their number
is now, of one size or another, and exclusive of the junks
of Siam and Cochin China, not less than 100.
" From the cultivation of the land I should not be
disposed to expect anything beyond the production of
fresh fruits and esculent vegetables, and when the land
is cleared, of grass for pasture. The seas in this part
of the world are prolific in fish of great variety and great
excellence ; and the Chinese settlers are found every-
where skillful and industrious in taking them.
" Some difficulty will, in the beginning, be experienced
with respect to milk, butter, and fresh meat : this wa^
the case at first in Singapore, but the difficulty has in
a good measure been overcome. The countries of the
Archipelago are generally not suited to pasture, and it
is only in a few of them that the ox and buffalo are
abundant. The sheep is so nowhere, and for the most
part is wanting altogether ; cattle, therefore, must be
imported.
" As to corn, it will unquestionably be found far
cheaper to import than to raise it. Rice will be the
chief bread-corn, and will come in great abundance and
cheapness from Siam and Cochin China. No country
within 700 miles of Singapore is abundant in corn, and
none is grown in the island : yet from the first estab-
lishment of the settlement to the present time, corn has
been both cheap and abundant, there has been wonder-
fully little fluctuation, there are always stocks, and for
many years a considerable exportation- A variety of
pulses, vegetable oil, and culinary salt, will bo derived
from the same countries, as is now done in abundance
by Singapore.
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 35V
44 The mines of antimony are 300 miles to the south-
west of Labuan, and those of gold on the west and the
south coasts ; and I am not aware that any mineral
wealth has been discovered in the portion of Borneo
immediately connected with Labuan, except that of
coal far more important and valuable, indeed, than
gold or antimony. The existence of a coal-field has
been traced from Labuan to the islands of Kayn-arang
which words, in fact, mean coal island to the island
of Cherinin, and from thence to the mainland over a
distance of thirty miles. With respect to the coal of
Labuan itself, I find no distinct statement beyond the
simple fact of the existence of the mineral; but the
coal of the two islands in the river, and of the main, is
proved to be from analysis and trial in steam-naviga-
tion superior to nearly all the coal which India has
hitherto yielded, and equal to some of our best English
coals. This is the more remarkable, as it is known that
most surface-minerals, and especially coals, are inferior
to the portions of the same veins or beds more deep-
seated.
44 Nearly as early as the British flag is erected, and,
at all events, as soon as it is permanently known to be
so, there may be reckoned upon with certainty a large
influx of settlers. The best and most numerous of
these will be the Chinese. They were settled on the
Borneo river when the Borneo government, never very
good, or otherwise than comparatively violent and dis-
orderly, was most endurable.
" Borneo is, of all the great islands of the western
portion of the Archipelago, the nearest to China, and
Labuan and its neighborhood the nearest point of this
island. The distance of Hong Kong is about 1000 miles,
and that of the island of Hainan, a great place for emi-
gration, not above 800 ; distances which to the Chinese
junks fast sailers before the strong and favorable winds
of the monsoons do not make voyages exceeding four
or five days. The coasts of the provinces of Canton
and Fokien have hitherto been the great hives from
which Chinese emigration has proceeded ; and even
Fokien is not above 1400 miles from Labuan, a voyage
of seven or eight days. Chinese trade and immigration
352 EXPEDITION' TO BORNEO.
will come together. The northwest coast of Borneo
produces an unusual supply of those raw articles for
which there is always a demand in the markets of
China ; and Labuan, it may be reckoned upon with
certainty, will soon become the seat of a larger trade
with China than the river of Borneo ever possessed.
" I by no means anticipate the same amount of rapid
advance in population, commerce, or financial resources
for Labuan, that has distinguished the history of Singa-
pore, a far more centrical position for general com-
merce ; still I think its prospect of success undoubted ;
while it will have some advantages which Singapore
cannot, from its nature, possess. Its coal-mines, and
the command of the coal-fields on the river of Borneo,
are the most remarkable of these; and its superiority
as a post-office * station necessarily follows. Then it is
far more convenient as a port of refuge ; and, as far as
our present knowledge will enable us to judge, infinitely
more valuable for military purposes, more especially for
affording protection to the commerce which passes
through the Chinese Sea, amounting at present to prob-
ably not less than 300,000 tons of shipping, carrying
cargoes certainly not under the value of 15,000,000^.
sterling.
"Labuan ought, like Singapore, to be a free port;
and assuredly will not prosper if it is not. Its revenue-
should not be derived from customs, but, as in that set-
tlement, from excise duties : upon the nature of those,
as it is well known, it is unnecessaiy to enlarge. They
covered during my time, near twenty years ago, and
within five years of the establishment of the settlement,
the whole charges of a small but sufficient garrison
(100 Sepoys), and a moderate but competent civil
establishment.
" The military and civil establishments have been
greatly increased of late years ; but the revenue, still
in its nature the same, has kept pace with them.
* Vide Mr. Wise's Plan (p. 3G2, 3) for accelerating the com-
munication between Great Britain and China, viz. the convey,
ance of the mails from Hong Kong to Suez (via Ceylon) direct.
Submitted to her niajest* nf, Hth September, 1843;
neloptrd 20th June. !R-l. r >
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 353
During my administration of Singapore, the municipal
charges fell on the general fund ; but they are at present
amply provided for from a distinct source, chiefly an
assessment on house-property.
" If the military and civil charges of Labuan are
kept within moderate bounds, I make no doubt but that
a similar excise revenue will be adequate to cover the
charges of both, and that in peace at least the state
need not be called on to make any disbursement on
its account; while during a naval war, if the state
make any expenditure, it will be fully compensated by
the additional security which the settlement will afford
to British commerce, and the annoyance it will cause to
the enemy.
"As to the disposal of the land, always a difficult
question in a new and unoccupied colony, the result of
my own inquiries and personal experience lead me to
offer it as my decided conviction that the most expe-
dient plan that which is least troublesome to the gov-
ernment, most satisfactory to the settler, and ultimately
most conducive to the public prosperity is to dispose
of it for a term of years, that is, on long leases of 1000
years, or virtually in perpetuity ; the object in this case
of adopting the leasehold tenure being, by making the
land a chattel interest, to get rid of the difficulties in the
matter of inheritance and transfer, which, under the
administration of English law, and in reference more
particularly to the Asiatic people who will be the prin-
cipal landowners, are incident to real property. Town
allotments might be sold subject to a considerable quit-
rent, but allotments in the country for one entirely
nominal. Those of the latter description should be
small, proportionate with the extent of the island, and
the time and difficulty required in such a climate to
clear the land, now overgrown for the most part with a
stupendous forest of evergreen trees, and the wood of
which is too abundant to be of any value, certainly for
the most part not worth the land-carriage of a couple of
furlongs.
" A charter for the administration of justice should be
as nearly as possible contemporaneous with the cession.
Great inconvenience has resulted in all our Eastern set-
23 oo 2
354 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
tlements of the same nature with that speculated on at
Labuan, from the want of all legal provision for the ad-
ministration of justice; and remembering this, it ought
to be guarded against in the case of Labuan.
"Whether in preparing for the establishment of a
British settlement on the coast of Borneo, or in actually
making one, her majesty's ministers, I am satisfied, will
advert to the merits and peculiar qualifications of Mr.
Brooke. That gentleman is unknown to me, except
by his acts and writings; but, judging by these, I con-
sider him as possessing all the qualities which have dis-
tinguished the successful founders of new colonies;
intrepidity, firmness, and enthusiasm, with the art of
governing and leading the masses. He possesses some,
moreover, which have not always belonged to such
men, however otherwise distinguished ; a knowledge
of the language, manners, customs, and institutions of
the natives by whom the colony is to be surrounded ;
with benevolence and an independent fortune, things
still more unusual with the projectors of colonies. To-
ward the formation of a new colony, indeed, the avail-
able services of such a man, presuming they are availa-
ble, may be considered a piece of good fortune."
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 355
CONCLUDING OBSERVATIONS.
[First Edition.]
THE recent proceedings of Government in following
up the impression made upon Malay piracy, as related
in these pages; the appointment of Mr. Brooke as
British Agent in Borneo, armed with the moral and
physical power of his country ; the cession of the island
of Labuan to the British crown ; and the great advance
already made by the English ruler of Sarawak, in lay-
ing broad foundations for native prosperity, while ex-
tending general security and commerce ; all combine to
add an interest to the early individual steps which have
led to measures of so much national consequence.
Deeply as I felt the influence of that individual on
the condition of Borneo, and the Malayan Archipelago
generally, while employed there, and much as I an-
ticipated from his energetic character, extraordinary
exertions, and enlarged views for the future, I confess
that my expectations have been greatly increased by
the progress of events since that period. It needed
nothing to confirm my faith in the results that were
sure to follow from his enlightened acts from his pru-
dence and humanity in the treatment of his Dyak sub-
jects, and the neighboring and interior independent
tribes from his firm resistance to the Malay tyranny
exercised upon the aborigines, and his punishment of
Malay aggression, wherever perpetrated. But when I
see these elements of good wisely seconded by the highest
authorities of England, I cannot but look for the consum-
mation of every benefit desired, much more rapidly
and effectively than if left to the efforts of a private
person, even though that person were a Brooke ! If
the appearance of H.M.S. Dido on the coast and at
Sarawak produced a salutary effect upon all our rela-
tions with the inhabitants, it may well be presumed
that the mission of Captain Bethune, and the expedi-
tion under Rear-Admiral Sir Thomas Cochrane, must
have greatly improved and extended that wholesome
state of affairs. Indeed, it is evident, by the complete
350 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
success which attended Mr. Brooke's official visit to
Borneo Proper in H.M.S. Driver, after receiving dis-
patches from Lord Aberdeen appointing him British
agent in the island, carried out by Captain Bethune in
November, 1844, that the presence of a British force in
those seas was alone necessary to enable him to sup-
press piracy, and pei-fect his plans for the establishment
of a native government which should not oppress the
country, and which should cultivate the most friendly
intercourse with us. Thus we find the piratical Pan-
geran Usop put down, and Muda Hassim exercising
the sovereign power in the name of his imbecile ne-
phew, who still retains the title of sultan. The prin-
cipal chiefs, and men distinguished by talent and some
acquaintance with foreign affairs, are now on our side ;
and it only requires to support them in order that civil-
ization may rapidly spread over the land, and Borneo
become again, as it was one or two centuries ago, the
abode of an industrious, rich, pacific, and mercantile
people, interchanging products with all the trading na-
tions of the world, and conferring and reaping those
blessings which follow in the train of just and honorable
trade wheresoever its enterprising spirit leads in the
pursuit of honest gain. As the vain search for the
philosopher's stone conducted to many a useful and val-
uable discovery, so may we be assured that the real
seeking for gold through the profitable medium of com-
merce has been, is, and will be the grand source of fill-
ing the earth with comfort and happiness.
Among the numerous visions of this kind which open
to our sense while reflecting on the new prospects of
this vast island so little known, yet known to possess
almost unbounded means to invite and return commer-
cial activity is the contemplation of the field it presents
to missionaiy labors. When we read Mr. Brooke's de-
scription of the aboriginal Dyak, and observe what he
has himself done in one locality within the space of four
or five short years, what may we not expect to be ac-
complished by the zeal of Christian missions judiciously
directed to reclaim such a people from utter barbarism.
and induce them to become true members of a fsiith
which teaches forbearance and charity between man
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 357
and man, and inculcates, with the love and hope of
heaven, an abhorrence of despotism and blood, and a
disposition to live in good-will and peace with all our
fellow-creatures ? There are here no prejudices of
caste, as in India, to impede the missionaries' progress.
Mr. Brooke has pointed out what may be effected in
this way, and we have only to say amen to his prayer,
with an earnest aspiration that it may be speedily ful-
filled.
Having enjoyed the pleasure of communicating to the
public this satisfactory description of the status quo in
Borneo to the latest period (September, 1845), I ven-
ture to congratulate them upon it. Thus far all is well
and as it should be, and promising the happiest issue ;
but I hope I may not be charged with presumption in
offering an opinion from my experience in this quarter,
and respectfully suggesting that, in addition to a perma-
nent British settlement jat Labuan, it will be absolutely
necessary to proceed with the suppression of Malay
piracy, by steadily acting against every pirate-hold.
Without a continued and determined series of opera-
tions of this sort, it is my conviction that even the most
sanguinary and fatal onslaughts will achieve nothing
beyond a present and temporary good. The impression
on the native mind is not sufficiently lasting : their old
impulses and habits return with fresh force ; they forget
their heavy retribution ; and in two or three years the
memory of them is almost entirely effaced. Till piracy
be completely suppressed there must be no relaxation ;
and well worth the perseverance is the end in view, the
welfare of one of the richest and most improvable por-
tions of the globe, and the incalculable extension of the
blessings of Britain's prosperous commerce and human-
izing dominion.
In looking forward to the certain realization of these
prospects, I may mention the important circumstance of
the discovery of coal in abundance for the purposes of
steam navigation. The surveys already made afford
assurances of this fact, and the requisite arrangements
are in progress for opening and working the mines. It
is generally known that the Dutch assert very wide
pretensions to colonies and monopolies in those seas. A
358 EXPEDITION TO BORN I
treaty has been concluded between the Netherlands
government and England ; and although that important
document contains no reference whatever to Borneo, it
is most desirable for the general extension of commerce
that no national jealousies, no ideas of conflicting inter-
ests, no encroaching and ambitious projects, may be
allowed to interfere with or prevent the beneficial prog-
ress of this important region. With such a man as Mr.
Brooke to advise the course most becoming, disinterest-
ed, and humane for the British empire to pursue, it is
not too much to say that, if the well-being of these races
of our fellow-creatures is defeated or postponed, the
crime will not lie at our door. The sacrifices we have
made to extinguish slavery throughout the world are a
sure and unquestionable pledge that we will do our ut-
most to extirpate the horrid traffic in those pails, and to
uproot the system of piracy that feeds it. It is the
bounden duty of both Holland and Great Britain to unite
cordially in this righteous cause. The cry of nature is
addressed to them ; and if rejected, as surely as there
is justice and mercy in the Providence which overrules
the fate of nations, no blessing will prosper them, but
wealth, and dominion, and happiness will pass away from
them forever. Mr. Brooke invokes their cooperation,
and his noble appeal cannot be withstood.
The central position of Labuan is truly remarkable.
That island is distant from
Hong Kong 1009 miles.
Singapore 707 ,,
Siam 984
Manilla 650
On the other hand, Mr. Brooke's territory of Sarawak
is distant from
Singapore 427 miles.
Labuan 304
Hong Kong 1199
How direct and central are these valuable possessions
for the universal trade of the East!
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 359
POSTSCRIPT
TO THE SECOND EDITION.
June 6th, 1846.
IN the foregoing remarks with which I closed the first
edition of this book, I ventured to congratulate the pub-
lic on the cheerful aspect of affairs in Borneo at the
latest period of which accounts had then reached me. I
could then say, with a joyful heart, " Thus far all is
well and as it should be, and promising the happiest
issue." But now I must write in a different strain. The
mischiefs I pointed out above as likely to ensue from a
desultory and intermittent mode of dealing with Malay
piracy have revealed themselves even sooner and in a
more formidable manner than I had anticipated. The
weak and covetous sultan of Borneo has, with more than
the usual fickleness of Asiatics, already forgotten the
.lessons we gave him and the engagements he solemnly
.and voluntarily contracted with us. Mr. Brooke's faith-
ful friends, Muda Hassim and the Pangeran Budrudeen,
with numbers of their families and retainers, have been
basely murdered by their treacherous kinsman, because
x)f their attachment to the English and their unswerving
determination to put down piracy ; and what is worst ot
all, Mr. Brooke's arch-enemy, the subtle and indefati-
gable villain Macota, the man whose accursed head was
thrice saved by my too-generous friend, has now returned
triumphantly to the scene of his former crimes, and is
commissioned by the sultan to take Mr. Brooke's life by
poison, or by any other of those treacherous arts in
which there is no more consummate adept than Macota.
I could trust securely to Mr. Brooke's gallantry and
skill for the protection of his life against the attacks of
open foes ; and my only fears arise when I reflect on his
(Utter inaensibility to danger, and think how the adraira
360 EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
bie qualities of his own guileless, confiding nature may
facilitate the designs of his enemies.
H.M.S. Hazard, from Hong Kong, having touched at
Bruni about the end of March last, was boarded by a
native, who gave the captain such information as induced
him to sail with all speed for Sarawak ; and there this
man made the following deposition :
Japper, a native of Bruni, deposes that he was Bent aboard
H.M.S. Hazard by the Pangeran Muda Mahomed, to warn
the captain against treachery, and to communicate the follow-
ing details to Mr. Brooke at Sarawak.
The Rajah Muda Hassim was raised by the sultan to the
title of Sultan Muda (or young sultan), and, together with his
brothers and followers, was living in security, when he was
attacked by orders of the sultan at night, and together with
thirteen of his family, killed in different places. Four brothers,
viz. Pangeran Muda Mahomed, Pangeran Abdul Kader, Pan-
geran Abdulraman, and Pangeran Mesahat, together with
several young children of the Rajah Muda Hassim, alone sur-
vive. The deponent Japper was in attendance on his lord,
the Pangeran Budrudeen, at the time of the attack. The
Pangeran, though surprised by his enemies, fought for some
time, and when desperately wounded, retired outside his
house with his sister and another woman named Koor Salem.
The deponent was there and was wounded, as were both
the women. The Pangeran Budrudeen ordered deponent to
open a keg or cask of gunpowder, which he did ; and the
last thing his lord did was to take his ring from his finger
and desire the deponent to carry it to Mr. Brooke ; to bid
Mr. Brooke not to forget him, and not to forget to lay his
case before the Queen of England. The deponent then
quitted his lord, who was with the two women, and imme-
diately after his lord fired the powder, and the three were
blown up. The deponent escaped with difficulty ; and a few
days afterward, the ring intrusted to his charge, was taken
from him by the sultan. The sultan, and those with him,
killed the Rajah Muda Hassim and his family, because he
was the friend of the English and wanted to suppress piracy.
The sultan has now built forts and defied the English. He
talked openly of cutting out any vessel that arrived ; .and two
Pangerans went down, bearing the flag of the Rajah Muda
Hassim, to look at the vessel, and to kill the captain if they
could get him ashore. The deponent had great difficulty in
getting to the ship; and should his flight be discovered, he
nsidnr tli" lives of tftr surviviiMr portion of tbf> Rajah
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO. 361
Muda Hassim a family will be in danger. The deponent did
what he was ordered, and what his late lord, the Pangeran
Budrudeen, desired him to do. The sultan had a man ready
to send, named Nakoda Kolala, to Kaluka, to request that
Pangeran Macota would kill Mr. Brooke by treachery or
poison.
(Signed) J. BROOKE.
Having put Mr. Brooke on his guard, the Hazard
proceeded to Singapore, whence the H.E.I.C. war-
steamer Phlegethon would be immediately dispatched
to Sarawak.
HH
302
EXPEDITION TO BORNEO.
CM-EDITION TO BORNEO.
363
msji^ijij i^
'ifirlliJU s *
i"
"= E > 3 T - o 5 c S
lllliiiflllf
f^saiill?*.!*
|2g^gO J1VI 1^
g ocsSo.,^
^Illlfll**
1 **
APPENDIX.
No. I.
NATURAL HISTORY. -
Mr. Brooke's Report on the Mias. (From the Trans-
actions of the Zoological Society.)
JAMES BROOKE, ESQ., TO MR. WATERHOUSE.
MY DEAR SIR : Singapore, 25th March, 1841.
I AM happy to announce the departure of five Jive ourang-
outangs by the ship Martin Luther, Captain Swan ; and I trust
they will reach you alive. In case they die, I have directed
Captain Swan to put them into spirits, that you may still have an
opportunity of seeing them. The whole of the five are from
Borneo : one large female adult from Sambas ; two, with slight
cheek-callosities, from Pontiana ; a small male, without any sign
of callosities, from Pontiana likewise ; and the smallest of all, a
very young male with callosities, from Sadung. I will shortly
forward a fine collection of skulls and skeletons from the northwest
coast of Borneo, either shot by myself or brought by the natives ;
and I beg you will do me the favor to present the live ourangs
and this collection to the Zoological Society. I have made many
inquiries and gained some information regarding these animals,
and I can, beyond a doubt, prove the existence of two, if not three,
distinct species in Borneo.
First, 1 will re-state the native account : secondly, give you my
own observations ; and thirdly, enter into a brief detail of the
specimens hereafter to be forwarded.
1st. The natives of the northwest coast of Borneo are all posi-
tive as to the existence of two distinct species, which I formerly
gatoe you by the names of the Mias pappan and Mias rombi ; but I
have since received information from a few natives of intelligence
that there are three sorts, and what is vulgarly called the Mias
rombi is in reality the Mias kassar, the rombi being a distinct and
third species. The Mias pappan is the Simia Wurmbii of Mr.
Owen, having callosities on the sides of the face : the natives
treat with derision the idea of the Mias kassar, or Simia morio,
being the female of the Mias pappan or Simia Wurmbii ; and I
consider the fact can be established so clearly that I will not
BBS
300 APPENDIX.
trouble you with their statements : both Malays and Dyaks are
positive that the female of the Mias pappan has cheek-callosities
the same as the male ; and if on inquiry it prove to be so, the ex-
istence of three distinct species in Borneo will be established.
The existence of the Mias rombi is vouched by a few natives
only, but they were men of intelligence, and well acquainted with
the animals in the wild state. They represent the Mias rombi to
be as tall as the pappan, or even taller, but not so stout, with
longer hair, a smaller face, and no callosities eithei )n the male
or female ; and they always insisted that it was not the female of
the pappan.
The Mias kassar or Simia morio is of the same color as the Mias
pappan, but altogether smaller, and devoid of callosities either on
the male or female adults.
By the native statements, therefore, we find three distinct spe-
cies, viz. the Mias pappan or Simia Wurmbii, the Mias kassar or
Simia morio, and the Mias rombi, which is either the Simia Abe-
lii, or a fourth species. The existence of the Sumatran ourang
in Borneo is by no means impossible ; and I have already com-
pared so many of the native statements, that I place more confi-
dence in them than I did formerly, more especially as their
account is in a great measure borne out by the skulls in my
possession. I had an opportunity of seeing the Mias pappan and
the Mias kassar in their native woods, and killing one of the
former and several of the latter species. The distribution of these
animals is worthy of notice, as they are found both at Pontiana
and Sambas in considerable numbers, and at Sadung on the
northwest coast, but are unknown in the intermediate country
which includes the rivers of Sarawak and Samarahan. I confess
myself at a loss to account for their absence on the Sarawak and
Samarahan rivers, which abound with fruit, and have forests
similar arid contiguous to the Sadung, Linga, and other rivers.
The distance from Samarahan to Sadung does not exceed twenty-
five miles ; and though pretty abundant on the latter, they are
unknown on the former river. From Sadung, proceeding to the
northward and eastward, they are found for about 100 miles, but
beyond that distance do not inhabit the forests. The Mias pappan
and Mias kassar inhabit the same woods, but I never met them
on the same day ; both species, according to the natives, are
equally common, but from my own experience the Mias kassar is
the most plentiful. The Mias rombi is represented as unfrequent
and rarely to be met with. The pappan is justly named Satyrus,
from the ugly face and disgusting callosities. The adult male 1
killed was seated lazily on a tree, and when approached only took
the trouble to interpose the trunk between us, peeping at me, and
dodging as I dodged. I hit him on the wrist, and he was after-
ward dispatched. 1 send you his proportions, enormous relative
to his height ; and until I came to actual measurement my im-
pression was that he was nearly six feet in stature. The follow-
ing is an extract from my journal relating to him, noted down
directly after he was killed :
" Great was our lii'iinp! > animal dead
APPENDIX/ 867
at our feet, and proud were we of having shot the first ourang we
had seen, and shot him in his native woods, in n Borneo forest,
hitherto untrodden by European feet. The animal was adult,
having four incisors, two canines, and ten molars in each jew ;
but by his general appearance he was not old. We were struck
by the length of his arms, the enormous neck, and the expanse
of face, which altogether gave the impression of great height,
whereas it was only great power. The hair was long, reddish,
and thin ; the face remarkably broad and fleshy, and on each side,
in the place of a man's whiskers, were the callosities or rather
fleshy protuberances, which I was so desirous to see, and which
were nearly two inches in thickness. The ears were small and
well shaped, the nose quite flat, mouth prominent, lips thick,
teeth large and discolored, eyes small and roundish, face and hands
black, the latter being very powerful. The following are the
dimensions :
ft. in.
Height from head to heel 41
Length of foot 10
Ditto hand 10i
Length of arm from shoulder-blade to finger-end . . 3 5$
Shoulder-blade to elbow 16
Elbow to wrist 1 1J
Hip to heel 19
Head to os coccygia . . 2 5
Across the shoulders 1 5J
Circumference of neck
Ditto below the ribs 3 3$
Ditto under the arms 30
From forehead to chin 9$
Across the face, below the eyes, including callosities . 1 1
From ear to ear across the top of the head . . .09*
From ear to ear behind the Jnead 9sj
The natives asserted the animal to be a small one; but I am
skeptical of their ever attaining the growth of a tall man, though
I bear in mind that full-grown animals will probably differ as
much in height as man."
Some days after this, and about thirty miles distant, I was for-
tunate enough to kill two adult females (one with her young),
and a male nearly adult, all the Mias kassar. The young male
was not measured, owing to my having waded up to my neck in
pursuit of him, and thereby destroyed my paper and lost my mea-
sure ; but he certainly did not exceed 3 feet, while the two
females were about 3 ft. 1 in. and 3 ft. 2 in. in height. The male
was just cutting his two posterior molars : the color of all resem-
bled that of the Mias pappan, but the difference between the two
animals was apparent even to our seamen. The kassar has no
callosities either on the male or female, whereas the young pap-
pans dispatched by the Martin Luther (one of them not a year
old, with two first molars) show them prominently. The great
difference between the kassar and the pappan in size would prove
at once the distinction of the two species ; the kassar being a
small, slight animal, by no means formidable in his appearance,
with hands and feet propojtioned to the body, and they do rot
368 A PI' KM) IX.
approach the gigantic extremities ol the pappan either in size 01
power ; and, in short, a moderately strong man would readily
overpower one, when he would not stand the shadow of a chance
with the pappan. Beside these decisive differences may be
mentioned the appearance of the face, which in the Mias kassar
is more prominent in the lower part, and the eyes exteriorly
larger, in proportion to the size of the animal, than in the pappan.
The color of the skin in the adult pappan is black, while the
kassar, in his face and hands, has the dirty color common to the
young of both species. If further evidence was wanted, the skulls
will fully prove the distinction of species ; for the skulls of two
adult animals compared will show a difference in size alone which
must preclude all supposition of their being one species. Mr.
Owen's remarks are, however, so conclusive, that I need not dwell
on this point ; and with a suite of skulls, male and female, from
the adult to the infant, of the Mias kassar, which I shall have the
pleasure to forward, there can remain, I should think, little fur-
ther room for discussion. I may mention, however, that two
young animals I had in my possession alive, one a kassar, the
other a pappan, fully bore out these remarks by their proportionate
size. The pappan, with two molars, showed the callosities dis-
tinctly, and was as tall and far stouter than the kassar with three
molars, while the kassar had no vestige of the callosities. Their
mode of progression likewise was different, as the kassar doubled
his fists and dragged his hind quarters after him, while the pap-
ds sideways placed on the
other in the erect sitting
attitude ; but this was only observed in the two young ones, and
cannot be considered as certainly applicable to all.
On the habits of the ourangs, as far as I have been able to ob-
serve them, I may remark, that they are as dull and as slothful
as can well be conceived, and on no occasion when pursuing them
did they move so fast as to preclude my keeping pace with them
easily through a moderately clear forest ; and even when obstruc-
tions below (such as wading up to the neck) allowed them to get
way some distance, they were sure to stop and allow us to come
up. I never observed the slightest attempt at defence ; and the
wood, which sometimes rattled about our ears, was broken by
their weight, and not thrown, as some persons represent. If
pushed to extremity, however, the pappan could not be otherwise
than formidable ; and one unfortunate man, who with a party was
trying to catch a large one alive, lost two of his fingers, beside
being severely bitten on the face, while the animal finally beat off
his pursuers and escaped. When they wish to catch an adult,
they cut down a circle of trees round the one on which he is
seated, and then fell that also, and close before he can recover
himself, and endeavor to bind him.
In a small work entitled " The Menageries," published in 1838,
there is a good account of the Borneon ourang, with a brief extract
from Mr. Owen's valuable paper on the Simia morio ; but, after
dwelling on the lazy and apathetic disposition of the animal, it
sl.at.rs in the same page that they can make their way amid the
pan supported himself on the open hands sideways placed on the
ground, and moved one leg before the
APPENDIX. .369
branches of tbe trees with surprising agility ; whereas they are
the slowest and least active of all the monkey tribe, and their
motions are surprisingly awkward and uncouth. The natives on
the northwest coast entertain no dread, and always represent the
ourangs as harmless and inoffensive animals ; and from what I saw,
they would never attack a man unless brought to the ground.
The rude hut which they are stated to build in the trees would
be more properly called a seat or nest, for it has no roof or cover
of any sort. The facility with which they form this seat is curi-
ous, and I had an opportunity of seeing a wounded female weave
the branches together, and seat herself within a minute ; she
afterward received our fire without moving, and expired in her
lofty abode, whence it cost us much trouble to dislodge her. I
have seen some individuals with nails on the posterior thumbs,
but generally speaking, they are devoid of them : of the five ani-
mals sent home, two have the nails, and three are without them ;
one has the nail well formed, and in the other it is merely rudi-
mentary. The length of my letter precludes my dwelling on
many particulars which, as I have not seen the recent publica-
tions on the subject, might be mere repetitions ; and I will only
mention, as briefly as I can, the skulls of these animals in my
possession. From my late sad experience I am induced to this,
that some brief record may be preserved from shipwreck. These
skulls may be divided into three distinct sorts. The first presents
two ridges, one rising from each frontal bone, which, joining on
the top of the head, form an elevated crest, which runs backward
to the cerebral portion of the skull.
The second variety is the Simia morio ; and nothing need be
added to Mr. Owen's account, save, that it presents no ridge what-
ever beyond the frontal part of the head. No. 9 in the collection
is the skull of an adult male : No. 2 the male, nearly adult, killed
by myself: Nos. 11 and 3 adult females, killed by myself : No. 12
a young male, with three molars, killed by myself: No. 21 a
young male, died aboard, with three molars : No. 19, young male,
died aboard, with two molars. There are many other skulls of
the Simia morio which exactly coincide with this suite, and this
suite so remarkably coincides through the different stages of age.
one with another, that no doubt can exist of the Simia morio be-
ing a distinct species. The different character of the skull, its
small size and small teeth, put the matter beyond doubt, and
completely establish Mr. Owen's acute and triumphant argument,
drawn from a single specimen.
The third distinction of the skulls is, that the ridges rising from
the frontal bones do not meet, but converge toward the top of the
head, and again diverge toward the posterior portion of the skull.
These ridges are less elevated than in the first-mentioned skulls,
but the size of the adult skulls is equal, and both present speci
ms of aged animals. For a long time I was inclined to thmk
...^ skulls with the double ridge were the females of the animals
with the single and more prominent ridge ; but No. 1 (already
described as killed by myself) will show that the double ridge be
Jongs to an adult and not yountj malp animal, and that U, brlongs
24
37$
to the Sirnia Wurmbii with the huge callosities. The distinction!
therefore cannot be a distinction of sex, unless we suppose the
skulls with the greater development of the single ridge to belong
to the female, which is improbable in the highest degree. The
skulls with the double and less elevated ridges belong, as proved
by No. 1, to the Simia Wurmbii ; and 1 am of opinion the single
and higher ridge must be referred to another and distinct species,
unless we can account for this difference on the score of age.
This, I conceive, will be found impossible, as Nos. 7 and 20 are
specimens similar to No. 1, with the double and less elevated
ridges decidedly old, and Nos. 4 and 5 are specimens of the single
high ridge, likewise decidedly old.
These three characters in the skulls coincide with the native
statements of there being three distinct species in Borneo, and
this third Borneon species may probably be found to be the Simia
Abelii, or Sumatranourang. This probability is strengthened by
the adult female on her way home : her color is dark brown, with
black face and hands ; and in color of hair, contour, and expres-
sion, she differs from the male ourangs with the callosities to a
degree that makes me doubt her being the female of the same
species. I ofier you these remarks for fear of accident ; but should
the specimens, living and dead, arrive in safety, they will give a
fresh impetus to the inquiry, and on my next return to Borneo I
shall, in all probability, be able to set the question at rest, whether
there be two or three species in that country. Believe me, my
dear sir, with best wishes, to remain,
Yours very truly,
J. BROOKE.
Borneo, like Celebes, teems with Natural History unknown to
European science ; and Mr. Brooke has sent some remarkable
specimens to England, though his own large collection was, un-
fortunately, wrecked on its voyage homeward. Every arrival,
however, is now adding to the stores we already possess. The
British Museum has been much enriched, even within the last
year, with rare specimens of zoology and botany ; and at the Ento-
mological Society there have been exhibited and described many
curious insects hitherto strange and unclassified.
No. II.
PHILOLOGY.
IT was intended in this work to convey to the studious in phi-
lology, upon which science, rationally investigated, so much de-
pends of our ability to ascertain the origin and trace the earliest
relations of mankind, as copious a vocabulary of the Dyak lan-
guage, with definitions of meaning and cognate references, as
might Ix 1 com '
APPENDIX. 371
of learning. But various considerations have induced us to forego
the design ; and not the least of them has been, not the difficulty,
but the impossibility of reducing the whole collection to a system,
or of laying down any certain rule of orthography in this Oriental
confusion. Nearly all the vowels, for example, have been found
of equal value ; and as they have but one general Malay name, so
it happens that (for instance) the consonants b d might be pro-
nounced with the intervening sound, bad, bed, bid, bod, bud, and
sundry variations beside, unknown to the English tongue. This
will in a great degree account for the universally vexatious, be-
cause puzzling, spelling, inflections, and pronunciation of East-
ern names, which is so injurious to the literature and knowledge
of those countries among Europeans.
The vowel-sounds adopted are :
a like a in father.
e a in fan.
i Italian /, or ec in tfiec.
i ,, i in pin.
o o in spoke.
u oo in cool.
H u in run.
y occasionally like t.
ow (ou) like ow in cow.
The final k in Malayan is frequently mute : thus Dyak is pronounced
DyaA, with the slightest possible aspiration.
gn is a liquid sound.
We add an alphabetical list of some of the words which have
occurred in the preceding pages.
rfrafuras, or Haroforas, natives of Papua.
Balanian, wild tribes in Borneo.
Bandar, or Bandkara, treasurer, high steward, high officer of state.
Basaya, tribes in the interior of Borneo Proper, locating near and resem-
bling the Murut.
Battara, one of the Dyak names of God (the Hindu Jvatara).
Borneo, the island of, written " Bruni" by the inhabitants.
Borneo Proper, the northern and northwestern part of the island ; an
independent Malay state.
Borneons, the Malay inhabitants of Borneo Proper
Bruni, the native name for Borneo.
Bugis, natives of Celebes.
Bulan, the Moon, a poetical title of honor to a pirate-chief.
Campong, a native village, or town.
Datu, a cape or point of land to the northwest of the river Banjamassim.
Datus, strictly, native chiefs, heads of tribes.
Dusun, agricultural villagers on the northern extremity of Borneo.
Dyaks, or Dyak, aborigines of Borneo, and generally pronounced Dyan.
Dyak Darrat, Land Dyaks.
Dyak Laut, Sea Dyaks.
Oantoiiff. a Malay measure for rice.
Ounonff, a mountain.
Hadji, a Mahomedan who has made a pilgrimage to Mecca.
Haraforas, or Jlrafuras, natives of Papua.
372 APl'ENDIX.
Idaans [KadiensJ, Borneon tribes, and the name generally given to most
of the varieties of the Indian Archipelago.
lllanunt, or Lanuns, pirates inhabiting the small cluster of islands between
Borneo and Magindano.
Jovata, a Dyajt name of God, of Hindu origin.
Kadiens, Borneon tribes, M ahomedans, the Idaan of preceding voyagerg
and writers. See Idaans.
Kalamantan, an original name of Borneo.
Kanowit, wild tribes in Borneo.
Kaya, a title of authority, Orang Kaya de Gadong, chief man of Gadong.
Kayans, the most powerful and warlike people of Borneo, living inland.
Kuchirtg, the former name of the town of Sarawak.
Labuan, the island off Borneo river, ceded by the sultan to the British
crown.
Lelas, guns.
Magindano, an island off the northeast of Borneo, the natives of which
are pirates.
Makassar, the straits of, usually written Macassar, but more accurately
Mangkassar.
Malays, settled on the Malayan peninsula, coasts of Borneo, &c. &.C., a
race of seafaring character, often piratical, and conquerors of various
native tribes in the Indian Archipelago.
Malukus, pirates from a bay in Gillolo, whose country is in the possession
of the Dutch.
Marundum, an island off Borneo.
Matari, or JUata-hari (the eye of day), the Sun, a poetical title of honoi
to a pirate-chief.
JWas Rombi and J\I. Pappan, two species of ourang-outang, determined
by Mr. Brooke.
Millanows, a tribe resembling the Kayans, living near the rircr Men,
river Bentulu, tolerably civilized, and fairer than the Malays.
JMinkokas, a wild tribe near the Bay of Boni.
JMorotaba river, one of the mouths of the Sarawak.
JMontrado, a very large and populous Chinese settlement near Point Datu.
JMurut, inhabitants of the interior of Borneo Proper.
Jfatunas, islands off Borneo.
Ondong-ondong, the written law of Borneo.
Orang, a man.
Orang-outang, a wild man.
Pangeran, or Pangiran, the title of a high Malay authority.
Panglima, the head warrior of a Dyak tribe.
Patingi, or Patingue, a high local officer.
Patobong, the name of the ranjows and sudas, defences in war.
Patakan Dyaks, said by the Malays to be cannibals.
Pontiana, one of the finest rivers in Borneo ; also the name of natives
on its banks. The Dutch have a settlement on this river.
Ranjows, bamboo-spikes stuck in the ground to wound the feet of attack-
ing enemies, or concealed in pits to wound or destroy them.
Rhio, a Malay settlement, under Dutch control.
Sadung, a river adjoining the Sarawak.
Snkarra, a Dyak god, residing in the Pleiades.
Sakarran, a river like the Sarebus (which see), with a similar native
population on its banks.
Satlgi, a wooden spear, or dart.
Sampan, a small praliu.
Sarebus, a river flowing into the deep bay between Tanjong Sipang and
Tanjong Sirak.
Sarebut, powerful Dyak tribes and pirates, located on the above, and
other rivers flowing into the bay. They have thrown off the Malay
yoke, and plunder as far as Celebes.
APPENDIX. 378
Serijf, or Sheriff, a high Malay tide, peculiar to persons of Arab descent.
Sibnowans, or Sibnyows, Mr. Brooke's favorite tribe of Dyaks, of superior
character.
Singe, Dynk tribes.
Songi Bescr, large river.
Sooloo, on tlie northeast of Borneo, a powerful piratical nest, the natives
of which massacred the garrison of Balambangan in 1775.
Sudahs, defences to wound the feet of attacking enemies.
Sumpitan, or Simpote, a tube seven or eight feet in length, through which
the Borneons blow small sharp-pointed poisoned arrows.
Tanjong, a point of land.
Taraj, or Tarajahs, natives of Celebes.
Tatows, wild tribes in the interior of Borneo.
Tiran, natives on the north of Borneo, reported (on doubtful authority)
to be pirates and cannibals.
Tuan, sir, an exclamation of assent to an approved speaker, instead of
" hear, hear," or " yes."
Tuan Besar, sir, great, great chief, higher applause and deference.
Tainangong, a local Malay officer.
Tumbilans, a beautiful group of about 150 small islands between Borneo
and Singapore.
Tuppa, a Dyak god.
Wakil, a deputy.
Zedong, like the Tiran, which see.
No. III.
Proposed Exploring Expedition to the Asiatic Archi-
pelago, by JAMES BROOKE, ESQ. 1838.
THE voyage I made to China opened an entirely new see
and showed me what I had never seen before, savage life
savage nature. I inquired, and I read, and I became more
more assured that there was a large field of discovery and ad
ture open to any man daring enough to enter upon it. Just take a
map and trace a line over the Indian Archipelago, with its thousand
unknown islands and tribes. Cast your eye over the vast island
of New Guinea, where the foot of European has scarcely, if ever,
trod. Look at the northern coast of Australia, with its mysterious
Gulf of Carpentaria; a survey of which, it is supposed, would
solve the great geographical question respecting the rivers of the
mimic continent. Place your finger on Japan, with its exclusive
and civilized people ; it lies an unknown lump on our earth, and
an undefined line on our charts ! Think of the northern coast oi
China, willing, as is reported, to open an intercourse and trade
with Europeans, spite of their arbitrary government. Stretch your
pencil over the Pacific Ocean, which Cook himself declares a field
of discovery for ages to come ! Proceed to the coast of South Amer-
ica, from the region of gold-dust to the region of furs the land rav-
aged by the cruel Spaniard and the no less cruel Bucaneer the
scene of the adventures of Drake and the descriptions of Dampier.
The places I have enumerated are mere names, with no specific
I i
B
*s
374 APPENDIX.
ideas attached to them: lands and seas where the boldest navigators
gained a reputation, and where hundreds may yet do so, if they
have the same courage and the same perseverance. Imagination
whispers to ambition that there are yet lands unknown which
might be discovered. Tell me, would not a man's life be well
spent tell me, would it not be well sacrificed, in an endeavor to
explore these regions? When I think on dangers and death, I
think of them only because they would remove me from such a
field for ambition, for energy, and for knowledge.
Borneo, Celebes, Sooloo, the Moluccas, and the islands of the
Straits of Sunda and Banka, compose what is called the Malayan
group ; and the Malays located on the sea-shores of these and
other islands may with certainty be classed as belonging to one
people. It is well known, however, that the interior of these
countries is inhabited by various tribes, differing from the Malays
and each other, and presenting numerous gradations of early civ-
ilization : the Dyaks of Borneo, the Papuans of New Guinea, and
others, beside the black race scattered over the islands. Objects
of traffic here as elsewhere present interesting subjects of inquiry ;
and while our acquaintance with every other portion of the globe,
from the passage of the Pole to the navigation of the Euphrates,
has greatly extended, it is matter of surprise that we know scarcely
anything of these people beyond the bare fact of their existence,
and remain altogether ignorant of the geographical features ot
the countries they inhabit. Countries which present an extended
field for Christianity and commerce, which none surpass in fer-
tility, rich beyond the Americas in mineral productions, and unri-
valed in natural beauty, continue unexplored to the present day ;
and, spite of the advantages which would probably result, have
failed to attract the attention they so well deserve. The diffi-
culty of the undertaking will scarcely account for its non-per-
formance, if we consider the voluntary sacrifices made on the shrine
of African research, or the energy displayed and the sufferings
encountered by the explorers of the Polar regions : yet the neces-
sity of prosecuting the voyage in an armed vessel, the wildness
of the interior tribes, the lawless ferocity of the Malays, and other
dangers, would prevent most individuals from fixing on this field
for exertion, and points it out as one which could best and most
fully be accomplished by Government or some influential body.
It is not my object to enter into any detail of the past history
of the Malayan nations, but I may refer to the undoubted facts
that they have been in a state of deterioration since we first be-
came acquainted with them ; and the records of our early voy-
agers, together with the remains of antiquity still visible in Java
and Sumatra, prove that once flourishing nations have now ceased
to exist, and that countries once teeming with human life are
now tenantless and deserted. The causes of such lamentable
change need only be alluded to ; but it is fit to remark, that while
the standard of education is unfurled, and dreams are propagated
of the progressive advancement of the human race, a large part
of the globe has been gradually relapsing and allowed to relapse
into barbarism. Whether the early decay of the Malay states,
APPENDIX. y7f)
and their consequent demoralization, arose from the introduction
of Mahommedism, or resulted from the intrigues of European
ambition, it were useless to discuss ; but we are very certain that
this " Eden of the Eastern wave " has been reduced to a state ol
anarchy and confusion, as repugnant to every dictate of humanity
as it is to the prospect of commercial advantage.
Borneo and Celebes, and indeed the greater portion of the
islands of the Malayan Archipelago, are still unknown, and the
apathy of two centuries still reigns supreme vjith the enlightened
people of England ; while they willingly make the most expensive
efforts favorable to science, commerce, or Christianity in other
quarters, the locality which eminently combines these three ob-
jects is alone neglected ami alone uncared for. It has unfortu-
nately been the fate of our Indian possessions to have labored
under the prejudice and contempt of a large portion of the well-
bred community. While the folly of fashion requires an acquain-
tance with the deserts of Africa, and a most ardent thirst for a
knowledge of the usages of Timbuctoo, it at the same time justi-
fies the most profound ignorance of all matters connected with
the government and geography of our vast acquisitions in Hin-
doostan. The Indian Archipelago has fully shared this neglect;
and even the tender philanthropy of the present day, which ori-
ginates such multifarious schemes for the amelioration of doubt-
ful evils, which shudders at the prolongation of apprenticeship
for a single year in the West, is blind to the existence of slavery
in its worst and most aggravated form in the East. Not a single
prospectus is spread abroad ; not a single voice is upraised to
relieve the darkness of Paganism, and the horrors of the Eastern
slave-trade. While the trumpet-tongue of many an orator excites
thousands to the rational and charitable objects of converting the
Jews and reclaiming the Gipsys ; while the admirable exertions
of missionary enterprise in the Ausonian climes of the South Sea
have invested them with worldly power as well as religious influ-
ence ; while we admire the torrent of devotional and philosophical
exertion, we cannot help deploring that the zeal and attention of
the leaders of these charitable crusades have never been directed
to the countries under consideration. These unhappy countries
have failed to rouse attention or excite commiseration ; and as
they sink lower and lower, they afford a striking proof how civil-
ization may be dashed, and how the purest and richest lands
under the sun may be degraded and brutalized by a continued
course of oppression and misrule. It is under these circumstances
that I have considered individual exertion may be usefully applied
to rouse the zeal of slumbering philanthropy, and to lead the way
to an increased knowledge of the Indian Archipelago. Such an
exertion will be made at some cost and some sacrifice ; and I shall
here quit the general topic, and confine myself to the specific
objects of my intended voyage.
It must be premised, however, that any plan previously decided
on must always be subject during its execution to great modifica-
tions in countries where the population is always rude and often
hostile, and where the influence of climate is sometimes so fatally
370 APPENDIX.
opposed to the progress of inquiry. Local information, likewise,
frequently renders such a change both advisable and advanta-
geous ; and circumstances, as they spring up, too often influence
us beyond the power of foresight, more especially in my own
case, where the utmost care would still leave the means very
inadequate to the full accomplishment of the proposed undertak-
ing. With a small vessel properly equipped, and provided with
Ihe necessary instruments for observation, and the means for col-
lecting specimens in natural history, it is proposed in the first
instance to proceed to Singapore, which may be considered as
head-quarters for the necessary intervals of refreshment and re-
pose, and for keeping open a certain communication with Europe.
Here the best local information can be obtained, interpreters pro-
cured, the crew augmented for any particular service ; and here,
if needful, a small vessel of native construction may be added to
the expedition, to facilitate the objects in view. An acquaintance
may likewise be formed with the more respectable Bugis mer-
chants, and their good-will conciliated in the usual mode, viz.,
by civility and presents, so as to remove any misconceived jeal-
ousy on the score of trading rivalry, and to induce a favorable
report of our friendly intentions in their own country, and at the
places where they may touch. The Royalist will probably reach
Singapore in the month of March, 1839, at the latter end of the
northwest, or rainy monsoon. The delay consequent on effecting
the objects above mentioned, beside gaining a general acquain-
tance with the natural history and trade of the settlement, and
some knowledge of the Malay language, will usefully occupy the
time until the setting in of the southeast, or dry monsoon. It
may be incidentally mentioned, however, that in the vicinity of
Singapore there are many islands imperfectly known, and which,
during the intervals of the rainy season, will afford interesting
occupation. I allude, more especially, to the space between the
Straits of Rhio and those of Uuryan, and likewise to the island
called Bintang, which, although laid down as one large island,
is probably composed of small ones, divided by navigable straits ;
a better acquaintance with which might facilitate the voyage
from Singapore to the more eastern islands, by bringing to light
other passages beside those of Rhio and Duryan ; and, ;;l any
rate, would add something to our geographical knowledge in the
immediate vicinity of our settlement. On the commencement of
the healthy season I propose sailing from Singapore, and proceed-
ing without loss of time to Malludu Bay, at the north end of Bor-
neo. This spot has been chosen for the first essay ; and in a
country every part of which is highly interesting, and almost un-
known, the mere fact of its being a British possession gives it a
prior claim to attention.
The objects in view may be briefly mentioned. 1. A genera!
knowledge of the bay, and the correct position of various points
more especially the two principal headlands at its entrance, so
as to determine its outline. The westernmost of these headlands,
called Sampanmange, will likewise determine the extreme north
point of Borneo. 2. Inquiries for the settlement of Cochin Chi-
APIT.ND1X. 377
nese, repoiieJ, on Earl's authority, to be fixed in the vicinity of
Bankoka : an intercourse will, if possible, be opened wHh this set-
tlement, if in existence. 3. The rivers which flow into the bay
will bo carefully and minutely explored, and an attempt will be
made to penetrate into the interior as far as the lake of Kini
Ballu. 4. For the same purpose, every endeavor will be used to
open a communication with the aboriginal inhabitants of the coun-
try, and every means employed to conciliate their good opinion ;
and (if the ceremony exists in this part of the island) to enter into
the bonds of fraternity (described by Mr. Dalton) with some of
the chiefs.
I speak with great diffidence about penetrating into the interior
of this country, for I am well aware of the insurmountable diffi-
culties which the hard reality often presents, which are previously
overlooked and easily overcome in the smoothness of paper, or
the luxury of a drawing-room. The two points to be chiefly re-
lied upon for this purpose are, a friendly intercourse with the
natives, and the existence of navigable rivers. It is mentioned
by Sir Stamford Raffles, on native authority, that a land commu-
nication, of not more than forty miles, exists between Malludu
Bay and Lake Kini Ballu ; but neither this computation, nor any
other derived from the natives, however intelligent otherwise, can
be relied on ; for the inhabitants of these countries are generally
ignorant of any measure for distance ; and their reckoning by time
is so vague, as to defy a moderately-certain conclusion. The fact,
however, of the vicinity of the lake to the bay may be concluded ;
and it follows, as a reasonable inference, that the river or rivers
flowing into the bay communicate with the lake. The existence
of such rivers, which were from the locality to have been ex-
pected, is vouched for by Captain Forrest. " Most of this north
part of Borneo (he says), granted to the English East India Com-
pany by the Sooloos, is watered by noble rivers : those that dis
charge themselves into Malludu Bay are not barred." It is by
one or other of these rivers that I should hope to penetrate as far
as the lake and mountain of Kini Ballu, and into the country of
the Idaan. I have not been able to learn that any Malay towns
of importance are situated in the bight of Malludu Bay, and their
absence will render a friendly communication with the aborigines
a matter of comparative ease. The advantages likely to result
from such friendly relations are so evident, that I need not dwell
upon them ; though the mode of effecting such an intercourse
must be left to the thousand contingencies which govern all, and
act so capriciously on the tempers of the savage races. The ut-
most forbearance, and a liberality guided by prudence, so as not
to excite too great a degree of cupidity, appear the fundamental
rules for managing men in a low state of civilization. The re-
sults >f an amicable understanding are as uncertain as its com-
mencement ; for they depend on the enterprise of the individual,
and the power of the native tribe into whose hands he may have
fallen. I will not, therefore, enter into a visionary field of discov-
ery ; but it appears to me certain that, without the assistance of
the natives, no small party can expect to penetrate far into a coun-
378 AIM- i:\uix.
try populous by report, and in many parts thickly covered with
wood. Without entertaining any exaggerated expectation, I trust
that something may be added to pur geographical knowledge of
the sea-coast of this bay, its leading features, productions, rivers,
anchorages, and inhabitants, the prospect of trade, and the means
of navigation ; and although my wishes lead me strongly to pen-
etrate as far as the lake of Kini Ballu, yet the obstacles which
may be found to exist to the fulfillment of this desire will induce
me to rest satisfied with the more moderate and reasonable re-
sults.
It may not be superfluous to notice here, that a foregone con-
clusion appears to be spread abroad regarding the aboriginal (so
called) inhabitants of Borneo, and that they are usually consid-
ered and mentioned under the somewhat vague appellation of
Dyaks. They are likewise commonly pronounced as originating
from the same stock as the Arafuras of Celebes and New Guinea,
and radically identical with the Polynesian race. The conclu-
sion is not in itself highly improbable, but certainly premature,
as the facts upon which it is built are so scanty and doubtful as
to authorize no such structure. On an island of the vast size of
Borneo, races radically distinct might exist ; and at any rate, the
opposite conclusion is hardly justifiable, from the specimens of
language or the physical appearance of the tribes of the southern
portion of the country. We have Malay authority for believing
that there are many large tribes in the interior, differing greatly
in their degree of civilization, though all alike removed from the
vicinity of a superior people. We have the Dyaks of the south ;
the Idaan of the north ; the Kagins ; and a race little better than
monkeys, who live in trees, eat without cooking, are hunted by
the other tribes, and would seem to exist in the lowest conceiv-
able grade of humanity. If we may trust these accounts, these
latter people resemble in many particulars the Orang Benua, or
aborigines of the peninsula ; but the Dyaks and Idaans are far
superior, living in villages, cultivating the ground, and possessing
cattle. Beside these, likewise, we have the names of several
other tribes or people ; and, in all probability, many exist in the
interior with whom we are unacquainted.
There are strong reasons for believing that the Hindoo religion,
which obtained so extensively in Java and Sumatra, and yet sur-
vives at Bali and Lombock, was likewise extended to Borneo ;
and some authors have conceived grounds for supposing a religion
anterior even to this. If only a portion of these floating opinions
should be true, and the. truth can only be tested by inquiry, we
may fairly look for the descendants of the Hindoo dynasty as well
as an aboriginal people. It never seems to have occurred to any
one to compare the Dyaks with the people of Bali and Lornbock.
We know indeed but little of the. former; but both races are fair,
good-looking, and gentle. Again, respecting the concluded iden-
tity of the Dyaks and the Arafuras, it is clear we have a very lim-
ited knowledge indeed of the former; and, I may ask, what do
we know of the Arafuras ?
In short, I feel as Hurtant to embrace any preconceived I henry
APl'KNOIX. 379
as I am to adopt the prevailing notion on this subject ; for it re-
quires a mass of facts, of which we are wholly deficient, to arrive
at anything approaching a reasonable conclusion. To return,
however, to the proceedings of the Royalist, I would remark, that
it depends greatly on the time passed in Malludu Bay whether
mir next endeavor be prosecutea at Abai on the western, or Tu-
san Abai on the eastern coast. The object in visiting Abai would
be chiefly to penetrate to the lake, which, on the authority of Dal-
rymple and Burton, is not far distant thence, by a water commu-
nication ; but should any success have attended similar efforts
from Malludu Bay, this project will be needless, as in that case
the enterprise will have been prosecuted to the westward, and
reach to the vicinity of Abai. As Kaminis is the limit of the Brit-
ish territory to the westward, so Point Kaniungan, situated to the
southward of the bay of Sandakan, forms the eastern boundary ;
and a line drawn from coast to coast between these points is rep-
resented as including our possessions. A reference to the .chart
will show the extent to be considerable ; and the eastern coast
from Malludu Bay to Point Kaniungan is so very little known,
that it is highly desirable to become acquainted with its general
features and conformation, and to seek thence the means of gain-
ing an inlet into the interior, should it be denied at Malludu Bay.
The reported proximity of Kini Ballu to Malludu Bay, and like-
wise to Abai would (supposing it is anything like the size it is
affirmed to be) lead us to expect that it cannot be far distant from
the eastern coast ; and it is but reasonable to conclude that some
rivers or streams discharge themselves into the sea in the numer-
ous indentations that abound on this shore. However this may
be, the coast, with its bays and islands and bold headlands, is one
of great interest, and almost unknown ; and the careful inspec-
tion of it as far as Point Kaniungan will, I trust, add something
to our knowledge. The longitude of Point Kaniungan and Point
Unsang will likewise determine the eastern extremity of Borneo.
Much more might be added on this topic, especially of the
reported communication by a line of lakes from Malludu Bay to
Banjarrnassim, which, if true, would in all probability place some
of these lakes near particular points of the east coast, as the
whole line, from the relative position of the two extremes, must
be on the eastern side of the island. These reports, and the vari-
ous surmises which arise from them, are rather matters for verifi-
cation than discussion ; and I will therefore only add that, tempted
by success, I shall not devote less than a year and a half to this
object ; but, in case of finding a sickly climate, or meeting with a
decidedly hostile population, I shall more easily abandon the field,
and turn to others of not less interest, and perhaps of less risk.
Equal to Borneo in riches, and superior in picturesque beauty
to any part of the Archipelago, is the large and eccentric country
of the Bugis, called Celebes. So deep are the indentations of its
coasts, that the island may be pronounced as being composed of
a succession of peninsulas, nearly uniting in a common center in
the district of Palos ; and thus, by the proximity of every part to
the sea, offering great facilities for brief and decisive interior ex-
380 Al'PENDJX.
cursions. The Dutch are in possession of Makassar, and had
formerly settlements on the northwest coast and in the bay oi
Sawa. Their power appears, however, never to have been very
extensively acknowledged ; and at present I have not been able
to meet with any account of the condition of their factories. This
information will probably be gained at Singapore. Avoiding the
Dutch settlements, I propose limiting my inquiries to the northern
and northeastern portion of the island, more especially the great
bay of Gunong Telia. It is impossible to state here the direction
of these inquiries, or any definite object to which they should
be turned, as I am acquainted with no author who speaks of the
country, save in a general and vague manner. It is reported as
rich, fertile, mountainous, strikingly beautiful, and possessed of
rivers ; abounding in birds, and inhabited, like Borneo, by wild
tribes in the interior, and by the Bugis on the sea-shores and en-
trance of rivers. The character of the Bugis, though so variously
represented, gives me strong hopes of rendering them, by care
and kindness, useful instruments in the prosecution of these re-
searches ; for all writers agree that they are active, hardy, enter-
prising, arid commercial ; and it is seldom that a people possessing
such characteristics are deaf to the suggestions of self-interest or
kindly feeling. The arrogance, and especially the indolence, of
the IVI alays, counteracts the influence of these strong incentives ;
and the impulse which governs such rude tribes as the Dyaks
and Arafuras is a dangerous weapon, which cuts all ways, and
often when least anticipated. The Badjows, or sea-gipsys, are
another race on whom some dependence may be placed. Mr.
Earl, who had a personal acquaintance with this tribe, and could
speak their language, always expressed to me a degree of confi-
dence in their good faith, which must have had some grounds.
1 may here conclude the first stage of the expedition, during
the progress of which the head-quarters will be fixed at Singapore.
During some of the intervals I hope to see Manilla, and to acquire
a cursory knowledge of the unexplored tract at the southern ex-
tremity of Celebes, called in Norie's general chart the Tiger
Islands.
The time devoted to the objects above mentioned must, as 1
have before said, be regulated by the degree of fortune which
attends them ; for, cheered by success, I should not readily aban-
don the field ; yet, if persecuted by climate, or other serious det-
riments, I shall frequently shift the ground, to remove myself
beyond such evil influence. It is scarcely needful to continue a
detail of projects so distant, having already carved out for myself
a work which I should be proud to perform, and which is already
as extended as the chances of human life and human resolves
will warrant. The continuation of the voyage would lead me to
take the Royalist to Timor or Port Essington, thence making
excursions to the Arru Isles, Timor Laut, and the southern shores
of New Guinea. That part of the coast contiguous to Torres
Straits I am particularly desirous of visiting ; as it has been sug-
gested to me by Mr. Earl, and I think with reason, that a better
channel than the one we are at present acquainted with may be
APPENDIX. 881
ound there. That such a channel exists, and will he discovered
when the coast is surveyed, I entertain but little douht ; but the
navigation is hazardous, and must, from the westward, be
attempted with great caution.
My own proceedings must, of course, be regulated by the dis-
coveries previously made by Captain Wickham or others ; and as
this gentleman has orders to survey Torres Straits, the field may
be well trodden before I reach it. The rest of the voyage I shall
consider as one merely of pleasure, combining such utility as cir-
cumstances will permit. It is probable that I shall visit our
Australian settlements ; glance at the islands of the Pacific ; and
return to Europe round Cape Horn. Before concluding, I may
observe, that there are points of inquiry which may be useful to
the studies of the learned, which (provided the process be mod-
erately simple) I shall be willing to make, and I shall always be
happy to receive any directions or suggestions regarding them. 1
allude to observations on the tides, to geology, to the branches of
natural history, &c. &c., for the general inquirer often neglects
or overlooks highly interesting facts, from his attention not having
been called to them. The specimens of natural history will be
forwarded home on every visit to Singapore ; and the information
will be sent to the Geographical Society, and may always, if it be
of any value, be used as freely as it is communicated. In like
manner, the objects of natural history will be open to any person
who is at all interested in such pursuits. I cannot but express
my regret, that from pecuniary considerations as well as the small
size of the vessel, and the limited quantity of provisions she car-
ries, I am unable to take a naturalist and draughtsman ; but I
should always hail with pleasure any scientific person who joined
me abroad, or who happened to be in the countries at the time ;
and I may venture to promise him every encouragement and
facility in the prosecution of his pursuits. I embark upon the
expedition with great cheerfulness, with a stout vessel, a good
crew, and the ingredients of success as far as the limited scale of
the undertaking will permit ; and I cast myself upon the waters
like Mr. Southey's little book but whether the world will
know me after many days, is a question which, hoping the best, I
cannot answer with any positive degree of assurance
No. IV.
Sketch of Borneo, or Pulo Kalamantan.
By J. HUNT, Esq.
(Communicated, in 1812, to the Honorable Sir Thomas Stamford
Raffles, late Lieutenant-Governor of Java.)
THE island of Borneo extends from 7 7' north to 4 12' south
latitude, and from 108 45' to 119 25' east longitude ; measuring
at its extreme length nine hundred miles, at its greatest breadth
382 APPENDIX.
seven hundred, and in circumference three thousand. It is
bounded on the north by the Solo seas, on the east by the Straits
of Macassar, on the south by the Java, and on the west by the
China seas. Situated in the track of the most extensive and val-
uable commerce, intersected on all sides with deep and navigable
rivers, indented with safe and capacious harbors, possessing one
of the richest soils on the globe, abounding in all the necessaries
of human life, and boasting commercial products that have in all
ages excited the avarice and stimulated the desires of mankind,
with the exception of New Holland, it is the largest island
known. Of the existence of this extensive territory, so highly
favored by Providence, and enriched by the choicest productions
of nature, there remains scarce a vestige in the geographical de-
scriptions of the day ; and its rich products and fertile shores, by
one tacit and universal consent, appear abandoned by all the
European nations of the present age, and handed over to the rav-
ages of extensive hordes of piratical banditti, solely intent on
plunder and desolation.
The natives and the Malays, formerly, and even at this day,
call this large island by the exclusive name of Pulo Kalamantan,
from a sour and indigenous fruit so called. Borneo was the name
only of a city, the capital of one of the three distinct kingdoms
on the island. When Magalhaens visited it in the year 1520, he
saw a rich and populous city, a luxuriant and fertile country, a
powerful prince, and a magnificent court : hence the Spaniards
hastily concluded that the whole island not only belonged to this
prince, but that it was likewise named Borneo. In this error
they have been followed by all other European nations. The
charts, however, mark this capital " Borneo Proper," or in other
words, the only place properly Borneo : this is the only confession
of this misnomer that I have met with among Europeans. The
natives pronounce Borneo, Bruni, and say it is derived from the
word Brani, courageous ; the aboriginal natives within this district
having ever remained unconquered.
The aborigines of Borneo, or Pulo Kalamantan, still exist in
the interior in considerable numbers ; there are various tribes of
them, speaking different dialects. Some of them acknowledge
Malay chiefs, as at Landa, Songo, Mantan, &c. Several com-
munities of them still remain under independent chiefs of their
own nation ; and everywhere their origin, their language, their
religion, their manners and customs, are totally distinct and ap-
parent from those of the Islams, or Malays, who have settled on
the island. About Ppntiana and Sambas they are called Dayers ;
at Benjarmasing, Biajus ; at Borneo Proper, Moruts; farther
northward, Orang Idan. Their original history is as much envel-
oped in obscurity as that of the Monocaboes of Malaya, the
Rejangs and Battas of Sumatra, or the Togals of the Philippines.
On a nearer acquaintance with their language, customs, traditions,
&c., perhaps an affinity in origin may be discovered among all
the original possessors of the Eastern isles. The Moruts and
Orang Idan are much fairer and better featured than the Malays,
of a more strong and robust frame, and havo thr r rod it of boiug a
APPENDIX. 383
brave race of people. The Dayer is much darker, and approaches
nearer in resemblance to the Malay. The Biajus I never saw.
The few particulars which I have been able to collect of these
people I shall briefly state : They live in miserable small huts ;
their sole dress consists of a slight wrapper round their waists,
sometimes made of bark, at others from skins of animals, or per-
haps of blue or white cloth ; they eat rice or roots, and indeed
any description of food, whether beast, reptile, or vermin : they
are extremely filthy ; this and bad food give them a cutaneous
disorder, with which they are very generally afflicted. Several
tribes of them smear themselves with oil and pigments, which
gives them the appearance of being tattooed. Whether this is
intended to defena them against the bites of insects, to operate as
a cure or prevention of this epidemic, or to adorn their persons, I
cannot take upon me to decide. They believe, it is said, in a Su-
preme Being, and offer sacrifices of gratitude to a beneficent
Deity. Polygamy is not allowed among them ; no man has more
than one wife ; they burn their dead. They are said to shoot pois-
oned balls or arrows through hollow tubes ; and whenever they kill
a man, they preserve the skull to exhibit as a trophy to commemo-
rate the achievement of their arms. They are said to have no mode
of communicating their ideas by characters or writing, like the
Battas. Driven from the sea-coast of Borneo into the mountains
and fastnesses in the interior, they are more occupied in the chase
and the pursuits of husbandry than in commerce. They, however,
barter their inland produce of camphor, gold, diamonds, birds'-
nests, wax, and cattle, for salt (which they hold in the highest
degree of estimation, eating it with as much gout as we do sugar),
china, porcelain, brass and iron cooking utensils, brass bracelets,
coarse blue and white cloth, Java tobacco, arrack (which they
also like), parangs, hardware, beads, &c. Some tribes of them
are said to pull out their front teeth and substitute others of gold,
and others adorn themselves with tigers' teeth. The greatest
numbers and most considerable bodies of these men are found
near Kiney Balu and about Borneo Proper.
The Malays represent them as the most savage and ferocious
of men ; but to be more savage or ferocious than a Malay is a
thing utterly impossible. Their representations may be account-
ed for. These aborigines have always evinced a strong disposi-
tion and predilection for liberty and freedom ; they have either
resisted the yoke of the Malay, or have retired to their mountains
to enjoy this greatest of all human blessings. The Malay, unable
to conquer them, lays plans for kidnapping as many as he can
fall in with. Every Dyak so taken is made a slave of, his chil-
dren sold, and his women violated. The Malay, hence, is justly
considered by them as the violator of every law, human and divine ;
and whenever any of these people meet with one, they satiate
their vengeance, and destroy him as the enemy of their race, and
as a monster of the human kind. The Portuguese missionaries
found these people very tractable converts, and very large bodies
of them are very easily governed by a single Malay chief, as at
Landa, Songo, and Matan. I have seen very largo bodies of them
384 APPENDIX.
at Kimanis and Maludu, but none of them possessing the ferocity
of a Malay.
The Islams, or Malayans, who now possess the sea-coasts of
Borneo (as well as the sea-coasts of all the Eastern islands), are
said to be colonies from Malacca, Johore, &c., planted in the
fourteenth century ; at this period, according to Mr. Poivre, " Ma-
lacca was a country well peopled, and was consequently well
cultivated. This nation was once one of the greatest powers in
the Eastern seas, and made a very considerable figure in the thea-
ter of Asia; they colonized Borneo, Celebes, Macassar, Moluccas,
&c." The Malays on Borneo are like the Malays everywhere
else, the most atrocious race of beings on the earth ; and from
their general character, and imprudent institutions, both political
and religious, are fast moldering in self-decay, or mutual destruc-
tion.
From the earliest date that I have been able to trace, the island
of Borneo was always divided into three distinct kingdoms. The
kingdom of Borneo, properly so called, extended from Tanjong
Dato, in latitude 3 15' north, to Kanukungan point, in the Straits
of Macassar, 1 15' north, which included the whole north part
of the island. The kingdom of Sukadana (from suka, happiness,
and dunia, the world, or earthly paradise), extending from Tanjong
Dato to Tanjong Sambar. which belonged to the King of Bantam
(when or how acquired I have not learned) : and the remainder
of the island from Tanjong Sambar to Kanukungan Point afore-
said, to the kingdom of Benjarmasing (from bendar, a port of
trade, and masing, usual, or the ordinary port of trade).
When the Portuguese first visited Borneo, in 1520, the whole-
island was in a most flourishing state. The numbers of Chinese
that had settled on her shores were immense ; the products of
their industry, and an extensive commerce with China in junks,
gave her land and cities a far different aspect from her dreary
appearance at this day, and their princes and courts exhibited
a splendor and displayed a magnificence which has long since
vanished.
Pigofetta says there were twenty-five thousand houses in the
city of Borneo Proper, and that it was rich and populous. Much
later accounts describe the numbers of Chinese and Japanese
junks frequenting her ports as great ; but in 1809 there were not,
three thousand houses in the whole city, nor six thousand Chi-
nese throughout that kingdom, and not a junk that had visited
it for years. But the ports of Borneo have not dwindled away
more than Acheen, Johore, Malacca, Bantam, Ternate, &c. All
these places likewise cut a splendid figure in the eyes of our
first navigators, and have since equally shared a proportionate
obscurity.
Were the causes required which have eclipsed the prosperity
of Borneo and the other great emporiums of Eastern trade that
once existed, it might be readily ansvvered a decay of com-
merce. They have suffered the same vicissitudes as Tyre, Sidon,
or Alexandria; and like Carthage for ages the emporium of the
wpalth and commerce 1 of top world, which now exhibit? on its
Al'l'UNDlX. 'ii>
site a piratical race of descendants in the modern Tunisians and
their neighbors the Algerines the commercial ports of Borneo
have become a nest of banditti, and the original inhabitants of
both, from similar causes the decay of commerce have degen-
erated to the modern pirates of the present day.
In exact proportion as the intercourse of the Europeans with
China has increased, in precise ratio has the decrease of their
direct trade in junks become apparent. The Portuguese first,
and subsequently the Dutch, mistress of the Eastern seas, exacted
by treaties and other ways the Malay produce at their own rates,
and were consequently enabled to undersell the junks in China.
But these powers went further ; by settling at ports on Borneo,
or by their guardas de costas, they compelled the ports of Borneo
to send their produce, calculated for the China market, to Ma-
lacca and Batavia, which at length completely cut up the direct
trade by means of the Chinese junks.
The loss of their direct intercourse with China affected their
prosperity in a variety of ways. First, by this circuitous direc-
tion of their trade, the gruff goods, as rattans, sago, cassia, pep-
per, ebony, wax, &c., became too expensive to fetch the value
of this double carriage and the attendant charges, and in course
of time were neglected ; the loss of these extensive branches of
industry must have thrown numbers out of employment. But
the loss of the direct intercourse with China had more fatal
effects ; it prevented large bodies of annual emigrants from China
settling upon her shores ; it deprived them of an opportunity of
visiting the Borneon ports, and exercising their mechanical arts
and productive industry ; and of thus keeping up the prosperity
of the country in the tillage of the ground, as well as in the com-
merce of her ports. The old Chinese settlers by degrees deserted
these shores ; and to fill up the chasms in their revenues by so
fatal a change, the rajahs have been tempted to turn their views
to predatory habits, and have permitted their lands to run to
jungle, by dragging their wretched laborers from agricultural
employments to maritime and piratical enterprises.
The first material alteration in the sovereignty of the territorial
possession took place in the kingdom of Borneo Proper, when
her rajah was obliged to call in the aid of the Solos to defend him
against an insurrection of the Maruts and Chinese. In consider-
ation of this important aid, the Rajah of Borneo Proper ceded
to the Sultan of Solo all that portion of Borneo then belonging
to him, from Kimanis, in latitude 5 30' north, to Tapean-durian,
in the Straits of Macassar, which includes the whole north of
Borneo. After this period, the power and fortunes of the Sultan
of Solo rapidly declined. The Spaniards succeeded in conquer-
ing all their islands. Solo, the capital, was taken and fortified ;
the sultan and his court made prisoners. When the English
captured Manilla, they found this sultan incarcerated. They
agreed to relieve him from prison, and reinstate him on the mus-
nud of his forefathers under tho express stipulation that the
whole of the aforesaid territory of Borneo, ceded to Solo by the
rajah of that kingdom, should be transferred to the English East
25 KK
386 APPENDIX.
India Company, together with the south of Palawan, and the
intermediate islands. These terms were joyfully acceded to by
the Sultan of Solo, and signed, sealed, and delivered by him to
the late Alexander Dalryrnple, in the year 1763.
The kingdom of Sukadana was ceded by the Rajah of Bantam
(in what year I know not) to the Dutch East India Company.
Whether the kingdom of Benjarmasing was ever actually ceded
to the Dutch or not, 1 have not been able to learn. But the oc-
cupancy of her capital, the military government of the country,
by the erection of forts, and a permanent standing force, since
transferred to the English arms, give to the East India Company,
actually or virtually, the entire sovereignty and rule over the
whole of this large island, with the exception of the piratical
port of Borneo Proper, and the portion of territory yet annexed
thereto.
The Portuguese, at a very early period, established themselves
at Benjarmasing : at Borneo Proper there still remain two bas-
tions and a curtain of a regular stone fort built by them: they
had also one on the island of Laboan, since destroyed. They
fixed themselves at old Sambas, from which they were driven by
the Dutch in the year 1690, and nearly about this period from al!
their establishments on Borneo.
When, or from what causes, the Dutch were induced to evac-
uate Sambas, I know not, nor have I learned the period when
they fortified themselves at Benjarmasing and Pasir, but believe
it could not have taken place before the middle of the last cen-
tury. They, however, settled at Pontiana in 1786, and built a
fortified wall round the palace and factory, but were compelled
to withdraw from it when the war broke out with the English in
1796. The ports at Benjarmasing, when evacuated, were sold
by the Dutch to the sultan, and are since said to have been re-
purchased from him by the English. The Dutch obtaining the
cession of the kingdom of Sukadana from the Rajah of Bantam,
and their subsequent measures in different parts of this territory,
will show that they had extensive views of firmly establishing
themselves on this island ; and waking from an age of lethargy,
at last began to see the great advantages and unbounded resources
these rich possessions were capable of affording them, without
any cost or expense whatever. The year they withdrew from
Pontiana they had it in contemplation to take repossession of
Sambas, and to unite all the ports, as well as the interior, under
the Rajah of Pontiana, in trust for them. Some letters to this
effect were written by the Dutch government to the late rajah.
That the English were not insensible to the value and impor-
tance of the once valuable commerce of Borneo may be inferred
not only from the number of the Honorable Company's regular
ships annually dispatched to her ports prior to the year 1760 (vide
Hardy's Shipping Register), but from the efforts they have re-
peatedly made to establish themselves on her shores. There still
exist the remains of a British factory at Borneo Proper. Before
ar 1706, they had iiiM'lf two successive 1 atlcmpts lo fortify
nrnnrm:r in
APPENDIX. 387
lishment on the sickly island of Balambangan (lying north of
Borneo, near Maludu) ; and in 1775, the Honorable Company's
ship Bridgewater was sent to Pasir with similar views.
The failure of these British attempts, as well as the exclusion
of all other powers from the ports of Borneo, may be principally
attributed to the sordid desire of the Dutch of monopolizing the
whole produce of the Eastern Archipelago, and their rooted jeal-
ousy in opposing the establishment of every other power in the
vicinity of Java, or that of the Spice Islands.
These considerations and feelings have induced them to commit
the most flagrant crimes, not only against the natives of these
regions, but against every European power. Their infamous
massacres at Amboyna, Banda, Bintam, &c., have been histori
cally recorded to their eternal disgrace. By their intrigues at
Benjarrnasing, the British attempts at a settlement twice failed ;
and Forrest, in his Voyage to New Guinea, says, that the Solos
were by Dutch instigation induced to cut off the infant establish-
ment of Balambangan, in 1775. They frustrated the attempts of
the Bridgewater at Pasir ; and even the massacre of the garrison
of Pulo Condore was effected by Javanese soldiers supplied by
the governor of Batavia. The English, from their strong desire
of having a port in the China seas, hastily pitched upon the most
unhealthy spots for that purpose, viz. Balambangan and Pulo
Condore.
The father of the present Sultan of Pontiana was the descend
ant of an Arab, residing at Simpan, near Matan. By the advice
and concurrence of the Dutch he was induced, about forty- two
years ago, to settle on the unfrequented shores of the river Pon-
tiana, or Quallo Londa, with promises of early cooperation and
assistance, as well as of rendering it the mart of the trade and
capital of all Sukadana. As soon as Abdul Ramman (the name
of the first sultan) had succeeded in attracting around him several
Chinese, Buguese, and Malay settlers, and in building a town,
the Dutch (in 1786) came with two armed brigs and fifty troops
to establish their factory. To make good their promises to Abdul
Ramman (the treaty I have never seen), they immediately over-
threw the chief of Mompava, and gave his country in trust to this
ally: they shortly after invested the ancient city of Sukadana,
burned it to the ground, transferred the inhabitants to Pontiana,
or dispersed them and their chief into the interior. The Dutch
likewise placed the present rajas on the musnuds of Songo, Landa,
&c., and kept up a force at the former, with the express stipula-
tion that the whole of their produce should be sent from each of
their respective districts to the Dutch factory of Pontiana. They
had it in contemplation, in 1795, to take repossession of Sambas,
and wrote to Abdul Ramman as to the preparatory measures re-
quisite, when the English war, as before observed, obliged them
to abandon Pontiana.
This Abdul Ramman, the first sultan or chief of Pontiana, reigned
thirty-five years, and died in 1807, leaving his eldest son, the pres-
ent Sultan Kasim, now forty-six years of age, his successor ; who
has a second brother, called Pangeran Marko, aged thirty-eight,
:388 APPENDIX.
and Pangeran Hosman, thirty-six years, beside lour sisters, one
of whom married the present Rajah of Matan. and about seventy
half brothers and sisters, the natural children of his father, with
an extensive sub-progeny. The present sultan has three sons
(Abibuker, heir-apparent, twenty-one years old, Ali, and Abdul
Ramman), and four daughters, lawfully begotten. None of the
royal family make use of either opium, betel, or tobacco, in any
shape whatever ; and the present sultan has much the appearance
of an Arab. The grandfather of the present sultan was from
Arabia, a Sayed Suriff; one of his relations was fixed at Palim-
bang, whose name is unknown to me, and the other, Shad Fud-
yel, at Acheen, who has been long dead.
The wet season commences from September, and ends in April,
when heavy rain, hard squalls, and much thunder and lightning
are experienced. From April till September is called the dry
season, but even in this portion of the year seldom a day elapses
without a smart shower or two. The monsoons on the northerly
shores of Borneo are found to correspond with those prevalent in
the China seas, viz. from the N.E. from October to April, and
from the S.W. the rest of the year. To the southward, about
Benjarmasing, the monsoons are the same as in the Java seas,
. e. westerly from October to April, and easterly the rest of the
year. Those parts of Borneo near or upon the equator have vari-
able winds all the year, and land and sea breezes close in shore.
This country is by no means so warm as one would he led to
imagine by its proximity everywhere to the line : this arises from
the perpetual refreshing showers and the land and sea breezes,
the former being wafted over innumerable rivers. In the month
of November, the thermometer at Pontiana ranges from 78 to 82.
During the wet season, the rivers swell and overflow the adja-
cent shores, and run down with such continued rapidity, that the
water may be tasted fresh at sea at the distance of six or seven
miles from the mouths: these overflowings fertilize the banks
and adjacent country, and render the shores of Borneo, like the
plains of Egypt, luxuriantly rich. Susceptible of the highest pos-
sible culture, particularly in wet grain, in the dry season the coast,
from these overflowings, presents to the eye the richest enameled
fields of full grown grass for miles around. It is at this season
that, whole herds of wild cattle range down from the mountains
in the interior to fatten on the plains, but during the wet season
they ascend to their hills.
The whole of the north, the northwest, and the center of Bor-
neo is extremely mountainous. The greatest portion of the
ancient kingdom of Borneo Proper is extremely elevated. That
of Kiney Baulu, or St. Peter's Mount, in latitude C north, is
perhaps one of the highest mountains known. The country abou t
Sambas, Pontiana, and Sukadaua is occasionally interspersed
with a few ranges of hills, otherwise the land here might be
deemed low. But to the southward, and more particularly to the
east, in the Straits of Macassar, it is very low. The shore in
these latter places is extremely moist and swampy, but. tin 1 inte-
rior is said to be dry.
APPENDIX. 389
The common charis of Borneo will show the innumerable rivers
that water this vast island in every possible direction ; but it is
worthy of remark, that all the principal rivers on this island have
their main source in a large lake in the vicinity of that stupendous
mountain before mentioned, Kiney Baulu. The river Benjarma-
sing takes its rise from thence, and after traversing in all its
windings a distance of 1500 miles, intersecting the island into two
parts, falls into the Java sea. Its rise and fall is said to be twelve
feet, and it has only nine feet at low water on the bar. It is said
to have numberless villages scattered on its banks ; but I have
obtained no particular accounts of them, or their produce.
The great river of Borneo Proper is certainly the finest on the
island. It is a deep, navigable, and majestic stream ; it has three
fathoms upon the bar at low water ; the rise and fall is, I believe,
fifteen feet ; there are docks here for Chinese junks of rive or six
hundred tons, and a first-rate ship of war might get up far above
the town. The country, too, is populous, productive, and healthy.
The southern branch of this river has been well surveyed, but the
branch leading to the Marut country is little known ; it has its
source in Kiney Baulu.
In the ancient kingdom of Sukadana, the five principal rivers
are the Sukadana, the Lava, the Pogore, the Pontiana, and the
Sambas. The former rivers communicate inland, and their main
source is in Kiney Baulu. The whole of these rivers are deep
and navigable for seventy or eighty miles ; but have all of them
mud flats at their mouths, which would not admit of the entry of
vessels exceeding fourteen feet at high water springs.
The third most considerable river on Borneo is the Kinabatan-
gan, lying in the north of the island, and emptying itself into the
Sulo seas. It is said to be deep and navigable much farther than
the Benjarmasing river ; it has several mouths, but it has never
been surveyed. The rivers Kuran, Pasir, and a variety of others
that fall into the Straits of Macassar, are said to be noble streams,
navigable for vessels of large burthen ; but I have no accurate in-
formation of them. The harbor of Sandakan is one of the finest
in the world : a correct chart of the same is published. The har-
bor of Tambisan, near Cape Unsing, is equal to Pulo Pinang, and
calculated for careening and building ships ; a tolerable chart of
these is also published. The harbors of Palo Laut, Punangan,
Maludu, and several others in the Straits of Macassar, afford good
anchorage and complete shelter for shipping.
Situated as Borneo is, immediately under the equator, everything
that can be produced in vegetation by the combined influence of
heat and moisture is here displayed in the highest luxuriance and
super-excellence. All the Oriental palms, as the cocoa-nut, the
areca, the sago, &c., abound here. The larger grasses, as the
bamboo, the canna, the nardus, assume a stately growth, and
thrive in peculiar luxuriance. Pepper is found wild everywhere,
and largely cultivated about Benjarmasing and the districts of
Borneo Proper. The laurus cinnamomum and cassia odoriferata are
produced in abundance about Kimanis. In no part of the world
iloos the camphor-tree flourish in equal perfection as in the dis-
KX9
390 A IT K \D ix.
tricts of Maludu and Fay ton, in the north of Borneo. The ebony,
the dammar, the tree that yields the finest dragon's blood in the
world, all abound here. The cotton and coffee trees are found in
all parts of Borneo, though not much attended to. The chocolate
nut of Sulo is preferred at Manilla to that from South America.
The tree that yields the clove-bark, and the nutmeg, and clove,
thrive luxuriantly, though never tried to any extent.
The woods about Pontiana for carpentry and joinery, are kayu
oulean, chena, mintangore, laban, ebony, iron-wood, dammar, and
dammar laut, &c. &c. The pine abounds in the bay of Maludu,
teak at Sulo. The fruit-bearing trees which enrich and adorn
the Indian continent, offer, on the B-orneon shore, all their kin-
dred varieties, nurtured by the bountiful hand of luxuriant nature.
The durian, mangustin, rambutan, proya, chabi, kachang, timon,
jambu, kniban, beside the nanka or jack, tamarind, pomplemose,
orange, lemon, and citron, all the kindred varieties of the plan-
tain, banana, melon, annanas, pomegranate, &c., are found on
Borneo.
The garden-stuffs met with are onions, garlic, yams, pumpkins,
brinjals, greens, beans, cucumbers ; and turnips, cabbages, and
potatoes would succeed, were there Europeans to attend to them.
The elephant was said to be seen about Cape Unsing, where
several teeth are still found ; but it is conceived this animal is
extinct on the island. There are no dromedaries nor camels ;
nor are horses, asses, or mules met with on Borneo (the former
are seen at Sulo). None of the larger breed of the feline species
are found here, as the lion, tiger, leopard ; nor the bear, the wolf,
the fox, nor even a jackal, or dog, that 1 ever saw. The ourang-
outang, or the man of the woods, is the most singular animal
found in these regions. The rivers swarm with alligators, and
the woods with every variety of the monkey tribe. The names
of other animals on Borneo are the bodpk or rhinoceros, pelando
or rabbit, rusa or stag, kijang or doe, minjagon, babi utan or wild
hog, tingileng, bintangan, &c. There are buffaloes, goats, bull-
ocks, hogs, beside the rat and mouse species ; a dog 1 never saw
on Borneo.
There are few snakes on the sea-coast, owing to the moisture ;
plenty, however, are found in the interior. The musketoe, the
fly, the frog, and the noisy beetle, with other insects and vermin
found in Malay countries, abound here.
The coasts and rivers abound with excellent and wholesome
fish in the greatest variety, and of the most delicious flavors ; but
such is the miserable state of society, that few Malays have either
the inclination or the inducement to venture beyond the mouths
of their rivers in quest of them ; and even there they are more in-
debted to the industry of the Chinese with their fishing-stakes
than to their own labor for the supply of their markets. The
names of their fish are, the kakab, klabaw, jilawat, lai-is, pattain,
udang or prawn, shrimp, talang, sinanging, bawan, rowan, tay-
laon, duri, bleda, tingairy, alu-alu, pako, jumpul, pari or skait,
boli ayam, tamban or shad, belut or eel, iyu or shark, lida or sole,
batu batu, kabab batu, klaoi, krang or cockle, tiram or oyster,
APPENDIX. 391
tipy and lapis pearl oysters, cupang or muscle, all the varieties of
the turtle, with several other sorts.
The ornithology of Borneo is somewhat limited. There are
the bayan, nuri, dara, pepit or sparrow, tukukur or turtle-dove,
herkey, kandang, kiridi, gogaw or crow, seyrindit, layang or swal-
low, kalilawan. The Chinese rear ducks ; the tame fowl abounds ;
but the turkey, goose, and peafowl are seldom met with.
The principal gold mines on Borneo are in the vicinity of Sam-
bas. There is a mountain called Guning Pandan, about eighty
miles inland ; from this branch out three rivers one leads to
Mornpava, one to Batu Bulat near Tanjong Mora, and one to
Landa ; the whole intermediate area between the above rivers is
of a firm yellow argillaceous schistus, or ferruginous quartz, inter-
spersed with horn and vitreous ores, of a remarkable dark reddish
color, abounding with the richest veins of gold, and equal if not
superior to any mine extant. There are only fifty parets or mines
now wrought in the whole kingdom of Sukadana, thirty of which
are in the Sambas district, each mine having at least three hun-
dred men, Chinese, employed in them. Their pay, one with an-
other, is four dollars per mensem.
The mines are rented from the rajah at the rate of fifty bunkals
of gold per mine per annum, beside a capitation tax of three dol-
lars per head on every Chinaman. There are thirty thousand
Chinese in the Sambas districts, and they feel themselves strong
enough to oppose or evade this tax ; it hence becomes a perpetual
contest between greedy extortion on the one side, and avaricious
chicane on the other ; there are beside about twelve thousand
Malays and Dayers.
The Laurat gold mines are situated to the eastward of the town
of Sambas, and are particularly rich and productive. The mines
of Siminis are one day's journey from Sambas, up a small creek
leading from Sambas river, below the town ; and the mines are
abundant. Salako is up a river fifteen miles south of the Sambas
river ; it lies nearly forty miles up, but communicates with Sam-
bas by another river : here the metal is found more abundant than
anywhere else ; and twenty thousand Chinese are found in this
district. Mantrado is three days' journey up the Mompava river ;
it is under an independent Malay prince. Some accounts make
the population of this district great, near fifty thousand Dayers,
Malays, and Chinese ; but perhaps half the number may be nearer
the truth ; these are chiefly employed on the gold mines, and in
producing food for the miners ; these mines, however, do not pro-
duce that quantity which they might under Chinese management.
Mandore is about a day's journey from Pontiana, and belongs to
the sultan ; it is reckoneda very rich mine, though but recently
wrought. There are as yet only twelve parets of about two hun-
dred men each, but it is capable of extension. Likewise are
found in this district some very rich specimens of copper ore ; it
has not as yet been wrought, gold being deemed a much more
productive article. The sultan wishes, however, he had some
boring utensils and an experienced miner, to enable-him to decide
whether it would be worth working under the peculiar circum-
tiy'J APPENDIX,
stances above mentioned. Numbers of Chinese aio set tied in this
district, and the population is annually increasing.
About three days' journey up the Pongole river lies the district
of Songo, with a population of twenty-five thousand souls, pay-
ers, and a few Chinese, under a Malay and an independent prince.
The population is chiefly employed on the rich mines of gold in
the neighborhood, which is particularly pure and abundant ; but
the mines are not wrought with the same industry as those under
Chinese management. The Dutch thought it of so much conse-
quence as to keep a force at Songo, and to place the present raiah-
on that musnud. About two days' journey farther up lies another
gold district, called Santam, the inhabitants of which are princi-
pally Dayers. Beyond Santam, and higher up on the same river,
lies the town of Sukadow, abounding in gold, the inhabitants of
which are also Dayers.
Matan belongs to the rajah of that name : he had the title of
Rajah of Sukadana, until driven out of the latter place by the
Dutch, seventeen years ago. There -are ten thousand Dayers in
this district, and a few Chinese and Malays. The mines of gold
are abundant, and capable of becoming highly productive, as well
as the mines of iron and unwrought tin ; but the sultan is much
addicted to the use of opium, and hence neglects a valuable coun-
try, capable, under better management, of becoming the most valu-
able district on all Borneo.
About three days' journey from Pontiana lies the celebrated
mountain of Landa, which, after Golconda, is the most valuable
diamond mine in the world. There are at least thirty thousand
people, principally Dayers, employed on the mines and agricul-
ture ; it belongs to a Malay prince, raised to that musnud twenty-
five years ago by the Dutch, through the agency of the present
Sultan of Pontiana : here also much gold is produced ; and much
more might be had under proper management.
There is a very valuable gold mine in the north of Borneo, at
a place called Tampasuk, situated in the district ceded to the
English by the Sultan of Sulo ; but having become the principal
pirate port on the coast, the working of the mines has been dis-
continued.
The whole produce of the gold mines of Sukadana is said to
be annually about twenty piculs, or a million of dollars, at twenty-
five dollars a bunkal ; but no calculation of this sort can possibly
be correct. Living, as the Chinese do, under the rapacity of
despotic and ferocious freebooters, who are actuated by no one
principle of honor, justice, or good faith, it is their interest to con-
ceal the riches they amass, not only to preserve themselves from
the clutches of these tyrants, but as the most compact substance
to transport to their native shores, to which they repair with the
fruits of their industry, by the annual junks that arrive at Pon-
tiana, leaving the mines to new settlers : from two to three hun-
dred leave Pontiana every year.
The standard of Slakovv gold at Pontiana is affixed at twenty-
three Spanish dollars the bunkal, of two dollars weight. Th&
Songo and Laurat is twenty-five dollars the said btmkal.
APPENDIX. 398
Not having had an opportunity to inspect any of the gold mineb
personally, 1 know not if the ores readily melt of themselves, or
whether they require the aid of any fluxes before they yield the
metal ; but I believe the principal attention of the miners is direct-
ed to the rich veins of pure native gold, and that no operation is
performed beyond that of pulverizing, and simple washing ; all
the gold about Pontiana being in dust, though some I have met
with in Borneo Proper was run into bars. About Landa, where
the diamonds are found, the whole of the stratum is observed to
be a clay of a red burnt appearance, nearly to the same degree as
that of burnt bricks, which gives to the rivers hereabouts a pecu-
liar tinge. Whether this has been formed by the action of sub-
terraneous fires, or is the effect of volcanoes or earthquakes, I
cannot decide ; the latter are said to be frequently felt at Pontiana
and at Sambas ; and the former are said to exist in the central
mountains of Borneo.
From the slovenly manner in which the diamonds are sought
for by the Dayers, they seldom collect them of a size exceeding
three or four carats weight each. When rough, the Landa dia-
mond has a white or yellow hue ; but none are found of that inky
and flinty tinge, so valuable in some of the Golconda diamonds.
But that Landa does produce them of a very considerable size,
the extensive and valuable specimens in Java, as well as the
quantities annually sent to Batavia, will evince. The King of
Matan is at this instant in possession of a diamond weighing 367
carats : the value of which, according to the old mode of calcu-
lation, would be (367 x 367 x 2 = 269,378/.) The Sultan of Pon-
tiana says, however, that a much larger price was offered for it
by the Dutch government of Java. He refused, it is said, twenty-
five laks of dollars, two sloops of rice, fifty pieces of cannon, and
a hundred muskets. Several from twenty to thirty carats have
been dug up. At Mompava there are said to be very rich copper
mines ; but from want of population, a vigorous government, and
scientific mineralogists, little is to be hoped from them at the
present day. At Pulo Bongorong, near Borneo Proper, there is
plenty of loadstone found.
About one degree north of Sambas there is a country called
Sarawak, belonging to the Rajah of Borneo Proper ; there is a
vast district abounding in tin, in veins as rich and as plentiful as
those wrought on Banca : but they have been neglected for a se-
ries of years ; they were partially wrought before those of the
latter were discovered, in the beginning of the last century. The
tyranny of that government, the want of hands, and the contiguity
of rich and valuable gold-mines, have together caused their utter
neglect ; and there is little probability of more favorable results,
except under a change of government, and a happier order of
things.
In the Matan districts there is an extensive and most valuable
iron-mine, producing pure metal without any admixture of ore : it
is fully equal in quality to the best Swedish iron. They run it
into shot, and much of it is exported ; but the gold-mines in its
vicinity, and the want of a proper government, are obstacles to its
394 A i-v i:\uix.
further productiveness and utility. Ai Maday, on tite northeast
coast of Borneo, in the province of Mangidara, there is a very rich
mine of gold. Pasir and Coti, in the Straits of Macassar, produce
considerable quantities of gold ; and gold and diamonds are
brought down by the river to Benjarmasing. I have, however,
no accurate information on the subject, and can simply note the
general fact.
There are several fine specimens of crystal found at Kimanis
and Sulo ; they call them water diamonds. To give full effect to
the mines in the kingdom of Sukadana, says the Sultan of Ponti-
ana, and to raise the excess of food required for the additional
hands, would together give employment to at least a million of
Chinese. Under the British flag, he thinks thousands of new
settlers will find their way in the annual junks.
All that extensive range, from Cape Unsing, passing by the
Tawi Tawi islands and Sulo, as far as Baselan, is one vast con-
tinued bed of pearl-oysters, principally of the Behoren or mother-
of-pearl-shell species ; these are called by the natives tipi. There
is likewise an extensive bed of the Ceylon oyster, called by the
Malays kapia ; the principal banks of the latter are found in Ma-
ludu Bay. The Sulo pearls have, from time immemorial, been
the most celebrated, and praised as the most valuable of any in
the known world. Pigofetta, the companion of Magalhaens,
mentions having seen in 1520 two Sulo pearls in the possession of
the Rajah of Borneo as large as pullet eggs. Very large ones,
from one to two hundred chaw weight, are at all times to be pur-
chased at Sulo ; and there are altogether sold here to the China
junks, the Spaniards, &c. more than two laks of dollars worth annu-
ally. The quantity of mother-of-pearl-shell, communibus annis, sold
there is two thousand piculs, at six dollars a picul. The fishery is
partly carried on by the Malays, and partly by the Chinese ; the
large pearls they endeavor to conceal as much as possible, from
a law that all pearls above a certain size of right belong to the
sultan. " The small narrow guts," says Dalrymple in his account
of the Sulo seas, " about Tawi Tawi, are the most rich and valu-
able fishery in the world." I have had an opportunity of inspect-
ing the banks about Manar and Tutacoryn, as well as all the
banks in the Sulo seas ; but the former have not banks near as
extensive, equaling in the quantity of oysters, in productiveness,
size, or richness, the Sulo pearl, nor are they to be compared in
any way to the Sulo beds. Still the Ceylon fishery has netted
the British Government from one to two laks of pagodas for
permitting it to be fished fourteen days annually. As this portion
of Borneo belongs to the English, a much greater revenue might
be drawn from these vast sources of wealth, under proper man-
agement.
As there are no people of sufficient opulence to contract for so
vast a fishery, the Company might undertake it themselves ; three
or four gun-boats would be necessary to protect the fishermen ;
and a small fort should be erected at Tambisan or Tawi Tawi.
But it is necessary to observe, the Sulo people do not practice
diving at all, as is the case at Beharen and Ceylon, but only com-
APPENDIX. H!*.')
prebend the slow method of dredging for the tipy with a thing
like the fluke of a wooden anchor. It would be a desirable thing,
in the event of prosecuting this valuable fishery as a national
concern, to obtain forty or fifty Arab divers from Beharen, and
perhaps an equal number of Chulias from Nagore and Negapa-
tam, from the number employed annually on the Ceylon fishery.
These men would teach the Malay the superiority of diving,
which can, in fourteen days' fishing, bring into government a rev-
enue of two laks df-pagodas, pay the expenses of the fishery, and
enrich all parties concerned ; while the Malayan operose plan of
dredging perhaps affords but a precarious subsistence. But had
they divers, from the extent of the banks, instead of fourteen days
in the year, they might, one after another, be fished the whole
year round, and never be exhausted. The Chinese fishermen,
though laborious, possess no enterprise, and can never be pre-
vailed on to dive, from apprehension of the sharks. The Caffris
from New Guinea and the Arroes would be superior to them.
The Sultan of Sulo, in 1810, proposed to me to bring over one
hundred Chulia divers from Negapatam on our joint expense and
profit : and the divers agreed to go over on receiving eacn twenty-
five rupees advance, their victuals being found, and one-fourth of
the produce of oysters allowed them, as at Ceylon. Circum-
stances, however, occurred to prevent an undertaking which I
think must have turned out highly lucrative. They dredge the
banks all the year round. The water on the Tahow, Maludu,
and Tawi Tawi banks, is from seven to ten fathoms deep ; in
other places they fish in fifteen fathoms water.
The Malays of Borneo understand the art of cutting, polishing,
and setting their diamonds. Gold and silver filagree works they
excel in ; gunpowder is manufactured at Pontiana ; brass cannon
is cast at Borneo Proper ; iron-shot is run from their mine. They
can manufacture and repair krises, and clean their arms. Their
carpentry extends to the building and repairing of prows, and the
erecting of a hut. Their industry is further exerted in collecting
birds'-nests and wax ; in cutting rattans and felling timber ; in
the pearl and tripan fisheries ; or as mariners in commercial or
piratical pursuits. The tillage of the ground and the edible fish-
eries are often left to the more indefatigable industry of the Chi-
nese. For the exercise of every other useful occupation also, the
mechanical and scientific arts, and the labor of the mines, these
indolent savages are indebted solely to the superior industry and
civilization of the Chinamen.
The amusements of the Malays in other parts are unpracticed
on the shores of Borneo : the only ones I ever saw were flying
the kite, swimming, and the songs of their women ; this latter is
confined to the rajahs.
Wherever a water-communication on Borneo presents, the
indolence of the Malay will not permit him to think of the con-
struction of a road. In the interior, however, there are pathways
in all directions ; about Mompava, where the river is narrow and
shallow, they have constructed several roads. Being a people
much occupied in maritime pursuits, they prefer, like the am-
396 APPENDIX.
phibious Dut>:h, traveling by rivers, or the innumerable cuts,
danals, and creeks, which everywhere intersect the country : be-
side, their prows afford more protection from surprise, and they
conceive their town as safer by being surrounded by a jungle and
situated in a swamp ; nor have they any conception beyond water-
carriage.
Their laws neither depend upon the Koran nor any written
code, human or divine, beyond the whim and caprice of the chief
(assassin) and his gang of desperadoes. The Sultan of Pontiana
has, however, established the following regulations :
Punishments for murder : Life for life, except when the par-
ties can commute the same by fine.
********
A proclamation is publicly affixed announcing the law, that if
any person be found adulterating gold-dust, or uttering it, so de-
preciated, with a view to defraud, the perpetrator shall lose his
right arm, and the adulterated gold shall be confiscated.
For theft : Five dollars per head is given by the sultan to any
one bringing in the head of a thief: if brought in alive, he is sus-
pended by the heels and flogged as far as nature can bear short of
death, and the punishment repeated ad libitum.
Prisoners taken from an enemy, whether found in arms or not,
are made slaves of, or suffer death, at the option of the captor.
The Malay government is said to exhibit the feudal system in
its most perfect form. The chief, or rajah, issues his orders to the
Pangerans, or princes of the blood ; to the Datus, or nobles of
royal descent ; or to the Orang Kayas, or wealthy vassals. All
these obey and follow him to war, free of expense, when the king
is sufficiently powerful to enforce it ; but whenever the vassal
feels himself strong enough to throw off the yoke, and to assert
his independence, he sets up for himself. These vassals exact
the same obedience from their slaves or villains, who pay the like
deference only so long as they are compelled to observe and obey
them. The property acquired by a slave he is often allowed to
enjoy unmolested during his lifetime ; but at his death, his master
administers to the estate as heir, executor, and sole legatee.
In fact, it is a government that inspires on all sides one univer-
sal distrust that rules by precedents of oppression without a
view to protection. The chiefs dread the power of their vassals,
who, in return, apprehend everything from the rapacity of the
governing power ; while the bulk of the people, having no prop-
erty to lose, are still compelled to appear abroad armed to defend
their very persons from the outrage and violence of the next as-
sassin they meet.
Where governments not only tolerate murder, rapine, thefts,
piracies, conflagrations, with every outrage violating the happi-
ness and safety of society, but are the first to set the example
and to consecrate the atrocity where the people are taught no
one principle of morality or religion where the arts and sciences
are wholly unknown or despised where the umiisernents and
sociabilities of human life are totally disregarded where the
bounties and comforts of nature are rather dispensed with than
Al'l'EMHX. 397
enjoyed, and wlu-iu the ;iiisolute necessaries to existence and the
decorations of life are more scanty and wretched than yet dis-
covered among the rudest set of barbarians extant ; if, from the
experience of the past, expectations of the future are to be formed,
we may safely infer that every vestige of Malay government and
dominion will be ingulfed in the vortex of self and mutual de-
struction. Such a system of society has in itself the seeds of
dissolution, and is rapidly verging to an inherent decay and gen-
eral oblivion, which it will doubtless meet, unless some benefi-
cent power arrest its baneful impetus, and direct its feverish
energies through channels calculated to promote the happiness
and to consolidate the welfare of the inhabitants of these scattered
regions.
Should so fortunate an occurrence ever fall to the lot of Borneo
should a strong and a wise government ever be established on
her shores a government that will religiously respect property
and secure to industry the fruits of her labor that will, by a wise
system of laws, protect the peaceable and punish the violator of
the laws of a well-organized society that will direct their indus-
try to useful purposes, and check their propensities to violence
and plunder such a government, in a short series of years, would
behold, as if by magic, a paradise burst from her wilds, see culti-
vation smile upon her jungles, and hail a vast and increasing
population, blessing the hand that awoke them to life, to happi-
ness, and to prosperity. That so felicitous a change is not the
mere reverie of a glowing imagination, or the sheer effusion of
benevolence alone, is easily demonstrable.
Whoever has seen the Egyptian fertility of the soil, from the
moistness of the climate, the numberless rivers meandering around
and intersecting the country in all directions, with the mild tem-
perature of the climate, from similar causes whoever considers
the vast extent and inexhaustible wealth of her innumerable
mines of pure native gold, her block-tin, her copper, her iron, her
diamonds, &c., her various valuable fisheries of pearl and tripan
whoever views her ports, her harbors, and her productive
shores, at the threshold of the over-teeming population of China,
and at the same moment recollects that the country abounds in
various valuable products in the highest possible estimation, and
of increasing demand in the empire of China, must easily conceive
what a tempting field and rich harvest this land of promise holds
out to their industry and cupidity under such a system of laws
and government as we have deemed a sine qua non.
If, under the present codes of tyranny, oppression, and general
ferocity, where nothing is permanent but violence and desolation
if, under such a system of barbarism, a hundred thousand Chi-
nese (which is the fact) have found inducements sufficiently
strong to settle on her shores, what might we not hope and expect
from the overburdened population of that vast empire under a
happier order of things? The astonishing number of Chinese
settled within a few years at Pulo Pinang, on a contracted soil,
possessing no peculiar advantages but from a free trade and equi-
able laws impartially administered, is both a fact and an illustra-
te L
398 APPENDIX.
tion ; and what might not Borneo hope ibr from a happier soil,
greater inducements, and other physical advantages ? Java, un-
der the despotism of the Dutch, with the character of a sickly
climate, and the remembrance of the cruel massacre of sixty
thousand innocent Chinese, could still boast a hundred thousand
of these people at the period it fell to the British arms ; and withal,
let it he remembered that these shores were once blessed with
the industry of these people to a far greater extent under a hap
pier period of her history.
Whatever, indeed, might prove the work of ages in various
other parts of the globe would, under the present circumstances
of the Chinese empire, be instantaneous on these shores ; and
their habits of industry and civilization, when once rooted to the
soil, would soon spread their genial influence to the extensive
population of the interior, unite them in the bonds of social life,
cement them in the general prosperity, and render these exten
sive shores a valuable appendage and an increasing resource to
the wealth and power that brought about so happy a revolution
in their affairs.
For a considerable series of years past, the piratical ports of
Borneo, &c., have been in the habit of committing depredations
upon the commerce of British India, in the capture of her ships,
the insulting of her flag, the offering of outrageous violence to the
persons and lives of her mariners, merchants, &c., and this, too,
with the most perfect impunity ; no retribution having been ex-
acted, no reprisals made, no remonstrance presented, and, in fact,
no notice taken of their atrocious depredations. Hence these
desperadoes, from inference and experience of the past, have been
led to conclude, that whatever was practicable would be tolerated ;
that wherever they had the means or opportunity of overpowering,
it was their duty, as it was to their advantage, to seize it to their
own use, without any other apprehensions of the consequences
than what might arise in the attempt.
Under this discouraging aspect of affairs, there was but little
more left to the commercial community of India than either to
abandon the valuable commerce of Borneo wholly ; or, if allured
to it by a prospect of gain, to proceed in armed vessels at an
increased expense and high insurance, so as to cover the extra-
ordinary risks. These enhanced prices either operated as a
prohibition to the trade, or circumscribed it so much, that an oc-
casional capture excited no surprise, and was frigidly dismissed
as a matter of course.
But. from the prodigious accession of territorial possession, in-
cluding the whole of the vast Dutch empire in the East, the com-
munications between these and British India have necessarily
increased a thousand fold ; consequently, the recent alarming
depredations upon our commerce, the serious obstacles to a safe
communication, almost tantamount to a blockade of our Eastern
ports by these pirates, imperiously call upon the British Govern-
ment to adopt the most energetic means and decisive measures
to crush their power and annihilate their resources, either by ex-
tirpating them wholly. <>r plarins: UKMII ;md their possessions
\rri.\Mi\. 399
under such future control and checks, as shall prevent the possi-
bility of a revival of a power capable of recurring to enormities
that have so long outraged and disgraced the British flag in the
Eastern seas.
The idea of extirpating whole hordes of piratical states, wc^re it
possible, must, from its cruelty, be incompatible with the liberal
principles and humane policy of a British government. The
simple burning down of a Malay town can prove no serious im-
pediment to future piratical enterprises : constructed, as they are,
of bamboos, mats, and atap leaves, a town is almost rebuilt in the
same period of time as it takes to destroy it. The Dutch, who
had centuries of dear-bought experience, knew there was no other
mode of prevention and radical cure than building small redoubts
at the principal towns, and keeping up an adequate force to check
piratical enterprises, and to turn their restless minds to exertions
of industry ; satisfied if, with the attainment of these objects,
they covered the expenses of the establishment. This is the true
history of the innumerable little forts on Celebes, Borneo, Timor,
and all the Eastern isles.
The principal piratical ports that still exist, beside those of
Lingin, Rhio, and Billiton, are 1st, Pangeran Annam, at Sam-
bas ; 2d, Port Borneo Proper, and four hundred prows at Tampa-
suk, both under the Rajah of Borneo Proper; 3d, the Pasir
pirates ; 4th, the Sulo pirates ; 5th, the Illano, or pirates on the
isle of Magindano.
1 shall, from memory, cite such few of their depredations as I
recollect.
In 1774, says Forrest, the British were expelled from their
infant settlement of Balambangan by an insurrection of the Sulos,
who, finding the garrison weak and sickly, unprepared and off
their guard, murdered and plundered them, and set fire to their
settlement: this was in return for having released their sultan
from prison, and reestablished him on the rnusnud of his ances-
tors. In 1800, Captain Pavin and a boat's crew were cruelly
murdered in the palace of the Sultan of Sulo while the command-
er was drinking a cup of chocolate : they fired upon the ship
Ruby, but did not succeed in capturing her. In 1810, they plun-
dered the wreck of the ship Harrier of a valuable cargo : several
of her crew are still in slavery at Bagayan Sulo. In 1788, the
ship May of Calcutta, 450 tons burden, Captain Dixon, was cut
off at Borneo Proper : they were invited up to the town with the
ship, and while at dinner, the sultan and his people fell upon
them, and murdered Captain Dixon, three officers, and ten Euro-
peans ; the lascars were retained in slavery, the valuable cargo
plundered, and the ship burnt. In 1803 the ship Susanna of Cal-
cutta, Captain Drysdale, was cut off near Pontiana by the Sam-
bas and Borneo pirates ; the Europeans were all massacred, and
the vessel taken. In 1769, Captain Sadler, with his boat's crew,
was murdered by the Sambas pirates off Mompava, having a pro-
digious quantity of gold-dust : they did not succeed in cutting off
the ship. In 1806, Mr. Hopkins and crew, of the Commerce,
were murdered hy the pirates of Borneo Proper . the ship was
400 APPENDIX.
plundered by them and the Sambas pirates. In 1810, Captain
Ross was cut off. In 1811, Captain Graves was cut off by the
Pasir pirates with a rich cargo. In 1812, the enormities of Pan-
geran Annam have out-heroded Herod : these are too recent to
require recapitulation. Independent of his depredations on the
Coromandel, a Portuguese ship, &c., nine Europeans of the Hec-
ate have been seized and made slaves ; two have ben since
murdered ; two have escaped ; and five are hamstrung and other-
wise maimed. Mrs. Ross and her son are still in slavery there.
The Tampasuk pirates, belonging to the Rajah of Borneo Prop-
er, aiding and abetting Pangeran Annam against the English, are
Datu Akop, Datu Aragut, and Datu Jumbarang, with ten large
men-of-war prows: there is also there the Rajah Endut, a Siak
chief.
Matan is under an independent rajah, who was formerly styled
Sultan of Sukadana ; but about seventeen years ago the Dutch
burnt down his city. At length, by some pecuniary aid received
from the late Sultan of Pontiana, he was enabled to reestablish
his affairs as Rajah of Matan ; and, in consideration of this aid,
entered into a treaty of alliance, which stipulated, that on his
daughter's marriage with the grandson of the late, and son of the
present, Sultan of Pontiana, he would cede his kingdom and large
diamond as a marriage-portion : the parties yet remain single.
Under the head mineralogy we have pointed out how valuable a
country this might become under better management. Iron, gold,
tin, and diamonds abound here ; also much wax, pepper, rattans,
garu, and about two piculs of the finest birds'-nests, which sell
at twenty-eight dollars the catty at Pontiana. Most of the trade
finds its way to Pontiana, Benjar, or Java, in prows. The popu-
lation is about ten thousand Dayers, &c.
Sukadana, once the most celebrated city on Borneo, as the
name implies, a terrestrial paradise, the capital of a kingdpm and
a great mart of trade, since burnt down and destroyed by the
Dutch, exhibits nothing but ruins. There still remain number-
less delicious fruit-trees, and a country still susceptible of general
cultivation, being yet clear of jungle and morass. It is utterly
abandoned : that it has not been rebuilt is owing to the Rajah of
Pontiana, at whose suggestion it was destroyed, and whose inter-
est it was to keep it down, having himself risen upon its ashes.
There are no towns of any importance between Matan and
Pontiana. The rise of this dynasty of sultans has been noted in
another place ; it is, however, almost the only power that has
been expressly raised, supported, and that still exists, by com-
merce. It is situated in latitude 4 north of the equator. The
river has two mouths to it ; the northern mouth is the deepest,
the most direct, and of the greatest breadth ; there are in this
branch only two reaches up to the town. The city is no more
than fifteen miles from the mouth of the rivers ; its site is on the
junction of the Matan and Landa rivers. About two-thirds of the
way up it is fortified ; first, with a battery on piles in the center
of the stream, mounting five suns ; on the left bank is another
with woolen pales, mounting likewise live ^\m- . on the
APPENDIX. 401
bank is a third, similar to the foregoing, witli a like number of
cannon ; and, lastly, on the same bank is their grand battery,
constructed of stone, mounting five eighteen-pounders, at the
batu, or rock. Here the mausoleum of the royal family is erected,
containing the tomb of the late sultan. The whole of this side
of the river exhibits the marks of infant cultivation. The jungle
has been, in part, cleared away, and here and there a solitary hut
greets the eye. The sultan's palace has a battery of eleven guns
of all sizes ; none of these are calculated to make any serious
resistance. So sensible is the sultan of this that he has com-
menced staking round with piles a low, swampy island, just
detached from the palace. On this stands the grand mosk. He
proposes throwing mud and stones within the ranges of piles,
and planting upon them the heaviest-calibered cannon : it is a
commanding site, and capable of being rendered formidable*
There are no roads about Pontiana ; the town is situated in the
midst of a swamp, so low that the tide at high water overflows
the lower parts of the houses, and this, with the addition of a
country overrun with impenetrable jungle, renders it extremely
unhealthy, and a most disagreeable residence.
The campo China contains about two thousand souls and lies
on the left bank of the Matan river, abreast of the palace ; the
campo Buguese, on the right bank of the Landa ; and the campo
Malayu adjoins the palace. The whole population is about seven
thousand souls: no Dayers are found hereabout. The whole of
the districts under Pontiana produce about three hundred coyans
of rice, the average selling price of which is from fifty-five to
seventy Spanish dollars the coyan. The king's revenue is forty
thousand dollars per annum. The Chinese plead poverty, but
some of the Buguese are pointed out as wealthy. The quantity
of gold that finds its way to Pontiana is annually from three to
four piculs. The imports there consist of opium, iron, steel, salt,
rice, hardware, cutlery, blue and white gurras, salampories, Java
cloths, gunpowder, beside China produce of all possible descrip-
tions. They make their returns m gold, diamonds, birds'-nests,
wax, rattans, garu, ebony, agar-agar ; beside pepper, sago, cam-
phor, cassia, tripan, &c. brought here by the prows : five Chinese
junks annually visit Pontiana, bringing down produce amounting to
about fifty thousand dollars. The depredations of the Pangeran
Annam prevent an extension of this most useful of all trades to
this country. One or two Siamese junks arrive annually. The
Tringanu, Timbilan, Karimata, and Borneo Proper proVfs trade
here ; and before Java fell to the British arms, the Buguese from
the eastward traded here to a considerable amount.
The stone walls built by the Dutch still encompass the palace.
The piles on which their factory stood are yet discernible, but
the buildings have been pulled down. Should the English hoist
their flag here, a new factory must be erected ; the most eligible
situation for which would be where the mosk now stands, or th
mosk itself might be converted into one, and another rebuilt else-
where ; but to this the sultan has insuperable objections. In an
English fort, to think to have a mosk open to the ingress of a
26 LLl>
402 APPENDIX.
large body of Malays at all times is wholly incompatible with
certain reserve and security required from it. Beside, as the
island is small, and soldiers at times inconsiderate, they might
profane or defile its holy precincts, and thus lay the foundation
of perpetual disputes, or even a serious rupture. The fort and
factory, if built at all at Pontiana, must hence be fixed in some
detached place. The sultan is building a new palace and cover-
ing it with tiles ; a novelty in this quarter. There is but a scanty
supply of fowls and buffaloes, and the necessaries of life are
scarce and dear. It is altogether the most uncouth and dreary
spot under the sun, though the sultan prefers it to Sambas and
Mompava.
Their naval force consists of two small ships, two brigs, fifty
prows large and small, and about one thousand men. There is
water on the bar to admit vessels drawing nine feet water. The
roadstead, with seven fathoms water on it, lies seven miles from
the river's mouth. Care must be taken not to mistake the Pon-
gole river seen from the offing, and which lies ten miles farther
southward. The only stock procurable here were hogs at ten
dollars the picul, and water shipped off in China tank-boats at
four and a half dollars the ton.
The next port is Mompava, about sixteen miles to the north-
ward of Pontiana, and the second port belonging to the sultan.
The river is shallow, narrow, extremely serpentine, and con-
stantly running down with great rapidity. The country around
is a paradise in comparison with Pontiana. It is upon an ele-
vated site, and, wherever the eye reaches, it is clear of jungle,
and of fine rich mold, susceptible of the highest culture. Thepe
is a walk up to the town about eight miles from the mouth of
the river ; here the fishing-stakes nearly extend across the river,
beside two miserable forts, mounting each five or six pounders,
to defend the river. The population is seven thousand meu r
Malays, Buguese, and Dayers, and about two thousand Chinese
Formerly the territory of Mompava extended as far as 1 north
latitude. This territory belonged to a chief or rajah, reduced by
the Dutch twenty-five years ago, shortly after they settled at
Pontiana ; the territory thus conquered was delegated in trust to-
the Rajah of Pontiana. The Sambas rajah has forcibly taken
possession of a part of it. Sultan Kassim. of Pontiana, governed
this district during his father's lifetime. On his accession to the
musnud, five years ago, he placed a half-brother there, a stupid
fellow, about twenty-five years of age. This man, about eight
months ago, was trying to establish his independence, which he
found he could not maintain. It has the same trade as Pontiana,
but the regulations of the sultan do not admit of any vessel's
touching here for that purpose. The palace is extensive, paled-
round with a sort of a fortification. The campo China, in Octo-
ber last, was in part burnt down by the people of Sambas, to the
number of four hundred houses. There is a variety of roads
hereabout ; one leading to Sambas, one to Landa, one to Min-
trada, &c. Groves of norn.-uiiit.-irers mark thr sitr of ancient
villages 'hat ' r "'i'' r ' <'>'
A i-r I:\DIX. 403
superiority and precmiiic nri-, | u inch ii lias been despoiled. In
point of susceptibility of cultivation, it is a full half century be-
forehand with Pontiana ; it is capable of great improvement, and
much grain might be raised with very little trouble.
There is a considerable mud-flat at the mouth of the Sambas
river, extending four or five miles out, but no regular bar. Ves-
sels drawing thirteen feet may get in at high water springs ; nine
feet is the least water, and there is thirteen at the flood. In the
offing there is a rise and fall of seven feet. At the entrance of
the river neither shore must be too closely hugged, having ledges
of rocks near them. Twelve miles above the bar the river branches
into two parts ; the broad or northern branch is called the Borneo
river, having its source in Kiney Baulu ; the other, leading to the
town of Sambas, is named the Landa river, having its source in
the diamond mines ; where these two unite below there was for-
merly a fort. The Landa river is extremely serpentine, deep to
the very bushes on both sides, and quite clear of danger up to the
town, except near Siminis creek, about ten miles below the fort;
here a reef of rocks runs across the stream, and as the fair way
over them is somewhat intricate, the channel ought to be buoyed
before attempted to be passed. The Barracouta, drawing thir-
teen feetjust scraped them at high water.
About five or six leagues up the Landa branch, and about thir-
teen from the sea, stands the town and palace of Sambas, on the
confluence of the Landa and Salako rivers. The fort on the right
bank of the Landa is about a league below the town, built of two
rows of large piles, the interstices being filled up with mud and
stones, apparently mounting five guns, eighteens and twelves in
the lower tier, and an equal number of smaller caliber on the
second or more elevated range. A boom or dam of fishing-stakes
was constructed across the river one-eighth of a mile below the
fort, a large armed prow was moored in the center of the river,
mounting two long twelves, and a masked battery opposite to the
right, the number of guns unknown. The reach which these
forts command is a mile and a half. The land makes an elbow
where these forts are, which obliged the Barracouta to haul
athwart the river, to get her broadside to bear. The whole of
this Landa river is very narrow, but near the forts not one-third
additional to her length. Both sides of this river toward the fort
appear tolerably clear from the mast-head, interspersed with pleas-
ant hills inhabited by the Chinese. The tides are pretty regular,
six hours and six hours, running a knot and a half per hour. This
river is too serpentine and narrow to admit sailing up ; sweeps,
towing, or tiding it up are the only modes that can be resorted to.
The great branch of Borneo river, before mentioned, when up it
twenty miles, divides into two ; the branch running north being
called' Tampasan river, the other still retaining the name of Bor-
neo. The Tampasan branch leads to old Sambas ; it is from
hence they get their supplies of rice and provisions, by the two
cuts above the town of Sambas, which reunites the Landa and
Borneo streams. There are roads from the great branch leading
to the town, fort, and palace. Since the Dutch abandoned Sam-
404 APPENDIX.
has, three sultans have reigned on this rnusnud (within fifty years,
or thereabout). There are lour Pangerans, Annam being the most
daring of the whole. His naval force consists of the Portuguese
ship of 400 tons, one brig, and eight or ten large fighting prows,
beside his allies from Borneo Proper, with ten large prows. The
population amounts to twelve thousand Dayers and Malays, and
thirty thousand Chinese.
Under the head mineralogy we have given a detailed account
of the principal sources of its industry. Sambas produces, be-
side gold, ten piculs of birds'-nests annually (of an inferior qual-
ity), much ebony, rattans, wax, &c. The trade here is much the
same as at Pontiana, and susceptible of a tenfold increase : it is
every way superior to the latter for the capital of a large mart.
The country is better cleared, and hence susceptible of more easy
cultivation ; the land more elevated and less swampy, conse-
quently healthier ; the river deeper and farther navigable ; the
population more dense, and, the land being clear of jungle, more
capable of being increased. Beside, it is the vicinage of the most
considerable gold-mines on all Borneo. The Sultan of Pontiana
would make it his capital if desired ; his apprehensions of the
power of the Sambas princes lead him to give the preference to
Pontiana.
The town of Calaca, belonging to the Rajah of Borneo Proper,
lies north of Tanjong Datu ; it is the principal port of trade south
of the capital, and the mart of the Sedang country. Here much
grain is produced, one hundred piculs of black birds'-nests, two
hundred piculs of wax, some gold, pepper, camphor, &c., but the
tin-mines, before mentioned, are utterly neglected. There are
several other towns upon each of the rivers along this coast ; the
principal ones are Salat, Bacalo, Pasir, and Baram. They pro-
duce nearly the same articles as the above, which are, however,
sent on to the capital as fast as collected.
It is here necessary to observe, that all the rocks and shoals
laid down on this coast do not exist at all ; such as Volcano
Island, the Byhors, Krenpel, the whole Slykenburgh, five Coma-
das, &c. Having beat up this coast twice, and carefully surveyed
the whole, I can declare a finer and clearer coast does not any-
where exist. The old chart, published by A. Dalrymple, is much
more correct than the recent ones. The numbers of immense
drifts and floating isles hereabout must have given birth to all
these imaginary dangers.
The town of Borneo Proper, the capital of the kingdom of the
same name, lies in latitude 5 7' north ; it is situated fifteen miles
up one of the finest rivers in the world, with three fathoms low
water on the bar, and a rise and fall of fifteen feet. A correct
plan of the river and town is published by Mr. Dalrymple. Here
are mud docks for vessels of 500 or 600 tons. The town consists
of about three thousand houses, built on stakes, in the middle of
the river, with a population altogether of fifteen thousand souls,
Chinese, Malays, Moruts, &c.
The palace is slightly fortified ; but the Rajah of Pontiana says,
the Rajah of Borneo Proper is preparing the means of defence,
APPENDIX. 405
apprehending the resentment of the English in vindicating the
rights of their flag, so frequently insulted by them with impunity ;
however, as there is sufficient water for a line-of-battle ship to
the city, nothing need be apprehended from them. The remains
of a stone fort up the river are still seen, but the one on Puk)
Laboan is destroyed. Both banks of the river are planted with
pepper, which formerly produced sixty thousand piculs annually ;
these are now running to decay from want of commerce. The
Chinese junks, for years past, have ceased touching here, from
the numberless piratical depredations committed upon them ; and
the Portuguese from Macao have attempted to renew the trade
from time to time, but at length, in 1808, their agent withdrew to
Macao, a large ship having been cut off and the crew murdered
the year preceding. They now have no other resource but piracy ;
and the produce, such as it is, finds its way in prows toTringan,
Sambas, Pontiana, Lingin, and Malacca. Very large quantities
of the finest camphor in the world are procurable here ; it comes
down from the Morut country, by the great river ; a great deal of
wax, some gold, much birds'-nests of an inferior quality, any
quantity of sago, cassia, clove-bark, pepper, betel-nut, rattans,
camphor-oil, &c., tripan, tortoise-shell, &c.
The hills hereabout are clear of jungle, and wear a beautiful
appearance, and, without the aid of history, bear evident marks
of a more extensive population and culture. There are plenty of
black cattle, buffaloes, goats, fruits and vegetables of all kinds,
abundance and variety of fish, turtle, &c. The articles best
suited for this market are coarse China, white cangyans, brass
plates, China crockery, brass wire, tea, sugar-candy, coarse China
silks and satins, blue and white coarse guras and salampories,
coarse ventipallam handkerchiefs, arcot chintzes, iron and steel,
quallies, cooking utensils, and other articles suited to a Malay
market all coarse ; no opium. The Borneo catty is two and a
half Ibs.
The English have been very desirous of a port in the China
seas for ages past, but have generally appeared to stumble on the
most unhealthy and ill-adapted places possible, such as Balam-
bangan, Pulo Condore, &c. ; and even the principal object of
Lord Macartney's embassy was the obtaining of a cession of this
nature. But if a capital harbor, a navigable and majestic river, a
productive country, a healthy site, population ready formed, and
a commerce all sufficient to pay the expenses of an establishment
(within one hundred miles of Balambangan) is required, the East
India Company ought to have pitched upon Borneo Proper. It
was once a most flourishing country, and a very short period un-
der British auspices would render it the first mart in the East for
China-Malayan commerce. There are large, populous towns of
Morals, and Orang Idan, who abhor the Malays, but who would
be soon reconciled to a milder and less traitorous government.
Kimanis lies in latitude 5 8' north ; this is the first port on
this coast ceded to the English by the Sultan of Sulo. The
town lies ten miles up the river, at the foot of some of the most
beautiful hills I ever saw, and is inhabited by thirty-five thousand
400 Ai'
Orang Man. , , ;uui a,.i>oi.l choked up at the
mouth. This province has the following sea-ports in it, viz.,
Kimaijis, Benouie, Papal, and Pangaiat, each governed by Orang
Kayas, which still continue to send their produce to Borneo Proper,
consisting of ten piculs of bmls'-nests annually, two hundred pi-
culs of wax, two piculs of camphor, and cassia, sago, betel-nut,
and pepper, as much as required; tripan, camphor-oil, and rice;
with fruit, fish, and provisions, of sorts which are cheap and plen-
tiful. The articles mentioned as fit for Borneo answer here, only
their produce is had about fifty per cent cheaper.
The province of Kiney Baulu has the following seaports :
Putatan, Mangatal, Innanam, Labatuan, Mangabong. Tawaran,
Sulaman, Ambung, Abai, Tampasuk, and Padasan. The whole
of this province is tremendously high. The stupendous moun-
tain of Kiney is about fifteen miles from Tampasuk, which at
present is the most considerable pirate-port in the Malay seas,
and belongs to the Rajah of Borneo Proper. The pirates frequent-
ing this place have committed such depredations hereabout as
to have induced the English to call the north of Borneo Pirates'
Point. These desperate banditti originally resided at Tawaran,
but were compelled to leave it from the resentment of whole
tribes of Orang Idan. The whole of this province is very fertile ;
it is the source of all the great rivers on the island, and is more
populous with the aborigines of the country than perhaps the
rest of the island put together. The gold mines of Tampasuk
have been mentioned ; there are also mines of rock-crystal. Ta-
waran and several other places abound in goats and cattle. Abai
has a small harbor, and the whole of this coast is accurately laid
down by Lieutenant James Burton, in the sloop Endeavor.
There are produced in this province much wax, tortoise-shell,
very fine camphor, sago, rattans, and a red birds'-nest (which
comes from Mantanane isle to Pandasan). They send their prod-
uce to Borneo Proper. The pirates are commanded by Datus
from Borneo Proper. The lake in the vicinity of Kiney Baulu is
said to be delightful ; it is many miles in circumference, well
cultivated, populous, and productive. It is said to be very cold,
from the extreme elevation, and the inhabitants are almost as fair
as Europeans. There is a valuable coral-tree somewhere here-
about.
The Bay of Maludu, on the north of Borneo, is thirty miles in
length, and from four to six in breadth, with numberless rivers
flowing into it. There is no danger on the right-hand shore going
up, but what is seen; on the larboard shore considerable coral-
reefs are met with. Laurie and Whittle's chart of it is tolerably
correct. The principal towns are, Sungy Bassar, nearly at the
head of tho bay, and Bankaka, en the left ; the former, under
Sheriff Mahomed, sends its produce to Sulo ; the latter, under
Orang Kayas, trades with Borneo Proper. The British, when last
at Balambangan, threw up a small redoubt on the Bankaka side,
with a view to supplies of rice and provisions ; and this part is
tranquil and a good roadstead, boinij sheltered from the swell
brought in by the sea-breeze.
APPENDIX. 407
The rich and valuable fishery of copis or Ceylon oyster in thia
oay has been mentioned ; it might be rendered of considerable
value. The whole of the rivere lor miles up abound in rattans ;
Mr. A. Dalrymple thinks four thousand tons might be easily cut
down every year without exhausting it, and sent by junks to
China. There are forests of beautiful pines of stately growth,
well calculated for the largest masts, and in high esteem at China.
There is no quarter of the world which abounds more in that
species of the sea-turtle (called by the Malays pakayan) which
yields the shell ; any quantity may be had on all the shores and
isles of this bay.
The interior abounds in camphor, which can be had in any
quantities ; so vastly abundant is it, and so little does the Orang
Idan know of the extreme value of this commodity, that a bamboo
of camphor may be procured in exchange for a bamboo of salt.
The petty towns are Sandeck, Bowengun, Patasan, Pone, and
Milawi. It produces in one year two hundred piculs of wax,
fifty piculs of tortoise-shell, ten piculs of best camphor, and as
much inferior ; ten piculs of birds'-nests, at ten dollars the catty ;
1st camphor, twenty-five ; rattans, one dollar per picul ; tortoise-
shell, one dollar the catty ; wax, twenty the picul. Articles re-
quired are the same as at Borneo Proper. Rice, provisions, fish,
and fruits are abundant and cheap ; the sugar-cane also.
The province of Paytan is the principal district for camphor of
any in the world. Whole forests for miles everywhere meet the
eye, and the produce from them is the finest that can be conceived,
large and transparent as Chin-chew sugar-candy. The principal
towns are Pitan, Kinarubatan, Kulepan, and the famous town of
Sugut. The coast is so full of coral-reefs, and has been so very
indifferently surveyed, that it is only frequented by prows ; there
is a road from Sugut to Bankaka in Maludu Bay. Much wax,
tripan, sago, &c., is produced here.
Labuk has the towns of Camburcan, Labuk, and Songsohi ; its
produce is somewhat similar to that of Paytan, with the addition
of clove-bark and birds'-nests.
Sandakan. This celebrated harbor has been already mentioned
as one of the finest in the world. The towns within it are Tow-
sam, Duyom, Lu, Bukean, Dom or Doung, Seagally-hood and
Tong luly luku ; all these are governed by Datus from Sulo, who
have expressly settled here to collect the prodigious quantities of
birds'-nests abounding in this district. They are procured here
at ten dollars the catty, and sent to Sulo, with tripan, wax, &c.
The Sulos are very jealous of any ships going in here, and will
leave no attempt untried in cutting off a vessel going in, although
an English port.
In the province of Mangidora lies the great river Kinnabatin-
gan, which is navigable a vast way up, with several towns of
Orang Idan on its shores. The other towns are Salasany Supa-
buacul, Tambesan, which forms also an elegant harbor, Laboan
or Sabpan, Tuncu, Salurong, Giong, and Maday, which has a
gold-mine, before mentioned. The whole of this province, it is
aid, will produce above one hundred piculs of the finest birds'
108 APPENDIX.
nests, much black ditto, some camphor, tripan, honey, wax, dam-
mer. Bum mats, fine spars ; sago and pepper were formerly largely
cultivated here. The pearl-banks of Tawi Tawi have been men-
tioned.
Tirun. The sea-ports of this last mentioned and valuable prov
ince, ceded to the English by the Sulos, are chiefly inhabited by
Buguese people. The towns are Sibuku, Sambakung, Leo or
Lcdong, Sikatak, Sabellar, Kuran or Barrow, Talysion Dumaung,
Tapeandurian. The principal ports are Kuran and Sibuku ; they
produce a large quantity of very fine white birds'-nests, a quantity
of black ditto, much dammer, sago, tripan, wax, rattans, carn-
phor, honey, Bum mats, gold, &c. The people of Tapeandurian
are represented as very ferocious, and the sea-coast hereabout
requires surveying.
The ports of Pasir and Coti originally belonged to the King of
Benjarmasing; very fine birds'-nests are procured here at twenty
dollars the catty; much gold, tripan, wax, &c.
Were Borneo to be settled, I think the principal factory ought
to be at Borneo Proper ; the second at Sambas ; the third at Ben-
jarmasing ; the fourth at Pasir ; the fifth at Tabesan or Sandakan.
In looking over the map of the world, it is a melancholy reflec-
tion to view so large a portion of the habitable globe as all Bor-
neo abandoned to barbarism and desolation ; that, with all her
productive wealth and advantages of physical situation, her valu-
able and interesting shores should have been overlooked by all
Europeans ; that neither the Dutch nor the Portuguese, with cen-
turies of uncontrolled power in these seas, should have shed a
ray of civilization on shores bordering upon their principal settle-
ments ; that her ports and rivers, instead of affording a shelter to
the extensive commerce of China, should at this enlightened pe-
riod of the world hold out only terror and dismay to the mariner ;
and that all that she should have acquired from the deadly vicin-
age and withering grasp of Dutch power and dominion has been
the art of more speedily destroying each other, and rendering
themselves obnoxious to the rest of mankind. Now that her des-
tinies are transferred to the enlightened heads and liberal hearts
of Englishmen, now that her fortunes are embarked under the
administration of a wise and liberal government, we may confi-
dently hope that a happier order of things will, under the bless-
ing of an all-ruling Providence, speedily restore these extensive
shores to peace, to plenty, and to commerce ; and we ardently
trust that another age may not be suffered to pass away without
exhibiting something consolatory to the statesman, the philoso-
pher, and the philanthropist.
APPENDIX. 409
No. V.
Extracts from the late Mr. Williamson's Journal.
IN October, 1845, Mr. Brooke commissioned some of the Euro-
pean gentlemen of his party to make a tour of inspection through
the outlying Dyak tribes dependent on Sarawak, for the purpose
of ascertaining their condition and prospects, and taking steps for
the redress of any grievances of which they might have to com-
plain. A few extracts from the rough journal kept on that occa-
sion by Mr. Williamson may not be uninteresting to the reader,
as showing what a large measure of success had already attended
Mr. Brooke's wise and earnest efforts to restore peace and plenty
to the poor persecuted Dyaks ; what incessant vigilance on his
part was still requisite to check the inveterate propensity of the
knavish Malays to plunder and oppress them ; and with what
well-directed activity he pursues his labors for the physical wel-
fare and the moral regeneration of his subjects and neighbors.
" Wednesday, Oct. 8th. At 11 A.M. arrived at Pankalum Bunt-
ing, where we found about thirty Dyaks in a small hut ready to
welcome us, and carry our luggage up to the village. At one
o'clock started for the Bakar village, about five miles from the
landing place, at the foot of the Sadong hills. This tribe con-
sists of one hundred families, occupying four villages. There are
about twenty-five houses in Mungu Babi (i. e. Hog Hill), the vil-
lage where we are at present, and five padi stores. It is very
recently that the Dyaks have ventured to store their padi in
houses. At 8 P.M. attended the feast given in our honor, where
we saw the women dancing ; they appeared very happy, and
pleased to see us.
" 9th. This morning we had all the Orang Kayas of the four
villages, who informed me they were very comfortable and happy.
I told them the object of my mission, at which they all seemed
pleased, and said that if they were oppressed they would come to
Sarawak and complain to the Tuan Besar. When I asked them
about the Sadong Dyaks, they said 1 should hear all when I met
them, as they will hide nothing from me.
" The only thing these Dyaks complain of is, that Nakodah
Mahomed told them he had the Tuan Besar's chop, and gave
them to understand that the powder, muskets, &c., in his pos-
session, belonged to the Tuan Besar ; in consequence of which
they carried these goods for Nakodah Mahomed without receiv-
ing any payment for their labor. I told them that in future they
need not carry goods for any man coming from Sarawak, or else-
where, without due payment in ready money ; and that should
traders at any time leave their goods in the Dyak houses, they
need not be alarmed, but bring the goods to the Tuan Besar and
tell him how they were left behind. They further told me thai
the Siringi wish to claim their siri cave, where they get their
birds'-nests, which is close to Kumpung, and has belonged to them
as long as they can remember ; that this cave is a whole lay's
MM
410 APPENDIX.
journey from Siring how, then, can it belong to the Sinngi?
answered, that on my return the Tuan Besar would set the mat
ter right, and give the cave to its proper owners.
" Same day. Proceeded to Jinan, about eight miles distant
There are here fifteen houses, and the Dyaks are very comforta-
ble, having plenty of grain, and being well off for sugar-cane,
sweet potatoes, plantains, betel-nut, beside various other fruit-
trees. The houses here, as at Mungu Babi, are very shabby.
" 10th. This morning met Orang Kaya Kusunan, who told me
the Toup Dyaks were waiting half way to receive us. At 4 P.M.
1 had the Orang Kaya Turnangong of Toup, and the Orang Kaya
of Kurran, Si Labi, Si Mabong, Daah, Bugu (Sadong tribes), and
the Orang Kaya Pasunan, beside other Dyaks, the Bandar Cas-
sim, with his Sadong Malays, ami our own people, at the house
where I was staying. I explained my mission to them, and made
them understand that, at the Bandar's express wish, the Tuan
Besar had sent me to them to ascertain their condition. The
Bandar then told them it was his wish to institute the same laws
and customs as at Sarawak ; after which, I informed the Dyaks
that there will be no more forcing of goods on them at exorbitant
prices, and that for the future, should any one ' serra' them, they
must complain to the Bandar, and subsequently lay their case
before Mr. Brooke. The conference, I am glad to say, ended to
every one's satisfaction.
" At 8 P.M. the Orang Kaya Rih and two others of the same
tribe complained to me of their grievances, and told me that Si
' Tore, a Sadong man, had forced 10 pieces of iron, weighing 15
catties, on them about two years and a half ago, and that he now
demanded 100 pasus of padi for it. (This is serra with a ven-
geance : 100 pasus are equal to 2 tons weight !) They had paid
10 pasus ; should they, they asked me, pay the rest ? 1 told them
I would settle the business at Bandar Cassim's village.
" llth. The Dyaks gave us a feast last night; the women
danced and the merriment was kept up till morning. At 11 start-
ed in boats with Bandar Cassim, and at 2 P.M. arrived at his vil-
lage* called * * *, where every thing had been got ready for our
reception ; a house was well fitted with gay curtains and mats,
and after a salute of three guns as we approached, we took up our
residence and made ourselves very comfortable. At 7 in the
evening we met all the respectable part of the community of this
little Malay village. I told them what I was sent for, the Bandar
as usual giving way to our wishes, and repeating that Sanuuk
and Sadpng, and Sadong and Sarawak, were as one country. I
told Si Tore, Sebi Gani, and Sirdeen, that they must make no
further demands on the Rih Dyaks, and that neither they nor any-
body else could serra the Dyaks any longer not even the .'
himself; for they must recollect that the Sadong Dyaks would
take refuge in Sarawak if oppressed.
" After the Bandar had left, the brother-in-law of the Orang
* The MS. having been under water in thr; wreck of ilie Great Liver
pool steamer, this name and some other* nre illegible.
APPKNUIX. U 1
Kaya oi Sinkaru, together with the Orang Kaya of Si Nankau
Kujang, and Orang Kaya Kurang, came to me. The former ot
these complained that Abang Tahar (the old Patingi's son-in-
law), about two years ago, forced a small tatawak* and one brass
dish on them, for which he demanded three Dyaks as slaves,
whom he sn/.rd at the tune and took away, and that now he de-
iiKindod another Dyak boy. I replied they were on no account to
comply, that they must complain to the Bandar ; and if he took
no notice of it, to go to Sarawak to the Tuan Besar.
" The Orang Kaya likewise told me that formerly there were
twenty-five families in his tribe, but now they were reduced to
fifteen, the rest having been seized and sold into slavery ! (Here
follow other complaints. The day's journal concludes thus :)
The Smkaru Dyaks have not yet returned to their former Turn-
bawong.t but are scattered about in the jungle and very poorly
off. I told them to return to their former place of residence, and
to collect the tribes there.
" Sunday, 12th.Or*ng Kaya Si Rubin and Orang Kaya Signa
Mantay, of Kubin, likewise came to me to say that they were
scattered, some at * * *, some at Bedope, and some at Kubin,
and all badly off for grain. When collected, they have about
thirty families ; formerly they had about fifty. Those missing
had mostly been seized and made slaves. At II 1 ' 30 ra we started
for * * * (part of Rubin tribe), where we arrived about half-
past two. . We found one house with five families in it, and a
PangahJ attached. Pa Rigan, the * * * of this tribe, told me
that Abang Tahar, Abang Ally, Abang Bakar, &c. &c. (all of
Gadong, under Patingi Miiel), demand from the Dyaks old serras,
which have been paid long ago. Dangon, a Sirkaru Dyak, told
me that Abang Tahar, a short time since, demanded from his
tribe a Dyak boy, and four Dyak boys from the En Singi Dyaks.
Bandar Cassim put a stop to these demands at the time, but he
has revived them since. The Malays of Sadong, whenever they
go among the Dyaks, seize their fowls, eggs, rice, cocoa-nuts,
and all sorts of property. The Bandar tells me he never permits
these people to go among the Dyaks, but that they do it by stealth
over land, and that the Tuan Besar must do something to prevent
them from oppressing and frightening the Dyaks. (Here follow
other complaints against the Gadong people, after which the
journal continues.)
" 13th. Girang, a Bedope Dyak of the Rubin tribe, told me
how very much he is bullied and troubled by the Gadong people,
who are constantly threatening to attack him. I advised him to
collect the tribe at Rubin, their old Tumbawong. At 7 started
back for the Bandar's village, where we arrived at 10 o'clock.
After a bath and breakfast, the Bandar's mother came to me with
a present of two sarongs, one for the Tuan Besar and one for
myself, and begged that I would urge the Tuan Besar to take
* A sort of gong.
t Tumbuwong is a place they ijave deserted, or been forced to quit.
i A head-house
412 APPENDIX.
care of the Bandar as Jt he were his own son, and not to cast
him off. I told her that Mr. Brooke would support the Bandar
as long as he conducted himself properly. The Orang Kaya
Baga, Orang Kaya Sinching of Milikin, * * * of En Tayen,
Orang Kaya Laja of Rahmone, Orang Kaya Rinjou of Sirkaru,
Orang Kaya Mior Muntah, Pangara Lilli of Bunan, Orang Kaya
Nijou of Mapuh, Orang Kaya Ganggong of En Kelas, and Pan-
gara Achong of En Singi, all met me. I told them the object ol
my mission in presence of the Bandar and several other Malays,
and they were highly delighted. They asked me to allow the
Bandar to govern them, as they are much troubled by the Ga-
dong people. Abang Tahar lately demanded four Dyak boys of
Pangara Achong, and two from the Orang Kaya of Sirkam ; be-
side which, the Sadong people seize their property whenever they
go among them. They are very poorly off for grain. They asked
me for a letter which should prevent people from annoying them.
I told them I should represent the matter to the Tuan'Besar, and
that no doubt he will give his chop to each tribe. They all speak
well of Bandar Cassim; but his people are bad, and those at
Gadong* are worse.
" 14^. At 6 b 30 m started up the river Kayan toward Tumma,
having left Talip with nineteen men to return to Sarawak by way
of Samarahan. At 8 we stopped at Mang-garut, where the Dyaks
presented us with a deer they had caught. These Dyaks are
badly off for grain, and it is the same tribe Bandar Cassim attacked
in the Goa Siri (sir! cave) some few years ago. Orang Kaya Pa
Jampat told me, that on that occasion the Bandar seized eight
Dyaks and took them with him.f The river here begins to be
narrow and shallow, with pebbly banks, and clear water. At
noon we stopped at Muara Rubin, where we intended to stay a
day to inquire for coal, which was stated to have been found in
this neighborhood ; but as nobody knew the whereabout, and as
the Hindoo remains (said to consist of one stone in the shape of
a Malay hat) were five hours out of our way, we continued our
route till evening, having parted company with the Bandar at
Muara Rubin, as I well knew the Tumma Dyaks would be afraid
of his approach.
" 15th. At daylight started toward Tumma, and at 9 stopped
below Muora Sangan, where we breakfasted, after which we
pushed up again, and at 1 arrived at Si Sijack, where the Tumma
are. Orang Kaya Pa Muany, the chief, told me they were very
much bullied, as a Sarawak man, named Pakar, and Marrat, the
father-in-law of Bandar Mulana of Sarawak, forced upon them a
quantity of goods in the name of the Tuan Besar and the Bandar
Mulana. (Here follows a list of things, such as gongs, tatawaks,
jackets, handkerchiefs, and the like, with the most exorbitant
prices affixed to them. The rice and padi had not, however,
been paid for.) There are three villages of this tribe ; two about
* Gadong is a small Malay village on the Sadong, considerably nearer
the sea than the Bandar's village.
t This occurred during SeriiTSahib's time ; the Dyaks were frightfully
oppressed.
413
250 yards apart ; one oi winch, containing about ten families, is
ruled by the Orang Kaya Pa Muany, and the other, with about
thirty families, by the Orang Kaya Mayo and the Orang Kaya Pa
Balet. In the other village, about three reaches above, is the
Orang Kaya Pa Magong, with ten families. They said they were
very comfortable under the Patingi Ali (father of the present
Bandar Mulana}, but that since Bandar Mulana has succeeded,
they have been oppressed. They told me they had run away
from Sadong because they heard the Tuaa Besar was a just and
good rajah, and that ail his Dyaks were comfortable, but now
they are oppressed. Pakar told them that if they did not take
his tatawaks they must not remain here, but run away !
" There are forty families of the Si Nangkan Soyar tribe, and
thirteen families of the Tibader tribe. The Orang Kayas told
me that, had I not arrived, the rice in payment of the goods forced
on them would have been taken down, as Pakar was here hurry-
ing them to carry it to Sanar ; but that when he heard of my
coming he could not be persuaded to wait and meet me. The
following goods have just been returned by the Gregan Dyaks
(here follows a long list of goods and prices). Pangara Achong
of the En Singi tribe told me that he has one family of his tribe
at Gregan, and he wanted them to return with him. I asked the
Pangara of Gregan whether this family wished to return, but he
did not know. I then told them no one could force them, but
that they might do just as they pleased. The Orang Kaya Pa
Jampat goes down with me to Kuching to lay before the Tuan
Besar a claim made upon him by the Malay Pangeran of Samar-
ahan. Beside which, I take down the Orang Kaya and Pangara
of Tumma, Si Markan Singan and Tebadu, together with all the
goods forced on them, that the case may be judged by the Tuan
Besar.
" Bandar Cassim demands a debt of the Orang Kaya Pa Muany
of Tumma; he originally sold them (i. e. forced on them, of
course) a gong for 150 pasus of padi, 100 of which was paid ; and
the question is, whether they were to pay the rest. This was
four years ago. I left it for the Tuan Besar's decision." (Here
follows a list of goods forced on the Tebadu Dyaks.)*
* The goods brought down by Mr. Williamson were on a public trial
confiscated, and the parties concerned fined. Tliese Dyaks, from their
distance and timidity, were afraid to complain, but will in future not be
imposed upon. It would be a hopeless task trying to prevent the Malays
playing their tricks on the Dyaks ; and the only chance of freeing the
Dyaks from these exactions is by inspiring them with confidence. In
Sarftwak this has been done, and may easily be extended ; for the Dyak,
though greatly depressed by a course of persecution, 1 have always found
ready to state his complaints whenever he has a hope of redress. The
Orong Kaya Pa Jampat of Mang-garut was freed of the debt claimed by
the Samsirahan Pangara ; and the other complaints referred to my de-
cision have been either rectified, or steps taken to do justice, and to render
the Dyak tribes of Sadong happy and easy. JVofe by Mr, Brooke.
THE END.
<D
O-
CD
oo
tr-
io
oi
I
<S
o
0)
O
PQ
O
Pi
Unryersify of Toronto
Library
DO NOT
REMOVE
THE
CARD
FROM
THIS
POCKET
Acme Library Card Pocket
Liider Pa'. "Ret. Index File"
Made by LIBRARY BUREAU